• 01ces INTERVIEWING AND COUNSELLING SKILLS FOR CANADIANS SEVENTH EDITION BOB SHEBIB This ]Xlge in1en1ionally left blank This document was created using Kindle to PDF github.com/pustaks/kindle-to-pdf If you found it helpful, please consider uploading your resources to Libgen or Z-Library Seventh Canadian Edition Choices Interviewing and Counselling Skills for Canadians Bob Sh ebib Facull)' Emerit11s Douglas College @ Pearson PC"arson Canad:a Inc.• 26 Prin« Andre\\· Place. North \'or\. Ontario ~1.3C 2H4. CoP)-riarht O 2020. 201 i. 201+ Pe:auon Can:ad., Inc. All riarht,. rntt'\'ed. Printed in the United S tate$ of America. Thi:1 public:ation i, pmttt.ted ~· cop)Tight, and permiuion ,00.UL:1 be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited rq,mduttion. :1tor.15,e in :a rl'tric\'lll $)'.$1:l'm. o r tr.m,mi.ssion in any form o r by :any mean~ d«tronk. m«h.:anic:d. photoco~·inar,. r«ordins, o r othc-no.·i:1e. For inform:ation rl'sardins pC"rmi.ssion~ rcque.$1: formit and the appwpriatt' conta~ pka$C' contact Pl"ar.ion Canada•, Rights and Pnmiuion:1 Oepartmt'nt b}· vi:1itin1 pear.ion.com/eJC"n/contact-uJpc-rmiu-ionithtml. •·w•·· Attrib ution, of th ird,pany contt:nt appe"ar on the appropriate' pll,iC' •·ithin the tt'xt. PEARSON is an exdu,ive tndemar\. mo.-ned h,· Pt"arson Can:ad:a Inc .• or it, :afli.liate$ in Canada :andfor o thc-r countric,. U nk" o thc-rwi,c- indicated hc-n-in. :any third p.:art)' tr.tdemarb th.:at may appear in this \\'OC'k ate' the- propc-rt)' of the-it respective ovtnt'u :and any rd't'n-n«, to third p.:art)' tr.Ide.marks, lo10~ o r othc-r tr...:k dtl'$$ :an- for dc-mon:1tr.1ti\'C' oc Je,criptive purpo$C':1 onJy. S uch rd't:n-n«:1 :an- not intt:ndW to imp ly any :1ponsorship. c-ndoc:IC'mt'nt. autho rCation . oc promotion of PC"arson Can ad:a products ~· the mo.-nt"u of ,uch m.:arb. or :any n-latioruhip he'!t\Oo"N"n the ov.T'IC'r and Pt"arson Can ad:a o r it, :afli.liatt'~ :author,, li«rutt,. or distrib uto rit If you purch:a,cd this~ ouuidc- tht" United State, o r Can ad:a. you should be avr.are that it has bttn imponed ,,dthout the- a pprm·al of the p ubli:1hc-r or the :author. ISBN 13: 9?S..0..ll-484248,6 20 Libr.uy :md Archive, C-1nad.:i Cat:alOJUinar in Public:ation She-bib , Bob, author Choice, : intt'r,•it'wins and coun,c-lli"i, s:kill:1 for Can.;tdian, /Bob She-bib . - Se\'C'nth edition. ISBN 9?S..0..ll-4842.fs..6 (,oftrn,·t'r) 1. Coun$C'linJ"'Textboob. 2. lntt'rYic-•·inJ"'T t'xtbook,. 3. Textbook,. I. Tide. 8F636.6 .S48 2019 158.3 @ Pearson C201S..90364S.I For my children and grandchildren., Ke•vin, Jodie, Eli, and Audrey. iii This ]Xlge in1en1ionally left blank Chapter Professional Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self.Awareness Chapter 2 The Skills, Process, and Pitfalls of Counselling 33 Chapter 3 Relationship: The Foundation for Change 66 Chapter 4 Listening & Responding: The Basis for Understanding 95 Chapter 5 Asking Questions: The Search for Meaning 126 Chapter 6 Empathic Coonectioos 161 Chapter 7 Supporting Empowerment and Change 192 Chapter 8 Difficult Situations: Engaging with Hard. to-Reach Clients 235 Chapter 9 Mental Disorders and Substance Misuse 271 Chapter 10 Cultural Intelligence 310 Chapter 11 Neuroscience and Counselling 342 • This ]Xlge in1en1ionally left blank Preface xiii Acknou-iedgme-nu Trauma-lnfo1med Practice xxiii BRAIN BYTE Trauma BRAIN BYTE Strqths·Based Counselling Professional Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 1 LEARNING OBJECTIVES Relationship Issue!? 3 Dual Rebtionship!l 5 Pro(es!lional Bound2de!l ConOdent iality 6 5 CONVERSATION l.l G~Hu mour 11 Ett.cs and Neuoscience 11 CONVERSATION 2.4 Resruiog and Supporting 15 The Compttent Counseuo, 16 18 18 2 De:Onition Cart Roge,s and the Core Conditions 28 29 32 CONVERSATION 3.2 Genuineness Counselling Contracts 68 69 33 Choices: The Need fo1 Versatlllty 36 Brie( Eneounter!l 3S 73 74 76 INTERVIEW 3.1 Conlractiog 3·3 36 79 Ena,aain¥ with Seniors 3S 73 73 Purpose o( Contraeth1¥ Relationship Contr2Cts Antieip,:nory Contr3ets Work Contr3ets I f Counselling and the Brain Music 68 Relationship and the Phases o( Counsellina CONVERSATION 3.1 Uncondi!ional PosiM Regard 34 CONVERSATION 2.1 Cooosellingand Psychotherapy em 67 71 Core Condit ions: ltnplieat.Ons for Counse1lors Whal Is Couns.ellfna? BRAIN 66 67 BRAIN BYTE Oxylocin 26 LEARNING OBJECTIVES em 66 66 The Counselling Relatfonsblp The Skills, Process, and Pitfalls of Counselling 33 BRAIN Relationship: The Foundation for Change BRAIN BYTE The Brainoo Rela1ionship The lmpor121l«' o( SeJ(,Aware1lt".$$ 20 lnere:asina Sel(,Aw:1reness 2 1 Who A1n I! How Do O ther!? See Me-! 22 Penonal Needs 23 Penonal and C uh ural V2lue!l 25 Sumtn2r)' Exereises Weblinb 62 20 20 Professional Survival 3 LEARNING OBJECTIVES CONVERSATION 1.4 I'm Just a Be.gimer Selt-Awa,eness 57 Sunun:l.r)' 64 Exerd.ses 64 Weblinks 65 13 CONVERSATION 1.2 Personal Feel~Ge'li'llheWa,; CONVERSATION 1.3 Personal lrr.dvement 'Mlh Clents SO 53 Client ¼riab1es 58 Counsellor V2riables 58 Common ?l.•Hstakes 59 11 Ob,eet ivity 50 COunselllng Ptualls.: Banlers to Success Tn~so( EthicaJ 01lenunas 12 Reso1vina Ethkal Dile.nunas 12 em The PrelimiMr)' Phase 46 The 8¢innin~ Phase 53 The Aetion Phase 56 The End in¥ Phase 57 8 11 BRAIN BYTE Ett.cal and Moral Oecisi:)n Maq BRAIN 47 CONVERSATION 2.3 Should I Read the File? 8 Belie( in the Oiiflhy and Worth o( People Client Sel(,Detenninaoon 9 Ethical Dilemmas The Phases of Counselling CONVERSATION 2.2 ~ ul Friends and Counsellors ValuH fo, Profeulonal Practice R~ts o( ChiJdren 41 Relationship,BuiJdu~ Skills 43 Explorin~ and Probi~ Skills 45 Ernpowerina Skills 46 Promotma Chaf1¥e Skills 2nd Str:ue.:ies 2 Soc:ial Work and Soda! Justice 40 40 Counselling Ski lls and S1ra1eglH 1 Professional Couns.ello,s In Canada Ethics 38 39 81 Sustaining the Counselling Relatfonsblp 82 l mmed1ae)' 82 T r.u,slerenee and Countertr.u,slerenee I NTERVIEW 3.2 Immediacy 84 vii 84 72 5 Asking Questions: The Search for Meaning 126 BRAIN BYTE Transference 86 BRAIN BYTE Childhood Abuse and Intimate Rela!ionships 87 CONVERSATIOH 3.3 Counsea:>r Self-Oisclosixe Endln& the Couns.ellfn& Relationship LEARNING OBJECTIVES 8·7 The Art of Aski n& Questions 88 89 Oe:alu,i with End1~ 90 INTERVIEW 3.3 Emings. 9 1 Sum m::ary 9 2 E.xerdses 92 \Veblinh 94 BRAIN BYTE En:Ungs. 4 Essential Queitlon.s: Some Options 95 TI,e Power o( UsteninK 96 Listening Barriers Questlonlnc Pitfalls 97 97 O,.,e~om inK Lis teninK BarrierS 98 BRAIN BYTE The Auci!ory A1atm System 98 BRAIN BYTE The Righi Ear Advan.iage 100 Anendlnc 102 Taflorlnc tile Interview 10 tile Client 103 Selective Attention BRAIN BYTE Multitasq Honverbal Communication 104 lOS 106 Meanina o( Nom~rbo.l Conununic:uion 107 CONVERSATIOH 4.1 Problems with Lis.1eningand Responding 107 BRAIN BYTE Nonvetbal Processing: 109 \ \1o rkl'l,i with Nom,erba! Communie:u.On 110 Met~mmuniea11on 11 1 SIience 111 TI,e Person.31 ?l.•1eanlfl¥ o( SUen« 111 Sileo« in Counsellina 112 BRAIN BYTE Sienoe 112 Nom,erba! Q.es and Sllenee 116 Eneour.¢ina Sllenee 116 CONVERSATIOH 4.2 Leam~ to Oeal"1th Sienoe Paraphra.sln& 117 Par.1phraSinK2nd Empoth)' Summarizi ng 135 Le:.dina(Biased) Quest ions 135 E>:eessh,e Quest ionlfl¥ 136 CONVERSATIOH 5.1 Alternatives to ()Jestions 137 Multiple Q uestions 138 lrreLe\+::tnt 2nd Poorly Timed Quest ions 139 Wh)' Questions 140 BRAIN BYTE Listeni"€ Active Listeni ng 130 Quest ions for Establlshmi Purpose 13 1 Quest ions to Def'lne the Counsellifl¥ Rel::at ionship !JI Quest ions for E.xpl<>rinK and U nde-rstandinK 13 1 Quest ion!? for Problem Sol"ina 133 Quest ion!? for Ev2lu:.tini 134 BRAIN BYTE The Impact of Questions 135 95 Listening for Understandi ng 126 Quest ions Support Counsellina Godil!i 126 T)•peso(Quesiions 127 BRAIN BYTE Memory 127 Listening & Responding: The Basis for Understanding 95 LEARNING OBJECTIVES 126 119 119 CONVERSATIOH 4.3 Effective Paraph'asing 119 INTERVIEW 4.1 Listen~ Silence, and Summarizing Skills 122 Sum m::ary 123 E.xerdses 12-1 \Veblinh 125 viii Con1en1s 140 \\'he:!, Clients Do Kot AnS\\~r Quest ions 140 Man:1.:mi the Ramblh,i lnter\+iew 1-12 lnt ervie"'ina Yo uth 143 BRAIN BYTE The Adolescent Brain 143 lnt ervie"''11'{t and Counselli1'{t Se:niorS 145 Senior Abuse 14 5 Coss.Cuh ural lnt(".fviewinK 1-17 Beyond tile Surface: lnterwlewlnc to, Conereteneu 147 TI,e Keed lor Conereu•ness 147 BRAIN BYTE Neu-al Development and Marginalzation 14 7 Str.u~ies for Aehie,•i1'{t Conereceness Mald1'{t Cl,oiees 152 116 Interview Transitions 153 Natur2I T r2nsition!l 153 Str.u~ie Tr3n!lit ions 154 Control Tr2nsit ions 154 Phase T r2nsitions 155 CONVERSATIOH S.2 Note-Taq 156 Conneet (Linkh,K) T r2nsit ions 156 INTERVIEW 5.1 lnterviewing: Skills 156 Sum m3r)' 158 E.xerd.ses 158 \Veblinh 160 150 6 Empathic Connections 161 LEARNI NG OBJECTIVES The Emotional Domain BRAIN em De"eloph,i OtSerepcancy 201 "Rollina with Resistanee" 202 Support Sel(-E(t"te:1er 203 161 161 Stages ot Change Emotional Memories BRAIN BYTE Mi'ra Neurons 162 163 The Un¥U3~ o( Emotions 164 Individual D1((ere:nces and C ultu~I Context Ambi\':lle:i,ee A((.., 16S Empathy Cog·nltlve Behavioural Counselling 166 168 CONVERSATION 6.1 Increasing Empathic Vocabula,y 173 173 lnvita11on::'1 Empoth)' B:ask Empothy Helping Cllt11S Make Bellavlolnl Changes IH 175 Jn(ern>d Emp,uhy Four Gene,allzatlons about Empathy 178 The Problem•SolVlng Proces.s 179 Emp::athk Response Leads 181 Whr Achievin¥ Emp::athk Underu2ndu)¥ Is So Oi(t"trult 181 Poor Substitutes for Empcuhy 182 INTERVIEW 6.1 Poor Substitutes for Empathy 183 Touah Emp:uhr 184 CONVERSATION 6.3 How Can I Be Empathic If I Have Nol Had the Same Experience? 18S INTERVIEW 6.2 Effecti-.<e Useof Empathy 186 Sumtiurr 187 Exereises I88 Weblinb 191 7 Supporting Empowerment and Change LEARNI NG OBJECTIVES 192 192 192 Hoo• Counsellina Promotes Em?O">ennent AntU)ppressiv~ Praettee 194 The S1rengU1.s Approach 194 196 BRAIN BYTE Stress and Crisis Empowerment and Seniors 197 Emp::ath)' 201 225 Brief Counselling 228 Se.lected Brie( CounsellinK Techniques Sumtiurr 233 Exerdses 2 33 Weblmb 23-1 8 LEARNI NG OBJECTIVES 235 235 Slans o( Resim1n« 236 UnderSC:ind10i and Respond10i to Reslsc:inee 237 BRAIN BYTE Resis:iance 241 Reslruu,ce and Counsellor Sel(,Aw:ireness CONVERSATION 8.1 Worq with "ll'l'YCbltary" Clients 242 INTERVIEW 8.1 Oealing"'11h Resis:1ance 243 CONVERSATION 8.2 Sa.)ing No 199 228 Difficult Situations: Engaging with Hard-to-Reach Clients 235 Confrontation: Proceed with Caution Crisi s Intervention and Empowerment 197 Motivati onal Interviewing (Ml) 193 220 St ep I: ldent i(r Alternath'i's 225 St ep 2: Choose :m Action Strate-a)' 225 St ep J : De"elop and Implement Pl.:ms 226 St ep 4: Ev:ilu::ue Outeon~ 227 CONVERSATION 7.3 l'\-e Tried Everything 228 Resistance Empowerment: Mobilizi ng Suengtti.s for Chante 219 Goal Sett ina 219 De"eloph,i Effecth~ God!! Stuemenu INTERVIEW 7.2 Goal Setting 223 176 Pre-por.uor)' Emp:tth)' I 77 CONVERSATION 6.2 When Net 10 Use Empathy 203 207 HelpinK Clients Reeoani:e ThinkinK P::attenu 209 Unhelp(ul ThinkinK P::atterns 210 BRAIN BYTE The Emcdonal Brain 210 Per(ectionism 211 HelpinK Clients Jnere:3se Helpfol 11,inkh,K 212 Re(r3mll1i 214 BRAIN BYTE Mindfulness 21S BRAIN BYTE Creating New Neu-al Patt,,.,ays 21S BRAIN BYTE Cognitive Behavicual Counselling 217 INTERVIEW 7.1 Cognitive Behavicual Tech,..,.es 217 CONVERSATION 7.2 When BunonsarePushed 219 166 Emp::ath)' Oeflned 169 The lmpor121l«' o( Emp:lth)' 169 BRAINBYTE LocationofEmpathy 171 BRAIN BYTE Selective Empathy 171 Client Reactions t'O Empcuhy I i l Types of Empathy 203 203 CONVERSATION 7.1 Worq with "t..aJY Clients Risk T2kinK 244 245 Tn,es o( Conlront3tion 245 The Misuse o( Confront::nion 24-6 Principles for E((enh'i' Conlront3t ion Contents ix H7 241 Argresslon and Vi olence 249 Risk Assessment for Violenee 251 Violenee and Mental Illness 253 BRAIN BYTE Head Trauma and Vdenoe 254 Violenee Risk Assessment: Ker Quest ions 254 Man:1.:u-1¥ An&r)' :and Potent ially Violent Beha\+iOUr 255 BRAIN BYTE ~sion 255 BRAIN BYTE Fligl,t « F'€11t 2S6 TI,e Phases o( V1olenee 25 7 CA-i1kal lnddent Oebrie01'{t 263 INTERVIEW 8.2 Violent Incident Follow-up 264 CONVERSATIOH 8.3 HON to Handle an Assault 265 Counselling Angry and Violent Clients 266 Pre,'e11t.On 266 Assertiveness Trainin.: 266 Co.:nit h'e Beh:wiou rat Counsellu,i (Ther2p)') An~r ?1-faM~'\"lnent 267 Substanee Misuse lnten'i":111.0ns 267 Psrthi.atrk lnu·n'ent ion 26 7 Reduet ion o( Streuors 267 Counsellifl¥ Vietims 267 BRAIN BYTE Children and Abuse 268 Surnm::ary 269 E.xerdses 269 \Veblinh 2i0 9 Mental Disorders and Substance Misuse LEARNING OBJECTIVES Mental Health In Canada 267 271 272 Wlthdr.tw31frorn Dru~ Detoxif'.e2tion 296 Substanee U se Disorders and the DSM 298 Bra.in Pbstkity 3nd Addtetion 298 SupportinK Recover)' from Addiction 199 x Con1en1s 302 Warnin& Sl,ans a.nd Risk A!lse-ss-ment Sutnm3r)' 307 E.xerd.ses 307 Weblinlcs 309 10 Cultural Intelligence LEARNING OBJECTIVES 302 310 310 Cultural Intelligence and Diversi ty: Working wllh Competence 310 3 12 The tanadlan C - CulttJre :.-.I Dl,.r>ly 312 313 BRAIN BYTE Cultural Neuroscience CaMdia.n l nuni&r,nion 315 Problems F:ieed by Jn,ml,ir3nt'S ::and Refu{ti'e!l 316 Sodopo.Jitieal R~bt ie!l 318 Key Elements of Cullural Understanding 271 295 Suicide Counselling 299 JOI TI,e ltnporta.nee o( M ulttruhural lnvol,'ement Mental He,ihh Asses!lment 272 TI,e 01;::1.:oosuc and Smistical Mani.di o( Mental D1sorderS (DSM) 274 ~fa,or Men1~I Oisorde-rs 277 CONVERSATIOH 9.1 Paranoia 281 BRAIN BYTE Neurotransmitters and Mental lloess 282 CONVERSATIOH 9.2 How to Respond 10 Hallucinations 283 BRAIN BYTE Depression 284 BRAIN BYTE Attentbn-OeficitJHyperaaivity Oisotder CAOHO) 289 Ould ::and Youth Mental Health 289 BRAIN BYTE Adolesa!nl Marijuana Use 289 BRAIN BYTE Adolesa!nl Drug Use 291 Counsellifl¥ a.nd Workh,i with People W ho Ha,~ Mental D1sorderS 291 BRAIN BYTE Psychotropic Medication 293 CONVERSATIOH 9.3 When Clients Don't Take Their Medcation 294 Substance Use DlsordeJS BRAIN BYTE Pleasure Pathway Co-oeturrin& Oisorde-rS 319 \\'orkJview 3 19 Personal Priorities. Values. and Belie(s 321 Identity: lndwklu::dism ,'erSUS Collectivism 32 1 BRAIN BYTE Culture and the Pleasure Centre 321 BRAIN BYTE Individualism and Collec!Msm 323 Verbal a.nd Emotion:111 Expressiveness 3H CommunK"21tion St)1le 325 L311iu~e 325 Rel:1tionship E.xpea:1tions 326 Belie(s about How People Sho uld Aet 327 Time Onentation 317 Counselling Immigrants and Mulllcullural Clients 328 BarnerS to C ultu~ll)' lntell.i~-e:in Practice 328 Cont rollu,i 1he- Tendency to Stereot)'Pf' 329 Respeet i1'{t Oiver!lity and lndwkll.dl D1(lerences 330 L~minK from Oienu 330 Counsellif)¥ Senior!? 332 TI,e ltnporta.nee o( Counsellor Sel(,Awareness 332 Indigenous Clients 3-3-3 lnd¢eoous Value!l 3nd World-.•iew!l 333 WorkinK with lnd1~nous People 335 Tradition31 H~bfl¥ Pr3ctkes 336 Splrft1tallty and Counselling 336 CONVERSATIOH 10.1 Praying 'Mlh Clients Sutnm3r)' E.xerd.ses Weblinlcs 339 3.W 341 339 11 Neuroscience and Counselling LEARNING OBJECTIVES 342 342 The Remarkable and M·ys1erlous Brain BRAIN em The NorH.;op B<ain 344 BRAIN BYTE The Amazing: B<ain 344 Mirror Neurons 3H Glial Cells 374 Rew:tr<I PathW3)' 374 342 B1aln Problems Neuroscience: An Emerging Force In Counselling CONVERSATION 11. 1 Mind and Stain 345 Why Neuroscience Is Important for Coun.sello,s Neuroscience Endorses Counsellu,i 346 3-16 351 Br3in lnu¥U1i 35 1 BRAIN BYTE Types ol Oepces.sicn 353 Neuroplastl city: An Empowering Discovery How to Stilnul.:ue Neuropbstkity Structure of the Brain 353 354 355 BRAIN BYTE Sundowning 378 BRAIN BYTE Is it No-mal or Dementia? 379 CONVERSATION 11.3 CoullSeq People with INTERVIEW 11. 1 Helping Clients Harness NeuroJ:Mstay 3 56 Hemispheres 358 BRAIN BYTE Ri5,flt Braivl.eft Brain Br3in Lobes 359 Br3in Lobes 2nd Counsellini The Limbk S)·Stem 361 361 362 CONVERSATION 11.2 Male and Female Brains BRAIN em Dementia 380 St roke 3SO Tr.-unutie Br.I.in lnJUr )' (TB)) and Acquired Brain Injuries (ABI) 382 Sumnurr 383 Exerdses 384 Weblmks 384 359 BRAIN BYTE While and Grey Matter 359 BRAIN BYTE Broca's and Wernidle's Areas Psychopathic B<ains 363 364 365 The Endocrine System 365 BRAIN BYTE Endocrine System versus Nervous Sys'lem Gl•=r, Cr3nfaJ Nen't:S Neuron,: Tile Brain' s Information System Major Keurotransrnitters 370 375 Ment3I Oison:lerS 375 Meninttitis 375 Eneepha!itis 375 Br3in Tumours 376 A1nyotrophie fater.l! sclerosis (ALS o r Lou Ge.hriK'S d1se::3se) 376 Cerebral pllsy 376 Epilepsr 376 Huntin~1.on'sdise:ase 376 M ultiple sclerosis (MS) 376 Parkinson's d1se::3se 377 Tourette srndrome 377 Dementi.:1 377 344 344 Six Key Forces in Counsellin& Studying the Brain BRAIN BYTE Endorphins 370 BRAIN BYTE Dopamine 371 366 36S 385 References 392 Tables. Figures. Contoe1StUions. huenrietvs, and Brain B1res Index 408 .A.urhor Index 410 Subjecr Index 414 Contents xi This ]Xlge in1en1ionally left blank "There is a crack in et,-erything, rhar's how the light gets in" uonmd Cohen (1968) Cohen's iconic words arc a messa,;c of hope reminding us that hardship, setbacks., and obstacles arc opportunities for growth, change, and learning. His poetic insight inspires us to believe that we need not fear our imperfections because resilience and empowerment can grow from obstacles and hardships. "Cracks" in Choices have enabled the evolution of seven editions and left me with the inescapable conclusion chat it will forever remain a work in progress.. (n cu.h new edition, user feedback, cmc.r,;ent research, and practice experience have helped me to re-examine my beliefs., discard outmoded ideas, and replace them with fresh pc.rspectives. The seventh edition of Choices maintains its basic format and its objective as an introductory textbook for students in counselling training programs and a practice reference for professionals in social work, criminology, nursing, child and youth care, addictions, psychology as well as professionaJs and voluntec.rs in other professions whose work involves interviewing and counselling. A continuing bcst.-scJler in Canada, Choices combines theory, practice examples with sample interviews, and challenging self-awareness c.xc.rcises in a comprehensive, yet readable format. Jt is aimed at professionals aspiring to gain a wide ran,;e of skills based on supported theory and evidencebased best practices. Although framed in the Canndian ethical and cultural context, the content of the book is designed to appeal to a broad international audience of professionaJs. This book aims to contribute to the development of professional competence in five \\--U)'S: t. lnmxlucing basic concepts and models to hcJp learners understand the theory and philosophy of effective counselling intervention skills. 2. Providing rc3Jistic examples to illustrate concepts in action. 3. Offering challenging exercises that prom(){C skill development, conceptual understanding, and self-awareness. 4. Promoting the importance of a range of skill choices for interviewing. rather than rules and recipes. 5. Presenting connections to relewm neuroscience research. In the seventh edition of Choices., all chapters have been rewritten to improve clarity and include current research, with updated references and wcblinks. This edition continues my commitment to producing a readable and practical text. As muc.h as possible, J have avoided the use of unnecessary jargon, and I have tried to be transparent and explicit regarding m'>' assumptions, a practice chat para.Jlels my approach to counselling. xrn Signif,cant changes and enhancements to the seventh OOition include: ■ A new Chapter 11 exploring neuroscience and counselling ■ Significant new content in many chapters related to understanding and working with seniors ■ Updated rderences and content in all chapters ■ New and/or updated success tips ■ New and/or revised conversations., BRAIN BYTES. and sample interviews induding the addition of a "reflections" section ■ New material on counsellor burnout, vicarious tTil.uma, and wcJlness ■ AdditionaJ content on substance misuse including drug withdraw·a.1, detox, and the opioid crisis ■ Content related to understanding and working with paranoia ■ R«onfigurcd Chapter 10: Cultura.J Intelligence THEORY AND PHILOSOPHY Choice-5 promotes an eclectic approoch that encourai;es counsellors to draw techniques and ideas from various theoretical models depending on the spccif,c needs of the diem and situation, not the comfort level of the counsellor. Counselling is a complex blend of skill, attitude, and creativity, with the work based on bcst.-practice tcdmiques that a.re supported by research. Core skills can be learned and practi~. but they arc not recipes. Based on individual diem need and context, high.-level professionals create, adapt, and cusromi!c skills and strategics, thus a.voiding any "one-site-fits-a.JI" approach. Among the modcJs that have hC11.vil-.• influenced this book's content are the following: ■ Person<cntred counseJling, pioneered by Carl Rogers ■ T rauma, informed practice ■ Cognitive behavioural therapy/counselling (CB1) ■ Motivational interviewing ■ Short-term and solution-focused counselling ■ Emergent insights from neuroscience The term "cognitive reserve" describes the brain's capacity to creative],.• find Wtt)'S to cope with life's chaJlenges. Socia.1 workers and other counsellors who have high level of cognitive reserve om "switch gears" when one way of solving a. problem does not work. Put simply, they have choices and they arc not disc.oura,;ed or defeated when one approach to working with clients fails. They can vary their approach to meet the unique needs of different diem~ cultures., and situations. Over a lifetime of a professional career, through reflection, education and practice experience that builds on success and learns from failure, they can grow their counscJling skills and cognitive reserve. Every interview requires an intcJligent choice of skHls and stnnegies. To make wise choices, counseJlors need to develop a wide range of practice skills based on sup.ported theory (science) and proven practice (cvidcncc.-bnsed best practice). When counsellors have a rcpenoire of skills, they can make knowledgeable choices based on the unique needs of clients and situations., rather than their own personal comfon levels or established routines. In simplest terms, the more choices counsellors have, the grcnter their ability to match their work to the needs and wants of their clients, and the less their need to repeatedly use the same skill. Effective counsellors a.re wise enough to know when to-and when not ttruse pa.rriculnr skills. Similarly, the goal of )UV Preface counseJling is to help diems achieve ve.rsatility in their capacity to solve problems and achieve goals. Slcill and to::hnique can be impressive, but n1one thq•arc insufficient. Compassion, car• ing, empathy, an ability to suspend judgment, objectivity, professionalism, sclfowarcncss, and sufficient psychologicnJ health arc some of the personal qualities and commitments that must operate in tandem with knowlo:Jge and skill. Counscllors need to be genuine, maintain warm and caring rqprd for the.ir clients, and rccogni:e the inhe.rent worth of people Kadushin (1990) discusses the impormnt mix of skill and feeling: ?I.fan)' midit s::1y th:u i( they h::.d to choose between (eelinK and technique they would choose (ee1m~ as the more important pre-requisite. Perh::tps so. but i( one has to make a choice between these qu2lif"teations. an injustke has 2lre::.dr been done 10 the client. It shouJd be p<,SSlble to offer the client an inter\'iev.'er who is both 3ttitu, dinally oorreet and ttthnk3lly prot"teient. (p. xii) Respect for Diversity and Culture Diversity includes differences in such major va.riablcs as race, religion, 3ge, sex, se>.."Ual oriem3tion, physical and mental ability, economic capacity, language, culrurc, vaJues., belief~ prcfc.renccs, and ways of think in a and behaving. The diversity of today's counselling cascloods requires th3t counscJlors develop a ranae of interviewing and counsellina skills. Competent counsellors arc able to vary their style dependina on the unique culture and ,vorldviews of their clients. Choices cmphasi:es culrural competence. Since everyone is unique, each with his or her own mix of values and belief~ culture is a varinble for work with all clients. \Vhen working with clients from visible minorities and those who arc marginakcd by poverty or discrimination, counsellors must examine the sociopolitical realities that frame the clients' circumstances. They also need to develop sufficient sclf-aw3renes.s to escape or manage any tendency to be culrurc-bound-thc assumption that aJI clients share their values, perspectives, and ambitions or, worse still, that client differences represent deficiencies. By sust3ining a multiculturaJ perspective that rccogni!es and prizes diversity, counsellors can avoid the pitfalls of ethnocentrism (the belief thu one's own views and culture are superior). Culturally competent counsellors view cultur3J differences as opportunities to widen their horizons and deepen their vers3tility. They remember to be humble enough to learn from their clients. Phases of Counselling This book divides the counsellina rclntionship into four phases: prcliminnry, beainning, action, and cndina. E3ch phase involves common as weJI as unique tasks and skills. For example, the beginning phase focuses on rclntionship development and problem exploration. Predict3bl)•, skills for devclopina relationships, like active listenina, arc most useful in the beginning phase, whereas skills such as confrontation arc not recommended. But the subsequent action ph3sc focuses on helping clients develop new perspectives, set goal~ nnd implement change strategics; thu~ skills such as reframina and confronting 3re used extensively in this ph3sc. The four phases 3re devclopmcntaJ, with success u one ph3sc dependent in part on success at previous phases. For example, clients arc more willing to accept confront3tion in the 3ction phase if a solid rcl3tionship or trust has already been established in the beainnina phase. In genera], reference to the four~phasc model nJlows counseJlors to mnke some predictions about the climate of the interview and to determine which Preface xv skills and casks will be needed. However, practitioners must be cautious in applying the modcJ too rii;orously to every counselling intc.rvicw because there arc ah\-"n)'S circum,. stances for which the sequence of events will differ sharply from the model Values and Ethics Edtics are principles of acceptable conduct. Professional associations sud,. as the Cann,. dian Association of Soc:iaJ Workc.rs and the Canadian Counselling and Psychotherapy Association Juve formal statements tlut define cc.hies and standards of practice for thc.ir members. Similarl'>', mfues arc ideas and principles that individunJs and groups considc.r import:mtor worthwhile. In counselling, cc.rtain core wlucs arc of pnnicula.r importance: I . BcJief in the dignity and worth of people 2. Respect for the client's right to self-determination (i.e., for freedom of choice and the right to control one's own life) 3. Commitment to work for social justice The Counselling Relationship All editions, including this one, have prioriti!cd the importance of the client/counsel.. lor relationship as a major dcterminam of success. The counselling relationship is something very special. lt's negotiated. It's non..rcciprocaJ. lt has a purpose. lt is dcsianed to rccogni!c and mobili:e srrengths. 1t requires counsellors to abandon their biases and suspend any tendency to give advice in order to listen and respond in a man.. nc.r that crcn.tcs the conditions for trust, growth, and change. Counselling should empower clients and strengthen their self-esteem. It has very little to do with giving "good advice," but it might involve providing information and assisting clients to evaluate alternatives in ordc.r to support them to make informed and scJf-Octcrmincd choices. Best-practice counselling draws on the expertise of clients to participate in decisions related to the goals and process of counscJling, For this reason, counsellors should demystify their worlc through open discussion of their methodologies, assumptions, and intentions. Moreover, commitment to client scJf-Octenninntion restrains counsellors from abuse of power or control. In promoting client self-Octcrmi.. nation, counsellors use a strcngrhs approach that empowers clients by assuming their capacity to cope and change. The counselling relationship crcn.tes the conditions for c.hani;c to occur and the motivation for change to proceed. The counscJling relationship nurtures the natural need that everyone has to grow and change. The cornerstone of this is empathy, a unique and powerful way of listening chat alone is sufficient to help many people. 1t is nor a technique that we nctiv:nc when counselling, bur rathc.r an empathic approach to life that Roger's describes as a ",'",.'>' of being," Counsellor Self-Awareness Effective counsellors arc scJf.awarc, open to feedback, and willing to learn. As counsel.. tors become deeply involved in a relationship with their clients, they need to control their own biases, and constantly monitor thc.ir feelings and thoughts so that they are able to separate their cxpc.ricnces and feelings from those of their clients. Knowlcdi;c of self, including consciousness of one's values and bcJicfs and the impact of one's behaviour on others, is a prerequisite for effective counselling. Coun.. sellors who lack scJf-awarcncss may confuse their clients' feelings with their own. \Vhcn counsellors are unaware of their own needs, including those that are unmet, ll.Yi Preface they risk unconsciously using thc.ir counscJling relationships to meet ~rsonal goaJs instC3d of client goals. In addition, without sclf-awarenes~ counsellors will be ignorant of those arc3s of practice in which they arc competent and those in whic.h it will be difficult for them to ,vork with objectivity. Competent professionals know thcmscJvcs, and they ensure that their vnJucs and beliefs do not become a burden to thc.ir clients. They acc:cJX that exploring and rdlccting on one's competence and the limits of one's role and expertise are fundamental to professionaJ practice. For counscJlors, this process of self-examination continues throughout their oi.rcc.rs. Neuroscience and Counselling In r«cnt years, neuroscience has emerged as an important new force in counselling. Since the 1990s new technologies have spawned an explosive interest in the brain. These imaging technologies have resulted in enormous progress in our understanding of the brain. One of the most rclevant and exciting findings is the discovery that our brains arc "plastic" and in a constant state of change. lifcexpc.ricnce, adversity, trauma, risk taking, and learning shape and reshape the brain in ways that help us co~ with the chaJlenges in our lives. Or. alternatively, they ma)' drive us to depression, anxiety, and substance abuse. A growing body of neuroscience research has confirmed the validity of counselling by demonstrating in dramatic ways how counselling changes the brain. Counselling works! Now, we have the science to prove it. \\:le have IC3rncd how counselling basics such as listening, empathy, asking questions, and the establishment of relationship counselling harness brain plasticity and promote positive brain growth. It's aJrcady exciting, even thouWl we arc still at the beginning stages of what is certain to be an avalanche of profound dcvcJopmcnts in coming years. Neuroscience is providing answers to the question, "How can counscJling help create conditions that promote positive, empowering brain growth or repair?" As a result, I think that in the near future college and university counscJling programs will require courses on the brain and neuroscience. Social Justice and Advocacy Although the topic is beyond the scope of this te>..'t, counsellors should also consider their responsibility to extend beyond thc.ir role as counsellors to social and politicaJ action. As advocates for sociaJ justice, they should strive to reduce gender, cultural, and other forms of discrimination. They should aJso promote changes in social policy as well as modification in the functioning of formaJ org:inimtions and institutions to meet the needs of clients. STRUCTURE OF THE BOOK The book is divided into 11 chapters. Chapter I explores professional identity and introduces readers to the basic concepts of ethics, values, and self-awareness. Chapter 2 explores the basic nature of counselling skills and strategies. Jn this chapter, four major skill dusters arc introduced: relationship building. explorinw'probing, empowering, and challenging. The four-phase model of counselling (preliminary, beginning, action, and ending) is proposed as a model for understanding the evolution of the counselling relationship. As well, the important components of a traumn,infonncd approach are introduced and discussed. Preface xvii Chapter 3 examines the heJping relationship and considers the core conditions of effective counseJling. Scs.sional and reJacionship contracting arc featured in this chapter. Chapters 4, 5, and 6 explore the active listening skills of attending. silence, paraphrasing, and summari! ing (Chapter 4), questioning (Chapter 5), and empa.thy (Chapter 6). Specific ideas for interviewing and working with )'OUth arc discussed in these chapters. Chapter 7 is concerned with action-phase skills chat motivate clients to think dif,. fercndy and make changes in their lives. Two important theoretical model~ cognitive behavioural counselling and motivational interviewing, are fenrurcd. Chapter 8 presents information on working in difficult situation~ such as when clients arc resistant or potcntia11)• violent. Chapter 9 looks at concepts for working with various populations, including those who arc dealing with mental disorders., contemplating suicide, or who have addictions. Chapter 10 explores important concepts and is.sues rcJatcd to counselling clients from different cultures. This chapter includes a discussion of spirituality and counsel.ling, reflecting a growing interest in and acceptance of spiritual issues in counselling. In this chapter, multiculrural competencies for Canadian counsellors arc introduced. Chapter 11 , new to chis edition, explores issues related to neuroscience and coun.scJling including a discussion of brain problems. Features People learn in different ways, so this book includes a range of features designed to assist learners in understanding at the cognitive, emotional, and behavioural lcvcls. Each chapter contains the following clements: ■ Lcarnini Objectives: key concepts that will be addressed in the chapter ■ Summary: a short review at the end of each chapter chat summari:es important ideas ■ Conversations: a unique feature presenting teacher- student dialogues about frequently asked questions ■ Sample Interviews: annotated interview excerpts chat illustrate and explain chapter concepts ■ Success T ips: short, practical ideas for counselling success ■ Illustrative Figures: diagrams that support or embellish chapter concepts ■ Brain Bytes: short links to interesting and relcwnt neuroscience ■ Exerci,;;es: end-of-c.hapte.r rdlcctivc questions to give readers practice developing self-awareness, practice skills, and conceptual knowledge ■ Weblinks: links to websites related to the chapter's material ■ Glossary: definitions of key terms SUGGESTIONS FOR STUDEN TS If you are studying this book as part of a course on counselling skills, you will probn.bly have the opportunity to develop skill competence in a number of different ways: x,,m ■ Watching instructor demonstrations ■ Conducting practice interviews using role-played or (preferably) real-life .scenarios ■ Completing the chapter exe.rciscs Preface ■ Rcce.iving fcedb3ck and evaluation from instructors and student colleagues who obse.rve your work ■ Using audio and video recordings to understand and assess your verbal and nonverb3J responses ■ \Vorbng with clients in practicum fie.Id settings ln most counselling skills courses, learning groups are u~ to practise skills. Usually, these learning groups use classroom simulations and practice interviews in which you assume the roles of dient, counsellor, and observer. Each of these roles offers unique chnJlenges and opportunities for learning. Practice Interviewing: When You Are the Client The client's role offers a powerful opportunity for you to understand diem feelings and expectations. You may find that your rc3ctions arc similnr to those that clients you will worlc with in the field experience: ■ Ambivalence about sharing fceJings or details about pe.rsonaJ issues ■ Feelings of vulnerability and fear of be.ing judged, cmba.rras~. or ridiculed As a dicnt, it will be up to you to control how much you wish to disclose; however, by taking reasonable risks, you can enhance your learning opportunities and insights. However, )'OU should remember that a training environment docs not pro\tidc the time or setting to address complex problems. Practice Interviewing: When You Are the Counsellor When you are asked to practise )'Our newly lc3rncd skills as a counsellor, you may fee] dumsy and insecure as you take risks to chani;c established communication patterns or experiment with new skills and strategics. As a student with limited training. you may be reluctant to ask questions that seem to invade the privacy of your colleagues. Moreover, when dealing with sensitive issues you may fear that your lack of experience will damai;c your clients. You may aJso fear that your colleagues will judge you as inept. As weJI, when you arc being observed by others, the intense focus on your worlc can be unsenling and anxiety-provoking. But all these reactions a.re common, and you will probably find that your colleagues fed the same wa't'· Most profcssionaJ counsellors take many yc3rs of practice and stud,., to become competent and comfortable using a full range of skills. What is important is that you persist and avoid the natural temptation to stick with familiar patterns of communicating. Skills that are awkward in the beginning will, with practice, become part of your natural and preferred style. SUCCESS TIP If you ere-ate the right conditions, othe-rs wiU help you wrth foodbaek that w,II support thedieve-bpment of you, skits and self-awareness. Practice Interviewing: When You Are the Observer Student observers are responsible for watching the interview and providing feedback to student colleagues who are practising their counseJling skills. At first, you may be reluctant to offer feedback, perhaps ,vorrying that your remarks will generate anger or Preface xix hurt fcdings. But keep in mind that the obsc.rvcr's role gives 't'OU an exceJlcnt opportunity to develop the skill of giving feedback 3nd practise this skill. Helpful focdb3ck is energizing and does not detract from 3nothcr person's se.lfe.steem. As people lc3rn and practise interviewing and counselling skills. they may feel vulnerable and awkw3.rd. Hence, it is important to re.main sensitive to their emotional and psychologicaJ needs, while balancing their needs for inform3tion 3nd correction. Obscrve.r feedback ma't' be of two types: supportive or corrective. ■ Supporth-c feedback reoogni:cs screngcM. Consider how you respond diffcre.ndy whm your st~hs arc 3ckno\\'lo:Jge;J rather than when your \\"t'3knesscs 3re targcto:J. Yet despite how obvious this idea seems, m3ny srudents and professional counsellors are very problem,oricnted 3nd fail to ocknowlooge client or colleague ~ h s . Supponive fttdback m~t be ,;cnuinc (rruc) and dclivem:J without rescuing or patronizing. If you lie to others to 3Void hutting them, your credibility 3S a source of feedbade will diminish. ■ Corrective feedbac k challenges others to ex3mine or change behaviour. But before giving corrective feedback, consider your rel3tionship with the othe.r person. If 't'OUr relationship is based on trust and caring, corrective feedb3c.k has the. potenti31 to be effective. Ho\\'evcr, if your relationship has unresolved conflict, corrective feedback is more likely to be: perceived 3S an attack. lf people think your feedback is h3rsh, demanding, or cont·rolling. there is a higher probability that they will resist. Here arc some general feo:lbock guidelines: ■ Be sp«ific. Avoid generalities such 3S. "Your interview was gre3t." Anchor your assessment by identifying the specific beh3viours and responses that 't'OU observed that contributed to the success of the interview. ■ Don't use corrective feedb3c.k as a means to control, impress., or punish. Pay 3ttemion to your tone of voice and other nonverbal behaviour. N13ke sure that you avoid lecturing and pointing fingers. ■ Timing and P3cing 3rc important vari3ble.s. Supportive feo:lbac:.k is more useful when self-esteem is low. In 3ddition, feedback is most effective when given 3S soon as possible, but ensure th3t you protect personal privacy. ■ Avoid ove.rwhelming student counsellors by providing too much feedback. Watch for nonverbal cues or 3sk them to let you know when they would like to stop the process. ■ Ask people to self-evaluate. before offering your opinions. You may be surprised to find that they already h3vc insight into the problem are.as; thereby reducing the number of are3s in which 't'OU h3ve to provide direct feedb3ck. ■ Feedback has the most potential for success if it is invited or tari;:cccd to perceived areas of need. Contract with others to deliver feedback. Ask questions such 3s "\Vould 't'OU like me to offer my ideas on wh3t h3ppene.d!" or ''Are there specific issues that 't'ou're concerned about?" ■ Everyone is different. Some people pre.for feedb3ck to be direct and to the point. Orhe.rs may prefer it "sandwiched" between positives. Orhe.rs need time to re.fleet before responding, or they may profit from visual and written illusmv tions. Discuss preferences with student counsellors, then respond 3ccordingi)•. Some people h3vc an immediate reu:tion to feedback that will differ from their reaction once they h3ve h3d time to ponder wh3t you have said. For example, 3 person who responds defensively or C'Ven with 3nger may, on reflection, come to 3ccept your input and see things differently. The opposite can 3Jso be true-people who rc3ct favourably may later develop other feelings, such 3S resentment or confusion. Checking b3ck during future encounters is one strategy for keeping abreast of others' re3ctions. a Preface Remember thnt giving helpful nnd caring feo:lback is one way of developing and strengthening relationships. 1f you are honest and supportive with others, you greatly incrc3sc the probability they will be honest and supportive with you when you ask for their helpful feedback. Developing an Effective Learning Group When you worlc with student collcngucs in each of the three roles, discuss 't'Our fears 3S well as 't'Our expectations of one another. You will need to work to develop 3 contract or agreement on how 't'OU will work together. Practice interviews arc powerful Je3rning opportunities when they are based on rcnl rather th3n role-pfoycd feelings 3nd issues. Consequently, it will be important to est3blish a climate of safety, where confidentinlity will be respected. Some important principles to remember: ■ Colleagues who nrc in the client's role are disdosina pe.rson3l is.sues and foclina~ so it is essential to respect their dignity and right to privacy. ■ Everyone h3s different cnpncities for intim3cy. Do not expect that all members of a learning group will disclose 3t the same level. Accept individunl differences. ■ Learning the skills of counscJling requires a willinaness to aive up familiar patterns of communication and attempt new npproaches. Expand your limits by mk.ing appropriate risks to try new skills 3nd be tolerant of collcngucs who 3rc engaged in similar risk~taking. ■ Fccdbaclc from others is nn import3nt pnrt of IC3rning. Therefore. try to make it easy for others to give you focdb3ck by consistently responding nondcfensivcJy. Hdp others give specific focdbaclc by 3slcina targ,eted questions. SUCCESS TIP Ext,ec1 that lhe ptocess of learning and experimenting wrth new Slull:S WIii res.un i"I a petiod of awkwardness and self<onsdousooss. FOr' a lime, ,t may seem as though your capaoly to counsel othet'S is rewessing. Keeping a Personal Journal A personal "for your eyes ont,.," jour03l can be 3 signific3m adjunct to 't'OUr learning. The journal is a tool for introspection th3t provides a private means for documenting 3nd exploring your thouahts and fodings related to the development of your counsdlina skills. There are no rules for journnl writing other th3n the need to make entries on 3 regular basis and to try to avoid sclf<ensorship. Using This Book If you arc using this book as P3rt of a course on counselling, your instructor will propose 3 su~cstcd rending schedule that srructurcs your reading over the semester, and he or she will assign or 3d3pt the ch3ptcr exercises to fit your learning needs. Another way to use the book is on 3n "as you need it" basis. using the index or ch3ptcr hC3dings to locate specific content. As wcll, you 3rc encourag,ed to use other books, journals, 3nd tools. such as lnte.rnct research, to supplement your learning. However, you should rend this boolc (or any boolc) critic3lly and sce.k to undcrsmnd and explore the kfe3s and try them out. Preface ai Counselling Skills as a Way of Life You m3y be surprised to discover that the skills of counselling are also the skills of dfcctivc cvef)tdny communication, and that the process of developing your counscJ.ling competence ma'>' begin to influence )'Our pc.rsonaJ relationships. As counscJling: skills become part of your style, 't'OU may find '>'ourself becoming a linle more inquisi.tivc and more sensitive to the feelings of others. However, you may find that others in )'Our life do not welcome the changes in 't'OUr manner and St)•le. When you change, others around you have to accommodate '>'our changes. ff you become more probing in '>'our questions. they must be forthcoming: with their answers. \Vhcn you become more empathic, their feelings become more transP3rcm. These changes move rhc relation.ship to a deeper level of intimacy, which ma'>' be friWltcning for some, particularly if the pace is too fast for their comfon level. an Preface I have appreciated the help offered by the editorial and production staff at Pearson Canad3, who have been very helpful in guiding this book through the m3ny steps required to bring the manuscript to publication: ■ Portfolio l\•fanage.r: Keriann McGoogan ■ Marketing Manager: Euan \Vhite ■ Content Developer: Eileen Magill ■ Content Manager: Madhu Ranadive ■ Project Man3ger: Susan Johnson ■ Copyeditor: Susan Adlam ■ Cover Designer: SPI GlobaJ Thank you to Venkat Perl3 R3mesh 3nd Aishwary3 P3nday for their terrifc copy edit of this edition. A special thanks to Collen Murphy and John Fox from Dougl3s College 3nd Joyce Shebib for their comprehensive review of the new Chapter 11. An adapted version of Chapter 11 was published in the online journal, The Neuropsychotherapist (2017), and I am grateful to its' editiors, Manhew Dahliu. and Richard Hill for their assistance in m3king this happen. All editions of this book have benefited from the feedback provided by reviewe.r~ reader~ colleagues, clients, and students. Over the year~ students from Dougl3s College, have offered candid and helpful feedback, and profession3f collengues who have contributed ideas and suggestions th3t I have assisted me. Thanks to Andrew Buntin, Barbara Picton, Irene Carter, Jason C3rte.r, Michelle Gibbs, Winnie Benton, Irene C3rter, Susan Davis, Karen Marr, Sheri McConnell, Sar3 Memel, K3ren Moreau, Neil Madu, Robert Owen~ Alyson Quinn, Melissa Medjuck, John Fox, Doug Este.rgaard, Bruce Hardy, Lawrence Becker, Elizabeth Jones, Colleen Murphy, 3nd Tabitha Brown. Each edition of Choices h3s included reviews from professionals in the field. In this seventh edition, 10 reviewers, each of who was intimately familiar with the content of the book, offered their perspectives on how the book could be improved. Their invaluable 3nd intelligent suggestions helped to shape this 3ddition. Thank )'OU to these colleagues who reviewed the seventh edition: Alana Abramson, Kmmden Pol)redmic Unitff.Sit1 Andrew Buntin, George Brown College Barbara Picton, Vancout'ff Communiry College Irene Caner, Uniomi1y of \Vind.sor Jason C3rter, Fleming College Michelle Gibb~ Mohawk College P3trici3 Miller, Mounr RO'J(ll Unit'ffSi1y Sue Davis-Mendelow, Humber College As 31ways, a special thanks to my wife, Joyce Shebib, who continues to offer support and very helpful critical comments. Readc.r comments and critical fccdb3c.k arc always welcomed. Please email me at shebib@tdus.ca. Bob Shebib f21C'ult)' En~ritus 0ou{tla$ ColLes:e Kew \Vestrninst~r. BC Customi:~ workshops and staff training based on this boolc arc available. Contact the author at shcbibb@tdus.net for details. niv Acknowledgments Stuart Miesfl23RF ■ Identify the Canadian professionals thnt provide counsellina services. ■ Identify how counsellors can work within the limits of their competence. ■ Define and describe professional ethics, indudina standards related to duaJ rela, tionships and confidentiaJity. ■ List and describe- the core va.Jues of counsdlina. ■ Identify principles for underst:mdina and resolvina ethical dilemmas. ■ Understand the importance of counsellor objectivity :md self-awareness. ■ Understand and manage personal needs and values in counsdlina. ■ Recoani:e and address burnout and vicarious trnuma as W'Orkplace hn:ards. PROFESSIONAL COUNSELLORS IN CANADA Many professional~ such as social workers, child and youth care workers, ps)•chologist~ psychiatrists, nurse~ and psychiatric nurse~ do counsdlina work. Most are members of professionaJ associations like the Canadian Association of Social \\:1orke.rs (CAS\\:' ) and the Canadian Counselling and Psychotherapy Association (CCPA: see Table 1. 1). TABLE 1.1 Professional Associations in Canada canae1ian Addi:tioo Counseuors Ce-rtification fedemtion w.-.w.caccf.ca C3nadian Art Ther.1py Association C3nadian Assoc:ial:ioo of Music The-rapists w.-.w.catas"lto.ca canae1ian Assoc:ialioo of Rehabilitation PtofessionalS tanadian Assoc:ialioo of Soda! WorM-rs w.-.w.musiclher'aP'f.ca w.-.w.carpoational.Of'g w.-.w.casw..acts.ca C3nadian Counse-t.ling and Psychotherapy Associatbn canae1ian C(.-ninal Justice Association tanadian Indigenous Nurses Association w.-.w.ccpa-accp.ca C3nadian NurSeS Association C3nadian Psychiattic Association w.-.w.cna-a6c.ca w.-.w.cpa-apc.org w.-.w.ccja..acjp.ca w.-.w.anac.on.ca canae1ian PsychOlogical Association w.-.w.cpa.ca C3nadian Thetape:utic Recmatbn Association CouOOI ot canadian Chad and Youth care- Associations w.-.w.canadian-lt.org w.-.w.cyceanada.ca PsychOsocial Rehabilitation canada w.-.w.ps«pscanada.com As members, they are subject to codes of ethics governing acceptable professionaJ behaviour. Membership in these associations usually requires a university degree and, in some cases, a maste.r's degree or Ph.D. Social ,vorke.rs gene.raJ)y have university training with a bachelor's degree in social work (BS'W) or a master's degree in social ,vork (MS\\:r). (n addition, they may have speciali.!cd training in are3s such as family the.rapy or group ,vork. Social workers might work in private practice or be employed in hospitals, prisons, schools, or community social service agencies. Many social workers also ,vork for government agencies invcstig:iting incidents of child abuse and neglect. Social ,vorke.rs arc the largest profossionaJ group providing support and counseJling to people with psychiatric disorde.rs. lncrcasingly, with the aging of the Canadian population, social workers are deployed to work with seniors. CounseJling psychologists are usuaJly qualified at the Ph.D. lcvcl, but some jurisdictions allow registration for those with a master's degree. They may ,vork as counsellors or may spcciaJi.!e in other are3s, such as in administering and interpreting psychological tests. Psychologists arc often employed in private practice, but they ma,., also work in settings such as prisons, hospitals, schools. and private industry. In contrast, psychiatrists arc mcdicnl doctors with advanced training in psyc.hiatf')t They are specialists in the treatment of people with menral disorders. Ps,.•chiatrists are the only counselling professionaJs licensed to prescribe medication. Psychiatric nurses generally have two to four years of training. Historical!,.,, they worked in psychiatric hospitals and wards., but today. increasingly, they arc working in community based mental health settings. Community college graduates with one to two years of college training aJso provide counselling services in senings such as transition homes, addiction centres, employment counselling agencies, and community mental he~dth. The nonprofit social service sec• tor also uses volunteers to deliver services in settings such as crisis phone lines, where people in distress call for assistance or referral. In addition, the professionaJ counselling community is often supported or replaced b\• an array of sclf-hclp support groups, such as Alcoholics Anonymous (AA) or Narcotics Anonymous (NA). Social Work and Social Justice Like other professionals in the helping professions, social workers counsel clients to help them develop insight, solve problems, deal with emotionaJ p3in, and enhance 2 Chap1er 1 rcJationships. They may also suppondients by providing information, social skills trnining, or resources. One speci3l feature that d istinguishes social work counselling from that performed by other professionals is itsdunJ focus on W'Orking with individuals as well as the.ir sociaJ environment (DaJe, Smith, Norlin, & Chess., 2009). SociaJ W'Orkers assume that an individuaJ can be u nderstood only in the context of his o r her environment; thus, they pay particular attention to the interaction of the person and the environment. Unique to social W'Ork is the important professional responsibility to promote social justice or "fairness and moraJ riahtness in how social institutions such as government, co rporations, and powerful groups rccogni!c and support the basic human rights o f all people" (Shcafor & Horcjsi, 2008, p. 6). Social justice commitment involves advocacy to promote human rights and more equitable income redistribution, political action to change oppressive legislation o r policy, public education to shnpe public opinion, and efforts to build community. Social workers recognize that social problems arise, at least in pan, from ineffective socinJ systems. \Vhile counselling is important in helping individunJs cope, it is insufficient in deaLing completdy with these great cha.Jlenges. Thus, because this boolc explores onh• the counselling component of social work practice, practitioners arc autioncd to approach this taslc with the broader mission of social ,vork in mind. Valu e 2 of the Code of Edtia of the Canadian Association of SociaJ ·workers (2005) o udincs the obligations o f social workers to advoc:ne for social change: Purjult of Soci::ll Justice All 2 result. !lod:lJ workers belie--.-e in the obii¥"3tion of people. individual!)' and eol, !ttth-e1y. to provide resour«.s. services and opportunities for the over111l benef'h of humanity and l'O a(ford them procect.On from h::arm. Soefa1 workers promote social fairncss and the equitable discribut.On of reSOurees. and take ::.et.On to redu~ barri.erS 2nd eicpc:md eho-iee for all persons. with !ipecM R1t3rd for those who 3re marttln::ii:ed., di~dv:tnta~d, vulnerable. and/or h::1:\'e e,:eeption::111 nee<k Soei::111 workers oppose prt'Ju.diee and d1serimination 21.'.ainsc any person or aroup o( persons on ::ti1)' arounds. and spedf"te:!111)' eh:t!Len~-e views and aet ion!l that stereotype p.,rtkular persons or $tr0u pi. Prindples.: ■ Soeial workers uphold the ril.'.111 of people to h:t,-e ae«ss to resourees to meet lxlsk hunun needs. ■ Soda! Yi'Orkers 2dl.'Oc."21te for l2ir and equitable~ l'O pu blk servieesand bene:flu. ■ Soeial workerS ac.h'()("3te for equal t re::atment and proteetion under the law and ehal~ le~e injustiees,. especially inJuStkes that 2(fect the vulncr.ible and d1S:ld\'an1a~-ed. ■ Soeial workerS promote soc:ial de,'1?1opment 2nd e,wironment:lJ mai1::1:~1ne:i1t in the intereru o( all people. (p. 5) ETHICS Ethics arc the p rinciples and rules o f acceptable o r proper conduct. All professions hnvc ethical guidelines, desianed to protect both clients and members. Ethical codes define the limits of pe.rmissiblc behaviour and the sanctions o r remedies for member violations of ethicaJ standards. Codes of ethics serve the following b ro3d purposes: ■ Professionals can use their codes to assist them with d ecision m31cing and as a reference for the.ir practice. ■ Ethical codes help shdtcr clients from incompetent and unethical practice by mcm.be.rs of the p ro fession. Ethical codes r«ogni:e that clients may be vulnerable and subject to manipulntion and abuse o f power by profossiona]s, so thq• constrain professionals from taking 3dvantage of clients. Protesslonal Identity: Ethics, Values , and Self-Awareness ethics: Ouidelilies that define the limits d pennissible behariour. 3 ■ Ethical codes nlso provide guidance on how counscJlors can dc3l fairly with col.leagues and their cmplO)'Crs, including the responsibility to address the unethical conduct of colleagues. ■ Codes outline the philosophical and vnluc principles of the profession. For exam,. pie, the code of the Canadian Association of Social \\:1otkers has six core social wotk values: Value I: Respect for the Inherent Dignity and \Vorth of Persons Value 2: Pursuit of Socinl Justice Value 3: Service to Humanity Value 4: lntea:rity of Professional Practice Value 5: Confidcntinlit)• in Professional Practice Value 6: Competence in Professional Practice (CAS\\:I, 2005, p. 4) These ideals arc echoed by the Canadian Counsellina: and Psrchothcrapy Association, which articulates the following fundamental principles as the b3sis for cthicnJ conduct: a. Bendiccnce: be.ina: pro3ctivc in promoting clients' best interests b. Fidelity: honouring commitments counsellina: rcJationships to clients and maintaining integrity in c. Nonmalefkence: not willfully harming clients and refraining from actions that risk harm d. Autonom)•: respecting the rights of clients to self-determination c. Justice: respecting the dignity and just treatment of all persons f. Societal interest: respecting the need to be responsible to society (CCPA, 2007, p. 2) Unethical behaviour typicaJly arises from issues related to one or more of the following: brcakina: confidentiality; misreprescntina: or worldna: beyond one's level of expertise; conducting improper relationships. including scxuaJ activity with clients; and causing conflicts of interest, such as emerina: into business or other dual relationships with clients. ProfessionaJ associations arc responsible for monitoring their mvn policies and for investigating and resolving violations of cthicnJ conduct. The CAS\\:I and CCPA arc examples of professionaJ bodies that can formnll)• discipline members who violate their codes of ethics. As weJI, counsellors who are 00( members of professional assocuttions may work with agencies that provide guidelines for ethical behaviour and decision makina:. In addition, legislation defines and restricts the use of certain tide~ such as social worker, psychologist, and psychiatrist, to those who have the appropriate degree or training. The clients of these professionals can report misconduct or concerns to the appropriate professional association: however, the.re may be no legislation preventing people from offering counselling services under 3 wide nma:e of other title~ such as counsellor, personal therapist, family and marital counsellor, and personal growth con,. sulmnt. These practitioners ma)' not have had formal preparation or training, and clients should be cautious when they seek their services. Although the codes arc the primary source for professional decision makina:, coun.seJlors should also consider relevant theory, research, laws, regulation~ and agency policy. \Vhcn faced with ethicaJ dilemma~ they should consider consultation with collc3gucs, supervisors, professional associations, and lea:al counsel In addition, the CCPA has published an ethics casebook (Shuh, 2000) designed to assist counsellors in clarifying ethics and standards of practice, and the CAS\V has published Guidelines for Ethical Practice (2005) as a reference point for social workers on cthicaJ practice. 4 Chap1er 1 Dual Relationships A dual re.larion.,;hip is a rcJationship in which the.re is both 3 counselling relationship and another type of relationship. such as a business relationship. a friendship, or one of scxu:.d intimacy. The essential purpose of counsclling is to meet dlC' needs of client~ but dual rein,. tionships IC3d to the risk th.nt counsellors could misuse (or be pc.rceivcd to be misusing) thc.ir professional relationships for pc.rsonaJ gain. In duaJ relationships, the counsellor has a persona] interest th.nt may con6ict with the client's interests. This may lead to intended or unintended exploitation, harm, manipulnrion, or coercion of clients. To prevent these problems and an,.•conflict of interest, dual rcJationships must be 3voidcd because of their potcntiru hnrm to clients and the risk of damage to rhe image of the profession. Not surprising),.,, the codes of ethics for the various counselling professions strictly prohibit certain types of dual rel.ntionships., especially those of scxunJ involvement. Generally, they also prohibit sexual intimacies with former clients for a specified period after terminating the counseJling relationship, but this injunction ma'>' extend indcfinitdy "if the client is dearly vulnerable, by reason of emotionnJ or cognitive disorder, to exploitative influence by the counseJlor. Counsellor~ in nJI such circumstances, clearly bear the burden to ensure that no such exploitative influence has occurred and to seek consultative assistance" (CCPA, 2007, p. Bil). Cl.Iii relatiooship: Aieb.~iooslip ii *h thEfe is bot!I aauasellillg ieb.~i>Rship -6 anctte ~ of retr.i>nship, sud! u ~«sa:aal ir.imacy. Professional Boundaries Despite ethical guideline~ boundary \•iolations and abuses do occur. Reviewing the available research, (Thoreson and colleagues 1993) found thal the incidence of se>..'Ual contact between counsellors and clients ranges from 3.6 to 12.1 percent. Conducting their own srud'>', the researchers found after surveying 1000 randomly seJectcd male members of the American CounseJing Association (ACA) that 1.7 percent of the respondents reported engaging in sexual contact with a client during a professional reJationship. and 7 percent reported engaging in sexual contact after a professional relationship (Thoreson ct al., 1993). Physical Contact The CAS\\:l's Guidelines {qr Eihical Pmaice (2005) offers this guid~ ancc on the issue of physical contact with clients: Sodd1I v.'Ork.ers a"oid e0$:aaina in ph)'Sical cont::.ct with cl1enu whe:i, there is a possibility of harm to the client as a result of tilt contact. Soeial Yi'Orkn'l who e0$:a~ in approprldlte physical contact with dients21re rttponSlbLe for settina dear, appropriate and cuhura.lJy sensitive bound:u-ieii to '-•oven, iiudi cont~. (p. 12) \Vhile the CASW guidelines do not de.fine appropriate physical contact, common sense neo:ls to prevail. Fear of the impliations and repercussions of touching has led some settings to become "no touch" environments; however, this practice may negate the needs of some clients, particular!'>' children who need physical conmct. In an editorial on the importance of touching in child and youth care sertings., Tom Garfat (2008) emphasi!ed the importance of touch when working with youth, but he also stressed that workers need to learn when not to touch. He distinguishes "between those who would touch youth in the most normnJ and healthy of ways; a pat on the back, a touch on the shoulder, a comforting hug when the world is a difficult place, a hand held in a moment of crisis, and those who use the opportunity to touch a young person as an opportunity to satisfy their °"'n needs and desires" (p. iii). Garfat strongly endorses the elimination of inappropriate touching, but urges us to remember that "touch is P3rt of human nature, touch is dcvclopmentnJI'>' necessary, touch is part of healing, touch is a form of communication, and touch builds bridi;cs" (p. x). Protesslonal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 5 While sexual intimacy is de~uly unethical, the appropriate boundaries of other relationships may be less dear. As Reamer (2002) observe~ Other dual 3nd 1nuhiple refationships3re more 31nb~uous and require e2reful an:11lysis and eonsuh:nion. Examples include $0Cla! v.-·orkers in rural communities who cannot 3\'0id cont~ with dienu in social settin~s. soeial workers who ue in\'hed br clients to attend an important li(e e"ent, soek.11 v.-·orkers' rebtionships with forn~rclients, and soeial workerS' unantidpcatc-d e:ncounterS with cbe:nts 3t 3n Aleoho!ics Anonymous n~tinK when both parties 3R' in rttO\>ery. (p. 66) Miller (2007)discusses the chaJlenges that profossionaJs who work in rural or smaJI towns face when applying and interpreting ethical standards such as "the need to main.tain professional boundaries and at the same time achieve a sense of personal belonging in the community" (p. 168). She aJso notes the vulnerability that workers foci, due to their high visibility, when their actions are scrutini!cd by members of the community. Pierce and Schmidt (2012) sugi;est that rural dynamics and culture affect how professional boundaries are de.fined: For example, over time. the pro(essional m3)' be invited to 001nmunity e"\>ents. 3 we'd, din¥, or a eelebr.uion for "-hkh attend3nce is viewed 3S SiKnif'lcant by the community. Not attendina m3)' cause disharmony <>r barderS between the practitioner and the community. (p. HS) Confidentiality absolute confidentiality: ,. assur•e that dient disclosures are not shared 'llih an)1)fle. ~&alive confidentiality: The assumpti)n that client disctlsures my be shared 'llihin the ,.ency • idl supervisors or ailleapes. Clllsi:\e the ,.ency -.idl client peraissia.. or _., odlers bec-.-se of lea..ahequiremeaa. s.a::h as those contailed .ithin ctid abuse legisbtica. 6 The rules rq:ardingconfidentialit)• are integral co every code of ethics. EthicaJ guidelines stress that the confidentiality of clients must be protected. Indeed, most clients enter counselling with an expectation that what they S3Y will be kept private. For the most part, counsellors can assure clients that they will keep their disclosures confidenriaJ; hO\\tC\-er, often it is not so simple. Absolute confidentiality mC3ns that client disclosures are not shared with anyone. Rclati\'e confidentiality means that information is shared within the a,;ency with supervisors or colleagues, outside the agency with the client's permission, or in courts of law owing to legal requirement~ such as child abuse legisla.tion. UsuaJI)•, clients can be assured only of relative confidentiality. To provide optimum service to clients., counseJlors must share information about them within the agency. To monitor the quality of ,vork and help counsellors improve their skills, supervisors need to review client files or consult with counsellors by review~ ing audio and video recordings of their interviews. Other counseJlors within the agency also have access to files. Many people believe that counsellors and other professionals enjoy "privileged communication," that is, thq• are lega]ly protected from having to share information that they have obtain~ while exercising their professional duties. Ho\\'e\'er, the courts can subpoena counseJlors' records because Canada has no legislative protection for licensed or unlicensed psychotherapists. There are valid reason~ including some legal requirements, for sharing informa,. tion. For example, aJI jurisdictions in Canada have legislation that rttauires counseJ.lors to report suspicions of child abuse and neglect to the appropriate authorities. Similarly, counseJlors might have to break confidentiality when thq• believe that clients might harm themseJves or others. Counsellors need to become familiar with the pre.cise wording of relevant statutes in their area since laws may vary significantly among jurisdictions. One often-quoted legal precroent is the 1976 Tarasoff case, in which the client told his counsellor of his intent to lcill his girlfriend, Tatiana Tarasoff. The counseJlor cold the campus police of the threat, but he did not warn his diem's girlfriend or her family. Chap1er 1 The client, a student at the school, subsequent!)• carried out his thrcnt and killed the young woman. The young woman's parents brought a successful lawsuit against the counsellor and the university. This litigation established that, when counsellors believe that a client represents "a serious danj;er of violence to another," they have a duty to warn potential victims (cited in Nesbitt, 2017.). duty to warn: The profmional responsibility that uunsellors haw to infora P!(lple . , . they baiew a di.may harm. SUCCESS TIP Become familiar wdh the legj:slatbn in you( a(ea that (eQuires you to (eport suspected cases of child abuse Or' neglect but remember it is not you(job to conduct an k\vestigation unless you are legally assigned thi:s (de. Since the Tarasoff decision, there have been numerous Canadian applications and legal precedents that address the duty to warn issue. The CASW's G11idelines for Ethiail Pmcrice (2005) allows for disclosure when "necessary to prevent serious, foreseeable, and imminent harm to a client or others" (p. 6). The guideJines also obligate social workers in such circumstances to notify "both the person who ma'>' be at risk (if possible) as weJI as the police" (p. 8). The CCPA Code of Ethics (2007) has a similar duty to w-arn obligation that requires counsellors to "use reasonable care to give threatened ~rsons such warnings as arc essential to avert foreseeable dangers" (p. 7). Clients have a right to be fully informed regarding the limits of confidemiality, including any legal or ethical responsibilities that require counsellors to share informa• tion. Through discussions rq:ardingconfidentiality. counsdlors can reassure clients that computer and file records arc safe. Counsellors can take a number of steps to protect client confidentiaJity. They should discipline themselves not to discuss clients in public plnc:cs and at parties or other social events. Counselling work is demanding, and an important part of dealing with the stress of the job is to unwind by talking about difficult cases and ~rsonal reactions with colleagues and supervisors. This is a healthy and necessary component of professional wellness. Unfortunately, time pressures and large caseloads may leave little or no time for this process during the working day, so it is easy to fall into the trap of discussing clients over lunch or in other settings where confidemiality cannot be ensured. The obvious risk is that the conversation will be overheard. Even when names are not used, accidentaJ listeners may think that they know the person being discussed. In addition, they ma'>' decide that they will never go for counseJling because what they Sil)' would soon be spread all over town. Although it is tempting for counsellors to discuss clients with family and friends because they arc awilable as supportive listeners, they should avoid doing so. Family and friends are not bound by the same ethics as counsclling profcssionaJs. They could easily disclose what they have heard, perhaps with a seemingly innocent observation or comment. Sometimes counsellors breach confidentiality b\• failing to take simple precautions. For example, taking phonecaJls during a counselling session can lead to careless breaches of confidentiality and suggest to clients that the counsellor treats their private matters casuaJly. In addition, counsellors should remove all case records, phone message~ and notes from their desk. This prevents clients from seeing the names of oth~r clients and reinforces the fact that the counsellor will not leave private r«ords in public plnces. SUCCESS TIP Yv'hen leaving phOOO messages fOr' d ients, give jusa your firsa name and say nothing abOut the nature of lhe call. Clients may 001 have informed room-mates or famity members that they are seeing a counselb. Protesslortal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 7 TABLE 1.2 Confidentiality Guidelines Review ptofessional guidelines such as lhe C/JSWs Guidelines lot £1/'Jk:al Practice and 100 CCPA's COde of £tNcs. l.nveive clients. Keep lhem infol'rned and seek lhei( permissio.n to retease information. Remembef' 1hat freeoom of rntotmatio.n sa.ah.ies may give cliMts 1he ~ t to access you( files. Become familiar with televant legal statutes (e.g., chtk1 abuSe or mental health legislation) that defW'le and limit conftdentiality. OisclOSe onfy lhe information that is (e.::iuir'ed. Pr·Olec:I dient (ec:ords Mh secure filing systems. Do not leave flies, notes. or poon,e messages aOOUt dients out vd'lem they may be read by others. Ensure tr.at etectronicaly stored data is protected. • Etls...-e lhat consultatio.ns with others concet'ni~ clients are legitimate and conducted in a private and ptofessional manner. This ptecludes co.nverSatioos abOut clients at soda! gatherings ot k'I public places such as resta...-ants. Etls...-e that interviews are private and free from inte(tuprio.ns. Discuss dieots only with supervisors and use only support staff for ptocessi~ necessary paperwor'k and documentation. Nevet use client names., k'llials, or identifying data in emails Or' text messages. E.xceprio.ns to the rules may, and sometimes must be made when thet'e a(e suspicions of child abuse or negtect when re.::iuited b-f law (such as a subpoena), and wtlen them is a risk to self Or' others (suicide lhmat or thteat of vidence). Nevet use soda! media to discuss dieots, even if you change names and identifying infor"mation. T he inte.rview it.self should be conducted in priwte, 00( whereothe.r sroff o r clients m3y overhear. \Vhen greeting a diem in the w3iting room, counsellors should rdrain from using surnames; however, they need to be sensitive to the fact th.nt many seniors and people from some cultures are insulted by the casu3l use of their fi rst names. Sometimes counseJlors meet clients by chance in public places. \\:'hen this h3p,pens, counsellors should ensure that they maintain conftdentiality, even when the client appears unconcc.rned. They should gently shift the conwrsation to 3 neutral topic or SllfiCSt a private time and place to continue the discussion. At th.nt time, counsellors can explain why they avoided a public discussion. Tab le 1. 2 outlines some important conftdemiality guidelines. VALUES FOR PROFESSIONAL PRACTICE Talues: 'MaM individuals and g,oups consider iapcrual or 11uth.tlile. Values arc principles or qualities that individuals 3nd groups consider important or worthwhile. Ethics are de.rived from values. Values represent beliefs about what is desir~ able and good. Personal values describe what individuals consider desirable and what they believe is riWlt and wrong. Professional values describe fundnmemal beliefs that the profession holds about people nnd Wtt)'S the worlc of rhc profession ought to be conducted. Clc3rly, professional values (as reflected in ethical codes of conduct) and personal wlues have a major impact on shaping the practice of counselling profession.als. T,vo key vaJucs of counselling 3re the belief in the dignit)• 3nd worth of people and the diem's riaht to self.-dete.rmination. Belief in the Dignity and Worth of People Belief in the dignity and wonh of people is the core vaJuc of counselling. This value commits counsellors to ensuring that their clients nrc t:rC1tted with rcgnrd for their rights. lt obligates counsellors to demonstrate accept3nce of the individuaJ and to uphold 8 Chap1er 1 confidentiality. Counsellors who wJuc the dignity of their clients apprccintc diversity 3nd reject stcrtt>typing, labelling, and other dehum3ni! ing practices. Counsellors must treat clients fnirl't', regardless of pcrson3l feelings to\\'ard them. For example, counsellors must resist the nnturaJ temptation to spend more time with clients they favour nnd less rime with those whom they find difficult. Counscllors arc expected to npply their skills and lcnm\-·ledge 3t 3n optimum levcl for eadl client, regardless of their personal rcaction townrd 3n)' client. Clients may hnvc behaved in \\'ays that counsellors pc.rceivc to be offensive, but this belief does not give counscllors licence to be disrespectful or to withhold services. Discriminatory practices arc srricdy prohibited by both mnjor codes: ■ Counsellors actively work to undc.rstand the diverse c.ulturaJ bnckground of the clients with whom they work, and do not condone or engage in discrimination b3sed on 3ge, colour, culture, ethnicity, dis3bility, gender, religion, scxunl oricma, tion, mnrit3l, or socioeconomic status. (CCPA, 2007, p. 9) ■ Social workers recogni.!c and respect the diversity of C3nadinn society, taking into nc.c.ount the breadth of differences that exist among individunJs, families, groups nnd communities. (CAS\X~ 2005, p. 4) These ethic.al guidelines underscore the need for professionals to le3m 3bout other cultures. Such le3ming increases sensitivity nnd 3w3rencss of how values, beliefs, and worldview define one's behaviour 3nd thinking. This topic will be explor~ in more depth in Chnpter I0. Counsellors, espcci31l)• tho.sc who \\'Orie with high-risk clients (such 3S those with chronic nddic.tion problems) nttd to be careful that their view of, 3nd attitudes toward, clients do not b«omc jnded. Jad~ counsellors often hnvc 3 cynic.al and pessimistic. perspective on the willingness 3nd otpacity of their clients to c.h3nJ;e 3nd grow. Counsellors who believe thnt clients arc inapablc of grmvth nrc likely to invest less energy in supporting c.h3nJ;c. Moreover, they m3y be more prone to using controlling responses because of their expectation that the "clients c3nnot do it on their mvn." \Vh.nt would you pr~ict to be the likcJ,.•outcome of 3 counselling session when the counsellor labels the client "3 hopeless nkoholic''! Conversely, belief in the dignit)• and \\'Orth of people is expressed through positive practices: ■ involving clients in decision making, g<>3l setting, and problem solving ■ ndopting n strengths appro3ch ■ m3intaining an optimistic view of human n3turc, including the belief that people nrc c3pable of change nnd growth Client Self-Determination Self-determination is the principle thnt clients h3vc 3 right to autonomy and freedom of choice to make thc.ir own decisions, insofar ns is possible. Counsellors h3ve 3 duty to respect nnd promote this right even when they disagree with the decisions of their clients. Moreover, choice is 3n integraJ part of client self-dcterminnrion. \Xfhen clients h.nve no choices, or believe th.nt they have none, self-determination is not possible; however, adherence to the principle docs not pre-.'Cnt counsellors from hcJping clients understand how their 3ctions might violnte the rights of others. Nor docs it prevent counsellors from helping clients 3pprccinte the potentiaJ consequences of their actions. Some clients, such as p«>ple with mental disabilities and young children, mny be unnble to make competent choices. (f so, counsellors m3y need to prevent them from acting in ways that nrc potentiaJJ,., harmful to themselves or othc.rs. Sometimes beginning counsellors 3re misinformed about the n3ture of counselling. They believe th3t their role is to listen to their clients' problems nnd then offer helpful Protesslortal lden111y: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness self-detennNtion: De pri~ t!l.i'! promffl the rill's ol dients to hM auton-, and freedom al choice. 9 control & Informed coo.... Acuuto Resources Kno~ge& lnfOl'l'l'lation ltWOl~rMnt in DecisiOn Mak»g Figure 1.1 Essential Elements of Self.Determination advice or solutions. The principle of sdf~focermination oblig3tes counsellors co avoid behaviours that control and manipulate clients. lnstead, they must employ strategies that empo\\'er clients to make independent and informed decisions. The counsellor 's expertise lies n()( in knowing what is best for the diem, but in being able co manage the process through which problems arc solved, feelings are managed, o r decisions are m3de. Empower ment is the process of assisting clients to discover personal strengths and capacities. In oche.r \\'Ords, through empowerment, counsellors seek to help clients take control of their lives and rcnli.!e that thq• can improve their situ3tion through their actions. (&e Figure 1. 1 and Table 1.3.) Effective counsellors accept chat clients have a r ight to be involved in counsdling decision making. They have d"K" right to be tre3ted as active pan-ncrs in the coun-sclling process and to participate in decisions affecting their lives. This right is underscored in the CCPA's Code of &hics(2007}. C lients' Ritch.ts and l nfor-m~ Con:l:ent. When counsetlu)¥ is initiated, and throu~,. out the oounsellin¥ pro«>ss as necess:arr, counsellorS inform clients o( the purposes. ¥°"ls. tttbntques. pro«dures. limit3tions. potential risks and btneflts of SeF\+keS t'O be performed, and other s ueh pertinent in(onnation. CounselLorS m.:tl:e sure that clients underStand the imphc::uions of di3¥00SiS, (~s and fee. collection arf30$:ements,. record TABLE 1.3 Strategy Choices for Promoting Cl ient Self-Determination Use advOCaey skills to help clients access reSOU""ces Or' remove ba(rie<s to existi~ options. Avoid pfe-scriptive advice and other contr·oiI.-ig responses. Help clients identify, access. and explOr'e options. Encou(age clients to make thei( own decisions based on infOfmed chOices of the costs and benefits ot any cou(se of actbn. Assist clients in evaluati~ the conseciuences ot thei( actions on others. Fuly infOfm clients abOut counsel.ling Sltategjes and 100 JX)tential (ISkS. P(omOle couatx>rative deeision making on goats. Whooeve( possible, pfovide acooss to (ecorcts.. Invite clients to evaluate the progess of counsem~ and the counse!Mog (elatiooship. When unde< eowt Or'de< or simila, nonvoluntary conditions, provide information on the client's right to decline semce, as well as 100 JX)SSible conseciuences ot such denial Whenevef JX)SSible, em(X)wet d ients with chOices. Adopt a minctset 1r.a1 (ecogni?es the client as the ·ex.pe<r on his or her own problems. feelings. and ptefet(ed solutions. Avoid dependency-promoting behaviours, such as dOing fOr' d ients Vtt'lat they can do fo( themselves, e.xcessive involvement, and indisc(iminate advice givi~. Encou,age optimism and fostet a relationship of safety to help clients lake (is.ks. Honou( client lifestyle chcices. 10 Chap1er 1 " ~ • CONVERSATION 1.1 STUDENT: I have just started my field placement, and I am disturbed by wtlat is happe-ni~. When the team goes for coffee, ever)()(le jOkeS and makes fun of the clients. If they Quit.· Such Mg.allows humou'. is one of the ways many ~ pie deal with 100 e-nOfmous sttess of their jobS. Jokes abOut tr~ ENents 0t client misfortunes help counsellors sustain tnell emotional wet-being. It ooes n01 mean that they have beeorne hardened°' uncari~ towatd lheit clients; mthet ii is a W:¥f of unwiOOingand relievi~ consrant pressu-e. As you\.e koow how their counseuors talked about them, they would never come back. I did 001 know lhat professionalS could be so Cdd-hearted. ts tnell behaviout unethic:ar? discovered. one of the dangers of gallows humour is lhat others wdl over-hear ii and draw conclusions abOut the person's attituOOS. ts it uoothi:.al? What dO you think.? TEACHER, Just before t,;sexecutial by haogj~. a c:oodetMed man is offered a cigatette. MNo thanks,.· hes.a~ M1•m trying to keepifl$:. 21nd limit'S o( ronf"tdentiality. Chenu h::n,e the ri$:ht t'O pc:uuc:ipote in the on~-o- re(use 2111)' reeommended servke!l. 3nd to be 3dvi.sed o( the consequence!? o( soch refuS3.L (pp. 7~) in~ counsellin& phms. t'O Rights of Children As a rule, "cnpable" children arc entitled to confidentiaJity unless there is n reason to suspect that the child might harm himself or herself or others. As wcll, situations involving child abuse or neglect must be reported. In this respect, a child can rccejvc medical treatment or consultation on is.sues such as binh control/abortion, mental health problems, and addictions counselling Ousticc Education Society, 2015). In 1991, Cannda signed the United Nations Oeclnration of the Rights of the Child, which oblig3tes it to enforce children's rights as outlined in the Declaration. Nevertheless., United Nations officials hnvc criticized the country for its failure to adequately address the needs of Aboriginal.disabled, and immigramchildren asweJI as those living in poverty (ScoffieJd, 2008). ETHICAL DILEMMAS An ethical dilemma exists when a choice must be mndc between competing wJucs and potcntl31 courses of action. A decision to remove a child from a home where there is ob-.•ious nnd significant abuse is 00( an ethical dilemmn since the gravity of the situation gives no room for choice. On the other hand, removing a child when the home situa, tion is marginal requires weighing the risks of potential abuse against the drawbacks of separating a child from his parents. By virtue of their role, counsellors may have simultaneous obligations to different people and groups., including the agency that employs them, their clients, the community at large, and the lcg3J system. When oblig3tions conflict, an ethical dilemma is created with risks and benefits to ench potential solution. )}t) BRAIN ethical dilemma: Asiluati>n invdving a,mpeting « ccaHictilc values or prilciples. BYTE functional magnetic f&S003r')C8 imagk'lg <fMRO has enabled researchers to identify afeas of the brain that are active when pooJje addmss m0tal and ethical dilemmas. The msu1ts sho.-.ed that amas of the brain associated with etnations tend to predOminate. particulatly when the-re is a more perSOoal involvement in 100 dtk>mtna (Science Dail'j, 2001). Aoothef study re(X)fted by Riddle (2013) in ScientifJC: American con- cluded lhat "out pfofessed mOr'al principleS can be shifted by subtle differences in mOOd and how a question is JX)Sed.• These findings underscOr'e the value of counsellors consulting with others and avoiding iinplJSive actions when confronted with diffreult ethical decisions. Protesslortal lden111y: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 11 While ethical codes that are based on the vnJucs of the profession attempt to define acceptable behaviour, they usually do not offor answers about specific situations that arise for counselling profossionnls. Even though they do 00( provide precise guidelines for resolving aJI dilemma~ codes arc an important reference aid for decision making. Types of Ethical Dilemmas I . Distribution of scarce resources (rime, money, and opportunity to participate in a pros:ram) ■ An agency has limited funds available to assist clients with retraining. \Vho should get the money- the client with the greatest potential for success or the diem who needs it most? 2. Professional competence and e thical bcha,four of colleas:ues ■ A student on internship (fidd placement) becomes a"'"Urc that her supervisor is attending an AA meeting with one of he.r clients. ■ One of the staff informs you of his intemion to phone in side to extend his vacation a few more da)'S. 3. Policies and procedures of the as:cncy setting that appear oppr~sh'e or inscnsith<e to the cultural/dh·ersity needs of the clients it ser,-es ■ A worker has information about a client that, if made known to the ai;cncy, would make her ineligible for services that she badly needs. ■ You become aware that your client, a single mothe.r on wdfare srrus.,tling to care for her four children on a meagre budg,et, received a cheque from her mothe.r to hclp with expenses. Legally, she is obligated to declare this income, which will be fully deducted from her next welfare P3yment, thus, depriving her and he.r children of much•nccded assistance. 4 . Behaviour of clients ■ A 17-year-old girl asks for your help to obtain an abortion without involving her pnrcnts. ■ Your client informs you that he has tested positive for HIV, but he hasn't informed his parcne.r. ■ A 16-year-old boy tc11s you that he is working as a p~titute. ■ Your client casually mentions that he robbed a bank several months ago but was not caught. 5. Competing values, needs, procedures, or leRal requirements ■ A IS..)'C3r-0ld girl discloses that her father has been abusive, but in recent wedcs, he seems to have changed. She asks that you do not make a report to the authorities. She says she knows her father will retaliate if he finds out that she has told anyone. ■ A young J6.ycar-old Jehovah's \Virncss as.sens her belief that she should not be given a blood transfusion to deal with a terminaJ illness. ■ An abused child S3YS he will 00( cooperate with removal from his parents and that he will run away from any foster home. Resolving Ethical Dilemmas Erford (2010) describes five ethic.al rules or principles that can be used to help resolve ethicaJ dilemmas: I. Amonomy: Honour clients' self-determination and the.ir frttdom to make their own decisions. 2. Beneficence: Pursue the welfare and benefit of others. 3. Nonmalef,cf!'nu: In simple term~ do no harm to others. 12 Chap1er 1 4. )1urice: Strive for an equal distribution of resources and equitable effort among p3rticipants. 5. Fideliry: Be loyal 3nd honest and keep promises. Under idea] conditions, counsellors c3n honour all five principles, but ethic3l dile.mmas by nature represent competing principle~ 3nd C3ch choice involves unique consequences. Ethic31 decision making involves identifying 3nd we.ighing which of the five principles ought to take priority in any given situ3tion. The application of any modcJ for ethical decision making docs not mC3n that resolution of ethical dilemm3s will be easy. When values and ethics compete, deciding which one should h3\'C priority c3n be painfully diff1euk Consider 3 case where an individu3l in remission from cance.r stipulates th3t if his cancer rerurns he docs not want further surge.ry or other invasive tre3tment. Suppose yc3.rs later, he devcJops dementia and his cancer returns. He now asserts that he wants trc3nncnt. \\:fhich "pc.rson 's" wishes should a c3regivcr honour, the one with sound mind from the past or the current one with diminished capacity! (Adapt~ from Locke, 2014.) lntimate knowledge of cthic3J principles and legal guidelines can make the decision.making process dearer, albe.it no less difficult. For example, 3 client's right mconfidenti3fity 3nd self-determin3tion must be given up when that client discloses child abuse, 3nd the duty to warn principle means that profcssion3fs must brc3k conftdentiality to warn potential \•ictim.s. However, it is not a1wa\'S dear when a client's bch3viour constitutes dange.r to the safety of others. The principle of sdf-determin3tion protects the right of people to make errors and c3rry out 3ctions that others might consider wrong. Counsellors must consider when the applic3tion of this principle must be abandoned because the individu3f 's behaviour might result in death, such 3s in a case where 3 client threatens suicide. \\:lhile counsellors have a clear legal and ethical responsibility to inte.rvcnc to prevent suicide, their responsibilities arc not as dear for other ch3llen,;cs. For example, the lifestyles of homeless persons m3y reach the point where their h\'gicne, living, and C3ting h3bits become dangc.rous for them. The point 3t which their right to self..dete.rmin3tion should )tield to their right to health and well-being is not easy to establish. An ethic3J dilemma exists. There 3re four steps counsellors c3n take to resolve ethical dilemmas(scc Figure 1.2). Step 1: Gather Fads During this stage, it is important to controJ 3ny tendency to act impulsively. Remembe.r that assumptions 3nd hears3y 3re not the s3mc 3S facts. Most ethic3J codes require that profcssion3ls s«k resolution with colleagues before procttding. For e.x3mplc, the CCPA code advises a counsellor who has concerns 3bout the ethical beh3viour of another counsellor "to s«k an informal resolution with the counsellor, when fe3sible 3nd appropriate" (2007, p. 6). In many case~ frank discussion with colleagues revc3fs additional information or results in a S3tisfactory solution. Step 2: Identify Ethical Issues and Potential Violations At this point, r<fer to the appropriate code of ethics (CASW, CCPA, etc.) to identify whether the matter unde.r question is addressed in the code. If the person in question is not govc.rn~ by 3 professional code, then 3gency policies and procedures or local legislation m3y ))t) BRAIN BYTE [ lI , ,, I 1 .• · JI, , Curr'ent and emerging oour'oimagi~ techniques raise 100 possibility that one day lhese lOOIS could be used to (83d minds. perhaps to deternine if a per-son is tying 0r harbOur'· ing prejudicial views. In fact, rudimeniary toolS to do lhis are · · I ,_ already being used. This raises rn'lportant ethical Questions: to what ex.tant migt\t neuroscience be used in le-gal settings to determine guilt 0t whether 0r not a person ShOulcl be gr'anted paroo CSmm,. 201311 Protesslonal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 13 l.Galher FaclS ... 2 . Identify Ethical Issues Pocential 3. Identify and Evaluate Options and Strategjes V.outions Figure 12 Model for Resolving Ethical Dilemmas provide important reference points. For example, m3tte.rs of discrimination in Canada are 3ddressed under the Canadian Human Righu Acr (1985). Step 3: Identify and Evaluate Options and Strategies Here the goal is to list the potential action strategies. \Vhere appropriate, consulting with colleague~ professional ori:ani.z3tions, 3nd supervisors c3n assist in generating altern3tives. Reflective questions help you consider the merits and ramifte3tions of any action pl3n. He.re are some S3mple questions: ■ What 3re the 3dvant3ges and dis3dvant3ges of not taking action? ■ What 3re the 3dvant3ges and dis3dvant3ges of taking 3ction? ■ What are the potenti31 consequences (short-term and long-term) of 3ction or inaction! ■ Who might gain or lose? ■ What other individuals or org:.mi:rations 3re likely to be affected? ■ To what extent might other factors be influencing my judgment (e.g., unresolved relationship problem~ bias, and hidden agendas)? ■ Wh3t values 3nd principles have priority? Boyle and colle:igues (2006) suggest 3 rank order of echicaJ principles (s« Figure 1.3). They identify seven ethicaJ principles, Figure 1..3 Ethical Princip les Hierarchy Adapt@d r,om so-,,1e e1 at. 2006. p. 97. 14 Chap1er 1 -- Ceetr,.._ ..,_ ..,_ No Figure 1.4 Matrix Oecision•Making Chart for Ethical Dilemmas giving the highest priority to protection of life, which su~rsedcs 3JI of the other rights. The equality nnd inequality principle entitles people to be treated equaJly, and this right supersedes an individual's right to autonomy and freedom. The least harm principle aims to minimi:c the advc.rsc consequences of any course of action. The quaJity of life principle SUjlRCSts that counsellors should choose aJtc.rnativcs that enhance quality of life over those that diminish it. Privacy and confidc:ntin1it)•, while important, arc given lesser priority than those rights higher on the hierarchy. Similarly, truthfulness and full disclosure arc important ethical principles, but they may be compromised if overridden by other, higher-mt~ principles. A matrix chart, such as that illustrated in Figure 1.4, can be used as a tool to compile and compare the bcndits and risks of the a1tc.rnatives. A ~parate anaJ,.•sis should be done for each choice. Entries should consider both the short.- and long-term costs and benefits of a given cour~ of action. Consult with experts and others when completing this task. Step 4: Take Action A ~ action plan should include details of the intended outcome. a list of the people who neo:I to be involved, required resources (e.g., information, mttt:ing space, and cxte.rnal facilitator), and the JittlUCnce of events that must be accomplished. A concrete timetable with dearly defined steps ensures that you will not lose time wondering what to do next. The action plan should also anticipate obstacles and identify strategies for addressing them. For example, if )'OU are confronting a colleague on a breach of ethical behaviour, it would be wise to consider what you might do if the colleague ■ launches a counteranac.k. ■ reacts with feelings such as anger, remorse, or shame. ■ denies that the behaviour occurred. ■ asks that you keep your lcnO'l.\rledge of the breach confidential between the two of you. SUCCESS TIP Resolution of ethical dilemmas is lntellectualy challenging and emotionaly &axing,. Seek appcopri".ate consultation and supervision for ~noing and debriefing. Objectivity Effective counseJlors ma)' become intimardy familiar with the lives of their diem~ )'et they arc required to remain objective. O bjectivity is defined as the capacity to understand situations and people without bias or distortion. \Vhcn counsellors are objective, Protesslonal Identity: Ethic s, Values, and Self-Awareness objectivity: ne ability to understad ree.p, thoclpas. and bdt.lriour without al~ penonal values, belit.ls. •d bias.es to interfere. 15 assumptions: Oistottions oc lalst c:icadusicm bas!d on siapliv.ic teasoning. ilcomp~e inforaution. • bias. they understand their clients' fccJings. thoughts, and behaviours without aJlowing their pc.rsonal values, belief~ and biases to contaminate that understanding. They aJso do not directly or subtly cry to impose their prefcrr~ solutions on clients. CounseJlors can fail to be objective in a number of ways. The first is to make assumptions. Assumptions arc distortions or false conclusions based on simplistic rc3,. soning, incomplete information, or bias. Counsellors who have had similar experiences to their clients' may assume that the.ir clients' problems and fttlings arc the same as their own. Conscquendy, they don()( take the time to investigate the distinctive viewpoints of their clients. Counsellors aJso may make assumptions about the meaning of words, but this danger cnn be avoided if counscJlors remain alert to the need to probe for individuaJ client definition and meaning, as in the following example: Client (spe:a.kina tet a Fir;;t N3detns <:eturuellor): I moved here :.bout (h~ )'l":arS ~o. I Kuess you know how t'O~ it is (m- an Indian in this dty. CetunseUor (Choke I): I sure do. PreJudiee i.!l e\'e:r)•where. CetunseUor (Choke?): As you say. it is not e:3Sy. But it's di((erent for e\'eryone. I need your help to understand better what it' s be<en like (or )Ou. CONVERSATION 1.2 ST\JDENT: I know vd'lat I'm supposed to do, but I'm wOfrted abOut hO'N Ican conttol my personal feelings vd'len I'm intetviewing SOO"MlOOO who haS done sornethi~ te(tible. sud'I as tape a ctltk:1 ot beat up his wife. How do you Slay objective in situations •ke those? SUPERVISOR: Tel me a bit about what you think you a(e sup. posed todo. ST\JDENT: 1need to make SU(e that I am obj,e,ctive and that I do not let my personal feelings interle-re. SUPERVISOR: Sure, that is the ovetaU goal. Ho-.veve-r, au of us wdl have some pel"S0031 feelings about \\tlat die-nts have done. Your fears a(e very normal fOr' someone just saarti~ in the field. usuatty, with a bit of expe(aence, most people a(e able to manage their footings. ST\JDENT: What if the client's behaviou( iovotve-s 1r.iogs that do not allow me to get past my initial (eYulsion? SUPERVISOR: If that happened to me. I would have to ask myse-if, ·can I be sufficiently in conttol of my own feeli~ to wOl'k effectivety with this person?'" In some case-s, I can compensate fOI' a bias, and in Olhet cases, 1ptObably should nol be iOVOl\l&d in the the-rapeutic (elationship. However, I am no1 sure tr.at anyone is at,e tosaay truly objective in situations whete they are iovotved with someooo who has pe(petrated a violent c,irne or hatmed a young chlld. The big questions fOI' me are, "How do I maintain an awareness and openne-ss abOut my personal feeli~r and "HON dO I mitigate those footings W'he-n deali~ with a pe(S()O \\tlo has done such a 16 Chap1er 1 thing?'" S0tnetime-s suctl cases bri~ up untesolved issues from our O'Nf'I past that need to be te-e-.Karnined 01' p t ~ flXthe-r. Sometime-s we simpty need toacknowtedg,e that the-re are certain practice a(e.as tr.at are not the be-sl fit• foe us individually as ptaCbtioners. The value of supervision in suctl clfcumstances rS Clea(. 8 STUDENT: Do I have to like my clients W'I orde( to wOr'k wilh them? COUNSEllOR: The-re will always be clients who rub us the wrong way. Some a(e demanding. insuting, Or' threatening. and it's a challe-nge to fe-e-1 any (e-al empathy. If that's part of the c~nt's usual style (and it oft.en is), then this pt'O\lide-s impor&ant information that can be addtessed in counse-tliog. If a client Mpushe-s our buttons_· some-time-s a lltue introspection is in Ol'de(. Do OU( (e-actions ttlgge( memorie-s of Othe-r unresdved issues 01' experiences in our lives? STUDENT: Transfe-rence? COUNSULOR: Yes, it sure could be. We atsoneed to deal wilh a range of olhet fee-tings that can a(.se such as feellngs of overp(otectivene-ss toward a client. Ct, when we have strong positive fee-tings. These tesponses may need to be managed just as much as. \\tle-n we wol'k with clients. \\tlo aro~ our disgust, a•(· 01' frusuation. STUDENT: from what you've been saying, in au cases, the goal is the same. Be aware of out personal teactions, 100n manage the-m. If this isn'I possible, (,efe, the Client Ol se-ek s.upel"Vision and support f0t youn;e-lf. (n this examp le, C hoice I cuts o ff th e discussion, and the counseJlor loses a vnJuable o pponunit)' to ap preciate the client's exper ie nce. Choice 2, on the o ther hand, o ffers gen tle e mpathy and then p robes for m ore detail. This second response reduces the risk that the cou nscllo r will make e.rrors o f assumption. A second way chat cou nscllo rs can lose objectiv ity is by over -ide ntify ing with clien ts. Whe n ove.r-ide ncification occurs, counsellors lose their capacity to keep sufficie nt emotio nal d istance fro m th eir clients. Their o"'n feelings a nd reactions become mixed up with those of their clients, cloud ing che.ir jud gment. C ounsellors who fin d th emselves in this position ma)' find chat persona] cou nsclling or consultation with a su per• visor is sufficient to help the m regain objectivity, or they may condude th at referral to another co unsellor is necessary. A third Wtt)' chat counsellors can lose objectivity is by becoming ove.rly involved with clients. This over-involvem ent includes duaJ relationships prohibited by ethical codes, as wdl as relationships in which cou nscllo rs rdy on clients to meet their social and psychological needs. To prevent chis from happening, cou nsello rs n eo:I to make sure that th ey are meeting the.ir personal needs in other W'n)' S. As weJI, co u nsellors should be alert to signs th at they ma y be ove r-involved with particular clients. SUCCESS TIP Waming signs of O\let◄nvotvement: Interviews that consistently run O\let lime, tefief when a client misses an appointment, excessive worry abOut clients, teluc&ance 10 end a counselling tetationship that haS reached a point of tennination, M~ttons• being pushed, 0t strong feelings (negative 0t positive) toNard the client evOk.ed. Tab le 1.4 summ ari!es p rotective strategies counseJlo rs ca n u se co avoid loss of objectivity. TABLE 1.4 Mai ntaining Objectivity Loss of Objectivity Pto1ective Stratery Choices Making assump(ions • Attempt to understand and monit0r you- prejudices. preferences., and biases (e.g., cullural, gender, and teli~us). • Develop setf-awareooss regarding personal needS and values. • Listen to but do not be contrOlled by the opinions of otherS. • Be k'lquisilive. Uptore ead'I client's situation to discover his 0t het unique perspective. • 8tainstOl'm 0t seek infotmation frOO'l all perspectives. • Check your conclusions with clients 10 see if they match lheil'sseek definition. detail, and examples. • Monit0r reactions and discover areas of vufnietability; be alert to strong negative Or positive reactions 10 clients. • Refer d ients vd'len you are not impartial ot able to conttol )'OIX Over-identification leeti~ • Know why you want to be a eounsettor- underStand your needs. • use COiieagues to analyie your reactions and give you feedbaek. • use toots sud'I as video rec0tdi~ to review interviews lot inappropriate attemprs to influence or contror. • Avdd promoting d ient dependency. • Develop a wellness program to ensure that you are not rel'jing on youf clients to meet )'OIX needs f0r social and psychOlogical i.nvolvement and acceptance. • Recognize wani ng signs of over◄nVOlvement. Prot esslortal Identity: Ethic s, Values, a nd Self-Awareness 17 CONVERSATION 1.3 ST\JOENT: ts it ever- Okay to be sexualty intimate with clients? TEACHER: No! Uni"8(S31Iy, ethical Coeles ot behaviou( PfO• hibil sexual intimacies 'Mth clients. for example, 100 CASN's Guide/it)es for £Jflical Ptactic.e (2005) succinctly states that •social WOr'k.ers dO not engage in romantic relations.lips. sexual activities 0t sexual contact with clients. even if such con1ac1 is sougt\t by dients· (p. 12). A similar iniunction ex,:ilic:itty stated i"I the CCPA's Code of Ethics (2007) prOhibits any type of sexual relationship with clients aoo any counsem.ng relationship with clients with whOm they ha\18 had prior sexual relationstips. STUDENT: That seems str-aightiorward. What about beCOming involved with f0tme-r clients? TUCH£R: That's a mOl'e diffieult question. My opinion is that you never Should. but you ShOuld consult indi\lidual cOdes of ethics fOr' specific guidelines.. For example, 100 CCPA code reciutes a minimum of 1r.ree years between the end of the counselling relationShip and the begjnn.-ig of a sexual relationship. The petiod is ex.1e-nded indefinitely if 100 client is cl8ar1y vlJnerable. In any case, counseUOrs Mcl8ar1y bear the b1Xden to ensure that no such explodati\'e influence has occu«ed" (2007, p. 9). A review of the liter-ature concludes that harm to clients does occur when p(ofessiooalS have sexual contact wtlh clients.,. including "denial, guilt Shame, isolation, a•(· deptession, impaired ability to trust, loss of self-esteem, difficulty ex.ptessing anger, emotional liabtlily, psycMsomalic disorders, sexual confusion, and increased risk of suk:;oo· (Beckman et al., 2000, p. 223). STUDENT: What about Other- types of involvement? If you are a counse!IOr' in a s.mal to-M'I, it's impossible to avoid social contact wtth clients.. Your client migf\t be the owner ot the onl'j grocery store in town. TUCH£R: COdes of ethics fo( the various counselling professions (e.g., psycholOgy or social wo,k) frown upon dual relationships when there is a possibility that counsenors wil lose obfe(::tMty or where there is potential fOr' client exploitation. In large cities, it's usualty easy to refer clients to avoid the conflict of i"lteresl of dual relationships.. As you point out it's much more difficult in a small town, and some dual relatiol\Shiparra~ments may be inevitable. Howe\18r, relationships Should oover include sexual intimacy wtth cu«ent clients. THE COMPETENT COUNSELLOR A high level of sc]f.3wareness enables counsellors to make important decisions regarding arc3s in which they arc competent 3nd those in which reforraJ to other professionaJs is warranted. Counsellors must practise only within the range of their competence, and they should not misrepresent their training o r c:xpc.ricncc. This helps to ensure that they do no harm to clients. T he following guidcJines provide reference for working with competence: I. \Vork within rhe limiu of competence. Counsellors should offer counselling services that arc within the limits of thc.ir professional competence, as measured by edu.cation and professional standards. Competent counsellors use only chose cc-ch.niquc-s and strategies that they have been adequately trained to appl)•. They know that the support and assistance- of other professionals is necessary for issu es that exceed their expertise. Until counsellors have received the necessary training and supervised practice, they should not work in specialized arC3s of practice, such as interviewing children in abuse situations o r administering or interpreting pS)•,. chological tests. For example, re3ding a boolc or attending a ,vo rkshop on mcmal health does not qualify untrained counsellors to make psychiatric diagnoses, nor would attendance at a short seminar on hypnosis qualify them to use hypnosis in their work. Such speci3Ji!ed interventions usually require certification b)• their professional body. CounscJling requires skilled interviewing but includes the additional goal of helping clients with such activities as problem solving, dealing with p3inful fee],. ings., and de-vcJoping new skills. Psychotherapy involves intensive counselling with emphasis on persona1it)• change o r the treatment of more severe mental disorders. 18 Chap1er 1 2. Pursm~ professional rraining and detelopment. CounseJlors should monitor their w-ork and scclc supervision, training, or consultation to evaluate their effectiveness. They should pursue continued profession:.d development to increase the.ir competence and kttp their knowledge current. This helps to ensure that their work is based on evidence-based best practice derived from accepted theory supported b)• empirical research. People would not want to Stt a doctor whose most r«ent training was decades ago in medical school. Similarly, clients should not be expected to work with counsellors who are not current in their ficld. Professional counsellors need a core lcnowledi;c base, which typicall)• requires nvo or more years of academic training:, including supervised clinical o:pcrie.ncc in a recognized counselling or social service serting. Moreover, throughout their career~ counsellors should expect to spend time in reading books and journals to increase their knowledge. As well, regular attendance at courses, seminar~ and conferences should be a part of everyone's professional career. By keeping the.ir knowledge base current, counsellors arc better able to be empathic because they arc more aware of the issues and feelings that their clients face. Moreover, keeping up to date helps counsellors avoid judgmental responses based on only their O\\•n frames of reference. The range of knowledge that counsellors need to pursue includes the following: ■ Specific is.sues, problems, and c.halleni;cs that the.ir clients arc facing. For example, counseJlors ,vorking: in corrections need to know something about finding a job if one has a criminal r«ord and coping with the stigma of a criminal record. As another o:amplc, many clients arc dealing: with poverty, and counsellors nttd to be aware of its social and psychological effects. ■ Relevant medical and psychiarric conditions (e.g., attention deficit disorder, multiple sclerosis, schi:ophrcnia, bipolar disorder, and autism). Counsellors credibility and competence is greatly enhanced if their lcnO\\•ledge of these conditions is current. ■ Lifcst)•le wriations(c.g.., same-sex relationships, single P3rents, extended families, and blended families). ■ Cultural awareness about the values, belief~ and customs of others. ■ Lifespan development (i.e., developmental chani;cs and milestones from birth to death). Life experience can greatly increase a counsellor's capacity for empathy and understanding. Of course, life experience may also cloud judgment and objectivity, so it is important that counsellors scclc training and consultation to increase their understanding of others' experiences. ■ Monitoring: emerging trends in neuroscience. 3. Be self-au,areof personal reactions and 1mresolt\!d issues. CounseJlors need to be aw-nrc of situations where their clients' problems parallel unresolved issues in the.ir O\\•n lives. This awareness is important to help counsellors lcnow when to scclc consultation or supervision, when to refer clients to other ,vorkers, and when to enter counselling to address their own needs. Clients have a right to expect that their counsellors are objective about the is.sues being discussed and that their judgment is not imP3ired by bias. unresolved personal problems, or ph)•sical illness. If counsellors have emotional or physical problems that affect the.ir ability to give competent se.rviccs., thq• should discontinue se.rvicc to the client. In addition, large caseloads and the emotional demands of counselling: worlc may result in emotional and ph)•sical fatigue, the.reby weakening: a counsellor's competence. Competent counsellors monitor their emotional health: by setting limits on their amount of worlc, they arc able to leave time to pursue personal wellness and balance in their lives. Familiar with the dangers of burnout and vicarious trauma, they de,.•c-lop strategics to prevent these career threatening reactions. Protesslonal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 19 CONVERSATION 1.4 ST\JOENT: I'm just a begj.nnet. So, if I am supposed to work withrl the limits of my competence, I ShOt.ldn't do anything. TUCH£R: Like many counseltors whO a(e just starting. you may feel a bit overwhelmed. ST\JOENT: I cSon't want to say or do the wro~ thi~. What if I doni know the right answers. Or' I oon·1 say the right thing to clients? TEACHER: flrst lhe(e is rarety a single rigt\t way to respond. Most often, them is a range of d'IOices ot thires to say Or' oo in any situation. Second, no one kroNS all lhe rigl\t answers. Be hOoost with diants abOut the fact that you are stll a Sh.dent and oon1 be afraid to adnil )(II.I' limitations, as this i:,ovi:Ses we.at modelli~ for clients. One goal of ttaini~ is fOr' you to ~ d your r'af'@e ot d'IOices so lhat you can respond based on the needS ot your clients and thes situations. Remember', leami~ to be an effeclMl c:ounseno, Isa lilOIOngproooss. At this Sfall!!. you, professional responsibility is to make effectf\18 use d supervisors to monitor' )(IU' \\O'k. use them to oovelOp you Skits. Make it easy f0t them 10 flve you feedback. Seek 1t out. an:S then try 10 be noroefensM>. l.OOk fat oppcrl\Jntties 10 •Pl'IY you, deYelopir'e k ~ base b'f &aki~ some risks 10 k>am re1t Skins. wren I first srarted k'I the flel:j_ I aaso feared sayk'lg something that would damage my client When I shated this feeling with one ot my prolessors. he put 1t in perspective by saying. "What makeS you think you're so important to the d ient?· In general, interviewing is 3 process of gathering inform3tion without any expectation of influencing or changing clients. Competent interviewing rttauir-cs an 3bility to explore 3nd understand clients' attitudes, fttlings, nnd perspectives. The basis for this competence is 3 nonjudgmental attitude 3nd intelligent application of the 3ctivc listen in a: sic ills of attending. using silence, paraphrasing, summ3rizing, and asking ques..tions (sec Ch3ptc.rs 4 to 6). Although the principal goal of interviewing is information gathering, the process of interviewing ma)' IC3d clients to rcJcasc P3inful or forgotten fttlings. Thus, adept interviewers 3re capable of dealing with unpredictable re3ctions th:.n the interview elicits or of referring clients to 3pproprinte altern3tivc resources. Moreover. they know when and how to probe effective!)•. SELF-AWARENESS Everything rhat irritares us a.bow others can lead us to an under.ttanding of ourselt.1es. --Ca,f )uns (publ lcdoma en) The Importance of Self-Awareness Compctent counscJlors need to acquire a high level of 3Wareness of who they arc. Until counsellors develop self-awareness of their own needs, fccJings. thoughts, 3nd behaviours, including their personaJ problems and their 3reas of vulnerability, they will be unable to respond to their clients with objectivity. T3ble 1.5 contrasts the characteristics of counsellors who h3ve high levels of self-awareness with those who have low Jc,.'Cls of self-awareness. CounscJlors who lack self-aw-arcness and 3re not motivat~ to pursue it arc destined to rem3in un3ware of the ways they influence clients. For c.x3mple, they may be un3ware of how their nonvcrbaJ reactions to controversial topics betra)' their biases 3nd discomfort. Capuzzi 3nd Gross (2009) highlight the importance of counsellors developing awareness of thc.ir own spiritu3I and religious beliefs to 3ppropriatcly engage with their clients' spiritual issues: "Counsellors m3y not pick up on their clients' concerns because of their own bi3s or may piclc up on these themes too rc1ldily to the exclusion of other issues" (p. 304). They m3y avoid pnrricul3r topics, or they may behave in cenain wa)'S to m3slc their in~uritie.s. As another o:3mple, counsc-llors with personal needs for control m3y meet this need through excessive and inappropriate advice giving. 20 Chap1er 1 TABLE 1.5 Self-Awareness counsellors with Setf-Awarei,e:ss • Recog.-.ze and underslancl their emotional (eactioos. • Accept tr.at everyone's experience is different • Know where tneil' foof~ end and those ot theit clients begin. • Recog.-.ze and accepa a(eas ot vulnerability and un(&SOl\ied issues. • Unde<staOCI pe-rsonal vah.Jes and their inftue~ on the counselling telationst-.p. CounsellOrs without Selt-Awarenes.s • Avoid ot ate unaware of theit feeli~. • Assume clients wi• resJX)nd ot f/MII the same as lhem • Project pe-rsonal feelings onto d ients. • R&SJX>nd inappropriately because unresolved prot,ems inte-rfete with theit capacity to be ot:;ective. • Unde<staOCI and conttOI personal defence mechanisms. • React emotionally to tnelr clients but don't uOClerStand why or how. • uncoosciousty use cliMts to WOr'k out looir o,m personal difficulties. • Remain blind to defensive reactions. • Recog.-.ze and manage internal diatogue. • Know hOw they influence clients and counselling outcomes. • Remain una-Nar"e ot how their behaviour inft~oces Olhers. • MOClify beha'Jiout baSed on teactioos of clients.. • Behave based oo personal needs and styte rather tr.an in response to the needS and feacl:.ions of clients. • Set prolessional goats based oo knowledge ot perSOoal and • Avoid Of limit goal setting beeause they are unaware of personal and protessi::>nal needs. skill SlrMgthS and limitati:)ns. • Accutatety identify and apptaise counselling skill competence. • Overestimate Or' underestimate eounseni~ Slul • Know those areas that are llk.ely to lrigger unhelpflA feelings • Are reactive without i.nsigt\t. competence. 0t responses. Increasing Self-Awareness Counsellors who 3rc serious about dcvcJoping their self.awareness are secure enough to rislc exploring their strengths and limitations. Self.awareness means becoming 3Jcrt and lcnowlcdgcable 3bout personal W3)'S of thinking. acting, and feeling. ScJf.3w3re counscJlors arc strong enough to be open to discovering 3spccts of themselves that they might prefer to keep hidden. This is 3 continuing, c3reer•long process that requires courage as counsellors loolc at thcmscJves and their ability to relate to others. Colleague~ supervisor~ and clients can be extreme!)• hcJpful sources of informa, tion, but their feedback needs to be cultivated. Generally, people 3re reluctant to deliver critic31 feedback, hO\\•e-vcr hcJpful it ma,., be. Therefore, it is important that counscJ.lors create the conditions th3t encourage feedback. They can invite input from others through a number of srrntegics. The first strategy is to create a safe climate. People balk at giving feedback to other~ because they fear how it will be rccejvcd. One concern is the rislc of retaliation: "If 1 SU)' something, will I be annckcd or m3dc to foci guilty?" Another common worry is th3t feedback will damage the relationship. The major conce.rn also might be that feedback will cripple the other person's sclf•cstecm. Therefore, counsellors must demonstrate th3l they arc read)•, willing, and able to respond nondefcnsivcly to focdbaclc. They have a responsibility to consider feedback 3nd, when 3ppropriate, to nct on it. They don't h3VC to 3grcc unconditionally with what has been s3id to them, but they must listen 3nd give nonaggrcs.sive responses-in other words, without blame or excuses. Sometimes such control can be difficult to sustain, pnrticula.rly if feedback is delivered in an uncaring 3nd hostile m3nne.r. A gencrnJ rule when denJing with clients is that, no m3ttcr what clients say or do, counsellors must maintain a professional role. Of course, this docs not preclude setting appropr13tc limits, nor docs it mean th3t counseJlors have to tolerate personaJ or physical abuse. lt means Protesslonal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Selt•Awareneu 21 stayina calm, beina nondcfensivc, and rcfrainina from rctaJiatory responses, such as name callina or makina punishing statements. The second StTil.teay is to use active listening skills to ensure that feedback is con.crctc or spccifte. CounscJlors can ask questions to J;Ct derails, definitions, examples, and clarification. Summari!ing and paraphrasina can also be u~ to confirm underst:mdina. Who Am I? How Do Others See Me? Self.awareness for counsellors involves answerina nvo basic questions: Who nm I! and How do o the.rs see me! These questions require co unseJlors to explore and understand their pe.rsonal feelings, thoughts, and behaviour. Feelings Effective counsellors arc comfortable discussina a wide range of emotions. They do not avoid feelings; in fact, they recognize that, for many clients, understand· ing and mannging painful emotions is the greatest o utcome o f counselling. To under• stand client emotions, co unseJlors must be in rune with their own emotional reactions. Empathy, the basic tool for unde.rstandina the feelings of o thers, will be contaminated unless counsellors are fully in touch with their own feeJings. This includes knowing whe.re their feelings end and those of their clients begin. Work and personal srress may also ncg3tively affect a counsellor's capacity to relate effectively to clients. Counsellors must be aware of stressful situations and understand how they react to them. Self.aware counseJlors avoid o r reduce strcs.sors b\• developing pe.rsonal wellness plans for coping with the inevitable demands of the job. Thoughts Counsellors need to be aware of their own inte.rnal d ialogue-the inner voices that evaluate their actions. Counsellors with low self.worth t)tpically find that the inner voice is c ritical, issuing mes.sages such as "J'm no good." Negative seJf-talk can lead to emotional d istress and interfere with co unseJling performance in several ways: ■ Counsellors may be reluctant to be assertive with clients and may be excessively gentle o r nonconfrontational. ■ Counsellors mn't' be unable to assess counselling relationship outcomes objectively if they tend to interpret problems as personal failures and to discount positive feedback or o utcomes. Counsellors need to become watchful of negative seJf-talk as a crucial first step in developing a program to combat its effects. Subscqucndy, systematic techniques such as tho ugln•stoppina can be used to replace depreciating self-talk with affirmations o r positive st:nemcnts. defence mechani sms: Mealal process or teadion t!lat shields a Pff'S• ffOffl ~ble orunaa:•able thCtlgllts, feelings. or COlldssioa t!lat. ii a«:ep:fd, 'Mlllkl aeate allliety•dlallerips toone's s.e of sfff. Coaaon deieace media• lisms ilclude deaial displaa!fflffll. tati> ama~ioo. StWtSsion, and ie,pession. 22 Behaviour Counsellors need to take time to discover how clients arc reacting to them. Personal needs and defence mechanisms may lead counsellors to assume blindly that problems in thecounsclling relationship arise from their clients' inndequades or failings. Although effective counsello rs have confidence in their own abilities, they have to accept that occasionally they may say or do the wrong thing. Counscllors neo:I to be m:nure and open enough to evaluate their work and to cake responsibility for their errors and insen.sitivitics. For example, o pen minded counseJlorsconsider the possibility that clients may be angry for J;ood reason, perhaps because of o ppressive agency routines. Counsello rs who lack seJf awareness m3y foil to understand or accept the needs o f their clients and are more likeJy to take their clients' behaviour too personally. UJti,. mntcl't', counsellors need to be se.lf aware enough to know which client reactions are reactions to their behaviour o r personalities and which arc the result of other variables beyond their control. Sigmund Freud first described defence mechanisms in 1894. A defence mechani-.m is a mental process or reaction that shields a person from undesirable or unacceptable Chap1er 1 thought~ feelings. or conclusions that, if ncccpccd, would crcnte nnxicty or dnmnac one's seJf-cstecm. Defence mechanism~ which arc unconsciou~ distort reality and serve to protect people from perceived threats. S imple defences include bfomina ochers or making excuses for the.ir own failures. For example, counscllors might take credit for counselling successes but blame failure on their clients. Common defence mechanisms used by counscllors include the followina: ■ Denial: Rdusina to acknowledge the existence of feclinas or problems. \Vhen counseJlors use denial, they fail to conside.r that their actions might be the reason for their clients' inapproprinte behaviour. ■ Displacement: Shift of emotions o r desires from one person or object to another person or object. For uamplc, counseJlors deal with their own work stress b\• behnvina aagressivdy with clients. ■ Rarionalhation: Developing excuses or explnn:nions to protect their self image. For exnmple, counscllors justify their inability to confront clients b\• concluding that it is best to offer only positive feedback. ■ Suppression; Averting stressful thoughts by not thinking about them. For example, counsello rs refuse to conside.r that personal biases might be affecting the.ir decisions. ■ Regression: Dealing with conflict o r stress by rcturnina to behaviour from an enrlier stage of life. For example, counseJlors deaJ with aggressive clients by becoming overly compliant or ove.rl)• pleasing. Counsellors should be alert to circumstances where they use defence mechanisms instead of confronting reality. Facing reality requires courage and mking risks because givina up one's defences means sacrificing safety. Moreover, feedback from oche.rs can be threatening because it challenges counsellors to let down the.ir defences by addressing aspects o f their situations that they might prefer to avoid. \Vhen counsellors unde.rstand themselve~ they r«ogni:e when their defences are up and can ta.kc steps to chanae the.ir reactions nnd behaviour. They know when and wlu~re they are vulnerable; then, they use this knowledge to cue or trigge.r noodefensive alternatives. For example, when clients are angry o r hostile, rather than yielding to the natural impulse to fight back, counsellors can d iscipline themselves to cake time to empathi!e and encourage clients to ventilate. &If awarecounscllors know their skill strengths nnd limitations. This se]f n\\--areness enables them to avoid overusing particular skills simpl)• because they arc strengths, and it helps them to know when it is appropriate to refer clients to other counsellors. Jt also helps them to set goals for professional skill development. Knowing the limits of one's ab ility is a measure of competence. Personal Needs Counsellors have the same basic nttds as ewryone dse, including the nttd to be loved, respected, nnd wlued b\• others. This is natural; however, counsellors must understand how their personal needs can adversely affect counselling outcomes. Lacie of sdfowarcness rcgnrding: personal needs can lead to unconscious structurina of the session to meet the counsellor's nttds instead of the client's. One srudent was told b\• her supervisor that her clients really liked her as a pe.rson, but when they had a problem, they would go to someone clse beotuse thq• did not believe she was apnble of dealing with tough issues o r giving critical feedback. Throuah supervision and rc.flection this srudent learned how her need to be: liked left he.r vulnerable and ovc.rh• sensitive to client reactions. As a defence, she avoided doing anything that might arouse anxiety. Protesslortal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 23 SUCCESS TIP Even positive feedback frOO'l clients must be interpreted cautiously. Clients may lty to pla cate counsenors ot use k'lgratiating 1actk::s to manipl.Aate, Or' ,t may be theit way of t elating to authOrity. 4 A range of counscJlor needs m3y interfere with counscJling, inclu ding the need to be liked: the need to achieve status or prestige, control, and perfection; and the need to cultiwtc soci3l relationships. Table 1.6 summari!cs the major wnrning signs and risks of these needs. Need to Be Liked In Cluptc:r 3, we will explore the importance of a w·arm and trust- ing counselling relationship. lnrgcl'>'• counselling depends on c.smblishing and maintaining a safe cnvironn'litm, one in which dicnts feel safe enough to take risks. Obviously. this is ca~ ier if clients lilce thc.ir counsellors: hm, -e\-er, counsellors need to remembc.r that h.nving di,. ent:s like them is not the p rimary goa1 of counselling. The aim of counselling is to support dimt change o r problem mana~ment. This mC3ns th3t counsellors have to be nssc.rtive enough to risk makina rc3sonable dem3nds on their clients, which, in rum, may generate tension and anxiety. Otherwise, clients c3n ClSil)• sray locko:J imo established but unhealthy pancrns. The need to be- liked becomes problem:nic when it becomes more important dun ndiieving the goals of counscllina. One beginning counscllo r, 3 )-OUng m3Jc, wrote in h is ;ourn:.ll: "\\:rhen 3 client S3ys something negative o r bcluwes in a sclf-Ocscructive way, I real,. i.!e I hold b3ck. I don't S3Y anythina because I want to be liked. J want the client to like me, 00( ~meas an authority figure. I'd rathe.r be- seen as a pal or a friend." This journnl encry hiahliahts the dangers of this counsellor's need to be liked and sianal.s an important insiaht that will help him question some of his assumptions 3bout counselling. He will need to rc-cvalunte how his behavio ur may be saboroging client progress. TABLE 1.6 Managing Personal Needs in Counsel! ing Personal Need To be liked and to be helplul Warnlna Signs and Risks • WithhOICli~ potentially helpful but critical feedbaek • lnapptoprlately a\lOidlng controversy Or' conffict • Trying to ingratiate (e.g.• excessivety praistng. tem~ clie-nts wtlat lhey wan1 IO hear) • Acti~ w'ilh rescuing behaviour • Expecting or re-act-.~ for compliments from clients Status or prestige Control Perlect;on;sm Trying to imptess with "exotic• ted'lnklues or t'.:l'iltiant interpmtations Taking credit for client success Na~roppiog Stagging abOut successes Advice givlflg lnterfe-ri~ with client se-tf~ete(minatioo (e.g., unnecessarily using authority, manipulating. and dominating) • lmposs"lg per'SOoal values • Stefe-otyping clients as needy and inadequate (which ere-ates a tde f0t someone to be "helpful") • • • • • • • focusi~ on mistakes • Pushi~ d ie-nts toward unrealistic goats • Re-sJX)ndlng with self-deprecation to mistakes (e.g., ..,,ma failure") Social relationst-.ps 24 Chap1er 1 • Becoming OYef-involved with clients (e.g., mee-1ing clients socialy, contS\uing counselling relationships beyond the nonnal point ot ctosure) • Indiscriminate setf-disclos...-e- Need for Status or Prestige Counsellors who have an excessive need to impress others. perhaps bcotuse of insecurity, may b«omc technique-centred instead of clientcentred. \Vith this switch in prioritic~ the nttds of the client ma'>' be overlooked as counsellors net to impress clients or others. The priority of counselling should be to bolster the self-esteem of clients. Need for Control Codes of ethics recogni!e that clients are vulnerable to exploita, tion. Consequently, counsellors need to pay substantial attention to refraining from behaviours that result in undue control of clients. The principle of self-dete.rmination (inmxluced earlier in this chapter) is a basic value that upholds the right of clients to make independent decisions. Counsellors interfere with this right when they attempt to take over clients' problems and orchcsrrate their solutions. ln some setting~ such as government agencie~ counsellors may have the legal mandate to impose their services. This siruation requires counsellors to be especially \'lgilam. As Brammer and MacDonald (1999) obse.rve, helpers in these settings "must be wary of identifying too closely with the power of the agency under the guise of carrying out the ai;cncy's mission. Often the helpec becomes lost in such settings, and the helping services tend to suppon the power of the organization. The result may be an exagg,erared emphasis on adjustment or pacification rather than on ac:rualization and liberation" (p. 40). Perfectionism Perfectionism, an unrealistic pursuit of exceJlence, can negatively affect counselling. Counsellors who are pe.rfectionists ma'>' be unable to appraise their work accurateJ'>', and they may have an unjustified tendency to blame thcmseJvcs for client failures. Sometimes counsellors who are perfectionists push clients toward unrealistic ,;oaJs or challen,;c them to move at too fast a pace. Need for Social Relationships Counsellors with unmet social needs risk overinvolvement with clicnts. Jf counsellors do not have outlets in their own lives for social interaction, they may misuse the counselling relationship for that purpose. Personal and Cultural Values Counsellor seJf-knowledi;c of personal values and preferences is indispensable for cff~ tive counselling. Values constitute a frame of reference for understanding and assessing clients and for making decisions and choices. Self-awareness of personal values is an important element of competence. All counsellors have personaJ values, and it is crucial that they understand what these values arc to avoid imposing them on clients. Self-awareness of personal values is a first step for counsellors to take to manage the bias that comes from inte.rprcting clients' behaviour from their own perspectives or cultures rather than from the clients'. Cultural self-awareness refers to knowled,;c of the custom~ traditions, role o:pccta, tion~ and values of one's culture of origin. Language is a particularly important variable. The word aurhorir1 will have a ve.ry different meaning for individuals who come from totalitarian countries and for those who come from egalitarian societies. Cultural self-awareness prepares counsellors to recognize and value the diversity of other cuLtures. Such awareness needs to be accompanied b)• a belief that one's own ethnic group is only one of many and that there are othe.r appropriate beliefs and behaviours. (ncvicably, the personaJ values of counsellors influence the way they assess client~ the tedmiques and procedures they use, and the goals that they deem reasonable, includ~ ing which topics will get more or less attention. Moreover, ce.rcain topics arc more valuecharged (e.g., abortion, assisted suicide, sexual orientation, religion, and abuse), and the beliefs of counsellors may bias their work in these areas. For example, counsellors who find that they never discuss sexua1it)• in their counselling work need to dete.rmine why. Protesslortal lden111y: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 25 TABLE 1.7 Values, Bel iefs, and Attit udes That Help and Hi nder Counsellors' Effectiveness Unhelpful Yali,es & Beliefs Helpful Values & Beliefs To accept help from 01oors is a sign ot weakooss. Some people are jUSI not d&Sef'Ving of OU( respect or cari~. People are inherently evil. Unless you a(e ca(eful, they wil take advantage of you. I ktlow what is best fot my clients. To accepa help is a sign of stte~. Everyone haS intrinsic worth and lhe capacity kl be P,Oductive. People are essential~ gpOd. People a(e capable of finding their o-,m It is essential that my clients llk.e me. answers and making decisions. The pu(pose of counselling is to help clients exe(cise d'loice, not to make clients ti.ke me. I've been there myself, so I kOowwhat my clients are leeli~. I can'I koow wtlat my clients are feelW'lg untJ I take the Ume to let them teach me. People are incapable of cha~iog, My religjoo/cult...-elviewpoint is lhe besl People can and dO cha~. In this wOr'ld, it is survival of the fittest We depend on one anOlhe(, and we have a respoosibiity to help Olhers. CounsetJors have a rigt\t to impose service Wrth some exceptions. clients can eho:>se to refuse service. wtlen it is in their clients' beSt interest I can accept a wide variety of cultures., refigfons. and viewpoints. Are they avoiding this topic because of pc.rsonal inhib itions? Are they unconsciously judging the sexual behaviour of their clients? One W'U)' for counscllors to address this problem is to disclose their values to their clients; however, they should do this in such a way that clients do not feel pressured to adopt similar values. Clients should feel free to maintain their own values without fear that they are in some way disappointing their counsellors. A counsellor's value S)'Stem is an important variable that influences the methods and outcomes of counselling. In general, counsellors are most effective when their wJ,. ues reflect an optimistic and nonjudgmental view of peoplc. lntcllectuaJly and emotionally, they accept and treasure the widest possible variations in lifestyle. They believe in the inherent strength and capacity of people and in their intrinsic right to freedom of choice. Table 1.7 examines some of the values that might impede or enhance counseJ,. lors' cffoctivcncs.s. \Vhcn counsellors have values that hinder effcctivencs~ they are more lilccly to find themselves behaving contrary to the ethics of the field , such as acting in wa)•s that inhib it self-determination or failing to respect the dignity of their clients. Conversely, counsellors who have w1ucs chat enhance che.ir ability arc more naturally inclined to support the ethics of the profession and arc more likeJy to behave in ways that empower che.ir cliems. PROFESSIONAL SURVIVAL Burnout: A state of emational, ment,l •d p~al aba11stion tut reduces • pew:nts peqi:le froa pe,fo,aing tlleir ;co. 26 \Vorking as a counsellor can be immenscly stressful and, for some, emotionaJly dangerous, p3.rticularly for chose who arc working with clients who have experienced trauma and abuse. People who work in hospitals and mental hc3lth settings. as well as those who work with children are P3.rticularly vulnerable. Continued exposure to client troubles can leave counsellors with little patience and resilience for deaJing with their own issues. Some experience burnout or vicarious rrauma. Burnout is a state of emotional, mcnml, and ph)•sical exhaustion that hinders or prevents people from performing their jobs. Burnout may affect people in different Chap1er 1 wa)'s, but certain symptoms arc typical T he stress of burnout may show itself as a genera] state of physical exhau stion, includina signs o f diminished health, such as headache~ sleep d isruptions, and d iacst ive upset . Emotional and mental burnout may reveaJ itself as increased anxiety, inability to cope with the normal demands of worlc, depression, excessive worry, discouraaement, pessimism toward clients, loss of a sense of purpose, general irritab ility, and an inability to find joy in one's career o r life. Vicarious trauma is a risk for anyone in the helping professions who wo rks with people who have been traumati:ed. Shea for and Horejsi (2008) offer this caution: After repe::ued exposures to clients who ha"e been tr.aum::ui:ed and 21re i.n areat distress. sod:)) worke-rs and o ther helperS 11\3)' de...elop symptoms o( tr.au ma themselve!l. sueh as intruSi\'e thou~,u and im~e!l. s leeplessness,. brstander auilt, (eelin,iS o( vuJner21bility, helplessnes!l. sel(.-doubt, 21nd r3~'C'. Workers who (eel especially 01:erwheln~ b)' d1saster, those who have h::.d a prior b:perience o( severe emotional tr.auma, 21nd those who 21re inexperien.e«I in di~ster,related work 21re espedall)' vulner:lhle to devtfopin& these S)•mptoms. (p. 57 I) vicarious trauma: An oa:upalional hazard for people in the llelpint prvlessions. ii wbQ they dMlop the same s,wrp:cai as llieir dents llflo haw beea traumatiHd. Counsello rs who suspect that they suffer from burnout or vicarious trauma should first consult a physician to rule out any medical condition that might be a factor. Obvi• ousl)•, the best way to deal with burnout is to prevent it from happening. For counsel• lors, this means balancing the demands of the.ir worlc life b\• taking care of thcmscJvcs. CounseJlors need to d evelop personaJ wellness pl.nns that address their own emotional, physical, and spiritual needs. An essemial part o f this p lan is time away from the job. Counsellors need to avoid b«omingovcr~involved by ,vorking unreasonably long hours and weekends or by skipping wcations. They need to make intelligent decisions about the limits of what they can do. CounseJlo rs can also prevent burnout by setting up and using a support system of fam ily, friend~ supervisor~ and colleagues. By doina so, they ensure that they have people to whom they can turn for assistance a nd emotionaJ support. \\:1o rk collea,iues and supervisors arc essential for hclpina counsellors manage their emotional reactions to clients. such as fear and anae.r. Counsellors nttd to r«ogni!e that being ab le co ncccJX help from others is a sian of strength and that they should model this bcJief in the.ir O\\•n behaviour. TaJking to others reduces isolation and allows for team participation and support with difficult decisions or situations. Jc is particularly important for co unse.llors to have someone to debrief with after stressful inter views, such as those with angry or abusive clients. Continued profcssionaJ d evelopment is another important strnteay for prcvcntina burnout. Seminar~ co urses, and conferences expose co unseJlors to new ideas and the latest research and can help them renew their enthusiasm and c reativity. SUCCESS TIP Preventin& Workplace Burnout Am:>ng the many p(oven strategj,es foe p(eventing btXnout a(&: a,Nareness and eatly inte(. vention to deal with symptOO'ls, exercise, nutrition, healthy personal relationsi-.ps, lifestyle balance, laughtet/having fun, mindful b(eathi.ng, mindh.Aness, debriefing wtth trusted COi· leagues and supervisors, use of a mentor or r·01e model. distancing oneself from negative cow0tkers, sleep, rec,eation, spirituality, taking a vacation, ensuring wofk.Jjace bl"eakS, maintaining teasonable office hours, scheduling chent interviews to mini.mile sustained perkx:ls of stress, wor1dng wtthin the limits ot one's cotnpetence, and accepting 1001 you can'I help everyone. Protesslonal Identity: Ethics, Values, and Self-Awareness 2·7 Cynicism • .........nt & ...... ... ._.., pe,sonal life Figure 1.5 Common Symptoms of Workplace Burnout SUMMARY 28 ■ CounscJling sc.rvices arc provided by a wide range of diffe.rent professional~ indud.. ing soci:.d workc.rs., nurses, psychologists., and others. ■ Professiona.1 codes of ethics define the acceptable limits of behaviour for profcs.sionals who provide counseJling services. They aim to protect clients from misuse of position and pcm"er by profcssiona.Js. and they strictly prohibit dunJ relationships that arc sexual or exploitive. ■ Ethics, derived from vn.Jucs., arc the principles and rules of acceptable conduct. The values of the counselling profession arc rooted in a few basic principles: belief in the dignity and worth of people, respect for divc.rsity, and respect for the client's right to self-determination. ■ An ethicaJ dilemma exists when a choice must be made between competing values. Five principles can help resolve ethical dilemmas: autonomy, beneficence, non.. maleficence, justice, and ftdcliry. EthicaJ decision making involves weighing the five principles and deciding which ought to have priority in a given situation. ■ Objectivity is the oi.paciry to undcrsmnd situations and people without bias or distortion. CounseJlors can lose their objectivity by making assumptions., ove.r.. identifying with clients, or becoming overly involved with their clients. ■ Sclf-:n\--nrcncss is esscmial for counsellors to work with objectivity. Self-aware coun.scllors know rhemsclv~heir feelings. thoughts, behaviour, personal needs, and areas of vulnerability. They understand how they affect clients, and they know the limits of their competence. They can answer the question, "Who am If' Chap1er 1 ■ Burnout and vicarious trauma. arc workplace ha: nrds that can b e addressed using a. variety of strategics such as lifcst)•le balance, nutrition, exercise, and effective use of trusti.XI colleagues and supervisors. EXERCISES Sett-Awareness I. What strong beliefs do memberS of youf clJturaVethnic g(OUJ) hcjd? 4. ExptOr'e yout perSOOal sttengths and limitations. Use lhe foHO\\;~ topi,'.:;s to structure your assessment: • capacity to be assertive (as opposed to Shy or agwessive) 2. Use the ciuestions and situations belOW to ex.-amioo your values in (elation to sexual orientation issues. a. If a client of yourS i:S gay Of lesbian, how might it inftu. ence the way you WOrk with him or her? b. What would you do if a friend told you an anti-homosex- ual joke or sto,y? What if the pe,-son teting the joke was a dient Or' a COiieague? • degfee of self-confidence • comforl dealing wilh a fflde range ot emotions • need to control ot be i"I Chafg,e • capacity to (elate to drverse populations (age, gender, cllture. fetigjon, etc.) • ability to give and feceive fOOClbaek (positive and c,iticaO • need to be helJ)fLI d. Do you think ho.inosexuality is an illness? How do the teachi~ of your religion mesh 'lfith youf pe,-son.al values and beliefs? • anxieties and fearS • ability to deal with conflicl e. YotX daugf\tef discloses lhat She is lesbian. Pfedid hOw you might feel, think, and behave. • self-awareness fegatding how Others see you • overau awafeness of pel'SOOal strengths and limitations f. YotX best friend confides lhat he feels he is lhe Wf'~ gender- and that he is in the early stages ot transitioning,. How do you r'e'SJX)nd? • c. Do you have gay Or' tesbian friends? g. What afe your views on same--sex. marriage? 3. Write an essay lhat explores yout values and beliefs. Explore issues and ci uestions such as: Why dO you want to oocome a counseltor'? What ~ s dO you expect to meet through your work? In vd'lat w:¥yS might your personal needs be an impechment? Ate people inherantty good or bad? What is youf understanding of the meaning ot life? Should people have the right to take theit own lives? ShotAcl immigrants be required to speak one ot Canada's two official languages? What are the char'3cieristics of lhe dient you \\()ul(I most and least want to w0tk with? (Be spe,cifac regarding as many variables as possible. such as age, gender, p(lf'· sonatity, cllture. and religion.) Why would you choose these characte-tistics? What topics Or' issues afe tikely to evoke strong personal reactions from you? What does authority mean to you? How dO you behave and feel when you are relating to people in authority? Whefe do you draw )'Ouf strength? When you die. what do you most want to be remembered fa<? • competance in initiating (elations.hips (beginnings) values and attitudes that will help Or' hindef yotX WOrk as a counseltor • caJ)aCity and willingness to cha~ Based on yout answers, identify what you coosi:Jer your five major stfengthS and yout five major limitations to be. 5. Evaluate your capacity for handlrlg feedback from Others.. Ate you geneta:lly open and nondefensive when Others criticaly evab.Jate your behaviout or perfOr'mance? Do you tend to avdd asking fot leedbaek? Do you acrivefy SOlkit feedback? lntef'Jiew friends and coneagues for theit opinions. 6. Ate you excessively dependent on your clients? Rate )'Ouf• self fof ead'I statement below using lhe folto.vi~ scale: 4 = always 3 = frequentty 2 = sometimes 1 = rarely 0 = neverI feel (esponsible for lhe feelings, lhOughts, and behaviouf ot my clients. I get ang,y when my help is ,ejected. I feel worthle'Ss or depressed when dients dOn'I d'lange. _ _ _ I feel compeUed to help people SOive problems by offering unwanted ad\lice. I want to lake cate of my dients and pr·otect them from painful feermgs. Protesslonat Identity: Ethics, Values, and Seit-Awareness 29 _ _ _ When clients don't like me, I feel rejected or inacl«:iuate. ___ I do lhings to make my clients like me, even if wtlat I do is 001 helpful. c. A ll>year-0k:I mate client roasts lhat if hisgjrtfriend tries to leave him, he 'liill kill her. d. A client from a counselling relationship that terminated six months ago phOOOS to ask you f0t a date. I a\'Oid confronting 0t ehafleogi.ng clients.. ___ I tell clients wtiat they want to hear. e. YOIX client leaves your office in a~t. determined to ~teach my ~fe a lesson tot the way She treated me.· _ _ _ I fOOI most safe when I'm gjving to Olher'S. f. Kno-/Mg that you ace in the macket fOt a new car, yout _ _ _ When clients fail. I take it personally. ___ I spend too much time proving to myself and my dients that I'm good enough. I tend to be very contrOIJiog with dients. ___ I tolerate abuse from dients to eosl.l'e lhey like me. ___ I feel responsible f0t soM~ my dients· prOblems. caretulty retJiew any siatements wtle-re you sc0ted 4 or 3. use your awareness of problem areas to develop a program ol self-dlange. client, a used-car saleSperson, otters to help you buy a car at the whOleSate price. g. Yout clWlnt is a young woman (age 17) who is questioning her sexual identity. She .-iqlires abOUt yout sex.ual orientation. II. Yout dient ask.S for yout email address so that he can keep in touch I. Yout client, a bisexual male, has tested HIV-positive, but he informs you that he ooes not wish to tel his wife. He says that he wll practise safe sex. 7. Imagine that you are a dient What migr\t your counsetlOr' need to knON abOut you (e.g., values, needs, and preJer. ences) to wot'k effeclM!ly 'lfith you? j. You receive a catl fromi a client's wife. She says She is concemed abOut het husband and asks wtlether you lhink her hUSbar\CI migtll be gay. 8. Take an inventOcy of )'OIX frienclShip clfcte. To what extent dO your Mends come from lhe same cultural group and have the same values baSe as your own? Predkt what might haPPM if you broadened your circle to include mor'e diversity. DIM!lop a plan to learn abOut the cultures and warld religions in yolM' community. k. Yout cOleagues begin to &atkabOut a dient. You are~th lhem at a local restaumnL 9. What pel'SOOal and religious values do you have that would gener-ate ethical dilemmas? a client. You notice lhat they are drinking a tx>ttte of wine. I. One of yout colleagues tells you that she has just re1urned from a one--day works.hop on hypoosis. She says that She can hardly wait to tty it oo some clients. m. You encounter one ot yout COiieagues having lunctl with n. You have an erotic dream abOut one of your clients. o. While you are counselling a student (in yout role as Skill Practice 1. Interview one 0t m::,re colleagues who deltiemtety introduce issues, leeli~. 0t behaviours that represent "tf.gg.ers• fOr' you. What did you learn from this interview? 2. Imagine that )<Ill are addressing a situation wher-e you believe a COiieague haS acted uoethi:.ally, for example. by breaching confidentiality Or' speaking rudely to a client. Assume that you have decided to approach 100 colleague informally to shate yout obServation.. Rol&-play what you migt\t say. Concepts 1. can we promise our clients abSOlute confidentiality? Why 0t wtly not? 2. What are some advantages and disadvantages to atlowing clients access to files? 3. Under- what conditions wouk:I you make exceptions to the principle of self~etermination? 4. use the concepts in this chapter to explore ethical issues and s1mtegies for each ot the fallowing situations: a. AA elderly, frail woman sufferi~ from inoperable cancer decides to lull herself. b. A client deddes to give his other life's savi~ to his Or' her church. 30 Chap1er 1 school counselbr), he discloses that he is selling marijuana to ctassmates. (Would your response be different if you were a counsetlOt in a community agency unconnected to the schOOr?> p. You are a counselbr wocking with a you~ gay client in dawn.town Toronto. He has been socialy isolated and is slow to trust anyone, but ovet time, you have managed to form a stro~ WOtklflg relationship. Imagine lhat he appr·oaches you with a request that you walk with him in Toronto's aMual gay pride parade. What variables would you consider in makW'lg your decision? What are lhe implicatbnsof going 'ldth him?Whatare the implications of not gc::i~? q. Yout client is do-.-m to her- last two dOltars. She offers to buy you a coffee. r. YOIX car is btoken and tequites an ex.pensive repair. Yout dient has been struggling to set up a mobile repait service. but business has been SIOw. He otfel'S to fix yout car fOr' a discounted price. 5. A gOOO friand invites you to a small dinnet party. When you arfrve, you are intrOduced to lhe Other- guests, includi~ a mar'ital<0unsem~ dient wtlom you have been WOrking with foc the past year. You oote lhat her companion fof the eve-nlng i:S not her' husband. F'rom obSeNing lheir behaviour', lhere i:S no dOubt that this i:S a roman.tic telationShip. She has oevef mentioned this telationship in the past. What would you dO lot the rest of the evening? Shouk:1 you disclOSe lhis relationship to lhe \\()man's husband? If she aSkS you to keep youf knowledge of this relationship from her husband, couk:I you continue to see the-m for marital counselling? ___ te11W'€; a dienl's partMt that he Or'She is HIVi'.X)Sithie ___ advising a client 10 le-ave an abusive marriage _ _ _ oyi~ in the pfe-sence of a client °' ___ counsem~ a friend ~igt\bOur at your agency (adapted from Shebib, 1997) 6. Assess lhe ex.tent 10 which you bel~e that each of the lol~ 7. Give ex.amJje-s of appfopri:ate physical con.tact between counse-tlOr'S and clients. How might clJttXal, age. Of genclef variableS affect your an.swe-t'? lawing counse-lOr' behaviourS night be acce-p&able usi~ the fOllo-lMg tating scale: 8. The case be-tow is baSed on a case fe-cor'd completed by a sodal \\()rk student. Use the- CCPA and CASW c:odes to evaluate the apptopriate-ne-ss of the language used. S = alway< 4 = often 3 = sometimes 2 = seldom 1 = oevef Be prepafed tode-fe-od you, answe,. How migN your answer vary depencli~ on lhe citcumstan.ces? ___ see-i~ a client afte, having had one alCOholic drink ___ accepting an invitation fof din.oo, at a client's home ___ hugging a client ___ inviting a fo«nef client to a party at yotX home ___ dating a formef client ___ havi~ se-x with a client ___ driving yotX client hOme ___ discussi~ you, dient with a supervisor ___ assistrlg a client to e-nd his o, her life ___ accepting a client's decision. to commit suicide ___ a!IOwing you, teen.age( to babySit fOr' your client buyrlg a car from yout client lending money to a client reporting you, die-nt to the po6ce (after the client tell$ you lhat he Of She committed a crime) reporting suspected chtld abuSe by you, die-nt Sharing pel'SOnal expe(~n.ces., fe-etings, ptot,ems, and so oo with youf client - - - ge-nrlg angry with yOU( Client ___ discussing a client with youf famity Of Mends ('Mthout mentionlng names) ___ giving a present to a client or receiving a pfe-se-nt from a client ___ shating in.f0<mation. abOut clients with other counse-llOr'S ___ wamlng a person lhat your client has threatened to harm himself Or' he-t'se-lf I visited lhe Smith hOme to investigate atJegations of chik:I ~ . I was met at the dOO( by Mrs.. Smith, a single pa(. ent. I was s....-prise-d by hef size; she was m0tbid ly obese and smelted as if She had not Sho-.ve-red in weekS. Roll:S of fat hung out of MtS. Smith's Shirt, and portions of he-r le-gs were covered with dirt. Mrs. Smith's SIOven.ly appea,ance suggests She is unable to care fOr' he-t'setf, much less he-r children (Reamef, 1998, p. 93). 9. Expl0<e the issues involved in discussing clients with Mends and relatives. Is it acceptable to discuss clients if you change the-it names and Other' identifyi~ data? Defend your answet. 1O. Shouk:1 some clients be fOr'ced to attend counse-ttiog? 11. Do you think gaUo-hS humour i:S ethical? Defend youf answer. 12. Review the cooes of ethics for three o, fou( diffe-ren.t canadian ptofessional Or'gan.izat.ions. What common and uniique featufe-s can you identify? 13. W0tk in a small g(oup to d8V't'IOI) confidentiality guidelines fOr' electr•onic stOr"agE! and Shari~ of data. What are the risks of Sharing infOr'rnation with othef ptofessionalS usa"lg email? 14. Social Media a. Discuss the ethics of using Google or other se.atch e~ioos to ftnd posted information abOUt a client without the-.' consent. Supi:ose a sea,d'I fe-Yea~ infOf'mation that is contradictory to discussions he-Id during a counseling session. Of, 'lff'lat if a se.a,ch ftnds posted inf0tmation crH.ic:al of the counse-tlOr? b. What personal infotmation abOut themselves is approptlate and inappfopti:ate to, counseltor'S to post on.line? c. Explore the approptiateoess of counse-tlOtS conn.,e,cting with Clients on Face-bOOk. What abOUt fO«ne( Clients? 15. Imagine lhat you afe directof of a social service agency. With limited funding. you have to make a difficult deei:Sion to fund on.,e pr·c ~am and te:fminate another'. Both programs have been successful. Discuss how you might approad'I the resolution of this ethical Challenge. Protesslonat Identity: Ethics, Values, and Seit-Awareness 31 WEBLINKS The Canadian Counselling and Psychotherapy Association webSite has links to notes on ethics, leg.al issues,. and standards The Markkula Cent~ fOr Applied Ethics at Santa Clara Uni ~ty website p,ovides articles and links on the toplc of ethics for counsenors www.stu.edu!ethics www.ccpa-accp.ca/eth1cs/ The canadian Association of Social Wor'ke:rs website has links This website has links to resources.. articles, and discussions on the topic of dual relationships and bounda,y issues and infoimation fOt social WOfkers http://kspope.comlduaVindex.ph p www.casw-acts.ca 32 Chap1er 1 &ives sped.Pie covnsel Oiuiin/Shunerstod( ■ Define what is meant by counselling, ■ Describe the n«cs.sary range of skill versatility for counscJlors. ■ Describe the csscmial clements of 3 trauma.-informed 3pprooch to counscJling, ■ Identify and classify the skills and strategics of counsdlina ■ Summari!c the dcvclopmcmaJ objectives of rhc four phases of counscJling. ■ Describe counscllina pitfalls. WHAT IS COUN SELLING? Coun....eUins: is a time-limited relationship in which counsellors hclp clients increase their ability to deal with the demands of life. Typically, people arc rcfc.rrcd to or seek counselling because of an unmanaacablc crisi~ such as the loss of a job, rcfationship problems, or feelings of disrress.. The immediate goa.1 of counsclling is to provide assistance so that people seeking help (clients) c:m g3in some control over chc.ir problems. The long-tc.rm gooJ of counselling is to restore or devdop a client's 3bility to cope with the changing dem3nds of their lives (empowerment). counselli,_-; MempOlleffflent prixess d ~gdients to lea,. skills.deal rib ree.,s, and aana,e pntil.tns. 33 Recen1 researd'I and developments in oouroscience confirm that counsetling has the potential to change client brains in ry positive ways. This research sup(X)rts the value of core ounsefling skill$ such as listening and empathy. Research ISO enclorSeS placi~ an emphasis on client stre~s and the centrality of 100 d ienvcounseuor relations.hip as a basis for d'laoge. Counselling enhances neurogenesis (the ptOCluction of new netXons in the bt'ain) and it takeS advantage of 100 bfain's neuropfastidty (the capacity ot the brain to change) (Mly, tv,)y, & Zalaquett 2010). T he Canadian Counselling and PsychotheraJ)\' Association (CCPA, 2012) offers this pe.rspcctive: CounselIin¥ is the s.ki!Led and p rindpled useo( rel.:ttionship l'O hieiliuu, sel(, Jmowled~ ernotional :)C'Co?p-tanee and ¥r0w1h and the optinul de,'eloprnent o( personal resources. The overall aim o( eounsellors is 10 provide an opportunity (or people 10 v.'Ork toward livi1'{t more sat id)·i~)' 2nd resoureelully. Counsellin¥ relat ionships w1II ,'3ry aeeord, i1'{t to nn'.'d but ,nay be ooneerncd with de\'t:loprnent~I issue~ addressh,i 2nd resol\'i.n~ specJf"K" problems. makinK decisions. oopi1'{t with erisis. de\'t:lopinK person:11I insi¥1u..s and kno,1;,led~-e, workinK throu,ah (eeli1l{tS o( inner contliet or improvi1'{t relationships with otherS.. Counselling is de.fined b\• three var iables: the needs and wnnts of the client, the mandate of the counsellina setting:, and the expertise o r competence of the counsellor. As discussed in Chapter I, profos.sionaJ counsellors a.re aware of the limits of their competence and know when to refer the.ir clients to other appropriate services. They are also aware of their own needs and unresolved issues and they r~fer clients to othe.r professionals when they cannot worlc with reasonable objectivity. In addition, they acc~pt that no one counsellor is qualified to work with all clients. Table 2. 1 summarizes how counselling: knowledge and skills e,.•o lve from beginning to advanced Jc,.'Cls. The work of counselling may entail a brood range of octivicics., indudina the followina: ■ hclpina clients cope with painful feelings ■ tC3ching clients new problem-solvina skills TABLE 2.1 34 Counselling Skill Levels Beglnnina Level COunullors Advanced Level COunullo.-s Bask:: use of core listening and reSJX)ndS'lg Skills Exemplary use of a t:t"oad range of listening and counsem~ skills and strategies.; capacity to be creative to meet the unique needs ot indMClual clients Sensitivity to cwert nonverbal cues Responsiveness to subtle nonverbal cues and themes Basic content knowledge ot field of practice ln<lepth knoldedge of evidence-oosed best practices; abiity to analyZe and adapt published material Rudimentary unclerStanding of self Sophisl:ic:ated kr10\\tedge of setf and cultural world'Jiew, one's in1pac1oo others, and one's abiity to selectM!ly use aspects of self to influence OlherS Tendency to •mimic" mentors and textbOOk responses capacity to eustOO'li?e tnetr apptoach; devetopment of individual Styles Slt'uggte to manage biases. personal reactbns Selkonscious "Second nature· capacity to stay appropriately detached and in contrOI of self even wtlen Mtested" by d ients F'oeus on d ients Tendency to want to fix., rescue. or solve client prOblerns Acceptance of the d ient as ·expert;- locus on client em(X)werment Chap1er 2 ■ mediating relationship communication difficulties ■ aiding clients in identifying and accessing resources ■ helping clients make decisions and implement action plans ■ supporting or motivating clients Interviewing skills are indispensable to effective counselling. The goal of imerviewins: is to acquire and organize rcJevant information through timely listening and responding skilJs. The primary goal is information gathering: however, clients may foe] rcJicf from sharing and organi!ing their thoughts in response to systematic interviewing. Good interviewers are comfortable with silence and know when to listen without interrupting. CounscJlors who listen to their clients give them a chance to air their foding~ and this step can be therapeutic in itself. Patient listening shows clients that counsellors arc willing to accept them without judgment and without burdening them with quick.fix solutions to complex problems and feelings. At the beginning of counsclling sessions or inte.rview~ silent listening may also give counsellors valuable dues about the potential focus of the interview. Listening also helps counseJlors IC3rn about their clients' priorities; it reve3Js which methods clients ma'>' have used and not used to try to solve their problems. interviewing: A•irint -.:J«ganiling relMnl inforlUlion u~ a«ive listening sliHs. inct.il:g al.1eading. sieooe. parapnsing. s.marizitg. questionini, and eafatlly. SUCCESS TIP However self-defeating ,t may appear, au human social behaviour has a purpose. Good listeners nJso know when and how to respond. Paraphrasing, summari!ing, questioning, and showing empathy constitute the foundation of effective listening. These skills enable counscllors to focus and deepen the interview. Good listeners usc questions to cfarify meaning and seek details and examples; whereas they pnraphra.sc and summari:e respon.scs to confirm understanding and highlight important information. A good interview involves methodical questioning and exploration of issue~ a process that can help dientsclarify and org:ini!e their thoughts. Finally, counscllors usc empathy skills to confirm their understanding of the client's feelings. psychotherapy: Ad\'af!Ctd CCllaselilg tatgtting S!'Me emotilflal or behaviCIJral diffltlllies « lisortlers. CONVERSATION 2.1 STUDENT: What is 100 difference between counselling and psychotherapy? TEACHER: The te-tms psychotherapy and counselling are often used interchangeabty, and the-re is no accepted dis. tinct.ion between 100m. 801h counselling and psych01oorapy a,e used to help clients learn Slulls, deal wilh fee:U~. and manage prot,ems. In counselling and psychotherapy, appcoprt.ate relationslips with dients are the crucial success medtum that establishes a foundation of safety and securily for clients to undertake the d'lange process. Although there is nociea, d,vi:iing Nne between the two terms. the major difference between counse:m.ngand psyd'IOIOOrapy is that psychotherapy tends to be more long. term 1rian counselling, with an emphasis on severe em01ional and behavblxal difftl.Aties or disorders. On 1he 01oor hand, counse:m.ng is targeted at assisting dients in managing siluational prob~ms. Whde psychotherapy can weatty assist people. 1t can be harmful if undertaken withoul appropriate araining, ex.pe-rience, 0t supervision. Attending a short wOr'kShop 0t reading a bOOk is tnsufftdent preparation. Currentfy, there are hundreds of different 1oorapeutic approaches., such as Gesa.at. transactional anatysis, psyc~ drama, rational emottve. Roge:rtan or person-centred, motrva. tional intervie-.ttng, cognitive behavioural. music therapy, art therapy, and Adle:rt.an. The Skills, Process, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 35 CHOICES : THE NEED FOR VERSATILITY diversity: Vari,a~icm in wmuf ilestyle.. culture, bSl\lour, semal orialtati>n, ag_e, a ~ility, religion. and a!her !actors. wersatility: TlleneedlorcoaseUcn to deYetop a broad range GI slills so theyca adapt ttlEli a~h to frt the listin«ive ccmpt!liti.s GI each itdNidual •dCORtell. The typical counselling cascJoad is ch3ractcri.!cd by its d iversity. Culture, gender, a,;c, rdiaion, sc>.."Ual orientation, language, education, economic abilit)•, and intcllectual capacity, as wcJI as beliefs, value~ prcfc.renccs, and personal style, malcc every client different. Skill versatility mC3ns that counsellors have choices that give them the freedom to adapt to individual diffe.renccs--vcrsatilit)• enables counsellors to customize their approach. For example, although most clients respond favourably to empathy, some clients see empathy 3S intrusive and respond with dcfonsivcncs~ preferring to k«p their feelings private. Effective counsellors are aJert to such re3ctions and h3ve the 3bility to use sic ills other th3n empathy with these clients. Brill and Le..,ine (2005) stress the importance of the counsellor's pe.rson3J in6uence in the counselling process. Counsellors "must consider the.ir weaknesses as well as their capacities and strengths in seJecring methods, technique~ 3nd procedures. Bec3use each individual is different, aJI workers must develop their °"'n styles 3nd che.ir own w3ys of handling the tools of the trade. This is the element of artistry chal is a vital pan of such work" (p. 175). Successful counsellors model high congruence between who they 3re and how they act. They are sincere and real in the way they relate to diems. In order to work effectivcly with diversity. the following key principles 3re essential: I . There is no "one-si:._e-{iu,,all" model of counselling. Respect for diem diversity requires counsellors to be ve.rS3tile in adapting their methods to fit the needs of ench diem or context. They may worlc from a modcl or process for exploring problems and helping clients build solutions. but they adapt that model to each dient situation. Most counsellors now accept that no single counselling appronc.h is best, and they are willing to draw ideas from different thtt>rctical schools. In the proces~ they learn to use an assortment of counselling cool~ including drnm3, role pin)•, toy~ music, 3rt, films. \•isunl ch3rts such ns geneaJogicaJ diagram~ personality tests, and audio or visu3l r«ordings. 2. Experr cott1UtllON draw on ellidence-ba.sed beSL pracrice5 and experience a.s g11ides in determining uihich skills and procedures tdll besL meer rheir dienu' needs. Evidence-based empirical dam can heJp counsellors predict which skills and approaches have the highest likelihood of success with particular problems. 3. Adapration of skills for individual clients and cirmmsrances i.s required. Counsellors who persist in using the same strategy for 31) clients, without regard to individual difference~ will never become effective. Skill versatility gives counsellors choices and the freedom to adapt to individual differences. \\:fhen one strategy foils or is inappropriate, another can be utilized. Culnm; spiritual values, gender, devcl.opmentaJ level, the presence of mental disorders or addiction, the narure of the problem, and the capacity of the diem are some of the variables to be considered when 3dapting skills. ))t) BRAIN BYTE By using a range ot counselling sttategies. counseuors can activate different afeas of lheit clients· bl'ains and stimulate the development ot oow neut'3I pathways 0r even the wowth of new neur'Ons. fot e.xample, feseatch has demonsuated thal using music. dance, and &efcise with Alzheimef's patients helps them to mcatl memories and em::>tions. Drawing on a different part of the brain (music tS one ot the last 36 Chap1er 2 parts of the brain to go with Alzheimer's), physical and em::>lional connections with the person are made possible that would 001 be available thfough 1alk alone. Music can atso be used to •Shift mood. manage stfes.s-incluced agitation. stimulate positive interactions, factlftate cognitive fuoction and c00tdinate mot0r movements· (Allheimer's Foundation of America, 2015). Versatility means bc.ing flexible rcgardina vari3blcs such as the location of the interview, the duration, the pace, the fee~ and the people involved. Although some counscllors work in office settings with scheduled 4S•minute or hour•long interviews, many work in settings where counscJling interviews arc less structured. Process vc.rsntiliry aivcs counsellors choices rcgardina the sequence and pace of counselling activities. \Vich most clients, the bejpnning ph3Sc is concerned with explorina problems and fcelina~ but with other diem~ counsellors may move immediately to action and prob lem sohtina. \\:lith some client~ counscJlors spend a great deaJ of time helping them explore their fcelinas, but with other~ counscJlors spend little or no time in this activity. Vc.rsntilit)' also extends to other facto.rs, such as the amount of expected or desired eye contact, the seating arrangements, and the physic.a] distance. Some clients are comfortable in an office serrina. but others prefer to work in thc.ir °"'n home or to meet in a neutral scttina. Adolescent boy~ for example, might prove more approachable if counsclling interventions arc combined with some activit)•. Some clients favour an open seating arrani;cment with no desk or obstacle between them and their counsellors. Others prefer to work over the corner of a desk. 4. Adaprilie counsellO'N know how and u,hen rouse skills, and rhey know tt--hen ro refrain frc,m using rhem. This rttauircs intelligent consideration of a wide range of variables., including setting, prob lem, client capacity and receptivity, time available, and so on. For example, at the beginning of a counsellina relationship. counscJlo.rs usually want to use skills chat promote the development of the working alliance, so they avoid more demandina stratejpes such as confrontation. Once th~• have estab lished a firm working relncionship. counsellors will want to use skills that hclp clients g3in new perspectives, so confrontation ma'>' be warranttXI. As another example, empa• thy often encouraaes clients to share deeper feelings. Therefore, counsellors who use empathy should be willing to invest the time that this sharina requires; how• ever, if the interview is nenr an end, the counscJlor might decide to avoid cmP3thic responses that stimulate emotions that cannot be dealt with in the time avail3ble. 5. Clienu a.re at diffnem sragesof morilYUion and each srage s,,uesr.s unique counsellor skills and strategies. For example, clients who are prccontcmplntivc (not thinking about change in their behaviour) will not respond to approaches that might work very well with clients who arc in the midst of chan,;c. 6. Effenil'e coun.sellmsare "m,drifinguaf." They adnpt their use of lanaunge and idiom to match the lanauage of thc.ir clients. Careful listening helps counscJlors learn their clients' communicative languai;c and metaphors, which helps counscJlors modify their language to fit thnt of thc.ir clients. Counsellors will find it easier to establish rapport and build crust when they match their clients' words with similar language. The following examples illustrate: Client I: ?l.·1'>' \'iew o( the problem is . . . Coun.seltor I: I( I~~ the pkture oorrectl)·, the war rou see it is . . Client 2: When I listen to m)•sel(. I know what I h::t\'e to do. Coun.se.U.or 2: Teti me more about what )'Ou are S3)'i"¥ l'O )OurSelf. Counsellors need to p3y attention to variables such as voice tone, volume, and tempo and then respond appropriately. To a depressed client, a high,-cnergy, fast• taJking counsellor might be annoyina. Similnrly, the counscllor who responds in a monotone to a client who is ecstatic about find in a a job might come across as cold and indifferent. There arc constraints on this principle, thouah: Counsellors should not yell at clients who yell at them, nor is it necessary for counscllo.rs to use vulgar language to march their clients. The Skills, Ptocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 37 The challen,;es of tod3y's diverse c3seload m3y require 3 counsellor to inte.ract in one interview with a client who has 3 sophistic3tcd and 3rticulate command of English, then meet with 3 client whose lnngua,;e skills 3re rudimentary. For each, a different \'OC3bul3ry is appropri3te 3nd necessary. SUCCESS TIP Although counseling s.kill:S and strategies a(e to be adapted to meet iOCIMClual needs and d (cumsrance-s, p(ofessionat ethics, attitudes, value-s, and behaviou( must remain constant Brief Encounters Some counseJlors worlc in settings where they are able to schOOule clients with pr(){ected time over a period of many months; however, in m3ny soci3J service and community centres, inter3ctions are brief, limited to a single encounter or even a few minutes. NevenhcJes.s, the potenti3l impact of this work, however brief, should not be discounted (Presbury, Ecluerling, & McKee, 2008: Carpeno, 2008). Among the possible positive outcomes are the following: ■ When clients 3re 3mbivalent 3bout change, support from the relationship c3n tip the sc3Jcs in favour of change by creating an 3tmosphere of rrust and s3foty. ■ Counsellors can m(){ivate by conveying optimism th3t change can occur, particu.larly when they focus on client strength~ not weaknesses. ■ Short sessions can provide an outlet for clients to vemil3te feelings. ■ CounseJlor empathy and nonjudgmental responses help clients accept the.ir feelings 3S normal. ■ Questions 3nd reflective responses can help clients organi!e ideas and plan for systematic change. ■ A client's way of thinking about a problem and its resolution can shift when coun.sdlors offer fresh ideas or re.framed reffections (i.e., looking 3t a problem from a new perspective). ■ Counsellors c3n help remove barriers to change through information or the pro\tj,. sion of resources. TRAUMA- INFORMED PRACTICE Traum3tic experiences can include single events such as violence/rape or n3tural disaster~ as well as those that arise from ongoing abuse or neglect. A person can also experience trauma from witnessing, reading, or hearing about the experiences of others. (n foct. counsellors m3y experience vic3rious traum3 from exposure to the stories of traum3 from their clients. People respond in unique ways to traum3. Some continue their lives with linle or no emotional disruptions while others experience "anxiety, terror, shock, sh3.me, emotion3l numbness, disconnection, intrusive thoughts, helplessness and powerlessness" (BC Provincial Mental Hea.Jth and Substance Use Pl3nning Council, 2013, p. I I). Counsellors c3n expect that a significant proportion of their client caseJoad h3s experienced traum3, as 76 percent of C3nadians h3ve experienced trauma at some point in their lives. Moreover. up to 90 percent of women in treatment for substance abuse h3ve been subject to 3buse-refatcd trauma (BC Pro\tinci3l Mental Health 3nd Substance Use. Pl3nning Council, 2013), for which their use of substances is a w3y of coping. 38 Chap1er 2 After trauma or oog0rng suess. the ~ppoc.ampus, a part of IM btain associated with memory, may be damaged and become smaller, which leads to more difficulty in prOblem solving. Al the same lime, tne amygdata, a part of the limbic system mspoosible f0r emol.ioos such as danger and fear. oocomes larger and mOl'e sensitive. which helps explain 100 hypersensitivity and paraooia lhat develOps after trauma. Damage to the prefrontex. cortex. after trauma may impair lhe individual's abtfity to plan and make apptopriate decisions (Bremner-, 2006). The BC Provincial Mental Health and Substance Use Planning Council (2013) has identified four essentiaJ clements of a trauma.-informed approach: trauma awareness, emphasis on safety and trustworthiness. opporrunity for choice, collaboration and conn«tion, and strengths-based skill building. t. Trauma Awareness Here, the focus is on building both client and counsellor knowledge about trauma and how it can affect one's life (mental, emotional, and behavioural), including chronic pain, slttp difficulties, depression, anxiety, e.motional numbnes~ memory problems, loss of life meaning, feelings of shamc/sclf-hate, inab ility to trust in relntionship~ difficulty sening boundaries, substance misuse, self-harm, high,-rislc sexual behaviour, suicide, isolation, and criminaJ behaviour (sec BC Provincial Mental Health and Substance Use Planning Council (2013, p. 22) for a complete list). The N-ational Child Traumatic Stress Network (2015) n()(CS that children may respond to trauma with a wide range of reactions. including difficult)• artaching, increased vulnerab ility to stress, relationship problems (e.g., friends and teachers), trouble with authority fiJ;ures (police), and problems expressing or managing emotions. Post-traumatic stress disorder (PTSD) is one common result of the rmuma of experiencing or witnessing a traumatic event. Jts symptoms may include a wide range of symptoms, including uncontrollab le flashbacks. distressing thoughts and nighnnares about the event, a need to avoid people and plnces associated with the mtuma, severe anxict)•, emotional numbnes~ inability to form trusting relationship~ slttp problem~ substance misuse, guilt, sham,; and anJ;cr (Mayo Clinic, 2017b; American Psyd1.iatric Association, 2013). 2. Emphasis on Safety and Trustworthiness The immediate focus follo"•ing any traumatic experience is to make sure that the person is safe, that basic needs are met, and that he or she is able to connect with supportive people and resources. Trauma upsets one's sense of physical and emotional security so it is esscntiaJ that the counselling environment be structured in a way that contributes to the restoration of safe()•. Establishing a wekoming environment from reception to physical space to service delivery that involves and keeps clients informed is important. CounseJlors need to be predictab le and reliable with consistent follow throuJ;h. The S ubstance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration (2014) emphasi!es the importance of offering cultural and gender responsive service, including utilizing cultural connections and rccogni.!ing and addressing historical trauma. An important part of this practice is to use, or support clients to use, culturally appropriate healing practices. 3. Opportunit)' for Choice., Collaboration, and Connection Trauma dise.mpowers people. Trauma.-informed practice aims to restore client power and control in their lives and as participants in the counseJling reJationship. Open communication, freedom for clients to express opinions and feeling~ nonjudgmental counsellor attitude~ support of diem choice~ and collaborative work with clients all contribute to this clement. The Skills, Process, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 39 Focusing on strengths helps to change the foctJS of the prefronlal C<><tex (tne part oflhe btain responsible lo< judw,,er,, ~nning. aoo decision mak.i~) from negative to J)OSitive thinlung (tvey, 1\/ey, & Zalaquett. 2010). Tlis find-,g has huge implications fOr' counselling clients with IOw seff.image and pessimistic thought pattems. Counsem~ from a sttengths perspective takes advantage of 100 btain's neufoi::i)sticity to enhanice imJX)rtant determinants of cha~, such as capacity to take appropriate risks, optimism abOut one's ability, and resiience to handle obSlaeles wiloout damage to self.esteem. 4. Strengths-Based Counscllina and Skill Buildina Strengrhs.-based practice shifts the focus from problems to opportu nities a nd sofu,. tions. Counsellors "hold the bclief that children, youth, and their families have strengths, rc:sourcc:s and the ab ility to recover from adversity (as opposc:d memphasi!ing problem~ vulnerab ilitic:s, a nd deficits)" (Hammond, 2010, p. 4). Clients and counsellors work as partners, and the "expertise" o f clients to make their o"'n decisions is rc:sp«t~. Relationsh i p Issues People "'ho have been traumatl!c:d often have difficulties in their per sonal and fam ily rc:lationships. Sensitive counsellors who utili.!e a trauma-informc:d approach r«ogni:e that some of thc:sc same d ifft eulties may emerge in the client/counsellor relationship. Some of thc:se problems indude the following: ■ difficulties trusting others and a. rclucmnce to share foc:lings ■ generoJ loss of interest in establishing intimate rc:lationships ■ hypersensitivity and a tendency to be suspicious about the motives of others ■ tendency to bc:come easily frustrated and tro uble managing ani;er It is critical chat co u nseJlors manng:e the.ir own fc:c:lings when working "'ith people who have bc:en traumati!c:d to ensure chat they do not respond defensivdy to d iem behaviours that arc provocative. They need to communicate to their clients chat the counselling relationship is safe and that counseJling will not exacerbate their trauma➔ Consequ ently, patience, empathy, honesty, and procttding at an appropriate p3ce for each client are particularly important when working with clients who have been trau.mnti!c:d. Fully involving clients and rcsp«ting their rights to self..dctermination and decision making will hc:Jp to restore a sense of control, so crucial to recover y from trauma➔ As a result, clients who achieve intimacy and find suppo rt in a counseJling rcJa,. tionship find that they arc also more able tocommunicnte in their persona.J relationships. Counsello rs "'ho have their own history of trauma. nttd to ensure chat this docs not ncgntivc:J,., impact their ability to counsel clients who have been tmumnti!c:d. Utilizing supervision as a tool to increase self-awareness of their behavio ur, emotion~ and impnct on clients is recommended. SUCCESS TIP With a trauma-infofmed app(oach, counsellors uooerstancl that lheir clients' behaviour, thO~IS and emotions, ho-.-.evet troubling. misguided, or confusi.ng, are copi~ sttategjes that enable them to deal with and sur'Vive lhe impact of lheif trauma. Counseth.ng can help dients deV80I) more effective chOie:es-for ex.ample, healthy communication s.kill:S, anxiety or an.get management, assertiveness, aoo inter-personal fetationshi!Y"uUimacy skills. 40 Chap1er 2 Treating Post•Traumatic Stress Disorder The ,;03J of post-traum3tic stress d isorder trcntmc nt is to help clients rcgnin control b)•dealing with those emotion~ behaviour, 3nd thoughts that 3re intcrfc.ring with thc.ir qua.Jit)• of life. Counselling (psychotherapy) is the primary trc3tmc nt. but this m3y be suppleme nted with 3ntideprcsS3m or 3nti• 3n.xiet)• medication. Medication, b)• itself, is insufficient. Comb ining medication with meditation and wellness initiatives such as exercise and nutrition will h elp with recovc.ry. The principles of traumn.-informed cou nscJling d iscu ssed in this section a re the foundation fo r 3ny intervention. A number of d ifferent counselling strategics have proven effective, in cluding the following: ■ Cos:n itive behaviou raJ chera~• (CBn to hcJp clients deal with unhelpful thinking p3ttcrns. (Sec Chapter 7.) ■ Exposure therapy, wh ic.h involves revisiting trauma.tic eve nts until they 3rc no lon,;cr troublesome. ■ Eye movement d esensitizatio n a nd r eprocessing (EMOR) a ver y spcci3Ji!ed nppro 3ch designed to help d icms process trau matic memories. (Shapiro, 200 1). ■ Use of s:roups fo r support and sharing o f coping skills. COUNSELLING SKILLS AND STRATEGIES T here is no stand3rdi!cd met.hod for cl3ssifying counselling skills 3nd strategics. Nevertheless, it is usefu l to think 3bou t skills and strategics in ter ms of their function o r intended purpose. Jn this book, four major skill and strategy d uste rs a.re d iscu ssed (sec Tab les 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, and 2.5), s.kill and strategy d us.ters.: Catepes of ~ and strl'teffes based on tileir intendei:f purpose « ~ . aNiliy. t. Relationship build ing 2. Exploring & p ro b ing 3. Empowc.ring & strength b uilding 4. Promoting change Some skills achieve multiple purposes. Sensitive active listening, for cx3mplc, contributes to the development of the rcl3tionship because it commu nicates acceptance 3nd the since.re desire to understand. At the same rime, 3ctivc liste ning is essenti31 for getting inform3tion, so this skill c3n a.Jso be cl3ssificd as an exploring and probing skill. Re.framing is both an empowc.ring 3nd a challe nging: skill. It serves to empower when it shifts a client's attention to something positive (emotion, perception, o r expc.ric nce) th3t has been overlooked o r never interp reted 3S such, but it challenges by influencing the clie nt to enter tain n ew interpretations that generate new behaviours o r changes in TABLE 2.2 Relationship Building Goal: EstabliSh a productive and professionally intimate relationship, sustain trust Sklll-S Stratt(IH • Active Uste-ntng: Altendiog. silence, paraphtasing, summartzrng. empathy, and asklrlg questions • Core Conditions: Congruence. positive regard, and warmth • Oeftne and Sustain Relationship; Conttaetiog. ln-.nediacy, and Retatioos.hip PrOblem • Maintain a safe, confidential, and professional envirorunent • F'oc:us on collabO<atioo • Be ltust\\()rthy, relia ble, a nd consistent • Help c~nts Mtetl their stones· without judgment • Re-member im(X)rtant details SoMog • Appfoptiate counsell0t self~iSdOsufe • Hurnou( The Skills, Proc ess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 41 TABLE 2.3 Explori ng & Probing Goal: Acquire and deepe:n understanding and motivate clients to "tell their stories.·· Skills • Active Listening; Attending, silence, par.1phrasiog. summarizing. empathy, and as.king <i u&Stioos Seek e.ampleS Oifectives Simple encourage<s 0,::.M-ended sentence completbn state~nts Pay attentbn to nonverbal channel of Stratet1es • Maintain focus oo key issues • Manage interview transitions (Cllange of 1opk:) • MonitOr' padng to flt individual client needS communication TABLE 2.4 Empoweri ng & Strengt h Building Goal: lnc,ease client choice, conhol, and opportunity. Skills • Recogriize and sea,ch b client strengths • Refr'aming fOr' new pe:r'Speclive such as viewing prOblems as op(X)ftunities for cha• Identify (&SOufces to assist client (rete«an Provide inf0tmatbn Teaching; tole playing, modemng Positive feinforcement: pt'3ise, reassurance, and tewatd TABLE 2.5 Stratet1es • Prioritize coltatx,ration • foster optimism • focus on growth and potential tot d'lange • Advocate oo behalf of dieot • UtJize s.Jults training progr'arns • use ot mentors Promoting Change Goal: Focus on solution and the PoSSibtlities for feeling and problem man.a@ement Skills • Challe~~: confronti~ and corr'ecti~ distortions Providing feedback • Using mftami~ to add oow pe-rspectives on problems and Sdutions • Aclbn Plannu,g; defring dear goals, exp!Oring alte«la!M!: chanfJ!: c¥itbns.. aoo maki~ char'@eS Hetpi~ die-nts i:1entify and modify unhelpful thiO!u~ patterns (see Chapter 7) Hetpi~ die-nts manage- problematic fee-lings: relax.at.ion and mindfulness Using JX)wer and authority Stratet1es • focusi~ on helping clients change: goal se-tting. e-xplOr"mg/evaluating alterr\atives., and implementing action plans b cha• • UtJizing client strengths emotional pe.rspective (see Chal){cr 7 for an in-depth discussion of this skill). CounseJ,. lors do not use skills compulsively. They have the knowledi;c, ability, and assertiveness to use a skill when necessary, but they a.Jso use selfoestraint to avoid using a skill when it is not in the client's best interest. Counsellor self.-disc:losure, for example, is an option, not a requirement. SUCCESS TIP A tr-auma inf0fmed approach features core conditions, tel3tionship building SkillS, and empowerment skJls as lhis combination of skillS and attJtudes \\()rk$ beSI to provide safe-ty and ensure coltabOtation with die-nts. 4 42 Chap1er 2 4 Practitioners need to be versatile, building skill competence based on knowledge of the following: t. Skills and strategics and their intended purpose 2. Best methods and situations for using each skill 3. Self-awareness of personaJ strengths and limitations with each skill 4. Acquired understanding of each client's caP3Cit)•, need, and willingness Relationship-Building Ski 11s Relarionship-buildini skills and strau.• iies arc the basic tools for engaging clients. developing crust. and defining the purpooc of the counselling. A strong counselling relationship is universally accepted as essential for counselling success. The relationship establishes and sustnins the ncccsS3ry 53fecy, trust, and intimacy for clients to explore their issues and feelings, then deal with the challenges and emotions associated with change. The strength and support of the relationship provides a base for clients to risk engagement in chc change process. Relationship-building worlc is of central importance during the beginning phase of hcJping. b ut effective counseJling requires chat the rcJationship be sustained and dttpened through all phases of helping. Core Cond itions Rogers ( 1951 , 1961 , 1980) and others have written cxtensivdy about the core condition.'> necesS3ry for forming a helping rclntionship--namdy, congruence or genuineness, empathy, and positive regard. Rogoers believed chat people are essentiaJly good, self-deterministic (able to make the.ir O\\•n decisions), and goaklirccted. Thu~ he believed that these core conditions are necessary for establishing the rapport and therapeutic alliance needed in a purposeful counselling relationship. Central to his theory was the notion that the core conditions create the emtironmcm within which change and growth will occur with the client seen as "the cxpen on his or her own life ... responsible for the direction of change and growth within counselling" (Erford, 2010, p. 16). Cons:rucncc, or jtenuincn~s, is the capocity to be real and consistent with clients. Con, gruent counsellors arc open with their reactions and feelings and demonstrate consistency in what they believe, say, and do. Congruency also requires counsellors to be "tTIUl.Sparent"\\tithout hidden agendas or false dcmc.mours. Rog:c.rs believed that the more counsellors arc :.n\--are of the.ir feelings and the more they genuinely express these feelings in the counselling relationship, the more effective their counselling will become. An important part of congruence is counsellor self-disclosure, patticularly with their "here and now'' feelings. Empathy is the most important core condition. ln simple terms, it means being ab le to sec the world through the eyes of the client. Essential to empathic understanding is the ab ilit)• to understand feelings without imposing one's own fttlings or reactions. Counsellor experiences have the potential to increase emP3thic understanding, providing counsellors arc on guard to ensure that they do n()( become prescriptive of hCM• the client must feel. Positive re-,:ard, or respect for clients, is the ability to recogni!e the inherent worth of people, rcg:irdlcss of their behaviour. relationship-buildirc skills and strategies: lids for enppig dents and dM.iop.g trust. core conditions: W.wmtt.. anpathy, posiweiegard.and ~ m. coogruence: ne capaciytobe real and consist• .ith clients; m.l~dling bebl'iour. ~ s . .tacticm. genuM!ess: Aaeasure al ho"• allllientic or teal me is ii a ielati>nship. empathy: The po:ess ol accurately undefs!and-i the emoti>nal perspecth-e d anather persca, and die ccmllllicatica d tiis understaading ■itklll imposing me's Otlll feelings• readions. pos.itire regard: Theabilityof uunsellors to ~ lite inlleienl ~ d people. acti're listeni,.-.: Atn descliling a dvster of skills that are uS!d to ilcrease tile accuracy of • ndentanding.. Attendi-,.. usilc silefltf. paraphrasing. summarilina. questioning.a. sha• ing empatt,,aie die basi:: stills GI adi,,,e istening.. attending: Atera used to descril:e tile •ar that caselkn communicate to tlleir clients tut they an te:ady. Milling. and a~le to listta. Vefba:1. ncaverbal. a. attitmal nes aie die esv.ece of effec. ti...e attend-,. Active Listening Active lisccn ini is crucial for building rclntionships and for understanding. If counsellors arc preoccupied with what to S3Y in reply, they cannot truly listen. Until they listen the.re is no way for them to understand the complexities and uniqueness of their clients' situations. Active listening is an interactive process involving six slcms: attending, using silence, paraphrasing, summari! ing, questioning, and showing empathy: silence: Ato:il used in a.selling ■ whel the dent is thin~. tile client is a,nfssed and unsuie GI l'lflat to say« ■ Anendini is the manner in whidi. counsellors communicate that they are physically and psychologically interested in what their clients arc S3ying or doing. Appropriate silence gives clients time to think and respond. Effective counsellors understand the multiple meanings of silence. Is the client confused! Have The Skills, Ptocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling di. or the dent It.as entOUntffl'd paint.I ree.p. Because ii is c11l11111t, defined. silence can also signal trust iss.a!'s « d...._ 43 we renched the end of the topid ls the client thinlcing! Slcillcd counsellors know when to intcrruJ)( 3 silence and when to allow it to continue. paraphrasing:: Atonjudg_•ntal mtatemeat of the client's ..on:ls and Gas in lie ~Elor's 0111n w.ords. sunvnarizing: A•ar of ccadensing content (See also CIXtMt SamMJtY•d TlwttSamM~ ■ Paraphrasing involves restating (usu3Jly in shortened form) the client's thoughts to clnrify the essence of wh:.n he or she has said. ■ Summari::ina mC3ns condensing the csscmial content and identifying important themes and ideas. ■ Questioning involves probing for information to confirm understanding and seek clnrific3tion, such 3S by saying, "Do you mc3n that . .. ?" \\:fhen combined with nonjudgmental counsellor responses that confirm understanding. questioning provides an opportunity for clients to "tell their stories," 3 process which is often cathartic and therapeutic. (J.teStioning: An actm lis,~ skill tu inYdvtS probing I• infcma• tion to confinn ~ rstanding_ and seek clari!icati>n. • EmP3thy is "the process of nccuratd)• understanding the emotional pe.rspectivc of 3nothtr person and dlC' communiattion of this understanding" (Shfflib, 1997, p. 177). Active listening is the psychologic3l incentive for clients to open up with further disclosure. \Vhen clients sense deeply that they have been heard, th3t the.ir ideas are not judged or rejected, that the.ir feelings 3rc accepted 3nd validated, trust develops. Active listening makes it safe for clients to explore ideas and feelings. Together with the core conditions, 3ctive listening says to the client, "I have heard you,'' "( am willing to understand 't'our feelings 3nd problems without judgment," and "I accept you." Active listening is a powerful tool for est3blishing rapport and undcrst3nding. the basis for strong working relationships. Defining and Sustaining the Relationship Roge.rs (1961) emph3si!es the importance of a.voiding moral judgment of the diem. He vividly C3prurcs the signific3nce of nonjudgmental exploration to the development of the rcfotionship: It is only as I undersu.nd the (eelin¥S 2nd thoud,ts whieh seem so horrible to )Ou. or so weak, or so sentiment31. or so bi:a.rre-it is onlr 2s I see them as )'Ou se,e them. and ~ept them and you, th::u rou (eel really ( ~ to ~pl ore all the h.icklen nooks and lr~t• enin~crannie!l o( )'Our inner 2nd often buried ~rience. (p. 34) Two major skills 3rc associated with defining and sustaining the rcfotionship: contracting 3nd immediacy. Counselling contracts ma)' ch3nge, sometimes frequently, as the ,vork proceeds. relationship contracting:: Hegcti~ the intended purpost of the uunselling Rbtion- ildu-,: a i ~ on the apa:ted des« both counsell« and cli.-. ■ Relation.,;hip contracting involves negoti3tingthc intended purpose of the counsel,. ling relationship. including agrtting on the expected roles of both counsellor and client. ■ Sessional contracting is concerned with setting the purpose of an individual session. Scssional contracting defines a work plan th3t is individu3li!ed to meet the needs of the client. Consider, for example, three women who seek counselling for the s3mc problem-a relationship brc3kdown. Bcc3use of contrncting, the first client may conclude that she needs help in m3na.ging her stress and P3in. The second client may wam to focus on developing her 3ssenive communication slcills for dC3l• ing with an 3busivc spouse. The third diem might want hclp with decision ma.king in choosing between leaving the rcfationship 3nd remaining in hopes of solving the relationship problems. (See Chapter 3 for a det3iled discussion of refotionship and scssion31 contracts.) ■ Anticipatory contracrina focuses on planning strategics and responses for events that ma)' occur during counselling, such as how co give fecdbaclc or how to respond to a drug use relapse. Clients 3rc often able to give counsellors valuable input and 3cfvice on how they (counseJlors) can best de3l with these events. session.al contract._-; An agree.Mt between counS!lor and client rega'-t the topic •d exieued ClllkOme GI • intervit'# « session. ('See also Ctx,;rx.tiRg.) anticipatory contracting:: Al~ • nl bE1~ ODaSellon-1 dients that plans kif predictable ew:nts. Antqii.;orr contracts prom!! g_uidance ICJ ~ • s •d ansv.er the questioo. '"M.at shNld I doif .. !"' 44 Chap1er 2 Immediacy (Eg:in & Schroeder, 2009) is a tool for examining and deepening the counselling relationship. It involves a process of evaluation that addresses the qmllity of the relationship in terms of its conmtcted objectives. The skill of immediacy can be used to troubleshoot rcJationship prob lems. 1t promotes candid discussion rcg:irding ways the reJationship might be changed to fulfill its objectives. \\:'Ith immediacy, relationship problems and feelings are addressed before they have a chance to have a lasting destructive impact. (Sec Chapter 3 for an extensive discussion of this skill.) immediacy: Atool t« exiforing, walualing. and deE1)erting CC11asEting ielati>nships. Exploring and Probing Skills Explorini a nd probini skills arc basic tools of interviewing that counsellors use to g:ithc.r information, clarify definitions, seek examples, and obtain necessary detail. These skills enable counsellors to avoid making assumptions. Active listening skills arc the primary tools of exploration and prob ing. ~ausc they communicate counsellor willingness to listen nonjudgmentally, they motivate and encourage dicms to tcll thc.ir stories. When clients arc helped to explore their problem~ they often g:iin insight from questions that provoke thinking in areas that may have been overlooked. As wcJI, reflec• tive responses such as empathy help them g:iin perspective on emotions. Directives, such as "Tell me more" or " Please expand on )'Our feeling~" control the direction and pace of the interview. Directives can also be used to focus the client on reJcvam priorities. Directives arc the " road signs" of the interview. Simple encouragers are short verbal and nonvcrbaJ cues that motivate clients to continue. Verba] stntemcms such as "Uh.-huh" or " Yes" and short directives such as " Please continue." a]ong with nonvcrbaJ signals such as head nods and an attentive posture, make up this skill set. Counsellor self-disclosure, used sparingly, can be a useful tool that models appropriate sharing of feelings. Counsellor self-disclosure ma)' reduce the clients' sense that their experiences or feelings are strange or abnormal. Subsequent],.•, when experiences are "normalized," clients arc more apt to open up and share. Jn this way, counsellor self.-disclosurc acts as an exploring/probing skill. Humour, if timcJy, can be used to r~ucc tension or encourage clients to take a lighter view of their situation, but humour must be used cnutioust,., so that it docs 00( offend clients or trivia.kc their problems. Opcn.-cnded sentence completion statements give clicms an opportunity to "fill in the blanks." The counsellor presents an incomplete statement, then pauses to allow the diem to complete the thought. Almost a.Jwa)'S, clients will finish the statement with thc.ir own content. This is a p0\\terful strategy that gives clients full control of the answer while the counscJlor controls the focus area. Here arc some examples: How might you finish this statement? ■ The one thing I need most from my husband is . ■ You're feeling .. . ■ So, the options 't'ou'vc considered arc .. . ■ Finish this statement. The one thing I nttd most is . ■ The next step is . &ploring and probing: skills: S~ uunsellors us.e to pth« inf«mali>n, d Mify definiti>n, S£ek w mples. •d dltain necessary dftail. directives: Sllott state.nts that promi!' directi>n to tlieals • s . inforaution. and pace (e.g.•"Tell me °' _,.I simple encouragers: Short phrases and gestuiessuch as •1e1 me Ml!: "Co 'Uh-huh: and head nods that enocuage dients to ocaiinue widl their stclfies. on: counsellor self-disclosure: Whal uunsellors disclose personal opinions. ree.p, or aae<dctes, it can be a usfful toct that med.ls appropriite wring. ud norauite the clients· feelilgs oc ~noes. CounS!lor self-di!dlsure shooId be used spari. ,solety to Met tile needsoldientsiu way tu does IIOl shift the foc.s to the a.selkll it..- humour: a uunselling tool that 'lltlen appropriate and ~ II tiaed, ffl..l)' SU~ PM the dewl>pment ol the relati>nship, iedlltf taasia.. encc.age tile dient to talle a lght.erviewol tilleir problem, or prom! an at.ernate perspective • tlleir si1Ualion. By responding to nonverbaJ cues, counsellors pay attention to such things as voice tone, posture, eye contact, and facial expressions. Sometimes the content expressed by a client's words is sufficient for undc.rstanding. But not infrequently, the major meaning or intent of a client's message comes through the nonverbal channel CounscJlors should never ignore the nonverbaJ channel, which enhance~ contradict~ or embellishes verbal messages. The Skills, Pt oc:es.s, a nd Pitfalls 01 Counselling 45 Managing transitions involves paying attention to or suggesting shifts between phases or topics. This skill can be used to organi:e the flow of the intc.rvicw or to link themes and ideas (see Chapter 5 for an e>..'tensivc discussion.) Empowering Skills empowering skills: S~ us!dto~p clients mobilile ocafidefltf, self-esteEa. •d contnf c,,,e, tileir lires.. Empowerins: skilJs help clients mobili.!cconfidcnce, self-esteem, and control over their lives. Counsellors who arc committed to empowering their clients must start with a basic be.lief that their clients arc capable of managing their own lives. They must relin.quish the mistaken notion that clients depend on them for advice, decision making, and problem solving. Clients are empowc.red when they participate in decisions about counselling goals and procedures. The principle of sclf--dctcrmination introduced in Chapter I promotes empowerment by helping clients recognize choices and encouraging them to make independent decisions. To avoid promoting unhcaJthy client dependency, counscJlors should not do for clients what clients can, and should, do for themselves. CounscJlors should acknowledge and give clients credit for their success. When clients arc successful and they "own" their success, their confidence and self-esteem increase. Four skill sub clusters are the essence of empowering: teaching, giving information, supporting, and above all searching for strengths. Teaching Teaching may be used in counselling as a way to assist clients in developing strengths. Skills training, rolc.-playing, and other tools can be used to hcJp clients develop their capacities. Giving Information lnformation giving empowers clients with knowledge of altc.rnativc courses of action, including resources that might assist them in dealing with their problems. Counsellors may also offer suggestions and advice regarding problem management. Supporting Supporting is used to bolster clients' energy and optimism. To some e:r...'tent, all counselling skills are supportive. Supporting reduces clients' feelings of isolation and provides them with incentives to address their problems, express their feelings. and begin a process of change. Supporting can also be used to tell clients that they arc on the right track and that their feelings and reactions arc normal. As well, supporting hcJps clients manage anxiety and stress, thus, incrc3sing their enc.rgy, scJf<onfidencc, and capacity for problem solving. streng_ths approach.: Acounselilc perspe«iw that asSllmes tile inherent capacity of people. lldimaals and communities are seen to haw assets •d iesoun:es that can be mobililed tw Searching for Strengths Clients arc often besieged by debilitating problems and chaos. Counsellors cannot ignore rc3l problems, but in the process, they should not focus all their attention on problem situations and what is d't•sfunctional in their clients' lives. The strens:ths approach assumes the inherent capacity of peoplc. Jndividuals and communities arc seen to have assets and resources that can be mobili!cd for problem solving(Shcafor & Horcjsi, 2008; SaJceby, 2009: Glicken, 2004). Empowering skills and principles will be explored in more detail in Chapter 7. poblea scf\ing. Promoting Change Skills and Strategies chal~ng skills: S~ us!dto e11CC1Jrageclients to critic-.a9/ e,aluate their beha\tCIUr and ideas. confrontation: Counstllint iliiiatiws that <Wlenp dients to criicall1 ex..ine their acti>ns andfor consiier other vitr11pciills. 46 Challenjpng s k ills arc used to encourage clients to e\laluate their behaviour and ideas. They push clients toward change and growth to fulfill the fundamental reason for the counselling relationship; hO\\•evcr, excessive or premature reliance on challenging skills may strain the counselling relationship. Confrontation prods clients to critically examine thc.ir actions or consider other viewpoints. CounscJlors may need to provide critical or corrective feedback, identify overlooked strength~ correct distortion~ suggest other viewpoints (rdraming), or Chap1er 2 request that clients assume responsibility. Confrontation skills arc: most c:ffoctive when there: is a strong relationship of trust and when clients understand and accc:J)( the va.Juc: of their use. Brill and Levine: (2005) offer this perspective on the challenging skill of confrontation: ?l.·1isuse of oonfront2tion c:u, be de\'astat intt, dest ro,.,i,l{t all previous e(foru.. \Vorke-rS must assess the 3tnount and quality o( eonfrontation the elient is willin& or able to use, 2nd they rnust be 2ble to Ki"e- support if the re:U1ty is overwheltnini.::. Worke-rS must noc use confrontation l'O express their own an~-e-r and frustr2t.On. 2hhou,ah these 3re etrt,iinl)' 2 part of the re:U1ty with whieh both workers 2nd dienu 1nust deal. (p. 186) Ideally. confronrotion skills incre3sc: clients' motiwtion for change. The counselling relationship provides the necessary base for confrontation. Clients are more likeJy to accept confrontation as credible when counscllors have: first listened and folly understood them. Clients may be appropriately confronted when they: ■ are working from false assumptions or incomplete information. ■ misread the actions of others. • • lack self~awarenes.,;; regarding the: impact of their actions (e.g., when they blame others for the.ir problems rather than examining their own responsibility). ■ demonstrate contradictions in their behaviour, thoughts, and feelings. self-awareness: The pocesso! be::oming atfrt and ~ 1edgeatle atout one's ~ WJ// d ttilling. acc.,. and feeling. den)' or do not recognize their personal strengths, capacities, or resources. Ac.rion p la n nini is a wa't' of helping clients bring about changes in the.ir lives. These changes may include: finding new ways of managing feelings, forming strategies for modifying ways of thinking, or developing new skills or behaviours. Action planning helps clients define dear and measurable targets for change(Koals), identify and evaluate alternative: strntegies, and select and develop plans for reaching these goals. action ptanning: flelping cli• s make dl.-ges in tilleir liws.: ll'lolws setting fOib, identi!Jing strategies t.Wn,e.. and dmlopilc ,.aans kif ieathing goals. Use of Power and Authority Counsellors derive or are given power by virtue: of their position. Such pO\\•er comes from man)' sources: competence, knowledge, education, control of resources, position in the: agency or status in the community, or simply the fact that the: client is the one who is in the: position of needing or seeking help. Counsellors are also rc:prc:sc:ntntivcs of agencies that wield power. For example, child protection social ,vorkc:rs frequently make decisions and judgments that have: a large impact on clients' lives. However gentle and caring counsellors arc:, clients may perceive them as pe.rsons with power and influence:, and often as people: to be: feared. Comp(on and GnJaway (2004) note: that families may have "negative expec:ro• tions, lack of trust, and fear of commitment" (p. 152) because of experiences where: they perceived professional authority to have been misused. Miller (2007) advocates the importance of an anti-oppressive model of practice that recognizes the inherent imbalance: of powe.r between clients and professionals. She promotes the use of methods such as the: strengths approach, transferring power to clients, and involving them in decisions (i.e., an anti-oppressive approach). As well, she invites dialogue: on the important issue: of what professionaJs "can or should do in the presence of organi!ationnJ and societal policies that do not support practising according to the: frame,vork" (p. 132). THE PHASES OF COUNSELLING Counselling relationships can vary gre3tl)• in te.rms of time. Some evolve: over a long period, but others may be limited to a few or even a single session while some may last for only a few minutes. Counselling inte.rventions usually move through a planned change: process involving sequentinJ steps or phases, each characte.rized b\•unique: as wcll The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 47 phases of comselling: SEqtential steps tk(qh whi~ uuns.elling teads to eYOl\'e. The four ,US.es are peliminary. begin-.g. ending. act• as common objectives and skills. For our purposes, four ph a.«?s of counselling will be discussed: (I) preliminary, (2) beginning, (3) action, and (4) ending. This model builds on similar modcls present~ by others such as Eg3n and Shroeder (2009), Shulman (2009), and Young (1998). Each phase is distinguished by its focus on different activities. The preliminary phase is essentially for planning. Proper planning increases the likelihood that clients will perceive chat their nttds can be met through counselling. The beginning phase is a time of engagement, when both the client and the counseJlor make decisions about whether they will work togcthe.r and, if so, under what structure. The beginning phase is also a time for exploring problems and feelings. Although clients ma'>' begin to change their behaviour or manage che.ir feeJings more effectively during the beginning ph3Sc, the action phase is more concerned with initiating change. During the ending phase, the working rclationship is brought to a close, perhaps with a referral to another resource or counsellor. SUCCESS TIP £very counselling relat.ionship wiU have many begiMings and endings and lhe presence and dynamics of each ShOuld be consider-eel. The most significant beginning is the start of the rel3tionship, bul each session Or' encounte( also has a beginning. When the focus of discussion Shifts to a diffemn1 topi:, lhis is at:so a beginning. Sirnilatly, ead'I encounte( also has an ending and as each topic draws to a ctose, thi:s is also an ending. The end of lhe relationshiJ) is a inJ)Ortanl enchng that deserves the hJI attention of the counsellOt. One common objective of each phase is forming and sustaining a working relation.ship. Thiscounsclling relationship is the vehicle for change and pro\tidcs a base of safety and security for clients to explore and understand their emotions and difficulties. The counseJling contract, an agreement on the goals and roles of the participants, is the reference point for the relationship. lt is continunJI)• reviewed and revised as the work progresses. A second common objective of aJI phases is to establish open, honest, and productive communication. Effective communication enables counseJlors to learn about their clients' needs and feelings. As well, it empowers clients to learn new ways of handling old problems. The third common objective of 31) phases is evaluation. Ongoing cvaJuation can review the esscntin1 eJements of the counselling plan (goals and methods), the ,vorking relationship, or the overall satisfaction of aJI particip3nts with the P3Ce of the work and its results. By using a problem.solving approach, counsellors and clients can explore ways to ensure that the work is relevant and efficient. Skill dusters heJp organize skills based on function. Since each ph3se of counselling supports different acti\'ltics, each ph3se 3lso favours different skills. For example, dur• ing the beginning phase of counseJling, relationship-building skills are the priority, and ch3llenging skills arc usu31Jy avoided, al IC3st until a foundation of crust and safety h3s been established. Exploration/probing skills arc also \•ital during the beginning ph3se. They enable counsellors to acquire information for understanding. thu~ heJping them avoid assumptions. Challenging and directing/te3ching skills tend to be more effective in the action phase, when a strong relationship and a solid b3sc of understanding have been established. T3blc 2.6 summa.ri:es the principal activities and priority skills of each ph3sc. Counselling tends to move through the phases sequentially, with success at each ph3sc depending, in pa.rt, on the success of preceding phases. For example, the 48 Chap1er 2 TABLE 2.6 Counsel! ing Activities and Skills Pbase Preliminary P1lnclpal AtdwitlH Prlodty Skills • lntefView pre~Mtng • Reviewi~ files and othef infOl'mation • Planning • Establishi~ Self-awareness sources • P(eparing the interview setttng Begj.nning • Establishi~ a eollabOtative, professional worktng relationship • lntefVieNi~ for understanding • Evab.Jating • Active listening • P(ornoting c0te cooelitioos • Defini~ the relationsl-.p (comracli~) • Searching fot St(engthS Action • Goal setting • Action ~nni~ • Helping clients change behaviow', manage f/Mlfiogs, and cha~ unhelphA think.i~ pattems • Revi:ss"lg lhe contract deepeni~ the relationship, and managi~ communication difficulties • Evab.Jating goal progress and lhe o~ing (elations.hip • Ending the helping relationship • Referri~ client to other fesotJfOOS • Evaluating goal achievement • Te.act-.~ £tiding • • • • lnfOl'mation giving Sup(X)rting Confronting Action planni~ • Giving information • Sup(X)rting preliminary phase is designed to support the w-ork of the be-ginning phase. Jt allows the counsellor to complete the prcp3rations th3t will help welcome chcdicnt to the ai;ency. As wcll, it works as a lcind of warm,-up, so counsellors can be ready and sensitive to the needs of their clients. Wc31c planning results in weak beginnings. Similarly, dfoctivc work in the action phase is C3sicr when the beginning phase has be-en successful. A solid base of understanding permits counsellors and clients to set more goals, and a foundation of trust allows counscJlors to be more challenging in chc.ir approach. (n contrast, counsellors who attempt to chaJlcngc dicms from a thin b3sc of trust arc likely to meet with resistance or rejection. Even in the action phase, it is important to cry to sequence the steps. Jf clients cry to dcvcJop action plans before they have set dear goal~ their action plans are more likcJy to be vague and dircctionlcss. Although counselling work tends to evolve sequentially through the four phase~ usuaJt,., it docs not move fonvard in a neat and ordcrt,., manner: The loaiC:U Pf"OKn'SSion of these ph:lSt'S makes the p ~ appear to be 21 linear, step,by, step Seto( 3Ctivities. In reality. chai,~-e, rarelr proceeds in ai, orded)• fashion~ r.tthe-r. it is more o( 21 spi~I, with frequent return!? l'O pr.Or phases for cl::adf'.e2tion or 2 rev.>0rki1'{t o( \':l.riOU!l tasks and ::.etwitie!l. (Shea(or &. Horej!li. 200S. p. 126) The phases of counselling also provide a systematic and useful checklist of the key activities and logical steps chat arc p3rt of the change or problem-solving process. By referring to the phases of counselling, counsellors and clients can remain dear on where they are in the counselling process, what has be-en done, what remains to be accomplished, and what options re.main open. However, as 30)' experienced counsellor will attest, "cu.h counselling encounter is different, C3ch relationship is uniquely complex, and the work may evolve in unpredictable ways" (Shebib, 1997, p. 71). Sometimes dc3r dh•isions between the phases of counselling arc app3rcnt. But more frequently, the.re arc overlaps between the phases and shifts forward and backward The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 49 between one phase and another, and, in some cases, phases may be skipped altogethe.r. Some typical counselling scenarios arc provided here: ■ ■ Jessica, a very private pe.rson, was distraught ove.r the breakup of her marriage. Aw-arc of her inability to cope and 00( knowing what to do, she attended scve.ral sessions with a counsellor. He.r counsellor proceeded slowly, gently encouraging Jessica to mlk about her fccJings. Jessica was surprised that during the second counselling session, she began to weep. Afte.rward, she remarked that she felt as if a great weight had been lifted from her shoulders. She never felt the need to rerurn for a third session. Be.rt was n()( interested in exploring his problem beyond a superficial level. Anxious to effect change in his life, he wanted to brainstorm ideas for dealing with his problems. Counselling worlc focused on helping him set goaJs. As this work progressed, client became more trusting, and the sessions began to focus on exploring his feelings. ■ When )O)'Ce was challenged by her counseJlor to examine how she might be contributing to the problems she blamed on her boss, she became angry and stormed out the office, never returning. A year later, a series of events caused her to recall her shore-lived counselling experience, and she decided to cake some responsibility for he.r difficulties. The counsellor never lcnew about the ultimate positive outcome of the relationship that appeared to end so badly. ■ As Fernando mJked about his problem, he suddenly realized chat his siruation was not as hopeless as he thought. Discovering another way to look at his problem allowed him to identify several new ways to solve it. ■ After a single session, Bob remarked to his counsellor, "My problem is the same as when I came in here, but somehow it doesn't seem to bother me as much." The Preliminary Phase The preliminary phase of counselling is essentially a time of planning with a focus on nvo central casks. First, the agency setting is made attractive for clients so they are mori.vatcd to eng3ge and remain with the agency. Second, counsellors prepare themselves for the interview. CONVERSATION 2.2 STUDENT: What is the difference between a conversation with a helpful friend and a counsem~ interview? TEACHER: The goat of a ftiendShip is to meet the needs of bolh people. Frtends (and fanity) are important. If they are undetstanding. caring. and supportive, they can be an effective source ot help. As With a cour\Selll.ng felationslip, just taik.i~ to a Mend can be cathartic to IM indrvidual. TM fe.ality is that lhefe a,e lim,ts. to what Mends can offer. Sometimes friends. and famtly dOn't have speciali:zed knowledge, Ot lhey may OOI know what (esotJ(ceS Ol se!'Vioos are available to deal with specific pfoblems. F' riends and famity may alSO be so emotionalty involved With you that it is hard f0t them to be obi('ctive. 50 Chap1er 2 STUDENT: You're rigt\t. I find my famtfy can'I sepatate their feelings from mine, and they atways end up givi~ me weUintentiooed but not very helpful advice. TEACHER: Effective counsetors are comiortable d1scussi~ feeti~. and they dOn't tell c~nts. hoN they ShOl.,jj feet Goad counselb"S are excellent listeners_ and they .West time to make SUfe they accurately understaoo clients' feeli~ and concerns. Counsellors know hOw to sys.tematicalty expl0te ptoblems. set goal~ and develOp plans f0t action. They assisl dients: in identifyi~ and evaluati~ altef'natives. 'llf'tile recognlzklg that the clients must cooose f0t themselves. Thefef0te, counsellors do no1 impose advi:e or by to rescue dients: btf taklng on theif problems. Unltke friendstips. counselling retationslips am dttected to meet 1rie needs of one person only-the dienl. The Agency Setting Jdcally, the 3gency is set up to appc3J to the client groups that it serves. A drop,-in counselling centre for teens should look different from 3 d3y program centre for seniors. Dim lighting 3nd be3nbag chairs meet the needs of tee.ns but present 3 safet)• hazard for seniors. TC3 is 3ppropriatc for senior~ but a soft drink m3kcs more sense when the clients 3re tttns. ldea.Jly, the agency should: ■ h3ve uncrowded waiting rooms. ■ allow for reception and interview space that is private and confidential. ■ greet clients in a w3rm and friendly manner. ■ provide for the needs of children (e.g., by supplying a pin)• are3 with agc-appropri3tc tO)'S). ■ allow for wheelchair access. ■ h3ve posters and other art th3t do not violnte the value~ religion, or culture of the ai;cnq's clients (generally, they should also be politically neutral). ■ h3ve up-to-date rc3ding m3tcrial in the waiting room. But often counseJlors fail to ensure that their interviews arc protected from phone calls 3nd other interruptions that impede the flow of conversation. When interruptions 3re allowed, the mcss3ge to clients is, "I have other concerns that arc more important th3n you. Hurry up and finish." Moreover, flexible office arrani;cmcnts arc best. Some clients and m3ny counsel,. !ors prefor 3n unobstructed arrangement without 3 desk between the p3rticipants, but others favour working over the desk. The office needs to be 3rranged with c3rcful consideration to the mcsS3ges that the design communicates. Chairs 3nd desks should be arr3ngcd so that no psychological advantage or power is given to the counsellor. Seating 3rrang:cments should allow for adequate personal sp3ce between counscllors 3nd clients. A comfort zone of about I to 2 metres (4 to 7 feet) is 3dcquatc for most client~ but other factors might result in 3 nttd for more or less distance. CounseJlors also need to be c3rcful in choosing personal items to displa)•. Picrurcs 3nd memorabilia that punctuate differences between counsellors and their clients should be avoided. Of course, clients may have different reactions. For example, some clients expect and appreciate seeing their counsellor's degrees or diplom3s hung on the wall. For these client~ knowing something about the tr3ining and crcdcnti3Js of their counsellors helps to establish confidence and credibility. Other clients, however, may react negatively to such a display. For them, the display sets up soci3J and inteJlcc:tual b3rricrs. GeneraJly, counsellors should structure their offices with the needs 3nd background of their clients in mind. Jn this respect, clients can be an invaluable source of consultation. Their opinions on office decor and (3yout should be solicited. Figure 2.1 The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 51 Interview Preparation Counsellors can use the preliminary phase to predict how the interview time will be used and to make decisions related to the time, place, and structure of the interview. As well, counsellors can think about specific questions and responses for working with particular clients, without setting up a script or rigid agenda. Shulman (2009) suggests that for a variety of reasons, clients often do not share feelings and concerns directly. They may be ambivalent about sharing, or they may hold back because of socictaJ and cultural taboos about talking about sex, authority, or money. As a result, clients may raise these concerns indirectly, and counsellors must be alert to recogni!e dues about their clients' concerns. For example, a single parent who asks her welfare worker if he has ever been on weJfare may be indirecth• expressing her fear that the worker will be insensitive to the stress she faces in trying to cope with a limited budget. Sometimes questions regarding personal background or circumst:mces may be indirect ways for clients to explore concerns about trust. Shulman (2009) recommends the preliminary phase skill of nming fn as a tool for anticipating the feelings and concerns that clients might bring to the interview. By runing in, counsellors can think about what clients might express and how they will do so. The preliminary phase is also a time when counsellors examine their own readiness. For example, counsellors should take a few moments prior to each interview to self-examine through questions such as the following: ■ Am 1 dealing with persona] stress or problems that might make me less effective or more vulnerable? ■ Am 1 sufficiently disengaged from my last client to be open and objective! ■ What personal biases do I need to mana,;e to work effectively with this client! ■ What reservations do J have about meeting this diem? ■ Do J have unfinished business with this client that J have not addressed! ■ What feelings do I have toward the client that might impo:le my objectivit)•! Client Files The preliminary phase is aJso a time for fact-finding to hclp understand a client's situation. For example, a counsellor could research Tourene's syndrome in preparation for meeting a client with a child who has been diagnosed with this condition. TypicaJly, most agencies have files on eac.h client that may contain considerable information regarding the client's age, place of birth, address, marital status, work history, educational background, prior experiences with counselling, and assessments of personality, values, past problems, ability to handle stress, communication pane.rns, and so on. Cliem files can also alert counsellors to any past incidents of violence and point out any neo:l to take special precautions. A review of client files can gready speed the intake process, but it is important to maintain an open mind and avoid prejudgment, particularly with respect to the assessments other counsellors have made regarding the client's manner and personality. Client reactions are influenced in part (and occasionally) by the personality and behaviour of their counsellors, as shown in the following example: Russ waited for his counsellor, who was h:U( an hour l.:ue for the scheduled inter\'iiew. Russ wu sc res.std bee1use o( pe-rsona! problems 2nd w3:S anxious l'O ~et home l'O ea.re for his sick cluldren. Estelle. his counse1lor, was also stressed bec3use o( a di((kult v.--eek o( work. Durin& her inter\+iev.> with Russ she wu 2lso 2w::are that her next 2ppointmen1 was already w::aitina for her l'O l'rnish with Russ. Determined l'O c::atd, up. she ,newed quid.I)' with questions 10 complete her assessment o( Russ·s situ:u.On. Russ, uiken aooek b), Estelle·s ::abrupt style. proceeded cautiously. hesit2tin¥ 10 share person:U in(orm::ation qukl.1,·. Later, when rompletif)¥ her Ole notes on the interview. Estelle: wrote: "Client was defe:nslve and. ¥u:trded. He ::appeared unusl.l211)' reslrumt 10 ~plorinK his (ee11~" 52 Chap1er 2 _ CONVERSATION 2.3 STUDE:NT: If lhem's already a file on lhe clW!nl. ShOuld I read it be:fom seeing the client fOr' 100 first lime? TEACHER: Thete are ptos and cons to reading clie-nt flleS in ad\tance. It's important to be awate of the risks of either route. Some counselt)rs pre-fe-r toconducl lheil' first interviews wtthout reacfi~ lheil' clients' flleS. They argue that by not re.acfi~ the flies, they are prevented from being unduly influenced (biased) by prior in.format.ion. After a fU'St k'lte-rview, they feel mote able to evaluate 100 validity ot previous rec0r'dS. I.n add~ lion, they argue that clients can cha~, and approachi~ the interview with a freSh perspective makes it easier to relate to the dient's present condition. STUDENT: But suppose 100 client has a histOf')' ot violance that rS reported in the file. How wolld I be able to get that inf0tmation to protect myself wtltle stil keepU'lg an open mind? Is there a w.ry of getti~ onty the pertinent information from the flle that would allow me to identify 1oose prOblems? TEACHER, Tharsane ol the d,a-NbaCkSof not madir,g the file. I like your idea of setting up some ldncl of pfocess fOr' ide-nt~ fying clients whO might be dangefous. Clients wtlo pfe-sent safety concerns could be "fed-flagged'" in SCll'ne way. ST\J0ENT: I think anOlhet drawback is that If you do OOI IOOk at the ftle, you wtU miss out on 11.nc:,m~ what's bee-n done, 'llf\at wol'ked, wt1a1 issues are key, and so lorth. ts the-re a W:¥f of teading a file- withOut be-i~ in.fh.Jenced by othe-t writers? TEACH£R: Being awafe of the potential fof in.fl~n:e rS crucial. II is important to f&mind ourselves that opinions in ftles are not the clients' opinions but those of 100 pe-rson writing the rec0td. Ideally, fe-co<dS ShOuld be shelfed with clients and the conclusions pn.ttysupported. Of course, thi.s is n01 at.vays poss,i:.e. ST\J0ENT: Could I share- the- file with lhe client to ge-t his Or' he-t reactions? TEACH£R: Probably 001, at least nOI wdhOUI the- pe-rmission of the- pe-rson W'ho wrote- 100 fecOtd. De-pe-nding on whefeyou live, freedom of access to infofmation legislation may give dients the- rigf\t to petition for access to 100 file. Usu- ally, the- onus rS on the agency 0t govemment department to pcovide a reason fOr' wtthhOlding in.formation. Counsellors need to be famtfiat wtth 100 regulations in theit area. The Beginning Phase Successful prdiminnry phase work establishes a base for the first mnjor cask of the beginning phasc--namet,.,, developing n safe and trusting helping relationship through which clients can work toward their ,;oaJs. This relationship between counsellors and their clients influences whether clients will be willing to risk disclosure and is n signifi• cant variable that determines whcthe.r clients will continue with counselling. The coon• selling relationship is time~limitcd nnd based on a contract that outlines the objectives and terms of the relationship. Some clients come willingly to counselling, perhaps because of an unresolved crisis or because they hnve been persundcd by others to seek help. Other clients arc involuntary and, in some case~ overtly nntagonisric to the counsellor. They may also be coming because of n current crisis or pressure from others. An employer, for exnmple, may insist thnt a staff member seek counselling to nddres.s attitudinal or addiction problems. Many clients are also under considerable stress, and this stress is intensified if the clients perceive counsellors neg:itivcly. Predictabt,.,, clients' experiences with other agencies and counsellors shape their perceptions nnd expectations. Clients who have had bad experiences with counsellors will understnndnbly be guarded ag:iinst further disappointment. In addition, because counsellors arc often in n position of authority, or clients Stt them in such a position, clients' experiences with ochers in nuthorit)• will come into play. Most clients, however strongly they mn't' be mociwt~, will have some degree of resistance or ambivaJence to change. Involuntary clients may be especially resistant and, in some cases, hostile. They may perceive any initiative by their counsellors as a hostile act, however, weJI mC3ning it w·a.s. The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 53 SUCCESS TIP The clie-nl's reason f0t corning to counseling may 001 reveal itself until much later-. fear, emba(rassment, trust issues, and ocher factors can impede irrwnedi:.ate intrOduction of lhe problem. In lhe beginning, it is the counsellor"s job to engage with the Mpresenting prOblem.• Successful engagement wilh this d'lalleoge helps to c,eate the conditions f0t mor'e intimate discussion ot ocher issues. The counselling relationship is fundamental to counscJling success. Even in short, one-session encounters., when a high lcvcJ of intimacy is 00( crucial, clients will be more apt to engage 3nd share when the counscllor gives some attention to dcvdoping the relationship. Ch.nptcr 3 more fully explores the importance of the helping relationship and specific skills for developing and maintaining it. A second major task of the beginning phase is to acquire and deepen an under~ standing of the client's situntion or problem. ln rhe beginning phase, clients arc asked to teJI their stories, describe their feelings. and explore their problems and dilemmas. For their P3.rt, counsellors must be prepared to listen, and this mC3ns be.ing prepared to learn. Preliminary phase worlc ma,., help counseJlors predict possible theme~ and experience may tC3ch counsellors a g.rent dC3l about common needs and issues; however, in the beginning phase, counsellors need to put aside all assumptions as they attempt to appreciate the unique nature of ench client. The active listening skills of attending, using silence, summarizing, paraphrasing, questioning, and showing emP3thy are the basic tools for this exploration. These skills tend to motivate clients to graduaJt,., open up, organi!e their thoughts, and identify their feelings. They move the relationship beyond superficiality and hcJp both the counsdlor and the diem achieve shared understanding. Active listening also enables counscJlors to probe for detail~ definition~ and examplcs--information that is essential for preventing assumptions. The Therapeutic Value of the Beginning Phase The therapeutic value of coun.seJlors listening without judgment c3n be enormous. Active listening enables what is often the most important pan of any counselling encounter- the opportunity to tcll one's story and express feelings without interference. Since incense listening is rare in eve.ryday encounters, clients ma)' be visibly moved when they fed heard. Moreover, when counscJlors accept clients without judgment, clients become better able to accept themselves. Effective counsellors aJso encourage clients to explore the emotional com.ponents of the.ir lives. \Vhen clients share emotion~ counsellors need to be c3reful not to sabot:.lge this sharing by rescuing, telling clients not to fed as they do, changing the subject, or conveying discomfort or judgment. In addition, as clients ta1k, they may rdC3se a flood of emotions. A client might remark, "I've told )'OU things that no one Figure 2.2 54 Chap1er 2 else knows." As clients open up, they may begin to fed unburdened, a process that is known as catharsis or ventilation. Effective: counsellors probe: for detail by askina questions systematicaJly. They identify fodings and mirror them with empathic statements. This work enables clients to organize: the.ir thinking and to explore: and accept their feelings. \Vhen clients are confused or indecisive, orderly questioning helps them cateaorize information and pinpoint details or is.sues that they may have ove.rlooked. catharsis: An eaotiooJI tell!'aS! of ~ about put «wrMI experifflces t!l.i'! iesults in a po-«ml telei.se ol peal· up feelilgs su~ as aaiiety« ang$. Cautions For some clients, a sinale session may be sufficient to meet their need~ and they may not return for the next scheduled interview. Sometimes they decide 00( to return because they feel they do not need to. The cathartic release of emotions in a single session empowers them enough to dC31 with their problems. Other clients may quickly respond to the pO\\•er of the: counselling relationship and disclose at a level they would 00( have predicted. Later, they ma't' fed embarrassed, fearing that they have gone: too far, or they may resent their counsellors for probina into areas they would have preferred to keep private. ln response, clients may cut off the: counsellina reJationship prematurely, or they may come to the: next session but remain distant and guarded to protect themselves from over...disclosina. One: way to prevent problems is to be sensitive to individual pacing needs. Clients may give dues that the session is moving too quickly. The counsellor should watch for indicators such as hesitation, questioning why the: counsellor w-ants to know something, or st:ne.mc:nts that the client would rather not discuss particular issues. Another strategy is to discuss with clients how they fed about the session. The following excerpt illustrates this technique:: CounseU.or: Later h'.)n.i~u, when )'Ou think about our time tOiether. how do )'Ou think )'Ou ·u (eel? Client: I think I w1II have mixed (eel in~ It was reall't' ~-ood to talk, but I wonder 1( I told )'Ou mo much. I hope you will not think less o( me. Counsellor: You took a real risk "'1th me in s~rinK your pri\'ate thou,ahu a.nd (~lu~j. I think it's reason:able to worry about how I re:l.l!ted. Would )'Ou like to know! Client: Ye~ verr much. Coun.~ellor : Do you trust me enou,ah to belie"e th::u I will not he to you or tell )'Ou somethin& Just t'O m.:tl:.e you (eel better! (f the client SU)'S 't'CS. the counseJlor might candidly share: his or her reaction to the: client disclosure: Counsello r: I admire your coura~-t to Nice such painful issues.. As 2 result, I (e,el closer to )'Ou 2nd beuer ::ible to underS12nd )'Our stru~e. Ko,. I don't think less o( )'Ou. (f the client s3ys no, the counsellor initiates discussion of wh3t work nttds to be done: to establish trust: Counsellor: Perhaps w~ could ~lk. 2 bit about w~t needs to happen betwttn you and me in order for )'Ou to trust me. ln the pre-.•ious example, the: counsellor helps the client anticipate feelings that miW't 3risc after the session. By doing so, thecounscllor can help pre-.•c:nt the client from renching false: conclusions or making erroneous assumptions about wh3l happened. For counsellors to h3vc: such discussions with clients, 3 hiah level o( counsellor sel{3w3reness is crucial. Counsellors need to be willina to examine: how they are refatina to their clients. They should be adept at identifying any pc:rson3J biases (positive or neaative) th3t they nttd to manage to work effcctiw.ly with their clients. The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 55 The Action Phase (n the beginning phase, counscJlors work to understand their clients' perspectives, and clients organize their thinking and express their feelings. The action phase focuses on soh•ing problems, managing fttling.s, setting goals. and exploring altcrna.tivc strategics. In practice, action•phasc work ma'>' happen simultaneously with beginning-phase work, as clients ma'>' make discovc.rics or achieve insiaht from o:ploring issues, feelings, and problems. Slcillcd interviewers ask questions systematically, probing for detail 3S approprhne. This process aJone hcJps clients organi:e their thoughts on complex issues. As wdl, summari! ing. paraphrasing, and responding with cmP3thy provide an impor• tant mirror for reflecting clients' feelings and ideas. As a result, clients may Stt their problems in a different light, or they ma.'>' discover choices for nction that they had overlooked. In the action phase, counseJlors pin)• a. key role by providing new information, ideas, or perspectives. This involves challenging distortions of problems and encouraging clients to consider issues they may have overlooked. As well, counsellors need to encourage the worlc of change b)• ensuring that clients set dear and specific goals, which form the basis for the development of realistic action plans. Subsequently, coun.sellors may assist clients in implementing their plans. This assist:mcc includes hclping them anticipate and address potentiaJ problems, as wd) as supporting them through the struggles of the change process.. Counsellors aJso help clients develop new strategics for coping through skill acquisition strategies such as role-playing or techniques for managing self-defeating thought patterns. When clients experience the core conditions of congruence, empathy, and positive regard, they become better able to accept themsdve~ less defensive, and more open to expe.ricncing and accepting their feelings. Client attitudes and feelings change as coun.selling progresses successfully. Some of the important signals that clients are changing and growing include the following: ■ cues that they feel less apprehensive about counselling and the counseJling relationship ■ increased acceptance of feelings and more honest expression of previously denied foclings ■ diminished negativism, seJf<loubt, and blaming of others, and increased optimism and sdf-accepmnce ■ increased acceptance of responsibility for behaviours or choices ■ reduced sense of responsibility for the actions and choices of others ■ increased empathy for others (Gilliland & James, 1998, p. 115) Figure 2 ..3 56 Chap1er 2 Figure 2.4 As noted earlier, bcginning•phase and action.-phasc activities can happen simul,. taneously. Shifts between bcginning•phase and action-phase work arc also common. For example, clients may explore a problem in depth, begin a change program, and then revert to beginning-phase work to rocklc another problem area. Some common scenarios include the following: AO$;elo's counsellor ene<)U~e<l him to deseribe his situ::ation. As he ~lk.ed. he disrov.. ere<! :lSpttt.S o( his problem th:u he h::.d overlooked :md that su~sted new possibilities for immediate ::.etion. P2ri,·ash tended to keep her (ee:11~ so v.--ell hklden th::u she w:u unav.>2re o( their effet!t or intensity. \(i ith iti>ntle encour2~-e.ment from her counsellor. she be~a.n t'O open up. Talki0$: about her (eeli0$;$ represented a dramatic s.hi(t in her beh::tviour. The therapeutic value o( this than,Ki' was enonnous, as she unburdened hel"Sel( from a lifetime o( pent-up emotions.. Chapter 7 will explore how to assist clients through the worlc o( the action phase. The Ending Phase Successful termination starts in the beginning phase, when the nature and limits o( the counselling contract are defined. When counsellors and clients agree on the 3ctivities 3nd goals o( counseJling, they have defined a point of termination. This point becomes the target o( 31) counselling work. Although the target may change as client needs and progress arc rc-evalu3tcd, counsellors should reinforce that termination is 3 reality o( the counseJling relationship. Although evnlu3tion is 3 component of all phases of counselling, the ending phase is 3 major opportunity to 3ssess what h3s been accomplished and what remains to be done. 1t is a time to help clients make the step to independence and to consider new directions 3nd goals. It may 3fso occ3sion3lly be a point of transition. such as when a counsellor refers 3 client to another service. The ending phase is also a time to cvaJuatc the counselling rc1ationship. This e\laluation ma)' involve addressing any unresolved concerns and expressing feelings 3bout the ending o( the rel3tionship. See Chapter 3 for a more complete discussion of endings. COUNSELLING PITFALLS: BARRIERS TO SUCCESS CounseJling rcJationships 3re formed to 3ssist people to reach goals such as making a decision, dealing with painful feeling~ improving interpcrson31 skills, or man3ging an 3ddiction. Outcome success is easy to define: lt is measured by the extent th3t goaJs 3re reached. Me3suring the success of an interview or communic3tion momem in the The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling S7 interview is more difficult since much of the ch.nnac w-ork happens outside the interview. An example illustnnes: Jerome stom~ out of the inten•iew when hii counsie1lor21sked him to consider how his drinkh,i n,iaJu be afftttifl¥ his family. His 3.11i r)' w<>n:ls 21s he sl.:unmed the door left the eounsellorleelinK r21ttlOO: "You're just hke ::.11 the rest. I thou~t '>·ou v.--ere on my side. but it's dear my wife hasp to )'Ou... Six months later, Jerome' s situ:uion deteriorated 10 the point where he was re::.clr to re6eet on his ::.cldietion. The counsellor's ehallen{ti' bee.me an important p3rt of his ri'(".(J\~ry. NevcrcheJess, counselling can and docs fail, so counscJlors neo:I to develop their capacity to S)'Stcmatically investig3te and review failure. They need to be able to distin.guish between failures thal arc beyond their control and those aused by their own mis.takes. Failure may originate with the client; it ma'>' arise from pcrsonaJ issues associated with the counscJlor, such as faulty technique or lade of skill; or it may stem from factors that arc outside both the client's and the counsellor's control. Eg3n and Schroeder (2CX>9) put it bluntly when they described what they call the shadow side of helping: Helph,i mode.ls ::are fb,,,,.ed~ helpeTS are sometimes selAsh and e\'en predator'>' and the,., ::are prone 10 burnout. Clients ::are sometimes se!Osh. la:r, and pred::amry. e\'e n in the helpina rel::ationship. (p. JI) Client Variables Substance abuse or menta1 disorders may make it difficult or impossible for clients to enga,;c with the work of counselling. Clients may resist or undermine counselling because of secondary g3in, whe.re the payoffs from maintaining the problem outweigh the benefits of change Or clients may resist change because of an unconscious foar of success, because they expect to fail, or because the risks of chan,;c arc too frightening to face. Counsellor Variables lntdlectually and emotionally secure counscJlors are willing to examine their methods and attitude~ and they are willing to take their share of responsibility for poor counscJling outcomes. Counsellor variables include mental attitudes, mood~ and behaviours, all of which an dramaricaJly affect how counsellors relate to and assess their clients. Some counsellor variables that affect counselling outcomes arc burnout and vicarious trauma, personal problems, and loss of objectivity. Burnout and Vicarious Trauma A career working with people in crisis may be intenscJy satisfying, but it can also be emotionaJly srressful and draining. Counsellors may experience unrelenting pressure in worlcplace demands, including high caselo3ds, limited resources, and crushing paperwork. Counsellors can become depleted from trying to respond to the needs of their clients and the organization. ln addition, coun.seJlors arc subject to the.ir own famil)• and economic stress and trauma. Counsellors may be resilient, but even the sturdiest person can become debilitated by stress. Personal P·roblems Counsellors are subject to the same stresses in lifo as other people. They can become depressed, their children an become ill, their marriages can foil, or they can become responsible for caring for ailing or elderly parents. Responsible counsellors accept that there ma'>' be times when they need help too. They recognize the importance of having people in the.ir lives to whom they an ask for assistance. \\:fhen counsellors have healthy reciprocal relationships with others, they arc less likely to use (subconsciously) the.ir clients to meet these needs. During acute periods of stress, counsellors need to recogni!e their vulnerability and take steps to protect their clients. These steps might include taking a temporary 58 Chap1er 2 reduction in workload, shifting to a less demanding caseload, caking a "mentaJ health" break, or s«king increa~ supervis ion or consultation to monitor their worlc. Jn extreme circumstances, they may choose to take an extended IC3ve or switch careers. SUCCESS TIP Asking for help is a sign of strength, nor weakness. This rS true foe d ients, and it is alSO 1rue to( counsetlOl's.. Loss of Objectivity Objectivity is a measure of counseJlors' capacity to relate to clients without allowing their °"'n feelings and biases to distort their judgment (see Chapter I for a detailed d iscussion). A number of facto rs can lead to a loss of objectivity, including unresolved persona] problems. difficulty dC3Jing with panicu• Jar emotions or topics, attraction or revulsion to clients, over-identification with di• ent~ and excessive or unrealistic fear of particular clients. Counsellors who are not aware of their values and beliefs and the impact of their behaviour on o thers are limited in their ability to monitor their levcl of objectivity. CounseJlors who are committed to increasing the.ir objectiv ity make themselves avail• ab le for foedbaclc o r supervision. Moreover, they recogni:e their personal limitations and their inab ility to wo rlc objectively with every client. They know when to refer clients to other professionals. Common Mistakes CounseJlors are constantly ma.king choices. They must decide which of the three domains to exp lore (feeJing, thinking. or behaviour). They must choose which skills to use, how much to probe and cha.Henge, how fast to move the process forward, and which materiaJ is relevant to pursue. A ll of this happens in an environment (reJationship) that is often ambiguou~ o ccasionally hostile, frequent!)• complex, and constantly changing. Tab le 2. 7 o utlines the top 10 most common counselling errors. Pseudo-Counselling: The Illusion of Work The goal of every counselling relationship is to improve the q uality of life for the client. Achieving this goal may invo lve problem resolution, assistance with decision making, or management of painful feelings. Counsellors nttd to screen their responses and activities to ensure that the.ir work supports the objectives of counselling. Pseudo-counselling involves what Shu lman (2009) describes as the illusion of work-co unselling sessions are animated a nd active, but they are essentially empty and TABLE 2.7 Top 10 Counselling Errors 1. Rigidity and use of a "one-si:ze-fits-a11· apptoach 2. Insufficient attention to the counseflOl'~lient relationship 3. A<Mce givk\g 4. Absence of com conditions---empathy, unconditional positive fegar'd, and genuriooess p ~ l i n g {illusion of WOltc): Apoces.s ifl .tlith tile w.o!Mf and tile ciefll ~ ifl a ccaversati>n that is empty and tut has no teal me.ing. Counselling -.,1Nskrelevan1e,:ilorati:in d is.sues. use ol diches and p;r.roniliflt platiudes. iMelectu.al esploratio. ol is.sues, and a-,Odaf!Cf ol subf.d.S or ~ lhat-.,oh~ paifl ifl fl\'Otlr d '"safe·1opits. 5. Missing the opportunities offered b-f paying attention to the nonverbal channel 6. Loss of Ol>jectM1y and judg,nenlal responses 7. Pad~ ptoblems (too fast, too stow. and i.napproptiate timing of resJX)nses) 8. lnapptoptiate use of self~isclOSure (too mud'I. too little, and poor1y lmt:?d) 9. Rescui~. fatse re.assurance, and minimi:zing prOble-ms 10. Cultural insensitivity The Skills, Process, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 59 without rcaJ me3ning. Shulman makes this important observation: "For the illusion to take place, however, two must engage in the ritual. The worker must be willing to allow the illusion to be created, thus, participating in its maintenance" (p. I 54). The illusion of work can be Crc3tcd through the following: ■ interesting but irrelevant exploration of is.sues that do not contribute to problem sohting. including an excessive focus on finding the root causes of problems ■ use of dichi:s and patroni! ing platitudes ■ overly intellectual exploration of is.sues ■ avoidance of subjects or ftt.lings that involve pain in favour of S3fc topics. Of course, it is sometimes appropriate to shift the focus to S3fc arc.ls of discussion (e.g., if the interview is almost over, or if clients are dearly unable to handle additionaJ stress). Inappropriate Advice Giving Society conditions us to seek advice from expert~ so it's not surprising that many clients come to counsellors expecting "expert advice" on how to mana,;e their lives and solve their problems. Students and beginning counsellors often believe that counselling rttauires them to listen P3tiemi)• to their clients' problems and then offer advice on what they should do. However, they nttd to learn that this approach is rare]y helpful and is sometimes harmful to clients. p3rticularly when such acktice is based on vaJues that arc inconsistent with the client's lifestyle or culture. Clients often s«k advice even when they know what to do to m3na,;e the.ir problems. Sec.king advice cnn be a way of expressing dependency or transferring responsibility for decisions and outcomes to someone cJsc. This dependency inhibits the riWlt of clients to make choices, and it may le3ve clients fccJing resentful or frustrated, particularly if the advice was unsolicit~. Advice giving ma'>' incrc3se counsellors' self-esteem by underscoring their ability to be resourceful and helpful, but it may also undermine clients' self-esteem, leaving them feeling inadequate bee.awe they have been unable to figure out their problems for themscJves or bc-c.ausc they lade the will or resources to act on the "good advice." Counscllors who tend to give advice can become overly concerned about whether clients follow their advice, and if so, whethe.r the advice is successful. They can also become disappointed when clients do not follow advice. As Compton and GaJaway (2004)condude: "it is n()( your job to 'fix' clients. Rather, )'OU help them set and work toward goals. You assist them to recognize and use person.in-situation strengths and resources for problem solving and go3l atminment" (p. 82). \\:le arc in a better position to empower and promote client scJf-Oetennination if we refrain from giving advice and if we honour what clients bring to the rcJationship: ■ knowledge regarding themsc]ves and the siruation ■ knowledge about the origin and devcJopment of the problem ■ expectations about how you can hcJp ■ a network of social rcJationships ■ views about what they would like to accomplish ■ strengths for use in pursuing goals (Compton & G31away, 2004, p. 82) This injunction ag3inst ad,tice giving does not me3n that counsellors should with.hold information or ideas that might benefit their clients. Herc are some examples of information or ad,tice that counsellors might provide: ■ 60 tentative suggestions regarding alternative courses of action that the client has overlooked: however, "when counscllors are unwilling or unable to present and explore all ,tiable alternatives neutrally, they have an ethical responsibility to refer Chap1er 2 the diem to another counsellor, or at the very least, to make their biases or limita, tions explicit" (Shebib, 1997, p. 33) ■ ex-pert information based on resC3rch or knowledge (e.g., job-sC3rch techniques and child-rearing principles) ■ ideas for improving communication or problem solving ■ sugi;estions regarding the process of problem resolution ■ opinions and information that will help clients avoid unforeseen consequences (dangers) to themsdves or impulsive or poorly considered action \Vhere there is a range of individual choices, such as decisions related to marriage or career, advice giving is inappropriate. In such circumstances, the role of counsellors is to assist clients in identifying alternative courses of action, then to help them weigh the advantages and disadvantages of each alternative. Counsellors may suggest alternatives, but they should do this in such a way that clients feel frtt to reject their suggestions. As a rule, counsellors should probe for client ideas first with questions such as "\Vhat are your thouRJus on what to do?" "\\:fhat arc your choices?'' "\\:'hat advice could you give yourself?" "\Vhat idC3s have you considered but rejected!" Rescuing R escuing, or "band-aiding," involves actions that prevent or pr()(ect clients from dealing with issues or feelings. Rescuing arises from the counseJlor's need to avoid tension and keep the session cheerful, but it is misguided because rescuing diverts clients from addressing important though difficult issues in their lives. Rescuing is therefore a misuse of the support function of helping. Counsellors may become so preoccupied with avoiding or reducing tension that they interfere with their clients' ability to cope or to solve problems. Jf problem situations arc to be worked through successfully, clients must be allowed to experience and express painful emotions. For their part, counsellors must develop their ability to be present for such work without their °"'n needs and anxiety interfering or becoming a burden to their clients. rescu~ Alsoc-.iled ~ aiding, dlis irm:ilws acounsellor's adionsthat pre• wnt or piotea diffl1s from dealing Mith issues or ffflings. Rescuing arises frcm tile counS!lor's need to a-,oid tensioo ud keep the sessicadleeml SUCCESS TIP Advice giving and tescui.ng arise more from the counsellOf's ooed to be helpful, intelligent, to receive ad\lk::e o, be mscued. Or' powerful lhan thQ client's nQQd There are three major types of rescue bdi.aviour: t. Ten.sion reducer.s: Avoiding cough but otherwise timely and important topics and feelings by changing the subject, using humour to cut off discussion, or suggesting a coffee break. Rodney MIS On:11Ur willina to ::.ddress his sadness O\'er the death o( his l2theT. As he ~ n to talk. he cried so(tly. As he d,d so. his counsellor reached out and put her hands on his shouJden. reassurinSt him that his ariel would P3SS. Par hcsi121td lor 2 1noment as he stru~ed to collect his thol¢hts. ScnsinSt t~t tl,is miaht be a p.,inful moment for him. his counse.lJor s~ested that he miaht prefer to ~lk about somethina else. CounscJlor responses such as these impede the work of counselling b\• preventing or discouraging clients from dealing with their feelings. For clients to learn to manaae their emotion~ they must be allowed to experience the.ir pain. If counsellors communicate discomfort or disapproval with expressed em()(ions, important opportunities for work may be lost. The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling 61 2. Placaring: \Vithholding potentinJly helpful but criticaJ confrontation or offering false feo:lback and empty reassurance. T::u·a expresud fear 3bout c:on1,iC'tin~ her l:1the-r, with whom she h:td not ~d oon1:v!t for llve )'e3rs. Her oounsellor offered support: "Everythll,i is it(>ina to work out v.--ell. J'n, sure )'Our father will be tts:t3tk 10 see you... Shirtq· decided oot 10 oonlront herd1e:n1 O\'e-r an obvious h)'pe:ne problem. She oonduded that it would be be-st not to upset he-r die:nt 3nd jeop:u-di:e- a stroll¥ rel::n ions.I, i p. 3. Beh.a,.,iours rMr impede independence: Speaking for clients and doing for clients what they are able to do for rhemsdvcs. Jessie's C'OunselLor w3nted to be seen :u helpful and resourceful. She offered to rewrite her d1e:n1's r&:unW, 3nd pkk up :lpplk::nion lonns from ~ I emplO)-e-rS. Jolie was h::1:vh1i t rouble- unde-rstandini 2 school :usi~nrne:nt. His C'hild C'areoounsellor phoned his te-::iC'her to ,isk lor c:13ri(k3tion. e\'e:n thoud, Jose w3s C':2EX'ble o( talkina to the te-::id,er himsel( For clients to become independent. they need to dcvdop the skills and srrength to dcaJ with their lives on the.ir own. This ma)' be a difficult process for diem~ requiring counsellors to be supportive without stifling their clients' growth. Counsellors must avoid unduly protecting their clients by inte.rforing with their opportunities and capnc:it)• to face their diffteultics. This requires counsellors to be full)• aware of their own need for power and control and to accept th:.n successful counselling requires clients to be their own problem solvers. Furthermore, counsellors must rid themselves of an)' fnnmsy that only they can save their clients. Communication Stoppers Some responses tend to bring communication to a hair. Rescuing and advice giving arc two prime examples, but others th:.n have the same effect include name cnJling, "pln)ting psychologist" by offering clever but unsolicited assessments, commanding, morali!ing, minimi!ing the fcdings or concerns of others, using platitudes or clichCS, and excessive use of interrogating question~ cspcciaJly urhy questions that tend to aslc for justification or communicate subtle judgment. Abrupt subject changes are aJso communication stoppers. They may communicate that the counsellor is uncomfortable with the topic or feelings expressed. Faulty Technique Some of the problems that a.rise in counselling can be attributed to counsdlors' inept use of skills. Poor technique can lend to missed opportunities - CONVERSATION 2.4 ST\JOENT: What rS the diffetence between supporting clients and f&Seuiog them? TEACHER: Rescuitlg robS c~nts of legtt.imate opportunities f0t gro-.,h. Support;~ promotes self-ooterminauon by prov;ditlg encoufagen-.ent 0t resoufces to motivate clients toward growth and cha~. Tuning is atso a factOr'. Rescuing OCCU(S when clients have the srre~ to deal with difficult areas Of feelings, but theif counseuors avoid the wor'k paitl that this woukS entail. On the othef hand, if clients are overwhelmed, some direc1 assistance by counsenor-s to leSSen their bu(den rS supportive. It may be wise to avoid excessive intimacy in °' 62 Chap1er 2 the begk\niog of a relationslip, and it may be hazardous to expt)fe highty em::>t.ional topics ne.af the end ot an interview. AA imporiant quest.ion fof counsetl0ts to considef is ·Whose needs are being met, mine or the client's?· Rescuing behaviour moots counsenors' ooeds undef IM guise of helping clients, but supportive behavio1S helps clients realile IMir objecti\les. In the loog run, thefe are limes when it rS m0te supporti\ie to anow clients to face lheir struggtes and experience tnek parl. Effective counsetlors afe courageous en~ to alloN clients to express their paitl and accept the feality that they cannot pfovide solutions to al problems. and, in c:xtrc:mc: cases, can be: harmful to dic:nts. For example:, counsc:llors might foil to respond to individual diffc:rc:ncc:s (c:.g., gendc:r and culture), or thc:y may ding to a rigid "one: style fits all" approach to counselling. They may also be: poor listcnc:rs, or they may lack empathy. They might push clients too quid:J,.,, or they might allow them to stagnate by neglecting to motivate them to make: changes. Uncontrollable Variables largecasc:loods may precludc:counseJlors from spending sufficient time: with thc.ir dicms. Resources may 00( be: available: to support clients in thc:ir change process, such as at a detox facility. ln addition, unexpected evc:nts and crisc:s such as illness, dc:ath, or job loss may frustrate progress. (n some: cases, clic:nt changes ma't' be subverted by family and friends who are unprepared to support change. Defence Mechanisms Sigmund Frc:ud (185~1939) first used the: tc:rm defence mech a n ism to describe how people protect thc:mseJvc:s from aru:ic:ty, unpleasant thoughts, and persona] threat. To some c:xtc:nt, the: use of defence mechanisms is normal and healthy; it nJlows us to cope with the demands of life. But dc:fc:nce mecha, nisms are problematic when they are overused or when they prevent us from dealing with problems that should be addressed. Herc: are some: common dc:fc:nce mechanisms that counscJlors are likc:ly to see in their clients. ■ Acting Om. Expressing emotionnJ distress behaviourally. Example: A 't'oung child deals with hc:.r frustration by breaking her doll. ■ Denial. Refusing to accept or admowlcdi;c: what may be dc:arl't' c:vidcm to others. Example: A man with a drug addiction will not admit he: has a problem despite: considerable evidence: and feedback from othc:rs. ■ Displacement. Transfer.ring fc:c:lings to a less thrc:atc:ning person or object. Example:: A man who is angry at himsclf for losing his monc:y at the casino talcc:s his anger out on his wife. ■ Diuociacion. Separating or disconnecting from reality. Example: Amnesia as a reaction to a trauma.; daydreaming. ■ Humour. Avoiding c:motionaJ conflict by looking at the humorous aspects of the situation. ■ lncdlecmalitacion. Avoiding fc:c:lings through excessive abstract thinking. such as focusing on the details of an event, while losing touch with the: associated feelings. ■ Passit-e Aggre.uion. lndirccth• expressing aggression. Example:: Withholding hc:lpful ideas or information from someone you dislike. ■ Projection. FnJsdy assigning our own unacceptable fccJings to othc:rs. Example: An ajlR'..ressivc: person sees othc:rs as hostile and angry. ■ Rarionalitacion. Using sclf/4crving but incorrect explanations to avoid emotional rurmoil. Example: A woman who did not get a job promotion rationali:es that she: did not want the job anyway. ■ Reaction Formation. Substituting behaviour, thoughts, or feelings that arc the opposite of those that are unaccc:ptablc:. Example:: Being overly friendly or hc:lpful co someone you dislike. ■ RegTeuion. Reverting to an c:a.rlic:r form of coping.. Example: An adult sulks rather than using problem solving to dc:al with a diffteult situation. ■ R$ression. Keeping fc:c:lings and mc:moric:s out of conscious awareness (but they still continue: to influence: behaviour). Example: A ,voman who was sexually abused as a child may have: no memory of the: c:vcnt, but she: re.mains uncomfortable with physicaJ touch as an adult. The Skills, Pt ocess, and Pitfalls 01 Counselling defencunechanisms: ._.al pnnss or teaeli>n that shields a P£fSOfl frca•O.Sirable or.acceptable t!loughts. f.eelings. • to11tlusi:ins tll.tt. if acoeptei 'llcd:I create _,.ty « euleng_es toone·s s-.eet self. Common de.ieace m.chanisms ilclude dellial dispbc-=at. r;11ionalilatiln, suppessia..-6 regrmion. 63 ■ Spliuing. Stting or experiencing things only as polar opposites. Example: Seeing others as either perfect or totally inadequate. This defence: prevents people: from considering more balanced views and expectations of self and others. ■ Sublimation. Involves converting unacceptable feelings or impulses into more acceptable behaviour. Example:: Dealing with anger through involvement in martial arts. ■ Suppreuion. Dc:liberatc:ly avoiding thinking about feelings or thoughts that provoke anxiety. (Smm't': A1ne-rica.n Pi<)~.hfatrie A$$0Cfa.tion. 2COO. Grohol, 2015. Mcleod, 2008) SUMMARY ■ Counselling involves a tim~limitc:d relationship designed to hcJp clients increase their capacity todea.1 with the demands of life such as dcnJing with fcdings, learning new skills, making decision~ and accessing resources. ■ Counselling case.loads arc: characte.ri:cd by diversity in culture, gender, age:. religion, sexual orientation, language. education, economic ability, and so on. \\:forking with diversity requires counseJlors to be: adaptive and to be able to use: rcsc:arch throry and experience: as guides to determine which skills and procedures best meet the needs of their clients. ■ There: arc: four essc:ntia.1 clements of a trauma~informc:d approach: trauma aware~ ness., emphasis on safety and trustworthiness, opportunity for choice, collaboration and connection, and srrengths-baS(Xf counselling and skill building. ■ Four major skill and strategy dusters define the: range of necessary skills for coun~ sc:llors are ( I) rc:lationship~building, (2) exploring/probing. (3) empowering and strength building, (4) promoting change. ■ The: four counseJling phases arc: (I) preliminary, (2) beginning. (3) action, and (4) ending. Each phase: is charactc:rizc:d by unique tasks and skills. During different phases of the relationship. different skill dusters assume priority. ■ Many variables can lead to poor outcomes in counselling. C lient variables include unrealistic expectations and poor motivation. Counsellor factors such as burn~ out, pc:rsona.J problems, and loss of objectivity can also lead to failure:. Process or faulty techniques, including pseudo-counselling, advice giving, and rescuing, can contribute: to failure. Finally, failure may arise from factors outside the: control of counseJlors and clients. EXERCISES Self-Awareness 1. Think of a recent o, current prObtem that you are fac~g. Oescr'ibe the ways lhat counselling might be used to assist you rn addressrng this prOblem. Usi~ concepts from this chapter, identify what mighl be the maj0t activities lot ead'I phase of counselling. 2. Review the taskS of ead'I of the phases ot helping. With whi:::tl phase oo you feel most comfortable? Least comforta~? 64 Chap1er 2 3. Desctibe a situation in which you gave advice to or rescued someone. Do you have a tendency to give advice 0t rescue others? Seek feedback from Olhe:r'S who know you to see if theit perceptions agree with your setf-evatuation. Skill Practice I. Imagine thal you are teSJX)ncling to lhe foUo-Ning dient questions: What is counselling? HON does ii WOrk? 2. lnter'View cOleagues or counseltorS fonn the field. Explore the.' answel'S to lhe fellowing question: What are some of yout bigg&St counselling mistakes.? What did you leam from the-m? Concepts 1. Rate 100 extent that you think each of the fOflowk'lg srate-ments is ttue usi~ lhe foltowing scale (be ptepared to defend yout answel'S): _ _ _ The counselling ptocess evOfves sequentially through a number of phases, ~th each phase having specifte taskS an.d te,ciuiring specific skills.. ___ Effective counsenors are consistent. They use the same Skills in lhe same way throughout the counselling process. ___ If the pr1n.dples of counselling are applied effectively, all clients wil be helped. ___ Eve,ything that happens in the counselling interview muSI be treated as confidential and Shared with no one. Thi:S is the law in C3nada. ___ Effective counsetling invdveS bleoeli~ the client's OOeds with tt'IOse of the counsellor so that everyone invcived is satisf~. 4 = always 3 = fre,ciuently 2 = sometimes 1 = tarely 0 = never _ _ _ It is important for counsetor'Stodevelo,:, a personal Sl)te so that they 1reat all clients the same way. ___ The counsem~ process has a IOt in. common. with the processes used by other professionalS, such as doctorS an.d lawyerS; lhus, competent counseltors gather- information, diagoose the problem, and offer- SOiutions or advice to their clients on the beSt tesdution. _ _ _ Usualty, clients W'ho seek help are in ctisis, and theit ability to make decisions is significantly impaited. Ther-efO(e, it is im(X)l'&ant lhat counsellOrS are comfortable with maklrlg Ul1portant decisions on behalf of theit clients. _ _ _ The application of sktlls or techniques deltacts from spontaootty. Prolessional counsellors sttive to be free of biases ___ The Skills of counselling are also the skills of effective ev«yday communication. 2. Write a Short essay supporting lhe follo-/Mg atgument: The capacity to accepa help from an01her- person is a sign of sueogth. 3. In 'lff'lat ways might advice giving di:Semi»NEr clients? 4. What do you think are the advantages and disadvantages of wot'Jd~ from a fout-phase mo:Jel of counsem~ 5. Identify and ex.ptore clients' legal rights to access fde infor- mation in your jurisdiction. 6. List the pros an.d coos of displaying ead'I of the tonowing in yout office: a. famlly phOtos b. motivational JX)Stel'S ___ CounsellOl'S wM have perSOl'lal expe-rieoce wilh the ptoblem or issues that their c~n.ts are experiend~ 'liifl be more effective. WEBLINKS This site offM links to a wide range of resou1ces on a variety of psychOlogy topics www.psywww.com/resource/bytOPfC.htm Government of Manitoba manual on trauma-info,med p,actice http:/lltauma-tn fo,med.catwp..contenVuploads/'2013/ 10/ Trauma-tnf01med_Toolkit.pdf Article that ext,IOres 15 Common Defence Mechan isms http://psychcentral.com/ lib/ 15-common~efense-mechanismsl Rep,int of a classic article by Cati Rogers, the founder of Person-Centred Counselling.. http://psychclassiC$.yorku.ca1RogerSltherapy.htm l he Skills, Process, a nd Pitfalls ol Counselling 65 Designer49 I/Shutte,s;o:k ■ Explore the features of a counselling relationship. ■ Explain the importance of the core conditions of warmth, empathy, and genuineness.. ■ Oemonstr:ne ability to negotiate relationship. anticiP3tory, and work contracts. ■ Demonstrate skills for maintainina the counscJling relationship. ■ Examine relationship endings. THE COUNSELLING RELATIONSHIP One of the most well-documented findina in counsellina is the fact that devclopina and sustainina an effective counselling relationship is widely accepted as critical to success (Cochran & Cochran, 2015; C ozolino & Santos. 2014; Heinonen & Spenrman, 2010; Nystul, 201 I; Rogers, 1980; and Shulman, 2CX>9). In fact, the rcJntionship itself is often the central reason for client chan,;e, and it can be " more important than any informa.tion aiven, rderrals made, or practice approaches used . . ." (He.inonen & Spearman, 2010, p. IOI). Research by Kivliahan, Celso, Ain, Hummel, and Markin, (2015)demon.stratcd that counsellors with better relationships have clients who make better progress. 66 Having a sttong relationship can activate lhe brain's tewatd system in the same way as a dtug by teleasing lhe oourotr'ansmittet dOS)amine, which is associated with pleasute and feeling good. Conver'Sety, the loss of lhe tel3tionship can lead 10 dep,-ession and anxiely (Jantz, 2015). Capuz! i and Gross (2009) conclude, "specific proc~urcs and techniques arc much less important than the alliance between counsellor and diem" (p. 65). Significant]}•, "even clients whose lives have predisposed them to distrust and suspicion often remain :.de rt to dues that this professional relationship may hold promise" (Miley, O'Melia, & Dubois, 2004, p. 130). Rather than focus on technique, wise counsellors make the helping relationship the centre of their ,vork. Over 50 rears ago. Rogers ( 1961) emphasized that a counsellor's attitudes and feeJing.s are more important than technique and noted that the client's perception of the counsellor's attitudes is what is most crucial. Re0ecting on this he wrote, "In my early professionaJ rears 1 was asking the question: How can I treat. or cure, or change this person? Now J would phrase the question in this way: How can I provide a refotionship which this person ma'>' use for his own personaJ growth!" (p. 32). The expertise that counsellors bring to the relationship lies less in the.ir ability to solve problems than in their capacity to recoanizc and mobili.!c diem strengths and resources. When strenai:hs are revealed and resources identified, clients become empowered with new choices and rcvitali!ed optimism. Definition A coun....ellin,: relationship is a time-limited period of consultation between a counsellor and one or more clients for assisting the client in achieving a defined goal. Counselling refotionships have some of the same components of intimacy, caring. and support that characteri:e deep personal relationships. High-level communication skills are as important to friendships as they are to counselling. Moreover, many of the skills of counselling arc aJso the skills of effective everydaycommuniation. Friendships grow out of mutual attraction and common interests., whereas counselling relationships focus on heJping clients achieve goaJs such as resolving crises, making decisions. and learning new skills. Counselling relationships are structured for the primary purpose of reuhing these goals, and once the clients have achieved them, the counseJling relation• ship is terminated. There is no expectation of reciprocity. Personal relationships can be terminated for personal reasons. Counsellors, how• ever, arc expected to persist in their efforts on behalf of clients even when they arc frustrated by l.ac:k of progress or client resistance. Counselling may be ended when there is little likelihood of reu.hing its goals, but not simply because the counsellor prefers other diems. One measure of professionalism is the capacity of the practitioner to sustain commitment. patience, and caring despite frusrrating obstacles. Many clients come to counselling with impaired ability to form or sustain health)• relationships., so counseJlors must remain sensitive to this fact and not allow their own emotions or "bunons to be pushed." Rogcrs's counselling classic, Cliem.-Cenrered Therapy (1951), describes the experience of a client who successfully completed counselling following an unsuccessful experience with another counsellor. The second counsellor asked the diem wh'>' he had been able to work through his problems on his second attempt. The client responded, "You did about the same things he did, but you seemed reaJly interest~ in me" (p. 69). Relationship: The Foundation lor Change c:ounselli,_ relationsh.,: Ali, . limited peri>d al coosultation bE1~ a toonsfflor W a dient dedicated to lldliMlg a de.fined f(lal 67 ))t) BRAIN n,, '. , BYTE 11 Oxytocin is a hormone and a ne-urotransmittef that plays a sigrlifacant tole in telationship t:X>ndi~. Both sex. and bitth inctease levets ot ox.ytoc:in, and it appears that strong telalionships atso increase ox.ytodn lew!ls. There is evidence that increased ox.ytocin levels reduce stress, anxiety, depression, and also increase empathy and one's geooral abtfity to communicate emotions (Gravotta, 2013; Simon-Dack & Marmarosh, 2014). 0ur brain/bOdy releases ox.ytocin to 8 strengthen relations.hips. Oxytocin gets released duri~ light caresses. sex., wtlen someone ShO'hS they trust you. and sometimes even simi;::iywith talking. When released, ox.ytocin increases feelings ot attachment for another- perSOO, as well as feelings ot trUSI. It also decreases feelings of stress. fear and pain· (Korb, 2014: onlioo). These findi~ undetscore 100 importance of payingattantion to the counsem~ r'ela~ ship and avoiding a strict taSk or prOble-m-sol\'ing orientation. The heJping relationship provides rhe necessary security for clients to disclose the.ir fttling.s and ideas. As rrust develops in refationship~ so docs the caP3cit)• of clients to become increasing),., open to revealing themseJves. Drawing from the srrength of their relationships with counsellor~ clients may rislc new ways of thinking and behaving, and in this way, the relationship becomes the medium for chanae. In positive counselling relationship~ clients perceive their counsellors as a.Hies. They become increasingly will.ing to disclose because they do not fear that they will be rejected, judi;cd, or c~rced to change in ways that they find unacceptable. Jn its purest form, the counselling reJntion.ship becomes a collaborative endeavour. CounseJling sessions a.re not always comfortable or pleasant. The process may involve exploration of painful feelings or o:pe.riences. Personal change involves risk and modification of one's usual way of thinking or behaving, and this can be stressful. Counsellors who a.re intent on kttping the counselling rclntionship pleasant ma,., com,. municate reluct:mce to deal with sensitive issue~ or they may withdraw at the first sign of difficulty by changing the topic or rescuing. SUCCESS TIP If you want to inftuence sotneone, fifSl pay anent.ion to the relatiotlsi-.p. Relationship and the Phases of Counselling Each of the four phases of counseJling-prcliminary, beginning, action, and endinghas associated relationship tasks and cha.Jlenges (Shcbib, 1997). In all phases, counseJlors need todcvclop effective skills and attitudes for engaging and retaining clients, including sincerity, perceptivencs~ honesty, respect for dive.rsit)', capncity to initiate conversa.,. tions, ability to be a good listene.r, comfon with discussing feelings, emP3th't', ability to communicate confidence without conceit, and warmth. The essential clements of the counselling relationship include core condition~ contract~ goals, and immediacy, with the worlc conducted within professional boundaries and time limits (Figure 3.1). Preliminary Phase The gool of the preJiminary phase is to create the necessary physical and pS)'Chological conditions for the relationship to begin. The counselling environment (e.g., ni;ency setting, office ln)'OUt, and reception procedures) can have a dramatic impact on the client's mood and expcctntions even before the interview begins (Knapp & Hall, 2006; Shebib, 1997). Preliminary phase work attempts to create first impressions that say to clients, "You will be respected here. You a.re important. This is a place where you will be supponed." 68 Chap1er 3 Co<e Conditions Immediacy Contrac1s Sooodaries & Time Goals limits Figure 3.1 The Essential Elements of a Counselling Relationship SUCCESS TIP The stage for the relationship is set long befom you moot your client. Upe-riences wdh past counsetJors, ext,ectations abOut lhe pcocess, factOr'S such as tM waiting room, hOw the client is greeted, and waiting time mean lhe relationship has already started befOr'e )'Our fllSt encounte-r. TM relatiotlsi-.p is further predefined by issues such as culture, gender, sexual Orientatbn, reactions to autnority, and the presence ot mental disor'dets. Beginning Phase The relationship g,c,al in the beginning ph3sc is co dcvcJop rapport, trust, and a working contract or agreement reg3rding the purpose of the work and the roles of rhc participants. The relationship at this phase must provide enough safety for clients that they will engage and continue with counselling. Counsellors create this c:nvironmcm of safety b)• communicating that they do 00( judge the diem and that change can occur. The relationship enables clients to fee] sufficientJ,., free to take on the first risks of counselling-sharing their feelings and concerns. Neverthcles~ some clients are poorly equipped to do this. and they may remain guarded or suspicious throughout the whole process. Action Phase Ideally, in the action phase, the reJationship continues to dcvdop and strengthen. Clients take new risks as they find the courage and strength to examine and change their wa)'S of thinking, feeling, and behaving. During this phase, reJationship work may need to focus on addressing communication problems including. at time~ tension or conflict. Ending P hase Termination of the counselling relationship comes when counselling has ~rved its purpose and clients have reached their goa.Js. Termination focuses on reviewing the work accomplished, helping clients consolidate learning. and SU)ting goodbye. Ending phase work will be discussed in more depth later in this chapter. CARL ROGERS AND THE CORE CONDITIONS Carl Rogers (1902- 1987). the founder of dicnt<entred therapy (later known as person• centred therapy), has exerted an enormous in6ucncc on the counseJling profession for the last 65 't'ears. Rogers (I 951, 1961 , and 1980) asserted the importance of s«ing others as "becoming." This notion underscores a fundamental belief in the capacity of people to change. Clients arc not bound b)• their past, and counsellors should not use diagnosis and das• sification as tools for depersonalizing clients and treating them as objects. In counseJling, Relationship: Tile Foundation lor Change 69 clients need to be seen for their potcntiru, strength, inner p0\\'Ct, and ai.pacity to change. Rogcrs's nondircctivc methods are based on the premise that if core conditions are present, then change is possible. The core conditions act to speed the natural process of healing or recovery from psychologicaJ pain or problems. The essential core conditions arc unconditionaJ positive regard, empathy, and genuineness. Core conditions arc aspects of attitude that are prerequisites to forming and maintaining effective hclping relationships. Although counsellors can use certain behnviours and skills to demonstrate core conditions. the conditions must represent the authentic values and attitudes of counseJlors. \Vhen counseJlors exhibit these core conditions. the potentinJ for chnnge and positive relationships with clients is incre3scd. However, there is no guarantee that clients will interpret warmth, aenuinenes~ and empathy (or any communication) in the way that they were intended. Prior cxperi.ences and expectations, as wdl as cultural and individunJ differences, can easily lead to discrepancies in the way communication is perceived. Counsellors can expect to be rejected at least some of the time, despite their best cffons. Moreover, a client may perceive empathy as an intrusive attempt to "get into my head" and may interpret caring attitudes as manipulation. Secure professionals accept this re3lity, knowing that considerable resistance may be encountered as they work to develop the heJping relationship. Unconditional Positive Regard warmth: M espressi>n of 10npomssitt caring tut reqlllies genuin•n-.:J • olwm•, the acoeptafltf of the equal YIOrt!I of oeks.. a IOflju~ntal attihlde, •d avoidance of tuaing. 70 UnconditionnJ positive rcg3.rd accepts the diem as a person of wonh and dignity. This acceptance is felt and communicated by counsel.tors without condition, judgment, or expectation. Rogoers beJieved that such uncon.ditionaJ rcg3rd creates the very best conditions for client growth to occur. Essential components of unconditional positive regard include caring., respect, warmth, and compassion. Rogers (1961) urged counsellors to shun any tendency to keep clients at a distance by tre3ting them as objects with detailed diagnostic labels. Instead, he ari:ued thnt coun• sellors neo:I to learn that it is safe to express their warmth and to let clients know th.nt they care. Warmth is difficult to define; yet its presence or absence can be fclt immediatdy. \Varmth communicates comfort and trust, and it is a precursor to trust. It attracts clients to take risks because it indicates the goodwill and motivation of the.ir counseJ,. lors. In the beginning, clients often come to counselling reluctantly, perhaps driven by external pres.sure or by the weight of their problems. Counsellors need to engage or connect with clients to hdp them find enough acceptance so that they return and suf,. ficient safety so that they can take appropriate risks. Warmth say~ "I'm approachnblc. You do 00( need to be afraid of me. I won't take advantage of your vulnerability. J'm a kind person." As a result, warmth is particularly important during the formative or beginning stage of the relationship. Warmth is also crucial for supporting clients dur.ing a crisis, and it is a necessary partner to ai.ring confrontation. Clients will be more receptive to feedback if it originates from a warm and caring attitude. Although warmth can to some extent be defined behaviouraJly, it must arise from genuine fodings of caring for the client. Otherwise, the counsellor's actions will appear lacking in genuineness. ·warmth is demonstrated by smiling appropriatdy and by show.ing since.re interest in the comfort of the diem. Counsellors show warmth when they communicate nonverbally that they are totaJly focused on their clients. Simple coune.sies, such as eliminating distractions from the interview, asking clients if they are physi.cally comfortable, offering them a beverage, and making e)'C contact all convey warmth. \VelL-timed humour can nJso add a warm touch to the interview. Counsellors need to be flexib le with their lcvcl of expressed warmth and caring. Highly suspicious clients may interpret warmth as manipulative, and some clients are not comfortable with a high levd of expressed emotion. As \\'di, gender may be a variable. Chap1er 3 Being warm docs not prec.ludedC3ling with difficult topics; in foct, w-amnh provides the neccss3ry found3tion for such ta1k. Nor docs it imply that a grc3t deaJ of the interview needs to be spent making small mlk, 3S one might do during a social visit. Sometimes in busy social service aJ;encic~ c3sdoads become unmanagC3ble and the pace of the work frantic. Constant crises and unrelenting papcnvork exhaust even the most energetic and caring workers, who m3y begin to lose the "spark" they h3d when they first entered the field. Unless controlled, the office routine can begin to feel more like an 3ssembly line th3n a counseJling service, as clients become numbers and the worlc becomes increasing),., m.sk.-oriented. How docs one continue to focl and express warmth under such conditions! The answer must be discovered individually, but we c3n learn something from the observations of one worker, a senior caseworker with over 25 years' experience: What works for me is to remind 1n)'SeJ( that no matter how overwhelmed I feel. it's worse lor in)' clienu. O(ten. they're broke. in crisis and not sure wbethe-r they w;,int to live or die. Tih~)' don't need me to be p::arc o( the problem. \V~c doesn·c work lor 1ne is to s.et cau¥ht up in oo(fee room neK"3ti\'ism. You know what it's like-the ones who ne\'er h::a"e ::anythina '--ood co 53)' ::and ::always expect thina,i co s.et worse. It :Uso helps if I take a few moments. sornecirnes precious se«>nds. between interviews to rned1t2te. When I n~t mr chent. I tr)' to spend some time just heh,¥ (riendl)·. Empathy Empath)• describes the capnc:it)• to understand the feelings 3nd \'lews of 3nothe.r person. Emp3thic 3ttitudes and skills can generntc powerful bonds of trust 3nd rapport. Emp3thy communicates understanding and acceptance. An cmpuhic artitudc is ch3rncteri:ed by one's willingness to IC3rn about the world of another and begins with suspending judgment. To be nonjudgmcntn1 rttauircs considerable discipline in controlling personal bi3sc~ assumptions, and reactions thu might contaminate understanding. CONVERSATION 3.1 COUNSEllOR 1: Maybe C3fl Rogers COUkS do ii, but I find 1t difficult, somethnes impossible, to have fespect and cari~ fof someone whO has oon,e something h0tfend0us, such as raping a Child. P1108ATION OFFICER: Even Rogers admitted to bei~ challenged. Sotnelimes he'd Share his oogative teactions ot feelings with his clients-maybe that's why he identified genllneness as a core condition. COUNS£UOR 2: Eyen if I have strong negati\le feelings toward my client, I can stil controt my behaviour. I can listen; I can ~ my active listeni~ skill$ to try to undersaand. I can empa thize, which doesni mt.an I awee with the client Of sanction the behaviouf. 4 P1108ATION OFFICER: One of 100 fitst people I wOt'ked with was a man whO was so abusive and he put his wife in the hospital. I dtShked him befor'e I even met him. But as I gOI to know him, 1found myself softeni~ a bit. I still was fepu~d by what he did, but I also came to understand his depression, his inabiity to get a job, and his own abuse asa chitd. He was much mofe complicated than I imagined. NON, I've wOt'ked in the Alber&a correctional system tot 1S years, and I've~ met anyone who is pufe evil. 31th~ some psyd'lopaths can come clOSe. COUNSELLOR 3: We have a professional t'de to play, and it's n01 out job to condemn Of put.Sh, but the feality is that we won'I •ke or tespect eitety dient we moot; howevet, we have a much better d'lance of helping the client cha• if we have a WOl'kiog felationSl'lip. This increases the poss,ibiity that clients 'Ifill trust us so that they can ex,:ife-ss and discuss important feelings and ideas. The bouom Ii~ fot me is this: fes,)ecl the dient, but reject the behaviout. When you do that the client has a safe relationslip, and often that alOne can generate movement to consttucli've change. If the client ex.pcesses remofSe ot self~oubt about his behaviout 0t if he hints at some de-sil'e to d'lange, we can buitd m::,mentum tot change with encOU'agi~ questions and feflections sud'I as ·Sou nets •ke there's a part ot you that WOlJd 1tke to be different,· Of "Suppose you wefe to make a change in the difection you describe. How WOUid you do if?• COUNS£UOR 2: Hefe's anolhef thought. I think 1t rS jUSI as important to unders&and and controt out strong pos,tive feeli ~ oocause lhese have the same potential to clOud ouf ObjeclMly. Relationshi p: Tile Foundation lor Change 71 In addition, counscllors need co be able to enter the emotional world of their di.ents without fear of b«oming crapped in their pain. CounseJlors who arc secure with themselves and their feelings have the capacity to enter their clients' worlds without fear of losing their own identity. Brill and Levine (2005) note that when a counscllor communicates acceptance. there is the "freedom to be oneself--to express one's fears, angers, joy, rage, to grow, develop. and change--without conce.rn that doing so will jcopardi:e the refationship" (p. I 18). Empathy has cwo components. First, counsellors must be able to perceive their di.ents' feelings and pc.rspecrivcs. This rcquircscounscllors to have abundant S(".lf•awarencss and emotional maturity so that they do not contaminate their clients' cxpe.ricnce with their own. The second component of empathy is to make an empathic response. This involves putting in words the feelings thnt the client has expressed. This task cnn be particularly difficult, since clients often communicate their feelings in abstract, ambiguous, or nonverbal ,.,,.,._,.,s. Empathic responses rttauirc a vocabulary of w-ords and phrases that can be used to define feelings. At a basic level, empathic responses adcnowlcdge obvious and dearly expressed feelings. At a more advanced or inferred level, e.mP3thic responses are framed from hints and nonverbnJ cues. An empathic response proves to clients that they have been hcard, unde.rstood, and accepted. Chapter 6 focuses on this critical skill. Genuineness Being genuine mcans being authentic and real in a relationship. Coun.sellors who arc ,;cnuine show high consistency between what they think and do, and between what they feel and express. Rogers ( 1961) used the term congmenr to describe this quality and emphasi:ed the importance of self-awareness to unambiguous com.munication. To avoid giving contradictory messages., counscllors need to be aware of how they arc feeling and how they are transmitting their feelings. Genuine counscllors are also hight,., trustwonhy. Thq•do noc lie to dien~ and they arc willing to provide feedback that is cimel'>' and helpfuJ. They sho,,v respect for clients ~• bc.ing open and honest while maintaining warmth and emP3thy in the relationship. They do not w-orlc from hidden a,;cndas., nor do they put on "masks" or play roles to hide their true feel,. ings. As weJI, ,;cnuine counscllors arc reliable. They do what thq• say they arc going to do. Core Conditions: Implications for Counsellors Rog,ers's philosophy suggests a number of introspective questions for counsellors to consider rcg:irding che.ir attitudes and behaviour in hcJping relationships: ■ Houican I acr so that dienu will perceil't' me as rmsru,onhy! This means counscllors do what they say they will do and net in a way that is consistent with how they feel. It requires counsellors to communicate without ambiguity and contradiction. ■ Can I permir m,"$e'lf ro experience positive arrirude:s of u,armrh, caring, liking, intereSL, and re:spec.r rOlmrd clienu! Can I be :srrong enough a:s a per.son to be :sepamte from my clients! This requires a high level of maturity, self.awareness. and courage. Ro,;crs summarizes this chaJlenge: ''Am J strong enough in my own ~parnccness that I will not be downcast by his depression, frightened by his fear, nor engulfed by his dependency! Is my inner sclf hard'>' enough to rcali.!e that I am not destroyed by his ang~r, taken over by his need for dependence, nor enslaved by his love, but thnt 1 exist scP3rate from him with feelings and rights of my own?" ( 1961, p. 52) ■ ■ Am I :secure enough ro permit clienu their separarene:s.s! Clients are not under their counscJlor's control, nor are they to be molded as modcJs of what counsellors feel they should be. ■ Can I le, mysclf fully emparhhe urirh my dienu' feelings and world per:spenil'eS without e,ialuaring c,,- j1Klging! 72 Chap1er 3 CONVERSATION 3.2 STUDE:NT: How far ShOuld I go With genuiooooss? What if I'm a~ry with my client? Should I say so? Or suppose I find my client disgustk"lg. Shouk1 1ex.press that too? TEACHER: You've identified an impoftant dilemma. On the one hand, the need for genuineness suggests that we ShOuld be open and hooost with our clients. We Shouldn't put on false fronts, lie to clients. Or' fake OU( feelings. Al the same time, ethical principres dear1y prOhibit us ftom dc::i~ hafm. Being genuine ooesn1 entitle counsetors to "dump· on tnell clients. Genuioo counsellors are truthful, but they ate alSO timely. They share personal petceptions and footings in an asserti\18 way to meet their clients' neoos. They night ex.press theit anger, but they dO so withOut intending to punish, rid~ cute, or trap the.' clients. As f0t feeli~ diSgtJSl toward a client, I can'I see hoN sharing thal information would sel'\le any pur. pose. On 100 other hand. it may be useful 10 the client if you explored the specific behaviou's or attttudes that gave rise to thOse feelings. With sensitive feedbaek, your client can have the benefit of leamk'lg abOut his or her impac1on others. Once you put 1t on the &able foe discussion., you no ~ ( have to hide )'OU' reactions. One final poi.nl: Strong react.ions toward our clients may hi.I'll at OU( own vlJnerabirrties. If you find a d ient disgusti~. I'd want to ask you. MWhem does that feeling come from? Are you sure 1t is related onfy to the d ient?· ST\J0ENT: Maybe the client Mpushes my buttons" the same way my pa(ents did. TEACHER, Exactly. COUNSELLING CONTRACTS A contract is n negotint~ agreement between the counsellor and the client reg3rding important variables that define the worlc. Counsellors typicaJl't' begin contracting enrly in the first interview; however, contracting is continuous throughout the life of the helping relationship. Rigid adherence to ne,;otiatcd conrracts is hazardous. Counselling contracts nttd to be pcriodicaJl't' revisited and updated, sometimes even severnJ times during a single session. The reasons for amending contracts include the following: ■ Exploration of problems nnd feelings ma,., promote insight. and this may lead changed expectations and revised goals. ■ (ncrcascd rrust may enable clients to address more difficult topics and feelings that they were unwilling to consider at the beginning of the relationship. ■ New problems and issues may emerge because of changing circumstances. c:ontr~t: Aneiomted agieemeai bE1•een coaselCl'i . t clients ieprding tile purpose of the 'llllfk. their ,espectiw soles, and the •Uiojs and f'Clllllines that • ill be 11sed to ieat h tileir agreed-on ct;e«ive. ('Seealso sessitxtJIGMlflt:t and wri GMtnct) to SUCCESS TIP Variables suctl as clJtu(e, level of t(uS'l, timlflg, mood, and stress can affecl a client's wflingness and capacity to address topics. Similarly, unresdved conftkl .-i 100 client~setlOr' (elat.ionship can dramatically affect the contract. Unless these variables are considered and until conflicl is resolved, the client may not cooperate or fulty participate. Purpose of Contracting Contracting ensures that clients and counsellors arc on the same page with respect to the goals of the w-ork and the counselling methods that will be used. Contracting 3fso involves discussion that defines the counscJlor~ lient relationship, including role~ right~ and responsibilities. Good counscJlors adjust their style to meet the need~ culture, and personality of their clients. They consult and negotiate with their clients to identify and understand these variables. Effective contracting respects clients' freedom to choose, and it gives them knowledge and control of the helping process. \Vhen counsellors and their clients are ,vorking toward agreed-upon objectives, it is much Relationship: Tile Fo undation lor Change 73 more liket,., that clients will "own" the ,vork rather th3n see it as somethina th3t h3s been imposed on them. Contractina reduces suspicions that counsellors may have hid• den ai;endas. Contrnctina directly addresses the reality that there may be (and often an~) sharp differences among the follO\\•ing: ■ the problem as perceived by 3ny referring source (e.g., another aaency, family, employer, etc.) ■ the problem as perceived b)• the client ■ your perception (as counscJlor) of the problem The contract is like a road map that provides i;enerol directions on how to get from A to B. Jr confirms that all parries are ,vorking tow3rd the same end. A counscJ.ling contract also predicts an end to the relationship. Defining tasks and goals makes it dear when the relationship should be ended. Jo this Wtt)', the counselling relationship is deart,., distinauished from a friendship. whidi may last for 3 lifetime. SUCCESS TIP ContracUng may change ave( the life of lhe relationship Or' even during a single session. Client insigrlt, changed priOl"ities, moo:J, ttust k!WI. capacity, and eme(gent issues arQ variables that drfvQ changes in tM contr'3Ct. Contracts may be formal and sianed by both the counsellor and the client, but more frequent])• they are informal and ratified with verbal agreement or a handshake. The.re are three types of contracts: relationship, 3nticipatory, 3nd work. Relationsh i p Contracts ~lationship contract: ANftotulion of tbe intended purp>S! of the uunselling telationsllii>. inc:Wiig an ag,ee~ • the ~Ed soles al bo1' counselklf and dient The relation.,;hip contract outlines how the counsellor and the client will work together. lt results in a cusromi:ed relationship th3t is uniquely respectful and responsive to the client's expectations, W3nts, and needs. The process involves candid discussion and exploration of client issues, such 3S the followina: ■ communication style (e.g., prefe.rred ways to communicate, problem solve, resolve conflict, and give and rcce.ive feedback) ■ personal wlues, worldview, and culture ■ exploration of how differences (e.g., gender, aae, race, and sexual orientation) might help or hinder the counselling work ■ past experiences with counselling The relationship contract, b)• its nature, honours diversity and individual differences in communication styles and patterns. The process signals to clients that their needs and wants will be respected and th3t counsellors are willing to adjust the.ir st)•le to accommodate clients. Pan of the relationship contractina process is discus.sing the methods 3nd process of counsellina. Counsellors should be open about what they are doina and not work from 3 sec.ret script with myste.rious techniques that they hide from clients. They should be willing 3nd able to describe their worlc in simple, non-jargonistic langu3ge. (n this way, clients can know something about what is happening, the direction of the work, and wh3t remains to be done. Shulman (2009) emphasi!es the need for workers to provide dear, non-ja.rgonistic st3tements th3t describe the rani;e of services available. This is particul3.rly important 74 Chap1er 3 in settings where the counseJlor ma.'>' be the one who initiates first contact. \Vhen the purpose of the mcetina is explicit, clients do not have to ,vort)• a.bout workers' hidden agendas, and they a.re in a. more informed position to cake advantage of assistance. ln the example below, a school counsellor is ma.Icing an excellent attempt to engage with an 11-yenM>ld boy who has transferred to the school in the middle of the a.endemic yenr and Sttms depressed and alone: Coun.seltor: My name is ?l.·1r. S1nith. I'm here bec3usie your te::.cher thou$:ht I mi$:ht be :1ble t'O help you with Sm»e of the problems you 're havinK :.t sehool. I know that ii ean be tou~, to be the new kkL Sometimes it's just not mueh (un. Maybe we rouJd 1~t :.nd see i( we ean O~-ure o ut 3 way to mW 1hi~ better. \Vh::u do )'Ou thin.kt Past Experiences with Counselling Many clients have considerable experience working with counsellors, and they have learned what works and what docs not ,vork. CounscJlors can learn from chis and adapt their approach nccordinaly. A sample probe illustrates as follows: Coun.seltor: I'd like )'Our help. I know )'Ou\~ bet>n oomin& to this 3~ncy for 3 while, :.nd you have a lot o( ~perienu as 3 user. h would help me i( )'Ou could tell me a bit :1bou1 )'Our ~perience~1ke. wh3t did )'Ou f'lnd helpful and not help(ul? TI,en we ean t3lk about how )'Ou and I t21n best v.-'Ork t~ther. \Vhile diems ma.'>' have had satisfying and empowerina expe.rience~ the reality is that many have fclt discmpowe.red by counsellors and other socia.J service providers. Open discussion about this can provide valuable cues for structuring the current rel3, tionship. Moreover, the process can help clients who have had a b3d expe.rience reach some closure on unresolved fcclinas. Ac the same time, the process dearly communi• cates chat chis relationship has the potentia.J to be diffe.rent. Discussion of the Roles and Expectations of the Participants Counsellors should know somethina about what clients want from chem. Do clients expect them to provide 3dvice on how to manage che.ir problems! Do they want to be challenged with new information and new perspectives? Are they looking for someone who is warm, gentle, and supportive, or someone who will just listen? Similarly, counsellors need to tdl clients a.bout an'>' exptttations they have. Role discussion may also address is.sues such as how the participants might 3ddrcssconflict, and how they can provide feedback to e3ch other. Clients may be a.ware of the.ir pain and may rccogni!e and accept the need for change and help, but they may have no idea what form this help might take. In such situations, counsellors need to be able to hdp them unde.rstand the potential assistance that counseJling can provide. Somedients also have unrealistic expectations of their counsellors and the process. They may believe that counsellors will tell chem what to do and solve all their problems. Or they ma.'>' have no faith in the process whatsocwr. According to Wicks and Parsons (I 984), when people enter counselling they often anticipate "either a. miracle or complete failure" (p. 175). Contracting is a significant opportunity for demystifying the process and for challenging unreasonable positive or negative expectations. The followina example is taken from the midpoint of a. second inte.rview. le illustrates how the counsellor gen th• encoura,;es the client to re-examine some self-imposed restrictions on the relationship: Client: Let's l:ttp rny feeli1l{tS out o( thil. I simpl'>' want 10 look at ways to improve rny relationship with my son. I( you could teieh rne some tt"<':hniques. I'd be rnosc Kr:l.teful. Coun.sell.or: Of eourSe you're entitled t'O privacy on issues <>r (e,eli~ that )'Ou don't want 10 share with me. At the ~rne time. I wonder i( )'Ou miiht be too hasty in rescrieth1K wh:lt v.--e t21n discuss. Relationship: Tile Foundation lor Change 75 Client: I don't i et it. What do )'OU mean? CounS(>IJOr. \Veil, you·ve bee!, throu$:h a lot. \\11th your son' s arrest 21nd his dis:1ppear, antt (or over a month. I'd be surprised i( rou weren' t (ee1m~ stress. CUent: \Vho ..vouk.ln·e CounseUor. That' s exxtly my point. When I don't ~lk about (ee.lin{t:l th:u are bother, ina me, I have to keep them inside or pretend they're not there. I've (ound that doesn' t work. Sooner or bter. I h:i,'t, to (21ee my (eelin~s. Client: I'm Just 21(r3id that i{ I start er)•i1l{t. I won't be :lbte l'O Sl'Op. CounS(>IJOr. Th:it tells 1fie that the pain must be ,'t,r)' deep. (Slknte as tht- clitnt tc>ars up.) CounS(>IJOr. I Yi·on't push )'Ou, but I hope our rel:u.Onship ean beco1fie a 5::11(e pl.:1ee for you. 1t·sobrwith me i( )'Ou ery. Many clients arc slow to develop trust, perhaps for good reason. They may have lifelong experiences o( betrayal or abuse by people they trusted. \\:fhy should it be any different with a counsellor? As a result, it is understandable that they approach counselling with a degree o( mistrust. Wides and Parsons ( 1984) provide a compel.ling observation: "Though there may seem to be a great distance between counseJ,. lors and their clients during the beginning phase o( counselling, they should not be discourai;cd because at that point their clients ma)' be closer to them than anyone dsc" (p. 168). Client: I really don't see the point in be.in¥ hen:-. ?l.·f)• sit"uation ishopeless. J','t, ~n l'O other oounsellorS and nothina worked. 1'1n onl)• here because mr wi(e insisted. She thou~,t rou mi~u be 3b1e to help. CounS(>IJOr (Choice I): You eer~inl)• do sound diseoul"3~-td. but I think you should Kive eounsellu~ another chanee. Marbe b)' talli~ about )'Our problems, we c=n discover some solutions you've O\~rlook.ed. CounS(>IJOr (Choke 2): Given rour past experie:nees,. I ean see wh)· you' re pessi1nistie. You're wise to be skeptical until )'Ou Ond out i( you can trust me. In the end, the results will be the most important thi~ In this example, Choice I is well-meaning but ill.-timed and may lead to n powe.r struggle i( the client fods compelled to defend his position. Choice 2 is not condcsccnd.ing, it avoids the power struggle trap, and it docs not promise success. Anticipatory Contracts antidpatoty contract: An ag,eement between couns!lots and clieus tu'! plans kif predictlble ew:nts. Antqii.;ory contracts pnrme g_uidance ICJ coasElcn •d ans•111.r tbe questioo. '"M.at shodd I d) jf .. !"' Anticipatory contracts enable counsellors and their clients to plan for predictable events. Jf you know something has been problematic in the past, ask your client for heJp on how )'OU might respond if the same situntion arises in the future. Some examples o( what counsellors might say are as follows: CounS(>IJOr (to .:1 client with a hl;;tory of \iolenc.e): "I need your help. I( I see that )'Ou are :u,irY. what would be a ~-ood thlfl¥ (or me to do that rou would And useful? .. CounS(>IJOr (to .:1 client iW.rtina a job search): "Suppose three or lour w~k.!l inl'O )'Our job seareh )'Ou 21re ~ttina diseoul"3~-ed. Give 1fie some ::.dviee on wh::u I miaht do l'O help you r«.3pture some o( the positive ene"iy you (eel todar. ·• Homebuilders usuaJI)• prewire n~w homes so that future instaJlation of services like cable television will be easy. In the same way, reJationships can be "prewired" to mnke resolution o( communication difficulties easier. Conrracting smnegics, such as discussing in advance how conflict will be addressed and working to develop and refine open communication, are the tools for prewiring relationships. )( conflicts occur, a 76 Chap1er 3 mechanism is aJrendy in pince for resolvina them. Herc arc some examples that illustrate the options: Counsellor: Suppose th::u I h::r\'e some (eedbr:lck for you. How would 2pprooch )'Ou? )'Ou hk.e me IO Coun.seltor: let's talk about wh::u e::.ch o( us tan do i( there's 2 problem be1ween us. l m~ne th::u I sar or do somethinK t~1 offends rou or you don' t like. All o f us h.nve preferences about how we like to give and rece.ivc feedback. Some o( us want it straight and to the point; some respond better to a "S3ndwich Sl)•le," combinina critical feedback with suppon and positive affirmation. Others need visual or behavioural illustTiltions. Anticipatory contractina identifies these preferences. SUCCESS TIP TM onus is on the counsellOf to adjust his Or' het styte of giving feeelbaek to moot 100 style of the client. Clearty, this fe<::iuites counsetlo, fkoobllily. Anticipatory eootrac1s tel the counsellOI" how to be flexit:,e. Work Contracts Whereas the relationship contract focuses on the respective roles and expecr:ntions of the participants and how they will communicate, the work contract defines the focus for the current session and the overall objective of the participants' ,vo rk toJ;cther. Sheafor and Horcjsi (2008) identify the following basic components of the wo rk contract: ■ problems o r concerns to be addressed ■ goals and objectives of the intervention ■ activities Iactions) the client will undertake ■ tasks to be per formed by the worker ■ expected duration ■ schedule of rime and place for interviews ■ idemification of other persons, agencies, or o rg3nizations expected to participate (p. 322) WOltc contr-ac:t: An ag,eemea1 di.at specifies the iMended to3ls• «r.OCdle ol uunselling.. As well, ethical issue~ including the limitations of confidentiality, arc also pan of the work contract. Sessional Focus The scs.sional contTilct answers the question, "\Vhat are we hopina to talk about a nd accomplish toda,.•!" Althouah the importance of defining sessional focus seems seJf-evidcnt, it is surprising how often counsellors procttd without a clear sense of direction or purpose. Or they assume that the.ir clients undersr:nnd and arc working with the same purpose in mind. \\:'hen clients are involved in negotiating the contract, they arc respected and empowered as active partners, not passive recipients of service. W ith clarity and agreement reaard ina purpose, clients arc more likely to support and participate in the work. Sometimes what counsellors sec as client resis• tance is better understood as legitimate client defence against something (i.e., goals o r processes) they experience as imposed. Sessional contracts can direct anemion to one o r more of the three major domains: behaviour, thinking, and feeling, SessionnJ contracts based on beh.nviour target objec• tives such as skill d evelopment, problem solution (what to do or say), decision making, Relationshi p: Tile Foundation lor Change 77 TABLE 3.1 Contract ing l eads What are you hopi~ to acc:ompis.h as a (eslAt of our \\()rk IOday? Whete do you feel most comtortable ssartl~ What brings you hefe? What oo you need to get out of tOday? What dO you need from me-? Lei's talk abOut hO'N we can use ouf time here. Flnis.h this sente~: When I leave he-re tOday, I hope tr.at . Several limes you've hinted at . .. Perhaps it migt\t be important to focus on this a bit ( To art il'tYOlunta,y dienO You feel forced to come-. Neve-rtheless. you could have chosen not to. So I wondet if we could talk aOOut hOw you couk1 make the beSI use ot the Ume we have together. The- e-xami:,es belOW are chOice options when you wish to intrOduce clients to the services available at tne age-ncy, wtle-n c~nts a(e stuck, and when d ie-nts have limited understanding of the possibilities of counseling. If you wis.h. we could ex.ptore . . Here's an idea of wtlete we might go from here. In my e-xpede-~. I have found that it is very helpful, sometimes crucial. to talk abOut feelings befOl'e \\()rkj~ on problem solutions. Ooos this make sense to you or not? Let me tell you a bit abOut the prawams here. Then we can discuss which ones. if any, you wish to use. He-re are two choices: Eithef we could wol'k now oo fiOOi~ a SOiution. ot pe-rhaps it might be be-tte-t to just spend time talking about how you fool. I wonde-t if it makes sense 10 talk a bit abOut . . . exploring options, 3nd goal setting. SessionaJ contracts ba~ on thinking arc concerned with hcJping clients explore vnJue~ assumption~ beliefs(induding spiritunJ beliefs), and scJf-csteem is.sues. \Vhen feeling is the focus of the comrnct, the work concentrates on clients' emotions. Counsellors 3re sometimes too quick to 3ssume that clients need to worlc on sofu,. tions when the.ir primary need may be to "unwind" with a sympathetic listener. Through sessionnJ contracting, counseJlors ensure that whal is done in the interview is explicit and relevant. Work Focus Jf there is no agreement on the purpose of counselling, the work is apt to be direc:tionless. 'W ithout an agreed-upon purpose, counseJlors tend to make assumptions 3bout the needs and wants of their clients-which arc frequently wrong. Sec T3ble 3. 1 for examples of leads th3t c3n be used to initiate contracting. Every counseJling a,;ency has a purpose chal defines and limits its service. Specialty a,;encie~ such as employment counselling cenrres, m3y focus on c3reer testing and job search skills, while a transition home may provide crisis counseJling and shelter. A community centre might provide a broad ran,;e of counselling, education, 3nd group suppon services. The multiple purposes of counselling can indude helping clients with problem soh•ing, decision making, and managing feelings. It can also provide suppon, give information, and foster skill acquisition. Counsellors define and limit their role based on their position in the agency and their training, An intake worker, for ex3mple, may be restricted to inirinJ screening and assessment~ while a community outreach worker ma'>' spcci31i:e in reaching clients who do not \'oluntarily seek service. But clients may have specific wants and needs that do not mesh with the mandate of the agency or its workers. Abrah3m Maslow's (1954) famous hierarchy of needs (Figure 3.2) can be a useful wa'>' of understanding client priorities. Maslow suggested that people normally seek to fulfill their basic survivnJ needs before pursuing higher order needs. As one counsellor put it, "You can't counsel a client who hasn't eaten." 78 Chap1er 3 ~ actualizailon Safely a.1cs...1va1 Figure 3.2 Maslow"s Hierarchy of Needs Contracting needs to con.sider three variables: client need, ai;cncy mtmdau; and counsellor expertise. Contracting ,vorks wd) when the client's needs matc.h the agency's mandate and the counscJlor's competence, but when the service the client needs is beyond the mandate of the agenq• or the competence of the counscJlor, rcfc.rral to another counscllor or a,;cncy is appropriate. lntcrview 3.1 illustrates how contracting is used to eng3gc and map out a plan with the parent of a teen who is abusing drugs. })!} INTERVIEW 3.1 This interview is exc:e-pted from the IS-minute mark of the first session with a parent of a teen who is abusing drugs. Counsellor: Let's take a few minutes to talk abOut hO'N we mighl \\()rk togetnet. Then we·u bOth have a Shared sense of direction. Cllent: Great i:lea. I was \\()ndeMgwhere we go from here. Counsellor: Pethaps you have some idoos on what you'd like to achieve. I'd like to hoor lhem. Then. if you wish. I can add some ot my own. Client: As I tOld you. my big goal is to keep my son alive. I don't want to (eceive a cau from the hOSpital saying he has overdosed. CounsellOr: Whether you( son uses drugs is n01 under you( control. If you ,.;st,, we could talk abOt.C some of tne ways you could deal 'Mth his behaviot.Jf, sl.d'I as how to handle it Vi'f'lef'I he b<eakS curlew 01wt1a1 todowMO you think he's high. Analysis: A simple. flot1-ja.rgo,,lstic statement initiates tfle contracting process. CCl'ltracting is presented as a col/at>txatlve process. Analysis: By seeking input, the counsellor communicates respect for lhe client's needs at'ld signal$ that lhe counseNor is t'10/ going 10 take control and make all the dedsJoos. Tfl;s helps &:, empower the clknt and minimae any tet1de.ncy for the clknt w become overly dependent. Analysis: The counsel/Or gently attempts to contain tfle M'Of'k within areas that the client can COf'lttOI, namely her behaviour.. Thedienrs reactictl COt'lf,rms ut'lderStat'ld1ngat'ld ptr,vides agree. mer1t 00 000 latget fotM'Of'k. Client: That would be g(eat.! Those are rwo of my biggest problems. Counsellor: Obviousty. this i:S a time of sttess for' you. One of the ways I may be able to work with you is to help you deal with your feelings. Sometimes you might feel OYe(· wool med by evefythi~ that's happenmg, and I'd be happy just to listen o, to help you sort out you- feeli~. Client: You have no idea how tough this has been fOr' me as a single parent. My fathe(was addicted to alCOhOI. and my son brings back ail those memories.. Analysis: Counsellors can suggest addJYiona/ Ideas to hel(J diet'lts make the be.SI use of the setVlces available. In this Slatement. t/'Je counsellor attempts to lntrOduce feelings as Ofle of the areas on which COUl'tSel/klg rnigftt focus. Analysis: The client's willingness &:, begin to share SOfl1e of her feelings signals to the counsellot ll'lat She has accepted ll'le offer we,p/ofe feelings. Relationship: Tile Foundation lor Change 79 >» INTERVIEW 3 .1 Contracting (continue} Counsellor: So, you're no str'an.ger to the pain lhat is caused b-f addiction. Analysis: Empathy Is the f)(eferred resp()(tS(J to srrong feelings. (Five minutes /all!r.) Anaty1l1: This work sets the sttJge fot feedback. It giWJs the COU!tSellor a dear picture of the c/J'enrs p,efetred style. KnM11g this, the counsellor ctJn tailot any feedback to fit the Client's ex,:,ectat!Ctls. Counsellor: Whal do you ooed and want from our relationship? Cl5ent: I want you to be honest with me. Counsellor: What do you mean by Mbe honest?· Cllent: Don't try to spare my feelings. If you ltlink I'm wrong, say so. Don't sugarcoat the truth. Counsellor: So, if I have some ideas abOut how you might dO thi~ differentty or another way of looking at thi~. I'll jusa tel you. Client, Eliac:lly. Counsellor: can I expect the same from you? Anaty,ls: The cout'ISeJIOr avoids assumpUoos of meaning atld asks tile cfietll to define tile word •hOf)(!St. • Wolds ctJn have ver'y differer,t meatllngs to ifldividuai'S... Later. if the cout1sell0t wishes to challenge tile ctier,t, he or she can use an ;ntroductOr'y statement such as I/le fo/l(}v;iflg to rem;nd the Clklnt of the C-Ot'ltract: ~Remember' whert we agreed that if I had some kieas that were different from youtS I should be hotle.st?" Because there has been f)(iot agreement, the cliertt Is l'l'l()re likely to support the f)((>Ce'SS and to be open to feedback or challenges. Client, (Hes/tall!~) Iguess so. Coun.sellor: You seem unsure. Would it be tough to confront me if you thought I was wro~ ClitM: I'm the kind of perSOn who likes to keep those kinds ot thi~ inside. Counsellor: Sometimes it makeS sense to hold back, and that's a s1rength. Uke with your son, you need to pick your battles. Overall. it's beltet to have Choices. In OIX refa~ ship, I'd like to invite you to risk telti~ the truth to me. (A Anatys/1: &me clients have trouble de:Jllflg with persoos in autflOtlty. Even tflOugfl the clietll agrees. it Is im,:,orttJnt to pick up on the he.sitab'ot1. Others are simply Shy and have habitual pattert'IS of taJd11g a passive apptOOCh to re/ab'ooship ptoblems. The cout1sellit1g relat!Ctlshjp c.an be an opporrut'llty to e,q:,erlmertt with new way$ ofrelating. WIie{) couttSe/lors create condltioos of safety for rislc-lakJflg, c/J'er,ts Catt Jeam Skills that they can ttattSfer to otflet relatiot1Sh;ps.. In 111;s excerpt, the cout1se/Jor also finds a way to hOr'IOU( strengths. few minutes later.) Cl5ent: AbOut a yeat ago. I we-nt to a family counsenor for help. That was a disaster. Counsellor: You might be wOt'ried that ttlis will turn out the samew.ry. Client, Yes. Counsellor: Now I'm worried too. (Cout1sel/or and client laugh.) Tell me what went w(ong; 1r.en, we can talk aoout how we can avoid 100 same ptOb· tems here. Just tell me what happened. but don't tell me whO your counseltor was. Cl5ent: Well, fOt' one lhiog. he never gave me any information. If I as.keel for a brOd'lure or something on heroin, he'd a~Nays say sure, and then he'd forget. Counsellor: I wonder if it migt\t be useful if we kept a few notes. Client, Okay. <A few minutes later.) Counsellor: Oo you have any questions? Cl5ent: WhO gets to see my file? Analysis: The purpose ofasking clients about experiences ;s tlOl to engage the client ifl a gossip ses'Slctl abOut the mistakes ofcoJ. leagues. Gandld dl'Scus'Slor'ls about what ~s effective at'ld ineffectlW! Pf(JVide Important lt1fO(matiot1 oo the cliet'lt'S e.xpectatiot'IS attd feats lot the curroot re/atiooship. Th;s gives the COU!tSel/or a chance to customize cout1selling to meet the needS attd ~nts of the client. A little shared humour adds watmlfl to the reliJt/Mship. Rev;ewlng the client's counselling Mstory flel,:,s avo;d the mistakes of the past. Of course. tflls dfscusslotl must be conducted in a professional maMet that does not invc/tle maflgning COiieagues. Analysis: o;scusslon regarding the limits of coofidentlality attd any other ethictJI concem-s that the clioot has cart addressed. Reflections: ■ How does the counsenor in this interview promote collaboration? ■ How would you have answered the counsellor's que,stion, MWhat do you need and want from our relationShip"? 80 Chap1er 3 oow be Relationships with Youth Establishing a relationship with youth involves all of the same clements of success thnt are involved in relationship building with adults. \\:'Ith youth, it is important to establish relationships with dear boundaries. It is desirable to hnve warm and friendly cncountc.rs where the convc.rsation ftt.ls nntural and spontaneous; however, conditions diffo:rcm from friendship arc present. For one, the.re arc limits to confidentiality and these should be discussed. Insofar as possible, the youth's right to privacy can be respected, but lcgn] and a,;ency responsibilities need also be considered. ln this sense, it is important not to compromise the role of other professionals by withhold~ ing information to whkh they are cntidcd, or by undermining thc.ir authority or competence throuWl collusion with youth. 1t is also essential for counsellors to avoid assuming a parental role. Unsolicited advice or attempts to control will likely meet resistance. Many youths who come to counselling have histories of abuse and neglect. Some may still be living in abusive or dangerous situations where fear and caution arc constants. Counsellors can expect that these youths will bring these same feelings to the counselling relationship. and initial attempts to connect with 't'Ouths may be difficult. If they expect that the counseJlor cannot be trusted, then whatever defences they use to cope with rejection will come into play. Thus, initiatives to establish counsellor trust, rcliabilit)', and predictability arc crucial. A tr..mmn.-informed approach should be used, which features the core conditions. r«ognition of the client's strengths, and collaboration as the foundation for relationship eng3gemcm and development. Adolescence is a time when there arc enormous physical, emotional, and social developmental challenges. During this period, anxiety, depression, moodiness, and indecision are common experiences. When the.re arc also issues involving substance abuse, poverty, the criminal justice system, mental health, marginalization, abuse, and neglect, the chaJlcngcs arc multiplied and new barriers cmcri;:c which ma,., bring youths to counselling. Jf a warm and trusting counselling relationship can be ncgotiat~. much-needed stability and structure is inmxluc~ into their otherwise chaotic lives. Chapter S will explore in more detail the skills and attirudcs n«essary for establishing this relationship. Engaging with Seniors Life Stories Counsellors who work with older adults should become familiar with the values and issues that have defined thc.ir lives. Just as the rise of terrorism and the events of 9/11 have left an indcJiblc imprint on current generations, seniors were impacted b\• world events such as the Vietnam \Var and the cultural changes of the 1960s. As part of relationship building with seniors, counsellors should ask them to share details of significant life events and influences. Some of these will be highly personal such as the birth of their children, death of their spouse, or significant travels. Others will be intimatel't' conn«ted to significant experiences like war (e.g., World War II, the Korean \\:far), the Cuban Missile Crisis. the Scarles, or the fall of the ~rlin Wall. One senior related how air raid sirens used in Cannda in the 1950s as a drill for nuclear war, left hc.r so tc.rrified that even today, sounds such as the siren from an ambulance rekindle her fc3.r. Hearing such stories will provide counseJlors with context for a grcatc.r understanding and empathy for lives that have evolved very differently than their °"'n. He.re arc some sample questions that might be used: ■ \Vhat were the most significant memories or moments from your life? ■ \Vhere have you lived (or travelled) during your lifd Hou.•did this clungc or affect you? ■ \Vhat were your happiest moments (or saddest)! \Vhat lasting ~ffcct did they have! ■ \Vhat changes in the world have affect~ you the most? ■ \Vhat arc the things about your life that arc important for me to understand? Relationship: Tile Foundation lor Change 81 Age Differences Signific:mt differences in a,;c berwttn counsellors and their clients is a factor th.nt can be discussed openly. Some seniors ma'>' be reluctant co share, fc~uing that a youn,;cr counsellor will not be able to understand thc.ir problems. Others may wckomc the idC3 of working with someone '>'oun,;cr as a chnnce to ,;ct fresh ideas and a "youth" pe.rspective. A simple lead can be used to initiate the conversation. For exam,. pie, "How do you think the fact th.nt I am much younge.r than you might help or hinder our ,vork tog,ethcr"! Counscllor IC3ds can also honour the experience and wisdom of their senior clients. Using a srrengths approach, a counsellor might say, "I'm betting that '>'ou've learned a lot in )'Our life that you can use to deal with your current problems." Relationship Dynamics Transference and countcrtransfercncc arc often at play. Some seniors may adopt a pnrcntnJ and protective role toward the counsellor. For their pan, counseJlors need to be aware of their own feelings (positive or negative) when working with seniors. For example, interaction with an aging client facing declining hC31th might trigger the counseJlor's own fears about death and dying. ln response, the counsellor might withdraw or become overly prot«tive. Counsellors need to be ready to examine their own assumptions regn.rding aging. Seniors arc a very diverse group. and there are vast differences among them with respect to health, cognitive ability, capacity for autonomy, lifestyles, and income. Counsellors must be willing to re-.•isit any negative assumptions they might harbour such as the notion that seniors arc rigid or not capable of making their own decisions due to cog• nitivc decline. \Vhile many seniors have hC3ring los~ this should not be confused with loss of mental ability. SUSTAINING THE COUNSELLING RELATIONSHIP Immediacy I mm ediacy is a tool for exploring, evaluating, and deepening counselling reJntionships (Eg3n & &hrocde.r, 2009). All rdationship~ including counselling relationship~ are subject to periodic conflict. This may arise from communiai.tion problems, strong emotion~ misconceptions, failed expectations, power struggle~ value conflict, and many other re3sons. Such conflict has the potential to be destructive, but it also presents a great opportunity for further development of the relationship. The~al of immediacy is to strengthen the counscJling reJationship by evaluating the gene.ml working di.mate of the counscllor- diem relationship. "The reJationship is cwlu,. ated or reviewed, and relationship strengths and weaknesses are examined by exploring the respective feelings, hopes, and frustrations of the parties involved" (She.bib, 1997, p. 114). All relationship~ including the counselling relationship. arc occasionally tested with minor or serious personn1it)• conflicts and communication breakdowns. Counscl.ling involves rislc..taking, whidi. can lead to stress and anxiety. This process of change means that the reJationship is not always plC3sant. Handled wisch•, these conflicts have the potentiaJ to deepen rather than impair reJntionships. When problems arc identified, they can be resolved through discussion, compromise, conflict resolution, or renegotiation of the relationship. Jmmcdiacy can address fttlings such as anger, rescntmem, or resistance that are adversel'>' affecting the reJntion.ship. Similarly, positive feelings of liking or attraction miaht also need to be addressed if these feelings are clouding objectivity or progress. The example below illusrrntes how a counsellor might initiate relationship immediacy: immediacy: Atool f o r ~ . evaluar.&. and deepening coun~ nlation~ s. CounS(>IJOr. I want to put ,iskle what v.--e\'t, been ~!kin¥ about ,ind ~ke a look at wh::u's h::appeninK betv.--een us. I think we have ,i ¥ R':at r::apport, and Yi't, both seem relaxed when 82 Chap1er 3 we're h'.)~ther, but I believe l\ee betome reluctant t'O be totallr hones«. ?l.fa)'be it's because I don't want the rel3tionship to become unple:aS3.nt. I( I'm not mistaken. you seem to hold back too. Immediacy is a pO\\rc.rful tool for preventing communication brc~llcdowns and build~ ing rrust. By addressing relationship difficulties as they arise, problems that are more serious are prevented from deveJoping because of the buildup of unresolved feelings. This does not imply that every relationship issue must be explored. With immffliacy, counsellors can address significant feelings and issues that affect the reJationship as they occur. but it is important for counsellors to be sensitive to timing and pacing. Gene.ra.11)•, immediacy should nor be introduced when a session is ending if there is insufficient time to resolve issues. 1t may also be wise to delay immediacy discussions if clients are unduly stressed with other is.sues. As well, avoid initiating immediacy discussion too C3rly in the relationship before a base of trust is developed. Counscllors can ensure the appropriateness of using immediacy by asking: Would immediacy be useful for the diend Does the client have the capacity (personal strength and resources) to profit from immediacy at this time? Immediacy is a way to get closer to clients. A dependent relationship arises when clients become overly reliant on their coon• sellors for decision making. Common indic3tors that a dependent relationship exists include excessive permission seeking, frequent phone calls or offKe visits for informa, tion, and an inability to make simple decisions or take action without consulting the counsellor. A dependent relationship undermines the principle of self-dne.rmination b\• shifting power away from clients and preventing them from deveJoping independence. A well-timed immediacy discussion can address dependency issues and lead to a new contract that favours client autonomy. (n the following example, the counsellor uses immediacy to identify a sharp change in the mood of the interview: dependent relationship: A uunselling Rb1ion~ ii wbQ dients tieoc. ow,t, teliant on lktr counsfflors for decision maliing. lndicitors indDde a:cesswt pe,mission seeting. frequent ptic. calls « office visiis rorillcrmat• and a11 inabiityto m..W simple de:isioa « Lale 11ihout c.sulting .ith tile uunsellor firsl act• Counsellor: You ~m to h:t,'t, become S<HnN·~t quiet. \\'hen I ~,sk:. question, you i-1\'t, me one. ort\\'0-Yi'i>rd 2ns"eers. Usual!)' you're q uite expressive. Is somethifl¥ wroni! Client: Now that you mention it, res. I'm just noc sure !'loo.\• 1m.ch I'm willina to trust )'Ou. At first it was okay. but now you ~m intent on pushina me to deal with thin¥,$ I'd rather keep pd\'ate. Couruellor : Perhaps l'1n movina too fast or brU,i.ina up issues v.--e h:l\'en't :!ir~d 10 talk about. Client: Mostly )'Ou don't take no lor an an5\\-e-r. When I s::I)' I don't want to ~lk about somethintt, I mean it. CounseUo r: Like earlier today. when I kept oomlfl¥ back to how )'Ou (elt when )'Ou broke up with )'Our wife. Client: That ·s 2 perl'ttt ex2mpte. Coun.se.ltor: I ttuess I was push)'. I knN• )'Ou would rather ::t\'Oid the topie. At the s::m~ t ime. I could see t~t there wu so much poin in\'olved ch:tt I thou{tlu it m~t be useful to talk 2bout your (~hn~. Client: You're probably ri$:ht. I should face it, but r,n :i(r2id. \Vhen responding with immediacy, it is important to use I -statements to under• score responsibility and ownership of feelings. (n genera], the emphasis should be on statements such as "I'm uncomfortab le," not "You make me feel uncomfortable." I-statements: Clear asserti>ns abo-JI penonal feelings« reaaions that de not blame or judge others. Coun!l('Uo r: Let's stop (or:. 1no111ent. r,n feel1fl¥COn(us«I, and r,n oot sure where v.--e're he~ed. What's happenina for you! Client: We do seem to be K()lna in circles.. I'm lost too. Coun.se.U.o r: All ri~u, let's talk 2bout how \ \'e can ~-et ix.cl. on track. Relationship: Tile Foundation lor C hange 83 In Interview 3.2, the counsellor uses immediacy to address concerns that his client has become dependent. Initially. the client is reluctant to discuss this issue, but the coun.sdlor's persistence sets the stage for the client to emerge with some important feedback. Changes in the relationship can then be negotiated. Morcovc.r, the process models communication and relationship problem-solving skills that are transferable to other situations. Transference and Countertransference transferenc:e: The tfadffl(J al tlieals toa,mmunicate ■idl, t!leir couns.elkn in the sa• •.tr that theycommunicated to signific,• people in the pisl Transference is a concept that ,.,,.,..s first introduced by Freud to describe the tendency of clients to communicate with their counsellors in the same Wtt)' that they communicat~ with significant people in the past. Transference can include reactions of both attraction and aversion. \\:'hen transference is strong. clients have intense feelings and reactions that arc unconnected to experiences with their counsellors. Transference is ))l} INTERVIEW 3.2 counsellor: Oo you remembet that when we fil'SI met, we agreed that from time to time we'd stop to evaluate hOw thi~ ate going? If it's okay with you, I'd like to talk abOut out rel3tionshi~O'N we're communic.ating, as well as what's wOr'kiog ar\CI what's not wOl'kiog. Client: I lhink it's been great. You always seem to know what to say. I don't know if I COlJCI cope if it we-ren't lot you. counsellor: ThankS. To be hOOeSt, I have mix.ed reactions to what you're saying. It's nice to be appreciated, but I'm alSO concetned. I wondet if by telyin.gon me so mud'l, il's bee:Omi~ harder fOI' you to do it on )'OU' own. Client: I can'I do it on my own. Counsellor: Okay, so you need help. 8Qt~ a~e to seek and accept help is a sign of strength. My concern is that I may be dcin.g things fOr' you that you need to do yourself. Client: Now you sound like my father. He's always saying that I ShOlJd stand on my own two feet more and not rely on him so much, but every rime I try to be independent. he intederes. Analysis: The counse/10t signal$ an interest In l()()l(ing at the relationship and P,OY!des a link to earlier relationship contracting. so the ,:,,ocess should not come as a surprise to the client. Ana/y1/s: Many clients are uncomfortable with immediacy discussions, perhaps because of past failures. The client's praise of the counsellor may be justified, or it may be an attempt to avoid any controve,sfal topics. Analysis: The counsel/Or self-discloses feelings and concerns. This alSo models fo, the clfent. Ana/y1/s: Without attempting to argue with the client, the counse/10t gently perSfsts In encouraging the client to look at the issue.. Analysis: The client ;s able to k:Jentffy an important parallel to her relationship with her father (transference). counsellor: Does that happen between you ar\CI me? Client: <Hesitates.> A rime. counsellor: Can you efatx)rate? Client: Don'I get me wro~. I really want you( help, but sometimes it seems like you've already decided what I Shouts do. I figufe that you probably kOOw what's best, so I just go atong 'Mth )'OIX ~n. counsellor: 11 sounds as though you have mixed feelings. On lhe one hand, you value my help. but on the olhet I alSO sense some retuctanice, maybe a bit of a~r at me. I wonder if part of you knows it isn'I good fOI' you if you don'I have 100 freedom to make youf oNn deeisions. Client: That's right 84 Chap1er 3 Analysis: The counsellor uses a simple probe to make su,e that he understands. Analy:sls: An empathic response recognizes the client's ambivalence Of mixed feelfngs. INTERVIEW 3 .2 ~JI) Immediacy {cMtinue) Counsellor: can you think of a recent example? I want to Analysis: Asking for an e.KAmp/e ensu,es that bOlh the coun- make sure I undel'$tancl. sellOt and client have the same understanding. As well, the enmple adds necessary detail and clarity to the Issue. Client: Earlier tOday when I mentioned lhat I wanted to go back to schOOI, you were really supJX)ftive, and I appreciated that, bul it seemed like you were buldozing me to take art. I like to paint, but it's a hObby. not somett'li"lg I want to purs:ue as a career-. Counsellor: That's a g()()j point Thar\kS f0t the feedback. Let's talk abOut hO'N we can change ouf relationship to avoid similar ptOblems in the future. fOr' my part, l'U try to be m::>fe sensitive to interfering. What abOut you? Analysis: The Immediacy d/scU$slon deepens the relationship and enables the counse.llor and the client to negotiate necessary changes. Client: I guess I should be mofe assertive. Counsellor: Meaning? Client: If I think you're pushi~. I wtl you tel you. Counsellor: And. when I sound like youdather . . . Client Watch ou~ (Both laUf/fl.) ReHectJons: ■ What might be the outcome if this conversation never happens? ■ Suppose the client insists that ..all is well." Suggest options for the counsello,. ■ The success tip below sugge:sts that relationship patters and p,oblems for bOth clients and counsell0rs tend to be duplicated in their relationship with each other. Expl0re how this might be hue in this relationship. liket,., present when the.re arc strong feelings of liking or disliking another person based on first impressions (Young, 1998). For example, a client might relate to the authority of a counsellor with the same withdrawal and inner anger that charactcri.!ed an earlier rcJationship with parents. In addition, as Egan and Schroeder (2009) note, "Some of the difficulties clients hnvc in their da)'•to-dtt)' relationships are reOected in their relationships to helpers. For instance, when they are compliant with authority figures in the.ir everyday lives, they may be compliant with their heJpcrs. Or they may move to the opposite pole and become aggressive and angry" (pp. 20 5- 106). SUCCESS TIP Relationship pattems and problems that clients have .-i theil' everyday lives tend to be duplicated in thei( relationships Vitth counsetlOr'S. Similarfy, counselbs may bring relationship patterns and ptOblems frotn their everyday lives to lhe counselling relationship. Examples of transforence: ■ Kevin despe.rately w-ants to be liked. He gives his counscllor unsolicited praise and gifts. Increasingly, he begins to act and talk in the same,.,,.,.,,., as his counsellor. ■ Claire suffered ab use from her father and both of her brothers. In the first session with a male counseJlor, she immediately begins to cry, despite the fact that she felt optimistic and self<onfidcnt before she entered his office. ■ Amar has n strong need for npproval. He withholds information that he thinks might provoke the counsellor's disagreement. Relationshi p: Tile Foundation lor C hange 85 countertran.sferenc:e: -ne positive • •ptiw •fahes. f•tasies, and feelings that acounsfflor •onsciom.ly dEts or transfen to adent. steaail:g frca tis or lier tni.nsoh,ed cooflicu"' (Cl~. 2011,p. 42). ))t) BRAIN ■ Jamie, a sb:•'>'C3r.-old who has been abused, behaves in a sexually provocative way. ■ Toby, age 18, has had a very strained relationship with his father. His coon• sellor notes how easily he becomes angry during the interview at the slightest provocation. With transference, unresolved is.sues result in distortions in the way that others are perce.ived. Consequemi)•, the successful examination and resolution of counsellordiem relationship difficulties heJps clients develop communiation and problem resolu• tion skills that will be useful to them in their daily lives. Jt is important that counsellors distinguish client reactions and feelings that arise in the currem relationship from those that arise from transference. Counsellors should not be too quick to rationali:e clients' feelings and behaviours as transference. Their clients' responses may be valid reactions to what has transpired in the counselling session. Transference happens to some degree in aJI relationships. but it is much more likely to occur in relationships in which authority is present. Of signifiance is the fact that to some extent all counselling reJationships involve J)O\\'er and authority. Counsellors such as probation and parole officers ma'>' have formal roles of authority. Counsellors may also have power because clients perceive them as having su~rior or expert knO\\•l.edge. Some counsellor~ such as those in weJfare setting~ have control over services and benefits that diems are seeking. Clients also may react to other variables, such as a,;e, socioeconomic status, position, gender, marital smrus., appearance, size, intelligence. and social deme3nour. Countcruansfcrencc is defined b\• Gladding (201 I) as "the positive or negative wishes. fomasie~ and feelings that a counsellor unconsciousJy directs or transfers to a client, stemming from his or her O\\'ll unresolved conflicts" (p. 42). The risks of coun.tertnmsforc.nce underscore the importance of counsellor self.awareness and the respon,. sibilit)• of supervisors to pro\tide opportunities for them to " monitor the tendency to be too helpful, and to deal with feeJings of sexual attraction as well as anger, fear, and insecurity" (Young, 1998, p. 169). Countertransfercnce is.sues are emotional reactions to diems whereby counsellors come to see clients as project~ sexuaJ objects., friends., or even extensions of themselves (Young., 1998). Below are some signs for counseJlors that countertransference is happen,. ing or that a risk for countercransference is present: ■ h3:Ving intense feelings (e.g., irritation, an,;er, boredom, and sexuaJ attraction) for clients '>'OU hardly know ■ feeling attraction or repulsion ■ being reluctant to confront or rending to avoid sensitive issues or feelings BYTE Neural networks, f0<med by loaming and experience, afe ac1ivated by explicit Or' implicit memory. Explicit mem0<y activates the frontal COftex. and the hippocampus to fecal ex.petiences, in.formation, Or' ideas. Implicit memocy ir'WOl\'es diffefenl parts of the brain, the basal ganglia, and the cer. ebellum. It encompasses m::>tof memo,y skills suctl as how to drive a car. as well as associative mecno,y, W'hid'I includes defences. emotions, and behaviours lhat emerge from trig• gers 01 associations. F'0c example, hearing a particular~ may evoke sadness that i:S connected to a past unpleasant 86 Chap1er 3 experien:e. This conoeclion ot association is nor available to conscious awafeness. (Gabbatd, 2006). Transferen:e occurs in counsem~ when implicit memories stimulate emotiooal and behavioural responses associated with other felatioo• ships such as wilh one's father. A clien.t who feared the harsh discipline of his father and kept his feelings to himself may do lhe same tt'ling with his counseltof, unawate that there are aspects of his counsel.lOt's appeatance Of behaviour that temind him of his father and have set off the same guatded response. Adults who wefe abused 0r ooglected as children may develop bl'al'ls It.at are JXX)rty eciuipped to fOl'm healthy feta• tionships.. TM amygdala, a part ot the brain that is fesponsible fOr' pfOCessing fear, can be damaged btf abuse. A person may entet adulthOOd with ex.eessive feaf of raking risks, a necessary part of reaming and k'lfunacy. In tess lhan one-half a second and outside ot consdous awareness. a damaged amygdala may triggef feaf and 100 ..flight 0c figru· fesponse befOr'e the mofe tational pre-frontal cortex can ascertal'I that a felationship is potentially safe. 1n lhis way, the amygdala erects bar(aers and gener'ates negative emotions that ptevent the formal.ion of meani~ul and intimate relationships. (Cozolino, 2010; CozOlioo & Santos, 2014). Abused children may feel unworthy of love and Mremain in dySfuncrional patterns of behaviof, hOtd on to failed str'ategSes, and temain in destructive felarionships• (Co2olino & Santos, 2014, p.163). A unk:lue opportunity to altef these patterns i:S possible if a strong and Irusting counsem~ relatiooslip can be negotiated using a ttauma-based approad'I. Cozolino and Santos (2014) discuss the ne-1.Xoscience: "A positive emotional connection sthn ulates fewardi~ metabOlic pfoc:esses that aclivate neuroptasticily, and secure relationships pfotect against sttess. wtlid'I inhibits pfotein synthesis and othet biotogjcal processes necessary fOr' brain gfoNth.· This is furthef evidence of the centrality ot the eounsetling telations.hip as a Pf81'8'Cluisite fOr' client groNth and d'lange. ■ continually running ove.rtime with certain clients and wishing that others would not show up for scheduled appointments ■ adopting rescuing behaviour, such as wanting to lend money, adopt abu~ children, or protect clients ■ thinking about client similarities to other p«>ple - -' - ' CONVERSATION 3.3 STUDENT: I think thal many counselt)rs mi:sund81'Sland selfdiSCIOSufe. Some of my COiieagues make a point of telli~ theif clients about thes' past whereas others Share little Or' nothing abOUt their private LiveS. TEACHt:R: CounseUOr' self~isclOs.ufe can be an impoftant para of effective counselling.. The problem is knowing W'hal to Share, hON muctl to Share, and when to Shafe 1t. STUDENT: I agree. I lhink some disclOSum conveys that the counsellor is warm and human, and 1t helps clients OYet'COO".e the common mistaken belief that they are the onl'j ones with problems. TEACHER: Self~iSC:l::>Su(e modets apptOptiate sharing of loolings and gives clients the courage to open uJ). Some clients may feel reassufed knowing that theit counsellOts have faced similar problems. but unless it's haOOled carefulty, clients may see their counsellors as~. STUDENT: Back to your earlier statement Whal do you share? HON muctl? When? TEACHER: The a~rs vary depencfi~ on the client and the situation. 1.n gener'al, a moder'ate level of setf-disclOSufe is appropriate (Sheafo, & Horejsi, Howellel, some sUua1.bns maywa«anI a great deal ot self-disctosure and some oone at au. Oependi~ on the siluatklo, too muct'I self-diSd::ISl.l'e may be as bad as too little. =>. STUDENT: As I see ii. the most impoc&anl principle is that self~iSC:IOSure shouk:I be an oprion, not a compulsion. CounsellOrs ooed to be able to self-disclose, but they al!.O should be able to consttain lhemsetves from always disclOSing. If the session is m::,ving smoothly withOut self-disclOSufe, then it's ptObably unnecessary. Self~isdosure must stfengthen the relationship or other'Wise contribute to lhe v.()rk. The primary goal is to meet 100 client's needS. TtACHER: Thal's ~ht fot me, the most important principle is to avoid letting counsellOC' setf-disdosure Shift the focus of the intel'View from clients to eounsenors. That leads to role reversal, with clients counseui~ counselOrs. As I sai:1 eartief, too much setf-diSdOSure leads clients to see counsellors as incapable and lose confidence in the ptocess and the capacity of their counsellors to help. The counselling relationship is not mutual, with each person taki~ rums Shari~ a problem. What's often forgotten is the fad that setf-disct>sum inwlves IT'IO(e than sharklg details of )'OU' past Or' youf per-sonal problems. Sharing your feelings wilh clients abOul the r'elationslip or the "-«k i:S al!.O self-diSC:IOSu'e and a key eternent of the skill of immediacy. Rogers (1961 and 19Sl), a centr'al figure in counselling and too found81' of client~ntred <~ntred) ther'apy, em,:tlasized the lf11portanice of bei~ tr'ansparenl and real in the felationShip by Sharing m::,ment-to-momenI feelings that am relevant to the relationship. Aftef all. if we can't be open abOut OUf fee6~. hON can we expect dients to be? Relationship: Tile Foundation lor C hange s·7 TABLE 3.2 Guidelines for Counsellor Self-Disclosure Self-disclOSure should 001 Shift the focus from client to counsetlo,. Self-disclOSure should be used only to meet the needs of the d ients. Counsetlors need to be able to self~ isclOSe as wel as able to 001self-disclose. Too much can be as rnapp(Ol)(aate as too Htle. RevealW'lg current feelings, concerns, and ideas is usually more useflA than revealing past ~ IO<y. If the work is prcxooeliog smooltlly without it. then it probabl'f is not necessary. ■ dealing with clients who have problems or personal histories similar to your own ■ employing unncccsS3ry o r excessive self-disclosure (see Table 3.2) ■ fccling rductant to end the cou nselling relationship ENDING THE COUNSELLING RELATIONSHIP Counselling relationships wry in length from a single interview o r a short e ncounter to many years. Some are super ficial, with minimal e motional investment by the participants, wh ile others result in conside.rablc intimacy and emotional involvement. Counsellors need to make intelligent decisions about when to terminate the reJation.ship. Term ination of counselling relationships may happen fo r a number of reasons: I . T he reJationship may be ended when the ,;oats of co u nscJling have bee n rcnc.hcd . Counselling relationships arc time-limited, so when clients have developed a sufficient ai.pacity to work on their own, it is time to end the relationship. 2 . Counsello rs may end the relationship if they do not have the tim e o r competence to fulfill their clients' n eeds. In su c.h cases, the ending will include refc.rraJ to other co u nscJlors o r agencies. 3 . Counsellors ma y d etermine that they are u nable to work with sufficient objectivity. Herc again, refc.rraJ is the preferred a1ternativc. 4 . Siruationa.J factors such as illness, mo\ting, o r the end o f a practicu m may necessitate ter m ination o r refer ral 5 . If evidence shows that cou nselling has not worked and that the re is lin le potential fo r success, it is tim e to term inate o r refe r. SUCCESS TIP Clients may decide to opt out of future service and fal to show up for scheduled appointments. However, lhis does oot necessarily mean that the work has been unsuccessflA because "as many as twi>thU"dS of dropouts reJX1r1 considerable progress• (Fortune, 2002, p. 459). T he Canadian Cou nscJling and Psychotherapy Association's Code of Erhic.s (2007) offers this guidance on term ination: CounsellorS tertnin:lte «Junsellina rElauonships. with dien1 ~ree.me:n1 whenc,'er po,$$ible. wtlt:I, it is reasonably dc.l.r th::n: the '--oc3ls o( rounsellirl{t h::t\'e b..>ei, met, thedient ii no Ion, ~er benef'ht irl{t from eounselhn$:, when clienu do not P3)' fees cha~ed. when p revious!)• d1sclosed 3'~11('.)• or inst itution:11l lunits do not allow lor the provision o( fu rther eounsel, lifl¥ serviees. HOYi'e\'t:r. counsellorS make re::tSonable e«ort.s to l::.ciJ1tate the eontinu:ltion o( eounsellifl¥ sen •kes when sefVi~s are inter-rup ted b)• such (:k't<>rS as counsellor illnes:s,. client or eounsellor rek1<'::ltion. client llna.nd:d d1((ku1ties. :md so forth . (p. 818) 88 Chap1er 3 The end of a counsetli~ relationship may t(.gge-r some of 100 same feeli~ as those ex.perienced in any relations.hip breakup. The psyd'lotogjcal distress thal people feel can noN be (partialy) explaiood by funcrional magnetic tesonance unaging (fMRI) of Ille btain. Imaging shows Iha! parlS of Ille btain 1hat typically ftte when people ex~ience physical pain a~ fite when tr1ggered by cues associated with 100 ended telationship. In addition, research also found tnal the tewatd system of the brain e ~ i"I a waysi'nilar to the~ perSOns with addiciions c1'3Vedrugs(Greenbefg. 2011). This research suppocts the imJ)Orlance ot spending ritne addressing the loss associ'.ated with the encl ot the counselling relationship. Endings can evoke painful feeJings. All relationships, regardless of their length, have the potential to be intimate. The counselling rdncionship is not designed to be permanent, but owing to its intimacy the ending of the relationship may trigger powerful feelings nnd behaviours in both clients and counsellors. For some clients, intense satisfaction and feelings of accomplishment punctuate their success, but ochers may fed abandoned and dese.rced. The ending may remind chem of the pa.in and sadness of other endings. so they may need help dealing with che.ir loss and grief (Brill & Levine, 2005; Shcbib, 1997, ond Shulmon, 2009). The ending of a strong counsclling relationship brings anention to the fact that all rc1ationships are temporary. Pending termination may generate a variety of emotions and reactions including anxiety, anger, nnd denial of the ending. Counsellors need to be sensitive to signals chat clients are having trouble with endings. Some clients who have shown progress miaht regress to previous ways of coping, or they may present new and complex concerns that seem to say, "I'm not read,., for this to end." Gladding (2011) emphasizes the importance of mutual agreement to end the relationship, although for a variety of reasons this may not always be possible. Other clients might express their pa.in about the ending by expressing unfounded anger nnd resentment (in dfect, avoiding the pa.in of the ending or denying the importance of the relationship). Still others fail to show up for the final meeting as another way to avoid dealing with the pain of the ending. Young (I 998) suggests that "a helper's feeJings of loss at termination may also be due to a reliance on helping relationships to meet needs for intimacy (friendship) as well as a conscious or unconscious sexual attraction" (p. 286). The termination may also remind counsellors of other losses in their lives. When these losses remain unresolved, the.re is a risk that counsellors may be unable to handle termination with the dient. They ma't' feel guilty for leaving the dient, and they might dcla't' or avoid termination to dude their own feelings of pa.in. Counscllors who have invested heavily in the reJationship have to deal with the.ir own fedings about the ending. This may result in a variety of denial renctions: ■ Denial of the ending b)• allowing or encouraging clients to remain in counselling loni;er than necessary. The counseJling relationship is not designed to be lifelong, and the counselling contrac.t should set an end point to the relationship. As wcll, individunl interviews should be structured within n time frame. A defined time frame helps to focus and contain the worlc. Excessively long interviews without time controls can lead to fatigue, unnecessary repetition, and inattention. ■ Denial of the ending by making false or unrealistic concessions or promises (e.g., by promising to visit or correspond with clients) ■ Denial of feelings by behaving apathetic:.llly or avoiding discussion of feelings about the ending ■ Denial of feelings b)• abruptly ending without warning Relationship: Tile Foundation lor Change 89 SUCCESS TIP C(edit the client for success ln counselh.ng. If, lot exami:,e, tM client says, "You am 1he only one that listens to me,· you might say, ·"What have you been dc::ing differently lhat has tnade it easy f0t me to listen?" Dealing with Endings The ending phase can also be a time of continuing growth for clients, so it is important to involve clients in the process. As Brill and Levine (2005) suggest: In termin::uion. as in the other step!? o( the probJem.-$0,JvinK proces!l. the d1e:nt's p.,r1ki, p3tion ill o( maxilnum import:mtt. I( the helpin~ rel::uionship is at 311 si~nif"lC3.nt. the way it ends will be import21nt for the d!ll'nt's sel(,im~e and C3p.1C'Jt)' for future rel.:uion, ships,. The re:ason (or termination should be dear in the minds o( both client and work.er and. whene,~r possible. (eeli1l{tS about it ~pressed and und.e.-scood. (pp. l~l~I) doorknob commt.nieation: A pkiloffl!IIOII descli:led tdlerein tli.-s twing - ~ issues at the end al the intervie,,,hebtimsll,f) 'lltlen then is iitle or• time to addres.s lliem. The ending ph3se, when h3ndlcd effective],.•, offers rich potenti31 for work. Surprisingly, many books on counselling do not e.x3mine the thera~utic possibilities of the ending phase. With trust firmly established in the reJntionship and the urgency of the end approaching, clients ma'>' b roach signific:.m t themes and topics in the ending phase (Shulman, 2009). Shulman (2009) describes the phenomenon of doorknob communication, whereby clients bring up important issues 3t the end of the interview/ rcfotionship when the.re is linle or no time to 3ddrcss them. Clients are typicnJI,., amb ivalent about dealing with the is.sue~ but their need to address them finally overcomes their need to 3void them. Tc.rmination or transfer should not be 3brupt but 3nticipnted 3S 3n outcome during all phases of counscJling, It should be "discussed during the planning and contracting phase of the helping process and the client should be reminded from the beginning that intervention is goal oriented 3nd time limited" (Shcnfor & Horcjsi, 2008, p. 479). Generally. termination of the counselling relntionship should focus on the following: ■ review of the e>,,'tent to which worlc contract goals have been realized ■ procedures for further conroct or services from the agency, if needed ■ rderral to other services, if necessary ■ relationship closure, including discussion of feelings regarding the ending- for e.x3mplc, unresolved feelings 3nd rcgrcts~ .dong with unfinished business ■ next steps The ending might also include some culturally appropri3te ritu3l such as the offering of a sm3ll gift, but generally, there is no expectation of counsellor reciprocity. One uception might be the end of a long rcl3tionship with a youth, in which case the worker might present 3 token of remembrance. It is appropriate for counsellors to express chc.ir feelings about the termination of the relationship. This models 3ppropriatc sharing for diem~ and it stimulates them to risk sh3ring their reactions and feelings. Of course, this discussion requires counsellors to be open to strong feelings that clients ma'>' express, such as s3dncss and anger. Shulman (2009) underscores the importance of counsellors sharing their O\\•n feelings, but he acknO\\•IOOgcs that this is a difficult skill to develop. In part, this difficulty arises from the fact th3t counsellors may be struggling with their own sense of loss as they prepare to cod the relntionship with a vaJucd client. Continued sclf-e.x3mination can help counsellors develop self-awareness 3bout their own behaviours 3nd feelings regarding endings and separations. 90 Chap1er 3 lntervicw 3.3 illust:raccs how the ending process can be used to address focling:s. The client is a young adolescent about to bc-dischari;ed from a residential rreacmem centre. For the last six weeks, he and his counsellor have bttn actively planning for his rctum home. The client has been looking forward to more freedom and release from the rules and restrictions of the centre. As part of his pre-release planning, he has spent two weekends with his famil)•. ))!} INTERVIEW 3.3 In this interview, the client. i 16-ye.ar-old youth. is abOut to be released from a heatment centie endiog a six-month relationship with the cOull$ellOI. During his time at the centie. the youth has g1own vey close to his counsenor. Client: How long are we gotng to be hem? I have thi~ I need to do. CounsellOI: If I'm not mistaken. you IOOk a little glum tOday. Client: can't you tl\let let anythi~ pass? Why don't you just get off my back? Counsellor: Tomon'ON you11be leaving the centfe to feturn hOme. Maybe we could talk atx>ut that. I'm wondering hoN you feel abOut it. I \\()lJCl.n1 be sufprised if you had mix.ed feelings of betng happy to be leavi~ but atso sad to be leavi~ youf friends hefe. Client: It's no big deal. but why should you cafe? Counsellor: I feel sad k.nowing you're leaving. We've become very close, and l'I miss OU' time togethef. Client: It's been all rigt\l. I guess you'fe Okay. Counsellor: ThankS. and you·,e Okay with me too. ( Ten seco(l(}S of silence.> How do you feel abOul us not seetng each Other- anym::>m? Client: I can handle it. Analysis: The counsello,- risks empathy by picking up on n<Jnverbal cues from the client. The counse/10t suspects that the client's overt anger may be connected to the ending of the relationship and the more Important feeling Is sadness. not anger. Analysis: TM client's first reaction is to deny his painful feelings about tM ending by expressing mote anger. The counsel!Ot is careful not to get hooked. 1h(J counsel/Or o,:,ts to keep the conversation active in the feeling domain. Analysis: By sharing her own feelings. the counsel/Or communicates her willingness to deal wlth emotions. He,- disclosure undersc0t&S that the relationship had meaning. This acts as a model for the client. Of course, any feelings tM counselk:Jr shares must be genuine. Analysis: AlthOugh his anger softens. he Is still reluctant to acknowledge his feelings. The counselk:Jr persists. Counsellor: I know you can. You've featly ShOwn a rot of courage dealt~ you( pfoblems. Client: I wish it wasn't happentng. I don't k.now if I'm ,eady togo. Counsellor: It's very sca,y lhinking abOut ~~. ClleM: I want to go home, but my mother and I always seem to end up fighti~. You and I can talk and not fight. Why can't it be that way with my m01oor? Counsellor: Maybe you have more conuOI than you think. What dO )'OU dO dlffetentlywith me than with )'OIX mother? Analysis: Although tM client has trouble labelling his feelings. M begins to open up. The counse.llor uses empathy to acknowledge the feelings suggested by the client's remark. Analysis: The client risks talking about his feelings abOut going hOme. 1h(J counse/10t tries to get tM client to accept credit f0t success in the counselling relationship. She challenges him to cons/de,- how he can transfer some of his behaviour from the client--counsellOt relationship to Ms relationship wlth his motMr. Reflections: ■ What might happen if this client is not able to resolve his feelings regarding leaving the centie and the end of his close relationship with the counsellor? ■ Explore the importance of cOull$ellOt self~isclosure in this encounter. ■ What impo,ctant p,inciples regarding endings are evident in this excerpt? Relationship: Tile Foundation lor Change 91 SUMMARY ■ Developing and sustaining an effective counselling rcJntionship is widcJy accepted as critical to success in counselling. ■ Throughout aJI ph3Scs, the core conditions of counscJlor warmth, empathy, and genuineness arc csscntfal. ■ Counselling contracts arc important tools for defining roles, purpose. and for antici• paring issues that might arise during the life of the counselling relationship. ■ Over the four phases of counsclling-prclimin:.uy, beginning, 3ction, and endingthe counselling relationship needs to be developed, sustained, and then ended. Understanding the concepts of transference and countcrtransfercnce, the imcJligent use of counsellor self-disclosure, and immediacy for dealing with relationship issues is cruciaJ for maintaining the working dim:.ue of the rcfarion.ship. ■ The inC\•imblc ending of the counselling relationship may trigger J)O\\'erful fodings in both clients and counsellors. The ending phase, when handled cffoctivdy, offers rich potential for work. EXERCISES Self-Awareness 1. What were (or are) the auributes of your most positive telationship with another person? The most negative? How can you use this information to be a more effective counsetlOt? 2. Pay attention to lhe people you see and meet over the nex.t week. Who evOkes str~ emotbnal reactions? Who seems most similar to your parents or other authority figures? Now ex.amine your feelings and try to identify transference reactions-feeli~ that you carry over from prior relationships and that ace not baSed on ot:;ective teacfions to the current relationship. 3. Most of us tend to repeat established patterns when we begin new mtationsrtips. Seek feedbaek from others W'ho know you and ex.ptore Questions such as the folto'M~: • What first impressions are you likely to leave with others? • How do their perceptions compare with your intentions or k'lner feelings? Now consider the fonowiog ciuestions: • What am your typical feelings, thoughts, and behaviours as you begin teN relationships? • How ace beginnings the same 0t different f0r you when you are relating to differant inclM:lualS or groups (e.g., clients, colleagues, 0t supervisars)? • What WOt'kS tor you? 5. This exercise is desigoed to expand your self-awareness regardi~ issues that might affect your counsem~ relationShips. Complete each sentence Qlkkty, without attempti~ to edit your thoughts. The one thing I have to have from other people is . What's missing k'I my personal life is . .. Somethi~ that people dO that bathers me i:S .. The one type of person I'd hate to \\()rk wilh is . Retatiooshil)s would be better if . What I like most abOut people is .. What I dislike most aOOUI people i:S . 6. Think abOut significant relations.hips in your life that have ended beeause of separation, death, or Other reasons. How did you res,:x,nd emotionally and behaWOU'all'j 10 lheSe endi~? In retrospect, are them thrlgs you wish you had said or 001 said? What ramains unresol\ied in 1hese relations.hips? (Suggestion: If thi:S ex.erdse evokes strong emotions, you may find it useful to debrief 'Mth a friend 0t colleague.> 7. In your answer to the pmvious Question, vd'lat behatJioural patterns am eviden1? What a,e lhe imi:lications of you, insights for your WOrk as a counsenor? 8. Rate the extent to which you think it would be apprOl)riate for you to disctose the infofmatioo listed belOw. Use the fallowing scale: S = a~N3yS appropriate • What ooesn't? 4. b.amine your own needs with respect to keeping the counsem~ relationship warm and pleaSanL How far would you go to ensure this as an outcome? Under what conditions migt\t you ooecl to sac,iflce pteasantoess? 92 Chap1er 3 4 = usually appropriate 3 = sometimes appropriate 2 = usually n01 appropriate 1 = never approp(aate Be ptepar'ed to defend your answet'S with examples. ___ Details of you( education and training _ _ Your phlosophy of counselli~ ___ Information abOut youf age. marital status, and number of childmn Your sexual orientation ___ ParUcutars abOut your life. such as pe-fsonal ptot,ems lhat you have faced ___ Details abOut youf eve-ryday life, such as your hobbies, reading pfeferences, and vac.ation plans ___ Intimate details abOut youf personal life, such as marital problems and recovery from addictions ___ F'eelings soch as anger, bOredom, confusion, or sexual attraction lhat afe influencing the interview To what ex.tent wefe your answers influenced by your comforl level with each of the categories? 9 . Evaluate your general comfort with self~isdos.ure and intimacy. What areas ot your life are you feluctant or uowilti~ to talk aoout? To what extent wouk1 your friends and colleagues describe you as open or clOsed? O::> you tend to be guarded aoout sharing in.formation, Or' do you generally disct>se a great deal to Others? How does your comf0r1 with disclosufe vary depending on wtlom you are talking with (e.g., family, friencts, authority figures., clients, COiieagues, and strangers)? What afe the imp6c:ations of your answers for your work as a counsenor? 10. Imagine you afe a client with liffle knowtedge of counselling going for youf first intel'View. Assume you are seeld~ help managing deptession. What are some of the thi~ you wouk1 want to know abOut the counselling pfocess and your pending relationship with the counseltor1 Skill Practice 1. Interview friends and coueagues on the to,:iics of warm1h, empathy, and genuineness. Ask them to describe how they kOON vd'len someone exhitits lheSe iMer qualities. 2 . Talk to people wtlO are hapP'f in lheif wol'k. Ask them to describe hoN lhey sustain lheil' energy and enthusiasm. 3. Otcoostrate an immediacy enicounter-. Conttaet with a colleague to spend one hOUf evatuati'lg and stre~ni~ your relationship. use the fOllo-Ni~ ope-n-encled statements to devetop lhemes f0( youf discussion, but be sure to explore your ideas and resJX)nses: Periodic.ally, Share hO'N you are feeling using a statement such as MRight no-N I'm feeling . . .• You are free to add other- significant lhemes in your retationShip that afe n01 sugg,asted in lhe at:x>ve list. When you are finished, discuss what d'langes you would like to make in youf relationship. 4. On the baSis of your Obsel'Vations and insights from lhe pfevious question, begJ'I the process of develo,:iing a range of different Skills and s1tategjes for beginni~ relationships.. This will help you avoid beeomi~ locked into estabis.hed patterns. Oeflne pet'SOOal goals fof development in relation to hOw you handle begk'lnings. As par1 of thi.s, detail three diffefent begj.nning styles you wish to add to your Skill rep. eftoi,e. Desctibe when and how you will experiment with these three appfoaches.. What prOble-ms do you anticipate migr\t interfere Vdth actlkNement of lhese goats? 5. Simulate a retatbnship contracti~ session with a coueague in the role of client. Choose youf own issue and setting, 6. Imagine you are interviewing a cl~t who believes Mcounselling is a waste of time.· Suggest several approaches. Concepts 1. Under what conditions do you thrlk it WOlJd be wise for a counsellor to avoid self~i:sctosure? 2. Evaluate the JX)tential appro,:iriateness of eactl of the lolbwing counsenor self+di:Sctosufes (the counseltof is speaking to a client): a. Youf situation fetniOds me of my own ptoblems. Maybe we can poo OU( energies and find a SOiution that WOr'kS fof bOth of US. b. I'm SOtry to say that it's none ot youf business whethef I have children. c. When my huSband abuSed me fOr' lhe firSt time, I knew the marriage was ovef and I left. d. (In an addict/Otis t,eatment ce.nt,e, meeting a client lo, the fi,st time) Hi, I'm JOhn, and I'm a recovering alcOhOlic. so I kt'IOw what you're going thl'ough. e. I'm feeling confUSed. 1think we need to stop fOr' a minute and decide where we'fe gci~. f. YOU' i:toblems are realty getti'lg to me. They remin:S me so much d my own struggles. They brklg back all my pain. a:. You have the most beautiful eyes. b. I like what you're weari~ tOOay. It's really sexy. I. Genierally, I like to lty to eslablish open communication in my fetations.hips, so I push myself to be open with my feelings even when it's difficult. The thi~ I value mosa in this relationship is . . The ooo thing that is mi:Ssi~ in our relationship is . When I fr'SI met you, my feaction was . J. You are most like . k. This has been a bad day lor me. The(e have been $0.IT'le cutback.Sat the agency, and I'm "«ried abOut losi~ my jOb, so if I seem a little ptOOCCupied today I hope you11 undel'Sland. I. What a weekend! We partied all night. I could hafdly make it to work tOday. When I lhink aoout sharing foof~ with you . . F'or us to oocome dOSef, 1WOUid have to . What I want most from you is . When I lhink of the future of OU' relationship. I . Your attitude really makeS me want to juSI give up on you. Rel ationship: The Foundation lor Change 93 3. Oescr'ibe hOw counseltor setf~isclosure might be appropriate in response to each of the fOllowk'lg client statements Or' questions. Suggest a response. a. Have you ever felt so angry that you wanted to kill someone-? b. My mother n.evet gives me the support I need. c. I began using drugs when I was 11. d. Are you gay? e. I'm te«ified abOut gci~ back to SChOOI. I don't think I can handle it It's been so many years since- I wrOle an essay Or' read a bOOk. 4. What are the is.sues (pros and cons) involved in counselli~ friends? 5. What themes trigr\t emerge as important and unique when devetoptng counselling relationships in different fields of practice Or' settings, such as woddng 'lfith seniors, group hOrnes fo, youth, fostet hOmes, addictions settings, immiwant clients, COr'rectional facifrties, rtXal settings, hOspitals and hospice settings, work in the LGBTQ (lesbian, gay, bisexual, transgender, ciue-stiooing) community? 6. Explore how a counseltof's age might be a factor wtlen working 'Mth youth, such as counse-llot'S wM are-vety you~ and those whO are much older. t My teenage son is d(rving me crazy. r.. 1think lhis counseli~ session is a waste of time. h. I realy Wke you. I. 1dOO't think anyone hasevet been as depressed as I am. WEBLINKS An overview of the basics of Person-Centered Therapy .. The Foundation of Pe-son-Centered Therap(' by Jerold O. Bozarth This site contains an article explo,ing juvenile offenders' perception of the counseHing relationship www.pet"soncentered.com/theraplst.html www.jtpcrim.org/August_2011/Juvenile-OffendersPercepbons-Joh n-Ryals.pdf This site contains links to major personality theo,ists, including Carl Roge-s www.Sh1p.edu/-cgboeree/pe,se:ontents.html This Counselling Today article examines technology and the c-aunselling relationship http:J/ctcounseling.org/2011/10/finding-technolOgys.. role-in-the-counseling-relationShip 94 Chap1er 3 This site contains YouTube video links where clients discuss their experiences with counselling www.youtube.com/ - ~ rch for Experiences of Counselling Part 2: Developing the Counselhng Relationship iQ:)noep1'ShuttetS':ock ■ Define the components of listening for understanding. ■ Identify and describe strategics for overcoming listening barriers. ■ Ex-plain the importance of active listening. ■ Describe nonverbaJ communication. ■ List and explain the multiple meanings of silence in counseJling. ■ Define and demonstrate paraphrasing skills. ■ Define and demonstrate summari: ing skills. LISTENING FOR UNDERSTANDING When yoH ralk, you are only repenting what )'OH already know, bur if you listen you ma)' learn something new (Dafai Ulma) Proficient counsellors are dynamic and responsive listeners. They arc persistent and curious Je3rners committed to understanding. They strive to hear, not just the words of the.ir clients, but also the nonvcrbaJ channel of inform3tion where variables such as voice tone, posture, and gestures act to support, repe3t, enhance, or contradict vcrbaJ mesS3ges. 95 Effective listening, not only includes silence, but also involves the components of hearing, observing, interpreting, 3nd responding through 3 complex process that requires sensory, mental, and bch3vioural competence. As a mcntaJ proces~ listening involves separating rdcwnc information from irrelevant information, 3ssigning meaning to words 3nd experiences, and remembering and linking related data. High~levd listening regards emotional unde.rst3nding 3S 3 prerequisite for fully comprehending the words and content of wh3t the speaker has said. Put simply, listening is making sense of what h3s been heard from the perspcctive of the other person. Counsellors ma'>' use questions to obtain cl3rification, definition~ and ex3mples. They use silence to reflect and communic3te respect for the risks that clients have taken to share the.ir stories. Summarizing, paraphrasing, 3nd cmP3thy 3re, in pan, listening c.heclcs to ensure the 3ccuracy of the.ir observations 3nd conclusions. Effcctive listening as a counscllor requires man3gement of or diseng3gemem from b3rricrs such as personal problems. boredom, lack of interest, or competing dem3nds to folly focus-both psrchologic.ally 3nd physicallr~n the mess3gc. Counsellors need to be self.aware 3nd constand'>' on the aJert to ensure that their own perspective docs not detract from or contaminate their capacity to understand the words and fttlings of the.ir clients. The listening process is oudined in Figure 4 .1. Since the challenge to effectively listen is demanding and potentially cxh3usting, it is not surprising th3t failure to listen dfcctivdy is a primary reason for relationship breakdO\\•n. The Power of Listeni ng Listening is a cornerstone of counselling 3nd is essential to understanding and reJation.ship development. Often clients come to counsclling with considerable experience of not be.ing he-3rd. They may have turned to family and friends for help but found that their concerns were discounted or were met with simplistic 3dvice by people who we.re so 3ru:ious to heJp that they failed to listen with attention. In contrast, effective counseJlors 3nd interviewers h3VC' a cultivated ability to listen. As a fundament3l building block for the counsclling relationship, listening com.munic.aces to clients chat their ideas and fodings 3re important. Our natural inclination is to interpret meaning to words 3nd behaviour based on our own experiences. This c3n easily lead to assumptions that 3re very different from those intended or experienced by others. Listening educ3tes counsellors 3bout the uniqueness of their clients, thu~ minimizing 3ny tendency to make erroneous assumptions. Moreover, listening encour• ai;cs clients to tell their stories and disc.lose che.ir feelings. In the proces~ they m3y gain enormous therapeutic value from rdc-3sing pent-up emotions. Also, when counsellors listen to clients, clients become better 3ble to listen to themsclves. In genera], S)'Stem3tic Hearir,g and Rememberir,g Verbal and Nomabal M._.. Selecting and Somog lnfarmation, Ideas. and Feelings Figure 4.1 The listening Process 96 Chap1er 4 Understanding Meaning and Emotions listc:ning, punctuated with appropriate probes, clarifiai.tion rc:sponscs, and summaric:~ helps clic:nts ori;:ani!c: confusing and contradictory thoughts. Listening is an act of accc:pt:mcc: and caring that says, "Your feelings arc: precious and unique:. 1 ,von't insult you by assuming that I kno"' "'hat you're going to sa)' before: you S3Y it. I w-on't judge or ridicule whnt you say. I ,von't try to change you to fit my idc:a of "'hat )'OU should be." Listening is an active attempt to undc:rstand our clic:nts' perceptions and fc:ding~ "'hid,. may be different from our own. Ironically, "'hilc: listening rc:quires counsellors to be silc:nt, rc:maining silc:nt doc:s not necc:ssarily mean that one is listc:ning. A silem person may hear the words and c:ven be able: to rc:peat vc:rbatim what has bc:en said, but a tape rccordc:r or a dc:ver parrot can do the: same thing. Good listening is an active procc:s.s that requires hearing the: contc:nt. c:motional tone, and context of "'hat is bc.ing said while controlling listening obstacles and using skills such as summari.!ing, paraphrasing, and empathy to confirm understanding. 'W ithout attention and self-control, learning obscadc:s can contaminate: mc:ssagc:s with unintended distortion, selective attention, and inte.rprctation. Thu~ good bstc:ning requirc:s that we: opc:n ourscJves up to learning. Listening is not a passive act---cffc:ctive listenc:rs arc busy "'ith the task of trying to comprehend what is happc:ning for their diems. Somctimc:s counscJlors arc patiently quiet as they respectfully yicJd the right to spc:ak to their clients. At othc:r times, they are vocal, with questions and directives for more derail, example~ or darification. At all time:~ they should ai.rcfully observe and try to understand nonverba.1 bdi.aviour. Active: listening, a collection of skills discussed in this and subsequent chapters, is the way that counsellors sho"' their dients that they are listening. This is possible because they are, in fact, mc:ntaJly and ph)•sically committed to the msk of listening. \\:lith so much at stake and so much to do, listening is hnrd work. 1t requires counsellors to focus all their intc:llcctual and physical anc:ntion on clients so that clic:nts hnve the counsc:llors' un"'avering commitment. Listening is the diem's re,.\--ard for talking. SUCCESS TIP To be heafd and deei;:iy underStOOCI by anothe-r pel'SOO rS a rare-and profoundly e-mpo.-.eri'lg ex.pe-tie-oce-. Consequently, an lhe he-Ip that some- clients need is the opportundy to shafethe-if problems Viith a patient, non;udgmental listene-t who ooesn-'t butden them with advice-. LISTENING BARRIERS Communiai.tion is a process involving a sender and a r«eiver (for two-person communi,cation). In its purest form, the communication loop begins "'hen one-person frames and sends a mes.sage using verbaJ or nonverbal channds (frequently both); the receiver must hear and intc:rpret the: message, then pro,•ide fc:c:d bac.k that confirms undc:rstanding. ))l) BRAINBYTE L,t,_1 1,; Barth (2011) re-pofted on a study by Prioce-ton neufosci- e-ntist tauten Silbe-rl who demoosttated that fMRI scans of good listene-rs showed thell brain activity patalle-led that of those to whom they wete listening. In addition. the scans showed lhat key b<ain ate-as lit up befofe wofdS wefe spoken. suggesting anticipation of what was abOut to be- said. On the one haOO, this might suppotl lhe- listening pfocess aoo add to a pe-rson's capacity to be- e-mpathic. On the othet hand, inacc.urate anticipation has pitfalls and can cle-arly le-ad to misunde-r'Slanding and communication bfeakdown. To p,-e-ve-nt lhis miscommunication, counsel lorS must temain ve-ry aue-ntive to ensufe that their clie-nts· mess.ages are in sync with any mess.ages 0c feelings they anticipated. listening & Responding: The Basis t or Unders1andlng 4 97 TABLE 4.1 Common Listening Barriers seooina Mes.sace:s Receiving Mes.safH • Not havi~ the wOl"ds to ex.press feelings and ideas. Lack of i.nsigt\t o( awa,eness Contradictory vet'bal and nonverbal messages • Assumptions, bias, and judgment • E«ors inte(preti~ messages • Selective attention • Heari~ words., but 001 emotions • Em::>1.iooal reaction • failure to attend to oonve-rbal channets • Unwlling to heat content or feelings • Distract.ions sud'I as fatigue, ooreoom, and preoccupation with personal issues • Ptanni~ wtlat to say instead of listening • lnte«upring. rushi~. or finishing 100 speaket''s sentences • Resista~ Bias Un(esolved trust issues Pet'specrive (eun.u,al/wortcMew) Unwillingness to communicate (self-ceOSO(S,,ip) Information gapslincomi:,&te communicatio.n • Resislance ln counsclling, this fttdb3ck, usually in the form of summaries, paraphrases, or emP3thic responses., acts as a po\\'e.rful incentive for the client to continue. Questions(as discussed in Chapte.r 5) are nJso an important tool in communication. They provide a W'll)' to get missing information, example~ and definition. Typically, the.re are a hui;e number of b3rrie.rs to listening (see Table 4. 1). Some originate with the sender, others with the receiver. These can interfere with cffoctive communication such that high-levcJ communication is often the exception, not the rule. Closed-minded listeners respect onl)• those who agree with them. Since they nlready have the "right" answ·ers, the.re is neither need to conside.r new thoughts and ideas, nor is there any reason to seek additionaJ information. ln contrast, opcn.-minded listeners are willing to explore new ideas and arc secure enough to he3r difforcnt opinions without distortion.. Overcoming Listening Barriers Be Patient To make themselves unde.rstood, people need to be able to frame their ideas. Clients who lack the ability to express themseJve~ perhaps because they have a limited vocabulary or capacity to articulate in precise terms, use words that are vague, ambiguous, or conrradictory. Others ma)' not have sufficient awareness or insight to describe their feelings. In such circumstances., counsellors can become impatient, and this becomes an obstacle to listening. They ma,., try to hurry the process b\• finishing sentences for clients who are struggling to express themselves. Or they can become lazy and assign their own mC3nings to words and phrases. Active listening heJps to minimi.!e the risks of misinterpretation. Summaries and p3raphrascs hclp confirm understanding, and they provide a re.flective mirror for clients to hear the.ir own ideas from a different but undistorted perspective. Targeted and sys..temaric questioning encourai;es exploration and specificity, and it helps clients orgnni:e their thinking and engage in problem solving. ~I· Ai.1 '. ,., ))}) BRAIN BYTE Al,111·1 Ten times faster than a visual image or a lhought can be processed. lhe auditOty cifcuits of the bfain respond to sound. (Horowitz, 2012). Neufoscientist Seth Horowitz (2012) depicts lhis auditory circuit as an alarm system in a constant state of readiooss to respond 10 sounds that signal danger or attraction. Most sounds a,e ignored as 98 Chap1er 4 S,,'.• ·1 irrelevant, while others, like a fingin,g phone, demand our immediate attention. But Horowitz wams of lhe dangefs in a new digital wOJkl, where effeclive listening beeomes difficult as ouf brains afe being seduced by constant noise. As a safeguafd, counsellors ne&d to soundproof their sessions. Focus on Trust Client messages can be incomplete or missing inform3tion because of trust issue~ particulnrly in the beginning phase of the counselling relationship when the client ma'>' be reluctant to share. This is understandable since the counselling rela, tionship has yet to be tested. Consequently, the client may hold back information or feelings that a.re ultimate!)• vitaJ for understanding 3ocf instead present "safe'' issues to test the relationship or only hint 3t conce.rns th3t are more important. ldeaJI,.,, as counselling: progresses, clients learn th3t they can depend on their counsellors to respond with respect 3nd understanding. Unforrunaccly, in some cases, they m3y learn that the.ir counsellor cannot be trusted with feelings. Control Distractions and Stay Focused Once mcss3ges 3rc sent, they must be received and interpreted accurately- hence the importance of a counseJling environment that is free from distraction and inte.rruption. Counsellors should never discontinue an inte.rvicw to 3nswer the phone since th3t m3y brc3ch confidentiality, impede relntionship rapport, and stop the flow of information. Similarly, pager~ fax machine~ cdl phone~ and even an unanswered ringing phone c3n destroy the ambience of a meeting. Ideally, a.II such equipment should be turned off. Good listening is difficult work that requires effort to stay focused. Since we can think many times faster th3n others can talk, it's easy co allow our thoughts to wander. The trick is to keep our minds busy with listening. Active involvement in listening, through summarizing, p3raphrasing, 3nd 3slcing question~ helps counsellors stay 3Jert 3nd focused. Mental involvement helps counseJlors concentrate on and understand what's being s3id. For example, as they listen, they can ask thcmsdvc~ "\Vhat does the client mean by chat? Wh3t arc the key points in th3t explanation!" However, counsellors should avoid trying to figure out what clients are going to say next since chis will only dive.rt che.ir attention from listening. lmcrn31 noise can 3Jso interfere with listening. Counsellors might be pr«>ccupied with che.ir own needs or ideas. They could be looking fonvard to their vacation and im3gining their break. They ma'>' be unde.r pe.rsonal stress. suffering: from fatigue or thinking about other clients. A tired counscJlor might ddiberatdy neglect to explore or define important idC3s. Stop Assuming Jf counsellors believe that they a.lrc3d'>' know what others arc going to SU)' and arc not open to new information, then listening is not possible. App3rent patient 3ttention and silence could give the illusion of listening, but assumptions and preconceptions quickly become obvious to asnue clients. Typical I'>', clients are guarded 3nd defensive with people who h3VC opinions different from their own. ln the following ex3mple, a high school student h3s just told her counsellor th3t she has been offered 3 scholarship at a prestigious university. Student: h's one o( the flnest unh'i'"rsities in the 2rea. It is an honour l'O h:ave been chosen from :ill the 2pplicants. Mr fad,e-r, who never h:ld a chance to ¥0 l'O univerSity, isecstatk. Coun.se.ltor (Choke I): Wow! TI,::u is ternfle. You must be so proud o( )'Oursel(. TI,is is re:tll'>' an ouutandin¥ opportunity. Coun.se.ltor (Choke 2): How do rou (eeJ about it! The counsellor in Choice I in this example assumes feelings 3nd mc3ning. As a result, further exploration is discouraged or cut off. Choice 2 is 3 listening: response that encoura,;cs more information. It 3Jlows for the possibilit)• that the client might say, "I'm depres~ 3bout it. I've been ,;oing to school for 12 years, 3nd I really wanted to t31cc a year off." Choice 2 illustrates 3 basic principle of effective listening: Good listeners arc open to learning. listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 99 Personal Re.actions \Vhnt clients sa'>' and how they say it may arouse a counscl.lor's tension and anxiety. Emotions in the client c:m trigger emotions in the counsellor, which, if unchecked, can lessen the counsellor's capacity to listen. For example, an angry diem might stimulate fear in a counsellor, who, preoccupied with fe3r or insecu.rity, then might act defonsivcJ'>'· A depressed client might have a contagious effect and cause a counsellor to become similarly despondent. Certain words or messages might act as emotional triggers for counseJlors and lead to faulty listening and understanding. Many beginning counsellors react strongly to clients who have been abusive, and they erect listening barriers. They ,;ct so trapped in their own neo:I to condemn the abhor• rent behaviour that they have no room left to become aware of their clients' frames of reference. Consequently. they fail to establish any base for understanding and any crcd.ib ilit)' to promote chan,;c. Entering into the private w-orid of clients whose behaviour and artitudcs differ sharpl)• from one's own requires emotionaJ maturit)', skill, and, often, abundant courage. Such apacitics distinguish and define competent counseJlors. Sometimes counsellors become bored (e.g.., when dealing with clients who spC31c in a monotone or clients who arc repetitious and long-winded), even to the point of falling aslttp during the interview. To stay alert during an interview, counseJlors must arrive alert. They should get enough sleep and exercise and avoid heavy lunches that might lead to drowsiness. Short breaks to take a walk, stretch, or dear the mind are important ways of sustaining energy. When clients share difficult feelings and topic~ some counsellors handle their own discomfort by becoming inappropriardy quiet or silent, becoming excessively talkative, changing the subject, or offering premature advice or reassurance. Such responses may communicate that the counsellor does not understand or is not listening or, in the case of inappropriate silence, that the counsdlor does not care. Counsellors need to become confident in their skills and abilities so that they can tolerate clients' feelings, rcoctions, and even verbal assaults with a minimum of defensive reactions, which obscure listcn.ing and understanding. Listening Does Not Me.an Agreeing A common misconception occurs when people confuse listening with agrtting.. One new counseJlor remarked, "ff I listen to someone who abuses children, am J not condoning it?" Another person remarks, "J told him what I want. \\:rhy doesn't he listen to me!" In fact, the other pe.rson may have listened and hC3rd, but has chosen not to comply. In this example, failure to comply is interpreted as e\!idcnce that the other person isn't listening.. This is a common error in thinking.. Exemplary counsellors are vigilant when they are dC3ling with clients who test the.ir values and beliefs. They discipline themselves by taking extra precautions tom.sure they arc listening accunndy. They also try to become alert to any inte.rnal noise that might impair their capocit)' to hcnr. They know they arc vulnerable, and they take preventive measures. Self.Awareness Since everyone's frame of reference is different, we can never per• focth• understand how other people arc experiencing their world. Our understanding is aJwa)'S clouded to some e>..'tent by the mC3nings we as.sign to events and by our own thoughts and feelings. Counsellors may have unrccogni!cd or unresolved prob lems ))t) BRAIN BYTE Reseatd'I has s00-1«'1 that when people feel ovetloaOOCI, they Mat better' with theit right eat. Tris is beCauSe the rigl\t eat COO· Mets to the lefU::irain hemispf'e'e which ~ a doninant tde 100 Chap1er 4 ;,, prC>OOSSlng 1ar-euage. nti,e ywr head., allow mom SOI.Wld to the rigtlt ear miNf impt(We: listeni~ an:S mamory frOO'l 8pereent to as much as 40 percent in some individuals. (Starr, 2017) parallel to those of their clients. Fo r example, o ne counsello r experienced unusual d isco mfort whe n trying to work with a client who was dealing with a n unw-nnted prcJ;nancy. Ten years before, the co u nsellor had placed her own ch ild up for adoption, but she had never addressed the emotions she felt over the d ecision. \V henever her clie nt focused o n her o ption~ the co u nsellor's o wn feelings made it tough for her to separate he r feelings fro m those o f the client. Table 4.2 summari!cs strategies for ove.rco ming co mmon liste ning p roblems. These strategics are presented as ideas rather than as recipes for responding. E.nch intervie w situation requires indiv id unli!ed and Crc3tive responses. TABLE 4.2 Overcoming Listening Barriers Ptoblem COunsello.- Choices The dient has prObtems with language (e.g., nisleading WOrd chOice and difficulty verbalizi~ ideas). Ask questions to clarify meani~ . Pay careful attention to noovet'bal communication f0t dues to meaning, Messages are incomplete, ambiguous. ot undeat Probe fOt detail and examples. Relationship ptot,ems/b'ust issues ate resulting in client cenSOr'St.p of feelings and ideas. Sho-N empathy. Have a candid discussion abOUt the ttust Or relations.hip issues. Go at a sto.ver pace and reduce questions. Communicate openness thraugh nondeteosive Pataphtase to confllm underStandlng. Ask for definition. There is outside i'\terletence (e.g., noise and laek ol p<ivacy). There is intemal interference (e.g., COU-IOt fatigue, difficulty concentrating, bOtedom. and hearing impairment). '"'-· HOid phone calts and move interviews to a ptivate setting. Start a personal wellness plan. Improve rme management Skins. Defer the interview. Use self-discipline to increase concentration (e.g.• mentally sum.mari?e key det.a'ils). Summarize, paraphrase, and empathize. The counseltor has a IOSs of ot;ectivity when dealt~ with ideas that are contrary to his Ol her values.. Use supel'\lision ot consultation to address perSOnal issues that ctoud objectivity. There are cuttutal barriers between counsetot and client. Etllist the client's help to understand cultutal values and issues; lhen adaPI the interview style to fit. Discipline yourself to ext,IOte different ideas. Use translators ot refer 100 client to a counsetlOt of the same culture. Oew!lop cuttufe-spe,cifllC kno-ldedg,e. Content is o...el'Wtletming f0t the counsetot (e.g., wtlen the client rambles Ot is long-winded). Summarize to identify themes and priorities. Seleclivety intertuPI to contrOI the Oo-N ot the interview. The dient is inappropriatety silent. Attempa to unders1anc1 the meaning of the slence; then respond apptoptlatety. The dient has speech prot,ems (e.g.• mumtling, stuttering, and wtlisperlng). Remembet lhat problems may decrease as the counseltor becomes more familiat 'Mth the client's style. Ask the client to speak up. list ening & Res ponding: The BasfS t or Under s1and lng 101 ACTIVE LISTENING Understanding is alwa)'S tentative- hence the importance of aJlowing clients to confirm or correct our understanding. Active listening describes a duster of skills used to incrc3se the accuracy of meaning. Attending, being silent, summari!ing, paraphrasing, questioning, and empnrhi!ing are the essential skills of active listening (sec Figure 4 .2). They b renthe life into listening so rhnt it becomes a continuous process of paying attention, hearing, exploring, and d~pcning. Active listening involves hC3ring what is said as well as what is left unsaid. Counscllors need to use both their e\•cs and enrs to asce.rroin meaning. Careful anenrion to sud,. cues as word choice, voice tone, posture, and verbal hesitations is nee~ sary to discover confirming or conflicting messages in the verbal and nonverbal mcssa,;cs. Subtle changes in voice tone o r sudden shifts in the topic may signal important areas for the counsellor to explore:. In one case, a 28-'>'C3r-old woman who w·as describing her career goals happened to mention her sister. As she d id so. the counsellor noticed that she avoided eye contact and her voice dipped slightly. He asked ho"' she felt about her sister. The woman beaan cryina as she related how her sister had alwa'>'S been the favoured one in the family and how she had felt rejected by her mother. Subsequently, this relationship became a central issue during counscllina, and the client developed insiaht into how she was using her career as a desperate: attempt to gain her mother's acceptance:. Active listc:nina skills defuse c ritical incidents. The FBI, for example, has rccogni!ed active listenina skills as essential competencies for resolving crises, including hosmi;ctn.king incidents, and it has replaced using force "'ith active listc:nina as the preferred strategy (Van Hassclt et al., 2006; Royce, 2005). Research has shown that active listc:n.ing, particularly the skills of paraphrasina. empathizing, and open..ended q uestioning, helps subjects (i.e., hoscage takers) release frustration, despair. anger, and other p,m,-erful foelings, with the result that they rerurn to a more normal level of arousaJ a nd rational thinking. One reason active listening is so effective: is because it docs n()( threaten people with an overt attempt to change them. Active listenina builds rapport because it sho"'s that the listener is nonjudgmemal and is interested in understanding. Individuals in SIience Att.ndlng • Asking Quest,ons Pa,iphraslng Figure 42 102 Chap1er 4 The Skills of Active Listening crisis may erect he3vy psychologicaJ defences, but "bec3use active listening poses no threat to an individual's self-image, it can help a subject become less defensive" (Nocsner & \Vcbster, 1997, p. 16). Active listening is a powerful tool for dcvcJoping a relationship, which becomes a basis for negotiation. Anending. nonverbal communication, using silence, P3rnphrnsing. and summarizing will be explored in the following sections. Subsequent chapters will address the skills of questioning and empathy. ATTENDING Attendini is a term used to describe- the way that counsellors communicate to their clients that they are rc3d)•, willing, and able to listen. When coupled with understanding and appropriate verbnJ response~ attending promotes exploration. As a basic active listening sic ill, attending conveys physical and psychological commitment and openness to the helping intcrviN•. Anending sa\'S to clients, "l'm here for you. You have my undivided attention. I'm not afraid of your feelings and what you have to say." Certain core attending skills are univcrS3lly applicable, and counsellors can use them with confidence. First, counsellors need to ensure that their ftt.lings, attitude~ and commitment to clients are genuine. Jf a counscllor has negative feelings about a p3rticular client, then refc.rral to another counsellor may be warranted. On the other hand, if such negative ftt.lings permeate a counsellor's attitude toward many client~ then additional remedies may be necessary, such as personal counselling, assistance to deal with burnout, consultation and supervision to manage feelings, or a career chanJ;c. Sometimes a counsellor's personal rc3Ctions can be a valuable clue regarding how a particular client imP3cts other people. The key conside.rntion here is whether the counsellor's feelings are unique to him or her, or whether they arc indicative of a client's general demeanor. Second, pro\•iding a safe and private space is an incentive for clients to open up. This includes efforts by counsellors to control distracting noise and curb the.ir own imcrnnJ distractions. ScJf,<fiscipline to suspend hasty assumptions and judgments is also essential. Counsellors need to avoid rc3cting with verbal or nonve.rb3l mes.sages that express imp3tience, disagrttment, or judgment. As noted earlier in this chapter, this may be difficult when clients present ideas that are offensive or conflict with the counsellor's values and beliefs. Third, counsellors can show that they are attending b)• being on time for the interview, remembering important detail~ and following through with agreed-on plans. A ce.rmin ph)•sical and verbal presence conveys comminnent. Verbal and nonverbal behaviours such as hC3d nods and encouraging probes convey interest. Counsellors need to bring warmth to the interview, which is communicated through appropriate smiling. changes in voice tone, and expressions of caring and support. An unemployed client who rcpons with glee to his counsellor that he has found work has a riWlt to expect more than a monotone, "That's grc3t." There may be cultural and individual differences that require adapting how )'OU attend to clients. For example, some clients arc notcomformblc with sustained eye contact, and others may be suspicious of warmth and humour. This rc3lity underscores the importance of continual work to devcJop cultural understanding and competence. As alway~ it is important to remember thal individuals vary in the extent they subscribe to the values of their culture of origin. There is general agreement that the following behaviours convey appropriate attending: ■ keeping an open posture (i.e., turning towards the diem, arms and legs uncrossed) ■ maintaining eye contact listening & Responding: The Basis tor Unders1andlng attending: Atera used to descriie tile •ar that c•selkn communicate to t!leir clients tu'! they an teady. 11illing. and able to liMta. Vefba:1. ncaverbal. and attitudinal CIIES are 1M es.seaceClf effeaiw attending. 103 ■ leaning fonvard ■ using responsive facial expressions like approprhne smiling ■ encouraging comments and head nods ■ speaking in a warm and pleasant voice As with any counselling skill or procedure, attending must be applied intelligently relative to diversity and cukuraJ variables. For example, among many Middle Eastcm.ers, six to tweJvc inches is a comfortable conversational distance; but an "arm's lcngrh" is more comfortable for most \\:festerncrs (Hockney & Cormier, 2005). Counsellors should also avoid rigid adherence to one style of attending. For example, the needs of a client who is embarrassed may be best served by avcned or less.-intcnse eye contact until more trust and comfort develops. Careful attention to words, phrase~ and nonverbal communic3tion opens counsel.lors up to lc3ming. Counsellors need to hear what is said, as weJI as what is not said. They need to rcffcct on how ideas arc communicated through cone of voice, posture, and other due~ and listen careful!)• for confirming or conflicting messages. As well, they need to sift through what ma,., be complex and sometimes confusing information to identify P3ttcms, priorities, and areas of relevance. This work may involve the major senses of hearing, sight. smell, and touch. Although counselling work gene.roJly centres on hearing and sight, significant information can be gleaned from our other senses. For example, alcohol and some other drug use may be detected by smell. When counsellors are patient, they give clients space to confront painful emotions and to gather their thoughts. \\:f'hen counsellors sit still, mainmin culturally appropriate eye contact, and avoid nco:lless questions they do much to convey to the.ir clients their unwav.ering attention. These actions focus the attention of the interview completely on clients. To accomplish thi~ counsellors must develop their ability to be comfortable with silence. SUCCESS TIP The pitfaus of listen.-ig include saying too much as weu as too liltle. SIience is important, bul ultimatety k\suffdent b effective listening. Selective Attention selectiw perception (selective attention): Atera 11Sed to desuibe the natwal taidency to avoid being OYM1helllied by illcrmat• by screaaing out material t!I.M is irrtlev•. Selective perception or selec,th•c attention is a term u~ to describe the natural tendency to screen out ir-relc\lant information to avoid being overwhelmed. Of necessity, counsellors must ignore some parts of a client's communication and selectivdy attend to othe.rs. It is not possible (nor desirable) to attend to everything a client says; however, communication breakdown can easily occur if a counsellor ignores issues or feelings that arc important to a client. This underscores the importance of the contTilcting process (see Chal){er 3) as a tool for ensuring that counsellors and clients are on the S3me P3ge. What a person pays attention to is likdy to be influenced by one's frame of refer.. ence, which is uniqueJ,., defined through influences such as past experiences, personal value~ current mood, interests, concerns, fear~ prejudice~ health, culture, and context. A tow truck driver looks very different depending on whether you have a flat tire on SUCCESS TIP Oients atso selectivety attend. FOr' example, lhOSe whO a(e O\ler1y anxious are more likely to pay attention to anxiety-prO't'Oking stimuli, and those who ate suspicious WIii be more sensitive 10 cues that the eounselOt cannot be trusted. 104 Chap1er 4 TOO brain is una~ to pay attentbn to l\\() thi~ at the same time. In Or'der to divert our attentkln to a different &ask, the t:tain must Shut cbNn an:S shift its focus from tne fW'SI task (Medna, 20'.)8). Research also SOONS that shifts rn attention resul in a greater risk of m$Si.ng important cues and no1 rememberi~ what clients have said (Taylar, 2011). This realily uooerscor·es the importaoce ot counsetbrS atk!Oeling to their diants' corrwnuricatkln Viitrout beeoni~ ,:reoccupied Mh what to say next. a dark and stormy night, or you are being to\\'ed for illega] parking. The word moiher may caJI up images of love and support or memories of abuse and pain. Recognizing and Managing the Pitfalls of Selective Attention Mnnng;ng rhc pitfalls begins with self-awareness about how our point of \tiew and life experiences influence our perceptions and interpretations. Counsellors need to re.fleet on their O\\'n listening habits to identify areas of vulnerability. Counsellors need to be alert to the dangers of selective perception in their own thinking and responses. They must be vigilant to make sure they understand how and when prior learning, va.Jucs, and current expectations influence where they focus. They need to be careful that they don't impose their own sense of what's important, which can easily lead to loss of objectivity as well as missed information and opportunities. Viewing scssional recordings and seeking feedback from informed observers is an important part of this process. Herc are some typicaJ counsellor seJective perception errors to consider: t. Egpcemricity. Hearing only messages that support established opinions and beliefs. \Ve need to remember that whal \\'e know is subject to change. 2. Role bias. Counsellors will pa)' more attention to cues that arc consistent with the.ir professional focus, training, and responsibility. An employment counsellor will be interested in career and vocationaJ data, whereas a marriage counsellor will be more alen to information on familial communication. This is necessary and appropriate; however, attending to one issue runs the risk that other important areas for inquiry are overlooked. For example, an employment counsellor who docs not recognize the S)•mptoms of a mental disorder or substance abuse will have limited effectiveness when dealing with clients who have these issues. 3. Disengaging. \\:'hen this happens, counsellors have simply stopped listening and their anention is focused elsewhere. This may occur for a variety of rc3sons, including boredom, disinterest, fatigue, or preoccupation with their own issues. As well, counsellors might deliberately discni;pge when they arc uncomfortable with the topic. 4. Preoccuparicm tdrh problems. When counsellors arc too fixated on problems, they miss the opportunity that comes from a strengrhs appro3c.h. Rec:ogniiing client strengths heJps to buikl confidence and self-esteem, and it mobili:es resources for problem solving. It is also important to pay aucntion to the counseJling relationship. Over the life of the counsellor-c.licnt relationship, various priorities will emerge related to beginnings, conrracting, problem solving, and endings. The vitality of the relationship is a strong predictor of a successful outcome in counselling, so this important wriable should never be ignored. 5. NOl. auending ro rhe emotional domain. By focusing on behaviour, counsellors ignore the emotions of their clients, which are often more important to problem resolution than finding behavioural solutions. Emotions can sustain problems, interfere with decision making, and crente stress that pre-vents problem solving. When clients express emotions, active listening, particularly empathy, is crucial For example, listening & Responding: The BasfS tor Unders1andlng 105 Miller, Forcehimcs, and Zwcben (2011) reported that "one of the strongest prcdic~ tors of a counseJlor's effectiveness in treating substance use disorders is cmpa,. thy" (p. 49). CounseJlors should also monitor and deal with the emotions that they bring to an inte.rvicw or that arise during an interview. 6. Nor co,uidering the nom't"'rbal channel. Listening to words without considering non.verbal communication ma'>' result in counsellors he~uing only a small pa.rt of what their clients arc communicating. 7. Snap judgmenu. Good listeners are curious, patient, and cautious in the pursuit of understanding. Medina (2008), a molec:ula.r biologist, n()(CS., "\Vhat we pay attcn~ tion to is often profoundly influenced by memory. ln eve.ryday life, we use pre..,i~ ous experience to predict whether we should pay attention" (p. 75). This suggests a major pitfall that has profound implications for counsellors. \Vhen our clients share stories., their stories may stir our own mcmorie~ and we may begin to "fill in the blanks" based on our experience. This shoncut to understanding can result in erroneous assumptions and mis~ information. \Vhile past cxpc.riencc with the same issues as our clients may give us an empathic advantage, this is only true if we remain viailant to ensure that we do not contaminate our clients stories with those of our own. Perhaps we are safer when clients present unfamiliar issues and problems because our lack of lcnowledi;c makes it easier to explore for understanding. 8. Muhira.sking. Neuroscience has demonstrated that the human mind is incapable of multirasking with respect to paying attention (Medina, 2008). Here's the most common problem in counselling: While clients arc talking. counsellors are thinking ahead, planning what to say. ln order to think ahead, their minds must disen,;pg,e from listening. Active listening skills can hdp counsellors maintain focus on what their clients arc communicating. SUCCESS TIP Too much time ex.plOring content comes at the expense of ptOblem solving and feeling management. Whtie some detail is necessa,y for uooerstandi.ng. excessive attention to all the de&aits rS neithet neoossa,y not ptOductive. NOr' rS it generally usehA to d1ted the wock of counselling to ftnd the ·(oor causes ot prObrems. Remember that listening is hard work, and you nttd to be physically and psycho.logically ready for the interview. One essential component of this readiness is to address )'Our psychological nco:ls by dealing with your own is.sues that might make it difficult to hear clients. If you have unresolved difficultic~ cspcciaJly if they mirror those of '>'our client. it will be paniculnrly difficult to listen effectively. A second component is to malcc sure you fully disengai;c from )'OUr last client before engaging with the next. Finally, make sure you understand before you move on. Summarize, paraphrase, and ask defining questions to enhance and confirm )'OUr understanding. As a rule, the more )'OU occupy '>'ourself with the active demands of listening, the less you will be tempted to let your thoughts ,\--under. NONVERBAL COMMUNICATION Most people are familiar with the physiological reactions that occur in moments of great fcnr. Powered by increased adrenal secretion~ our bodies respond automatically with eJcvared heart rate, rapid breathing, dry mouth, and ()(her symptoms. Many of these reactions arc dearly ,risible to any observer, even before any verbal declaration of fear. Nonverbal behaviour is usually outside our conscious control and is less likely 106 Chap1er 4 TABLE 4 .3 Nonverbal Behaviour: What to Observe Eye contact movement, tears, dilated pupils Eyes Facial cues and expmssions Frowning, Shaking the Mad, smilWlg. clenched m::>uth, blushtng Vocal Tone, volume, use of silence, hesitation, pace, mood Use of space Appearance/Dress Body language Seati~ dislance. movement, bOdy position Grooming. hygl,ene, dress, tattoos. t.'ancli~. scars Posture, gestures, pacing behaviour, arm and hand m::,vements Toudl HandShake (e.g., Ump, aggressMl), hugging, hand on Shouldet Distractions Playing with a rtng 0t pen. touchi~ hair Blunted, flat, inapptopriate, labile, mstricted (see gtossaJY) Affecl to be censored. Consequently, counseJlors can often trust nonverbal communication as a more reliable indicator of feelings than ve.rbal communication. Sue and Sue (2008) found that "studies support the conclusion that nonverbaJ cues operate primarily on an unawareness level, that they tend to be more spontaneous and more difficult to censor o r falsify, and that they arc more trusted than words" (p. 171). Table 4.3 includes some of the key things to look for in your clients' nonverbal behaviour. (n ,;cneral, research has shown that often 55 to 65 percent or more of the meaning of a message is conveyed nonverbally (Shcafor & Horejsi, 2008). Sometimes aJI signifi• cant communication comes from the nonverbal channel; for example, people's emotions may be conveyed much more accurate!)• by their body posture and eye contact than b\• their words. Counsellors who rely only on words will be limited and ineffective by 00( integrating that part of the interaction that contains the meaning. Knapp and Hall (2006) offer these condusions: KonverbaJ eornmunie::uion should not be stud100 as an isolate-cl phenomenon bu1 :lS an inseparable pore o( the total eommunbtion p ~ . . . Nom'e'rbal eonununie::uion is import=nt beeluse o( its role in the t'Ot:il 001nmunk21tion system. the tremendous quant ity o( in(orm::uion:11I cues it ah,es in 20)' p3rtkubr situation. :ind its uSc in (und3mcntal 2re:lS o( our d3ily li(c. (p. H) Meaning of Nonverbal Communication CounscJlors can learn a great deal more about their clients' ideas and feelings if they cardull't' observe and try to unde.rst:md the nonverbal channel GenemJly, nonverbal communication serves one or more of four purposes: ■ Confirming OT repeating: Nonverbal mes.sages are consistent with messa,;cs that arc spoken. Alternativcl't', nonverbaJ cues embellish the intensity of the client's ideas or feelings. Example: thumbs up with a smile while saying yes. CONVERSATION 4.1 STUDE:NT: I find that I'm so busy ltying to lhink of what to say next that I miss what the client is sayi~. TEACHER: Yes, 1t is tough. That is a eotnmon problem. even for ext,erienced counsellors. TM brain canno1 ml.dtitask Its. tening and planning. One tas.k must stop for the 01t1er to occur. Of course, it is hard to stay focused on what is bei~ said witoout some thought of wtlat kl do next. but with ptaetice it can be done. One ttick is to lhink about \\flat is being said before thinking about what to say. As you reflect on 'llf'lat is bei~ sakl, try to identify majoc themes and footings. Often, )'OU' response will emerge naturally out of lhis effOr'l. DeYelOp your comf0tt with silence. If you need a moment to think, ask for it listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 107 ■ Comradicring: Disp3rities between the verbal and nonverbal mesS3ges arc apparent. Example: Cliem might say, "I'm «static," but in a sarcastic manner that conveys the opposite. Another common example occurs when people say, "l'm interested in what you have to say," but at the same rime, they continue with another activity, betraying their lnck of interest. ■ Subsriuaing: Ideas and feelings arc communicated only in the nonverbal channel. Examples: shaking or nodding the head to say no or yes; shrugging the shoulders, expressing confusion or indecision. Nonve.rb3l communication such 3S vocal into.nation~ pauses, and hand gestures can aJso be used to regulate the flow of conversation (e.g., turn-taking). Yawning might unconsciousJy signal to your guests that it is time to go home. ■ Expressing emorion: The client's emotions are suggested through nonverbal mc3ns. For example, crying might signify sadness, fc3r, or jO\' ; a mi~ voice might suggest anger or frustration. Counsellors need to interpret nonverbal behaviour cautious!)•. NonvcrbnJ behaviour can have many mc3ning.s, C11C.h of which can vary according to culrurc, context, and individual comfort level. For example, people from some cultures interact at very dose personaJ distances, but others experience the same personal distance as intrusive or even aggressive. Some people consider direct ere contact rude, while others view avoidance of ere contact as cold or as e-.•idcncc that people are lying. Jn fact, in some cultural groups averring one's eyes is a sign of respect and courtesy. Hays and Erford (2010) offer this perspective on Native Americans: To subd)' ,natch this Je...el o( ere eon12et is respectful and shovi·s an underst2ndinK of the dient's way o( bein&, Tilt eyt:s 3re oor,skler«I to be the p.,tJ1w-3y to the spirit: therefore. tooonsiscentl)' look someone in tl,e i')'e is to show 2 Level of e:ntitle.ment or 3iKl'dSM'>n. It isi ood to Kl.:11l« 31 someone e\'erronce in a whi.le, but hstenh,K in tl,e tl"3d1tion.3I W2)' is sornetl,ina tl,::u happens with tl,e e3rs and the heart. (p. 320) kinesics: Tliestudyolbcd7l-,:ua,e. such u p)sture. lacial expessioos. pstu,es, and qe aotica Body Language Kinesics is the study of body language, including such variables as posture, facial expression~ gestures, and eye motion. Sometimes body language is easily interpret~. such as when ~pie use gestures that have dir«t verbal equivaJcms. For example, people might point to indicate direction or use their fingers and hands to signify size or numbers. At other rimes, body language is ambiguous and more difficult to interpret, particularly when people communic3tc contradictory mesS3ges. For example, a person miWlt appear to be listening intently and making appropri3tc eye concac:t, but if these actions are accompanied by fidgeting and rapid finger tapping, then the rc3l mcs.s3ge is "l'm bor~." Even a simple smile may have multiple meaning~ including warmth, amusement, or ner\'ousness. Te,us ma)' convey sadness, amusement, embarrassment, or fear. Consequently, counsellors should look for multiple indicators of meaning rather than a single explan3tion. Factors such as context, culrurc, relntionship, power dynamics, and gender may be loosely or intimately connected to the me3ning of any nonvcrb3l mes.sage. In some situations where ve.rb3l and nonverbal messages appC3r contradictory, the client may be 3mbivalent and both messages may be corr«t. For example, a mother might SO)' how proud and happy she is th3t her son is leaving home to attend college, but at the same time be crying. In this example, it is dear she has mixed feeling~ and an appropriate empathic counsellor response might be, "Even though )'OU'rc proud to see )'Our son taking this important step, it still hurts btt3usc he will no longer be at home." Voice VocnJ nonverbal cues include tone, \'olume, pitch, and rate of speech. These variables can reveal if clients arc depressed, euphoric, angry, or sad. For example, Kadushin (1990) concluded that anger tends to be expressed with sptte.h that is more 108 Chap1er 4 Ema'il aoo text messaging communication is often misintef. p(eted beeause lhe(e is no access to lhe non-verbal channel which signalS the subtle meanings. emotions aoo in1en1ions of the sender. To fully process meaning, Ou( bfains need to access and intefpret bOth the vefbal and the nonverbal channel. Note thal IM nonverbal channel is often more impoftant aoo reliable, parlicular1y when emotions a(e invol\led. Generally, nonverbal communk:ation is p,-ocessed in IM rigt\l hemisphere of the b(ain. Damage to the (ight side of the b(ain can lead to a vatiety of social communication difficulties, including understanding nonvefbal cues and oar.er subtleties of communication such as humour Of metaphors (Ame(ican Speech t.a~uage Hearing Association, 201 S). rapid 3nd loud, whcrc..ls sadness is ch3rac:terizcd by more pauses and slowness of speech. Silence is 3fso an important component of nonve.rb3l communication. Coun• sellors need to be 3ble to rc..ld nonverbal cues to decide how, when, 3nd if they should interrupt a silent moment. Spatial Oistance/Proxemics Proxemics describes how people use space and dis• tancc. Hall's modcl ( 1959) is still widely used to describe the four m3in distances (for Weste.rn.-born C3nadians): proxemics: Alelmusei:Jtod.scribe how people sse space -6 diManoe in social bala'lioia t. lntim3tc distance is a :one of up to0.5 merrcs (l feet), rcse.rved for private exchanges of intimate thoughts 3nd feelings. 2. Pcrso03l distance is 3 zone of about 0.5 to I mctre(l to 4 feet), used for less intense uchanges with friends and family. 3. Social distance is 3 zone of approximately I to 3.5 metres (4 to 12 feet), used for more impersonaJ meetings and social contact. 4. Public distance beyond 3.5 metres (J 2 feet) is used for casu3l cxch3ngcs, such as giving a speech or lecture. How an individu3J uses space is influenced by many wri3blcs, including gender, 3g,c", culture, ph)•sic3J characteristics. smru~ various personality trait~ and the narure of the rcfationship. Thus, counsellors should 3dapt their se3ting to mttt the nttds of individual clients 3nd siruations 3nd remember th3t angry clients usuaJI)• need more space. Moreover, in such situation~ counsellors need more space for safety reasons. Counsellors should 3fso be mindful of spatial shifts during the inte.rvicw. Often these changes arc subtle, such 3S when a client shifts his or her chair back, 3S if to say, "I'm not comfort• 3ble with what we're taJking 3bout." Simil3rly, as clients le3n in and move toward them, counsellors can conclude that imim3cy and trust 3re increasing. When clients physically withdraw, counsellors might want to avoid confrontation or sensitive topics. Counsellor Self~Aware-ness of Nonverbal Behaviour Counsellors neo:I to be 3w3re of the.ir own nonve.rb31 behaviour and the subtle ways it might influence the.ir clients. Counsellors may inndve.rtcnrly communicate displeasure by frowning, rurning 3w3y from clients, or increasing the physic31 distance from clients. Altcrn3tively, they communic3te interest by smiling, using a pleasant tone of voice, inc.reasing eye contact, 3nd lC3ning toward clients. SUCCESS TIP Clients can be very adepa at notic::i~ nonverbal cues lt'lal might betray thei( counsetlol"S' judgmen1, bias, deception, disinte-rest, anxiety, o, lack of genuineness. listening & Responding: The BasfS tor Unders1andlng 109 Some counsellors might laugh nervously when they are anxious or scared, thereby confusing their clients. Counscllors can review videotapes of rcaJ or mock counselling sessions to increase their sensitivity to appropriate and inappropriate nonverbal com,. munication habits. Culture and Nonverbal Communication All cultures have unique nonwrbal languages. In the deaf culture, for example, nonverbal communication is an e>..'tTemely important adjunct to ASL (Ame.rican Sign Languag,e). Gestures and fucinJ expressions may be emphasi:ed to define meaning. One Canadian study supported the conclusion that the French speak more often with their hands and rypicnJI)• use more gestures in their interactions (Adler, Towne, & Rolls, 2001). Spatial dismnce also differs among cultures. Mid die Easterners stand and communicate much closer than most Westerne.rs ,vould be comfortable doing, With respect to eye contact, Adle.r et al. (2001) make this observation: Like-di.ruul«', potterns o( ere eont:w!t vary around the world. A d1reet ~a:e is eonsidc--red 3ppn>pri:ue (m- speakers in Lat in Arneriea.. the Arab world. :md southern Europe-. On the other hand. Asfaf)$. Indians,. P2kist3nis,. and northern Europe:ms K"3:e at a listener peripher.tll't' or noc 2t 2ll. In either ease, deviations from the norm are likelr to make 2 liste,~r u1lM-lnlortabLe. (p. 231) Some nonverbnl communications such as smiling, laughing, and fro\\•ning have the same meaning everywhere; hO\\•e-ve.r, some cultures put more emphasis on controlling the expression of personal feelings., which sometimes makes it difficult to g:iuge the intensity of the client's feelings. An example illustrates how a counsellor might use cultural knowledge: CounS(>IJOr. (S/Ji!aklng ,o a mi.ddlt,a,ged Ad.an u.OO!Mn.J How 3re rou (eelina! C lient: (Ulitl, a ~rtght nn/Je.) I'm f'me. I'm doina okay. CounS(>IJOr. On a ~le from I to 10. with JO bein& the best you ~,~ e"\>er (elt. wl~re would rou put )'Ourseln C lient: (H~taus.) ?l.·bybe 3 or a -t. In the preceding example, the counsellor knew that the Asian woman might (as pan of her culturaJ learning) hide and suppress her feeling~ perhaps not wanting to burden he.r counscJlor with her pain. The scnling question provides a face~saving way for her to reveal he.r emotions. SUCCESS TIP Client nonvetbal cues will tell )(lu when you have spoken too much, when the client wants to 131.k, and when lhe moo:1 of the interview has shifted. TrUSI these cues mor'e lhan lhe WOtdS you Mar. Working with Nonverbal Communication Nonve.rb3l communication needs to be considered as P3rt of the toml communication process that includes verbal behaviour and context. Herc arc four ways to respond to client nonve.rb3l communication: I . Use it as a basis for under.standing. By paying attention to the nonverbal channcJ, counscJlors can greatly increase. their knowledge of those are11.S that are important or sensitive for the dient. 2. lgnO'fe. lnconsequential nonverbal behaviour (e.g., a small shift in body position or scratching one's nose) docs not need to be addressed. 110 Chap1er 4 3. Defer. Sometimes nonverbal behaviour is potenti31l)• signif,canc, but a sufficient levcl of rrust has not yet bttn established. PotentiaJly significant nonverbal messages may come at the end of the interview when there is no time to address their meaning. In such circumstances, it ma)' be wise to defer, but a mental note can remind the counsellor to deal with it later when there is more time. 4. Acknowledge in the t~bal channel. Use responses such a~ "Your tears really say how much this means to you." Responding to nonverbal cues communicates a dttp sensitivity to the client's experience and (in this example) a willingness to worlc in the emotional domain. M etacomm uni cation Metacommunication is the message that is heard (inte.rpreted), which may differ sharpl)• from the ,vords spoken or the intended message of the speake.r. Factors such as nonverba.1 cues (especiaJly voice cone, volume, and inflection), context, history, relationship trust lcveJ (espcciaJl't' regarding unresolved conflict), mood, and many others all influence how someone interprets a message. So, it is important that we stay ale.re for signs that a different meaning has been ascribed. For example, the seeming),., simple offer, "Can I heJp?" might be understood (heard) by different people as: ■ You don't trust me. ■ You don't thinlc I'm capable of doing it on my own. ■ You need heJp, and J'm the one who can solve your problem. ■ You want the credit for what I'm doing. ■ You think J am doing a lousy job. ■ You are willing to do it for me. ■ You are angry because I didn't ask )'OU metacommunkation: The messaie t!l.i'! is Mard (illerp«:fd), lldli::h mar diffef fromdie ..onls sp,k£ft or the intended messaie of the speaker. to hclp. The following example illustrates what some clients might "hear:" Coun.seltor I: Wh't' don't you tell hlln how you (eeJ! Mronll"l8 of the mts:soge fe,, du• client: You Yi~re not smart enou,ah 10 think of th::u on )'Our own. Coun.se.U.o r 2: Do you aaree with wh::lt I S3kl! MNmf1.8 of du• me~ for 11.t- clit'nl: Do not disaaree. SILENCE The Personal Meaning of Silence Another major active listening skill is silence. One distinguishing quality of effective counseJlors is their mastery of language to communicate ideas and promote change; however, language fluency a.Jone is insufficient. Counsellors aJso need to understand the importance of silence in communication. They need to balance their verbal agility with an tttua11y strong capacity for silence. Sometimes the most effective and appropriate counselling response is to say nothing. Individuals and cultural groups sh<:M• considerable differences in their comfort with silm.cc ln some cultures, silence is a sign of respect. For many counsellors, silence is unnatural and if pauses occur in the conversation they become anxious and fear that their clients will Stt them as incompetent. They also often burden themselves with pressure to fill the silent ,roid with words. A silent pause, even as short as a few second~ may lead to inner panic. Almost on reflex, they act to fill silent moments with questions and interprrtations. listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 111 Some p«>ple judae silence hnrshly. They sec quieter people as unmotivated, unin.terested, aloof, rejecting. and ianoram. In n discussion with a group of srudents in a counselling class, I asked members who rated themselves as "more verbal" to ta.Jk to "less verbal" members nbout their typical reactions to silence. The verbal members made statements such as "I feel judged," "I don't think you're very interested," "I'm boring you," and"( wonder if you care about what we're doing?" Their comments deart,., indicated that they felt threatened by silence or viewed it as evidence of judgment or lack of interest. In contrast, the members who rated themselves as quieter noted that they often did not have enough time to respond and revealed thnt they were fearful or felt inadequate. Sample comments from this group we.re: "You don't give me enough time to speak," "I'm scared to ta.Jk," "I ,vorry about makina n fool of m)•sclf," and "By the rime, I think of what to say, someone else has already said it." Silence in Counselling attended silence: Atleaded sil!llce is tharacteriled t,, •ali-, eye «intact. ~ al and psycb:dogic-M locus c. the dient.-.:J self-drsC.,line to • inimite illemJl-.:J Memal disuauion. ))t) BRAIN As noted above, counsellors can have the same anxieties about silence as other people have. Silence mtt)' heighten their sense of inndcquacy as counsellors and lead to unccrtninty in the interview. As a result, counsellors may become impulsive and try to fill silences too quickly. However, disciplined counsellors who nJlow silence in their interviews may find that their relnrionships mkc on nn cmireh• different tone, with thc.ir clients answering their own questions nnd discovering their own solutions. A repe.rtoire of skills position counscJlors for dealing with silence in nn interview. CounseJlors should become comfortable permitting silence as wcll as knowing when to interrupt silences appropriately. Knowing when to speak nnd when not to requires some understanding of the vnrious meanings of silence. A survey of the use of silence in counselling suggested that counsellors use. silence "primnril't' to facilirote reflection, encoura,;e responsibility, focilitntc expression of feelings, not interrupt session flow, and convey empathy" (Hill, Thompson, & Ladany, 2003, p. 513). Silence may be ill-advised, however, with clients who are ps\•choric or with those who are likeJy to view the silence as punishment. During silence, counsellors need to do more than just keep quiet; they also need to attend to the silence. Attended silence is characteri!ed by e\•e contact, physical nnd psychologicnJ focus on the client, and self-discipline to minimi!c internal nnd external distraction. Silence is not golden if it communicates lade of interest or preoccupa.tion, or if it snys, "I'm not listening." This means refraining from fidgeting and other digressions, such ns raking notes or nnswering the phone. At the snmc time, counsellors should not sta.re or turn the silence into a contest to sec who breaks it first. Counsellors should 00( nutomatically assume that silence means failure, nor should thq• think that n few moments of silence means that the work of counselling has stopped. Passive clients may be busy with thought, or they mny be seeking to gain control or understnnding of p3inful and forgotten feelings. S · BYTE ·1 ,_ Co20fino (2010) suggests that some clients find silence in counselli~ difncult and they imagine that the eounseu0r Mthinks they ate bOting, stupid. a waste of lime, ot a bad client· (p. 88). He suggests that lheit teactions ate activated by implicit memories (unconscious) lhat mitrOr difficult telationShips with theit parents. It seems that 112 Chap1er 4 fot some, ·defences to escape negative feelings come 10 tequite constant action and distraclion to keep us from becoming frightened ot overwhelmed• (p. 88). In contrast, CozOfino identifies anothet group of clients who ftnd silence supportive and a bl"eak ftom lhe ptessutes of communication. Every silent interlude: h3s a different meaning, and counsellors need to be 3stute to discover the signific3ncc: of each quiet momem and the most appropriate response. Understanding different types of silence: hclps counsellors look for cues 3nd consider 3ppropriate responses. Herc 3re the six common meanings of silence: in counselling: t. The dient is thinkina. Although all clients need time to process information 3nd frame their response:~ some need more time than others do. Some clients talk with only a momentary p3use to catch their brc:3th, but others punctu3te their speech with periods of re.flection. If counseJlors do not allow this time for contemplation, their clients m3y fee] disc:mpowerc:d or inadcqu3te. Clients may be formulating their thoughts or feelings. onh• to be prc:marurcJy cut off by counsellors whose own anxiety with silence docs not permit them to wait. When clients need time to reflect, counsellors c3n simply rcm3in anemive and nonverbally show their interest 3nd involvement through eye contact, open posture, and so on. Thc:yc3n 3lso verbally indicate their willingness to listen by using simple phrases, such 3S "I sense )'OU nttd some time to think. That is oka't'· I'll wait" 3nd "h's ok3y with me if you just need to think without speaking." 2. The dient is confused and un.,;ure o f what to say or do. Sometimes questions arc undC3r, the focus of the interview is ambiguous, or clients do not know what is expected of them. Cliems may sit in silence, shifting uncomfortably 3nd 3ttc:mpting to sort out what to do next. When cliems become quiet because they 3re confused, 3llowing the silence to continue sustains or increases the clients' anxiety. These circumstances w3rrant intenupting the silence to cforify meaning, direction, or c:xpcct3tions. Rephrasing. summari! ing, paraphrasing, 3nd even repetition can help in such situ3tions. Coun.se.U.or: Perhaps )'Ou' re confused. Client: V,..1ods.) Counsello r (Choke 1): t think t mi~t h::n't' confused )'OU with tn)' !:1st q uestion. It didn't make sense to rne either. Let me reword it. Counsellor (Choice?): let's s.loo• down:. bit. Help me to underst.:1nd "-hat is unclear or eonfusi1l{t. In addition, clients may have diffteulty expressing their idea~ or language: problems ma,., be a barrier. Sometimes clients just need 3 littJe more time to find the right word or phrase. At other times, counscJlors need to tentative!,., sugi;c:st idC3s or help clients label feelings. Clients 3re more likely to be silent during the beginning ph3sc: of counselling and during first interviews. This is norm3J 3nd usually indicates that clients arc unsure of what to say or do. Consequently, they depend on the counsellor to t31cc: the IC3d to cl3rify role and direction. 3. The dient is encounce rins: painful feelinas. lntc:rviewing 3nd counselling can stimulate powerful feelings 3nd memories. CounscJlors who can tolerate: silence give space to their clients so that they can o:perience and deal with pain or anxiety. (n some c3ses, clients may be ambivalent 3bout facing thc.ir fceJings. They ma,., be afraid of their intensity, or they m3y be unwilling to face thc.ir feeling~ at lc:3st at this time. Silence is 3 chance for clients to examine: the merits of continuing further or rctrenting to safet)•. Usu3Jly, such moments arc obvious because the discussion is intense immediatcJ't' before the silence. When clients arc struagling with powerful feelings. counsellors m3y need to use multiple responses. First. you C3n 3llow this type of silence to continue. Responding listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 113 with :.ntentivc silence can be very thcmpc:utic and supportive. 1t says, "I am here. J understand. 1 have the courage to be with you as )'OU dc:aJ with your P3in." S«ond, you can suppon silence with empathy when dc:aJing with powe.rful client feelings. Othe.rwise, clients might fcc:l ignorc:d o r misunde.rstood. Empathy confirms that fcc:lings have been hc:ard, and subsequent silence gives the client time to p rocess. Empa thy might be u~ to let clients know chat they have been u nderstood. As well, empath)• tells clients that they have not been abandoned and that their counsellors arc ready, willing. and able to be with them while they consider their feelings. Once the co unsellor has expressed empa thy, silence may be appropri,. ate. ln the following example, empathy frames nvo long, silent moments: CounseUor. As I hsten to )'Ou. I am bei.innin¥ to sense your (eelinK o( resentment that your mother cont inWIII)' t ries to run )'Our life. ( I 5 ~ d J of Ji.ftnte) Client: (fMrs m NT eyes.) Resentment! That's only port of it. I don't think I could ever li"e up to her expectations.. (CounklfOJ ,n.aintahu eye Mntat1. far:n dknt.) (IO~dsof slftnte) Client: But it's K'()ina to be okay. I reali:e that I h::t\'e m)' oo•n eicpectations to n~t. It's 1ne I h::t\'e t'O face in tll(' 1nirror. Counsellor: Sounds like )'Ou are be.:i.nnina to ::.ccept that your mother is not ¥Oifi¥ to than~-e and. th::u onlr )'Ou ha"e oontrol over who you are and how you act. 4. The client is dealin~ with issues o( trust. Before crust develops in the counselling relationship. clients may be hesit:mt to share personal information, and they may communicate this reluctance through silence. T h is is a normaJ and self-protective way for people to avoid rejection and maintain a sense of control over private matters. A different trust issu e may arise with involu ntary clients who use sile nce as a W'll)' to control o r sabotai;c the interview o r demonstrate hostility. The.ir silence says what the client may want to express: "I'm here, but you can't make me talk." Silence becomes a way of retaining d ignity and control in a siruacion in which thq• feel d isempowercd. GencraJly, counsellors will want to move the interview genth• toward more openness and intimacy. One way to proceed is to acknowledge the risk in sharing a nd to d iscuss issues of trust. You can open the door with a comment like this: " ( know it's not easy to share your feelings with a stranger. You don't know me rec, and you can't be sure how 1 might respond." Another strategy is to move at the client's pace and discuss less threatening content until rrust in the relationship dcve]ops. Sometimes it is preferable to put trust issues on the cable rather than try to proceo:I when the.re is ob-.•ious resistance. Consider using a lc:ad such as the following: CounseUor. I'd hke to share a per«ption with )'Ou. 1',..e not iced that whenever I ask 2 question. you answer me quickly. :lnd then )'Ou beconl(' rathe-r silent. I'm v.-'Orried that there mi$:ht be so1ne problems betw~n you and me th::u w~ should dis.cus!l. OT perhaps you ~ it differently. In any case, I think it v.--ould help i( we could discuss it. I'm ce-r, tainl't' w1ll1n& to ltSten to anr o( )'Our concerns or fttlin~s. (Oknt luJknt.) Coun!l(>IJOr. I'm not )'Ou, 2nd without )'Our help I c::rn't underStand how you (eel, but I Sus. pen )'Ou 'd r.uher not be here. Th::rt ·s how I'd (eel in the same drtumstance. ln the preceding example, the counsellor's invitations do not guarantee chat the client will open up to d iscuss feelings about being forced to attend the interview; 114 Chap1er 4 however, such openness to discuss rhe issue frequently works. ln any c3sc, clients will have heard the invitation, and it ma,., help to build trust. 5. Silence L-. the client's usual way. Some clients arc quiet by nature. They arc unu~ to giving long or spontan«>us response~ and they may be more comfortable keeping their ideas to themsdvcs. Silence is not a sign of counsdling failure, so counsellors should avoid the tempt3• tion to end it prcm3turcly. Sometimes counseJlors need to modify their own expectations and W'tl)'S of rcfoting to nJlow for the extended silences of some individuals. As we will sec in the next chapter, there arc interview techniques th3t arc effective in drawing out quieter clients. For example, opcn..ended questions that cannot easily be answered with a simple yes or no ma,., help overcome P3ttcrns of continued silence. Another technique is to discuss with clients how silence is affecting the counselling work and then to explore ways for them to become more expressive. Sometimes clients don't understand the expectations of theircounscllors, but once they do they arc willing to cooperate. Professionals should re.fleet on the foc:t that whereas they have had training in the skills and process of counselling, their clients have not. Clients may be inaccurately seen as resistant when they are just unsure of what to SU)'. This underscores the importance of counseJlors keeping clients full,., informed by taking advantage of opportunities to explain their intent and procedures. Simple stnteme.nts such as the following hcJp dcm)'Stify the counsel,. ling process: Cou n.se.U.o r: l 'rn sure there's tn<n-e th:u you ean tell me. It will help rne t'O understand better i( you tell me more det,i1ls 3nd perhaps s:_l\'e me a few ex3mple~ Counsellors can also adapt the.ir methods by using strategics that require less verbal inte.rnction. Children, for example, may respond better to play, art, music, and drama. Adolescent males may be more motivnt~ to talk if the interview is conduct~ in conjunction with an 3Ctivity, such as a walk in the park or a game of pool. Counsellors arc wise to remember that while they tend to be most comfortable with verbal intcrnc:tion, their clients might favour other methods. For example, some clients like to write in a journal, which gives them a chance to think inrrospcctivcJy without time pressures. With thesedicnt.s, counsellors might seek agreement to use rdC\.nnt journal entries as reference for discussion. (n the following C3.SC. a counsellor relates how poetry was used: The dient was 3 20.rear-old Yi'Om3n who se,tn~. at f'irst. n>1uttant to ulk 3bout her depre$$iOn. Her usl.dl responses wen> one•Yi'Ord or short ansv;-erS.. I remern, bered th3t she h::.d mentioned th3t she liked poetry. so I asked her i( she would be willina to brin¥ some o( it to our meecini, She was wi.llin¥ 3nd in (::.ei e~er to sh3n> her ..vork. She brou¥Iu a short poem t'O the next session. wh.id, she re:3d to me. TI,e poein m,e3Jed her deep depression 2nd her preottup3tion with death. A(terw3rd. we talked about her tonnent at a Le\'t:I t~t ..vould not h2,'e bee!, other~ wise possible. fa,d, ..veek, she brou¥ht 3 new poem. 3nd these poems bec=in~ our startina point. As she be¥aJ1 to (eel better 3bout herSeU. her po.:-rns be<-3tne more buorant and optirnistk, 3nd. the,., beeame one n~sure o( her pqress.. 6. The client has reached closure. Silence happens when there is nothing more to say about a parriculnr topic or idea. Silence is a way of saying, " l'm finished. Let's talk about something else." When counselling topics reach natural and appropriate closure, counsellors need to move on to a new subject. They ma)' break such silence by seeking confirmation that an end point has indeed been reached. One strategy for prevent• ing premature closure is to nd:nO\\rledge the possibility of closure, as wd) as the listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 115 possibility that the client may need time to formulate more idC3s. A comment such as the following acknowledges both aJtc.rnatives: CounS(>JIOr: I'm think in¥ th::rt we miilu h:t\'e K(Jne as far :u we e,n with that ide:3. O r perh3ps there is tn<n-e )'Ou would like to S3y. Subsequently, a transition to a new topic is appropriatc.1t may also be valuable to take a few moments to summari:e before moving to a new area of discussion. Nonverbal Cues and Silence Sometimes nonverbal cues can rcveaJ the meaning of silence. Presenting the open palms o f one's hands ma'>' SU)', " \Vait. I neo:I time." Looking awa'>' and clenching a fist ma'>' signal an angry silence. At other time~ the meaning of silence is unclear. Jn such situa.tion.s, counsellors may choose to let the silence continue for a while to sec if its meaning becomes apparent, or they ma'>' wish to see.k help from their clients to understand it. Following ::are some sample responses th3t counsellors can use: ■ You've (We've) become very quiet. I'm ,vond cring wh3t that means. ■ HcJp me understand the meaning of your silence. ■ Perhaps you arc hesitant to tcll me, or maybe )'OU just need some rime to think. Although silence is often ambiguou~ and understanding its meaning is difficult, some dues can help counsellors inter p ret silence. Tab le 4.4 presents some of the mes.sages of client silence. The table includes a range of nonverbal cues and idC3s about how to respond to each; however, all nonverbnJ behaviour neo:ls to be inte.rpreted with e>..'trcme caution. The same behaviour may have multiple meanings. C rossed arms may SUfiest defensiveness but may also signal that the client is physically cold, or the client may be both defensive and cold. You need to interpret all nonverbaJ behaviour by considering the individuaJ client and the overall context in which the behaviour occur~ and then check with the client to confirm accur3cy. Encouraging Silence S ilence can serve a number of useful purposes in counselling. It provides rime to cxpc.rience fcclings and contemplate. lnsight may emerge from moments of uninterrupted thought. Therefore, it makes sense for counsellors to promote periodic silence in their interviews with clients. This may be panicularh• useful when working with clients who CONVERSATION 4.2 ST\JOENT: How IOOg is a feasooable amount of time to allow a silence to continue? TUCH£R: Without knowi~ the context, I can'I answef )'Ouf question. Somethn es aftet a few seconds of sdence, it's appropriate 10 bfeak in and say scwnethi~. In othet cifeumstan:es. an extended silence of several mrtutes is okay. Ead'I situation must be IOOked at indi\lidually. STUDENT: I agree, but my pl'Oblem is that I get uncomfortable after- a few seconds. I get so anxious that I usualty rUSl'I to say something, eyen when I know I sholACI keep quiet. 116 Chap1er 4 TEACHER: Try paying anent.ion to 'llf'lat you're saying to your. setf during silent ll"IOt'l'M?nts. Watd'I for depfedating se•-talk. s.ud'I as Mlf I d0n1 say something, the client will think I'm incompetent.· Counter- this by reminding yourself that sdence has its place W'I counsetti~. If you inter-rupt too soon, you rob clients of important opportunities to reflect. Remember that comfort wtth sileoce can be learned, but as with au Slults. leafl'liing feQLifes practice. It may help 10 have a gtass of water so that you can take a long, SIOw sip to pfevent speaking premahxety. Deep bmathing may atso help. finalty, do 001 over'Compensate. Some silences sholAd be inter-rupted. TABLE 4 .4 Responding to Silence: Nonverbal Cues Cllenl AttJons Palm ol one hand ,.;,,a 90 d,wees, S(juintiog. fur(owed tx-ow, eye m::wement, and smiling (positive 0t pleasing thOUgt\U. Intended Message Shoulder Shruggi~. raised palms, and r-apid eye movement. "Help--fm confused and don't ktlow what to do next: Se-t the direction; clarify instructions. Ignoring°' providi~ inapptopriately shor1 answe-rs, movi~ the chair baek. "You can't make me talk: "I don't want to be hete. • Communicate that it's Okay 001 to talk.. Empathi:ze with resistance. Describe your feelings wtlen forced to &alk. Starling lo lalk, ab,upl!y Slopp;og, shaking head, and stutte(mg. "I don't know Vtt'lether to &alt or not.· Empathi:ze with ambivalence. Discuss the risks of Sha(mg and not Sha(.-ig. Pf¥ieal withdr-awal. averted eye contact carefully measured WOtdS, and whispering. "I'm scared of what you might thlnk of me.· Reassure and convey a nonjudgmental attitude. Tears, covering eyes, quivering lips. flUShed face, loold~ at the ft()()(, and trembling. Low vdce tone, a pattern of short answe-rs. "I'm overwhelmed w'ilh these feeUngs. • Show empathy, use attended silence. and tneo ;,This is the way I am. I 000'1 say much: Accept it as a cultur"al or lndividual norm. Gentty encour-age w'ilh open-ended questions. Leanrng baek, smiling. saying, .. That's it· "I'm finished.• Summarize. Change the topic and move on. "Please be patienl I need rime to thlnk.: Counsellor Respon-Se Choices Verbalize willingness to wait. Indicate attended s~oce v.;th eye contact and Other nonver-bal expressions of support. Rephrase the last response. reveal further empathy. ExJ:jain lhe importance of sharing. are impulsive and diems who seem afraid of silence. The followina are examples of counsellor leads: ■ I thin k it miaht be useful if weeoch rook a q uiet minute or two to think about this idea. ■ Let's pause for 3 moment. ■ lt's oka,., with me if you wam to thinle 3bout it for a while. ■ \Vhcn you're ready, we can talk about it. In the meantime, I'm comfortable if we don't say 3nythina. ■ Occasional silence is somcthina that m3y occur during our time together. Sometimes one or both of us will need time co thin k. SUCCESS TIP Avoid the imputse to respond irrwnediately to a client's question. Sometimes dients ask a ciuestion bul after a pause go on to answe-r ,t lhemse-tves, ex.ptessiog their thoughts and feelings in more depth. This rS another example of hOw silence can be a high-level counselling response. PARAPHRASING Paraphrasini means rest3ting the client's words and ideas in your own words, but paraphrasina is not the same 3S r~pe3tina what the client says. Repetition confirms mcmoriz3tion, but it docs not mean that the words and ideas h3VC been understood. Paraphrasing is a way of stating thoughts from a d ifferent angle. The defining feature of 3n accurate p3raphrase is its interchangeability with the client's ideas. listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng pa,aphrasi,_ A IIOlljldgmeau l 1u1atement of the dient"s w.ords and idei.s in the 00'.llselkw'SOIUl 'Mlf'ds. 117 Paraphrasing is an important active listening skill that sc.rves two purposes. First, paraphrasing confirms that counsellors have been listening and have understood clients. Second, paraphrasing gives clients an opportunity to correct inaccuracies. Jn the begin.ning phase of counseJling, paraphrasing is particularly important b«ausc the counseJ,. lor is just starting to unde.rst:md how the client thinks and fceJs. Paraphrasing helps the counseJlor "J;ct on board." Paraphrasing, summari!ing, and empathy arc reflective skills that are crucial to dcveJoping the counselling relationship. As well, it helps clients explore their problems in a way thal is less forceful and directive than direct question,. ing techniques. Paraphrasing concentrates on immediate client statements. It is presented without judgment and without an attempt to solve problems. The important point to remem,. ber is that paraphrasing does not add to or alter the meaning of a client's statement. (nstend, it promotes more discussion and elaboration. (n the following example, notice how the counsellor's paraphrased responses otpture the essence of what the diem has said: Client: Losin& 111y job was 1ust the start o( a bad )'i'3r. I h:a"e h:ld bia riurri.:1~-e probtems too. ::and now 111)' d.:1uahter is on the scn:-et. CounU"Uor. You have h::.d 3 nuinber of serious thin{tS i'°' wronK thii year. Client: Ri,aht now, the most u~•ent thll,i is t'O Ond some W3)' t'O ~t 111y dauKhter b3cl. home. I 1ll'('d to know she's s:a(e. Counsellor: So the (()("us o( )'Our attention ii ~in& t~t )'Our d::al¢hter is out of d.:11~r. Client: I'd lo"e t'O be able to le:t,'e mr husband ::and move to a new dty. but "-hat would h::appen to mr d::au~ter! I e2n' t be seJOsh. Counsellor: I( it were just you, you'd know wh::at your priority. t'O do.. but )'Our d.:1u~1ter really is Client: You're ::abso1utelr ri~t. On~ she's ok3r, then I'll uike c::an:- o( mrsel(. It is always preforablc for counsellors to present paraphrases tentative.I)•. This provides the opportunity for clients to correct errors, confirm accuracy, or provide more det::ail. A tentative paraphrase opens discussion for deeper o:plorntion. Statements such as "Correct me if J'm wrong" and "Would it be foir to Sil)' . . . ?" suggest tem::ativencss. Table 4.5 provides some other examples of p::araphrasing statements. Sometimes counsellors move too quickly by doing two things at once. ln the foJ,. lowing example, the counsellor offers a potcntinll)• useful paraphrase and then abruptly switches to a question that will move the interview in a different direction: CounseUor. As I~ it, )'Ou\'e re::.ched .:1 point in )'Our li(e where )·Ou're not ~-oinK t'O take 2ny rnore abuse. \Vh::at do you see as )'Our opt.Ons! In this o:amplc, a vocal pause or short silence should have been given to allow the client the chance to confirm th::at the paraphrase was correct. Client confirmation may come from both verbal and nonverbal channels. TABLE 4.5 The l anguage of Paraphrasi ng Put a different~. you seem to be sayi~ . As I uOderstand ii . Is lhis right? You're saying. In Othet WOfdS • . It seems as if . It sounds a bit like .. . As l heatit . TM picture I get i:S • 118 Chap1er 4 Paraphrasing and Empathy Paraphrasing differs from c.mp3thy because it concenmncs on the content of mcss3g~ information, facts, details, and descriptions-whereas empathy focuses on feelings. Paraphrasing may be less threatening to clients who have trouble discussing feelings. Para, phrasing can be u~ as a prelude to empathy, with cmP3thy being introduc~ as clients become more trusting and willing to address their feelings. (n general, paraphrasing arises from words that the client has actually said, whereas empathy builds on verbal and nonvcrbnJ cues, responding to feelings that the client may never have identified. Paraphrasing is more closely rclat~ to summarl!ing. Both paraphrasing and summari! ing condense content, and both highlight key ideas in the client's communication. The following example shows the difference between paraphrasing and empathy: Client : Noc h:wina a ,ob is~ttu-)¥ me dovm. I know it doesn'c help to sit in front o( the TV 211 day hopin¥ s<.uneone will call with tn)' dreim job. Cou nsellor p:l.r.l.phnlSe: You're aw;,ire th::u you have l'O become more :ietive in se::.rehina (or:. job l'O stop the downward sltde. CounselJor empath y: You' re ::rware that wishina for a job o((er is ma.kill¥ you depressed. ln the paraphrase response, the counsellor paid anemion co the key message (content) in the client's statement and then restated it in different words. ln the empathy response, the counsellor picked up on the emotion3l component. Counsellors often find that simple paraphrases such as the prec~ing one have a powerful, positive effect. Paraphrasing helps clients reali:e that counsellors are listening and that they are interested. Subsequent]}•, clients who fod heard and understood often release the.ir defensiveness and fears about sharing. ln turn, the process o( sharing and exploring may generate new understanding or insight for clients regarding their foeJings and problem situations. SUMMARIZING Summarizing is an active interviewing skill that can serve a number o( purposes. First, summari! ing confirms understanding and checks assumptions. Since client mes.sages may be complex and ambiguous, it is crucial that counsellors validate their inte.rpreca, tions. \Vhen they summari: e content, counsellors present a snapshot o( their clients' main ideas in condensed format for verification. Cou nsellor: So far, )'OU se,ern to be s:ayin¥ th::u )'OU don't se,e 211)' point in lr)'ifl¥ the same old scr21~ies. T2lkin¥ l'O he-r didn't see.in to work. ijp,onna her was e\'e:n v."'01"$('. Kow )'Ou' re not sure wh::u elSie )'Ou t21n do. Does th::n seem like an :)C('ur2te surnm::ary! CONVERSATION 4.3 STUDENT: If the client has just said something, what's the pcint in testating it? I think that a d ient migt\t find pataphtaS- iog very imtaling.. TEACHER: You're sayi~ why an.get your client by repeati~ \\tlat's obvious? STUDENT, That"s nghl. TEACHER: Notice that I just pataphtaSed what you said, and you seemed Okay with it. STUDENT, (Nods in agreement.) TEACHER: AA effect ive paraphrase is m::,fe than just mechani:.al festatement Or' pa,rl'Oti~ ot the client's worcts.. Verbatim restataments may imtate clients because lhey don'I add anythi~ to the interview. A useful pataphrase considers client ideas ftom a diffefent perspective. Paraphrases ate most potent when they invite ot stimulate further etabOration and discussion. Nevertheless, I think it's best to avoid e.KCessive use of pataphrasi~ 0t any othef Slull. use pataphrasing vd'len you ~ to chock yout pefCeptions and when it sootnS important to let a client know that you uodet'Sland. listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 119 Second, summari!ing is a Wtt)' of o rgani!ing complex data and content by tying d isjointed but related ideas together. This ma,., help clients look at existing problems d ifferc:ndy, thu~ permirting new insights. Such summaries can :.dso significant!)• reduce a client's confu sion by o rde.ring ideas in a more coherent sequence. The following example is excerpted from the midpoint of an hour-long counselling session. Prior to this point, the d iem had been ta.Jking a.bout a variety o f ways to manage his d ep ression. CounS(>IJOr. Let me Stt 1f I can su1n up what ..ve'"e been ~U:.inK ::ibout. Essenti.:11llr, 21s you ~ it, rou need 10 Yi-Ork on lorl{t~t erm solutions. so-ine refated to improvin& )'Our fl tncss,. others ta~til,K )'Our social life. As well. rou want t'O look at thin~s rou C21n do iinmedi.:ue1y t'O reduce rour depression. indudinK s.eui~ a medical 21nd look.in& for some fun thin,a:<i to do. ls th:u a fair way t'O o utline our discussion? T he counsellor's summary helps the client systemati!c his o r her action plan. Sum,. ma.ries such as this help clients and counseJlo rs identify priorities. By summarizing, counsellors configure their clients' problems and issues in a way that gives precedence to certain ideas. T h ird , summari!ing can be helpful in working with clients who are verbose-who introduce irrelevant mate.ri3I and wnnder from topic to topic. Summari.!ing separates what is important from what is irrelevant b\•focusing the inter view on particular themes and content. CounS(>IJOr. From w~t )'Ou\-e ~n sayil,K, it Sttms th at your problems 21t Yi-Ork with your supervisor 2re your top priority. Do you aaree.! content St.nrna,y: As.marythat lccum • content and is• • IIEdi'..d conoe.sing of the client's •crds. theme St.ftlmaty: As.taaarythat edits-«Ss.wy detail .tatt~s to ii.ntifyley pal.'lerns and areas« urgency. Summarizing ma)' focus on a short time within an inter view or it may encompass a broader pe.riod, induding the whole interview o r the entire helping relationship. Two types of summaries arecontent(or simple) summaries and theme summaries. A content summary focuses on conte nt and is an unedited condensing o f the client's word~! ideas arc included. A theme summary ed its unnecessary detail and attempts to identify key patterns and areas of urgency. The fol!O\\•ing example illustrates the two types of summaries. The client, a 45-'t•cnr-o ld male, has been describing how unhapJ)\' he has been as a welder. Client: From the Ars:t d ayor1 tl,e ,ob. I k new th:n weld in¥ wasn'1 for me. E\'en as21 duld. I alW'3)'S wanted to wo&. with people. As a wi'lder. I spend 11\0St o( rny time on my o vm. La.st v.--eek was 21 aood example. Frorn ?1.fonday to Timrstl3y, I was in tl,e shop bo.sei1~1t. a.nd tl,e only time I had :l.11)' h uman interact ion was when I v.--ent to lunch. It's not mud, better ::at home. My wi(e has aone back to 9Choo1. so she's b u sy with homN-ork e\'ery niaht. The kkls a.re arown. ailCI we don't see them t~t often. AU I seem to do is work 21nd watcl, n.,: \V1th tl,e junk on TY. th at's not mud, o( 2 li(e. TI,e only thi~ worth w:1td,i1l{t ii ct\.1'. Content (or simple) s ummilf)·: Frorn the beQ:inninK, )'OU were aware th::lt your weld ins. career didn '1 meet )'Our lona,s:t::indins. need to work with people. It seems th::lt your work. with last week as a l't'Pk.:111 ex21mple, lea,-es )Ou on your OYi'n. With your wi(e s tud yinQ: 21nd your children aone. TV olfer-s little com (Ort. Them(> summ21f)·: You ·re (eel in¥ 001::ated. Keitl,er ,.·our job nor )'Our home life ah'\"S )'Ou mud, opportunity 10 S3t isl't' )'Our L<n,~,standh,K need t'O work with people. LIVE: An IICfOl'1ffl tu descrbs tile loure~ial steps in s.aa.riz-,: ista1. ii.ntify, Wfbaliie. m luate. 120 Content summar ies make linJe or no ju dgment about rclcwncc. The major ,;oaJ of the content summary is to organi!e ideas and sum up d3 t3➔ Theme summaries a.re risky. They require interviewer s to d etermine which information is rcle\.nnt and which is irreLevant. In the preceding example, d ifferent interviewers might focus on different theme~ depending on the.ir mandate. A researcher investig:iting u•.le-.•ision p rogramming would hear this client's statemem d iffcrcml't' from a career co unsello r or a marriage counsello r. Good summari!ing involves four csscntia.1 steps that you can remember with the acronym LIVE: listen, identify, ve.rbali:e, evaluate. Chap1er 4 Step 1: Listen In this step. the ta.sic is to listen carefully to verbnJ 3ncJ nonvc.rbal mes.sages that provide dues to content 3nd meaning. Counsellors must exercise a grc3t deal of scJf,<Jisciplinc to 3\'0id contaminating clients' idC3.s with personal bi3.s and dcfi• nition. Counsellors can aslc questions, request example~ and probe for definition as ways to reduce any rislc of imposing their own biases and assumptions. At the s3mc time, they need to control distractions, indudingoutside noise, daydreaming, attending to other activities, or becoming preoccupied with what to say next. In genera], active involvement in wh3t is being said divens counsellors from any temptation to become distracted. Another technique to avoid distraction is to silently repeat or review client mes.sages. Listening mC3ns pn)•ing attention to the five W's -Who? \Vh.nd Where? \Vhcn? Why!- plus How? Sample questions co consider arc: \Vhom arc clients t31king 3bout! What are they S3)'ing? \Vhat arc they feeling! \\:lhat are they thinking? \Vhcn docs this happen? \Vherc docs it occur! \\:lhy docs it happen! How are clients saying it? Step 2: Identify and Interpret The prim3ry goal of this step is to make sense of nJI that has been said and heard. This involves distinguishing import3m informa• tion from irrelevant inform3tion, identifying underlying themes and P3ttcrn~ and setting priorities. 1t also means hc3.ring what has been said in context and avoiding a common pitfaJI in listening: not seeing the forest for the trtts. The counsellor's goal is to arrive at as similar a meaning as possible to the meaning the diem intended. At this step. counsellors need to remember th.at their ~rsp«tives 3rc biased. \Vhat they deem significant 3nd what their clients view 3.S important m3y differ sh3rply. This reality underscores the importance of discussing these differences openly within the interview. One technique that counsellors can use is to listen for keywords in cu.h of the three domains: behaviour, thinking, and feeling. Some sample reflective questions for counsellors include the following: ■ \Vhat is my client doing? ■ How docs he make sense of what is happening! What beliefs docs she have about hc.r problem situ3tion! ■ How is he feeling? Step 3: Verbalize Your Understanding The goal of this step is to vc.rbali!c ),'Our understanding of what the dicnt has said in a summarization response, using words 3nd phrases that the client can understand. Undc.rst3nding is 31\\"ll)'S tentative, at least until clients have 3n opportunity to confirm or ch31lengc counsellors' perceptions. So, this step is crucial to test the accuracy of comprehension. The move to a summarizing statement can be flagged by leads sud,, 3S the following: ■ To summ3rize what you've been saying . ■ lf I may offer 3 summary . ■ To be sure I understand . ■ Let's summari:e . ■ Summing up . ■ Let's pause for a moment to recap. Step 4: Evaluate After summ3ri!ing for clients, the next step is to watch and listen carefully for signs that the summary is correct. Accurate summaries ma'>' be signaled nonverbally by the client's head nod~ smile~ and relaxed posture, and vcrbaJly with short statements, such as "That's right" or "Exactly." listening & Responding: The BasfS t or Unders1andlng 121 Oisagreemc:nt may be: dirc:c:t, with c:.xpressions lilcc: "No, that's not right," or it may be nonvc:rba.J, with clients mO\'lng back, hc:sitatina. or looking away. Lulcc:warm responses, such as "Kind of," are subtle: clues that your summary is incomplete or inac~ curate. In addition, para.Jinguistic cuc:s, such as spcec.h that is drawn out, may indicate: a lukc:\\"8.rm response:, c:vc:n though the: words may appenr to confirm undc:rscanding. \Vhc:n dc:aJing with lukewarm responses, counscllors need to use questions and state:~ mc:nts to invite: confirmation. This reinforces the: notion that the dienc's riaht co be henrd accurateJy will be: respc:c.ted, and it empowers clic:nts to take: an active: role: in evaluation. Lc:ads such as the following can be: used: ))l} INTERVIEW ■ Ooc:s my summary capture the: important points! ■ I'm wondering if you agree: with my summary. ■ Is that accurate? ■ How does that sound to you? ■ What have I missed? 4.1 The followii,g interview excerpt illustrates some important concepts from this ch.apter. This is the second interview with a client who is seeking help with anger management The excerpt begins abOut frve minutes into the interview. counsellor: Lei's feview what we talked aoout laSI week. (Three seC011ds of silence. Client smlle.s and oods her head.) Analysis: This opening comment sets the stage for a summary revittw of the last interview. This is important for re-ttslabllshing the contract. It confirms that issues important in the last session still remain priorities. Counsellor: I remembet two pcints. fll'st, you indicated that you wanted to find out what youf tr1ggers af&-the thi~ that lead you to bse contfel. Second, you wanted to explOr'e some ideas fof staying in contrOI. What have I missed? Analysis: After offering a summary. it is important to confirm its becuracy. In this case, the counsellor uses the brief silence to allow for the client to respond. This theme summary foe.uses on what the counsellor cons;ders to have been the priority of the last session. Checking for client agreement is an imJ)Ortant component of making su,e the p,ocess is cOl/abOrative. Analysis: The client confirms partial accuracy and then adds a point that the interviewer's summary has missed. This should alert the interviewer to the client's priorities. Analysis: A succinct paraphrase offers another pe,spective. Perhaps the counsellor missed an opportunity to get mo,e clarity on the WOrd ..pushover." Client: Yes, that abOut sums it up. But I don't want to beCOme a pushover". COunsellor: So, a•f manage~nt but not at lhe ex()Mse ol gjviog up your rlghlS. (Ten SSCC(lds of si-e.) Counsellor: vou•ve beCOme very quiet. I'm suuggling to under"Stand what that means. (Ten secot'ldS of silence. C/J'ent /coks at Ille flcor, tears Ill her eyes./ counsellor: Pethaps thi:S i:S painful for you to think aoout. ClleM: In eitety relationshiJ) I've ever had. I end up being the underdog. I do everything to please my partoet, but nothing fOr' me. I a~ysgive in. Inside, ifs a diffetent sto,y. I'm ful of rage and resentment. 122 Chap1er 4 Analysis: There is not enough information fo, the counsellor to understand the meaning of the client's silenc.e. It might be tempting to move on with further quest.ions, but the counsellor suspec.ts that the silence is significant. A gentle statement invites the client to give meaning to her silence. Nonverbal cues (looking away and tea,s) suggest that the client Is encountering strong feelings. The counsellor then focuses on feelings. Analysis: The client's comments suggest tha-t she is willing to take a trust risk. This is a critical moment in the interview. The cllent will be watching carefully for signs of ,ejection. i>» INTERVIEW 4 .1 Listening, Silence, and Summarizing Skills<contn.te) COunullo,: Teti me mote. (Leat'IS toward c/J'ent, maintaining eye COflttJct.J Client That's 100 essence of the prOblem. I let things butld up inside and 1hen I ex,:,IOde. Once, I was even f11ed when I bleN UJ) at my bOSS. COunullor: So, your anget is a bit like a time t:ornb, tickl~ away until you explode. Cller,, El<aclly. (Short silence..) Client But, as I think abOut ii. it's not just my a~t. guess what I'm realy afraid of tS nev« having things go myway. COunsello,: As I hear it, you seem to need to have more controt <:Net you, life. Client: No, lhat's no1 it H's not contfol so much as validation. Analysis: This directive encourages the client to go on with her story. It confirms direction and Is short enough not to Interfere with the momentum that the client has established. Attending behaviour shows that the counsel/Or is Interested and o,:,en to hearing the client's Ideas and feelings. Analy:sls: The client continue.s to risk. This signals that trust is growing, but the connection may sJill be very fragile. As we will see in Chapter 6. It is now impo,tant fo, the counsellor to make an empathic connection with the client's feellngs. Analysis: Here the counsellor paraphrases, using a simile that is consistent with the client's phrasing. Analysis: This silence m~ be a simple pause that allows the client to decide what to talk about next. Analysls: The client does not accept the counsellOrs paraphrase as accurate. Secure counsellors need not fear such mistakes 0r corrections. The client's willingne.ss to correct the counsellor indicates that she has enough trust in the relationship to feel safe In challenging the counsellor. Ofcourse, some clients may challenge because they have no trusJ. Reflections: ■ ■ ■ If you were the counsellOc in this interview. what feelings might you have experienced during the extended silent moments? Early in the interview, the counsellor asks, MWhat have I missed?" Consider the advantages of this question compared to an alternative. "Have I missed anything?" Sugge:st le.ads that would enable the c-0unsell0c to follow up on the client's statement, • 1don't want to be a pushover." SUMMARY ■ Listening is the basis for understanding and a prerequisite for relationship development. ■ A wide range of problems, such as culturaJ and language barriers, difficulty in framing idea~ outside noise. ambiguity, loss of objectivity, and spcec.h problem~ can inte.rfere with this listening process. Competent counsellors remain sensitive to these problems and take steps to overcome them. ■ Active listening (silence, anending, summari! ing, paraphrasing, questioning, and empathizing) is an essential tool for inc.rc3sing unde.rstanding, communicating interest, and letting clients know that they have been heard. Active listening involves counseJlors in an ongoing process of pa)•ing attention, listening, exploring. and deepening. ■ Significant information is communicated through the nonverbaJ channel. listening & Responding: The Basis tor Unders1andlng 123 ■ Silence may have multiple meanings. Effective counsellors are comfortable with silence, but they :.dso have the wisdom to know how and when to interrupt it. ■ Attending is the way that counsellors communicate that they arc physically and psychologically committed to the heJping relationship. ■ Paraphrasing is a way of restating someone's words and ideas in your O\\'n words. Paraphrasing is important in counselling because it confirms to clients that counsel,. !ors have heard and understood them. ■ Summarizing helps clients o rg:aini:e complex thoughts and is used to focus on rcl.evant themes and content. EXERCISES Self-Awareness 1. Describe an encountefyou have had where nOOW!tbal communication was more im(X)rlan.t than the content of lhe vet- 3. Conducl an. interview with a colleague on an.y topic of inte-rest. Practise pataphtaSi~. Watch fOr' vetbal and n.onvetbal in.dic.at0rs that )'OU' par'aphr'ase- was cortecl. 4. Conduct a five- Of ten-minute in.tel'\liew with a coueague bal messages. 2. list wOr'ds, phtases, an.d siluations that you think are youf e-motiooal triggers that mighl make ii difficult for you to listen. 3. Ovef the next week Of so, pay attention to the vocal pauses and silences that you and otherS use in evet'yday and pt~ fessional communication.. What in.di::'.atOr'S sugg,asa comfort wilh slence? Oiscomfor1? 4. Oellberately altef yolM' resJX)nse time in a con-..el'Sation. to experiment with silence. 5. Ask a coneague to ObServe yout use of silence dur1~ an intetview (e.g., attanded slence. apprOl)riate in.tet'fuptioos, and leoglh). 6. Videotape an. inteNiew Or' ask a coueague to Observe you( attendi~ behaviout. 7. Metacommun.ication.. Oesctibe the possible- meaning (fof you) of each of the- fOIOwiog: a. Youf te-ad'ler askS you to see hef rigr\t after class. b. Youf pal"ttlet forgets yout birthday. c. A Men.d asks if you are free ~ Sat1Xday mor'ning. d. A client does n.ot soow up fOr' an apJX)intme-nt e. Youf client ask.S, "How old afe you?· Skill Practice 1. Outing interviews with some colleagues or clients, ftnd o,:,por1une moments fOr' bde:f pe(a:xls of reflective- silence-; 1hen con.tin.ue lhe inteNiew. Discuss 'Mth your coueague-/ client what the impact of lhe silence was on the in.tel'\liew. 2. Work with a cotieague to ~ lore 100 effects of poot listening. As an &efcise. delibe,atefy (but subtly) violate lhe prlnciptes of effective listening ar\CI atter\Cli~. FOr' example, inte-rfupt inappcOl)(aatety, ask unrelated ciue-stions, switd'I topics pmmatufety, and avoid eye con.tact and othet in.dicatOr"S of intemst. When. you are ftnished, discuss hoN it fee-ts to not have othel"S listen to you. 124 Chap1er 4 on. any topic of in.tefe-st. As interview-er, you should ptactise summatlzing skill.$. Try to offet bOlh content ar\CI theme summaries. Al the conclusion of the in.terwew, offet a complete summary of the session. ASk you( partoet fOr' feedback. 5. Conduct practice interviews with a colleague to experiment with spatial diStance. Oeliberatety increase or decfe-ase the distance be-tween. lhe r.w of you to learn abOut the e:ffed of space-. Al what poin.t did yout space- become tJiotated? How did physical distance affecl the quality of youf vetbal exchange-? 6. Attempt to communicate with a COiieague using only nonverbal cues and gestures.. 7. ObServe the n.onvetbal communication. patterns of diffetent age woups. What similarities and differences am apparent? 8. F'orm a small woup of fouf to five cOlle-agues. Identify on.e of you whO is wiling to discuss a eurfent pr•obfematic situation. Two or lhree people will ObServe the interview, and r.w will act it out. Counsellor 1: Conduct a 10-minute intel'\liew whtle payi~ cafeful attention to lhe detail of the prOblem. Deliber-ately avoid addfessi~ feelings. Counsellor 2: Conduct the in.tel'\liew while paying cateful attention to em::>tions. Oetibetately avoid expl0ting the details of lhe prOble-m. Counsellor 3: Oelibet'ately inctease lhe le~ of counsetlOr' pauses (silence). Debrief and compare the outcomes of lhe interviews. Concepts I. Explain how silence can. be- used effectively in counsetling. 2. Paraphrase e-ad'I of the follO-.-dng dient saatements: At a party the Othef night I finalty met sorneon.e Mh whOm I can cany on. an intelligent conversation. He- seemed intefested too, but he di:fn.'t ask for my phone- n.umbet. It's a dilem.rna. I dOn'I knON whether to ftni:sh lhe SChOOI yeat or dtop out and get a handle on some of my debtS. My super.to, wanlS 10 see me today. 1kt'Owstie~to talk 10 me beCauSe rvet:JeEo late fOr'v.O'k Oler' the lalSt ie-Nweeks. If Sile wanted me toe.all het, wily didn't shesaysometiw,g? Rrsa my cat~ OONr\ lhM the fri:2ge. NON it'stOO ,:It.Im~ ,,g, 1shOuld """IY someone wro;,; ~ at fbong tt'ings. I think lhat 'Mth AIDS and all the othet diseases you can catch, we shoukl all take precautions. You nevet know wl'oO migllt be infected. Well, to pu1 it bluntly, I think my partoet haS a lovet. But I could forgjve that. I jUSI want OU( (elations.hip to be the way it was when we firSt met I've tried everything. I have a great r~s~. I've caued ever-yone I kOON. I IOOk fOr' WOrk five to six hOurS a day. StiU, I can't fand a jOb. Lately, I've been thinking that there has to be more to life than wOr'k and play. I'm not even sure if I believe in GOd, but I need to find some meaning fOr' my life. • I just IOSt it. My anger- bul t up and I hit her. She got so upset lhat she packed up and left with the kids. I've never- 0000 anything like that in my wtlOle life. I realiZe that I didn'1 SOive any1hing by losing my tempet. Now I may have tuined my marriage ar\CI hxned my kids against me. • I guess I'm goi~ to have to find some way of dealing with my dtink.i~ ptOblem. The othet day, I was so sick from drinking lhat I couldn't even get out of bed. I jUSI can'l let bOOZe continue to jeopatdize my WOtk and my family. 3. ln.tef'Jiew people from different cultutes regarding theit use of nonverbal behaviout (e.g., greetings, saying gOOClbye, summoning a waiter, eye con.tact ph)'sic.al contact, and use of space). 4. Ext,lain wtly counsellot'S might a\lOid paying attention to cettain topics because of their' own needs. Alter'natively, ex.plain why counseuors might pay ex.ces.sive attention to cettain topics beeause ot theit own needs.. WEBLINKS Links on listening from the International listening Association: The International Child and Youth Care Network (click on the www.hsten.org "Reading•· tab f0c ac-cess to practice hints. a reforence library, and othier useful connections): ..Tips on Effective Liste:ning." by Larry Alan Nadig: httpdkyt-net0<g www.drnadig.com/listening.htm listening & Responding: The Basis t or Unders1andlng 125 #- ' t• r,;, )' ~ . ;1 i~ { ~ . I '-~\· ~'1~" - ~J: q('l'loep1 /l23RF )! , LEARNING OBJECTIVES ■ Describe rhe importance of asking questions. ■ Explore esscntiaJ questions (dosed, open, and indir«t) and hO\\• they might be used cffectivcJy. ■ Identify and describe common qucstionina pitfalls. ■ Explore strategics for interviewing youth and seniors. ■ Explain how to promote concreteness in counscJling. ■ R«ogni:e the five different types of interview transitions. THE ART OF ASKING QUESTION S Questions Support Counselling Goals No single approach to quesrionina works with every client. Counsellors must consider numerous fuctors., such as the goals for the session, the comc:x"t in which questions are asko:J, and the individual needs of dicnts, and then adapt thc.ir questioning t«hniqucs accordingly. \Vith a rcpcnoirc of techniques, slcillful intc.rviewers use questions to cngnge clients in hiahtr-ordc:r thinking., kindle rhe.ir curiosity. and prompt them to consider new possibilities. 126 Asking questions is a cornerstone of active listening and counselling. Purpo~ful 3nd well-timed questioning considers variables such as the current interview ph3se, sessional contract, level of trust, 3nd the c3pacity of the client to handle that level of questioning. Used appropriate1y, questions support the J;03ls of counselling in a number of ways: ■ Gmhering infonnmion. Answe.red questions provide counseJlors with detail~ definitions, 3nd examples. As an adjunct to empathy, questions help clients explore, clarify, and define emotions. Counsellors who use questions to learn will be less likdy to make erroneous 3ssumptions. ■ Prmriding /oms. Session3J contracting is used to define the purpose of the inte.rview. Subsequently, questions control the topic and direction of the interview consistent with this contract. Focused questions ensure that the interview remains on trade. ■ PromOling in.sighr. Thought-provoking questions stimufote clients to begin a reOective process that can promote insight. Asking the right questions can promote aw-areness by leading clients to ex3.mine issue~ ide3s, and fcdings th3t they might h3ve othe.rwise overlooked. Effective questioning can also help clients m3ke connections 3nd uncover patterns in their thinking 3nd prob lem solving. A ~ries of questions C3n S)'Stematically lead clients through problem exploration, goal setting, and prob lem solving. ■ CarMni.s. Stimulating questions in combin3tion with nonjudgmental responses fuel the cath3rtic process by encouraging clients to tell their stories 3nd explore the.ir feelings. Often the therapeutic va]ue of this is sufficient to provide the necesS3ry strength 3nd motivation for clients to address the.ir problems on their own. Types of Questions When counsellors wry the W'n)' they ask questions, the interview takes on more vit3lity 3nd the use of time becomes more effective. Effective questioning technique depends on 3 number of factor~ including timing. the nature of the refationship, the purpose of the interview, and the mood of the participants. Moreover, questions that 3re surprising!)• u~ful with one diem m3y generate hostility in another. There is an 3.rt to 3slcing questions th3t precludes 3ny attempt to structure questioning in the same way for each client. Closed Questions Closed questions can easily be 3nswered with a yes or a no, 3nd they are u~ful for confirming facts and obt3ining specific information. Since closed questions do n()( invite detailed responses, they can effectively bring closure to an interview or slow the pace of clients who are overly verbose. On the other hand, dosed questions should be avoided with clients who tend to be succinct. For example, clients })l) BRAIN BYTE dosed questions: Cluestic.s di.at can easilybe aniv.eied rib a simple ,es• no (e.g.•"!lid JOU g_o byyca-wlfM. r,l,_1-1 ,1, Questions can triggef recall of memories long lotgOtten. Questions evoke answerS 01 emotional teactions baSed on stoted infotmation and expe(I(>~ from the past A simple ciuesrion such as Mwhete did you attand Sd'loolr may triggef a stmng em::>tional fesponse from an Indigenous per'SOO W'ho endufed the abuSeS of the canadian Residential SchOOI sys. rem. Metnary ir'WOl\'es all five senses. The s.mel of cOOkies in a bakery may prOduce a pleasant fecal ot one's t,andrnotl'wl-r. A IOud noise may instantly take a C3nadian veteran back to his expe-rienc&S in Afghanistan. ~uently, when asking ciuestions, counsellors need to considef that their clients may interpr'el tne question frOO'l an entirety diffetMI frame of te:fe-rence. Uoox.pected fesponses and nonvetbal communic.ation are dues that this may be happenlOg. Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 127 can ea.sit,., dismiss the question "Do )'OU have anything 't'OU want to taJk about today?" with the answer "No." Typic:.dly, dosed questions begin with words such as can, did, are, hal't', is, uiill, u,-otdd, and do, as in the following examples: ■ Can you tcll me whnt )'OU 'vc done about id ■ Did you hnvc an opportunity to call the schooH ■ Are you fodingdcprcsscd? ■ Is my understanding corr«d ■ Do you agree that the most important problem right now is . .. ? In J;Cncral, when counsellors want a definite )'CS or no answer to an important question, a dosed question is preferable. In the following example, the client hints that suicide might be an is.sue. This possibility is too significant to be ignored, so the coun.seJlor uses a dosed question to sec if this is a risk. Client: Lately. I ~,~been so down I wonder, wh::u·!l the point o( ~oi~on! CounseUor. Have )'Ou been thinldfl¥ about killin& yourself'! Sometimes oraanizations require an intake interview that requires a great deal of inform:nion. A series of dosed questions is an dficiem way to gather data quickt,.,. Unfonunatc1)•, too many dosed questions may irritate clients and leave them feeling interrogated and restricted. To minimize these effects, counsellors should blend dosed questions with various interview stratcgic~ in particular, other active listening skills. SUCCESS TIP At the beginning of an .-iterview, 1t is usually beltet to mioimi:ze questions and sim~ encout- age clients to Mtell lheit sto,y.• By ooing so, counsellOrS may fand that they Obtain much of the infotmation lhat they need without having to question clients. open questions: Ouestilns tut promo:eespansive ans-""1. These types ol quesli>ns ta.at be aasMltd d a simple yes orno (e.g., •i-ro. doyoa le.I abclll her!"). Open Questions Open question.'> are distinct from dosed questions because they are difficult to answer with a simple yes or no. For this reason, open questions arc usu.nil,., prefc.rnble to dosed questions. Thq• provide a great deal of freedom for clients to ans,.n~r the questions in the way they choose, with 3S much or as little depth as they wish. Open questions may be used to begin an ime.rview, for example, "\\:fhat brings you he.re today?" They may also be used to explore thoughts, feelings, or behaviour: "\Vhnt were you thinking?" "How did you feel?" "How did you respond!" Open questions begin with urho, tt-h.ar, tt-h.ere, tt•hen, or tt"1.1(thc "five W questions") or how. ■ Who knows about )'OUT situation besides )'OUT wife? ■ Whnt have )'OU been able to do to cope with this problem? ■ Where do you see this relationship going! ■ When did this begin? ■ Why do you think it has been difficult for 't'OU to copc?(As will be discussed later in this chapter, wh1 questions should be used cautiousi)•. ) ■ How do )'OU see id ■ At whnt point do you think you might be read,., to malcc a decision? Keep in mind that with some clients both open and dosed questions yield the same result. \Vith these diem~ the dosed question "Did you have any feelings about what happened?" and the open alternative "How did you fecl?" will generate the same 128 Chap1er S response. However, counsellors should avoid using the dosed n1te.rnntive with less verbal clients. If co unseJlors want an expansive answer. they should avoid using clo~ question~ particularly when dealing with clients who tend to provide single-word or short answers to q u estions. For example, instead of asking. "Did you come he.re for help with your rCsumC?" a counsellor might ask a q uestion that conveys a greater expectation for detail, such as " \\:'hat we.re your reasons for coming in today!" Clo~ questions become leading q uestions when they su~est the "right" or expected answer to the client. ln the following example, a single mother describes her .situation: Client: I often think that 11\)' kids do not i-h'e me e:no~ respect. Just once. I'd like them t'O ~,sk me how mr da)' went. When r,n tired, they rould help out more. Coun.settor: Do you feej 3n~ry? Client: Sure I do. \Vho wouldn't? In this example, the client hints at strong b ut u ndefined feelings. Even though the client affirms anger, this may not be her main fecJing. The client may indeo:f be angry, but other fttl ings may be dominant. Yet many clients find it easier to go in the d irection suggested by the counsellor's q u estion than to shift the answer. A less biased q uestion miaht be "How do )'OU feel about this?" Kadushin (1997) suggests that o pen questions can be intimidating for incxpe.ricnc~ clients who are unsure of their expected role: "For .such inte rviewees, open..endcd q uestions provide little structure, little guidance for what they are suppo~ to tn1k about and how they arc .supposed to talk about it" (p. 24 I). As a rule, clients may remain confused, resistant, o r threatened by q u estions until clarity is estab lished regard ing the goals and process of counselling. This underscores the importance of relationship contracting that establishes counseJling ro utines and expectations, which typically ICOOs to more client control and colla boration a nd a reduction in client resistance. SUCCESS TIP Questions can lead to surprtsi.ng and unexpected client responses (for bOth clients and cou~). These responses create options for aransitions to new areas ot ioqliry and for renegotiated agreement on the direction of wOr'k (contracO. When clients respond to ciues1:ions with sttong emoti:)ns, empathy is a preferred response. Indirect Questions Indirect questions, o r embedded question~ arc statements that act as q uestions. Indirect questions are a .softer way of .sec.king information. They arc less intimidating than open and dosed questions. Indirect questions are effective for breaking up the monotony and threat o f constant questioning, particularly when they are combined with other skills, espcc:in1ly empathy. The following are some examp les of indirect questions: ■ I w-onder whether you believe that it's possible. ■ Perhaps )'Ou're feeling confused over her response. ■ I'm curious about your opinion. ■ Given what you've said, I wouldn't be surpri~ if you decided to accept the offer. ■ I have no idea what you might be thinking. ■ I w-ould not be surprised to find that you have strong feelings on the maner. ■ You may have already reach~ a conclusion. ■ Your views on this are very important to me. indirect questions: State.nts that impt, questicm (e.g.. ·rm curi>usabOIIII hc,#)1)1.1 respodd">. Table 5.1 summarizes the various types of question~ including their advantages and disadvantages. Asking Ques tions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 129 TABLE 5. 1 Types of Questions Type Description Advantages Disadvantages Examples Closed quesUoos Quest.i:)ns that can be answered yes no • Conftrm fadS. • Restrict answers • Wtll you be going to the parents' group • Slow the pace of a l'ambti~ intetview by limiti~focus Ate easy f0t clients to (do, will can, are, If) °' • Open <i u&Stioos (who, what. where. when, Questions that promOle a mor'e • Statements that act as questions • • When asked repeatedty, can leave clients feeling intefrogated tonight? • Did you say everything that you wanted to say? answe( Allow fOr' an unrestrk'ted expansive answe-r why, oow) Indirect questions • conclusions, or aweements l'a• of responses Em po-.ver clients by • May be more Ume-consuming process • Are mor'e d'lalleogjng for clients to answer • What a(e you( plans for this evening? • How are you feeling? g'Ning 100m incr-eased control of answers Ate less tt'lreateni~ 1r.an traditional questions • May not elicit a response from the dieot I am interested in kr10\\;~ if you have thought aOOut what todo. ESSENTIAL QUESTIONS: SOME OPTIONS struc:b.red Interview: An inteMl!'w that fol!Gws a l)ffdet.rmiflfd sequeace d -· oostruc:tured hrtertiN: An illervi!w that doeitot haw a preset plan that mtricts dir!Cli:in, pace.« content Some interviews arc highly strucrur~ with a series of q u estions to answer, such 3S a survey o r 3 st3ndardi:~ assessment tool or p rotoco l. For example, 3 suicide risk assessment interview will include targeted questions designed tog,et inform3tion about knO\\rn ris k factors. A psychi3tr ic interview gnthe.rs data to see whether a client's symptoms m3tch the criteria for P3rticular mentaJ disorders. Although it is possible (and some~ times desirable) to conduct 3n interview without question~ the ab ility to fo rmul3te targeted questions is 3n indispens3b le skill for every counsellor. A structured interview follows 3 d efined sequ ence o f predetermined stand3rd questions. E.x3mples include inter views th3t require counsellors to complete forms to establish clients' cJigibilit)' or to m3ke assessments. (n structured inter views, there is little o r no freedom of choice reg3rd ing the focus 3nd pace of the inter view. An unstruc.tured interview gives interviewers and clients freedom to go in any d irection without a predetermined set of q u estions. In this t)·pe o f interview, the tone is more conversational, and the pace and style of questioning is less rigid. The conmtct remains flex ible. Typically, most interviews will h3ve the following process goals: I . Establishing purpose (ses.sioMI contract) 2. Defining, strengrhening, or troub le shooting the counselling refotionship (reJntion~ ship contract) 3. Exploring and understanding the client's siruation and p roblems 4 . Problem solving 5. Evaluating the work T he follO\\ring sections propose s3mp le questions for each of the preceding 3rens. It is alw3ys p referable to have 3 variety of ideas (choices) for 3ccomplishing the S3me tnsk. A reperto ire permits ffexibility 3nd contributes to keeping the interview interesting and individuali:~ . To increase the chances for rnppon, counsellors nttd to modify ques..tions and word choice to meet the particular nttds, educational levcJ, 3nd culrure of 130 Chap1er S C3ch client. Other active listening: skills such as summari! ing and, in particulnr, empathy are essentiaJ to ensure that the interview does not become an interrogation. Questions for Establishing Purpose Contracting was introduced in Chapter 3 as a tool for ensuring that clients and counscl.lorsdearh• understand the intended purpose of the relationship. \Vhen clients come for service, the basic question counsellors need answered is "\\:'hat brings you he.re toda,.•?" Of course, this does 00( prevent counsellors from introducing: their own ideas, but this question and its variations ensure that clients are consulted regarding their nttds and expectations. This is particularly important when working with involuntary or reJuctant clients. Here arc some sample questions: ■ How would ■ Do you have feelings and concerns from our last session that you want to address! ■ \Vhat would you like to talk about! ■ \Vhat do )'OU think would be a good starting point? ■ \Vhat would you like to accomplish today! ■ \Vhat is '>'our gonH )'OU like to spend our time together! Questions to Define the Counselling Relationship Clients may come to counselling: with denr ideas of what they wam from the.ir counsellors, or they may be aware only of their pain and be hopeful that some heJp will be forthcoming:. In any case, it is important that both clients and counseJlors understand their resp«t:ivc roles in the process. Relationship contracting (see Chapter 3)gives clients and counsellors an opportunity to define their relationship and how they will work toj;cther. TypicnJ questions include the following: ■ \Vhat experiences have you had with counseJling? \Vhat did you find heJpful/n()( helpful? ■ \Vhat are your expectations of me! ■ How do you prefer feedback (e.g., soft, direct, and "sandwic.hcd")l ■ \Vhen you imagined coming he.re today, what were you hoping would happen! ■ How will you know if our time together has been useful? ■ Anticipatory feedback helps to plan for things that might arise in the counselling relationship. For example: ■ ff I notice that you arc getting discouraged, what should 1 do? ■ \Vhat would be a good way for me to approoc.h you if 1 think there were problems between us! Questions for Exploring and Understanding At the beginning: of an interview, or when a new topic is introduced, an open-ended question such as "\Vhat do 1 need to know about your situation?" empowers clients to identify areas of immediate concern or willingness to explore. This question communicates to clients that counsellors will respect their needs and wants without making assumptions. It ~ms to say, "I nm willing to listen and lenrn. I will treat you as a person, not as a number or a category." At least initially, clients may 00( put forward the.ir most urgent need. They ma'>' start with a safo topic to test the waters for understanding and acceptance. Once they fed more trust, they may present matters that are more serious. Asking Questions: Tile Searell lor Meaning 131 Sample wrintions of this question arc "\Vhat arc the important things I need to understand about you and your problem?" and "Can you tcJI me the key points we need to explore!" Concreteness probes are used during all phases of the interview to ensure clarity and secure examples. They move the interview from superficial understanding to shared understanding. Questions designed to learn about a client's situation genc.raJly target three important areas or domains: I . How the diem {«ls about the problcm-affec,rivc domain affective domain: HGwclients feet. CO,gJ'litiw, dCWt'lain: Koll cliffl1s think abclul tlleir situati>ns. behavioural domain: 'Mai'! cli!als andcini, 2. How the diem chinks about the problem-cognitive domain 3. Whnt the client is doing about the problem- h e.h avioural domain Affective Domain (Feeling) Sometimes solutions to problems nrc obvious to clients, and they do not need help with decision making or problem solving but still lack the capacity to cope with their dilemmas. Often this is because their struggles to deal with painful feelings detract from their power to solve the problem. So, in many circumstance~ managemcm of emotions is a pre.requisite to problem solving. Questions thnt explore the feeling or affective domain include the following: ■ How do )'OU fttH ■ Whnt emotions docs this rriggcrr ■ I'm interested in hearing more about your emotions. ■ Whnt feelings best describe your reaction! ■ Are you feeling .. . r The question "How do you feeJ!" is one way to introduce feelings and co encourage clients to explore the emotional components of thc.ir problems. Cognitive Domain (Thinking) setf-ta.lk: .Mental messages p8l$)1e give to t!lems.elve (e.g., -rm no good1. 132 How people think about their difficulties is often more important than the problem itself. An event thnt may be no big deal to one diem may represent a life-threatening crisis to another. Self-talk, or inner dialogue, refers to the mental messages we give oursclves. Ncg3tivc self-talk is associated with inaction and poor self-image. In contrast, positive self-talk builds conf,dence and is self-empowering, 1t moves people away from a victim mcntnlit)• of feeling powc.rlcss. It also enables individuals to deal with crises realistically, without self-imposed rigid and punishing demands. By seeking to understand how clients think about problems, counsellors can get valuable clues rcgnrding important issues, such as sclf-estccm, motivation, and irrational thinking. Subsequently, counsellors can directly chnllcnge clients' ncg3tivc self-talk. Sometimes counsellors can achieve quick and dramatic counscJling interventions by chnllcnging the rationality of the worrier. By offering factSi, challenging assumptions, and inviting clients to consider the rc3l probabilities of dreaded events. counsellors introduce much-needed critical thinking that may interrupt the worry cycle (She.bib, 1997. p. 81). This strategy is an esscntl31 clement of cognitive behnvioural counselling, which will be cxplor~ in Chapter 7. Herc arc sample questions thnt can prompt exploration of the cognitive area: ■ Whnt arc you thinking! ■ Whnt is the evidence for your belief? ■ How do )'OU know this to be true? ■ Whnt do you say to yourself about this problem? ■ Whnt does your "inner \'oice" say? Chap1er S ■ \Vhat messai;cs do you give yourself th3t are self-defeating! ■ \Vhat arc you tcJling yourself! Behavioural Domain Although it is important not to move too quid:J,., to work on problem sohting. an important patt of ,votk in the beginning phase involves interviewing clients to le3rn what they arc doing and not doing about their problems. Such information is important for assessment. It tells counsellors whether their clients arc active in seeking and working on solutions or whether they have become withdrawn and have given up. Some questions for exploring the behavioural area include the following: ■ \Vhat have you done? ■ \Vho cJsc is affected by this problem! ■ Can 't'OU identify what triz:crcd 't'our relapse? ■ How did you respond! ■ \Vhat did you do or say? ■ \Vhcn is the problem worse or better! ■ Has the way )'OU have been h3ndling your problem changed! SUCCESS TIP Changes in any of the lh(ee domains-feeling, lhinking, or behaviou(- will stimula te changes in the other two areas. For ex.ample, when a clien1 is able to alte( negative lhinklflg patter~ positive changes are mote likely with respect to thei( feelings and lheir behaviou(. (See Figure S. l). Questions for Problem Solving Questions can assist clients to think systematically about the sequenti31 steps involved in finding remedies to their problems. Questions of this type arc more appropriate when the problem h3s been fully explored. Some key template questions include the following: ■ \Vhat do 't'OU see as possible strategics for overcoming this problem? ■ \Vhat arc the costs and benefits of this a1ternativd ■ How would Figure 5.1 )'OU feel if you took this step? How would you feel if you did 00( act? The Three Domains Asking Questions: Tile Searc ll lor Meaning 133 ■ Wh.nt prevents 't'OU from caking action? ■ How can you overcome this barrier? ■ Wh.nt eJsc do you nttd to make it h3ppcn? ■ Wh.nt do you sec 3s 't'our first step toward ch3ngc? ■ How can you m3kc it (your go3J) happen! ■ Wh.nt strengths or resources will help you achieve 't'Our goal? ■ When will you start! SUCCESS TIP Avoid the eotrwnon tendency to move too ciuicidy to prOblem sotving. Make sure that the prot:,em has been fl.Aly expl0ted firSt and that clients have been given an opportun.ty to expmss and process their feelings. Questions for Evaluating Ongoing evaluation of counseJling outcomes and the counsclling rcl3tionship ensures that the work rem3ins on track. EwJuation enables counsellors and clients to trouble~ shoot relationship problems before they become cam.strophic. Evaluation also informs contract negotiation and revision. Some examples of questions th3t might initiate evaluation arc as follows: ■ How has our work met your expectations? ■ Looking back on our session, what were the things that you found helpful! Unhelpful? ■ How woukl you like things to be the same or different next time we meed ■ Wh.nt remains to be done? ■ Wh.nt ch.nnges would 't'OU like to m3kc with respect to the way we communicate? ■ On 3 scale of 1- 10 how w-ould you rate our time together? ■ How would you evaluate our work! At the end of 3n interview (or 3s a significant topic ends), the question "Wh.nt have we missed?" often yields surprisingly rich information. This question provides a last<hnncc oppommity for clients to t31k 3bout unexpressed issues and feelings. In addition, when clients have been ambivaJent about sharing some det3il~ this question m3y tip the scales in favour of sh.nring. 1t 3lso empowers clients by giving them control over content, and a final chance to make sure their nttds are on the table for discussion. Some variations of this question include the following: ■ Wh.nt eJsc do we nttd to discuss! ■ Wh.nt's left to explore! ■ H3vc we cove.r~ all that is important? ■ Wh.nt questions haven't 1 asked? In the following example, the counsdlor prompts the diem to examine the session: CounS(>IJOr. Our time is almost up. and I want to make sure I ha\'i":n '1 O\'fflool:.ed ~mp thin¥ t~t is import:uu 10 you. \Vh::u have we 1nissed! Client: ~e.lJ. v.--e h::n'i'n' t e"en be~-un to talk 3bout hoo• m't' di\'Ortt h:uth:u,~-00 my kids. In m:u,y W'3't'll. the,., ~,,e be,en the re:al victims. 134 Chap1er S > : •. Ne-ufoptasticity means that ouf brains are constantty irwOlved in f0tming new ne-ural pathways as well as pruning ones that are no looge-r used. Effective intel"Viewing can help 10 form a Mnew brain.· FOr' e-.xample, questions that focus on selling goats create neural pathways that strengthen the focus on moving forwatd and change. Questions targeting client str'e-ngths activate areas of the br'ain that stimulate positive emotions, and increase the oouro1tans.mitter serotonin, which is essential to a sense of well-being (Ivey, ""Y & Quuk, 2009>. Coun.se.U.or: I :l¥ret with you. It's verr important th::u Yi't, don't overlook them. Does it m::d.:e sense IO you 10 make th::u discussion pore o( our next meetin,a! I want to make- sure tilt-re is eoou~, time. Client: Yes. that makes Sense. Coun.seltor: Then let'!? make- th::u number one on our list for next time. Remember th.nt there are some risks to opening: up new nrca..s of discussion at the end of an imc.rview, panicularly if the topic involves strong emotions for the client. ln the preceding example, the counscllor suspected that this was a complex topic, so she ~to:I deferral to the next session. In such circumstances, thecounscllor might have been tempc:cd to :.lSlc further questions or to empathize. but these responses miaht have prolonged the interview bc\nnd the time 3wiJable. 1t is important to end the interview without Je3ving the client in a state of disrrcss. SUCCESS TIP Six Key Questions 1. What beings )(lu here IOday? 2. What a(e you( expectations of me? 3. What do I need to kOON abOul your situation? 4. What do )(lu mean by . . . ? 5. What did we accomplish? 6. What did we miss? QUESTIONING PITFALLS Asking questions is a skill. Faulty questioning may b ias answers, antagonize clients, or keep the interview at 3 superficial level Jn addition, insensitive questions that disregard clients' feelings or culture can leii.ve them feeling judged or abandoned. Poorly timo:I questions may rush the interview or frighten clients with demands for disclosure before trust has been established. Leading (Biased) Questions A leadina question suggest the "correct" answer b)• conveying a strong due about the 3nswer the interviewer would prefor to hear. The following ex3mples illustrate this pitfaU, leading CJJtStions: Aquev.ic. t11a1 suigests a preferred a11SWH (e.g.• ~ on't )1)tl think ourses.sia. W!ftl realt, ~ II today?"). "Don't you beJieve it's time you toolc care of yourseJf inste3d of putting 't'Our husband first!" "You lilce school, don't 't'ou?" Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 135 "Do )'OU really want to keep working for a man who trc3ts )'OU that way?" "You're not thinking of killing yourself, arc you!" C lients who have a h igh need to be liked, those who tend to be compliant, and those with dependency n eeds arc especially vulnerable to lC3ding q uestions. These clients are less likeJ,., to be assertive by disagreeing with their counsellors. How a question is wo rded can also dramatically change the answer. Asking your spir itual leader, "Is it a.JI right to smoke while praying?" may get a ver y d ifferent answer from asking, "Is it a.JI right to pray while smoking?" (Sudman & Bradburn, 1983, p. I). Counscllors may use lc3ding questions to camouOag:c their own ideas. For example, the counsellor who a.sics, "Do you think you should be doing that?" is probably sa ying, "I don't think you should be doing that." Leading q uestions tend to corner client~ as in the following interview excerpt, in which a co u nseJlor talks to a man about his mother: CounseUor. Gwi":n wh::u )'Ou\'t, been s:1yin~ it's t ime (or action. \Vouldn't )'OU ai.:re,e th:u allowina your mo ther to ll\'t, alone 3t home is not in 3n)'One's best interest! CUent: I su ppose you' re r!iht. CounseUor. 'Would you prefer to put her in 3 sen.OrS' home! CUent: I ~ll)•don't want t'O put her in a home. TI,::u v.-,oukln't be ri$:ht. CounselJor: Don't )'Ou think this mi,aht be easier on )Our family th3n taldni.: on the enormous probtems involved in movh)¥ her in with )'Ou! CUent: (Hes&atd.) I suppose )'Ou·re n~ht . But . . . Coun!l(>IJOr. (lntc·rrnpcm,g.) I h::n'e a list o( possible pl::.eeme:nt!l. Do )'OU w;,int to 1nak.e some calls no"-! It's C3SY to sec how the counsellor's agenda in the preceding encoume.r d iscounted the views and needs of the diem. By selectively emphasizing one aJte.rnntive, the coun.seJlor allowed the client little fTttdom of choice. Consider how the outcome might have been d ifferent had the counsellor used the following lead : Coun!l(>IJOr. Gwi>:11 wh3t you h::1,'t, bee!, s:iyintt. it seems you\~ re::iehed a point wilt-re it's t inlt' for action. What do )'Ou se,e as )'Our opt ions! Such a lead would have a.Jlowed the d iem to identify alternatives, such as arrang~ ing for in.-home care for his mother or inviting her to live with him. The counsellor's favoured aJte.r nntive docs not cont3minate the discussion. Counsello rs need to remind themselves that the solution belongs to the client and there may be considerable ambiva,. lcnce rcg3rd ing the alternatives. The counscllo r's role is to support the management of this amb ivalence by paying 3ttention to feelings, exploring the problem, and weighing alternatives. Excessive Questioning Although questions can be an important part of most inte.rvic:ws., excessive question,. ing can quickly leave clients feeling inter rogated and bombarded and, as a result, some clients fail to return for a sa:ond interview. Others become increasingly defensive and terse with their response~ particularly if they arc unsure of the purpose of the quc:s.tions. Excessive questionin g can overwhelm clients., IC3ving them frustrated, confused, and exhausted. Questions put co u nseJlors in control, and they remind the client who has power in the rcJationship. Some clients simp l)• do not respond well to questions. Counsellors may find that r3the.r than gcning more information, they arc obtaining less. For example, involuntary clients may c:xpc.ric:nce questions as an invasion of their privacy. As wcll, clients from some cultures may TC3Ct unfavourably to questions. In such circumstances, reliance on 136 Chap1er S CONVERSATION 5.1 STUDENT: Sometimes it leets as if an I do is ask Questions. I can't help thinkil'lg that if I were the client, I'd be really irritated. I don't want to le.ave clients fooling intefrogated, but ciuestioos seem to be 100 only way to get 100 information I need. Oo you agJee? TEACHER: You're rigt\t to be coocemed. There is a real dange-r that dients will beeome defensive if they feet cross-examined. By paying attention to the needs, feelings. and responses of individual dients, you wil be able to see if you are alienating 100m. Sometimes counselling works best if you avoid 0t minim.ize questions. for ex.ample, clients who have not yet developed trust in lheir counselJors may r&Sl)OOCI better in interviews vd\en questions are minimi:zed. Another drawback to aSki~ too many questions is that too much respons,ibdity foe the d,recti::,n and content of the interview can be left on your ShOuklers. This can be disempowering to, clients and can lead the-m to beCOtne overly dependent. STUDE:NT: But are there ways to ex.plOfe and get information TEACHER: Yes, there are a number of skill alternatives to Questions fOf' gathe-ri~ k'!foanation and makl~ asseS:StnMts. In some cases, pte-rnterview questionnaires can be used to gathe-r importanl information. Switching to a nonverbal mode btf using tools such as fliJ) charts, J)ictures, J)lay (with d'lildren), Of music can also be effectNe ways to eon~t 'Mth dients. Technk:lues such as ShOwing empathy, summariZing, usi~ S1:lence. and self~i:sclOS~g may be more effective ways of getting details, fac1s, and examptes. Empathy, fof e.xample, is a powerful counseni.ng tool that tells clients. that we undefs.tancl Of afe trying to aJ)J)reciate lheif feetrngs and perspectives. Empathic tesponses and s.ummafaes create an essential base of tfust btf ShOwing that counsellors are nonjudgmental and caJ)able of listening and understanding. In f&Sponse, clients often beeome mofe courageous and motivated to Shafe and explore. AJ)J)rOJ)ri.ate use of silence creates SJ)ace fof clients to speak. QuestioM are important fof effective interviewing, but you should try to add vaftely to your interviews by using a range of siuns. without asking questions? questions will frustrate the gools of the interview. Counsellors should be 3le.rt to signs th3t the.ir clients 3re reacting poorly to questions. For example, their clients' 3nswe.rs m3y become briefer, a dear sign of the.ir intention to be less cooperative. Clients 3fso may com, muniane their displC3surc nonve.rbally by shifting uncomfortably, grimacing, or 3\-erring eye contact. Some clients m3y refuse to 3nswe.r by becoming silent, but others ma,., be more outspoken with the.ir disapproval, saying, for instance, "I don't Stt the point of all these questions." Jf counsellors continue with questions when it is cJe3.r th3t their clients 3rc rejecting this approndi., se.rious d3mage to the counselling relationship m3y result. Con5tt1ucndy, it is important that counsellors 3re able to modify their approaches to reduce or eliminate questions. Sometime~ for example, an empathic response c3n 3chieve the s3me purpose 3S a question: Client: I just don't know what I'm ~-oinK to do. Slnce she le(t, l'\'e (eh lost 21nd unsure of what I should do with my l1(e. Coun.se.U.or (Choke I): \Vh:lt ::are some possib11itiesr CounS(>JIOr (Choke 2): Sounds 21s 1( )'Ou (eel 31131onc ::and u1ltert21in o( what l'O do next. Choice I seeks more inform3tion from the client about wh3t a.1te.rnatives he sees for him.self. This question moves the int~rview away from feelings to problem solving 3nd decision making. In Choice 2, the counscllor 3Clcnowledges the client's feelings as well 3S his indecision, and the response is much more likcJy to be perceived 3S supportive 3nd sensitive. Sometimes counsellors have to ask man,., questions. such as in dete.rmining eligibility for se.rvice or completing an intake (first) interview. One way to lessen the imp3Ct of excessive questions is to have periodic P3USCS to check how their clients 3re doing. For example, they might S3\', "I'm asking a lot of questions. How arc )'OU doing? I know it c3n be a bit overwhelming." Respectful comments such as these empower and involve clients in the process. Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 137 It is important for counscllors to remcmbe.r to balance questions with responses that confirm u nderstanding (summa.ries) and empathic responses that affirm sensitivity to feelings. \\:lhen q u estions arc dearly linked to the ngreo:1-upon purpose of the inte.rvicw (contract), clients are much more likdy to bc-coo~rativc, but if the questions nppenr meaningless or intrusive to the diem, resistance is likely. Asking questions is an appropriate way to g,et informa tion. Howeve.r, skilled cou nscllors have the ab ility to switch ton non-questioning mode when the situation warrants. The foUO\\,ing example shows some of the different options for exploring a client's an,;cr: Open Quesdon: \V~t happens when )'Ou ~et 21nar)'! Cl~ Q uESt.ion: When )'Ou 21re af)¥r)', do you become violent! lndittet Q uestion: r,n curious about how you handle )'Our 2111~-er. Self-dl$Clo11:ure: \Vhen l'rn a.ni r)', I :UW3yS wonder " -hat to do with it. Empathy: Sounds as thou$:h. in 21ddit1on to your anier, )'Ou also~,~ a lot o( poin. Silence: (Appropri21te si!e,~ 21vokls arousinK the d1ent's de(en«s. It Kives the client time to e>:preS.$ his or her feeli.n~il.) Contract: Perhaps we ea.n pause for a moment and dttide whether this is a iood tune to explore )'Our feel1n,a:-i of af)¥er. Directh~ : Tell rne rnore. Sentence completion: Use 2111 ineomplete se:nte:nee (se:ntenee stern) that pauses with 2111 expec12tion that the client will f'l.niilh the Sentence. Usl.dlly the client will f'lll the pause with his or her thou£;hts or (eelin~s. Herc are some examples: ■ It seems rhar urhen you become angry, you tend LO ••• ■ And you are feeling . ■ The mosi imporranr rhing f« you is ro . ■ If :,ott u-ere LO rell him tt-'har :,ott think, ,ou u,'Otdd . T h is tool enables counscJlors to control the process by p rO\tiding clients with stimulating prompts while ensuring th:.n the content comes from clients. Summ21ry: The theme i.n " -hat )'Ou a.re s:ayi1l{t seems l'O be a iltro1l{t (eelin¥ o( 21~r. P21r.1.phr21se: l.n otherwon:ls. )'Ou're a pe-rson who wi.11deal with )'Our21~r in sorne " 'ay. A ll of the preceding examples are potential counscllor responses, a nd C3ch has the potential to achieve the process gonJ o f angc.r exploration. They illustrate the range of choices that arc always available to skilled, versatile counsellors. SUCCESS TIP Consider switching to a no~questioning mode (1) to reduce lhe tone of inte(rogation and avoid the power s t ~ trap, (2) when client responses are guarded and defensive, (3) wtlen clients are not responchng to questions, (4) for el.Atural adaptation, and (5) to add variety to your interviews. Multiple Questions Multiple questions nrc two or more questions asked at the same time. ff the questions arc complementary, they are not problematic. A second q uestion ma)' be asked simul.tnnoously that embellishes o r clarifies the first: Counsellor (Ex21mple I): How did you feel about it! How did )'Ou (eel when he rejected you! 138 Chap1er S ln Example I, the second question does not detract from or contradict the first. Of course, the second question a1one would have sufficed. In contrast, the follo"'ing example illustrates how multiple questions can be confusing: Coun.~ellor (Ex::ample 2): How did )'Ou (e,el about it! Did h::mdlina the !lit"u::ation! )·OU see any other war of \Vith E.x3mple 2, both questions 3re potenti3lly useful, but n()( when they 3re 3sked 3t the same time. The client has to decide "'hich question to answer. Each "'ill take the interview in a different dir«tion: the first focuses on feelings while the second moves the discussion to the behavioural domain. At their worst, multiple questions can inundate 3nd assault clients with complex and conflicting: demands. Imagine if you were the client in the following interview: Coun.se.U.or: So. is there :l..11)1hifl¥ )'Ou ca.i, do! Do )·Ou think )'Ou mi,.i,t h:a"e mid heihow )'Ou (elt! Or 11\3)' be )'Ou see it di(ferentl)'. How lofl¥dO )'Ou think )'Ou ca.i, continue to h::anion! The counsellor ma)' be wen-meaning, but responses such 3s these complic3te matters 3nd m3y add to the client's confusion. As a rule, counseJlors need to curb any impulse to 3slc more than one question 3t 3 time. When thq• aslc a question, they should wait for the 3nswer before proceeding: to another question or topic. Irrelevant and Poorly limed Questions One way that counseJling inte.rvie"'s are distinguished from everyday conversations is that interviews have a definite purpose or intem. \Vhcn counsellors know the purpose of the interview, they are able to frame questions that suppon that purpose. Converse.I)•, counsellors "'ho are unsure of the purpose 3re more likely to ask random questions. Counsellors should have a purpose for questioning, and they should be prepared to share this purpose with their clients. They might offer 3 brief explan3tion, for example, "lt woukl heJp me to understand your situation better if I asked you some questions. This "'ill give me an ide3 of ho"' )'OU see things.'' Prc3mbles such as this inform the client of thecounseJlor's motives and procedures. When clients know what is happening, they are less like1)• to be defensive and more lilccly to support the process. Sometimes counsellors 3sk excellent questions but ask them at the wrong time, which IC3ds to inappropriate topic changes. A common error of this type occurs "'hen counsellors ask content questions after clients have expressed the.ir feelings: Client: I wa!l luriou!l with her. I ne\'er im::aained that 11\)' best friend Yi'OuJd be havina an :affair witl, my husband. 'We' ,..e been married for 10 )'elrS.. and I thou~t I could trust him. I (eel like a complete loot Counsellor: How d,d you llnd out the)' were se,ein& e:ich other! ln the preceding example, the counsellor's question ma)' be valid, but it is timed insensitively. Since the client has just risked expressing strong feelings, the counsellor should consider empathy 3S the preforred response. The next chapter addresses the critic31 skill of emP3thy. A second common error occurs when counsellors shift the topic "'ithoutexploring: beyond a superfici3l level This can happen for seve.ra1 re3sons. First, counsellors may be unskilled 3t probing 3 topic. Second, they may be overly cautious about probing, perhaps fearing that they will be invading their clients' privacy. Third, they may be fix3ted on problem solving, 3S in the following example: Client: We A,.iit all the time. Coun.se.U.or: How do you think )'Ou n,i~ht cut down on the O~hti.n~ Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 139 In this ex3mplc, the counsellor jumps to problem solving far too quickly. A better choice would have been questions to find meaning 3nd empathy to connect with fcel.ing.s. For example, the counsellor needs to learn what the client meant by "fight." Do they yd) and scream? Do they refuse to taJk to each other! Or is the.re physic.al conflict? Perhaps the best response choice w-ould be a probe ta~ting feeling~ such 3S "How do 't'OU fed about the constam fighting!" Why Questions \Vhy questions should be used C3utiousJ,., since they tend to be more thrc-3tening for clients if they arc perceived 3S 3slcing for justific3tion, or if the tone of the u1Jt,question communicates judgment, disapproval, or embedded advice. The question "Why don't you leave him?" may put a dient on the defensive with the implied mcs.saJ;c "You should leave." \Vh1questions ask people to explain 3nd justify the.ir bch3viour. Frequently, this requires a degree of insight th3t they simply do not have. In response, clients may make up answers or feel exposed and stupid for being unable to answer the question. Even when judgment is not intended, "when someone asks why you did something, 't'OU might fed she or he is judging you for not being 3ble to handle the situ3tion more effectively" (Hill, 2004, p. 121). \Vhy questions may provoke defensive rc:.lcrions, including 3voidance 3nd attack because "m:.ln't' clients 3ssoci3te u1hy with a past experience of be.ing grilled" (lvey, Jvey, & Zalaquctt, 2010, p. 103). The following excerpt illustrates: Client: I e2n't rel.:ue to my father :10,.,rnore. He eannot see that I !"K'ed my independence. CounS(>IJOr. \\'hy don't you just move out :tnd live on )'Our own! C lient: Impossible. I h:ave h'i'<> n\On' 't'i':::lrS of rolJe~~. and I ean 't af(ord it. CounS(>IJOr. \\'hy not just tell him i'lic:M• you (eel! C lient: h'se:uy for 't'Ou t'O say. but you just don't unders:tand. K3dushin (1997) suggests asking urhar instead of urh, questions. For c:x3mplc, "What prevents 't'OU from sharing 't'OUr fttlings?" is more helpful th3n "Why don't you slurc your feelings?" The first question (what) seems to accept that there arc expl3nations and rt':.lsons for thedicnt's behaviour, whert'3s the second question (why) sccms to dcm3nd justification. TAILORING THE INTERVIEW TO THE CLIENT When Clients Do Not Answer Questions Sometimes clients do not 3nswer questions, or their answers 3re supe.rficial. To decide how to proceed in such cases, counsellors need to consider some of the reasons why clients miaht be reluct:.lnt to respond. Questions Are Not Understood Clients m3y not understand questions because they have not heard them. For example, clients may be hard of he:.uing or deaf, or coun.seJlors may be speaking too softly, or b3ckground noise interferes. As wdl, clients may not have been listening. In 3ddition, counscJlors may be using ,vord~ phrase~ meta.phors, 3nd expressions that 3re not part of the client's repertoire. Effective counsellors arc able to 3dapt their idiom3tic language and voice volume to meet their clients' needs and expectations. They 3\-oid technical terms and jargon, p3rticularh• when communi.cating with clients from different cultures. Furthermore, counscJlors are role models for their clients, and one of the interesting :.lnd positive outcomes of counselling is that clients may lc-3rn how to listen. \Vhen counsellors demonstrate effective listening and responding skills. clients tend to imitate them. Alte.rnativdy, counsellors can tC3ch clients to use listening tools. For example, to encourage clients to summari:e, leads such 140 Chap1er S as this can be used: "Please tc11 me in your own words what your understanding of our agreement is. 1 want to make sure we both have the same unde.rstanding." The Purpose of Questioning Is Unclear Clients have a riaht to lcnow why questions arc be.ina asked, and they arc more apt to respond when the purpose is clear. CounseJlors may simply sane the purpose in an explanatory sentence: "The reason I am asking this question is . .. f' However. if counseJlors do not have a valid reason for aslcina particular question~ they should not ask them. Questions arc crucial for accomplishing the goals of counsellina. but they must be used cautiously, either to obtain important information or to direct the interview to relevant channels. The Answers to Questions Are Unknown Some questions are difficult for clients to answer. For example, the questions may call for insight and explanations that arc beyond the clients' current lcvcJ of undcrstandina. Sometimes clients are unable to articulate the.ir ideas and inner feelings. Learnina disabilities arc also a factor for some clients. \\:'hen clients don't have answer~ "why" questions arc particularly frustratina. Client Privacy Is an Issue Jf clients arc concerned about the.ir privacy. they may say (verbally or nonvc.rbally), "That's not an issue 1 care to explore." They may change the topic abruptly. or they may respond with silence. Some clients resist questions because of prior expc.ricnccs of beina embarrassed, interrog:itcd, or put on the Spo(. Moreover, the.ir cultural norms may disc:ourai;c questions of an't' type, or they may restrict the areas in which questioning is appropriate. In some situations, clients withhold answers because they fear that their answers will not be understood or that they will be judg~. At other time~ they arc simpl)• 00( ready or able to address the issues the questions raise. Unresolved Relationship Issues It will be difficult to proceed with counscllina if there is outstanding tension or conflict in the relationship. Good question~ insightful emP3thy, accurate summaric~ even warmth and ca.ring may be rejected because they are filtered through the relationship discord. In such situations, it may be a bener choice to shift the discussion to address the conflict. Response Choices When Clients Don't Respond to Questions First, counsellors should honour the rights of clients to control areas of discussion and levcJs of inti• macy durina any phase of the rcJationship. Using the contractina proccs~ counseJlors can respect clients' wishes not to explore the particular area and shift the discussion to less threatening content. Neve.rchcJcs~ some anxiety is normal and po(entially productive when difficult topics arc being addressed, so counsellors should not automatically shift the topic when anxiety arises. Second, counsellors can evaluate whether they have given their clients enough time to answer. Some clients arc slower to respond, and counsellors ma)' misinterpret the.ir silence as reluctance to speak. Third, counseJlors might tactfully ask clients what is preventing them from answcrina. Sometimes trust issues impede candor. Candid discussion of barriers usuaJly increases trust, if counsellors are nondefcnsivc. Moreover, by remaining nondcfensive, counsellors demonstrate their capacity to be open and nonjudgmental. They show their ability to handle tough issues without retaliating. As well, when questions target sensitive or private information, counseJlors can express empath)• regarding how hard it miaht be to share such personal material. Fourth, counseJlors can simply stop askingqucstions. Jf they continue to ask questions even though clients refuse or dismiss them, unfortunate con5tt1uences will likely result. Moreover, under pc.rsistcnt questioning clients may become increasing!)• frustrated, angry, and resistant, or they may feel inadequate because they have been unable to meet their counsellors' expectations. Table 5.2 summa.ri:es conditions for using questions appropriately. Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 14 1 TABLE 5.2 Guideli nes for Questioning 00R't: Do: Bombard clients with questions. Satance and add variety to lhe interview with a range of Othe< Skills. As.k more than one q uestion at a time. Pause aftef ead'I question to gtve clients time to answet. Re~mbef' that summary and empathy responses are important to confirm understanding, use leading questions to control clients and theit answe<s. use whyquestions, as they usuatty imply blame or c,oovey j udgment. As.k questions unleSS you have a feasoo to need. 0t a right to have. lhe answet. As.k a ~ se-ries of closed questions. Ask dOsecl q uestbns when you need to confirm spedfi::: facts 0t ideas. Ask questions ooe at a time. Respect eultutal no(ms and individual style'S that may make certain Questions k\approp(aate. Ask questions for a specific pur(X)Se. Ask open questions to gtve clients maximum COOt(C,. Managing the Rambl ing Interview A challen,;e th3t all counsellors face is how to focu s and control ove.rly verbose clients, who ramble from topic to topic with u nnecessary or ovenvhdming detail. Significant ly, the thinking patterns th3t lead clients to verbose w3nde.ring in the interview may be the s3me P3tte.r ns that prevent them from h3ndling their problem siru3tions nppropriatdy. Consequ ently, it is importnnt that counsellors take some responsibility for m3nnging the interview p rocess. In this w3y, clients lenrn 3bout sequencing and managing problem exploration 3nd resolution. He.re are some strntegy choices: ■ Since open questions tend to elicit detailed responses, counsellors can use more closed questions. ■ Identify the p roblem. For ex3mple, the co unseJlor might make a comment such as, " You're giving me a lot of inform3tion , and ( ,.,,.,mt to m3ke sure I don't miss an\•~ thing. So, can J h3\-e your permission to focus on one point at a time?" ■ Aslc q u estions that chtdlenge clients to be b rief and focused, such 3S. "ff J asked )'OU to summar i.!e your siruation inn sente.nce o r two, wh3t would )'OU S3y?" ■ Monitor the use of nonverbal cues that might enco urage wandering, such as an 3ttentive posrure, head nods, 3nd paralinguistic cues (e.g., "Go on," "Yes"). ■ Be candid with the client by using a sc:ntement such 3S "Jt seems to me that whenever we st3.rt to talk about a topic, we end up w3nde.ring off the subject. \\:fh3t do you think might be hnppeningf' ■ When clients m3ke innppropri3te or premature shifts, immediately refocus on the topic be.ing 3ddressed. Jt m3y be helpful to let the client know why )'OU 3re doing this with a comment such as "I'm going to slow )'OU down a bit. I want to m3ke sure we fully explore the issue of .. . before we move on. If we stay with one is.sue nt n time, we are less likdy to miss important work." ■ Identify time constraints. Set time limits on the intentiew 3nd remind clients of the interview time remaining. Although it may be necess3ry to cut some clients off, it is important th3t this be done in a way that the client does not feel dewJued o r overpowered. Counsello rs need 142 Chap1er S to monitor and control their own negative fcclings, such 3S irritation and frustration that may be e\'oked by their verbose clients. ff this is not done, it will be difficult for them to communic3te 3 genuinely caring tone and empathic attitude. SUCCESS TIP I.n the beginning phase, clients often need an unintefrup(ed opportunity to tell theif stOr'y and Shafe their feelings. ContfOlling and focusi.ng the intel'\liew too quickly may impede and negate the cathartic beoofit to( a client that is made possible btf attentive listening. Interviewing Youth The period from puberty to young adulthood spans ~12 ye3rs 3nd is ch3racte.ri:ed by enormous biological, psychologicnl, 3nd S<>cinl development, 3S well as significant changes in cognitive devdopment and the brain. Even under the best of circumstances, it is often a trying time with rapidly ftuctu3ting emotions, insecurities, and angst 3S people confront the challenges of developing an adult identity. These ch3Jlenges 3re compounded for 't'OUth in the social service system who could bede3ling with 3ddition3J issues such 3S fnmil't' b reakdown, homelessness, poveny. drug abuse, physical and se>.."Ual 3buse, mental disorders, and conflict with the legal system. Like nil groups, the.re is no one-size.fits-all script for working with youth. Although they ma't' be dealing with common problems 3nd challenges, each young person is unique and the counselling relationship must honour these individual differences. P3ying attention to the counselling relationship m31ces this possible. The core conditions (uncondition3J positive regard, empathy, and genuineness) discussed in Chapter 3 of this text are the foundation for this relationship. Youth may come to counselling with considerable suspicion so counsellors need to be patient, c3lm, and consistent during wh3t might be a lengthy beginning phase of trust building. Past rcJntionships where trust has been \'lol3tcd ma,.• leave youth justifiably suspicious 3nd cautious of the motives of others, including wcll.-mcaning counsellors. Counsellor consistency and predictability provides structure that increases 3 sense of safety for the youth. The contracting process C3n be used to explore 3nd understand the youths' neo:ls, what thq• w3nt from you, 3s well as individual preferences. Open discussion to achieve cl3rity on the role of the counsellor and the goals of counselling, 3S well ns the limits of confidemiality, helps to reassure 't'outh th3t there are no hidden agend3s. Youth may present with behaviours that don't make sense. Intense reactions to seemingly innocuous triggers, resistance to simple rules, anger, acting-out behaviours, 3nd an in3b ility to make simple decisions in the.ir own best interests m3y signal 3 history of traum3. Youth who distrust the sincerity or commitment of the.ir counseJlors ))I) BRAIN BYTE The prefrontal cortex (behind the forehead) is a majof area of the btain responsi~e f0r fegutatrng behaviour, making good judgment chOices, and predicting the outcome of behaviout It also ptays a paft in fegulating emotions and sexual ufges. It is the last afea of the brain to f-.Aty develop, with full maturation delay&d until earty adullhOOCI. As a fesu1t, adolescents are more likely to ac1 imp-.Asivety and to experiment with drugs and high ri.sk 0r sensation seeking behaviouf <Ashwell, 2012). Compounding the problem is the fact that dfugs such as aitOhol compcomise the pce-frontal cortex., fufthef limiti~ its ability to support effective decision making. Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 143 may test che.ir rcfotionships repetitively by questioning motive~ eng3ging in provocn,. tive behaviour, and exhibiting outright expressions of hostility tow-ard their workers. This requires chat workers be exceptionnJly patient and resilient and not cake their clients' actions personally. A trauma.-informed approach to youth recognizes that these behaviours and reactions serve a self-protective purpose, and counseJlors need to cake time to cry to understand these clients in the context of their trauma. This underscores the importance of giving )'OUth time to "teJI che.ir stories" and the criticaJ importance of counsellors letting them know chal their stories have been heard. Active listening skills, in particular empathy, are crucial in this process. On the othe.r hand, excessive questioning can fed intrusive, and it ma)' unde.rmine the intended collaborative gonJ of the reJationship. Table 5.3 offers additionaJ tips for interviewing youth. Indigenous youth may be deaJing with significant issues of marginali!ation, including a system involving workers who arc typically Caucasian. An anti-racist approach such as the one described by Hick (2010) demands that workers "change their own awareness and procedures, and social reJations and systems that operate, both ove.rtly and covenly, to perpetuate racism" (p. 267). As pan of chis, counseJlors should activcl't' explore how they can support the use of Indigenous spiritual and healing practices. Youth can be an incredibly satisfying population to ,vork with, as there is great potential for shifts and chani;cs in their lifestyle that could result in major positive movement. A strcngth~bascd approach shifts the focus from dcfteits, problem~ and idemifying what is wrong to collaborative relationship where the emphasis is on helping clients take control by utili!ing pc.rsonaJ, community, and family strengths. \Vayne Hammond (2015), President of Resiliency Initiatives Canada, emphasizes that children can be resilient and grow, even thrive, when faced with adve.rsity and that our approach should cmphasi: e hope, solutions, and possibilities. He Sll)'S that "those who embrace a strength-based perspective hold the bcJief that children, youth, and the.ir families have strengths, resources, and the ability to recover from adversity (as opposed to emphash.ing problem~ vulnerabilities, and deficits)." TABLE 5.3 Success Tips for Interviewi ng Youth Don't get drawn into powet str'uggleS. Maintain self-.awar'eness and a nol'lfudgmental attitude rega,di~ is.sues such as dr'&SS, hair, and txxly piercings. Avoid pmssuriog youth to make d'langes they are not ready fOI", as lhis is Wkety to evoke r'esistance. Pay close attention to d'langes in baseline (established pattems of behaviour) as lhey may sigoal increased stress Or' suicide risk. Seek youth input in goal setting and decision making to rnc,ease the likelihood 1r.at they will engage in and susiai"I cha~. Be friendly and wa,m. but ramember you are oot their' perSOoal Mend. Avoid ltyi"lg to be "with ir b-f adopting 100 language, maMerisms, and dr'ess of lhis group. It's 001 expected; it may 001 be respected. Remember that what may seem to be "no big deai- to )'Ou may be a majot c,isis to 100 youth. What is important is how they see and define the problem. Don't assume heterosexuality. Support and eoltabOtate with Other prolessionalS whO may be invclved with you( d ient. Social media is a big part ot most teens· lives. lOOk for op(X)rtunilies to discuss safety issues (e.g., the dangets ot ·sextiog·). Etlcoutage clients to utilize apptopriate online r'&SOur'ces to assist them to undersaand is.sues rn 1t1eir lives. 144 Chap1er S Interviewing and Counselling Seniors Canadn's 6 million seniors are a very diverse population. lntc.rvicwing and counselling with this group requires consideration of a large number of variables. In addition to the usuaJ cultural and personality difforcnccs that define any group. counsellors will w-nnt to consider factors that are significant for seniors, including ph)•sicaJ health, cognitive ability, economic status, famih•, and community supports. ?l.•fason and Paul 3n' lifeJonK friends in their early se,'i":lnies.. ?l.•fason is physically ::.etl\'t, 2nd enjo)'!I spend!~ time with his wife 2nd six $tr3.ndchildren. Paul uses 2 walk«. lwd in a l<,r1~,term c:ire facilit)·, 2nd is dependent on medk2tion for a vuiet)' o( llt::31th i$$UCS indudinads:tbetes,. Parkinson' sdi:sease, and depress.On. P2ul in"~ed wiselr and is AMneidilly independent wtule ?l.•fason continues to \\'Ork pc:ut,tin~ in orde-r t'O ,~t his basic needs. Ch:.dlenges and problems fucOO b)• seniors can be discmpowcring. As with any grout; the gooJ of counseJling is to assist them to restore or sustain elements essential to an empowered life including independence, freedom of choice, and an opportunity to pursue ,;oaJs and dreams. All of the principle~ values, and counsclling strategies discussed in this book arc still appropriate when working with seniors. As always., flexibility in the choice of skills is cs.sentiaJ in order to accommodate individuaJ difference. Counsellors who work with seniors need to be exceptionally empathic. They need to invest considerable effort to understand life issues that they have not 't'et faced. For example, the neo:I for a senior to move to assisted living ma)', in the face of diminishOO capacity and failing health, seem seJf-evident and necessary, yet it is met with considerable resistance. This resistance must be understood from the perspective of the client's emotions which have been aroused by the implications of the multiple losses associate with the prospect of mO\'lng. Empathy and patience provide an opportunity for the client to express and process these emotions. Table 5.4 provides further success tips for interviewing and counseJling seniors. Senior Abuse When interviewing seniors, counseJlors should be alert to the possibility of abuse. Senior (dder) abuse includes a wide range of problematic issues induding: physical assault, sexual abuse, over/under medication, neglect, denial of personal rights such as the right to practice one's religion, threats., emotionaJ abuse, and harassment. It may come from stran,;crs who target seniors, caregiver~ or in any setting providing service, but it is most likdy to come from someone known to the senior, usuaJly a family member. Neglect in care facilities may occur as a result of inadequate staffing or training. ln recent years, onlinc predators have targeted seniors and have successfully duped many of them out of their life SU\tings. Counsellors need to be fully familiar with the.ir legaJ and professional responsibilities with respect to elder abuse. Sometimes the abuse is a criminal offence (e.g., assault, theft, and uttering threats) and protection and invcstig3tion arc subjcct to the jurisdiction of the criminal code. The Canadian CMrrer of Righu and Freedoms offers protection ag3inst discrimination. There is no spccifte legisJation in Canada that deaJs \\'lth the rights of seniors but each province has enacted its own laws regarding issues such as guard~ ianship (sec Canadian Centre for Elder Law, 2017) for details on provinciaJ legislation. Counsellors should look for dues that suggest abuse such as: ■ Signs of neglect: shaggy appearance, malnourishment, lack of personal hygiene, and be.ing left unbath~ ■ Injury: unexplained or untreated W'Ouods, blade eye~ or bruises Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 145 TABLE 5.4 Success Tips for Interviewing and Counselli ng Seniors • Adapt fot hearing problems. Minimize noise, and if you need to talk IOudet, take ex.tta precautions to insure confidentiality. • MOdify the k'lte-rview as necessary to accotM1odate vision and m::>bility ptoblems.. for' e.xample, ptovicle any written material in a larger font. Ens.ufe that off.ce fumitufe is n01 a ba«iet or an obsiacle to the client. • Be careful with physical contact FOr' example, a firm hands.hake may injure someone with fragile bOOes. • If your client has cognitive impairment, keep ii simple, speak slO/dy, summarize, use repetition, and simple and focused questioos. • Altow time f0t the client to reflect and ptocess. Pictures can be used as memo,y cues. • Focus on empowennent. Adopt counsem~ strategies that gtve clients conuOI and cOllabOr'ative in\(ll\letnent in decision maki~. • Adopt a strengttrs-based approad'l lhat assumes capacity, not incapacity. A client may have vision impairment, but this does not mean that he Or' She is unable to make independent decisions. • Ext,l0te and understand the events and life experiences lhat have shaped lhe values and WOtld view of dients. • Adapt counsem~ strategies to tne cultural n0tms, values, and beliefs of 100 client Facilitate life revie~ that help seniors make sense of their lives. Be open to discussioos tr.at invcive spirituality. Use Mr.: Miss.; or ·Mrs.: unle'Ss you are k'lvited to use first names. Be sensitive to gender-r'elatect issues.. Eliminate age inapprop(aate jargon or unfamiliar acronyms. • When \\()rking 'Mth fanilies. talk directly to the Older person, 001 tlvough other faintly membe-rs. Similarly, wtlen using a translatOr', maintain eye contact with 100 client and speak to lhem, 001 about lhem. • Remember, some seniors may be meeting social/emotional needs llvough their retationShip with a counsetot. This factOr' may add tnOr'e ti.me to the interwew. However, oldet dients may have le'Ss energy, so avoid lengthy sessions that cause fatigue. Use empathy to convey unclerStanding, but be careflA that empathy does 001 invade the clients' need fOr' privacy as they may not be comfortable 'Mth excessive intm3cy with a stranget. Be sensitive to clues (e.g., bruising or unexplained injury, changes in baseline behaviolX in mood Or' social involvement. lack of hygj,ene) that 100 client may be a 'Jictim of negtecl, Or' physical, emotional, sexual, and financial abuse. Be alert to 100 facl that depression, soci'.al a~ty. and multiple IOSSes may trigger thoughts of suicide. Ooo'I be afraid to ask the •intent question· (see Chaptet 9). Listen. There i:S much to learn frOO'l the acquired wisdOO'l of seniors. 8 8 See Chapter 11 f0t strategies for WOrki~ with seniors who have dementia. ■ Behavioural changes: withdrawal, depressio n, defensiveness. and pcrsonaJity changes ■ FinanciaJ changes: altering a will o r power of attorney, large cash withd rawal~ and exploitation by unscrupulous business ■ Unsafe living conditions Seniors, even when asked, may be very reluctant or unable to disc.lose that they are vie.rims o f abuse. This ma'>' occur because of shame, o r fear of the consequences, o r a desire to protect family members from legal con.sequences. ln the following example, a social worker notices that her client, age 8 I , has a blade eye. Socbl \Vorker. I ean ~ th::u yo ur eye is sv.'OIJen. Client: It' s no thin&Socbl Worker. Ho w d,d it happen! Client: I must h:3,ee bumped into a door o r sornethi1l{t. I re:311)' don' t reme.mbe-r. Soci31 \Vorker. \Vas your h usband with )'Ou when it h::lppened! Client: Like I 53,.,J, it's nothinK co v.'Orr)' about. Soci31 \Vorker. I'm wo nderina i( )'Ou (eel s:.(e when )'Ou 2re 2lone with him. Client: The l2sc ft'\\•yeu s h::t\'e no t bee., easr for him . He really is a 1t(JO(I nun. But. since his stroke. tilt-re are times when . . . . (Long prawe.) Soci31 \Vorker: You care for your h usband, and it sounds like )'Ou do n't w:mt l'O cause hitn an'>' trouble. 146 Chap1er S Client: I don't know wh:u I'd do without him. Soda] \Vorker: Sure, but it's also important that )Our nt<tds are rnet. You need to be 2ble to (eel sa(e in ourov,m home. Marbe, "~•re 211 a point where both o( )Ou could use some extr:i support. (n the example, the social worker proceeds with considerable p3tience and tact while gently maintaining the trust that will set the stage for a referral to appropriate follow-up and support se.rviccs. Each province and city will have its own resources chat can be accessed by seniors for support and protection including police, social se.rvice a,;cncies, hea.Jth authorities, shelters, community care facilities, and other ori:anizations chat offer spccia.1i!cd se.rviccs for seniors. Cross-Cultural Interviewing CounscJlors nttd to be careful chat their counseJling and questioning methods arc 00( cukura.11)• biased. For example, cukura.J groups diffe.r profoundly in the way they react to questions. When attempting to relate effective!)• to members of other culture~ coun,se.llors need to avoid stereotyping and ovcri;:cnerali!ing. 'W ithin a culture, an individual may subscribe to all, some, or none of the cultural norms. Following are some points to consider: ■ Clients with histories of oppression may tend to be overly compliant during the interview. Consequemly, closed questions such as "Do )'OU understand!" may be answe.red "yes," when in fact the client docs not understand. Open questions arc preferable. ■ Use sea.ff or interpreters who spc3lc the immigrant client's language. \Vhen using an inte.rprcccr, look at the client when the inte.rprcccr is translating. ■ \Vhcn langua,;c skills are limited, pay careful anemion co nonverbal cues. ■ Some cultures may react neg3tivcly to question~ or they miW't find some questions on parciculnr topics intrusive. ■ Speak slowly, repeat or summari!e often, and allow frttauem pauses. Sometimes \•isua.J or written cues will assist communication. Use simple langua,;c and minimi!e jargon and idioms. Spc3king louder will not hcJp. BEYOND THE SURFACE: INTERVIEWING FOR CONCRETENESS The Need for Concreteness Concreteness is a te.rm used to me3sure the clarity and spccifteity of communication. le is "a way to ensure chat general and common experiences and feelings such as depression, anxiety, an,;cr, and so on arc defined idiosyncratically for each diem" (Cormier & Cormier, 1985, p. 48). \Vhen communic3tion is concrete, aJI participants share an Ivey, Ivey, 2.alaqueu. and Quirk (2009) teported lhat neutoscientists have found that 100 stmss of poverly, oppression, sexism, and racism can create unhealthy and damaging lew!IS ot COr'lisd in the brain, which negal.M!ly impac1 netXal developtnent in areas of the brain associ".ated with language concreteness: Atermused to musuf! the clarity ud spetifdy d communflli>n. and memory. This unde-rscofes the im(X)rtance of counse~ IOr's sup(X)rting social action initiatives to combat oppression. Counselling can atso assist clients to explOr'e ways that they can mitigate 100 tc»6c darnarge from mafginalization. including ways to de.al with oppressive systams. Asking Questions: Tile Searell lor Meaning 147 understanding of words, phrase~ idC3s, feelings. and behaviours. 'W ith sclecto:I probing skills. counsdlors assist clients to provide necessary definition and detail. Counsellors also need to model concreteness b)• ensuring that their ex-pres~ ideas and feelings are dear and specific. (n addition, they need to remain aJert to signs (verbal and nonverbaJ) that their clients may be assigning different meanings from tho.sc intended. When client communication lacks concretenes~ counsellors can use interviewing skills to raise it to the desired level Figure 5.2 outlines various strategies counsellors can use to achieve concreteness.. Probing for concreteness is necessary for the following reasons: ■ People see and experience et-enu differemt,. \\:'hen someone describes a problem or shares a feeling, there is a natural tendency to make assumptions based on our own prior learning and experience. \Vhcn a client asks a counsellor if he knows how she feels, the counsellor may automatically answer "yes" without funhcr inquiry or clarification. Even though personal experience can hdp them appreciate the problems and feelings of client~ counsellors risk communication breakdowns if they neglect to explore their assumptions for accuracy. Active listening enables them to understand the experiences of others with less risk of contamination. ■ The meaning of urords and ideas is •~Y much influenced 17:, factors such as culture or history. Although people may have links and similarities in their experiences and common human need~ everyone is unique. All people have different frames of rdercnce based on their learning and experience. Consider the images that a word such as anger miWlt evoke for various people. One person might vividly rccaJI an abusive childhood, in which anger always led to someone getting hun. Another might visuali:e screaming and hurtful words, while someone dse thinks of withdrawing and saying nothing. To a 12.-year-old, 30 might seem like old age, but to a man in his late 80~ 70 is young, Similarly, a joke may be pe.rccivcd as humorous by some p«>ple but provocative, insulting. or sexist by others. Clitnt Statement/ Respanse • c- Quesljc)ns • - Explore ...... Figure 52 148 Chap1er S Strategies for Achieving Concreteness ■ ma, Jargon and idiom cc,nfu.se dienu. Questions must be dC3.r and understandable to the diem. Like many other profcssionaJs, counsellors 3nd their work settings h3ve their jargon, consisting of abbrcvi3tions, distinctive ,vord~ and phrases th3t arc commonly understood by the people who work in the ficld. This jargon allows for a quick shorthand flow of communication and helps to define activities and routines precisely. Unfortunately, jargon is often used inappropri3tc1y with clients who do not undc.rstand it, 3S in the following example: Coun.seltor: I'm assuminK th::u this ii the flrst time th::u you\'t, K(Jne throuah the intake process. A(ter we eomple1e your app, I ean refer you to an appropri::ue oonununily resource. A new client may h3vc no ide3 wh3t is mC3nt by the terms inrake process and co~ muniry re.source or the 3bbrc-.•iation app. Too cmb3.rrasscd to 3sk, such a diem m3y be left feeling demoralized, stupid, and incaP3blc. Non.assertive clients frequently respond to jargon by acquiescing or pretending that they undcrst3nd when they h3ve no idC3 what h3s been S3id. ■ Messages are ofr.en unclear, incomplete, or ambiguous. Important information ma)' be mis.sing. Sh3.rcd understanding between two people is possible onh• when c3ch p3rticipant understands a message in the w3y th3t the sender intended. ■ People may lack ,he tocabulary 10 express ,heir ideas preci.sefy. \\:fhen langu3ge abilities arc limited, it is difficult to communicate idC11.S 3nd feelings. ■ People may be unatmre of ,heir feelings. Questions c3n stimulnte thinking 3nd bring clients' 3ttcntion to areas and feeJings that they m3y not h3ve considered. ■ Communication may be .superficial. \Vhen counscJlors move too quickly without exploration of key ideas and feelings, the interview is likely to remain on a surface level, and it m3y quickly run out of ste3m. He.re's 3n example: Client: I lee.I stron{tly about ii. Coun.~ellor: I'm not Surprised. From wh::u that W:l.)'? )OU h::t,'t, be<en ~yin&. who wouldn't (eel The counseJlor is supportive but docs not explore further to find out how the client is feeling. This client hints at feeJings but gives no information about their precise narurc. Unless the counsellor probes further, assumptions 3nd misunderstanding arc the likely outcomes. Probes for concreteness propel the interview from 3 superftei31 level of discussion to 30 intimate lcvcl that requires a deeper investment from eve.ryone involved in the inte.rview. Chapte.r 2 defined the illusion of work concept as a kind of implicit p3rmership between counsellors and clients. In this 3.rrangemcnt, counscllors permit clients to avoid the P3in and struggle that 3rc often associated with growth, while counsellors 3Void the risk that purposeful challenge cnt3ils: \Ve h3VC all developed thec3pac:it)• to engage in convcrs3tions which arc empty 3nd which h3vc no mc3ning ... \\:lorkers h3\-e reported helping relationships with clients that have SP3nncd months, even years, in which the worker 3fways knew, dttp inside, th3t it was all illusion. (Shulman 2009, p. 154) ■ Content alone does nor full1 communica,e meaning. A counscJlor can casil't' miss important information by failing to notice the underlying emotional or personal content in the words. Counsellor Reluctance to Probe One distinguishing characteristic of cxcmpl3ry profcssion31 interviewers 3nd counselJors is their c3pac:it)• to be comfortable with any topic. Effective interviewers and counscJlors arc learners, 3nd they recognize that the best te3chcrs 3rc their clients. This means having the courage 3nd assertiveness to ask Asking Questions: Tile Searell lor Meaning 149 diff,cult questions about private matters. If counsellors have personnJ needs to avoid certain topics o r if they are fearful that the discussion miWlt unleash strong diem emotion~ they miaht hold bade to meet the.ir own neo:ls to keep the interview pleas.ant. At the same time, co unseJlors need to lcnow when to back off and respect their clients' right to declare some topics off limits. Probing too deeply o r movina too fast may result in clients revealing a grc3t dC31, but having done so. they may react adversely. They might foci violated and not return to future session~ or they miWlt put up barriers to protect against further unwanted inquiries. To be ethical, counsellors must question wisely, explorina onh• those maners that are rcJevant to the work and fit their competence and rrnining, Thu~ asking clients for more concreteness requires that counsellors arc willina to invest time and energy to listen. Client Reluctance Some thoughts may be private, and lack of relationship rrust may preclude full disclosure. For example, people fearing judgment or ridicule may tcll others what they thinle thq• want to hear, or what they believe will result in accept:mce. lndividunJs may also distort or exngi;erate messai;es because of experiences. Emb3rrass..mem, fear, uncertainty, taboos about taking help, and simple mistrust of the interview process, including suspicion about the motives of the interviewer, present natural b3rriers to shnrina information. For some people, talcina hcJp from someone else suggests dependency and we3Jcnes.s, which may result in feelings of inadequacy. None of this means that the interview relationship is dysfunctional. In relationships, everyone must decide how much, when, and with whom they are willina to reve3J persona] thouahts and feeJings. Everyone differs in the degree to whidi. they are comfortable with disdos..ing intimate thouahts and feelings. Restraint and self-censorship of some ideas and feelings are normal and necessary. Some people prefer to remain private, sharina linle o r nothing. Others open up very slowly and only with people whom they deepl)• trust. C ulrural norms may aJso influence what individuals arc willing to share. Clients often view co unseJlors and intervie,.nrs as authority figures, and they tend to relate to them b3scd on their prior experiences and imaaes of people in power. Even though thecoun.seJlor may have very little real authority, what is important is the perception o f the client that the counsellor has power. Probes for concreteness arc invitations to clients to trust their counsellors by revealing thoughts that they miaht prefer to keep hidden. Shulman (2009) suggests that the same sodct:.d taboos that inhibit open discussion o f sensitive topics also affect helpina relationships. Among the taboos that Shulman identifies is reluctance to tn1k about sex, money, dependency, loss., and authority. To Shulman's list of common tabooscould be added discussions about spiritual issues and hC31th, as wcll as others that vary between people and between c ultures. SUCCESS TIP Compete-nt intervievdng requires cu(iOSity and a willingness to learn. This beeomes even more important when counsellors have personal and prolessional experience with the issue on the table. Unless c o u ~ monitOr' and control their assumptions, they are vurter-at:,e to assuming they kOOw thei( client's situation without needl"lg to be told. Strategies for Ach ievi ng Concreteness Let Clients Know the Purpose Counsellors should probe for understanding only in those arc3s that support the purpose o f the counselling relationship (contract). \Vithout a dear contTilCt, the counsdlina interview is more likely to be haphazard and random. However, in the beginning, it ma)' be necessary to give clients some time to tell their story. When counsellors have a nttd for information o r if they wish to 150 Chap1er S explore a particulnr area, they should consider sharing their objective, as in the following example: Counsellor: You h:t,'t, not 13lk00 much about )'Our (eelu~ l 'rn wonderin¥ i( it rni"1u be uselul lor us to spend a little bit o( time ~orll1¥ thii important 2rea. TI,::rt mi$;11t help us undersc2nd S<H»e o( the pressure you \'t, ~n under 2nd how l'Ough it is l'O tnO\'t, lorw2rd. Wh:lt do you thll,k? \Vhcn clients understand and support the purpose, they arc much more likely to respond positively to probes for concreteness. Respect Timing Herc are some brood ,;cneral guidelines: ■ During the beginning phase of n relationship. probe more cautiously until trust is developed, or you gee a sense of the client's capacity for more in-depth exploration. ■ \Vhcn there arc relationship conflict issue~ consider the wisdom of dealing with this reality first. ■ Probes for concreteness may stir up ftt.l ings that clients nttd time to process; therefore, during the ending phase of an interview probe more selective!)•. Use Simple Encouragers and Directives The simplest way to probe for more information is to use short phrases and ,;csturcs thnt cncoura,;c clients to continue with their stories. Nonverbal gestures, such as head nods, sustained eye contact, and :mended silence, convey such support and interest. Directives arc short statements chat provide direction to clients. Using directives is nnothcr way o f gathering informntion. They can also be used to control the pace and flow of an interview, and in cognitive behavioural counselling (discussed in Chapter 7), they are used to nssign homework to clients. Directives such as "Describe- your feelings," "List your main reasons,'' "Give me an example," "Tell me what 't'OU did," "Share your thoughts," "Tell me more," "Expand on that," "Don't move too q uickly," "Describe your feelings," and "Put it in your own words" nJI help nc.hicvc concreteness. S ince overuse of directives may leave clients feeling controlled, they should be used sparingl)•. A softer tone and open body lnngua,;c can lessen the command nspect of the directive. Short statements and directives, such ns "Tell me more," "Yes, ,;o on," "\\:fhat else?" "Please expand on that," and simple encourage.rs such as "Uh-huh, hmm," c.nn be used to sustain client sharing without interrupting the flow of the interview. A short example will illustrate-: directives: Sllot'I stateaents that promi!' directi>n to tlieals • s . infor1Ution, and pace (e.g., "Tell me °' _,.I Client: I ¥m'SS rm prett't' an{tr)·. Coun.seltor: Meanil,K! Client: O ur refationship is on the rot.ks. Coun.seltor: Tell me more. Client: M)· brother always puts me dov,m . It's '--ot to the point where I don't want to be a.round hitn. Coun.seltor: (Nods: aurnt/t\' sifentrJ Client: We used to be so dose. \Ve were insepa~ble, but in the fast year. it's bero1ne so eompetitive. Questions Questions nrc the primary tool for seeking information. lnteJligcnt questioning can be used to get example~ define te.rms, o r probe for detail. The following interview excerpt demonstrates chis process: CounseUor: I want to nuke s ure I unders12nd. \Vh::u do you me:2n when you ~y eOfn/~ltlu~! Client: It's somethh-)¥ ualy. Not just wantll,i to wll, but al,so needina to win. h's as i( ever,.•thil1¥ rides on winnll1i, Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 151 CounseUor. Is th::u true for both o( )Ou! C lien t: At first, it wu Just him. Kow I'm JUSt :u but. Coun!l(>IJOr. \\'h::u's:. typie:d ex::ample! Counsellors can use ~rics of questions to explore vague statements beyond a supe.r~ ficinJ level. The following excerpt illustrates: Clien t: I know there are m3n)' times wben I let my (ee.li1'{tS ~ the better o( me. Coun!l(>IJOr. \\'h::at kinds o( (eelin,iS,! C lien t: Son~unes I let my an~-er build to the point where I'm read)' l'O explode. Coun!l(>IJOr. "Ready to eicplode"-wh::at does that mean! C lien t: I would never become ph)•Sie:U and hurt someone. I'm JUSt a(r3id o( ~-ettin¥ re:Ul)' mean ::and s::arh,i hurt(ul thi~ Coun!l(>IJOr. H:u t~t happened! C lien t: Yes. (Heslt.ata) A lot. Coun!l(>IJOr. C::an you think o( a ~ ex:imple! C lien t: ?l.·ty mother. She's alwars tryin¥ to eontrol m)' li(e. Most o( the tune. I just Ir)' to iifi()re he.reonstant n:ij$in~ but l::atelr it seems th:u e\'e-rr s«ond. d3)' she pho!"K's with ::.dv iee. I don't w::ant it. and I don't !"K'ed it. Ye.sterd::ar I blew up 31 her. Coun!l(>IJOr. \\'h::at did you do or say? C lien t: I told her in no uneert:.in tenns to buu out o( my life. She started toer,·. Then I felt ~-uiJty. Empathy Although it is n()( usunJI,• thought of as a probing tool, empathy in foct Cre3tcs a powerful incentive for clients to open up. Although the.re arc exceptions, successful empathy builds trust and safety for clients to reveal and explore their feelings. \Vithout empathy, clients are more likcl,• to kttp their feelings private. Follow Cl ues Often clients hint at a concern, which provides counsellors with a natural opportunity to probe for more detail nnd to open the discussion to a gre3ter levcl of intimacy. C lien t: (Aoorldmg eye oontact.) h's not e3S)' to open up to 3 stra.n~-er. Coun!l(>IJOr. It is tou~,. You mi~ht wonder hoo• I ::am it()in& to re::iet or whether I w1II hold wh::at you S3)' ::t:it'3inst you. C lien t: It' s just so emba.rl"'3ssina. Coun!l(>IJOr. One wa,· tOO\~reome tJ131 is to t::t:ke a eh::aniee on me I'm open to a.nythin~ you have to s::ar. I flnd that when I avoid talki~ :.bout 3 tou~, area. it becomes e,.•en more dirAeult to de:U with later. C lien t: L2tel,·, l cannot sJe.ep :it nidlt bec::ause I'm wonderi~ i( I midlt be ipy. SUCCESS TIP "To helJ) a client. discuss &abOO feelings and concerns, the worke-r has to create a unique 'culture' in lhe helJ)ing interview. In this cultu(e, 1t is acceptable to discuss feelings and concerns 1ha1 the client may ex.pe-rience as tabOO elsewhere'" (Shulman, 2009, J). 156). To create lhis culture, IOOk fo( clues that tabOO-r'elated btOCks are present, b(.-ig discussion of the blOek 10 the open, and 1hen renegolr.ate a new aweement that allows fo( opan d.rscussion of lhe labOO area (Shulman, 2009). Making Choices A theme throughout this book is that effective counseJlors have a broad range o( alternatives for responding. When they have choices, counsellors are not locked into 152 Chap1er S repetitive panern~ nnd interviews are more interesting and \tibram for both clients and counsellors. The follo"'ing example demonstrates some of the many "'ays that a counsellor might respond to a client: Client: I suppose I should ha\'e ~peeled it. Mr Kirlfriend said she needed time to think to "re-ev.llu::ue our rel:1tionship, .. 3S she put it. It was tol¢h, but I s.a ...e her some t ime alone. Counsellor (Choice I): How d,d )'Ou feel :lbout what W'3S happenin~ (an open question that focuses the di$CuSS.ion on the dient·s feelinKS] Coun.seltor (Choice?): What was )'Our plan! la.n open question coneentr:ltina on the client's behaviour a.nd thol¢htsl Coun.se.U.or (Choke 3): Tell me wh:lt )·Ou pbnned t'O do. fd1rtttive] CounselJor (Ch.o k.e 4): Sounds M:.e th.is wu a painful lime for you. [empathic response dirttted t'O the client's (~li~I Coun:1;eUor (Choice 5): I'd be interested in knoo•ins. how you h:1ndled it. lindireet question] Coun:1;eUor (Choice 6): (Sifen«.) fsdenee used to {th'i' the d1e:nt 3n opportunity to continue sharil,K] Counsello r (Choice 7): It was hard. but )'Ou v.--ere able t'O Kh'i' her time to reaS!le$$ )'OUr relat1onsh.ip. (poraphr3seJ SUCCESS TIP Choices fot ptomoring etabOtation (concteteness) ioclude combining each of lhe six. bas.ic open ciuestion stems (who. what, when, whete, why, and how) wdh ead'I of the thfoo baSic domains (behaviout, feeling, and thinking). Simple encotXagers: such as ·Teu me more· and F'0t ex.ample ... • p(omote fwthe( depth and ctarity. 8 INTERVIEW TRANSITIONS An interview transition occurs when the topic of conve.rsnrion shifts from one subject to anothe.r. Such shifts ma.)' occur spontaneously in the course of the interview, or they may be orchestrated to further the objectives of the interview. The need for a. transition a.rises in the following situations: interview tran$ition: bhifl in the topicolthe interviea t. Discussion of n pn.rticular issue is finished, and it is time to move on. 2. Discussion triage.rs ideas in another area or links to earlier areas of discussion. 3. The topic is too threatening or painful, and a topic change is needed to reduce tension. 4. The subject has limited relevance or hns lost its relevance to the goals of the inte.rview. 5. A change from one phase of the interview to anothe.r is necessary (Shebib, 1997, p. I 56). There are five types of transitions: narural, strategic, control, phase, and connect or linking (Shebib, 1997, p. 156). Natural Transitions Natural transitions a.rise as the discussion Bows seamlessly from one topic co another, with dear links between the two topics. The most common natural transition occurs Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 153 when clients mention new themes as part of the interview, and counseJlors use this information to jump to the new topic. Client: All I ~lk about my di~tisfaction with 11\)' job. I rdh:e that the s::m~ could also be sakl about mr marri~e. CounseUor. Pert\:tpS we could addrtSS th:u new.•. Tell me wb:u·s h::appenb-w in )'Our tn.:trrb~ Clients arc unlikdy to resist natural transitions since the interview moves clC3rly in the direction they have SUstRCStcd. The topic chanae is not abrupt, and transition responses indiate that counsellors have heard what their clients have just stated. Strategic Transit ions Strategic transitions arise when counsellors make choices among topic :.dternatives. Imagine that a client makes a statement such as the following: Client: This h:as been the: worSt year on record for me. Mr f'lnanees were: a d1saster an)•w:ay. 2nd now that J\,e lost my job I think I'll KO under. Ke,edless 10 ~)', this hasn' t been i ood for 11\)' marria~ I can se:,e how h:anl it is on mr kkls. ?l.·1y eldest dau~ter see.ms to avoid 1ne entirely. 2nd I'm sure mr son ii on dru~. h :all becomes too mueh. How should a counscJlor respond to this revelation? Should he or she select finances as a priority for follow-up? Or go with one of the other problems: marriaae, rcJation.ships with children, drug abuse, or unemployment! Should the counsellor focus on problems or fccJing.s or both? How a counsellor responds is a strategic decision that affects the direction of the interview, at least for the moment. As much as possible, clients should be involved in decisions to make a strategic transition. Control Transitions Because counsellors have to orchestrate the flow of the interview, they sometimes use control transitions to manaJ;e the interview's direction. Redirecting the flow of an interview is warranted when the discussion topic is irrelevant or when it prevents diaJogue on more important is.sues. Preventing pre.mature subject changes is crucial for ensuring concreteness or full exploration of content and feelings. Moving too quickly from topic to topic results in a rambling and superficial interview where many things are discussed, but few are unde.rstood. Control transitions are used not to dominate clients, but rather to exercise profes..sionaJ duty to ensure that the interview rime is productive. (n practice, counsdlors and their clients should share control, with counscJlors giving clients as much po\\'e.r as possible to set the course of counselling based on their needs. For the.ir pan, counsellors hdp by monitoring the process and pace of the interview to ensure that discussions have sufficient intimacy and stimulation. Skilled counsellors are sensitive to the following elements of the interview that arc open to control: I . Specific topics that are the subject of focus 2. The e>..'tent that the interview focuses on each of the three domains: feelings (indud.ing control on lcvcJ of emotionality), behaviour, and thinking 3. Sequences in which topics are discussed, including decisions to move the interview from one ph3se to another 4 . Use of time, induding depth of discussion as wcll as interview start and end times 5. The following example illustrates a control transition: Counsellor. I think we m"-'u be mo..,ina 100 quickly here. ~e havm ' t h3tl 21 th:utee to talk a.bout yo ur (e,eibl{t.t. I wonder 1( )-OU'd ~ree that v.--e should do th:n before v.--e mO\'i' on to a di Ire-rent topk. It miaht help us both to understand wb)• it's been sod1(t".e-uJt (or )'Ou to tn.:tke:2 decision. 154 Chap1er S (n this o:3mplc, the counscJlor gives a brief rc3son for slowing down the interview 3nd focusing on feelings. Clients who understand what is happening: are much more likcl)• to support the process. But clients thcmscJvcs may suddenly change the subject of the interview for a vari• cty of rc3sons. For o:amplc, perhaps they were rC'\•caling too much, or the materinJ was too painful or persona] to discuss. Because of issues of client rrust and rcadines~ coon• sellors need to use control transitions wiscJy and be mindful of the underlying feelings that client-initiated shifts signal One way for counsellors to deal with a topic shift is to openly acknowledge the shift, then gently explore its meaning. Coun.se.U.or: Arn I n~n in think in¥ th:u you seemed un«unfort2ble talkina about ,.·our relationship with your father! Client: It'll not somethin~ I want to s.e1 into ri¥ht now. Coun.se.Uor: Th:u's okay. I w1II not force )'Ou. On the othe-r h:md. )'Ou mi,aht deeide later that )OU ~ue ready. Counsellors can use summaries as a way to introduce control transitions. As the following example illustrate~ summari!ing makes the topic switch seem less abrupt. This is important because abrupt transitions ma,., appear harsh to clients and accentuate their feelings of being cros.s-ex:.lmined. Coun.~ellor. So. as I understand it, dru¥ abuse h:u h:ld a SiiJ1i0can1 imp::.et on )'Our work. Your boss h:ls re:.1ehed a point where he w1II support )'Ou. but only i( )'Ou e:nte-r rehab. Let' s sluft our forus for a minute and talk 2bou1 problems with )'Our family. Phase Transitions CounscJlors also use topic changes to help move the counscJling process into the next phase. For example, in the beginning phase relationship building and problem explora• tion arc paramount. However, at some point, it becomes dear that sufficient time has been spent on problem exploration, and it is time to move on to the chaJlenges of the action phase, where the activity shifts to problem solving: and scssionaJ contTact work on feeling:~ thinking, or behaviour. Thus, phase transitions are needed to bridge the work of one phase to another, as illustnncd by the following: o:amplc: Counsellor: I wonder if v.--e have reached a point where it makes sense to ~ n talldna 2bou1 the ehan~ you W'3nt to make. ~e could b¢in to discus!? some o( )'Our ¥°"Ill and then think about how to ::.chie..-e the-m. (n the following o:ample, the counsellor uses a phase transition to end the int~rvicw and to establish a linlc to the next session: Counsellor: I'm impressed with )'Our ins¢1sabout how )'Ou tend l'O put )'Ourself down. It ~m!l to me th::u the next lo$:.ieaJ step 1ni,ah1 be to explore hoo• 10 combat this tendency. I( )'Ou 2~~. we can start "'1th th::u nb:t t ime. Pacing Generally. inte.rviewcrs should proc~ at a pace that their clients can manage. This docs not mean that clients must aJways be 100 percent comfortable with the intensity of the interview. lndccd, the work of interviewing and counselling can be demanding, and exploring difficult topks can be exhausting. He.re are some genemJ guidelines for pacing: ■ Move more slowl)• in new relationships and first encounters. ■ Expect diffc.renccs among clients. ■ Don't expect to maintain the same intensity or an ever-increasing intensity throughout the interview. Periodic "rest" periods with nonthreatening or less demanding topics c3n energize clients. ■ End interviews with less demanding: questions and responses. Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Meaning 155 CONVERSATION 5.2 ST\JOENT: What are your looughts on takl~ nOles duri~ an interview? TUCH£R: You fl'SI. ST\JDE:NT: 1have mix.eel footings. On the one hand, I don't want to forget anythi~. On the other hand, it seems so COid and dinical to be writing wtlen die-nts are talking, It seems to lake .r14y from the intimacy ot the relationship. TEACHER: Suppose you were IM client. and I were takltlg nOles. ST\JOENT: I'd wonder about what you wete W(itiogabOut me. I'd be really scared that someone else might see the notes. I'd probably be really careflJ abOut what I said. TUCH£R: What if I tOld you that you could see the nOles? TEACHER: AU clients have a right to that information. They may n01 ask but, as a rule-, you Should tell them. You rarSed a gOOCI point earlier abOut how nOle--takiog can dettaet from rapport in 100 inteiview. I agree. I think it's partkular1y important to put 100 pen oown when clients are 1aUd~ abOut leeliogs 0t Olher private matters. On the other hand, most clients ex.pec:t that you'll write oown informatbn such as phone numbers and add fesses. STUDENT: I'd preiet not to take notes at au during the interview and just Wl'ite up a summary aftef the client leaves. TEACHER: That v.()uld be ideal. Of courstt that's 001 atways possible. There may be fofms ot computetlzed questionnaires to complete that can'I be delayed until afte-r the interview. Or you may have other clients warli~. so there may be no time after the interview. ST\J0ENT: That would help. Then I'd be able to COtr'ed any mistakes. 1-'d re-ally want to know wM would have access to 100 file. Mortt>ver, counseJlors need to m3na,;e interview transitions between one topic and another. As well, they should avoid r igid agendas such as might be followed in a formal meeting and instC3d allow some freedom of movement bcrnf'C(.'n topics. Counsellors also need to be careful not to sprint from one topic to 3nother without adequate exploration o r completion. Connect {Linki ng) Transitions Connect or linking transitions arc used to join or blend ideas from recurrent themes. For e.x3mplc, a client m3y m31cc continuaJ subtle rcfc.renccs to 3 need to have everything just right. The counsellor might use a connect transition to bring this theme to the foreground: Counsellor: ln~ll )'Ourex::unples, )'Ou t:llk about how you make- Sure' th::u you pay 3UC'n• 1.0n t'O C'\eery little deuul. Then )'Ou sec-m t'O ber:ue your:W'I( i( e,eer)•thin¥ isn't pc-rfttt. ))l} INTERVIEW 5. 1 The followiog excerpt illustrates selected interview skills. This is the first int~iew with the client, a single mother on welfare. The counsellor w01ks in a C-Ommunity service centre that offers a variety of programs. (During the first five minutes of the interview, the cout1sel/cr at1d the client engage ;,, small talk.) counsellor: Per'haps you can tetl me what bt'ings you here tOday. You did not tell me much on the phone, but I had the impression that you fett some ufgency. ClleM: I've been on wetfare f0t year'S, and I just can't make ends meet. 156 Chap1er S Analysis: lt1lervkw c,pet1fngs t!Stabllsh first lmpressJOfls. A few minutes spet1t on small talk helps clients relax. and it should t1ot be considered time wasted. Analysis: A simple phase trat1sition begins the process of establishing the purpose of the Interview. By making a llt1k to the ifltake phone call, the counselk:Jr demOflstrates that thectkt1t's sense of emergency was heard. This Jets the client know that the counsel/Or Is a good listener at1d sensitive to feelings. i>» INTERVIEW 5 .1 Interviewing Skills (continue) Counsellor: Sounds (OUgtl. Tefl me more. Client: Ifs not just 100 money-ifs what il's dci~ to my kids. Counsellor: What do you mean? Client: My oldest is 18. He doeso'I seem to have any motivation. He says he can ha(dtywait until he is 19 so he can go on wetfare too. Counsellor: I wondet if it seems to you that being on welfare somehOw conne<:ts with yout son's attilude. Analysis: A supportive and sympathetic reaction communicates warmth and concern. The counsellor uses a directive to seek more detail and concreteness. As well, it creates an apportunlty for the client to tell her story. Analysis: It would be easy to assume what the client is talking abOut. Instead. the counsellor probes for definition. An open question gives the client full freedom to speak freely. Analysis: This Indirect question offe,s an interesting ,eframe for the client to consider. Client: Good i:dnt. I hadn't thought of lhat, but it makeS sense. It's all we've ktlown fo( the last five years. (A ftrN minutes later.) Counsellor: I need )'OIX help to undet'SlaOCI what you we(e hoping would happen when you came here today. Client: I need to gel into some sort of mtrainiog, My skillS are way out of date. Client: I'm willi~ toWOr"k anywhete, but eventually, I want to frnd something that frts. Counsellor: Fils? Client: I'd mally like to WOrk with people. I'd like )'Ou( job. (Ba/h laugh.) Counsellor: I noticed eatlie( lhat as you described you( voluntee( wOt'k with ldds. you seemed happy. Client: 1-'d IOYe to do it full time, but the(e's no way. Counsellor: What prevents you? Analysis: Here the counsel/or- might have asked an open question to initiate the working contract. However, an Indirect question ;s substituted. This adds some v.vlety to the interviewers style and helps to /WOid leaving the client feeling Interrogated. Analysis: The counsellor's response accents a key word using a questioning tone. This is yet another way to seek info,mation that ls more concrete. The counsello,-'s Interest stimulates the client to say mare. Humour lightens the tone, but provides an apportunity to probe further. Analysis: A linking transition connects two parts of the lntel"llew. Good counsel!Ots try to remember a blt of Information that might be relevant o,- useful later-a kind of '"mem0ry Post-It note. N Analysis: An open question to identify barriers. Client: I need to earn a li'o'I~. Veiunteet'Saren'I pai:S. To get hired ful lime, I'd need to get a diploma. Counsellor: But .. . ? Client: But .. . That takes money, and I ha\18: no idea hO'N I'd pay for it. Plus, 1-'venever been a g()()j student sogotng back at my ag,e may be a recipe fOt' disaste(. Analysis: Here, a simple unfinished res,:,onse is a useful prompt for the client to identify ba"lers. Counsellor: Sounds as if you've al(eady looked into it. Although you sound like you'd lave todo it, you'(e wOt'ried abOUt au the ObStades. Client: Yes. As I said ear1iet, I'm detefmined to gel out of lhis rut. I suppose I sholJCI do somethtng abOUt it. Reflections: ■ What is the lmpo,ctance of the client telling her story? ■ How d,oe,s the counsell0r in this interview communicate empathy? ■ Suggest what the counsellor migJ,t say or do next. Asking Questions: Tile Searcll lor Mea ning 157 SUMMARY ■ Questions are an important interviewing tool for g3thering information, pro\tiding focus to rhc interview, promoting client insight, and supporting catharsis. Good questioning can systematically lead clients through problem solving and can heJp clients examine arc3s th.nt they might otherwise ovcrlook. Jt is important to balance questions with responses that confirm understanding (summaries and paraphrases) and empathic responses that confirm sensitivity to fccJings. So experienced counscJlors use a broad rc~rtoire of skills all the time. ■ Questions can be either dosed or open. C losed questions can be c3sily answered yes or no. Open questions are difficult to answer with a simple 't'CS or no. The vast majority of open questions will be "five~, ., questions (who, what, where, when, why, and how). Another effective questioning tool is the use of indirect questions, which are statements that function as questions. ■ Faulty, insensitive, and poorly timed questioning may bias clients' answer~ antagoni:e them, or keep the interview at a superficial level. Common errors include lead ing question~ excessive questioning, multiple question~ irrelevant or poorly timed question~ and urhy questions. A lternative options to questions arc always available for use by skilled counsellors. ■ Interviewing youth and seniors involves paying attention to individual differences as well as cognitive ability. ■ Concreteness concerns the extent to which the discussion conveys dear and specific meaning. When communication is concrete, all participants share understanding of langungc, ideas. and feelings. Strategics for promoting concreteness include using simple encouragc:rs, probing for detail with questions and dirtttivcs. ■ Interview transitions occur when the topic of the interview shifts from one subject to another. Such shifts may occur spontaneously in the course of the interview, or counsdlors ma)' orchestrate them to further the objectives of the interview. There are five different rypcs of transitions: natural, strategic, control, phase, and connect (or linking). EXERCISES Self-Awareness 1. Pick an issue that you have wry stt~ footings abOut (e.g., abOrtion, capital punishment. Or' canadian politics). Conduct a 5- to 10-minute inter'view with a colleague to ex.plOm his Or' her' viehS oo the same 10pic. Howevttt", do not reveal any of you, feellngs or th~ts on the topic. Afte, the intetview is ovet, discuss the experience. To what ex.tent we,e you able to keep you, oNn views separate? 2. Think abOUt an expe(aence where you had a sliong reaction to being questioned. What were you, thOu.ghts and leeli~ durk'lg the enicountet? How did you react? 3. Ask a friend 0t COiieague to monitor your interactions over lhe nex.t week 01 so regarding your use of questions. Seek feedbaek. 158 Chap1er S 4. Conclucl an i'\ter'viewwith a coneague. Use questions k'la~ ptopriately (e.g., ask irrelevant questions, change the topic freciuantty, bOmbard with questions, and ask leading ques. tbns). After the inter'view is completed, discuss how it fett to be k'I tx>th the rnter'vie.ver and the client ,·ote. What did you learn atx>ut yourself from this ex.perieoce? 5. Reflect on the variables that might make it difficlAt lor you to se•~isclose 10 a counsell01. What issues rn your lile would )<Ill be A!luc&art 01 uf'Mili(€ to discuss? How dO )<Ill think )<Ill migt\t react if a counsellor pursued these topics? 6. Think abOut some of your pel'Sonal and WO(k relation. Ships. Ate you mofe likely to be the one asking questions 01 the one answering questions? In what w:¥yS does this impact the powet dynamics of the relatbnship? 7. On a scale of 1- 10 (1 =easy; 10 =tougtt), rate hO'Ndiff!CIJt it might be for you 10 conduct a d ient interview Ydth the 101IOwing themes or topics: Oealll c. It's been a long time. d. I knO'N e-xactty what she me-ans. e. You have no idea hOw I fool. f. I'm realty angry with you. Spiritual issues a:. The-re are some significant thi~ happening in my lile Sex and intimacy right Mental heallh issues now. b. I'm 001 sure I can handle this pfoblem. I need he-Ip. 1-tyijeoe 4. Each of lhe fonowi~ client slate-men.ts has ooo or m0te Aging YOIS relationstlip with him/her What can you learn aoout )'OU'self from your answerS? Skill Practice I . Coo:foct a 10-mW'lt.lte locused interview with a Cdleaigue. YOU' task is to explore one topic in as much depth as JX)Ssible. However', in this interview, you are n.ot allowed to ask ciuestbns. Use a range of Skits other than quesl.bnir'lg,. (Note to the client: Keep yots answers very brief. Try n01 to be overl'j cooperative.) After the i'\teM8W is O'iet, discuss the exparience. See 00W many diffefenl strategies you can identify fOI' getti~ ir'D'matioo c.-. addil.ioo toOl)(!l'I and ct)Sed questions). 2. As a conditioning &efcise fOI' interviewi~ ciuiel clients, conduct an in.tef'Jiewwith a COIie-ague-. Set up the in.te-rview so that your colleague- does not resJX)nd verball'y. use a variety of ted'lni::lues Other than questions. 3 . Videotape an extended intel'View with a celleague. Classify each response that the counse-tlOr' makeS in tem'ls of ly~ open ciue-stion, closed Question, summary, and so on. Identify patterns. Ate the-re Skills that are overused 01' underused? Concepts I . ClaSsify each of the foltowing questions as open, closed, Of indirect. problems with concreteness. F'ust, identify lhe concre-t&ooss problem. Second, suggest a possible counselloc response to promote concfe-te-ne-ss. a. 1stitJ have lee-Ii~ fOI' he-r. b. IW ftlen tt a lot of lhOugl\l. c. I hardly sleep at nigr\l. d. I've tried to control my kids, but nothrlg seems to WOrk. e. She's an elder1y person. I. I f... bad. 5. Each of lhe- fallowing counsellor statements contains phrases or jargon that may be unfamiliaf to d ie-nts. Reword each using everyday language. a. It seems as 1h0u.gh youf son has a 101 of inte-rpe:ISOl\3I difficllty, and ii is gene-rating acring~ behaWOuf. b. Cognilive-ly, he see-ms we-II within the- mean. c. It appears 10 me that you are feeli~ ambivalent. d. After intake it seems appropriate to make a refe«al to one of our community resources. e. Youf aflect is euthymk::. 6. Work in a small group to brains.tofm jargon that is used in a setting that you knON. Next, reoor'd these tefms and phrases so that lhey are easity unde-rsaaodable. 7. Watd'I a talk Sl'IOw. See if you can identify the interviewing Skills that are ~d. LOOk for e-viden.ice of improper interviewing techni(lue. a. How do you feel aoout your brOthe-t? b. I'm pUZlled aoout yotX mact.ioo. c. Do you have time to see me oex.t week? d. I'd like to kn.ow somethi~ aoout your sttategy. 2. Rew0r'd the fOflowing clOSed questions as (a) open ci~ I.ions and (b) i"ldirecl ciuestioos.. a. Are you enrolled in the seo-etarial PfO!Jam? b. Did the principal refef you? c. Are you feeling sad? d. Do you want 10 talk abOUt your feelings? e. Did you tell hef hOw you lel? 3. lmagk'le that you am responch~ to the lolto.-dng d ient statements. Suggest fOflow-up responses that are- open ciuestions, closed ciue-stions, indirect ciuestions, and d1fe-ctives. a. I have mixed feelings. b. The~ step is to Sdve the blOOdy prOblem. 8. Identify six or mo(@ different chOices for obtaining lhe folk)\\;~: • The- p(~ of a oottte of socsa • l.nfOl'matbn abOUt your client's feelings • Youf client's reason fOI' se-eki~ help 9. Imagine that you are a counse-uor preplaMing an interview with each of the follo-lMg d ients. What in.formation do you think you might need? Identify Questions and directives that you migttt use. • A patient who has been physically fe-strained in a hOspi. tal e~rgency wafd aftef a dfug OYefdose. • AA elder1y woman vd'I0 is going blind. • A man whO seeks he-Ip tor ang« management. • A pafe-nt of a child who has been taken into cus.to:Jy. Asking Questions: The Searc tl lor Mea ning 159 IO. Interview Aerobics 11. Prepare l'las.h caros \\1th the names of various Skills oo each cafd (e.g., open question, ck>Sed question, paraphrase-. summary, empathy, iOClirecl question, direclive, silence-. wild card (any Skill), self-di!.clOSufe. and contractl"lg). Then use them in an inter'View with a COiieague. Note: The foUo-Ni~ exercises are desigr\ed to help you develOp a range of SkillS. The mofe comfortable you are wilh a 'hide afr'ily of responses.. the mor'e you wUI be able to respond based on the oeedS of the client and the situation. Uerdse 1: Shuffie the cafds. The counsellOf istens carefull'f to what the client says aOCI then setects the fil'SI card in lhe stack and fol tows the dk"ections on that card. For example-. if lhe next cacd reads "closed question,· the counsenor must ask a clOSed question, even if that migr\t 001 be the beSt response. (Note: Do n01 IOOk at the card until lhe client has finished speaking,) Exercise 2: WOr"k in a group of three (counsellor, client, and coach). Dufing the interview, lhe coach coooses an appropriate ski\J cafd fOr' lhe counsetor to use. Exercise 3: Conduct an interview using the cans in any ordef that you choose. Continue interviewing until all of the cafdS are used. ca,ds may be used more than one time. Exercise 4: Conduct an interview using the ca,cts in any ordef that you wish. Howevef, you can use each card only once. Exercise 5: OeV1!IOp your o-.m strategy for using lhe cards. (Adapted ftom Sneb;b, 1997, p. 161) WEBLINKS Article on investigative intervi~ing of childieo. "Guidelines on lnyestig~to,y Interviewing of Children: Wh.at Is the Consensus in the Scientific Community?.. by Hollida Wakefield (2006). American Jourt1al of Fo,e11sic PsychO!Ogy, 24 (3), 57- 74. www.i pt.forensics..com/hbr.ary/.ajfp 1.him 160 Chap1er S Basie: counseling skills for wo,king with teens (Center f0t AdOlescent Studies) https:l/centerforadolesce:ntstud1es.coml3-b.asic<0unselingski Ils-working-teens/ =C- '"""' -' ~ ~~ ..... .;~ . ~~ - ,:;;-~ -..... ■ Explain the impormncc of emotions in counselling. ■ Define what is meant by empathy. ■ Identify the types of empathic responses, including when and how to use them. ■ Explore lccy principles (g:cncrali:ations) for using empathy. "" , SimikOIIShutterstock THE EMOTIONAL DOMAIN At any moment in a counselling interview, counscJlors can choose to focus on one of three brood areas: behaviour, thought. or fcdings (emotions). All thrtt are potentially important and necessary for problem mtmai;cmcnt and change. Of significance is that change in any one domain will have impact upon and trigger change in the others. \Vhcn the emphasis is on behaviour, counscJlor questions and responses tarj;ct what the client is doing or S3ying. Responses such as, "\\:' hat did 't'OU say?" "How did you handle the situation!" and "\Vh.nt do you Stt as the next logical step!" 3re dominant. If the focus shifts to the thinlcina (coanitive domain), responses such a~ "How did you make sense of what happened!" and "\Vh3t were )'OU thinkina?'' 3re evident. Work in the feeling or affective dom3in will involve counsellors in responses and questions th3t explore emotions. Questions such 3S. "How do you fecH" 3S weJI as empathy will 161 dominate the ,vork. The bruancc of this chapter will explore concepts and strategics for working in the important emotionaJ domain. Chapter 7 will explore how counsellors can work in the behaviouroJ and cognitive domains. Emotions define and shape the course of our lives. They remind us that we are alive, but sometimes they make us long for death. Some cmotions--such as joy at the birth of a child-demand to be expressed. Some that are too frightening to acknowledge are destined to remain forever hidden, perhaps e,.,cn from ourselves. Carl W Buechner underscored the importance of emotional connections: "they may forget what you said, but they will never forget how you made them foci" (public domain). Shared emotions are the cornerstone of intimacy. One's emotionaJ reaction, while not always mtionaJ, dear, or understandable, often controls the finaJ judgment on communicative meaning. EmotionaJ responses trifler unique physiologicaJ responses in our bodies such as nausea or headadie~ and they can have a profound impact on our health and well-being (Seligman & Reichenberg. 20 I0). In fact, "Emotions experienced as positive can activate the inner pharmacopeia, those chemicals that reJax, help fight infection, and restore" (Solccl,y, 2009, p. 17). Historically, emotional responses have helped humans respond to important situations: ■ Anger: The hands swell with blood, making it easier to use weapons or strike back; increased heart rate and adrcnaJin serve to increase energy and power. ■ Fear: Blood Bow to the legs increases, making it easier to escape; the body may freeze for a moment, giving time to gauge whether hiding is a better response. ■ Happiness: Brain activity inhibits negative thoughts and fosters increased energy. ■ L01.-e: General bodil't' responses promote well-being and a ,;cneral state of calm and contentment. ■ Surprise: Raising the eyebrows cxP3nds the field of vision, thu~ making it easier to figure out what is going on and to plan the best course of action. ■ Sadness: A general drop in energy and enthusiasm creates an opportunity to mourn. (Golcmon, 2005) Jones (2006) makes this interesting observation: "Emotions are clever design solu.tions to the problem of making fast decisions in response to significant practical problems posed by the natural and sociaJ worlds: we percejvc a danger and fear immediately primes us to take protective action" (p. 3). But she aJso comments on the way that emotions can cause us to act inappropriate!)•: "They prepare us to embrace motivationally actions we should shun and leave us in physical turmoil when we would be better served by calm" (p. 8). Murdock (2009) identifies how problems miaht arise from emotional reasoning: "Because of the emotional investment in an idea, it is seen as true, reg3rdless of discrcP3m information" (p. 329). ))t) BRAIN BYTE Emotional reactions are also linked to our emotional memi> rtes. TM human brain compcues current expe:ftence with past events f0t similarities. and it may command us to •feact to the present in ways that wefe impcinted IOog ago, with thoughts, emotions, teactions reamed in msponse to events perhaps only dimly similar· (Goleman, 2005, p. 21). This may tesult in what Goleman (2005) desctibes as Mout-of~ate 162 Chap1er 6 neural alarms· that cause us to feact with outdated ot iooffective fesponses. Mofeovet, emotions can be partkul3r1y baffling beeause Mthey often date from a time earty in OUf lives when things were bewildeting and we did no1 have w0tds foe compfe-hending events. We may have the d'laotic feeli~. but not lhe WOfdS fot the memories that fonned lhem" (p. 22). Because the human expe.rience is so closely connected with emotions (feelings), we c3n upect co unselling work to frequ ently focus on heJping clients identify, explo re, man3g,e, o r accept their emotions. CounseJlors engng:c with clients' emotions in a n umber of ways. The co unselling relationship provides safety for clients to explore and understand their feelings. Friends and family may be well-meaning but poorly equipped to deal with complex emotions. T hey ma,., be prone to simplistic advice giving, o r they may try to chani;c the subject when painful feelings are revealed. CounseJlors, on the other hand, are able to deal with feelings. They do not tell clients how they should feel, nor do they insult or frustrate clients with quick.-fix solutions. Instead, they allow clients to express emotions without nco:ling to censor what they reve3J. Nonju dgmental responses and pe.rmissive encouragement from counsellors can be enormousl't' therapeutic for those clients who have struggled on the.ir own to cope with their emotions. The pursuit of empathic understanding opens up an avenue for communication and insight that is seldom accessible in everyday communication. Golema n (2005) sus:i;csts that the ability to rccogni!e feelings as they happen is the cornerstone of emotional intdligc ncc, and that people who are more in touch with their feelings arc better able to navigate the.ir lives a nd are more competent decision makers. G ladding and Newsome (20 10) suggest that "people who are unaware of the.ir emotions o ften exper ience problems in relationships" (p. 154). Prcsbury, Echte rling. and McKee (2008) conceptualized emotional intelligence in two C3teg<>ries: skills related to understanding the seJf and skills related to understanding others. Self-skills include ab ilities such as recogni!ing., monitoring, managing, and remaining open to our own emotions; being congruent in what we feel and how we behave; and u sing emotions as part o f problem management and creativity. Emotional intelligence when relating to othe.rs requires empathic ab ility, including the capacity to unde.rstand, manage, and navigate emotions in others that may be complex and ambivaJem. As well, we need to be ab le to rccogni.!c incongruence; that i~ inconsiste ncies between what people feel and what they sa y o r do. Seligman and Reichenberg (2010) give an ex:.lmplc: A pe-rsoi, ~press.in¥ words o( lo"e w1II spe-.l.k $0(dy. 111::aintain K()od ere cont~ , ::and h::1:,,e 211 open ::and ..vtJrominKposture. HOYi'e\'tr, i( that person ,>erbr:1111:es 101:e but has poore)>e contact. an :l.11$tr)' tone o( voice, or 2 ten,sie 2nd dosed poscure. conflict in¥ ::and con(usii,K emotions are co1nn1unk::rted. The receiver ,nay not know "-h:u t'O belu.'•,,e. only IX''t' 2tten1.0n to part o( the mess~e. m isinterpret the mess~e. or discredi1 the n~~-e because o( its delivery. (p. JJ2) Howeve.r, communication d ifficulties and problems ofte n occur, since there arc wide variations in the extent to which individuals value and express emotions. Many factors impact this, including ::age, cultural norms, i;cnder, setting, mental disorders, and soc:ialimtion. For example, people from Asian cultures value emotional restraint, whereas \Vesterncrs tend to be more boisterous in expressing feelings. (ndividuaJs may openly ~xpress emotions when they are with peers o r friend~ but be guarded or mute with pe.rsons in positions of authority (induding counsellors). Counsellors need to be alert to the impact of these variables, and they must also monitor their own emotional reactions and mood to m::ake sure that the.ir feelings do not ))I) BRAIN BYTE Recent ne-ufdOgic:31discoveries may help explain the foots of e-mpathy as well as the (ISkS ot ,.;cafious ttauma foe those- in the hefpi~ pfofessions. When we listen to 0t obServe others, •mifl'Of neufons• in our btains tend to fire in the same way as tr'IOse of OU( clients. Put simi;::iy, when we heaf abOut 0r witness an event OUf bralfls respond in the same way as if we expe-rienced the event directly. As a res.ult.. OU( fee-tings tend to mimic our clients' feelings. Empathic Connec tions 163 ncgntivdy impact the work. Grancllo and Young (2012) cmphasi:e that "clients in counseling must be nJlowcd to work through their own issues without regard to the changing emotional state of the counselor" (p. 119). Counsellors can hcJp clients consider how their emotions might be intcrfe.ring with decision making or eve.ryday life. Decision making, for example, may be difficult when clients' emotions pull them in different directions; however, many unhappy feelings. such as sadness, anger, grief, and disappointment, are part of everyone's life. (n fact, feelings like grief are healing responses., and they arc not usuaJly pathologicnJ or in need of treatment. The Language of Emotions Our language has wisely sensed the tivo sides of being alone. It has created the ulOrd "loneliness" ro express the pain of being alone. And it has creared the u:ord "solitude" ro express the glory of being alone. - Paul Tillldi (TM Etn-naJ Nou,. 1952) Much of counselling involves gening in touch with the subjective experience of cli.ents, particularly in the emotional domain. CounscJlors are constantly chnllcngcd to understand and respond to the range of subtle feelings that clients express in language that they can unde.rstand and accept. Despite the fact that there are hundreds of words for emotions in the English language, words alone often fail to communicate precise information about client fee.lings. A client who says, "I'd kill for a chocolate ice cream," is dca.rly exaggerating. Another might minimi!e a problem, saying, "It doesn't bother me," but context and other cues might reveal evidence of profound pain. Table 6.1 presents a feeling inventory of the most common families of emotions. lt is self-e-.•ident that cmotionaJ intensity varies among people depending on the circumstances. Sometimes., word modifiers (e.g., t'ff)', exr.remely, .somewhat, mosdy, and lirrle) serve to limit, quantify, and add further precision to the levcJ and type of emotion expressed. For example, we can expect some difference in emotional levcJ between people who describe themselves as somewhat happy and others who say they arc incredibly happy. Metaphors Metaphors describe a state by using a symbol in a direct comparison. For example, a diem who says he is "going around in circles" is using a metaphor to describe his fedings of confusion. Herc arc some metaphors with the possible fccJing that cnc.h one su~ests: ■ tied up in knots. in a pres.sure cooker (stressed) ■ about to blow up, bent out of shape (furious and angry) ■ on a sinking ship, down in the dumps (hopeless) ■ tearing my hair out (s\\--ampcd) ■ in a sticky situation (vulnerable) ■ between a rock and a hard pince (helpless., confused, and ambivalent) ■ butterflies in m't' stomach (fear and excitement) ■ on top of the ,vorld, on cloud nine (happy and ecstatic) ■ taken for granted (dcva.Jucd and put down) ■ going around in circles, feding pulled apart (confused and ambivalent) ■ Cfi on face. lilcc cw'O cents (embarrassed and shamed) In addition, sometimes people use metaphoric phrases to describe ways of dealing with emotions, such as "rising above it." 164 Chap1er 6 TABLE 6.1 Feeling Inventory Intensity tateao,y ot Emodon Ana,e, fur tow Level annoyed. il'filated, miffed, olfencled, resenthA, ptOVOked. disi:,eased. aggravated. put off, licked, upset and disturbed Medltn levet Hieb level angry, mad, hOstile. hatefu l, disgusted, inflamed, in a tiff, fed up. sore. agttated, and seettlS'lg outtaged, fu(ioUS, ve~hA, repulsed, bOili~. in a fage-. irate, and infufiated alarmed, net'VO!Js, anxious, teased, uneasy, timid, bOthered. apprehensive. frightaned. scared. WOr'ried, distressed. fearful, jumpy, and ShOC:ked. hottified, pa.ntked, uptlgl\t and c()lj sweat confodent, capai:.e, adepL healthy, quaHfied, whole. ene~oo. dynamic, tough, suong, brave, detefmined, and secufe irwulnetable, in conttol. OOld, potent. couragoous. and unbeatable weak, vulnerable, falling apart. burnt defenseless, impotent, worthless. no good, po-Net'less, ex.r.austed. lifetes.s. useless, and petnfM!d terl'ifted, mortified, terrorized, intimidated, and butte-rflies Ellll)Owerment adequate, up to the d'lalleoge. able to cope, and stable Vulnerability OO!k.ate, insecufe, Umk:1, Shy, small. ftagne, tifed. weary, emba(tassed, Sl)O()ked. Joy~leasure Saidness appfe-heosive, and concemed sick, i.ncompetent, i.nadequate, and unptotected, frail saUsfM!d, i,ad, good, pleaSed, and eotnfortable happy, contented. joy!IA, loY<d, excited. optimistic, and cheerful disappcinted. hurt, trout:,oo, unhappy, glum. sad. depressed. melanchOly, blue, lonely, dismal, and pessimistic: cSowncast, upset and bOlhefed focus distracted. muddled, u~rtain, OOUbtful, hesitant, mixed up, unsure, and indeeisive Shame out, eowafdty, helpless. usetess, embartassed, humbled, and regretful Surprise startled. and puzzled love atttaeted, and friendly confused. baffled, per~oo. puzzled, ambivalent. stumped. jumbled, disjointed. and frustrated belittled, diSCfedited. guilty, Shamed, femorseful, and ashamed surprised, stuMed, and shocked ctose, intimate, wa(m, tendet, Cherished. smitten v.;th, anddoti~on euphOric, jubilant, ecstatic:, thrilled, delighted. passionate-. elated, mal'W!IOuS., fu!I ot life, terrifoe, and o,e,joy,!d agonized, dejected, de<pairi~. de<pandent. hopetess, and miserable (_.. a state oO pandemonium O( chaos, mystified, and swamped disgraced, scanda~. huniliated, and mortified astonished, astounded, flabbergasted, amazed, overwhelmed. anct in a-.ve IOvecl, adOl'ed, entaptured, craiy abOut, wild aoout, flip over, idOliZe. and worship Nonverbal Communication of Emotions One key to successful communication is monitoring a nd understanding the nonverbal channcJ of communication. Body langun,;e (especially facial expression): voe.al c ues such as tone, intensity, rate of spe«h; and affect are essenti3l components of emotions that confirm, embellish, or commdiet verbal statements. All cues should be interpreted cautiousJy, including these common ones: tears, forced smiles, grimaces, covering clenched fist. shaking, becoming silent, smiling, shaking he1ld, pacing. looking at the floor, turning away, and 't·elling. For example, lack of eye contact may be culturally appropriate in some Indigenous groups in Canada, and so non-Indigenous helpers should 00( inte.rp ret it as a sign of disrespect. Counsellors need to remember that their O\\'n nonverbal communication is not always under che.ir control, and it may be outside their lcvcJ of awareness. As Sue and Sue (2008) note, a counsellor "who has not adequatel't' dealt with his o r her O\\'n biases and racist attitudes may unwitting),., communicate them to a culturally diffe.rent client" (p. 171). Despite their words and seated intentions, their nonverbal communications express an uncensored meaning. Empathic Connections 165 Individual Differences and Cultural Context All feelings can be c:xpcricnc~ as positive or negative 3t wrying lcvcls of intensity, but this subjective determination is individunJt,., defined. For some ~pie, anxiety c:m be debilitating, serious!'>' affecting: the quality of thc.ir lives; however, for an athlete the same emotion may arouse a competitive spirit and the individu:.d might thrive on its physi.ologicaJ consequences. CounscJlors need to remember that their clients ma'>' respond with emotional reactions very different from their own- with similar fccJings, sharply different feeling:~ without significant cmotionaJ reactions, or with markedly increased or decreased intensity; therefore, counscllors should a,-oid using: thc.ir own mC3suring: criteria to interpret the emotions of others. For example, if they expect rhal people in crisis will be verb3J 3nd ded3re their pain, then they might miss the fact th3t the quiet child is much ncedie.r th3n the one who is 3cting out. But circumstances and context 3re not 31\\"ll)'S good predictors of feelings. One person miaht be anxious about public spC31cing but find the experience exhilarating, while another pe.rson is terrified by the prospect. One individu3l might enjoy parties 3nd be stimulnted by the ch3nee to meet new people, but a second person looks for any excuse to avoid the p3nic brought on by c.rowdcd social events. Consequently, when the mean,. ing is notobviou~ counsellors should aslc clients to explain the.ir emotional experiences. In the following example, the counsellor m31ces erroneous assumptions 3nd then, sensitive to the client's nonverbal mess3gc, ,vorks to correct the error. This models openness to the diem 3nd serves to reinforce the rea1it)• that counsellors arc not pc.rfcct. Client: Mr mother isrominato visit me ,~t wttk. CounS(>IJOr. Oh, th::u'!i nice. h'!i alwa)'!i $trt:::II when you h::n,e:. chance to see ,.·our (olh. Client: (H~tatmg.) I ttuess so. CounseUor. (Pk ldng up on tht- clit'flt'f htutadan.) Perh::aps I was mo h:lSt't' in assu mh)¥ you Yi'Ould be happ)' th:u she was cornini, I should h::a"e waited un1i.1 you told me how you (elt. How do ,.·ou foe.I :iliout her \ti.Sit! Client: I dre::.d it. ?l.·1y mother :dw3)'S w::ants to tell rne hoo• to run my li(e. lndh•iduals arc also often governed by cultural norms, and there 3re wide vari.ances in the e>..'tent and manner to which they express emotions. Some cultures value emotionnJ expression, whereas others favour emotional restraint. CulrurnJ empathy (Connie.r & H3c.kncy, 2008) requires counsellors to pay 3ttention to both cukurnJ 3S well as contextunJ considerations. Note th3t emp3thic responses should be culturally appropriate with consideration of issues of pride and shame. For some dientSi, empathic responses m3y le3d to embarrassment and "loss of (acc." Thu Si, diem receptivity to empathic responses should be conside.red. Ambivalence Clients interpret their own problems and expc.riences and find them frequendy compli.catcd by multiple and seemingl,.•contradictory feelinas from two or more emotional famj,. lies(sce Table 6.2). A great deal of stress and confusion can 3risc from the pushes and pulls of competing fcdings that, if unm3naged, C3n disrupt a client's life. The tenns ambi1~lence and of tu'O minds are often used. Ambivalence is normal, and although it can kttp people stuck, identifteation, exploration, and resolution of ambivalence can be a wlunble P3rt of decision making, Four key questions can be used to systematicaJly ewlu3te options: I . What 3re the 3dvant3ges o( m3intaining the status quo! 2. What 3re the 3dvant3ges o( changing! 3. What 3re the diS3dvantages of the status quo? 4 . What 3re the diS3dvantages of ch3nging? 166 Chap1er 6 TABLE 6.2 Common Mixed Feelings Happy and scared Happy and sad Depressed and fed up This olten arises in coojul'd.ion with a lifestyle change (e.g., getti~ ma«ied, retumtng to Sd'IOOI, starting a MN job. sending child(en to daycare, and experienctng the "emp1:y nesr when children le.ave hOme). Some transilional life events, such as leava"lg one job lot anotner or seeing a chik:I off to COilege (or kinde(garten, etc.), elicit these leeli~. A sense o( IOSs as well as gain is olten present. These feelings suggest that the person has "bOttOO'led out.· Significantly, 100 feeling of be.-ig led up may be used as a st(ong morivatOr' for change (e.g., deckli~ to change a self~estrucrive drug habit). An&ry and afraid fear i:S often the n'IOr'e significant emorioo, but anger is m::>re c0tM1ooly expressed (e.g.., a pa(ent fad~ a teenage!' wM is 1wo hours late fOr' curlew). Hopeful and despairing Many clients fluctuate between believing tr.at cha~ is possit:,e with the potential for lite to get bette( and that nothi~ Viill knprove and further effort i:S futje. Oe\ltllOping and susiaintng motivation is crucial in such situations (e.g., a pe(son cop.-ig with a life-threatening i!Joess). Many people who am consideri~ changes in thei( lives experience tnese footi~. Part of them wants thi~ to be diffetent, and part wants the security of thei( p(esent situation. however, distressflA (e.g.• a perSOn contemplating leav.-ig an abusive (elatioos.hip). Attracted and repelled <•Pt>roaclll avoid) Love and hate This usually arises in the face of conttadictory evidence (e.g., a friend whOSe behaviour i:S ooatic-sometimes IOvi~. sometimes abuSive). This method adcnowlcdgcs thnt there arc costs nnd benefits to each co urse of action. lt aJso presents a nonjudgmental way to honour the fact that clients ma,., resist chnnae for good reason, even when they P3Y a henvy price for doing so. For example, a client may continue to abuse su bstances despite enormous persona] and financial costs because it provides relief from h is severe d ep ression. SUCCESS TIP Counsetors need to remember that dients are lhe ex.pe(ts on theif own lives and tr.al they have made the best chc::ice frOO'l what they consider to be thei( available options. Counselling empowers dients by hell)lng them identify add1t.ional ctu::ices and by helpi.ng them to address or remove barrie-rs to options that were not seen as viable. Motivational Jnterviewing (Miller & Rollnick, 2013) was developed as a collnbo rativc communication style specifically for assisting clients co resolve ambivalence. Empathy, a ccncraJ feature of Motivational lnterviewing "normalizes ambivaJence and demonsmttes that the counsellor unconditionally accepts the client" (Capu:i.zi & Stauffor, 20 16, p. I 53). This popular, evidence~bascd approach will be~xplored in derail in Chnpter 7. Example: A wonun dest:ribes the j~• she felt when her son ielt home l'O b¢in trainiO¥ as a counsel~ lor. but as she c~lb, her ~-es well u p with tears. C learly. she is expe-riendn&:. scrona sense o( los!l. despite the fact t~t words speak to her prkle and happiness.. More accur.nely. both (eelin~ exist sl1nultaneo usly. SUCCESS TIP When responding to clients who express mixed foolt.ngs, say and instead of but. This rS less confrontational and fully honours the presence of bOth feelings. Empathic Connec tions 167 People also have feelings about the emotions they experience. Sometimes they are very aware of these mixed fccJings. sometimes not. Try this simple experiment. C lose 't'our eyes and r«all a r« cnt strong emotion, such as anger o r joy. Take a moment to get in touch with 't'OUr feelings. Now try to complete this sentence, "l feel about feeling (your recent strong emotion)." Many readers will find that this simple exercise leads to a deeper unde.rst:.mding of the.ir emotions. Some may find guilt behind their joy; others fear. Mixed fttlings arc often associated with anxiety and stress, especially when the fttlings require opposing responses. Jf a person is both attracted to and repelled by a particular choice. anxiety is likely to continue until he o r she resolves the dilemma. Affect affect: A tera t!lat counS!lors uS! to desuibe hlw~ tiprm emo:ioa. blunted: Eaotiouespressi>n is less than one aight eapa:t. flat: Ttie,e is an absellce« ne.- abS!IICe ol any s.ps of emational expessica inappropriate: TIie perso.'s manner • d mood cootr,dict what one might espe«. For a clieal migflt laugll ,...ile describing die deatl of • is MIiier. w_., labile: Tliere is abncmal variability ii affect. wiih rti)eated, rapid, and atwupt shifts in affective e,:pressica restricted or constricted: Tllereis a aild reduuion in die range • d intensiy ol emoti>nal tipression. affective disorders: Distarbaaces in aood. indllding d~ss• • d mania. mood disorders: See also affective d;SIXders. dysthym.ia: Achronic tonditi>n 11ith S)fflptom similar to depfessi>n bell duit an less sMre. Affect is a term co u nsellors use to describe how people express emotions like sadness, excitement, and anger. C ulrurc and context help to define what is considered within the "normal range" of affect. Moreover, affect is communicated through voice tone and quality, posture. facial expressions. a nd other nonverbal cues. These terms arc o fte n used to describe affect: • • • • • Blunte& EmotionaJ expression is less than one might expect. Flat: There is an absence o r near absence of any signs of emotional expression. Inappropriate·: The per son's manner and mood contradict what one might expect. For example. a dicnt might laugh while describing the d eath of his mother. Labile: There is abnormal variability in affect, with repeated, rapid, and abrupt shifts in affective expression. Restric.ted or constric.ted: There is a mild reduction in the range a nd intensity of emotionaJ expression. (For more information, sec Amer ican Psychiatric Associa.tion, Diagnostic and StmisticaJ Manual of McntaJ Disorders., 4th ed., 2000.) Psychologists and other mental health professionals use the terms affective disorders o r mood dic;;orders to describe a variety of disturbances in mood. T he most common mood disorders are major depression, d't•sthymia, a nd bipolar disorder. Cfi,. ents with major depression arc likely to experience many of the following symptoms: depressed mood; inab ility to experience p leasure: loss o f energy and interest in life and wo rk; changes in appetite; sleep d istur bances (especially insomnia)~ decrease in sexual energy; feelings of ,vo rthlcssncss, helplessness., guilt, anxiety, or pessimism; and thoughts of d eath o r suicide. Oysthymia is a chronic condition with symptoms similar to d ep ression but that arc less intense. 'W ith b ipo lar d isorder, clients have alternating depressive and manic episodes. Manic episodes inclu de these symptoms: abnormally elc..,ated mood, irritability, hostility, grandiosity, ovcractivit)', flight of ideas., decreased need for sleep. a nd buying sprees or other indicators of poor judgment (Da..,is, 2006; American Psychiatric Association, 2000). In these situations, refc.rral to a physician should be considered as an adjunct to counselling (see Chapter 9 for 3 more in-depth d iscussion). EMPATHY It is the mind which create-s the world about us, and euen though u:e srand side b:>· side in the same meadou\ nt)' eyes will never see whar is beheld by )'Ours, ID)' heart will never stir to the e-morions with which yours is rouched. ~or~-t Gissina (1857- 19.13) 168 Chap1er 6 Empathy Defined In cveryda'>' terms, emparh1 means seeing the world through someone clsc's eyes. For the purposes of counselling. though, cmp3thy is defined as "the process of accuratdy understanding the emotional pc.rspcctivc of 3nother ~rson and the communication of this understanding" (Shcbib, 1997, p. 177). The primary objective of empathy is to understand and respond to feeling~ but there is 3Jso a cognitive component. Reiter (2008) defines cognitive cmP3thy as "an understanding of the values, worldvicw, and intentions of the client" (p. I09). Cognitive empnthy is an cs.sc:nti3l component of appreciating how emotions arc experienced and understood from the client's perspective. But as Baron.-Cohcn (2003) note~ "empathi!ing does not entail just the cold caku13rion of what someone else thinks and feels. . . . EmP3thi!ing occurs when we fee] an appropriate emotionnJ reoccion, nn emotion trigge.red by the other person's emotion, and it is done in order to unde.rstand another person, to predict their behavior, and to conn«t or resonate with them emotionally" (p. 2). To be dfective, empathi!ing needs to come from n position of compassion and caring. Rogers ( 1980) outlined what he considered to be the essential clements of empathy: ■ Entering the private perceptual w-orld of the other and becoming thoroughl)• at home in it. ■ Being sensitive, moment to moment, to the changing felt meanings that flow in chis other person. ■ Temporarily living in his or her life, moving about in it deJic:ately without making judgments. ■ Sensing meanings of which he or she is scarcet,., aware. ■ Not crying to uncover feelings of which the person is totally unaware, since this would be coo threatening. (p. 142) SUCCESS TIP Empathy needs to be expfessed to be effective. The empathic process rS not complete until clients have an opportun.ty to confirm, correct. or embelli:sh lheit feell.ngs, and they know that U'leit feelings am understOOCI and appreci'.ated. The Importance of Empathy Carl Rogers (1902- 1987), one of the most influential psychologists of the twentieth century, wrote and lectured extensively on the importance of empathy in counselling. He conceptunli!ed empathy as one of the core conditions of helping (along with unconditionaJ positive regard and congruence) that determine the outcome of counselling. In fact, Rogers argued that the core conditions we.re not onh• necessary but also suff1eient co effect change. Near the end of his life, he offered this comment on the importance of empathy: "To my mind, empathy is in itseJf a healing agent. 1t is one of the most potent aspects of therapy, b«ause it releases, it confirm~ it brings even the most frightened client into the human race. If a person can be understood, he or she b.-loTIJ:S"(l981, p. 181). Empathy is a fundamental building block for the helping relationship nnd is clearly connected to positive outcomes in counselling(Table 6.3 outlines some of the ways that emP3thy hclps clients). le is widet,., nmlced as among the highest qualities that a counsellor can possess (Cla.rk, 2007, 201 0; Egan & Shroeder, 2009; Reiter, 2008; Roge.r~ 1980; Empathic Connections 169 TABLE 6.3 How Empathy Helps Encoufages ex.pressioo of emotions. which is cathartic Normalizes and validates feelings, reduces isolation, and contributes to 100 develOpme-nt of the counselling relationship ll'k:l"eases awareness ot emotions, including ambivalent feelings Stimulates furthe( explOr'ation of clients' sut,ective ex.pe-riences Helps clients (ecogrwle the impact of emotions oo themselves and others Assists d ieots to uooerstand how emotions influence decision maid~ Of hOw they can impede action Provides a starting JX)int b managi~ and expressing emotions in constr'ucrive ways (e.g., r'e cogoiZi~ triggers) and Shulman, 2009). Emp3thy is a powerful hdping tool nnd a core condition for nJI hcJping rcJationships, reg3rdlcss of the counselling or therapeutic model adopted. Among clients who abuse substance~ research shows that empathy is one of the strongest predictors of success in reducing relapse (Miller, Forccchime~ & Zwcbcn, 201 I). Appropriate empathy communicates understanding, builds trust, and assists in establishing the counsellor's credibility. Miller and Rollnid: (2002) conclude that the degree of empathy expressed by counsellors is a signifteant determinant of the success of clients in addictions treatment, whereas confrontationaJ counseJling leads to high dropout rates and poor outcomes. P«>plc tend to protect thcmsdvcs from judgment and rejection through defensive reactions or by e\lading disclosure; howeve.r, as Clark (2007) obse.rves, empathic responses reduce ps,.·chologicaJ threat. Effective empathy is nonjudgmental and it is non prescriptive (i.e., it docs not suggest that the client's feelings need to be changed or "treated"). The counsellor's manner and cone convey acceptance, comfort, and capacity co listen. When counsellors arc empathic, they arc less likely to oversimplify complex problems. Because they understand more, they are aJso less prone to insult their clients with wcll~mcnning but unusab le and premature advice. A common counselling error is to move too quiclcl)• to problem solving when, for many clients, their difficulty is primaril)• emotional. They may al'l"COOy have ready solutions to their problems, but emotional tur• moil or ambivalence is a barrier preventing action. As a result, they arc unab le to engage in taking action until the.ir emotionaJ needs are unde.rstood and managed. By assisting clients to understand and manai;c feeling~ energy is freed up for problem solving and clients ma)' be able to move ahead without further counsellor involvement. Counsellors who accept the feelings of their clients help them accept themselves and their feelings. Effective empathy honours the fact that clients have real and rational rt':lsons for feeling as they do. Roi;crs (1980) note~ "True empathy is always free of any evaluative or diagnrucic qualit)t The recipient perceives this with some surprise: 'If I am not being juds;cd, pc.rhnps I am nm so evil or abnormal as I Juve thought. Perhaps I don't have to Jud~ myself so harshly.' Thus, the possibilit)• of sclf..acccptance is graduaJly increased" (p. 154). Rogers further suggests that empathy is more than just a skill- it is a Wtt)' of be.ing with another pe.rson. As he succinctly put it, "The ideal therapist is, first of aJI, empathic" (1980, p. 146). As important as empathy is, it should not prcdude efforts to understand other parts of clients' experience~ such as their thoughts, experiences, behaviour, and the context in which they live the.ir lives. Empathy aJso assists clients in identifying and labelling feelings, which allows them to deal with thrue feelings. Moreover, with strong and supportive counsellor~ clients can find the courage to den] with feelings that may have been too painful or overwhelm,. ing to address on the.ir own. In this sense, empathy conrributcs to therapeutic chan,;c. 170 Chap1er 6 ))I) BRAIN BYTE Recent f&Seatch at the Mount Sinai Medical Center (2012) has found lhat an ate-a of the brain known as the antef10t insular cortex is wtle-re empathy is p(ocesSed. This frnding has huge futute implications foe conditions suctl as autis.m, dementia. and some perSOnality disol"derS whete a laek of empathy is a centtal feature. Furthermore, clients often adopt the communication patterns of their counsellors. Thus, counscllors who use empathic communication nnd other active listening skills arc modelling skills that clients can use to improve their rcJationships with others. CounscJlor empathy modcls a healthy and effective way of communiating. To cmpathi.!e cffectivel't', counsellors need to be able to demonstrate comfon with a wide range of feelings. For instance, they need to be able to talk openly about painful feelings such as grief. Just as doctors and nurses need to be able to dea.1 with catastrophic injury without losing control or running away, counscllors must develop their capacity to w-ork with intense feelings without neo:ling to change the subject, intcllccruali!e, or offer quid: fixes. Sometimes counsellors misinterpret this capacity as meaning that they nttd to be emotionaJly detached nnd coldly indifferent. ln fact, empathic counseJlors are deeply involved with the.ir clients. They put aside or suspend the.ir own reactions to their clients' fccJings and adopt an accepting and nonjudgmental attitude. Rogers (1961) emphasi!cs the neo:I to "sense the client's private world ns if it were your own, but without ever losing the 'as if' qua1it)• . .. To sense the client's anger, fear, or confusion as if it were your own, yet without your own anger, fear, or confusion getting bound up in it" (p. 284). Rogers aJso provides this important observation about emP3thy: You 13)' aside your own "iews and "alueii in order t'O enter aiu>the-r'ii ",orld without preJudiee. In some se~, it means that you lay aside )·Our self: thiii can only be done by persons who are secure eoou~, in themselves that ther k°""• they will noc iet loiit in what tlU)' tum out to be the !ltr.ln,ii' or bi:arre \\'Oddo( the other. ai,d th::u ther can comfortablr return t'O their OYi'n world when ther wi.iih. (1980. p. 143) An empathic connection does not mean that we endorse our clients' \'lews or behaviour. As Miller nnd Rollnick (2002) note, "It is possible to accept and understand a person's perspective while not agreeing with or endorsing it. Neither does an attitude of acceptance prohibit the counselor from differing with the client's views nnd expressing that dive.ri;cncc" (p. 37). In extreme cases, clients may present with attirudcs and behaviour that we find abhorrent- a man who has ab used his partner, for example. Understanding this client's inner world in such a case may even be vitaJ, as it establishes the counscllor's credibility for understanding and, subsequent!)•, as a potential influence to help the client move toward non-violent responses. ln such situation~ empathic efforts often help counsellors to become less reactive with their O\\•n feelings after they learn about the complexities of their clients' lives. > : •. Gwen Oewaf (2015) reviewed fecent research on empathy and the bt'ain and re(X)rted a numbef ot significant findings. She found that ex(X)Sure to medta violanee can blunt ou, ability to be empathic to other'S. She also reported that the fesearch suggests that we afe less sensitive to lhe pain and em::>tions of others when they are str-angers, members ot a differ'ent race or subgroup, Or' individuals who am subject to social stigma. Empathic Connections 171 Client Reactions to Empathy ClicnL,;; may respond to empathy differently. Posit ive reactions include: ■ ROOuction of pain through the rclensc of feelings (catharsis): ■ Increased insight as feelings arc rccogniz~, 13bellcd, and managed; and Increased trust and rapport with the counscJlor. Nc,zath·e reac.rions include: ■ Anger at the counsellor for crenting rhc conditions that led co their feelings being exposed; ■ Embarrassment arising from fear of being judg,ed as wcalc; ■ A sense of intrusion if empathy violates pcrsonnJ, familial, or cukuroJ vaJucs that preclude sharing feelings with others; and ■ Fear of continuing the counselling work if empathy pushes the client to deal with feelings before they arc rc3dy. Consequent!)•, in sessions where powerful feelings are reve3Jcd, counsellors should leave time to process thedicms' rcoctions. This might uncover any feelings or concerns that should be addressed before moving on, or it may prevent clients from dropping out of counselling. Example-: CounseUor. \Vhen you 1.-0 home toni~u and retlect about wh:u you shared rn,b)•. "-hat do )'Ou think you m~t say to )'OurSelf! Client: I think I'll beembr:lfr.l:;$$('d that I eriied. You must think I'm really w~k and (r.11i:Ut. CounseUor. \VouJd )'Ou like to know how I (eel! Client: Sure! CounseUor. I'll tell you, but first I W'3nt to know i( )'Ou will belie,'t, rne. Client: You\'t, always been up front with me. I'll believe )'Ou. CounseUor. I think it took 2 lot o( ooura~ for )'Ou to be open with )'Our (eelin~s. and I respect )'OU for takina th:u step. For me. it was 2 sian o( stren,tth. In some e,ses, the di31o~ue mi$:ht take a different route sucl-i 2s the (olJowina: Coun!l(>IJOr. I'll tell you, but first I W'3nt to know i( )'Ou will belie,'t, me. Client: You·n probably just 5::1)' somethi11K to m.:11ke me (~I better. CounseUor. So. let's talk about what needs t'O h:tppen before you ea.n trust me. Sometimes clients who have shar~ dee-ply come to the next session dcte.rmined to exercise more control over their emotions. They may appc3r defensive or withdrawn. A lead such as, "\Vhat are )'OUr thoughts and feelings about the last rime we met?" can be used to debrief the Inst meeting. On the other hand, it may be healthy to avoid confronting this apparent resistance; instead, see it as a healthy W'n)' for the client to feel safe and g:iin composure. Angus and Greenberg (2011) su~cst that some clients have developed problematic emotional responses that often originate from trauma. For example, if a client learned as a child that closeness and kindness was followed by sexual abuse, then, as an adult, she may respond to empathy and requests for intimacy as an impending violation. As a result, counsellor empathy may be- met with anger and rejection, particularly in the early developmental scages of the relationship. On the other hand, sensitive and weJl-timcd (measured) empathy can provide an opponunity for he.r to begin to address how prior learning, while protective at one time, now prevents her from dcvcJoping deep and meaningful relation.ships. Exploring emotions associated with the trauma can help her become unstuck from automatic emotionaJ reocrions and ncrions that arc no longc.r useful or appropriate. 172 Chap1er 6 _ CONVERSATION 6.1 STUDE:NT: I WOtAd realty like 10 incfe-ase my empathy Slults. but my \'OCabulary is so limited. I seem to k.nO'N only a few fooling v.()fdS, such as happy, sad, scafed, and angry. How can I increase my feeling WOtd d'loice? TEACH£R: It's not necessary to have an eocyctopedic \'OCabula,y, but you should have eoough WOr'd ctu:ice to capture a tx"oad range ot feelings. Study Table 6.1 (which appeared earlier in thi:S chapter) for new feeling v.«ds: 100n take advantage ot every opportunity to practice empathy and use U'lese v.()rdS. The lnte-r~t has many s,tes 1001 feature leeli~ word inventOl'ies and these can be usehA, but remember that feel- ings are often mixed. Try reading books and watching TV with a special ear for discemiog how people are feeling. One of the t>est ways is to use invtlational empathy to as.k others hoN they feel. then to listen carefully to their WOtds. This wil help se-nsitize you to their unique \'OCabulary. By adopting an attitude ot inte-test and curiosity and focus~ on feelf'lgs, you can dramaticaly k'letease your vocabulary. AnOlher suategy 'llf'len listening to clients is to lty to recall footings that you migt.l have had in similar d r'Cumstances. This might give you some ten1ati\ie: ideas abOul what yolM' dien1 could be fooling. STUDE:NT: What abOut the danger ot imposing my feeli~ on them? TEACHER: Yes, lhat is atways a tisk. Hence the need to be tentative, remembering that people may respond to IM same situation in widety different ways. NevertheleSs, there are often SCll'M comrn:::,n aoo predic1able emotions fot most people in a given situation. It's also important to w0tk on beeoming aware of yout own lee6~. TYPES OF EMPATHY The three types of empnrhy arc invitational cmp3thy, basic cmP3thy, 3nd inferred cmpa, thy. \\:'Ith invirotionaJ empnthy, a counsellor uses strategies to encourage clients to rolk about thc.ir fcclings. With basic empath)•, a counsellor mirrors what the client has explicitly said. And with inferr~ empathy, a counsellor reaches empathic undc.rst:mding b)• interpreting subtle dues. At 30)' point in an interview, counsellors can use empnthy to explore a client's bdi.aviour, thinking, or feelings. \\:'hen counscllors focus on behaviour, they explore what clients arc doing or saying or they shift anemion to problem solving. When they pursue thinking, they are interested in their clients' bcliefs and assumption~ including their inner dialogue and self-esteem. Empnthy enables counsellors to pay primary anention to the third area-feelings (Figure 6.1). Frequently, counsellors are too anxious to solve prob lems, and they move the interview focus prematurely to prob lem Thinking Feelings Figure 6.1 Empathy Focuses the Work of Counselling on the Feeling Domain Empathic Connections 173 solving, ignoring, or discounting whnt may be more important thnn solution~ their clients' feelings. invitational empathy: Ato:il a counsel!« uses to ..,ur;aie clieali to esi,:lore eaotioa. Invitational Empathy I m •itational empathy encouragesdients to explore emotions. It signals intent (or an invi,. tntion) to move the interview 3'\-,t)' from one of the other domains (behaviour/problem solving or thinking) to a focus on emotions. lnvitationaJ empathy is initiated with a simple question such a~ "How do you feel?" Another choice is to say something like, "It might be helpful if we put solving this problem aside for a moment to explore how you feel." lf appropriate, counsellors can make further process comments about the importance of addressing feelings as an integral part of problem management. lnvirotional empathy SO)'S to the diem that the counsellor is re3dy and able to ta1k about difficult feelings. Todo this, counsellors can draw on their knowledge of human growth and devclopmcm, such as ways thnt people tend to deal with particular life evcms and crises. Some clients are reluctant to share their feelings for fear of judgment, or they ma,., believe that they shouldn't feel a particular way. Others may think they arc the "only one" or that they are "crazy," "evil," or "abnormal." For example, it is common to feel some relief, even happiness (as well as grief) when a loved one who has been struggling with a painful illness dies, but a diem may feel guilty for feeling this''",.)'· Invitational empathy normalizes the expc.ricncc, making it easier for the client to talk about it and accept it: "h's normal at a time like this to struggle with mixed foeli~rief, pain, comfort, and perhaps joy that her suffering is at an end." By encouraging clients to talk about feelings and then responding nonjudgmentally, the counsellor is saying, "It's olcny to fee] this way." In the following example, the coun.scJlor uses invitational empathy to "give permission" to a client who might othenvise suppress or ignore his pain to experience and verbali.!c his emotions: Client: I ttuess it's no biide3L So. wh:lt i( the)' know the scoop on my m::arit::il problems.! CounS(>IJOr. A lot o( people in the S3me situation 1ni~t (eel emb::ar~ a.nd perhaps di~ppointed or :l..11ir)' that a (rie:nd oouJd be so indiscreet about son~hi1'{t ~id in eonf",denee. In the following example, the counsellor uses nonverbal cues as a basis for invirn,. tionnl empathy to encourage the client to explore a difficult topic: CounS(>IJOr. \VouJd )'Ou mind i( I shared 2n obser\'ation with rou! I ,nay be wron~. so I'd like your opin.On. Client: Sure. 1.-0 ahead. 53,., it. CounS(>IJOr. I notiee that wbene,'er mention o( )'Our l2ther eomes up. you seem keen 10 ehan~ the topie. (Lon,g s1lmce; dknt starts a, tht- jloorJ CounseUor. Some memories are p.,infol- maybe e"en too painful to talk 2bout. Client: (So/d,. tears ln hiseyd..) h's just th3t his death wu so unexptteed. ~e h:ld 2 fl$:ht th:11 mornilli, 2nd I didn't e"en i.~t a eh:1..1,ee to sar ~b)'e. Invitational empathy begins with questions and responses tnrgctcd at encouraging clients to express feelings. The choice o( strategy is influenced by the usual variables, including the amount of trust in the relationship. time constraint~ culture, and the counsellor's role. Timing is one o( the most important variables. Since the exploration o( feelings can be time.consuming, it is important for counsellors to make sure that they have enough time to complete the process. Intelligent use of silence is another important variable. Clients may need thc.ir counsellors to patiendy listen and restrain themselves from filling evc.ry silent moment with words. 174 Chap1er 6 One w3y to brid,;c the inte.rvicw into 3 discussion of feelings is to use invitational statements, such 3S "I don't know how you fed, but if you're feeling pain or lonelines~ I'm f'COOy to listen." Comments such as "I need 't'our hdp in understanding: your feelings" c3n also move the interview into the 3ffcctive-or feding--area. Frequently, clients pro\•ide n3tural opportunities when thq• give hints about how they are feeling:. Then the counsellor can use questions to encourage further sharing. Open questions promote clients to sh3re feelings: "How 3re you feeling?" "\Vhat feelings best describe how 't'OU reacted!" Closed questions t3Jl:Ct spccifte information 3bout feelings: "Did you fed angry?" "ls this something: you feel strongly 3bout!" Helping clients understand the importance of 3ddressing feelings is 3n important step th3t keeps clients involved in decision m3king (contracting). \Vhcn counsellors inform cliems and solicit their support for the proces~ clients' motivation is higher. He.re are some sample lc3ds: ■ I think it might hdp if we shift our focus and talk 3 bit about how you feel. This might hclp us both to understand why your decision is so difficult. ■ \Ve haven't yet talked about your feelings. In my experience, feelings often present one of the biggest b3rricrs. ■ Umil feelings arc unde.rstood 3nd 3Ccepted, they can distort our thinking: 3nd even reduce the 3mount of control we have ove.r our behaviour. So 't'OU might find it useful if we spend some time exploring how you feel In addition, directives c3n be used to move the interview into the feeJing are3: "Tell me how you feel." "let's switch our focus and talk about your feelings.'' Directives arc one w3y to man3g,e the flow and focus of the interview. Moreover, with some clients, counsellor sclf-disdosure is 3 Pffi\'Crful tool if used sparingl,.•: "I don't know how it is for you, but I know that for m3ny months 3ftcr my marri3g,eended, I was in a state of shock." Another tool for exploring fcding.s is the sentence completion statement. Sentence completion statements give counsellors a way to focus feelings on a particular arc3, and they give freedom to clients to control the 3nswer. ■ \Y./hen I think about 31) my problems., I feel . .. ■ If I could use one feeling to describe my situ3tion, it ,vould be . ■ \Y./hen I first came for counselling., 1 fclt . ■ The feelings th3t 1 most nttd to deal with arc . . But invit3tion3l cmp3thy should 3fways respect the clients' rights to privacy. Many variables., especially trust, imp3Ct the e>..'tent that any client is willing to open up and discuss fceJings. In addition, vari3bles such as gender, past experience, socializ3tion, mood, 3nd power issues can also influence how much individuals 3re willing to share. Basic Empathy 'With basic empathy, counsellors perceive 3nd respond to feeJings that 3rc explicitly communic3ted. Basic cmP3th't' ma't' involve labelling feelings or summ3ri! ing expressed feelings. Frequently, clients W3nt to talk about feelings. particular!,.• those closely rclated to their problem situations. \Vhcn they take the initiative to introduce feeJing.s, it is relatively easy and nonthreatening for counsellors to respond with b3sic empathy. &sic e.mP3thy simply Sll't'S. ") have heard how you foe], 3nd 1 accept your feeJings without judgment." \Vith b3sic cmp3thy, no anempt is made to interpret, judge. or promote greater 3Warcness or insight beyond that which the client h3s alre3d't' 3rticulatcd. Despite its apparent simplicity, basic empathy c3n be a powerful heJping tool. \Y./hcn people express feelings in evcl)•tfoy communication, they may be blocked or discouraged Empathic Connections basic empathy: AtounS!lor's actnCMtedg_•nt d adienrs cleafty a,mmunicated feelings. 175 when others react by judging. ignoring, or giving advice. For example, one common but o:trc.mel,., unhelpful response is "You shouldn't ftt.l that way." ln contrast, basic c.mpGthy crc3tcs a clim:.nc in which clients do not have to defend or hide the.ir feelings. For m3ny people, basic e.mP3th)• responses arc an unusual and satisfying cxpe.ricnce. As one client described it, "For the first time, I felt safe. Someone had finally listen~ and heard me." Furthermore, counsellors who puncruatc their work with frequent empathy are more likely to build rapport and evoke further information from clients. Simple logic suggests that when people bclicve that they are accepted and understood, they are more likely to feel secure and less likcly to raise defences. As a result, clients are more inclined to share and o:plore at a deeper level of intimacy than they would under more threatening conditions. The following example illustrates basic empathy: Clien t: I wu ready to ki.11 her. How eouJd she embarr"3SS me in front of all those people! CounseUor. So )'Ou' n:- a.n¥rY th:n she d,dn't h::r\'e e:nouah sense to ke"('p quiet. Clien t: Anary. but ~lso hurt. After all. she w;,is supposed to be eould !ihe double<ro!i!i me! In)' be!it friend . How CounseUor. Sounds as if )'Ou fe"('I betr.tyed. But empathic responses also need to be presented with an air of tentativeness to give clients an opportunity to offe.r corrections. A simple pause or a question such as "Have I j;O( it right?" can be used to this end. SUCCESS TIP To make simple, yet effective, empathic r e s ~ use lhis format: ~vou fool . .. (add tee1,n g wotd) because .. . (add contMtT Inferred Empathy inferred empathy: IN ificatia.ol a clients"feEfings based • IOIIYttbal 00.S •d indited cca.aicatica I nferred empathy, sometimes called ad,~nced empathy (Egan & Schroeder, 2009), involves identifying clients' feelings b3scd on nonverbal cue~ theme~ and hints. Coun,sellors should also pay careful attention to what their clients do 00( say, including topics they ::rvoid and sudden shifts in focus. lnforr~ empathy is a pO\\•erful counselling tool that enables clients to dC3l with feelings at a level deeper than expressed emotions. Some clients find that their trust level incrc3scs when counsellors identify their hid.den feelings: "M 't' counsellor seemed to know how I felt without my saying so. Finally, I felt understood. In fact, I began to understand myself better." Moreover, inferred empathy may be P3rticulnrly useful with clients who lack feeling vocnbula.ry or arc unaccustomed to expressing feelings. lnfe.rred empath)• s«ms to say, "I have thecouraae and the ability to hC3.r your feelings." Clien t: It was a tou~, !iitu::ttion. Here I W3$ in front o( ~ll those people with 11\)' prh'3te life hl1id lxtre. CounseUor. From the tea.rS in )'Our eyes. I suspect this w;,is a painful ::tnd emb::trraS.Sll1i moment for )'Ou. In the pr«eding o:ample, the client sec.ms willing co explore her experience, yet she stops short of wrbally identifying her feelings. The counsellor takes a mild empathic risk and considers context and nonverbal cues to infer empathy. lnfcrr~ empathy should always be present~ tentatively to allow room for correction and further exploration. With inferred empathy, some speculation based on the evidence of feelings is necessary. Consequently, there is more risk involved than with basic empathy. There are two significant risks. First. because the information b3sc for infc.rrcd cmp3thy is more ambiauou~ more errors arc likcl)t Hence, counsellors should be especially tentative with 176 Chap1er 6 inferred empathy. As wcll, counseJlors should nvoid becoming overly speculative to the point where they arc simpl)• guessing at their clients' feelings. Second, inferred emp3thy may be met with resistance from clients who are unwilling or unable to acknowlcd,;e their feeJings. Inferred empathy notices subtle cues, and clients ma)' be surprised to henr that their ftt.lings h.nve been communicated. They may renc:t with anger and resentment that their feelings have been uncovered. In addition, some clients are afraid of the intensity of the.ir feelings, whereas others have strong needs for privacy. Thu~ inferred emP3thy must be timed appropriately. The counselling rcJntionship should have a rea, son.able level of trust, and the counselling session should h.nve sufficient time left to process any renctions. Otherwise, it is best to defer inferred empathic responses till later. Since inferred empnthy involves "reading" the client, counsellors need to de,.'Clop skills in this aren. First, clients provide clues to their feelings in a number of ways. They might be emb3rrassed about shnring their feelings or reluctant to ask for help, so they talk about a "friend who has n problem." Second, as stressed earlier, understanding nonverbal behaviour is crucial. Astute counsellors learn a great deal about the.ir clients' feelings b\• carefully observing: changes in voice tone, sudden shifts in posture, nervous behaviour, ten.rs, grimace~ clenched fist~ finger tapping, and smiling. As \\'CII, certain behaviours can suggest feeJings. For example, a boy who runs away from a group home just before a visit from his mother may be saying something about his fe3r or anger. A client who arrives late, refuses to take his co3t off, and sits with arms folded across his chest might be saying, "I don't want to be here." SUCCESS TIP Yv'hen lhefe afe time pfess.ures, counsellOrS tend to locus more on task at the expense of felationship. Appfopriate and pfoportional empathy, even when time is limited, helps che-nts to manage beltet than if the interview Of encountef addressed only task. People often express emotions using analogies. For example, a client who comp3res his life to a speeding train may be expressing his fears of be.ing out of control. Some clients hint at the.ir feelings by asking questions, such as "Do )'OU worry about your kids when they arc out late at night?" ln addition, clients who minimize problem~ as in "I h.nve a bit of a problem. Do you have a minute?" or "This is probably not impormnt," may be signaling: that they have sianificant issues and feelings that they need to discuss. Preparatory Empathy Tuning: in, or preparatory empathy (Shulman, 2009), is another useful way to prcpnre for inferred empathy. Prep3ratory empathy is n prcJiminary phase skill that involves trying to anticip3te the feelings and concerns that clients might bring up in the interview. Since clients often do not directly revenJ their feelings, tuning in helps counseJlors anticiP3te how clients might communicate feelings indirectly. Shulman (2CX>9) illustrates tuning in with a common exnmple involving an e.ncounter between a ll•ye3r-old counsclling novice and a 38-year-old mother of seven children. The mother asked the worker, "Do you have any children!" The worker responded defonsivdy by talking nbout her training: in child psychology. Shulman sugi;ests th.nt the worker missed the implicit feelings expressed by the mother- the fear that the worker will not understand her. Had she used the tuning-in skill, the worker might have been able to consider in advance the range of feelings that a mother of seven kids miWlt have when meeting with a young counsellor who has nochildrcn. With such advance prcpnration, the worker might have been more sensitive to the mother's real question, perhaps responding, "No, J don't have any children. \\:rhy do 't'OU ask? Are you wondering if J'm going to be able to understand what it's like for you having to raise so many? J'm concerned about that as well. If I'm Empathic Connections preparato,y empathy: Atounsfflor's 11netJf1 to a.sider (in advafltf al the interviewJ the feelings and CCIC'fflS t!l.i'! tile client may commllicate ida::tly. 177 to help you, J'm goina to have to understand, and you are going to have to hdp me to understand" (Shulman, 2009, p. 57). This response is an excdlent illustration of genu.inenes~ which in this case provides an opportunity for a discussion of the mother's feelings about w-orkcrs and gives the ,vorker a chance to share her own feelings. Similar counsellor strategies might be appropriate for diem question~ such as, "Have 't'OU ever been to jail!" "Do you know what it's like to live on the srreed" and "How old are you?" Table 6.4 summarizes the three types of empathy. TABLE 6.4 Type Invitational Types of Empathy OescrfptJon E~agtng dients to &alk. abOul feelings Maj<M" Use Comments To stimulate discussion of emotions To oonnalile feelings Invitational empathy undet'scores the ll11portance of emotions. It counter'S any tendency to m::we too quickly to problem solving without fully considering the role that emotions ~y. Basic empathy contributes to the 00Vt>lopmen1 ot trust It signats to clients that counsellors are wifli~ and able to deal with feedngs. Basie ResJX)ndl"lg to clearly aflkulated feelings To encoufage continued expmssioo of feelings To connrm capacity to hear feelings Inferred ResJX)ndl"lg to oonve-rbal cues and other indicators of To move feelW'lgs into the verbal chanool ot communi::ation lnte«ed empathy may genel'ate tnOr'e anxiety in some clients if feelings that they avoided, suppressed, Or' wanted to keep hidden are made visible. lnte«ed empathy may ptOO'lote dien1 insight. feeti~ ))) CONVERSATION 6.2 SllJDENT: I don, think empathy is always such a good thing. 1watd'led one taped interview of car1 Rogers and two olhe:f lherapists interviewing the same client, GIOria. If I had been Roger'S's client, I wolld have been irtitated. He seemed to continualy regtXgitate what the dient had just said. TEACHIR: You've l'aised a good point. Too much empathy, particl.Aar1y wtlen you get stuek at a basic level. migt\t leave you and )'OIX client going in circtes.. It's alSO true that If you move too fast With empathy, your dients can lee! lhr-eataned and put up lhell defences. This is particularly tfue with clients W'ho have stfong needs for privacy. They may view your empathic statements as an unwanted intrusion into their feelings. Empathy invites greater relationslip intimacy, and some clients are 001 ready lor the (isks that this entaits. As Clark (2007) noted, Msome fand the emotional closeooss of 100 therapeutic retationShip threatening and invasrve· (p. 37). Some clients open up to empathic responses only to tater regret having revealed too much. They may ·ciam up· in future sessions, nevef return to counselli~. or they may (esent their counsellors f0t allov.i~ that to happen. But~ trough you migt\t have been irritated. it's s'lteresti~ to note that, years late(, Rogers's client Gtoria described OOH he( Sim time Vfilh Rogers was lite~hangj~ for het. This reo'lindS us that cliants respond diffet'antly to the same techl'lique. Be cam/'-' lhal )W' P<!(Cei:,ion of !he Rcgers tape doesn1 dO!e( )<lU from using empathy. It may be e""'-1Jy wt,at )<lU' cloot . - s. 178 Chap1er 6 Other clients W'ho may 001 be ready lor empathy are lhOse who are so caught up in their own talking lhat they do 001 even hear empathic statements. As Shea (1998) suggests, attemprs to empathi:ze with this woup may adualy be counterproductive because empathy interferes with what lhey want most-an audience to listen. STUDENT: I lhink one way to handle that is to test y()U( client's capacity fOr' empathy with a few bask empathic Slaternents. If lhey a(e not well received, you can baek off by switching to less demancfi~ content or more basic empathy. TEACHER: t ag,-ee, back off, but not fore.....! As kust - p s , the dient may welcome that same empathic response Iha! he Or' she at fir'Sl rejected. To continue 100 lisl of times 'llf'len empathy may not be a good idea, I'd add the lollOwi~: • YOIX clients reject empathy. • It's dear1y time to move on to ptoblem Sdving Or' another activity. • Empathy is continuousty misinterpteted by the client (e.g., as conttolling or intrusive). We Should always remember that counselling techniques will not work the same way wtth al clients. Cultul'al norms, tlUSI IM!I, mOOd, and personal resiliency are au vartableS that influence how empathy is received. FOUR GENERALIZATIONS ABOUT EMPATHY Generalization One \'(Ihm dienu share feelings, empathy is (more often th.an nO() che preferred response. A positive reinforcer "prescmcd immediately following n bch.nviour C3uscs the bch3viour to increase in frttiuency" (M3rtin & Pear, 201 I). Clients talcc an intcrpc.rsonaJ risk when they share their fccJings. EmP3thy acknowledges this risk by conveying recognition and acccpcancc of the client's fccJings. Empathic responses are a reward for sharing that conveys the mem-messaj;c: "This is a safe place to bring your feelings." ln this way, it rc.inforccs the wisdom of the risk and motivates clients to continue sharing feelings. On the other hand, when clients share feelings and they arc not rc\\'tlrded (or reinforced) with cmpnrhy, rhc:n they tend to keep their feelings more private. Non-empathic responses to expressed feelings carry the mct3•message, "Your feelings 3rc not important." or " I'm not comfortable miking about wh3t you're feel. ing." This underscores the importance of ex-pressing cmp3thy C3rly in the rcl3tionship. When dealing with reluctant or mandated client~ empathy provides a w3y to acknowl• edge and validate their strong emotions. Subsequently, as these clients feel understood 3nd listened to, their reluctance will often lessen. Generalization Two Risk expre.ssing emparh1 eart, in rhe relarioru.hip. Norms, once esmblishcd, arc difficult to alter. E3rly cmp3thy helps form the norm th3t the counselling relationship is 3 safe place to express feelings. To become comfort3ble with empa• thy, counsellors need to overcome their own fenrs about bringing emotions into the foreground. Many counsellors fear that by encouraging clients to express emotions, they might trigger extreme reactions, p3rticularly suicide, but this fear is not substami• 3tcd by research. ln fact, it takes energy to suppress emotions; therefore, by helping clients express 3nd get in touch with their feelings, counsellors can help them decrc3sc the ncg:itivc effects of these feelings. (nvimtional empathy is useful for working with clients who arc reluctant or unable to articulnte feelings. Counsellor timing is criticnl, and counsellors should present invi• tational cmp3thy in a gentle and tentative m3nne.r. Early in the counsclling relntionship, counsellors should give priority to acquiring, maintaining, 3nd deepening empathic undcrst3nding by rcm3ining alert to emp3thic opponunitics. One obvious opponunity arises whenever clients vcrbali:e feelings. ln such moments, counsellors can use basic empathy to confirm understanding. Some• times clients rcve3J feelings nonvcrb31Jy, and counsellors c3n use inferred empathy. When clients h3\'C not sh3red their feelings, counsellors c3n 3dopt invitation3f empathy to encourage them to share their emotions. Generalization Three Netff as.Rime rhar U't' ain know anorher penon's emorions in rite way char rhcyknoui them. People often try to be understanding 3nd comp3ssionatc by say- ing, "I know just how 't'OU feel." \\:fhilc this response h3s the potential to be supportive, it is more likely that it will sabotage further opportunity for exploration and IC3rning. h docs not honour the fact that each of us emotion:.dly processes experiences in our O\\•n way. The fact that we h3ve h3d a similar experience does not give us C3SY access to instant understanding. Our own cxpc.ricnce, with 311 of its assocfatcd memories, emotions, 3nd outcomes, m3y 3ctu3Jly be a b3rricr to empathizing. Empathy requires th3t we ,vork to see the world from the client's perspective. This means th3t we must carefully gu3rd 3g3inst bi3~hc n3tural tendency to 3ssumc that how we feel or have felt under like cir• cumsta.nccs is how the client is feeling. High-le\'CI sclf-awarencss, he3lthy curiosity, 3nd humility about our limited capacity to appreciate the client's emotions arc prerequisites. Active listening. P3rticularly empathy, will help us to get closer to this go3I. "I know just how 't'OU feel" also discourages people from the C3tharric benefit of telling their storr~nc of the most therapeutic outcomes of active listening. Jc hij3cks Empathic Connections 179 any opporrunity for the counscJlor to learn. Since we aJrc:ady "lcnow" what the person foe.ls, what point is the.re in discus.sing it? Counsellors should express empathy tentatively. Thu~ it is important to chc:c:k with clients to confirm empathic understanding. Counsellors need to refrain from using empathy as a wc:apon by insisting that their clients must feel a particular way. Counsellors should also look for indicators that clients have accepted their empathy and that it is accurate:. Clients provide confirmation through head nods, smiles, mani.festing rcduc~ anxiety, and verbal confirmation (e.g., "That's right" or "You seem to know exactly how I'm feeling even before I tcll you"). Clients also implicitly confirm willingness to accept empathy when they continue: to sh.arc feelings at a deeper level. Conversely, clients may verbally signal that empathy has missed the mark (e.g., by saying "No" or "That's not right")or with subtler nonverbal and paraverbaJ messages. Some clients who are reluctant to challenge: may agree with empathy that is off the mark, so it is important to remain aJcrt for contradictory nonverbaJ messages such as tentative voice tone (e.g., "I guess so") or hesitation in their responses. Sometime~ empathy misses the target and clients offer corrections. This is good news and should be view~ as an important and positive: outcome: of empathic rislc. Empathy is a devcJopmc:ntal process rttiuiring counsellors to remain open to adjusting and refining their understanding until they reach a point of shared meaning with their clients. Moreover, when clients correct their counsellors, counsellors know that they can trust them 00( to capitulate. Generalization Four Empachy requires flexibility in its use. induding che abilicy to refrain from using ic. Empathy is an important and powerful skill, but counsellors need to use it intcJligc:ndy. \\:fhcn clients arc willing to address feeling~ empathic responses are dfcc,. tivc (sec Table 6.5 for sugi;c:stions). \Vith some client~ empathic statements result in the opposite of what was intended. lnstead of deepening trust and encouraging clients to open up. empathy arouses defences. This may happen when empathy targets feelings that clients would prefer to hide, or when clients experience empathy as invading their personal space. When clients resist empathy by withdrawing or becoming defensive, counsellors should discontinue: using it for a while. SUCCESS TIP If clients exl)f&SSfeeling. respond wrth empathy. Risk ex.pressing empathy early in lhe relationshiJ). Be tentative-we can nevef fully ktlO'N how othet'S fool. Oew!loJ) ftexibifily (hO'N, when, and when n01 to use empathy). Moreover, situationaJ difforc:ncc:s influence how the work of empathy unfolds. Some clients arc verba.1 and open with their feelings. They arc likely to respond posi.tivcJy to empathy. Others need gentle encouragement to tallc about feelings. and they open up discussion of feelings gradually and in a very controlled manner. Counsellors will gc:nc.raJJ,., find that they encounter less resistance: when they match their clients' pace. TABLE 6.5 The Empathic Communication Process Decide if it is an app,q:iriate tme to exi;:b'e emciions (coosider' cootext,. limi.-.i aoo 1e-..e1 of trusa). Use invitat.iooal empathy to initiate discussion of feelings. Pay attentbn to vefbal and nonvetbal inclkators of emotion. ExplOl'e feelings fOr' detail, deflnition, and ex:amJ)le. Forml.Jate a tentative empathic msponse. Wait b Or' encour"3ge the d ienl to con.firm Or' COtr'ect your' empathic: perception. COl'r'OCt 01' offer a doope:f empathic r'es:i:x:>nse baSed on the clien1's r'&S,:)Onse. 180 Chap1er 6 Empathic Response Leads Using 3 range of different responses adds interest and variety to the interview. Using the same words and phrases too often can irritate clients and reduce the interview's energy 3nd vitality. Having 3 ran,;c of leads for empathic response prevents the interview from sounding artificial or robotic. The following list sugi;csts some variations. I m •itational Empathy ■ How/\Vh.nt do you fed? (open question) ■ Do you want to tallc about your feelings! (do.scd question) ■ I'm wondering how you are feeling. (indirect question) ■ Tell me how you feel (directive) ■ Any thoughts on how thnt made you foci! (dosed question) Basic Empathy ■ You foel . ■ My sense is that 't'OU might be feeling ... ■ From your point of view . ■ As you sec it . . ■ I w-ondcr if what you' re S3ying/fcding is . ■ You appcar to be feeling . I nferred Empathy ■ Your tears suggest chat you might be feeling . ■ You've become very quiet. Perhaps )'OU are feeling .. . ■ One the.me th3t keeps coming up in what )'OU are saying is . . ■ \Vhen you taJk about .. . 1 sense you feel . ■ \Vhat 1 understand from wh3t you have said is . SUCCESS TIP A tMtative tone and a pause fof further dient input or correction is an important part of any empathic tesponse. Why Achieving Empathic Understanding Is So Difficult Empathic errors are ,;enernJly unlikely when counsellors are simil3r to their clients (in a,;e, gender, race, etc.) 3nd when they have had simil3r problems 3nd experiences; however, even in these situations., empathic errors C3n happen if counsellors do 00( separate their own experiences from those of their clients. CounseJlors need to reme.mber to nJlow for individu3l differences by remembering th3t, however, simifor their O\\' n experiences might be. they c3n never fully understand how their clients feel. Through emP3thy, they can ,;et 3 sense of their clients' feelings 3nd rise 3bove imposing the.ir own interprct3tions., feeling~ and judgment~ but this understanding will never be perfect. Empath)• is perhaps the most difficult counselling skill to master. Empathy demands a lot of mentaJ energy from counsellors. First. they must man3g,e their own emotioMI and judgmemal reactions. Then they h3ve to find meaning and discover feelings from their clients' verbal and nonve.rbal communication. This can be exceptionally demand• ing since clients m3y keep fccJings hidden or suppressed, or l3ck underst3nding and Empathic Connections 181 nwarcncss of their emotions. Relationship issues, including lade of trust, cmb3rrassmcm, and fear of being judged, can inhibit clients from disclosing. For example, there may be societal, cultural, or personaJ norms thnt prohibit sharing of feelings. Or clients may not have the ability (language) to communicate their emotions. Further complicating theempnthic process is the fact that counsellors must respond right away. Jn nn interview, there is no time to use a thesaurus or a dictionary and no opportunity to consult others, rehearse the.ir empathy, or ponder the feeling state of their clients. Empathic risk means daring to share percejvcd understanding with clients using concrete words and phrases that are accessible in the siruation. Poor Substitutes for Empathy \Vhen counseJlors express empathy, they adcnowlcdgc the feelings that cliems have expressed (verbally and/or nonverbally). They might include a brief "because" clnuse that summari!es content. ln most siruation~ they will stop there. This gives clients a chance to process what they have hc3rd, to offer correction~ or possibly to share at n deeper level. At this point, counsellors should avoid cutoff responses, subject changes, empty responses, sympathy, or any other response thnt divens attention nwn't' from empathy. Cutoffs Cutoffs are phrases thnt inhibit the further expression of feeling. Counsdlors who make statements such n~ "Don't fed ... " and "You should feel ... " aredem.onstrating a low level of understanding nnd acceptance of how their clients feel. Such statements are not supportive. They force clients to defend their feelings. Similnrly, when counseJlors nsk clients questions such as "Why do you feel like that!" n judgmcn,ta1 tone is present that can leave clients feeling defensive (sec Chapter S). Another response that may inhibit clients is silence. \Vhcn clients risk sharing feelings, empnthy is bener than silence. \Vhcn counseJlors fnil to aclcnowledi;c feelings, they mn't' be saying, "This is 00( important" or "I'm 00( capnblc of dealing with your emotions.'' ln response, clients might fee] abnndoned, embarrassed, or judg,ed. CounseJlors can also make the mistake of cutting clients off by changing the subject or offering advice. A subject change gives the mem,-messagc "Let's not talk about that." C lient: Sometimes when he speaks t'O me that way. I Just want to '--o hide in 2 corner. CounS(>JIOr I (appropriate empath)'): It sounds like m.:1ybe you're (~lu~ emb,urassed. Counsellor 2 (in2pproprb1te empathr ~ubject jhift): It sounds like ma)·be ,..ou're t'O talk about ways o( O\~roomlfl¥ it? (eel in¥ embarrassed. Would you hk.e Empty Responses Empty responses arc de-void of content. Phrases such as "I hear what )'OU'rc S3ying" and "I understand what )'OU mean" convey no confirmation that the counsellor has understood. Another empty response is P3rroting, or repeating what the client has said. Egan and Schroeder (2009) describe p3rroting as "a parody of emP3thy" (p. 145). ln contrast, empnthy communicates the counseJlor's cffon to go beyond merely he~uing the words to understanding the client's feelings and perspectives. Using empathy, the counseJlor rephrases the client's statements and nssigns labels to feelings that the client has expressed but not named. Be aware that diches and platitudes, such as "Everybody has to have a little pain in their life," pntroni!e and reject clients' feelings. As Egan and Schroeder (2009) put it, dic.hcd responses say, "You don't really have a problem at all, at least not a serious one" (p. 145). Sympathy Sympnthy and empnthy are frcqucnth• confused, and many people view them as idcnticaJ; however, there arc important and signif,cant differences between the nvo concepts. Sympathy refers to concern for other people's problems and emotions 182 Chap1er 6 ))!} INTERVIEW 6.1 The following excerpt illustrates some of the itMpProprldte responses that counseuors som~imes use instead of empathy. lgno,ing feelings and offeting empty resPonses, simplistic advice, and sympathy are inadequate substitutes fOI empathy. Client: (Softly, with tears fr, he( eyes.) I just haven't been lhe same since he left. I Sltl look out lhe dOOr' and ex.peel him to come hOme. Counsellor: How old was he when he ran away? Analysl$: /napproprfate to,:,lc shift: TM client Is clearly experiencing ,:,aln, perhaps grief, and she trusts the counselk:Jt enough to share these feellngs. Generally. when clients share feelings, particu/.vty feelings that are strong. empathy is the prefe"ed resp(J('ISe. The counsel/Ors response shifts the foe.us away from feelings to content. This may subtly signal to the client that the counse.llor is uncomfortable with feelings. Continual shifts such as this will ..,,afn" the client not to share feelings. Client: He was just 16. I still tt'IOu~tof him asmy OOby. NON I go to Sleep at nighl wondering v.tiethet he's dead or alive. Counsellor: You thOught of him as you( baby. Now you go to sloop at ~ t wonderi~ wtlethet he's dead O( alive. Silence. Counsellor: I unde-rstand hoN you feel. Cllent (Buries her face itt her hands.) Sometimes I just don'I ktlow vd'lether I can go on livi~. If something ooe-sn't happen soon. then .. . (Counsel/Or intertuf)ls...) Counsellor: You have to lhink of you( hUSband and you( other- chilclreo. ClleM: Yes, I ktlO'N, but dO you have any ide-a wtlat I'm going th(ough? How tough it is just to get out of bed in 100 momiog? Counsellor: My guess is that you feel vety a~ry at lhe wor1d, maybe- e-ve-n some guilt that you are,esponsible fot you( son's running away. someho-N Client: No! I don't feet guilty. I was atNays a goo:J mothe(. I think if my son we(e here, he'd say that too. When he became addicted to drugs, it was more than eithe( of us ktle-w hOw to handle-. Counsellor: I heat vd\31 you're saying. Client: So, what am I sup(X)Se-(1 to do? I fee-I so empty and Analysis: Parroting. Repetition at this Point sl!M!'S no purpose. Some.times key wo,ds o, phrases can be emphasized as a w.,y to focus attention. but this type of parroting ;s inappropriate here. Analysis: Superficial response. The counsellor tries to be supJ)Ol'live, but the response is empty. Until the counsellor rls.k.s empathy with specific feeling words and phrases. the client cannot know whether she has. in fact, been heard. Analysis: Misguided rescue attempt. Ignoring feelings. It seems Obvious that th;s courrselkJr ls unable to deal with the Powerful feelings that the client presents. After an ill-timed interruption, the counsellor offers a misguided and simplistic solutkm, while Ignoring the emotions the client ex.pressed. Analysis: Inaccurate empathy. The counsellor-attempts infe"ed empathy. Unforlunately, there Is insufficient evidenc.e to sup. Port the counsellOrs conclusion that the client feels angry o, guilty. The counsellor may be right, but as suggested it Is merely a guess, a JJOOf subs.titute (Or empathy. M0reover, the counsellor- is not attending to the feelings that the clfent has already ex.pressed. Analysis: Superficial rt!SPonse. This res,:,orrse has the same problems as her earlier OM, " I understand how )(lu feel." useless. Counsellor: H's a ve-ry bad feeling (Brief silence.) Counsellor: You shouldn't lee-I tnat way. One day your son mighl walk rn the door. You have to go on living. Client: I sup(X)Se you'(e righl ThankS for istentng. It felt gOOd to get It off my chest. Counsellor: I'm glad I was able to he-Ip. Analysis: Inaccurate empathy, Jack of specificity. The counsellor attempts empathy but m;sses the intensity of the client's feellngs. Then, the counsellor- quickly shifts the foe.us without giving the client time to ,espond. Analysis: The counsellOt''s rt!Sponse violatt!S the im,:,ortant requirement to ac.cept clients' feelings without judgment and withOut trying to tell them how they should feel. Analysis: Someti mes clients bl!n'1fit from the Tntervl~ when the counselkJt's res{XJ(tSl!s are as ,:,,oor as thOse t1ep;r;ted in th;s encounter. Sim,:,ly telling one's story and verbalizing feelings can help people deal with pain or problems; however. it ;s much more likely that this client ;s ready to dismiss the counsellor. The coun.sello, may be just as ,ellewd that the interview Is over. ReHectJons: ■ Suggest alternate approp,i.ate resPonses that the counsello, might h.ave used. ■ What might counsellors do when they r~gnize that their resPonse was inaccu1ate or inappropriate. Empathic Connections 183 and is related to our own emotional and behavioural reactions. SymP3thy is the coun.seJlor's personal reaction, and though it is intimatd't' connected to the d iem's foe],. ing.s, it is not the S3me as empathy. Sympathetic responses arc self-disclosu res., whereas empathy is a process o f seeking to unde.rstand anothe.r's feelings; however, counsellors arc human, and it is normaJ for them to have emotionaJ responses when listening to their clients. In fact, their reactions are the basis for compassion, an indispcnS3ble com,. ponent of a caring counselling rcJationship. T he.re arc moments when it is appropriate for co unsellors to express symP3thy by letting clients lcnow that they support them and that they are moved by their P3in. At the same time, it is cssemial for counsellors to d evelop the ab ility to separate their emotional reactions (sympathy and comP3ssion) from those of their clients. Counsellors also need to ensure that their s,.•mpathy docs not detract from the client's feelings by interfering with their need to express feelings, tell their stories, and face the reality of their problems. C lient: l 'rn re:Ul't' v.-'Orried about tellinK my d:.d th:u l'\'e dropped o ut o( oo.Jleiti'. Even when I was a little 1.::irl. tn)' (:uher kept s:ayi1l{t. "You\•e p to ~'t't an education or ,.·ou'II ne\'er iti't anr,\-here in li(e.•· CounS(>JIOr(Ch.o ice l ~·mp:uhetk re3ction): I don't think it wu ,-er)' fair (or him t'O h::n-e l3kl sueh a he:h')' burden on )'Ou. It alwap1 makes me somewhat a~r)' when I he::ir about parents push in¥ their kids.. Counsellor(Choice 2---empathk reactlon): So )'<lu (e2r th:u you \-e Let your father down!. In the preceding example, Choice I is a misguided anempt to offer support. Judg~ memal in tone, it shifts the focus from the client's feelings to those of the counsellor. Choice 2 expresses basic emP3thy, setting the smge for further explorntion. C lark (2007) cautions thu ''A counsellor is subject to being ps,.•chologicall't' drawn into the experiences of a d iem, and the interaction can lead to a distortion of perspcc.tivcs" (p. 14). For example, an overt,., sympathetic counsellor might curb discussion of painful emotions o r might change the topic or avoid funher d iscussion of the area to "protect" the client from the distress of facing the issue. Too much sympathy might also cut off an opportunit)• for the client to explore foeling:s and options for action. The following example illustrates this: C lient: A(ter 15 )'ears of \\'Orkin¥ for the cornp:mr, they tell me th::u e\'en thou~, 1\-e done a ¥ ff:at ,ob. I h:a\'e t'O take a par rut and a new job because the)· can' t afford to ha,-e two supervisors. CounseUor. That' s so un(air. What do they expect? You desen -e better. It's eaS)' to speculate how in the p receding example the counsellor's response might c urtail a more balanced airing of feelings and later exploration of the merits of a pay c ut as one of the options. He.re is a more appropriate empathic response-: CounS(>IJOr. Perhaps )'Ou (eel used, bel1evh11i:: that their pr:aise was just empty words.. SUCCESS TIP Clients a(e often successful in making us feel as lhey do. Use lhis as a baSis for empathy and as a ~ to monitor, undetsrand, and conuOI yout own emotions. Tough Empathy It is easy to feel caring and compassion for most people in pain, such as the aging d iem who loses his job, the young mother who has had a second miscarriage, and the single parent who is trying to raise children on a limited income; howcve.r, some clients may challenge a co unsellor's tolerance. Even the most accepting counsello rs occasionally find 184 Chap1er 6 CONVERSATION 6.3 STUDE:NT: I haven't had a lot ot life e-xperlenice, and I'm worried that I won't be able to uOOefSland what IM c lient is feeling. TEACHER: Somethnes counseUOrs do lheit beSI WOr'k when they ad inst they don'I unders tand, then take the time to listen. We ate constantly challenged to wor'k 'Mth clients who are very different from us, so we ~ to be willi~ to le.am and wdti~ to let d ie-nts "teach· us abOut their extieriences and feelings. While we may not have had the same experience, we can df3W on events in out own lives that have evoked sin-.lar feeli~ such as pain 0t IOSS. If we have been thete oursetves, we ha\18 some ad\tan~ but only if we are cautious to avdd assuming that OU' feelings, perspective, and solutions will be the same fOr' OIX clients. The best w.ry to do this rS listening to out clients' stories, even if we think we know wtlat they ate going to say. ST\JOENT: Maybe there's an advantage to n01 having had the satne ex.perience in that I'll be m0te ready to listen, leam, and be curious. it difficult to ta,., aside pc.rson:.d reaction, suspend judgment, and respond with cmp3thy to clients such as the following: ■ Bob, an 3ngry 20-,.•e3r--old who savagely artackcd an cider!,.• woman ■ Perncll, a father who argues for the morality of sex with girls ove.r IS ■ Eileen, an HIV~positive prostitute who ignores the dangers of having unprot«to:I sex with her customers ■ Ruby, 3 W'Oman who rejects 3nd attacks efforts to help Counsellors working with clients such 3S these often experience strong emotion31 rcu:tions, and they m3y find it difficult to put aside their personal feelings to feel and express empathy. Some criminal psychopaths live with cruel disrcgnrd for the rights and feelings of others. displaying a complete absence of ability to feel empathy or caring. ln fact, "the blotting out of emp3thy as these people inflict damage on victims is almost always part of an emotioMI cycle that precipitates the.ir cruel acts" (Goleman, 2005p. 106). Commenting on the research, Goleman offers evidence th3t suggests a biologic.al basis for a 13d: of empathy in psychopaths. \Vhy then should counsellors respond with empathy to such people? First, empathy is 3 way for counsellors to understand how their clients think and feel. Second, as noted C3rlier, empathy is instrumental in forming the helping rel3tionship, the pre.requisite condition for the contract between client 3nd counsellor➔ One outcome of emp3thy is that clients come to feel valued and understood. Because of the empathic rcfationship, cliems begin to rcve3J more, make discoveries 3bout themsclve~ and alter the.ir pcrsp«.tives about themselves and others. With clients who lack emp3thy for other~ counsellor use of empathy obliges them to face their feelings 3nd those of their victims. (n situations in which it is difficult to respond with empathy, counsellors ma't' need to work on their own issues. For example, they c.nn ask themselves. "\Vhat is it 3bout this particular diem that makes it difficult for me to be empathic?" "Does this client remind me of someone else (e.g., parent and forme.r partner)?" "To what extent do I have unresolved fttling.s and is.sues th3t this client triggers?" Another strategy for counsellors is to spend time getting to know the client. Usu3lJy, familiarity increases emp3thy, as in the following example: Carl. an emplo,.•ment counsellor, c3re(ull't' re::.d Anmnio's Ate. Antonio was a 19-,.~r-old unemplored tn.3!e. From all indk::mons. Antonio W'3S not ve:r't' interested in f'mdil'l.¥ 3 job. His n\Othercompl.:1ined that he usu.:111)' sle-pc until noon and th3t he rare!,., o?\'i":n read the Empathic Connections 185 nN·spcaper want ads. Antonio arrived (or his appointment 20 minutes fate and a;h'i' out a dear rness~~ that he d,dn't want t'O be there. ''How Joni will thisuike?" he asked bluntly. Carl's n::uu~I reaction was an~r and di~ust at Antonio's 21titude. He v.'Ondered to hitnsel( why he should spe1,d time with this die:nt, who w-as clearly u1ml0t1vated. PuttmK his personal (e,elinKS askle. Carl dttided to reSpo1,d witl, empatl,y. and he ~-e:i,tlr replied. "~•1y hunch is that )Ou don't se,e much point in beina here. Marbe )'Ou'reeven a little anar)' at beina forced to come." Antonio. a bit surprised at C3rl's. percep11,·e:ness. told him how mud, he resented everyone tryil,K to run his h(e. Gr.klu3lly. Antonio be~an to Let do-Nn his de(e:ncesa,,d a ve:q• di((erent picture emer~-00. Antonio talked about the rejection he (elt from countless. emplO)~rS who turned him ::rway. Soon it wu de3r to Carl t~t Antonio was deeply depressed. He slept l3te because he could not sleep 3t ni~ht. He had stopped lookina for work bec3use it was his best choice (or deal in¥ with the pain o( rejection. Sometimes counsellors fo3r expressing empathy because they mistakenly believe that empathy endorses their diems' beliefs or lifostylc~ but keep in mind that being emp3thic docs not mean agreeing with the client's fodings or perspectives. Empathy simply attempts to Sil)', "I understand how )'OU foci and how you see things." ln fact, clients must fee] understood before they will respond to any efforts to promote change. Empathy is one of the wars that counsellors csmblish credibility nnd win the trust o( their clients. \Vhen a trusting relationship exist~ clients may be willing to consider other pe.rspcctives and look nt the consequences of their choices. })!} INTERVIEW 6.2 Client: F'o, as loog as I can remember, I've been drinking ~ ly basis. It's no big deal. counsellor: (Sc/tty, whi.le ma;nttJirlirlg eye COtltact.J Drinking has bee-n part ot yout life, and you don't see a prOblem with it. (Client nod~) Counsellor: You mentioned lhat your family gives you a hard time abOul drinking. How do you feel abOut that? Analysis: The counsello,- trittS to proceed cautiously with b.tt.ic paraphrasing. Mirroring the client's t1,oughts conveys that he has been heard. Suspending verbal and nonverbal judgment helps to dtNe/op trust. Analysis: An open question encourages the client to talk about his feelings. Such st.atements atso say to the client that the counsellor is willing to listen. Client: Yeah. I work hatd all day. If I want to have a dtink. no one has a rigt\t to tel me to stOI'). Otinking helps me relax. counsellor: Sounds as though you resent it wtlen otherS interfe,e with somethi~ that gives you pleasuce. Anaty1l1: Inferred empathy. Although the client doe.s not diteclly label his fee.lings. based on the wordS. context. and nonverbal messages. the counselk:Jr speculates that resentment might be the predominant feeling. Client: (Loudly.) They should baek off and mind their own business. I don't tell them how to live. Analysis: The client ·s response suggests that he is ,espansive to the counsellor's empathy. He signals this by continuing to share at a deeper level. Th;s is a significant event in the interview, which should give the counsellor confidence to COtltinue to ,;sk empathy. counsellor: It's tnOr'e than j ust resentment Pethaps you're angry that they oon·1 respect your tigt\t to Hve your life as Analysis: Anger is inferred from the client's n<Jnverbal e.rpression (volume). By labelling the anger, the counsellor gives the client "permission" to dlscuss h;s anger. you see fit. 186 Chap1er 6 ~JO INTERVIEW 6.2 Effective Use of Empathy<conHn,e> Cllent: 1guess I shouldn'1 be so ticked off. After au, my father was an atcohdic, and I know fltst-hand what it's like to live v.ith a drunk. Counsellor: To some extent, your feeli~ am mixed. You feel anger beeause you think they sholJCI mind theit own busiooss, and you atso see where lhey're coming from. You are sympathetic to lheit fearS. Analysl$: Since the counse.1/or accepts h;s anger, the client may feel less that he has to defend it. Analysis: The counse.llor picks up on and ldftntifles the client's mixed feelings. Mixed feelings can often be a source of anxiety for clients. particularly if they pull their emotions in different directions. Client: Well. to be perfectly honest, it's not just their fear. I dOn't want to drink tnyself 10 death like my father did. Counsellor: You've oone some thinking aoout hOw you'd like yout life to be different When yolM' wife confronts you, it realty touches a nerve, and you're mminded of fear'S you'd rather n01 have. Client: No way I'm gci~ to let that happen to me. Counsellor: You're determined to control your drinking. Client: I'm n01 going to be like my father. Counsellor: Co«ect me if I'm off base, bul as you 1alk, I wonder if a part of you is afraid that youf drinld~ could get Dul of hand. Analysis: Inferred empathy. This client was initially guarded and de.tensive, quick to de.fend his right to drink. As he flnds acceptance from the counsellor, he begins to let his guard down. In some interviews, such as this one, trust can develop quickly. but more often, the counsello,- requires extended patience. Analysis: This bask empathic response gives the clfent some breathing room. Counse/lOtS shOuld avoid constant pressure on clients to move to a higher level of intimacy. The counselk:Jr needs to move deeper, but caution is eritical to avoid moving too quickly. Analysis: The counsellor uses both confrontation and infe"ed empathy in this statement. Presenting the ide.as in a tentative manner softens the confrontation. Reflections: ■ What might have happened if this cOun$tllOr had used a m0re confrontational approach? ■ If you were the counsell0r. what would you want to do in the nex.t half-hour with this client? SUMMARY ■ Because of the centm1 role that emotions play in our lives, counsellors must give priority to exploring :md understanding clients' feelings. Emotions are characteri:ed by physiologicnJ as weJI as psychological and behavioural reactions. Mixed feeling~ including contradictory emotion~ arc common. A great dC3l of client stress and confusion can arise from the pushl":S and pulls of competing feeling~ which, if unmanaged, can control a client's life. ■ Empathy is a core skill for all helping reJationships. Empath)• helps build the helping relationship, assists clients in identifying and labelling feelings, modcls a healthy W'a)' of reJating to other~ and helps clients accept their own feelings. Although counsellors can neve.r know exact])• how their clients feel, empathy enabll":S them to move closer to understanding. ■ The three types of empathy are invitational, basic, and inferred. Jnvitational empa, thy involves strategies to encourage clients to talk about their feelings. Basic empa, thy mirrors what the diem has explicitly said, while inferred emp:nhy attempts to reach empathic unde.rstanding from less obvious clues. A variety of strategies can Empatlllc Connections 187 be used to encourage clients to express feelings. includina invitational statements, questions targeted at feelings, explan:.uions of rhe importance of addressing fedina~ directives., self-disclosure~ and sentence completion statements. ■ There are four key gcne.ro1i!ations about empath\•: (1) When clients share feelings, empathy is often the preferred response. (2) Counsellors should risk expressing empathy early in the relationship. (3) C ounseJlors should express empathy ten.tativdy. (4) Empathy requires flexibility in its use, including the ab ility to refrain from using it. EXERCISES Self-Awareness 1. Begin a bg to track your footings. Al periodic intervals (e.g., every hour), rec0td WOr'ds and phrases lhat best deSCribe hOw you are footi~ at lhat moment. Try to be as precise as possible-. usi~ terms thal captLXe the essence and in.tensity of hOw you feel. Maintain your IOg lot at least one week. a. What patterns or cycleS are apparent? Are there limes of the day Or' week when you are more likel'j to feel par. ticular emotions? b. How could you have altered your emotions (e.g., to inc,ease pleasurable feeli~ and decrease negative feeHngs)? life that involves emorion.s. In response, other members attempt to identify the predominant feelings exptes.sed. 2. Practice ln.ter'vie'N: Work in. pairs: wilh one pel'SOn acti'lg as a dient Shari~ lhe details of something curten.t that in'VOl\ies emotions, and the other person acti~ in the counseuor role. AIIO-N abOUt 15 minutes for the interview. As counsellOr', use lhe three types of empathic responses to keep the in.terwew focused on. footings. When the interview is over, review the experience with each Other' using the foltoM~ questions as a glJcle: ()ient: What was easy and difftellt abOUt s.hating your footings? What responses from your partner were help. ful? UnhelJ)flA? c. What have you learn.eel abOut yourself from this ex.ercise that 'liill assisl you in yolM' WOrk as a coun.setor? 2. Recall the 10 families of emorion.s: anger, fear, strength, weakness, joy, sadness, con.fusion, Shame, surpri.se. and love. Rate your ability to Show or ex.ptess each one on. a scale of 1 to 5 (5 = suong. 1 = unable to express). a. What are the emotions that you have m0te difficulty expressing? Ate 1here feelings you would never- express? b. How dO your ability and wiUiogoes.s to Share emotions vary depending on. the person you are with? 3. Would you flOO it easier' to tel your friandS (your parents, fam. tty, etc.) that you tove them Or' that )(Ill are angry with them? 4. What d«1 )(Ill learn. abOut expr~ emotions when you were gro~ up? bt,lom l'ON this migt\t help Or' hinder- your v.<lrk _.. your field d practice. F'Or'examJ:je, if you wewupin a famly Or' culture wtlere em::,tions were seldom extiressed, consider hOw Ui s haiS impacted your curtent 'lfili~ to sOOW your leeliogs or to encourage Otf'lerS to share their emotions. 5. Describe in. detail how you feel, think, and act when you experience specific emotions. For example, you migt\t write, ·When I feel seated, I want to escape. My breathing is shal• low. I tend to IOOk away. I become quiet. I think I might vomit.· (Hint: use yolM' imagination to visualiZe situations where you might experience the specific emotion.) CounseUOt: What aspects of responding with empathy d;d you fond most challengµ,g? 3. The purpose of lhis exercise is to dewlap your ability to "ttaek· the flow of an. interview. including identifying the use of particular interviewing and counsetting skill$. Wot'k with Sluden.t coneagues. One student wll be the counsellor, another the client 'Mth the others as obSer'vets.. Videotape a 15-minute segment of a counseli~ interview. Classify each counsellor response (e.g., open. question, closed question, silence, empathy, self-di:sctosure, Or' mixed msponse). Use the tonowing table to compile interview statistics. Ptace a d'leck each time a partkl.Aar skill i:S uSed. Notice that the table is organiled to divide the _..terview into time segments. 0-S millUles Open ques1ion Closed ques1ion Indirect question Sience Empathy Selk:lisct>sure Directive &.mma,y Leaming Group Paraphrase 1. Work in a smatl group of tour Or' five students. Take turns mak_..g a brief saatement abOut something current in your 188 Chap1er 6 Other (spedfy) ~1 0 • i.Us 11- 15 mines Aftef the inter'view, discuss these questions: d. Mtf I started ctyi~. 1oon·t think I coukS eve( stop: a. Did the counsetklr' use a vafiely of diffetent fesponses? e. (An ex-offender to his or her pa.role offlcer.) · Have you b. To what ex.tent did lhe counsellof vaty his ot her appfoach as the session ptogressecl? c. What interview uansitions were appafent? Were lhey appfoptiate? Considet, fOr' example.• whethef the ltans~ tion occuffed prematufely, befote concr-ete undel'Slaoelk'lg or ex.ptoration was com pteted. ev« been to jair?· f. (A 16-year-okl bOy.)Ml'd rathef live on the sareet thangp to another fostef home. Five foster homes an five years.. IW had enougl>!" a. (A gay man.) "I dkl.n'l expec1 to live to see 40.• d. What Skills were ovefused or underused? b. MWhy do you want me to go to see a psyd'li:altist? Ooyou think I'm ctaiy? You're the one who's crazy.• e. Which fesponses were productive? Which responses were counterpr·oductive? I. (Patient speaking to a paramedic.) · Leave me alO.ne. I 4 . Interview calleagues Or' friends from diverse ethnic groups to ex.ptore how different individuals: ex.ptess emotions.. 7. ln.tetwew people from different cultufes. If JX)SSible.. intef- 5. In a smal group, predict and describe the possible emotions that difletent individualS in the following scenarios might experience. What nOOWl'bal cues might you ObServe in each case? a. Man whose wife ot 60 year'S haS just died Middle-aged man fired from his job d. 20-yeat-old man told by his doctor that he has SChiZOphtenia e. view first-geootation immigrants wtlo have been in lhi:S country fof onl'j a shor1 time. Ex,:,l0te their views on emotional expression, fof e.Kample, the ex.tent that theif personal. familial, and clJh.-al roots value Wring emotions. Remembet that peoples' viewpoints do not niecessarity represent that of theit culture of or~n. Concepts b. Young teenager on a firSt date c. jusa want to die.· Mothef discove-ring her teenage daughtef is usi~ drugs f. A young \\()man subjected to online hatassment 1. Assume that lhe fOllowtng clients a,e speaking to you aoel that an empathic response is appropriate. Suggest a response to each statement a. (Y'outh speaking to a youth }U$t/Ce worker.) "You doo'I care abOut me. All you guys are the same. You tel me that you want what's best lot me. You' fe just tn this job fOf the mo.ney.• g. PerSon wt10 lost his "e savings in the stock market It. Prisooef abOUt to be sentenced I. An3Y dient j. Oient seeing a counsetklr' fO( the fll'St (or last) time k. Patient in hOspital waiting fO( maj:)f surge,y I. Child en.te-ring a foster home b. (Client, smiling.) · Fof the flrst time. lhings am really saafti~ to come togethet lot me. My kids afe an ooing well in schOOI, my marital ptoblems are o.n the upswing. and I finally put some money aside fOI' a rainy day: c. (Parent to a teacher.) Mf don't know what to do. I know you said I s.houkS try to help my son with his homeNOrk m. Man who has just abused his wife and ShOw some tnteresa in his \\()rk_ but he comes home n. Couple on lhe day of theit ma«iage from school and goes straight to his room. When I ask o. abOut his h0mew0tk, he a~NayS says that lhere wasn'I any. When I offer to help. he makes it cteaf he'd rathef do it on his own: Immigrant whO has left his wife and children at home vd'lile he settles in C3n3Cla p. Setial killer q. Compulsive gamble( afte-r a big win and aftet losing his paycheque r. ll-year-<lld girl wro haSbOOn sexually abuSed byhe< father s. 75-yeat-(jj woman remanying thfee yearS after too death of he( hUSband. (She was happily maffied for 45 years.> d. (Teenage.r, crying.) ·i-m ptegnant. This will kill my dad, but first he'll lull me: e. MEvetyo.ne atways says hOw togeth« I am, but I dOo't feel together. Sometimes I get so wound up that I think I'm gci~ to bur'Sl.• each of the fonowing clients may be feeling: f. (Man. age 57, talking abOut his family problems.) " I have to make every decision. I can nevef count on my wife Or' kids fOr' hell:): a. a. 6. Identify teeli~ words and phtases that beSI describe hOw MEveryone in my life keeps putting me down. Even my childten constantly criticiZe 01m me: b. (Shakil'lg.) "fifteen hafd year'S with lhe same company and what do lhey do? They dump me with three weeks' notice.· c. (A six-year.c,td boy. crying while speaking torecrMtion sJaff.J •Noooo wants to play'lfith me. No one llk.eS me: (Parent to a teacher.) ·My so.n does not have ADHO. I 000·1 cafe what you say. I'm not going to put him o.n drugs.: b. (Client shouting.) Mf am calm!• I. (Mt)man, age 50-plus, talking to a 23-yea,-old worker.) ..You're pfetly young to be working hefe.• j. (Patient In an ambulance.) MOo.n'l let me die: Empatlllc Connections 189 2. Each ot the fOIOwing client statements expfesses mor'e than one feeling. Identify feeling \\()fds and phrases that beSt describe the mixed foof~. Next, fOr'mulate an empathic response. b. ·I'm not ashamed to admit it. Once in a wtltte, 1hl my wife. It's no big dea1.· a. "Thank.S fOr' seeing me tOday. It really felt good to get thi~ otf my chest. No one has evef listened to me the d. · 1want to die. I've lhOught abOut it fOr' months, and I just way you did. I hope you dOO'I think l'm crazyOr'Stupid." b. (Eyes we/litJg up with tea,s,J-1t'stM'll. I don't care to be with him anymOr'e.• c. Ml was bro~t up to believe you should handle your problems oo yotX own. LOOk at me now-sitti~ he-re JX)uring my guts out to a counsetlOr'.• d. "lo tel you lhe truth, I'd like to just mard'I rlgN in, 100k him in the eye. and tell hlm exactl'j whefe to go. I don't know wtiat to dO... e. "F'lnding out that my fotmef g'i"lfriend had my bab-f was totally shocki"lg. After we bfOke up, She didn't even tell me She was pregnant I'd love to be a fathet, but I don't want a relationship with her. Maybe it wouk:I be beSt if I just forget thewhOle lhiog. but I want to dowtlat's rigN.• t MLM~ on your 01m is the pits. Now I doo'1 even knON where my next meal is c:omi~ from. I used to IOve betng martied. I felt as if life really had meantng. At least, I don't have towony abOut being beat up b-f my hUSband every time he gets drunk. It's just so diffteult. Maybe I s.houk:I gj\iQ him anothet chance.· r.. (Woman, 79 years old, crying.) "My daughtef keeps saying lhat she is coming for a visit. but it has boon weeks sinice I have seen hef. (Wipes away the tea/$.)lt's not that important. I realty do not want to bea bOlhef. I'm just feeing SOtry fof myself this mor'ntng.• h. (A clvll engineer from Syria who Immigrated to CatJada.) " I was so ex.cited to begin my new life in caoada when I came three years ago. Bui all my dreams have disappeared. The onty wOr'k I've been able to find is drM~ a cab.· I. {12-year.oJd girl.) ·1 flashed my breasts on the Internet whle I was in an onlioe chat room. Now my life is ruined. Everyone at school calS me a Slut. I have no one." f. ·n,e 2015 te«orisl klllings in Pans realty messed me up. 1haven't been able to steep, and I constantly think abOut my kids. I don't travel or even gp to movies anymCl(e. It could happen hefe: 3. This exetcise albwS you to apply tough empathy. The foi. lowing statements may evoke stfong per'SOOal feactions. Assume that the petSOO is speaking to you and that you afe responding with empathy, even though empathy may n01 be the ptefetted response. a. MCanada was much beltef when it was white and Chfisti:an. With such high unemployment, don't you think it's time to stop letting every damn lfflmigrant into the country? No wonder I can't get a job: 190 Chap1er 6 c. · 1 don't cate what you s:¥f. I won't give up on you untH you eonvett and save you( solJ.• d00'1 want to live anymore.• e. ·What's lhe big deal if I have to steal a bit from Safeway to make sure my kids afe feel? It's oot like it hurts anyone.· f. (Student to teacher.) · 1 suppose this course is gci~ to be like au the Olhers:. LOts of feadlng. a bunch of papers:. I only hope lhere's some relevance to it al ." g. (Client, 35 years old.) Ml had oo idea she was only 15. She was the ooo vd\owanted to have sex. Ftom the look in her eyes, I colJCI tel She was begging fOr' it. It's featly unfait that I'm now charged with rape. Besides, 15 is Old enougtl fof someone to make up theit own mtnd." II. ·This counsetling isn't very helpful." I. · 1 reatlydOn'twonytoomuchabOutAIOS. What can I do abOut it? If I'm meant to get it then 111get it. So what? We all have to die sometime... j . ·I'm 001 stupij. I know that he sholJCl.n't hit me. Bui I guess I desetved ii, lhe way I put him dOl«'I. I sholJCI learn to keep my mouth Shut. When I see him, I'll apolOgJze.• k. (Client. with angry tone.) ·No one is willi~ to 1alk to me abOut the fact that I migtlt be dying. I can accept it, but every time I ask lhe big question, people change lhe topic." I. ·There's no way I'm going to pay for her stupidity. If she didn't want to get ptegnant, She sholJCI have taken the pil . Now she ex.peels: me to sup(X)rl the baby until he's 18. I 000·1 care if I am the fathet. NOi a chancer What do you think are the advantages ot resJX)ndtng with empathy to the pteceding clients? 4. Each of the follOwing client statements might be a routine tnqliry for in.formation 0t could be an tndirect way of ex.ptesstng feelings. Assume that the client is ex.ptesstng feelings and lormulate an empathic response. a. How old afe you? b. Have you ev« been uoemplOyed? c. Have you ever lived in a fostet home? d. Oid you use dcugs when you wefe my ag,e? e. Have you ev« taken psychiatric medications? 5. Record a television pr·awam. Watch l Vfith lhe sound lutned off. Pay attention to the nonvetbal communic.ation of the aetars. Now watch it with the sound lutned on. How sucoossflJ wefe you in correctly reading the nonverbal cues? 6. The fOlloMng is the tr'anscript of a por1ion of a counsellOr"s interwew. The wOr'ker is an emptoyment counsetlOr' at a Vancouvet social service agency. Ctiticalty evaluate the counsetlOr"s tesponses (e.g.• approprt.ateness of questions, use of empathy, etc.). What attitude do you think lhe counsetot conveys to his dient? Suggest alternative resJX)nses baSed on empathy. Counsellor: Hey! Are you Leah? I'm Mr. Short. Won't you come in to my office? (Brief small talk 111 office.) Counsello1: So wtlat i:S yout ptoblem? How can I help you? Client: Well, I don't really know wtlere to begin. Ri~t now. my life i:S a mess. I've gotten ato~ well so far, but latety . .. well. I'm just not coping very well. (Client pauses. wipes tears with a tissue.) Counsellor: Okay, cam oown. Try not to er,. Have you been to thi:S agency before? By lhe way, hOw old are you? Client No, lhis is the fll'SI lime. I wondet if anyone will evet give me a d'laoce. So~es I lhink, why not g;,.,e up? I feel so sw:.ared al the time. Oon'l get me wro~I really want to w0tk, to be independent. to buy my kids all the lhiogs I haven't been able to afford. 1just don't koow if I can do it. I haven't wOt'ked in 10 years. Plus, there's the problem of daycare ... the things you read . .. it's hard to koow wtlo to trust. Things just seemed so much easier when my husband was alive. Counsello1: You say you haven't w0tked in 10 years. What was lhe last jOb you hek1? What dkl you do? What ate yout Clie-nt: Mostly, I've WOrked as a secretary in Toronto. It was okay, but I don't want to dO that anymore. I realtydon1 have a Clue what I'd like. Counsellor: So you know you want to get out of cletical wot'k, but you'te uns1Xe what etse you might dO ot like. Cliem: Yes, exactty. Counsellor: Have you considered social services? There are lots of gOOCI programs that you couk:I complete in a short time. Cli&nt: No. I don't lhink I'd like that. Coun-Sellor: How can you be sure until you give it a try? Sometimes votunteet wot'k is a really go:xt way to ftnd out if you like il Cli&nt: Wei .. . I guess so. Counsellor: Actually, I was in the same bOat as you. Then I vOlunteetecl. Nex.t thing I knew I was baek in Sd'IOO. Now 1·m wot1d~futl time and loving it. I have a friendwhoWOrkS at the votunteet bureau. Why don't I gjve het a Call and set up an ap!X)intment fOr' you? Cll&nt: Okay ... thanks. Counsellor: No ptoblem. I was glad to be of help. 111phone her, and then l'l gjve you a call. It'll probabty be next week OtSO. job skills? WEBLINKS Roots of Empathy, a p,ogram with Canadian o,igins, to teach empathy skills to child1en Website offering comp,ehensive tOOls and WOrksheets on emotions and a variety of other relevant topics www.rootsofempathy.org http://www.therapistaid.com/ The Compass OeRose Guide to Emotion Words: A c-0mprehensive list of emotions and fe,eling words as well as some links to other resources and articles on the topic Emotional Intelligence Network http://www.6seconds.org,' www.derose.neVsteve/resou1ces/emotionwords/ewords.html The Association f0c the Development of the Person Centered At,proach (includes links and articles based oo the teachings of Carl Rogers) www.adpca.org Empatlllc Connections 191 Jacek Oudzinsk.Vl23RF Empowerment: TIie prooess o f ~ dients discowr personal stiengths-6 capacities so tu'! ...,ate~ to1alle contrdowr t!leirhes: the elJIE!(ted outa,me of succtssful counselling. 192 ■ Identify the clements of empowering clients. ■ Explore the srrengths approach. ■ Appreciate the complex and diverse chaJlenges of ,vorking with seniors. ■ Understand the goaJs and skills of crisis intervention. ■ Describe the principles and strntegies of motivational interviewing. ■ Identify and describe the stages of change model. ■ Explore the principles and strategies of cognitive behavioural counselling. ■ Understand the process of problem solving. ■ Understand the principles and techniques of brief counselling. EMPOWERMENT: MOBILIZING STRENGTHS FOR CHANGE Empowerment that results in clients discovering strengths and taking control of their lives is the expected outcome of successful counselling. There are many clements of empowerment that impact all three domains: feelings, thinking. and behaviour .ll Figure 7.1 The Elements of Empowerment (sec Figure 7.1). Empowered clients have high self-esteem 3nd confidence, enabling them to cake appropriate risks without undue anxiety. Able to enjoy success without guilt, they arc fully aware of their needs and values. They behave assertively, aware of thc.ir right~ yet respectful of the rights of others. \Vith access to knowledge and resource~ they make their own decisions by using a r:mgc of skills and strategies. Although empowered clients have the ability to act indcpc:ndc:ndy, they arc also able to draw on social and community supports. Empowerment is the antidote to oppressive S)' Stcms that deny people access and opportunity to particiP3tc in decisions that affect their lives. Empowerment requires self-determination as well 3S the mca.ns. opportunity, resource~ and freo:lom to exercise choice. Fully exercised, empowerment ensures foll particip3tion in decisions nffecting clients' lives. Responsible empowerment is founded on the principle of reciprocity nnd respect for rclntionships and the rights of others. It is 3ssertive for personal rights 3nd freedoms. but not 3t the expense of the rights 3nd freedoms of others. In relationship~ responsibleempmnrment commits people, insofur 3S possible, to negotiating, coll3borating:, consensus sec-Icing, and rem3ining occountable. Responsible empowe.rment is nssertivc, neither passive nor aggressive. How Counselling Promotes Empowerment Counsellors do not empower clients; rather they promote the conditions where empowerment can flourish. Counsellors support diem empowerment with the foundntion3J belief that clients 3rc capable of change and h3ve a right co mnnngc their own lives. An empowerment 3ttitude focuses on the cap3citics nnd strengths of clients while forgoing: nny need to control clients by t31cing on an "expert" role that m3kes them dependent. When empowerment is the priority, clients become the expert~ 3nd there is "coll3borntion and sh3rcd decision mnking within the profession3J reJntionship" (Sheafor & Horejsi, 2008, p. 79). CounseJlors dem,.•stify the counselling process through open and non-jargonistic discussion with clients of their methods 3nd nssumptions. Sdf..detcrmination, 3n important component of client empowerment, is promoted by helping clients recogni!e choices nnd by encouraging them to make independent decisions. Counsellors shouJd not do for clients whnt clients can 3nd should do foe themselves. Supporting Empowerment and Change 193 SUCCESS TIP PerSOr\3I identity, that sense of kOowm"lg whO you are and how you connec1with Olhel'S, is an essential part of empowe<ment. CounsellOt'S can help d ients inctease pel'SOl"lal identity (and se•~oom) b'f helping them ex.ptore and appreciate U'leit roots, in particl.Jat positive aspects of g(oup hisl0cy, lncluding accompfish~nts, cl.Ahxal and (eligious pr'actices, and language. Anti-Oppressive Practice anti-oppressi'lt practice: 'Mien couns.elkn 'llllfk ICJ str~ural dl..-ges il«ganizatioos. pcicy, -.:Iii promoting equity in lie disttibutioo of m ouroes, opportunities. and po--. Often clients come from diS3dvantag~ and marginali:~ groups where they "have been 'beaten down' by oppression, poverty, abuse, and othc.r harmful life experiences. They want better lives for themsdvcs and their familic~ but they feel powerless to make the necessary changes. Some clients have a pervasive sense of failure and foci different from and rejected by other ~pie" (Sheafor & Horejsi, 2008, p. 422). Sometimes pO\\•erlessncss 3rises from neg3tivc self-evaluation 3nd lo"' sdf-cstcem or from lade of confidence in one's ability to 3lter one's life, but sometimes the systems that 3re set up to 3ssist clients are themselves oppressive and contribute to powerless..ness. Anti-oppressive practice involves counsellors working for structural changes in organizations or policy, 3nd in promoting equity in the distribution of rcsourcc5i. opporrunitie5i. and power (Drolet, Clarie, & Allen, 2012). P3ul Moore (200 I) suggests that 3n anti-oppressive framework ch3Jlenges workers to examine and challenge the lenses that may colour our vie"'points on what is "right and acceptable:" racism, sexism, heterose.xism, 3bleism, ageism, and cl3ss oppression. Feminist theory 3ddresses the power differential th3t allows men to enjoy privilege at the expense of women. Ben Carniol (2010), 3 C3nadian social work ~uator and 3d\'OC3tc, re.minds heJpcrs that since racism and other prejudices may deny clients access to jobs and resources such as 3dcquatc housing, helpers have a responsibility to advocate for a progressive system 3nd social policy changes. Since client self-determination is enh3nccd when clients h3\'t". more choices, counscl.lors should 3lso be involved in broader 3Ctivitics such 3S working to identify and re.move gaps and barriers to service and encouraging more hum3nc and accessible policies and services. The counsdling process itself offers empowerment to clients. The beginning: phase offers many clients a unique opportunity to explore their situ3tion and their feel.ing.s. Active listening skills hdp clients bring: long-forgotten or misunderstood fcdings to the surface. Ventilation of ftt.lings c3n energize clients, 3nd it can lead co spontan«>us insight into ne"' "'3YS of h3ndling: problems th3t seemed insurmountable. For some clients, the work of counselling: is finished 3t this phase. THE STRENGTHS APPROACH streng_ths approach.: A counselilc perspe«iw that asS>Jmes tile inherent capacity of people. lldimaals and communities are seen to haw assets •d iesouttes that can be mctiililed I• probleascf\ing. learned helplessness: Astate al aind tu'! oa:urs llflen indi\ifualsUle learrlfd throug) lailure that their effcru ¥ill not result i• change. 194 The strcnjtth s approach is 3 perspective that shifts the focus from diem problems and deficits to possibilitie~ c3pacities, and resources th3t can be mobiliz~ in the pursuit of goals and change. Many clients come to counselling "'ith lo"' self-esteem and confidence. Sdigm3n's (1975) concept of learned helplessness suggests th3t individu.als can become demoralized through foilure to the point that they give up trying to alter their circumstances, e,-en in situations in which change is possible. Persons "'ith learn~ helplessness c3n be difficult 3nd frustrating to work "'ith bec3use these clients do not believe the.ir efforts "'ill make a difference. \\:fhen they 3rc successful, they 3re likdy to attribute it to luck, rather than their efforts or c3pacity. As long: as they hold these beliefs, they arc unlilcdy to engage in risk.-t31cing to solve problems and achieve Chap1er 7 empowerment. Signif,candy, individuals may in foct be quite capable, but believe they are not. For others, anxiety about rislc-tnking or failure deters them from action. ln addition, if clients nre locked into a view of themselves ns victim~ they nre likeJy to resist change, or they may enter into dependency relationships in whidi they relinquish power and control to others, including their counsellors. The key is to help them set small goofs and implement a successful action plan, then accept the conntttion between their actions and success. Cognitive behavioural techniques are also vaJuable in helping clients change the way they think about themsdves. SUCCESS TIP Counseilol'S need 10 manage lheil' own unmet needs then mighl impede lheit capac,ty to be helpful. F'o, example, if lhey have a higri r')OOd for' control, they can potentially take power' from clients, who lot their part may freely g;,.,e it away. Here are some basic strategies for maintaining a strengths approach: t. Negoti3te coll3borative relationships with clients where they share responsibility for identifying priorities, goals, and preferred wnys of proceeding. Accept that they are the "experts" on the.ir own lives and that with encouragement they can make decisions on what will and will not w-ork. Counsdlors need to be Oexible and accept that every intervention plnn will be individuali:ed to the unique needs and attributes of each client. What works with one client may be counterproductive with another. 2. Trust that clients have the capacity to change, and that they can learn to cope with the.ir problems and challenges. Every experienced counsellor can relate ama!ing stories of people who have recovered from adversity and overwhelming odds. 3. Stay interested in strengths. Acknowledge clients' skills, resourcefulness, motiva, tion, and virtues. \Vhen workers value their clients' strengths, clients learn to vnJue themselves. Discovering overlooked abilities, lcnowledgc, and experience can also ene.rgi:e counsellors nnd clients. 4. Ask questions or make statements thnt uncover strengths, such ns "Thinle of a time when )'OU were able to handle problems such as this. \\:fhat skills and resources enabled you to cope?" Other approaches include these: "\\:'hen you were nble to manage, what were 't'OU doing that helped )'OU succeed?" "\Vhat are the things in 't'our life thnt you fed good about?" "What's ,vorking well for you!" "\Vhat ,vould 't'our friends say arc your best quaJities?" 5. Help the client identify strengths that come from adve.rsit)' with questions such ns "In whnt ways have the problems you've faced in 't'OUr lifemnde )'OU stronger!" To a client who has struggled for six months to find work and get off welfare, you might say, "I'm impressed with )'Our ability to hang in the.re. Mnny people would have given up." look for strengths in the way clients have handled adversity with comments and questions such ns "You've been through a 10( in your life. but somehow 't'ou've managed to survive. How have )'OU been able to do this!" Or you might Sil)', "In what ways have your problems made you stronger?" 6. U se cognitive behavioural techniques to help clients challenge and mann,;e selfdeprecating remarks that reinforce low sclf-esteem. 7. Avoid diagnostic labels ns a way of describing clients. Labels tend to ignore strengths by focusing on pathology nnd deficits. 8. Focus on problem soh•ing and goal setting rather than on discussions of blame or on finding the root causes of current behaviour or problems. There may be Supporting Empowerment and Change 195 cathartic benefit to discus.sing history, but once this purpose is achieved, the focus of the ,vork should shift to present and future events. Goal setting energizes clients to action and mobilizes their resources and motivation for change. 9. Use the info rmal resources of fam ilies, neighbourhoods, and communities that are potentiaJ sources of help and srrength for clients. Use community d irectories to pinpoint agencies, services, and self-help groups that coukl be supportive. ChaJ,. lenge clients to ide ntify and discover these resources: "Who do )'OU rrust?" " Who suppor ts )'OU when you neo:I help!" Strengths-based counselling shifts the focus from deficits and problems to a process in which clients' strengths, capacities, and resources are recognized. Strengths are the resources that e nable clients to overcome prob lems. ln this sense, client as.sessmem moves beyond identifying obstacles and prob lems to discussion of personal and envi.. ronmental resources. Helping clients renke their strengths empowers them with the belief that thq• are capab le of change. For example, helping clients re frame how thq• think about p roblems can enable them to see their problems as opportunities. SaJCffly (2009), a major proponent of the strengrhs approach, offers these perspectives: It is a collaborative process .. .. It is an 3ppt"Oach honorh-)¥ the inn.2te wisdom of the hutiun spirit. the inhe-rent eapad ty for translonnation of even the roost humbted and ::abused .. . . Rally clients· interests,. eapadties. motwations,. resources. and emotions in the v.'Ork of re::1ehinK their hopes ::and dre::1ms. help them llnd pathways to those "°"ls. ::and the p.,yoff ,nay be ::an enh::ul«d quality of d::ul't' life for them. (p. I) SUCCESS TIP "Practicing from a strengths perSpec1ive reqlires lhal we Shift lhe way we lhink abOul. approach, aoo relate to our dients.. Rather lhan loc:using exclusively or dotninantly on problems, )'Our eye rums towards pos$,lbiily. In lhe thicket ot trauma, pain, and trouble, you see blOOms of hope and transfotmatioo.· (Saleeby, 2009, p. 1) T he strengths approach rW uces some of the power differentiaJ that occurs when client vulnerabilities and d eficits are given priority over their strengths. G licken (2004) offers this reminder: "There is usually more a bout clients that is positive and functionaJ than is neg::ative or d't•sJu nctional" (p. 4). W ith the strengths perspective, the client is the exper t and the primary author of the change p rocess. "Thus, the worker's ro le is to listen, help the client process., and facilitate by focusing on positive behaviors that might be useful to clients for coping with the.ir current life situations" (Glicke n, 2004, p. 6). Our minds and bOdies react wilh mmarkable speed to deal with C(isis and stress. To divert ils resources 10 fighling the crisis, the brain Shuts dOwn nonessential actMly such as digestion. Our hearts pump taste( and our b<ealhing inc,eases to maximize oxygen to the bOdy. Adrenaline, the stress hOrmone cortisol. and dozens of 01her hOrmones a(e released. The bf3in signats the liver to release mo(e sugar C(eating a burst of eootgy. While cortisol, ad(enaline, and 01her hOrmones help us cope in the short run, with chronic 196 Chap1er 7 (prolonged) stress. depression may inc,ease, lhe prOduction of oow brain neurons i:S reduced, and the(e is damage to the Hippocampus, a part of lhe btain associated with memory and learning. Maladaptive attempts to deal with srress using d(ugs, overeating, and s.mOking compound lhe problem by iner-easing lhe (iSk of suoke, heart anack. liver disease. and a myriad of olhe( health problems (Ashwell, 2012; The Franklin Institute, 2015; and University of Maryland, 2015). EMPOWERMENT AND SENIORS On July 1, 2017, there were almost 5.8 million people in Canad3 over 65 't'C3rs of age representing about 16 percent of the population, and for the first time, the number of seniors over 65 years of 3ge in Canad3 is grc3tc.r than the number of children under 15 (Srotistics Canad3, 2017). The first of the baby boomc.rs arc now in their 70s. Thc.ir lives have evolved very diffcrendy than past generation~ and they are rewriting the book on 3ging. \Vith improved life expectancy, thq• can expect to live 15 to 20 years or more and their cxpcctntions for 3n 3ctivc and productive retirement are high. As a group. they arc healthier, more educated, and more financinJI'>' secure than previous generations. Today's seniors 3rc very adept 3t self-advocating for their rights and needs. Generally, they have led lives where they we.re active pnrricip,mts in decision making, so there is linle doubt that they will have an enormous imP3ct on services for this age group. They will want to be very involved in defining and developing programs and services that will meet their needs. Since the foundation for empowerment is choice and control, counseJlors will welcome this proactive stance as one that is very consistent with strengths and empowerment counseJling philosophy and routines. Aging offers many opportunities. 1t is a rime when people can have more time to pursue hobbies, spend rime with family, assist with raising grandchildren, travel and realize dreams that were not possible in the.ir young,er •fears. Increased attention to fitness and nutrition along with bener healthcare results in more seniors living longer, healthier, and independent lives. Financial need, better health, and a ,;eneral desire to remain active in the labour force has resulted in many seniors ,vorking wdl past the traditional retirement a,;e of 65. Aging can also pre.sent with man,., unanticipated challen,;es that lead seniors to seek counselling (see Table 7. I) For example,. health issues may have imP3cto:J the ability of many seniors to w-orlc or pnnicipnte in octiviries that have defined their lives. Some, bo::ause of mobility or hrokh issues. including loss of ~-csight, have become dependent on others for the 6rst rime in their lives. \Vomen live longer than men, so they are more likd)•to face the prospect of living alone without their spouse, sometimes with very limited income or suppon. Retirement or unanticipated job loss can result in dramatic changes in role and stnrus that have de.fined a person's life. \Vithout the demands and time commitments of employment, retirement requires people to find new ways to structure their time and find meaning in their lives. Otherwise, depression, loneJiness, and despair may take over. Consequently, helping seniors achieve or maintain a sense of purpose is an essential empowerment ,;oaJ. CRISIS INTERVENTION AND EMPOWERMENT A crisis can take many forms. NarurnJ disasters, terrorist attacks, and w-nr create crises that impact all members of a country or community. Personal experiences such ns rape, denth, divorce, loss of income, or incarce.mrion dearJ,., affect individunJs and their families. Many factors influence how an individual copes with a crisis, including past experiences, overall physical and psychological health, the presence or absence of social and community supports, substance use, personality factors such as impulse control, and genetics. Catastrophic disasters, assaults, war, and other traumas can disempower even the strongest individual~ and people may experience devastating and debilitating life change~ such as post-traumatic stress disorder. For some, a crisis ma)' stir up pnst memories of other traumas and the impact may be cumulative, leaving them more vulnerable. As a result, the.re is further psychological injury leading to depression, ph)•sical illnes~ anxiety, hopelessness, suicide, or withdm,.,,.-nl. Supporting Empowerment and C hange 197 TABLE 7 . 1 Empowering Seniors Component MedicavPsychiatric Potential Issues • Complex health, f0t example. loss of eyesigt\l, heari~. and physical mot,li1y • Oep(ession • Oemtmtia includi~ Alzheimer's Disease Flnancial • Po,,el'ly (especially women) • Unexpected job IOSS • Costs of hOusi~ in IO~tefm ca,e • financial abuSe • Oisc(ntination (ageism) • Managing time, use of leisure.• and copi~ with retirement • Emotbnal and phyS:ical neglecl and abuse • ISOiation and fear of abandonment • Housing • Couples who beeome separ-ated in diffefent care facilities beeause one of them oeects tnOr'e complex cafe PsychOI. .I • LOss of control, indepe-ndence, and identity and the • • • • • need to find pur(X)se in life Oeali~ with death and dyi~ LOss of control, identity, and independe~ ISOiation and fear of abandonment Grief exacerbated b-f multiple IOSSeS (friends, family, and spouse) Sex.uaity Suppon Choices • famity sup(X)rt and education • Lifestyle counse1Hng-t1ut(rtion and exefcise • Appropriate use of medication and the heafth system • Respite care • cafe« and job counselling fot those remaini~ in the wor1dofce • Community fesouroos f0t financial and housi~ support • Legal ramedies • Wellness counsem~ • Expt>r-ation of meaninghA social and recreational opportunities • use of advocate groups and 0tganiz.atioos • Empt>yrnent of vOlunteers • Police inteiwntion • LObbyi~ fof systemic: change • Pets • Arrangement of traosportat.ioo (famil'j, vOI~ unteers, and seniors' services) • • • • Stfengtns-based counselling Grief counselling MaximiZing in'V()l\lement rn decision maka"lg Utili:zation ot adlAt day care and droP.,.n progr-ams for seniors Neve.rtheles~ many people adapt and may even thrive during a crisis. T hey dis.cover their resilience and untapped strengths, including previously unknown resources. OptimisticaJI)•, the resolution of a crisis is an opportunity fo r growth. Presbury, Ech.terling, and McKee (2008) suggest that post-traumatic g rowth (PTG) happens when people "come away from traum:nic events having gained a new perspective on life and having achieved important understandings" (p. 212). Supportive crisis intervention by counsellors and others can increase the probability of post-traumatic growth (lames & Gilliland, 2013). A crisis can overwhelm individuaJs and disrupt their ability to cope and function normally. Persona] crises that may arise from depression, loss of job, or rape mil)' evoke emotions so intense that action or rational thinking is impossible. Sometime~ as in the case of a disaster like a flood or tsunami, people are c ut off from the.ir basic physical needs. Whatever the nature of the c ris is, the p riority goal for counselling is to heJp clients obtain power and control b\• re-establishing safety and stability. One centra.1 step is to help and encourage connections with supportive family, friends, and community resources to restore equilibrium and to reduce psychological trauma➔ SUCCESS TIP In the immediate aftermath ot a crisis, counsellOts n'lay wish to minimize (but no1 prevent) expfession of footings rn favouf of l!litiatives that locus on safely aoo coMection with sup. portive family and community resources. 198 Chap1er 7 The ultimate goal of crisis inte.rvention is diem empowerment, so that wherever possible counsdlors should collaborate with clients; however, bcc3usc of physicaJ inca, pacitation or emotional in3bility, there ma)' be times when counsellors need to assume power and be more dirtttive. For example, if 3 dicnt is suicidal and not responding to counselling initiatives, the counsellor ma,., need to caJI for emergency se.rviccs and hospita1iz3tion. ff 3 dicnt is emotionally unable to make rational decisions, the counsellor may be required to take chari;:c. Table 7.2 summa.ri:::cs counsellor skills and strategies for selected crisis intervention goals. ln the remainder of this chapter, strategics for motivating clients and helping them develop and sustain change will be explored. MotivationaJ Interviewing (Miller & Rollnick, 2002, 2013) is a tool to hdp clients deal with the ambivalence that inhibits them from making necessary changes. The stages o f ch ans:e model (Prochaska & Norcross, 2001) is based on the notion that people go through different motivational stages, C3ch of which requires different counsellor skill choices for success. Frequently, the stages of change model is reflected in Motivational Jnterviewing. Cognitive behavioural counscJling is a collaborative (counsellor and diem) approach to helping clients make changes in the three major psychological domains: thinking. behaviour, and emotions. stages of chance, model: A IMOry of mo:rt~ion tut recopil2s liw changes ol piecontemplat • contemplat • st• preparation. auion. and main~.--e:. MOTIVATIONAL INTERVIEWING (Ml) Motiv-arionaJ lnterviewina (Ml ) (Mille.r & Rollniclc, 2002, 2013) is an empirically validated strategy for helping people ove.rcome ambivaJcnce to change. Motivational interviewing requires a collaborative, nonconfrontational relationship. lt assumes that motivation and capacity for change arc within the client. Consequently, it honours the client's right to seJf-dcte.rmination regarding whether change is to take place, as well as the ultimate gooJs of any change process. "MI allows clients, both mandated and voluntary, to discove.r their own reasons for making change. Ml aJlows the impetus to change to emerge from within a client, thus honoring the client's unique circumstances and worldvicw" (Caponi & Stauffer, 2008, p. 145). TABLE 7.2 motirational interviewi~ (Ml): A nocCllfruuati>nal coaseHing approach t!l31 promotes behavml change by assisting tlieals to recognize: and iescbe ambi~ Crisis Intervent ion Intervention Goal Pt,ys;cai safety Counullot Skill and Strategy CholcH Link to fesouroos f0t fOOCI, sheftef, and medical assislance. Help d ient move to a physical psychologically safe setting. Access emergency secvtes (e.g., police and ambulance). °' P~hOIOgjcal safety Etlcoutage client to ink with personal supports (famlfy, friends, and religious leader). ShoN empathy Catlow clients to ex.press feelings). Normalize feelings. Empowefment Provkle information. EtlcotXage decision making. Promote and reinforce small goals with reaistk time frames. carry out 1tauma counsetling. Mobilize Or' help client coMect wilh sup(X)rt groups. Restore balance Offer reassurance. Provi::le sel'Vioos (informat.ion, support, and refenal) to significant family. Communicate hope and optimism. Etlcoutage resumption of normal routines.. Plan f0t follow-up. Supporting Empowerment and Change 199 Miller 3nd Rollnick's (2013) conception of Ml highlights the following features: ■ The "spirit of motivational interviewing" is more important th3n technique. "The spirit of motivational interviewing" as conccptuali:~ by Miller and Rollnick (2013) is primaril)• conce.rned with the 3ttitudc of the counsellor and the counseJling refo,. tionship. It derives from Roger's person-centered 3pprooch with 3 high cmph3sis on client sclf-determin3tion and faith in the ability and cap3city of people to change. They identify " four key interrcl3t~ cJements of the spirit of Ml: p3rtnership. acceptance, compassion, and evocation" (p. 15). Partnership emphasizes colfoborativc conversations to assist people to strengthen their motivation for change. Acc:cpt3ncc involves the esscntiaJ core conditions described by Rogers (1961) of unconditional positive regard, empathy, and genuineness (Stt Chnptcr 3 of this book). Compassion, as defined by Miller 3nd Rollnick, involves a conscious focus on promoting the best interests of clients by giving their needs priority (p. 20). Evocation focuses on the inherent strengths of clients as opposed to detecting problems and deficits. As discussed earlie.r in this chapte.r, the strengths approoch assumes that clients arc experts on the.ir O\\•n lives, and they h3ve within them the experience, wi~ dom, and resources that need to be the focal point for decision making and change. ■ Avoidance of the "righting reflex.-thc desire to fix what seems wrong with people" (p. 6). This desire to fix might involve confrontation (which tends to promote rcsi~ tance), 3nd advice giving on the best course of 3Ction. It often involves trying to persuade clients to change. The righting reflex tends to put clients on the defensive whe.re they take positions that hnve hisroric3lJy been defin~ 3S resistant. In MI, counsellors are encouraged to consider how their bdi.aviours and responses might be evoking resistance. (Sec Chapter 8 for a further discussion of this important perspective.) ■ A belief thnt the resolution of 3mbivalencc is a criticaJ step in supporting change. Ambivalence Miller & Rollnic.k note that most people who need to change are ambivalent: they hnvc reasons to change as well as reasons to maintain the status quo, however, dsyfuntionaJ that might be (2013). Anxiety and indecision can leave people stuck. Ambivalence is a normal part of the chnngc process. For clients who are not interested in changing, the emergence of ambivalence would signal movement t0\\'3rd change. When people are 3mbiwlent, they are drawn in opposite directions at the same time. People may be ambivalent for a number of reasons, including the following: I . The aJte.rnatives are cquaJly appealing (Approach/Approach). 2. Neither course of action is appealing (between a "rock and a hard place"). 3. Both altcrn3tivcs have features that are both 3ppealing and unappealing. 4 . Conflicted fccling~knowing what is right, but finding one's emotions taking one in the opposite dir«tion (Hcan/intcllect). 5. Desire to move in one direction, but fear of loss if that direction is chosen. 6. Simply not knowing what is right. "Change Talk" and "Sustain Talk17 One way counsellors can address ambivalence is by listening for "change talk"- dient statements favouring change and "sustain talk "- dient statements favouring the smrus quo (Mille.r 3nd Rollnick, 2013, p. 7). Here are some examples of diem statements that signal change tallc: change talk Clieal statanents laYOJring dt.an,e. sustain talk: Client Mat.ement.s laYOJring 1M mtus quo. 200 ■ I wish my life was different. ■ I w3nt to quit drinking. ■ I could ask my family for help. ■ I miaht be able to work pan.-time. Chap1er 7 ■ I probably should go back to school. ■ I need to find a W'll)' out of this mess. ■ I will look into it. ■ My intention is to fight this problem. ■ I tried to stop using heroin. SUCCESS TIP The fact lhat a che-nt firmly defends a lifestyle that he knows is unwOr'kable is prool that he is in need of great assistance and suJ)port.. (WickS & Pal'SOOs, 1984) \Vhcn counsellors hear change talk, cardully targeted responses can increase the level of change talk and motivation for change. Client: "I know th:u smokin¥ is Nd and. I !"K'ed to q uit (chan,e talk). but I'm 2(rakl. that i( I q uit I'll ¥:l.in \\re~t (tlillam talk)." Coun.seltor (Ml choice~): ■ I( )'OU rn:lde 2 dedsion l'O q uit. how would )'Ou do it! ■ \Vh::lt are )·Our re:asons for wanth1¥ to quit! ■ Hoo• important is it for )'Ou m s:.ive up smokiOi! A decisional balance sheet lists the benefits and costs of different choices. By addressing barriers to change, counsellors may help diem to "tip the baJancc" in favour of change. ln the above example, exploration of the ways one can control weight g3in ma,., help this client overcome resistance to change. Empathy EmP3thy and other active listening skills are now universally recognized as important to any counsdling relationship. regardless of the choorctical approach of the counsellor. Ml is no exception and empathy is a central feature of this approach. "\Vithin the Spirit of Ml," it creates an interview climate where clients are free to explore their value~ perception~ goal~ and the implications of their current situation without judgment. Conversely, "confrontationaJ counscJling has been associated with a high dropout rate and rdativet,., poor outcomes" (Miller & Rollnick, 2002, p. 7). Active listening, especinJly with the use of empathy, increases intrinsic motivation for change. Developing Discrepancy The ove.rnJI gonJ of motivational interviewing is to help people get unstuck. The method is to initiate "change talk" by caking advantage of naturally occurring opportunities in the interview to embellish diem statements chal suggest differences between the way their life is and the way they would like their lives to be. Simply focusing on a client's goals and aspirations can often help people appreciate how the.ir current lifestyle is inhibiting che.ir ideals. Motivational interviewing uses a number of strategics to evoke change talk, such as the following: ■ Asking evocative questions about disadvantages of the status quo, advantages of change. optimism 3bout change, and intention to change. ■ Using scaling questions- for example, "On a sc3Je of t~rms of satisfaction with )'OUr life?" to 10, whe.rc are you in Supporting Empowerment and Change 201 ■ Exploring the positive and negative consequences of the status quo. ■ Using eJaboration skills (e.g., asking for darifiC3tion, examples, description, and further infor-m:.nion) to clicit furthe.r change caJk. ■ Querying extremes, such as "Suppose you don't make any changes. \\:lhat do 't'OU think might be the consequences of this in the worst-case scenario?" ■ Looking back to help clients remember how things were before compared with the current situation. ■ Looking forward by asking clients to describe their hopes and goals for the future. ■ Exploring goals and vaJucs to target discrepancies between important goals and current behaviour (Miller & Rollnick, 2002). ■ Helping clients understand their ambiva]cnce to change using the metaphor of a secsaw- ,vhen the costs of continuing present behaviour and the benc6ts of change outweigh the costs of change and benefits of continuing present behaviour, change will occur. " Roll ing with Res istance" \\:fhcn counscllorsconfrontdients with arguments for change, they can e3sily find themselves in power struggles where they are pressing for change and diems are resisting. ln Ml, client resistance is seen as a message that the counsellor nttds to do something different. Power struggles arc likely when counsellors do the following: ■ Offer unsolicited advice from the cxpe.rc role. ■ TeJI clients how they should feel. ■ Aslc excessive questions. ■ Order, direct, w-am, or threaten. ■ Preach, moralize, or shame. ■ Argue for change. ■ Blame, judge, or critici!e. SUCCESS TIP "As long as )(lu( clients are goi.ng to (esiSI you, you might as 'm!II encourage it• (Milton Erickson., sou(ce uokoown). radical acceptance: A strateg:, that ifl\'OIWS ..agini espressi:in al statemeais t!latyo, tend to disagree wit!I or philos-icalJ oppose. Radical acceptance is a strategy that involves encouraging expression of state~ mems that you tend to disagree with or philosophically oppose, for example: C lient: I don't see the point. The onlr reason I C3tne rn,b)• is the fact that 1( I didn't show up. I'd be cut off wel(:ue. CounS(>IJOr. I' in Ve?")' $:lad )'Ou bro~t this up. Man)' people s.h3re views soch as )'Ours but ..von't speak up. so I appred::ue )·Our willin{tness t'O be honest. ampl.ified reflection: Atethniqll! that exauerm wtuit a cliea1 has said Mt!I the llope tu 1M clieal 11ill ,-seat the ether siJe of aabivalenoe. 202 Amplified reflection is a t«hnique that exaggerates what a dicnt has said with the hope that the diem will present the other side of ambivalence. However, as Mille.r and Rollnick (2002) stress, " (t )his must be done empathically, because any sarcastic tone or too extreme an overstatement may itself elicit a hostile or otherwise resistant rcac~ tion" (p. IOI). Chap1er 7 Client: I don't se,e what the problem is. \X'h::u 's the harm in havin¥ 2 (e,., drinks a(ter a h::ard d::ar's v.-·o rk! Counse.Uo r: So, you're s::ari.n~ th2t drinldn& 211)' reason (o-r ooncern. h::.sn't c::aused 30)' problems or aiven rou Client: Well. I wouldn' t ao th3t far. Support Self-Efficacy To begin and sustain change, clients must bclicve in their np::acity for change. For their part, counsellors can have an enormous impact on outcome if they believe in their diem's ability to chanae and when they take steps to enhance diem confidence. One choice is to heJp clients identify past success. Another is encouraging clients to m:.llce an inventory of their strengths and resources. \\:forking on small achievable goals often starts a chanae process that gathers momentum. CounseJlors can also look for opportunities to affirm their clients' effons. strengths, and successes. STAGES OF CHANGE Risk Taking Change involves risk, and risk creates anxiety. Even when motivation to change is high, emotions such as fear make it difficult to replace established behaviour with new W'n)'S of behaving. As a result, there is often tremendous (seJf-imposed) pressure on clients to maintain the status quo, however, ineffective it might be. Sometimes change involves a "sdlina" job, but the results are bette.r when clients, not counseJlors, do the selling. Clients need to convince themseJves that the benefits of chanae outweigh the risks, and they neo:I to dcvclop positive attitudes and beliefs about their capacity for change. Counsellors with a strengths perspective believe in the capacity of their clients to change, and this beJief in them can be a powerful motivating factor. Johnson, McClelland, and Austin (2000) identify three factors important for motivation: "the push of discomfort, the pull of hope that something can be done to relie,.'<' the problem or accomplish a task. and internaJ pressures and drives coward reaching a goal" (p. 133). Thus, not on!)• must clients want to change, but they must also believe in their capacity for change. The concept of secondary iain is a useful way of understanding why some people resist change despite the obvious pain or losses involved in maintaining their current situation. Secondary gain refers co the benefits that people derive from their problems, such as increased attention from others, having an a\--nilable rationale for not changing or participating, financial advantage, or escape from W'Ork or other tasks. Secondary gain: Auseful•arof undefs!and-,.,.,. some people m ist dl.-ge des.pie the «Nioas pail or lossei inrolwd in aailllainilc their curreat si1ualion. CONVERSATION 7. l ST\JOEHT: The clients Ihave the most trouble with a(e the laZy ones--the ones whO won'I even get out of bed in the mOO'ling to go IOOk for a job 01 100 clients whO nENer fonow through on commit~nts. TEACHER: Sure, these clients can be exceptionally diffadt and frusuati~ to \\()fk wtth. Sometimes it's hard to do, but we ShOtJCI discipline oursetves to be nonj udgmental regardi~ motivation. AJ!hough it might be tempt~ 10 label SOt'ne cl.ants as laly, we ShOtJd remember that they may have given up for good reason. They may not have IN resCIU'cesor supp:,rt they need tor change or they may have given uJ) k'I Order to protect themsetves from the furthe( damage to lheir self~eem that would come from repeated failure. In this way, their behaviour may be soon as adaptive. It's normal f0r counselbrs to lose patience with lhem and give up, but it's important to remember that precisely what they did to lhemsef\ie~ up. That's one of the reasons they need counseling, Supporting Empowerment and Change 203 transtheoretical model of change: A aodel tu identifies fiw stages ol dt.ange---piecontemplatio.. contemplatioo, pnq:iaratio.. actio.. . t aa:intenance. 0-Sellof re$p)IIS! choices an difiefat depeaiing • the dierrt's stage of chang_e. The stages of change model, nlso known as the transtheorerical model of chans:e (Prochaska & Norcross, 2001), has rcce.ivcd a great deal of attention in the literature since its inception in the 1980s. In this modcl, five stages of change arc rccogni!ed: pre~ contemplation, contemplation, prc-P3ration, action, and maintenance. As wdl, change is viewed as progressive development in this modd, with success at any phase depcn,. dent on the success of previous phases. Figure 7.2 illustrates the five stages of change. Although this figure implies an orderly progression from one phase to another, in reaJ~ icy, clients may progress through stages and then drop back to an earlier scag:c (relapse) before starting a.gain. An essential assumption is that counselling interventions need to be selected to meet the needs and motivation of the particular stage clients are in. Thus, for example, it makes no sense to talk to a client who is not ready to change (precontcmplativc) about change strategies, but this tallc ,vould be wholl)• appropriate for a diem who is preparing for change. A client may be at different stages of change for different problems. For example, a client may be precomemplative (not interested in changing) rei;prding his drinking:, but ready to cake action with respect to his foiling marriage. Accordingly, discussing strategies for cuttingdO\\•n his drinking is likeJy to meet with failure; hO\\revcr, exploring: strategics to improve his marriage is likely to elicit a positive response. P'recontemplative Stage: " I Don't Have a Problem." Clients at this stage have no intention of changing. These clients do not pe.rccivc themselves as having a problem, despite the fact chat their behaviour is problematic for themsc.lvcs or others in their lives. These clients are not thinking about change, and they may rationnli.!e their problems. minimi.!e the consequences of their action~ or blame others. For these clients, empathic and sensitive listening chat encourages them to examine their situation and its consequences can be very heJpful. Counsellors can provide information, offer feedback, or encourage reflection with questions such as "ls what you're doing now working to mttt your needs!" Obviously, for clients to change, they Contemplati\le Fl • Actian Figure 7 2 204 Chap1er 7 The Stages of Change must move beyond the pr«ontcmplative stage. Unforrunatdy, many people, including some counsellors, believe that confrontation is the remWy for denia.L Denial is a defence mechanism that enables people to cope, perhaps by protecting themsclves from the risks of change. As a result, confrontation threatens this protection and it often rri~ers further and deeper resistance. OiClemcnte and Vclasquez (2002) observe that "Sometimes the reluctant dient will progress rapidly once he or she ve.rbnJi.!es the reluctance, fttls listened to, and begins to feel the tension between the reluctance to chani;e and the possibility of a different future" (p. 205). DiClemente and VaJasque! (2002) offer this perspective: Clinki::uu o(ten belie-\'e th::u rnore edueat.On. n\Ore intense treatment. or more confron.t:ltion will ne«~nl)' produce more chan~'C'. Nowhere is this less true th::m with precontempl:1t·orS. More inteiuit)' will o(ten produce fewer resu!u with this Stroup. (p. 2C6) Contemplative Stage: "Maybe I Should Do Something About It." A, the contemplative stage, dients know they have a problem and are thinking about change, but they have not developed a plan or made a commitment to take action. Contemplative clients may be ambivalent and may vacillate between wanting to alter their lives and resisting any shifts in their behaviour or lifost)•le. At this sroi;e, clients ma)' be open to new information as they self-assess their problems and the advanmi;es and disadvantages of change. Ex:1rnp1e: A~nes has been in an 2busive rel:1tionship for )~rS. She wishes th:u she could !e::n,e 2nd s12rt O\'er. In f::.et, she h:u !e(1 her husband twice in the past, but C.l.ch time she h:u returned " '1th in:. (ew wttks. Contemplative sroi;e clients like Agnes are "burnt out" from previous unsuccessful attempts at change. They are often in a state of crisis with considerable associated stress. Although they desire change, they doubt it will happen, and they believe that if change is to occur, it will be beyond their control. They aJso lack self-esteem and believe that they do not have the skill, capacity, or energy to change. Ex:1mp1e: Peter (.S5) ~s ~n 1.memplO)~ lor alu\OSt t'Yi'O )'e:lrS. but he h:lS nOI looked (or 2 ,ob in months. He 52yS. "l1lt-re·s no work out there. Besides. who is it0111K 10 hire 2 nun o( rny a~?" Seligman's (1975) concept of learned helplessness is a useful perspective for understanding these clients. Ptt>ple with learned hcJplessncss come to believe that their actions do not mane.r; as a result, they are unlikely to extend any effort to change since they believe that thq• have no control over their lives and that what happens to them is a result of chance. They believe in a "luck ethic" rathe.r than a "work ethic." Their beliefs are reflected in srotements such as the following: ■ "You have to be in the right place at the riWlt time to succeed." ■ "ff I'm successful, it's because the task ,.,,.,..s C3sy." ■ "It doesn't maner if I work hard." ■ "There's nothing I can do about it." The key to working with people with learned helplessness-indeed, with most clients at the contemplation stage-is to assist them "in thinking through the risks of the behaviour and potentia1 benefits of change and to instill hope that change is possible" (DiClemente & Velasquez, 2002, p. 209). Many people with low self-esteem and lcarned helplessness are in fact quite capable; it is the way they think and feel about themselves that is problematic. Consequently, it is important that counscllors look for ways to counter the client's self-deprecating remarks (e.g., encourai;e clients to sec the.ir past failures as deficits in the plan, not deficits in them). As well, counsellors can encourage clients to sec clements of success in previous efforts (e.g., P3rtiaJ gooJ achievement, Supporting Empowerment and Change 205 lessening of problem severity, and short-term achievement). Cognitive behavioural techniques, discussed later in this chapter, have also proven to be effective. Confrontation should be used cautiously. As a rule, confrontation is most effective when it is invited in the context of a collaborative relationship-in other words, when it is invited. Then, it may be useful as a way to help clients understand incongruities between what they believe and the way they act, and rccogni:e self-defeating ways of thinking and behaving, behaviour that is harmful to sclf or other~ blind spots, blam.ing behaviours, and communication prob lems. As wcJI, confrontation can aJso target unrecognized or discounted strengths. Preparation Stage: " I'm Going to Do It Next Week." \Vhen clients rcuh this third phase, they have made a decision to chani;c and motivating them is no loni;cr the principal task; however, counsellors neo:I to sustain the energy for chani;c through support, encouragement, and empathic caring. The principaJ msk for the counsellor is to assist the client to dcvcJop concrete goals and action plan strategics. \Vithout concrete, system.atic plans, change efforts can be quickly frustrated and abandoned like soon-fo~ncn New Year's resolutions. The essence of good planning consists of Setting concrete goals, identifying and evaluating alternative W'tl)'S of reaching goals, selecting an action plan, and anticipating potential o bstacles. For clients with learned helplessness, Setting smaJI, achievable goals is crucial for establishing and maintaining a climate of success and hope. Example: Iris. a 't·OUni siniJe parent. is excited about the po$$ibilit)' o( returnin& t'O school. She sees a sc.hool counsellor for assistance with enrollment in the hiah schoors speeial proal"3m for teen 1noms,. but she has not 't~ considered issues like d:t)'C:!Fe. Using a strengths approoch, counsellors can assist preparation stage clients to draw from their past experiences (proven success strategics and lessons learned). As well, clients can learn about strategies that h.nve ,vorked for others. FinaJly, it is very important to conch these clients to anticipate potentiaJ obstacles and to plan strategics for addressing them, including the emotional stress of the ch.nnge process. Action Stage: " I'm Changing." At this stage, clients are ac.tiveJ,., involved in the change process. They arc working on the goals and implementing the plans developed in the prcP3ration stage. DiClemente and Velasquc! (2002) offer this perspective on counsellor srrategies for this scagc: Cl1ent'S in action ,nay still h::n,e some oonfhctinK (eelin~s about the tha.n~-e. They ma,., 1niss their old l1festyLe in s<.une w:iys 21nd be struj$1ina t'O llt int'O this new behaviour. Ca.re(ul listeniO¥ 21nd 21mrmina clients t~1 they 21re doiO¥ the thin¥ are important in this sta~-e. It is also important to c.hec.k with tilt c.lient to see if he or she has d1SCO\~red p::aru of the tha.n~-e plan th3t need revision. (p. 212) ""'t When clients encounter anticipated obstacles, counsellors can re.mind them of previously developed contingency plans. If there are unanticiP3ted obstacles, counsellors can assist with interventions to support clients as they deal with these potential setbacks. Maintenance Stage: l'l've Done It. I Need to Keep Doing It." ln the final stage, the challeni;c for the client is to maintain the changes that have been made and to deaJ with reJapses, which may occur for a number of reasons (e.g., unexpected tempta.tion, personal stres~ triggers, letting down one's guard, and sabotage by others who are threatened by the chang,c). Counsellors can heJp clients accept that relapses, while undesired, are pan of the change proces~ and they can hclp them to reframc the relapse as an opportunity for better success ne>..'t time. For example, they can heJp them develop new or rc,.•ised strategies for dealing with stress points or triggers. Table 7.3 oudines the stages of change. 206 Chap1er 7 TABLE 7 .3 The Stages of Change Staao/C4al PfecMemptatfwe Slage Clients with no desire or intent.ion of d'langi~ • Counselling goal: JllCfease awarell6$$ of neoo for change. contemplative Stage Clients who afe lhinkiog abOut d'lange • Counselling goal: Resolve ambivateoce w engage in the change f)(OCess. Strateo Choices • Emptoy empathy and Olhet active listaning skits. • Provide information and feedbaek (if invited). • E~age dients to seek S'lklrmation and feedbaek frOO'l others. • Help clie-nts beCOme aware of attractive alternatives. • use lhOught-proYOking questions. • Avdd dllective and confrontational techniciues. • use films, brochures, bOOkS. and self-assessment questior\nakes as tOCiS to increase client insight. • With irwOluntary clients, extilore feeli~ and concems openly, self<tisctose your own feelW'lgs aoout being bOOCI, give clients choices, involve them in decision makl~, and encourage client-initiated goats. • Support "change talk: • Discuss risks and beoofits of change. but avoid argui~ in favou( ot change. • Help clie-nts uOderStand and manage self-deprecating remarks (e.g., reframe past failutes as learni~ ex.pel'ieoces). • Identify elements of success in p(evious d'lange efforts.. • Uptore pmvious relapses emphasizing failure ot ~ns. not failure of dients. • use support groups. • Convey hope and belief in the dient's capacity for success. Preparation State • Setgpats. Clients who am committed to change • Counselling goal: Develop C011ctete strategies lot action. • Plan systematic action. • Assemble/mobilize tesoutces to support d'lange. • Make contingency plans (anUdpate obsiacies). Action Stage Active change effort • Counselling goats: Implement change at'ld • Reward (p,aise, sup(X)rl, and ackno-ldedg,e) change efforts. • Assist client to antidpate and manage JX)tent.ial obStades. sustain momentum. Maintenance Stage Sustain cha~ • Counselling goal: Sustain change. • Assist client to deal with periodic ObStades or (elapses. COGNITIVE BEHAVIOURAL COUNSELLING "l know rhar you believe )'OU understand what )'OU think 1 said, bw l 1m nor sure ,·ou realit;e that whar you heard is nm what l meant." - Robert McClosk~ Thouahts nre the birthplnce of emotions, sclf-cstttm, nnd behaviour. Positive (helpful) thinlcina creates an "I can do it" attitude, which IC3ds to a arenter willinancss to embrace new chaJlengcs and to rake appropriate rislc.s. Neg3tive o r unhelpful thinlcina panern~ on the other hand, Cre3te distress and interfere with one's ove.rnJI sense of weJL-being. Cognitive behavioural tedmiqucs focus on increasina helpful thinking and on changina problemntic behavioural patterns. Cognitive behavioural coun....elling (therapy), or CBT, hns been empirically tested in hundreds of studies. T he results have demonstrated its usefulness for a wide range of sociaJ, emotionaJ, and mental health p roblems such ns mood disorders (depression and bipolar disorder), anxiety disorders (obsessivc<ompulsive disorder and post.-traumatic stress disorder), substance use problem~ enting disorders. g:imbling problem~ anger, personality disorders, srres~ unresolved afief, 3S weJI as medical problems such ns hypertension and low b3Clc pain (Buder, Chapman, Fauman, & Bcc:lc, 2006; Chambless & Ollcndkk, 2001; ond Beck & Beck, 2011). Supporting Empowerment and Change c:ogniti¥t beha-tioura.l c:ounselli,_ (therap7'): Acoonsellint appiod t!l31 assists dients to ii.ntify-.:J mdfy unhelpW t!linling and pdlt!m.a~it bebtiour. 207 Figure 7.3 ABC Model Amc.ric:.m psychiatrist Aaron T. Beck (192 1- ) is considered the founder o f CBT. \Vills (2008) identifies the ccm:raJ assumptions behind Beck's npproach: ''At rhc heart o f the CBT paradigm the.re is a very simp le yet effective working modcJ: the way people think a bout their situations influences the W'll)' they foci and behave" (p. 5). CBT docs not focu s on finding the root causes of problems; rather, it emphasizes problem solving to hcJp clients find new W'll)'S o f thinking a nd responding. Counsellors can q uickly teach clients the basic ideas behind CBT and, in the pro-ccs.s, hcJp chem lenm a bout how unhelpful thinking impacts behaviour and emotions, and how behaviour and thinking that is lenmcd can be unlearned. The k~• to changing problematic behaviour o r emotions is to explore and modify d istorted thinking:, and then to learn and p ractis e new responses. CBT focuses on understanding current thinking(thc prescnt)and problem solving todcvdop new behavio urs. Marie and Aiesh:3 3re pa$$(":i1~-t-rS on the same airline fh.i1t. t-.-b ne ii consumed by her le::tr th3t the pfane will eras.I,. thin.kin¥. "This is 3 d3n~rous situ3tion. \\1h3t if the en&ines fam A nd 2ir turbulenee will surely te3r the pl:me :lp3rt." Aiesh3 boards the pfa.ne 2nd qukkl)' immerses herself in a book with no intrusiv~ thou$:hts o( <lrin~ Ellis (2004) developed the famous ABC model (Fiaurc 7.3) as a tool for u nderstanding why Marie and A icsha experience the flight so differently. ln the model: ■ A represents an activatina cvem (in this case, the airplane flight). ■ B refers to the beliefs that are triggered by the activating event, A . ■ C is the consequent emotion or behavioural reaction. C lear!)•, Marie's beliefs about fl)•ing arc markedly different from Aicsha's. Cogni.tive behavioural counselling would concentrate on how Marie can modify her thinking about flying, which is based on erroneous and distorted beliefs about its d angers. Moreover, the skills Marie learns will help her adapt to future problems she may encounter in other areas o f her life. SUCCESS TIP If ooe's thinking changes, behaviour and emotions a~ d'lange. If one's behaviou( changes, thinking and emotions also change. If one's emol:ioos change, thiMing and behavi::lut also d'lange. See f igu(e 7.4. Cognitive behavioural counselling uses a combination of methods to help clients learn more effective copina strateaics. indud ina 208 ■ hclpina diems recogni:e thinking patterns, in particular those chat are unhelpful; ■ hclpina d iems modify thinking patterns; and ■ assistina clients to develop action plans and strategics (modifyina behavio ur). Chap1er 7 Figure 7.4 Interd ependence of Feelings, Behaviour, and Thinking Helping Clients Recognize Thinking Patterns "\Whether )'OU rhink you can or think )'OU can 1c- Jou 1re right." - Henr)' Ford (pubi,c dom3in) Frttauend)•, behaviour persists because clients are locked into unhelpful wnys of thinking about their problems or solutions. Thinking pnne.rns that drive fee.lings and beh.nviours are frequently outside a client's awareness. and theyemerJ;e from schema or core bdiefs. Schema are the "basic beliefs individuals use toorgnni:e the.ir view of the self, the world, and the future" (Sperry, 2006, p. 22). Significantly, a person's thinking ma)' be driven by schema, assumptions and errors in thinking that are not fact based. (ndividuals who are potentially very capable may act as if they were incapable because of faulty beliefs. Automatic thous;:ht.'i occur spontaneously and are often outside of one's awareness. Usually, they repeat weJL-establishcd themes such as. "J ,von't succeed," and this repeti• tion strengthens J)O\\'er of the belief. Such unheJpful or maladaptive thoughts can lead to distress., innction, low self-esteem, depression, and reluctance to engage in healthy risk-taking, such as initiating social relationships. Cognitive beh.nviouraJ counselling helps clients recogni!e automatic thoughts, identify "errors in thinking," and explore how thouRJus hinder them from re3ching gon.Js. Table 7.4 outlines some common heJpful and unhelpful core beliefs clients might have. Once clients become aware that an automatic thought is about to h.nppen, they can practise replacing that thought with an alternative. This interrupts the repetitive cycle of problematic behaviour. On a broader level, clients IC3rn to understand and modify schemas that drive dysfunctional bchav• iour and painful emotions. TABLE 7.4 automatic thoughts: T~ s t!l31 CICtW spoo1a118lUst, and areob outSd' «• 's Nareness Helpful and Unhelpful Core Beliefs Unbtlpful Helpf\11 • I am unlovable. • I am a pe-rson wOr'thy of IOve and r ~cl. • I can ask for and offe-r assista~. • I am resJX)nsible f0t my own haJ)piness . • To seek helJ) is a sign of weakt'less. • Without a (elationShiJ) partnier, I am OOlhiog, • I wi• fail. I am helptess. • I have to be IOved by everyooe. • I must be J)erlect in ever-ythiog that I dO. I musa be soon by otners as the best • I am special; I can lake advantage of J)OOJ)le. • I will do my best, savour my success, and le-aro from my mistakes. • I accepr that not everyone wi\J IOYe me. • I accepr my limitations: they dO not diminish me. • My rights as well as the rights ot Others need to be (espected. Supporting Empowerment and Change 209 Example: A new social setting t,iggers Troy' s automatic thoug,,ts: "'I don't belong. I won't fit in ... These thoughts originate from hisc0re belief, " I am unlovable." Hi$ automatic thougtits and his core beliefs aeate anx.iety and fear. His strategy is to use drugs to curb his anxiety, which in tum lead to the new belief that he won' t be able to cope unless he uses drugs. Unhelpful Thinking Patterns It is the mark of an educated mind robe able ro enrerrain a thought wirhour accepting it. - Aristotle (publie domain) Most of the rime, our thoughts are outside of our awareness. Cognitive behavioural counselling is designed to help clients develop conscious awareness of the.ir thinking p3ttern~ then criticall,.•examine the.ir validity 3nd usefulness. Subsequently, clients Je3rn strategies for interrupting unhelpful thinking, while increasing helpful thinking and behaviour. Thinking errors can easily lead to faulty ime.rpretations and maladaptive behaviour. Other thinking patterns. while they ma)' be 3ccurate, 3re simply not helpful. In 3 cfossic early work, Beck (1976) proposed the notion of "Cognitive Triad" (alc3 Beck's Triad) consisting of views about seJf, the wo rld, and the future to explain depression: Self: "I am worthless. .. (or ui,worth)·, useLess,. and de:f"tdent) \Vor)d; "The world ii unsa(e.•· (failure is imminent) Futun:-: "TI,e future is arim.·• (problems will per-Sise inde:l"mitel)•) .-thelpful tt,,intd,_ patterns: Fatty m:so11i11g caused bydist«tic., ifltOfflplete • at,sis. ~ ity. ripfty, and self-defeating tllougllt. The assumption is th3t the negative tri3d sustains the client's depression; therefore, CBT focuses on helping clients to ch3ni;e their maladaptive and unhelpful inter-prcta.. tions of self, the world , and the future. It is important to understand the major unhelpful chinking patterns, such as e.mo.tional decision m3king. distortion, selective 3ftention, worry, m3gnif,c3tion/minimiz3,. tion, mind reading, ~rfcctionism, and self-defeating thought. Emotional Decision Making In a Mr. Spock (Swr Trek) world , nil decisions would be b3sed on totaJI)• objective, ration31 nn3lysis of the facts, 3nd emotions would pin)' no p3rt. In eve.ryday life, it's not so simple. Emotions can 3nd often should pin)• a p3rt in most decisions. Emotional decision m3king is problematic when it results in negative o utcomes. Or, emotions might strongly support one conclusion despite evidence to the contrary. For ex3.mple, peo ple might feel inadequate and unlovable while igno ring the fact that they have nc:hieved succes~ and they h3ve many friends. Distortion Disto rtion results from misinterpretations, faulty assumptions, o r c u),. tural biases. An extreme form of this is delusio03l thinking, which involves holding beliefs th3t have no b3sis in reality. Here are some common examples: ))}) BRAIN BYTE I ■ Misre3ding 3nother person's silence as lack of interest (mind reading). ■ Assuming th3t othe.rs should know wh3t we want, neo:J, or feel without be.ing told. Tl' ':: I ,[1, I ~1 ",1: I Recent brain research (Naqvi. Shiv. & Bechara, 2006) is mapping hO'N different parts of the brain (some rational and some emolional) are ac1ivat&e1 during decision making. In some circumstances. the Memoriooal btain" hijacks 210 Chap1er 7 rationality and people make (and sometimes repeat) decisions and actions that are not in lheir best interest. Moreover, this can continue despite full awareness of lhe continuing er-r0c. ■ lnter-preting lade of eye contact as a sign of disrespect or lying when, in fact, the other ~rson is from 3 culture where dir«t e)•e contact is discouraged. ■ Arriving 3t false conclusions such as bclie-.•ing (after hurting a friend's feelings) th:.n "( 3m a horrible ~rson', and she'll never spe3k to me 3gnin." Selective Attention Selective 3ttention errors arise from a failure to look 3t all 3Spects of 3 problem or siruation. For e.x3mple, people with low self-esteem m3y owrlook evidence of their successes and strengths by looking only at their failures or limitations. Or, people ma)' be egocentric and not consider other people's fecJings or ideas. As a result, they may be seen by others as insensitive. Selective 3ttention ma)' involve 3ny of the following: ■ Listening onl)• to information and facts that support )'OUr point of view. ■ Having 3 selective memory th3t overlooks or distorts important information. ■ Losing focus on wh3t a person is S3)'ing (beatuse of factors such as boredom, pr«>ecupntion with personal issues, or setting distractions). ■ Focusing only on the present without considering the long-term impliai.tions. ■ Oispl3ying egocentric thinking that does not consider other points of view or the impact of one's behaviour on others. Worry or Rumination Excessive worry interferes with problem solving, 3nd it m3y lead to feelings of an.xiet)•, depression, helplessness, and pessimism. Unhelpful worrying might involve dwelling on P3St events or failures, or it m3y focus on events th:.n clients fc3r might h3ppcn in the future. Magnification/Minimization These types of thinking p3nerns distort faces b)• extreme and exaggerated thinking. Here are some examples: ■ Splitting (all or nothina}-the tendency co interpret people, thing5i, 3nd experiences as either totn11y good or totally b3d, with no sh3des of grey. ■ Overi;:eneralirntion-drawing conclusions from a single fact or event. For example, after be.ing rurncd down for a job, 3 man concludes th3t he is wonhless and no one will e-.'e.r hire him. ■ Discounting-rejecting compliments by refusing to believe that the other person is telling the truth. ■ "Catastrophizing"- mngnifying small mistakes into disaste.rs or tot3l failures. Mind Reading This common error 3rises when people assume they know how others 3re thinking or feeling. Mind reading frequently arises from personal insecurities. For example, low self-esteem m3y result in interpreting the actions of others as rejection. Perfectionism HC3lthy individuals set re3Jistic, challenging, and achievable goals. They 3re motivated to do their best, 3nd they maintain high standards for themselves. Conve.rseJy, people who 3re perfectionists set unrealistic standards of 3chie-.•ement with 3n expectation of constant success. Perfectionist individuals are under constant srress ai.used by the 3n-Xiet)' to perform, or the renli:z:3tion that they have failed to reach or sustain the.ir unrealistic expectations of seJf. lrration.nJ beliefs that arise. from perfectionism include the following: ■ I can't make a mistake. ■ I nm 3 failure if ( 3m less than perfect. ■ I have no value unless ( 3chieve the very best. Supporting Empowerment and Change 211 setf-ctekating thoughts: lnne, liilog• al critic-M MSs.JteS. MOANS: Matf'C¥1orthe'Mlfdi must. ought. alwa,s. neve,, and should, Mflich . I irrati>nal or self-defeating ~gilt. ■ If I can't be perfect, then J might as wcJI give up. ■ I have to be the best. To win is the only option. ■ I'm probably going to fail anyway, so wh't' try? The personal cost of perfectionism can include chronic pessimism, lo"' self-esteem, lack of confidence, depression, anxiety, and obsessive concern with order and routine. Pc.rfectionists frequently use the words must, only, always, nevc.r, and should (the MOANS acronym introduced in Chapter .S). Self-defeating thoug.hts are irrational (unhelpful) idC3s about one's own weaknesses. Albe.rt Ellis (1962, t984,t993a,1993b, and 2004) has wrinen a grc3t deal about "'hat he defined as irrational thinking and its impact on emotions and behaviour. Ellis argues that people's belief S)'Stcms influence how they respond to and understand problems and events. \\:fhm the.ir beliefs are irrational and characterized by an unrealistic shor.dd, they are lilcet,., to experience emotional anxiety or disturbance. This thinking is often accomi:mnied by sdf-dcprccating internal dialogue: "I'm no good," "Everyone must think I'm an idi()(," and "No one likes me." Ellis believed that irrational beliefs come from sdf-imposed rigid dc.mands or shotdds, such as") have to be perfect" and "Everyone has to love me." Golden and Lesh (1997) use the acronym MOANS for five ,vords that often signal ncgntive self-talk: muu, ot1gJu, alwa:,s, netff, and should. ■ I musr succeed or 1 am worthless. ■ I oughr to be able to do it. ■ I afuu,s sere"' up. ■ I "'ill net'l:'r be able to get a job. ■ I sho1dd feel different!,.,. ■ Everything mua be perfect. SUCCESS TIP Chen.ts will profit from considering what triggel'S self~efeating thoughts. Fof U'IOse with addiction problems, triggerS afe a pfelude to subStance abuse. By suceesshJly eounte-ring cogndive triggerS such as Mlt'le only way I can telax is to use drugs,· subSlaoce abuse and relapse can be preve-ntoo. Helping Clients Increase Helpful Thinking \Vhcn people learn to P3't' attention to their thoughts, they can begin to identify those thoughts and pancrns that are unhelpful and then take nction to change their thinking. Thinking patterns arc often well established and firmly anchored by core beliefs, so considerable practice mn't' be necessary to ~ffect change. An important first step is to hdp clients become a,.,,.-nrc of their automatic thoughts. Counsellors can ask questions such as: ■ What were (arc) you thinking! ■ How strong was this thought! ■ How much (1- J0)do )'OU bdievc it to be true? ■ How does this thought/imngc link to fcdings and behaviour? ■ HcJpfuH Not HclpfuH If clients have trouble identifying thought5i, counseJlorscan ask them to visualize and "replay" the problem situation. Or clients can do homework to monitor their thoughts 2 12 Chap1er 7 and rc3ctions. (The.re arc numerous online sites that offer thought monitoring form~ example: https:.//www.psychologytools.com 3nd search for the heading "CBT tools.") SUCCESS TIP Yv'hen clients de-scribe ptoblem situations or em::,t.ions, lhe quest.ion "What we-re you lhink• ing?" may help lhem to discover- unhelpful thinking pattei-ns that have contributed to the problem Of 1he outcome. Thought-Stopping/Diversion Negative self-mlk can easily b«ome 3n 3utomatic response. Thought-stoppini is 3 technique for interrupting repetitive unhelpful thinking that impedes action and confide nce with positive, empowering substirutions. After identifying negative self-talk, clients nttd to develop positive st3tc.ments to replace intrusive negative thoughts. Herc 3re some examples: Unhelpful Thou~ht: "I'm so stressed about aoing for the job intc.rview, I'm aoing to p3nic 3nd make a complete fool of myself." thought-stopping: A tedriaique I• brea._, tile pattern of «¢itne self-defeating llioug)I patter-ts. khniquesilclude tkluglll replacement. yea.g •stop• il)'Cllr mind un~il die undesiied t._.t disappears. wpping an ebstic b.t on the wrist toshil t!lilling. and acthily diwrsion. Thought Substitution: "I'm qualified for the job. I can control my 3nxiety through deep breathing." Unhelpful Thouiht: "(f I don't do everything well, then I am a failure." Thought Substitution: "I don't have to be perfect. I'm hum3n and sometimes I'll miss the mark." (see Ba:k & Beck, 201 I, p. 213 for more examples) Clients might find it useful to think the word STOP to intc.rrupt unhelpful thinking, then immediatcl)• use thought substitution to introduce helpful thinking. A lternatively, other cues can be used as a thought.-stopper. One d iem carried a p icrurc of hc.r son as a baby. This helped hc.r interrupt negative thinking 3bout him that w3s trigi;er~ b)• his current drug abuse. Anothc.r im3gincd 3n 3.XC as 3 cue to substitute a new helpful thought. Figure 7.5 illustrates the sequence. Thoughr.-stopping works, but it requires practice. Negative self-talk P3ttc.r ns may represent years of learning th3t must be "unlearned," and the best wa't' to do this is to IC3rn new ways o f thinking. Intrusive thoughts c3n 3Jso be countered by diverting attention with activity, music, physicaJ activ ity, or mcdit3tion. Mindfulness ln recent years, many cognitive bdi.avioural counsellors h3ve intc• grat~ mindfulness techniques in their ,vo rk. Mindfulness is simpl)• defined 3S "3warcness of present expc.rience with accept3nce" (Siegel, 2010, p. 27). W ith mindfulncs~ mindfulness: FOQlsing on momeaM~ mcaent ~noes wilhlul judgment Unbelpful Thoui,-t Thought-Stopper New helpful Thought Figure 7.5 Thought-Slopping Sequence Supporting Empowerment and Change 2 13 "the intention is for parricip3ms not only to bring their 3w3reness to prcscnt•momcm expe.ricnce but aJso to become 3w3re of the tendency of the mind to w3nde.r 3W3\' from the moment and to IC3rn to gcndy guide it b3c.k without judgment" (Bowen, Chawla, & M3rlatt, 2011, p. 34). 1t helps people to disengage from worry about past, current, and future problems that m3y not occur. Mindfulness is not difficult, but practice is essential. Mindfulness has shown to be an effective adjunct to cognitive beh3viouraJ therapy in the treatment of a range of disorders, including depression, obsessive-compulsive disorder, posvtraum3tic stress disorder, and others (Firouzabadi & Sh3reh, 2009; Godfrin & van Heeringen, 2010; and Vujanovic, Niles, Pietrefesa, Sc.hmenz, & Potter, 201 I). SUCCESS TIP "MiOO lhe Gap·- TM time gap between lhinking and action provides an opportunity to make new chc::ices. In the abSence of effort and attention, lhe same unhelpful patterns of thinking aoo behaviour 'liill be (epeated aoo strengthened. Mindfulness slows dOwn experiences and giving people an opportun.ty to identify thinking patterns. SubSeq~ntJy, they can practise helpful ways of thinking and responding, Practice then c,eates and sarengthens new netXal pathways. Evidence Finding Beliefs ma'>' arise from foulty assumptions 3ncJ ocher errors in thinking, or they m3y be based on emotions, not foct. UnchnJlenged beliefs can limit new learning, 3nd they may lcccp clients locked in old, ineffective W'a)'S of acting or thinking. Evidence finding is 3 CBT technique th3t teu.hcs clients to be their own "de,.•. il's 3d\'OC3tc" through the use of disputing questions to test the validity of their bclicfs. As well, counsdlors c3n also encourage clients to seek out information 3nd data by suggesting they talk to others to expand their perspective. Counscllors can 3Jso directly challenge beliefs with facts., examples, or they can use brainstorming t«hniques to generate alternate idC3s. Guided discovery (Neenan & Dryden, 2006) involves asking qucs..tions to help clients consider perspectives that are currcnth• outside their 3w3reness. Herc are some counsellor responses that will stimulnte evidence finding: ■ How much of what you believe is based on how you foci 3nd how much is based on fact? ■ How do )'OU know chis to be true? Do you have facts or 3re )'OU assuming? ■ Let's try to explore evidence that this may not be true. Play devil's advocate. ■ What 3rc some other w3ys of thinking about '>'our situation? ■ If 3 friend thought this w3y about his situation, whnt would you SU)' to him? be- SUCCESS TIP Oo,,1 retr-am.ing: Atechnique ror lllelping dients look at things dittetealty by suggev.ing altematite inteqntatic.s, perspe«iws.• new ~ s . Re.tr.es should Pl!S:ftl loffeal Hd p)Siti...e alle.m,a.;iw..-ays ot llin-,_ 2 14 e,,~hing you lhink (Thomas l<ida, 2006). Reframing Reframin,: is 3 counselling skill thnt hclps clients shift or modify their thinIcing by suggesting altt~rnative interpretations or new mC3ning.s. It empowers clients by focusing on solutions and redefining negatives 3S opportunities or challenges. Client stubbornness might be r~framed as independence or greediness as ambition. Chap1er 7 > : •. Neuroplasticity refers to the brain's ability to wow and teat- ra* neut'al pathways based on MN ex.perien::::es 0c leacning. Cor'Wersely, ne1Xal pattrways that are not used will be pruned. NetXal groMh can be JX)Sitive Or' negative, bul in the at>sence of awareness, effort. 0r new ext,erience the br'ain tenets to ad on autopilot, repeating and reinforcing established patterns. MiOClfulness creates awareooss of lhOughts and feelings as well as the ability to change mental focus with the goal of influencing bt'3in wowth in a positive way. Although niOOfutness can stimulate re-la.xation, that is n01 its goal. MindhAness involves a 'Mlde range of strategies lhat might invOlve al five senses. It helps people develop self-awareness and acceptance of their moment-tCHnOment lhOughts and leeli~ b-f paying attention to one ex.pe-rience at a time. Mindfulness can focus on sounds, thou~ts. smets, taste, visual hnages, and bOClily sensation uslng techniques such as the foUOwing; • Mindfully attending to a sensary ex.perience. such as eati~ a banana. • focusing on breathing; paying attention to the Row of Ulougl\t<. • Simply paying attention to any daily activity such as washi~ the dishes.. • Perl0tmi~ 100 "bOdy scan,· which helps people beCOme aware of physical sensations that often precede 0r accompany habitual msponses. The ptocess invclveS systamatically locus1ngattention on ead'I part of 100 bOdy, including breathmg. (See Bowen, Chawla, & Matlall, 201 I, p. 42, 0< Siegel, 2010, p. 72 f0< detailed k\stJuction<). Ex3mp1e: Out 3~ 11, is pfarina b::a:Seball b)• himsel(. He throws the bdill inm the 2ir 3nd exclaims. "I'm the are3test b3uer in the Yi'Orld.'' He swin{tS 2nd misses. Once ~in. he tosses the ball into the 3ir and 53.ys. "I'm the are3test OOuer in the world." He SYi•in,a:<i 2nd misses. A third tune he thrOYi'S the ball into the air prodaimin,a ernphatblly. "l'tn the are::atest pitd,er m the world." (See Table 7.5 for 3dditional ex3mplcs.) Before presenting rcframcd ide3s, counsellors should use active listening skills to fully understand the client's current pe.rspectivc. As well, emP3thy is crucial~he.rwise, clients may conclude that their feelings are being discounted or trivi31i!cd. SUCCESS TIP flve ways to refr'ame: • Tum p(Oblem statements into gOalS. • Help c~nts accepa thei( emotions and reactions as ·n0tmal.• • LOok at pe(ceived weaktlesses as strengths. • See ;,trtggers· as an opportunity to ac1 differently. • Exi:,or-e the posdive outcomes of advet'Sity. Rcframing should not be confused with p latitudes, such 3S "It's 3hvays darkest just before dawn," which arc typically not very supportive or helpful. An ex3mple of a welL-meaning but misguided re.frame thnt people give in times of grief over the loss of 3 child is "You're )'OUnJr-)'OU C3n hnve more children." A response such 3S this ignores Exi:,oring the past may help clients develOp some insight into theif behaviour and emotions. However. it may feinbce neural pathways tr.at have sustained unhelpful think.I~ and actions. Consequently, it is rn'lportant to use technklues such as lhOu.ght-stopping, behaviour-al rehearsal, and the Mmiracle question,· beeause these actions ""ill create new neural connections that will support goats and changes that clients largel Supporting Empowerment and Change 215 TABLE 7.5 Reframi ng °' Client's Petspeethre Statement This counseling is a waste of lime. Reframlna l ead Sounds as if you've done some tt'lrtking abOut how out work coukS be m0te relevant to you. I 000·1 fit in. I come from a differ'en1 cult...-e Of eour'se. Some people have not had ex.pel'ience with your culture, and they may be frighte-ned. Per'haps you couk1 IOOk at tt'lis in a different w.ry. Your experiences migt\t alSO be fascinats"lg lot people wt'lo have not lived outsi:1e lhe country. They nigl\l wetcome your fresh <leas. and my ideas and values must seem strange. I'm very Shy. When I first join a group, I usually don1 say anythi~. F'Ot tne firSt time in 20 years, I'm 'liitnout a job. Wheneve-r I am late fot curlew, my mother waits up fot me and immediately starts scre.ami~ at me. My life is a mess. rve lived on the street lot the last six m::>nths. You llk.e to be patient until you have a sense of wf'lat's happens"lg. People who are implJSive are WOr"Jd~ to develOp this skill. You also soom to want to devt'ICII') altemative-s, such as being tnOr'e expressive in 100 beginning, Obviously, thi:S is devastating, At the same time, I wonder if this migt\t also be an op(X)rlunity fOr' you to try something different I'm curious aOOUt why she might do this. Per'haps She haS ttouble telling you hOw scared She is that something may have happened to you. It might seem strange, but hef anger could be het w.ry of saying hOw much She IOves you. Sounds like you've had kl sut'Vive under conditions that might have defeated m:>St people. How did you do that? the person's grief by offering well-meaning but simplistic and ineffective advice. Rcfram,. ing should not trivialize complex proble ms with pat answers; rathe r, it should offer a reasonable and usab le altcrnntivc frame of reference that challcng,es clients to brc~llc out o f unhelpful Wa)'S of thinking about their problems. Tim ing is important. Even though it may be obvious that a client's thin king is d istorted, it may be wise to hold back on rcframing until the client's problem is fully explored. Moreover, as p reviously SUficsted, it is important chat the client's feelings be acknowlcdg,ed through empathy. Exploration and empathy ensure chat the cou nscJlo r unde rstands the client's feelings and situ ation, a nd they pro\tidc a basis for the client to consider reframcd ideas ns rc3sonable o r wo rthy of consideration. If counsellors push clie nts too q u ickly, clients ma y feel d cvnJucd and misu nde.rstood, and in response they ma y resist new idcns. Empathy helps counsellors to establish and maintain credibility with their clients. In addition, counsellors ca n use rcframing to invite clients to cake control over feelings and bcha\tiour: ■ C lient might S3Y, " I can't get ori;:anizcd ." Herc, a counsellor can chaJlenge the d iem by proposing that the diem rcframe this state me nt with " I won't let m)•self get organi:ed." ■ C liem m ight sa y, "She makes me feel hopeless.." In response, the co u nsello r can propose that the client rephrase the stateme nt by SU)•ing, "l have decided to feel hopeless." The latter response underscores the client's control over personal fccJ.ings. As part of this wo rk , counsellors can empower their clients by explaining that clients have ownership over their feel ings and that no one can make the m feel a cenain wa)•. Refrnming can ene.rgi:e clients. \\:fhen clients arc locked into one wa)' o f thinking about their problems, their solutions a re lim ited. But when they consider new perspcc~ tivcs., problems that seemed insurmountable can yield new solu tions. Moreover, rcfram,. ing can serve to red irect client anxiety away from self-blam e and onto ocher rational explanations that a re less self-punishing, ln these W'U)'S. effective refrnming e mpowers clie nts to action, problem resolution, and management of debilitating feelings. 2 16 Chap1er 7 ))I) BRAIN BYTE canae1ian neuropsychotogi.st Donald Hebb (public domain; 1949) made the now famous saatetnent, ..neUl'"ons lhat fife together' wire togethef: The meani~ i:s tr.at repetitive actions 0r tnoughts strangthen neural pathways and links. F0r exam- ple, if one experiences anxiety in a social situation. repeated expe(~nces may cause the per'SOO to beCOme stuck in a pattern of social anxiety fueled by unhelpful self-talk. With CBT clients learn to bmak lhis pattern and, in the process, new neural pathways are created and sare~ened. Thete i:S ex~iinental evi::leoce tr.at CBT alte-rs the btain. f0r example, a study by Kumari et al. (20 11) found that lhere are meas.ureat:,e d'langes k'I the brain as an outcome of CST. In particular. the positive symptoms of psychosis, espedatty delusions reduced in severity. As well, afte-r tr'eatment, clients had decreased fear and anger responses. A ,eport ~ Mayat (2004) noted 1r,a1while anUoop,essanl moo;. cation attacks depression by alteri~ the neurotransmitters, cogrilive behatJioural therapy atso cha~ tne brain, but in a diffetent way by d'langing activity io tne ptefront.al cortex., ~ppocampal and dorsal cingulate areas of Iha brain. Anotherstudy by de La~ et al. (2008) using patients with Chfonic fatigue syndrome (CF'S) demonstrated that brain shrink.age (eefebral atrophy) associated with CF'S might be partially mversed ~ CBT. })!} INTERVIEW 7.1 The fOIIOwing interview excerpt illustrates some of the essential strategies of cognitive behaviou1al c-ounselliog. The client, a 40-~-old first-ye.ar university psyt,hology student, has sought help to deal with the fact th.at she has been " overwhelmed and depressed" since returning to school. Counsellor: feelings, thinking. and behaviou( afe all connected. Change one and the other rwo alSO change. In particular', it's critical to explOr'e hoN yout thinking affects yotX feelings and youf behaviou(. Client: I'm at Iha pcint whete. if I don't do something fast. I'm going to lose Iha whde term. I might as well drop out. Analysis: Cognitive behavjoural counsellillg requires a co/Jabotative relaticnSh;p. All jm()Orlanl compofle(lt of this js edUCtJtjng the clier'll oo hOw the process vi'Oflt"S. This also h(!!p 1/'Je client to make her own intervenb'ons when she recogr,Jzes proble.maUc thillking. wm Counsellor: You're leefi~ desperate. AnaJysls: Wirh aR courrsellitlg apptOaeheS, empathyisan im{)Oftant response. Mote than any other skill. it tel/s clknts that they have been heard at'ld that their feelings have been ut1derstootJ. Counsellor: can you remember a time in the last few days when tl'W'.!$8 feeli~ were particular1y strong? What was goi~ AnaJysls: Ellcitiflg and exp/oriflg examples such as this ,:xovides a database for helping this clknt understat'ld hOw her thoughts contribute to her feelings. Signif,cantlY, probe.s to discover lh;nklng ,:,atterttS may reveal "lnner dia.lOfP,Je" (se/1-defeatiflg l/'JOught pattems) ot lmages. lhrough yotX mind at the time just before class? Client: YestQ'day, I was scheduled to make my fll'Sl-ctass pre- ""'"'tion. I was llwlki~1ha1 I was gong IDma1<e a loo ci myself in front of tt'l8 woote CbSS.. Ever,-one etse seems so confident when lhey lalk, bul I - 1 bOOn ;n SCOOOI fat 20years. Counsellor: And that made you feet . . . Client: Stupid and te«ified. I finalty phoned in sick. Counsellor: So, hem we ha\18 an e,ram~ of hOtY vd'lat you W(f'@ lhinki~Ml'm gci~ to make a foot of myselr - influeoe:ed hOw you were feefi~and vd\at you did. Does 1his make sense to you? Let's use the ABCm:xlef to illustrate it. (The COUttSellor uses a /Tip chart, A /acti,ati!lg situationHh,;,,king of mal<iflg the /J(ese,itatio,,, 8 /beJil!f/-·rm !!Pi!'€ to /ool( /il<8 a foci"; and C /conseq""'11 emotionJ-fear. feeling °"""""/med. Counsellor: If you agree. I'd like to ask you to make notes during the next week when you fl"ld yourself feeli~ warse. When this happens, I want you to pay attention to what's gci~ thfough your mind. Analysis: [a,t;er the couttSellot atld the client discuss«/ the essential elements of cognitive behavbutal COUt'ISelliflg. N(YN lfle clknt's example can be used to re;nforce the princl,:,le.s.. Using a flip chart ot dra";ng is very helpful for mar1y clients., particularly lot those who are le.ss comfortable in the verbal moda.lity. Analysis: Homework Is essential to effective cogr,it.lve behavloutal cout'ISelliflg. Here, the homewotk creates an opportut'llty lot the cl'iertt to become mo,e famillar with haw her feelings and behaviour are lnb'mately COt1rJeeted to her lhit'IJdflg. Supporting Empowerment and C hange 2 17 >» INTERVIEW 7 .1 Cognitive Behavioural Techniques <conHn"') In the next session (ex.eefpted late(). the counsellor uses re:framiog and lhOught-stoppi~ as tOOIS to help the client Cha~ he< thinking, Counsellor: YotX jo11na1 is great. You've identified rots of great e.Kamples. Let's try somethi~ different f0t a minute. What if it "-ere possible to look at your leafs differentty? (Ctient nods approval.) counsellor: I think it's natur"al wtle-n we ha\18 a problem to C!Well on au its unpleasant aspects.. 1ktlow lhat I tend to do that uniess I discipline myself n01 to. For example, when you think of how oorvaus you ant you lhink of au tne oogatives, Analysis: The counsellor jntrOduces Ille ,:,ossfb;lfty of ,etrarmng. Analysis: The couflSe/lO('s ShO,t self-disclOSute commuroc.ates Ullderstaridlng at'ld a n()('Jjudgmemal attitude. sud'I as you migtit make a fool of youfself. Or' your mind might go blank vd'lile you're talking. Client: (Laughs.) Ot that I might lhrow up in front of ever)(lne. counsellor: Okay, those are real fears. But b-f considering only your fear'S. you beCOme !bated on the negatives, and you may be overlookl~ some im(X)rtant JX)sitives.. If you can IOOk at it diffe-rently, you might discove( a woole new way of dealing with youf class presentation. Analysis: One teoot of cognitive behavioural couflSe/Jing is that people tend to pay too much attentkJn to the r,egatlve aspects of the;r situations while Ignoring posiUw,s or other explanations. Counsellor: Want to try it? (The c/ief)[ nods.) Okay. lty to identify some positi\ie aspects ot your fear. Analysis: As a rule, 1rs more empowering for clients togerwate their own suggestioos before couttSe/kJrs Introduce their Ideas and suggestiotls. In this way, diems become self-conftootlng and are more likely k> cane up Milfl Ideas that lfley Mill accept as ctedible. Analysis: In this example. the client Is able to getterate a reftame, which lfle couttSellor embe/JisheS. Ill other situatlMs. counsellors might 111tt0duce reframes of their O"M). Client: Wefl. I guess I'm not the onty ooo W'ho is scared of public speaki~ . COunsell01: So. )'OU koow tnat ther·e wil be Other peoJ:le in 100 class who understand ancl will be ChOO'i~ for you to succeed. ClleM: I never thought of that befofe-. He-re•s another- ijea: Because I'm so nel"VOUs. I'm going to make sure th.at I'm mally ptepa(e-d. Counsellor: Great! Do you think it mi.gr.I be possible to look at yo1S fears diffe-rentJy? Consider that it's normal to be ner\'ous. Or go a step further and look at it JX)Sitive-ly. Maybe- there's a part of it that's exciting-kind of like going to a SIC.3ry movie. Analysis: The cout1seltot offers the ct'ient a teframed way of IOOJdng at ttef\,'()U'Sf'leSS. ClleM: I did come baek to school bec.ause I hated my bOring Analysis: The client's response suggests that this notion is jOb. One thing is for SU(e, I'm 001 OOfed. possible. counsellor: So, the more you scare yourSelf, the mom you ge-t your money's worth. (Tfle counseJkJt and the clie.nt laugh.) counsellor: Her-e's an ide-a th.at WOrkS. If you agree, I'd like you to try it o,,,r tne next -k. Eve,y lime you notice yourself starting to get overwhelmed or feeling distressed, in'lagi.ne a stop sign i"I )'OU' mind and immecfiatelysubstitute a healthier though!. 218 Chap1er 7 Analysis: SponttJneous humcur helps tfle client see her protr lemS ltt a lighter way (yet aflOlflet reframe). Analy,is, Anolhe( ,xamp/e ofcounse/6ng l>OrOOwOrk. The CO<Jr>sellor ifltroduces tflOught-stopping-a 1echmQue to help clients COtltrol self-defeating thiflidng (DattlNo &Freeman. 2010). The basic assumption is that ;f self-defe:Jtlng lflOugflts are interrupted, tfley will eventually be replaced by more em()OK-ering, Jmitoo perspect1,es. ~JO INTERVIEW 7 .1 Cognitive Behavioural Techniques (con,;nue) Reflections: ■ How mig,,t you intrOdue:e cognitive behavioural c-aunselling to a 10-year-Old child? ■ Suppose the client returns f0c the next session and reports that "thought-stopping did not wo,k." Suggest counsell0c choices f0c dealing with this outcome. ■ Identify this client's neural pathways. At this point. the cout1se/10t could also help the client develop diffeI11t1t chok:e strategies for dealirtg with dysfut1ctional thinking. such as an activity dlverslot1 to shift attention. use of a prepared cue C/Jfd with a positive thought ,ec0rded, imagining success. 0r su~tituting a different Image. CONVERSATION 7.2 STUDE:NT: can we use CST to deal wtth OU( C)N(I (eac;tions? CIT Counsellor: AbSOlutely! Clients can Mpush out buttons: test our patience, and leave us OOUbti.ng OUf ability to wOr'k effectively. Sometimes. negative feet.i~ such as a•(· frus.. tratioo, 0t lea( can e:toud OU( objectivity and impalt OU( ability. Feelings ot atttaction p(otectiveness can be just as p(oblematic. When we begin to take client behaviout personall'j, \\tlen we become disconnected from essential skills and altitudes such as being nonjudgmental and empathic, it's time to do some wOt'k on self. That's wtlere CBT strategies can be very hel plul. °' STUDE:NT: How? CIT COunsellor, The CBT approach ;m<)I,.,. payu,g attenuon to the connectbn amoog hOw we Irtink, feel, and behave.~3'Na(eness (egat'ding dienl behaviour~ wrich trigger unhelpful thir'iung ghies us an opp:)rtunity to criticaly exarna"le thei' valklily, then Challenge umelpful lhOughlS I>, usir,g · ~ · ~ SUCfl as 1hougN-stopping. Iat-Nays IY'ld it telpful toconsi:Jet that my dent's behavioU" may be theit usual way, so if, fOt' ex:ami::,e, they a(e rude to me. I can understand that this is part of their pe~ty. and I am much leSS •kely to take it pe,sonall'f. Student: People in (ecovery from substance misuse leam to recogni:ze triggers that could lead to relapse. Counsenors can do the same thing by identifyi~ client situations behavburs, which trigger problematic feelings. °' HELPING CLIENTS MAKE BEHAVIOURAL CHANGES Goal Setting Obstacles are those frightful rhings you see when )'OIi take your eyes off your goals. - Henr)• Fon:!, public: dom::ain Goal scttini is a counselling process th::at helps clients define in p recise, measurable terms what they hope to ach ieve from the work of counselling. Goals c3n be classified as p rocess or outcome goals (Shebib, 1997; N)•srul, 2011). An outcome ioal relates to what the client hopes to achieve from counselling. These goals have to do with changes in the client's life, such as getting a job, improving communication with a spouse, de:.lling with painful feeling~ o r managing self-defeating thoughts. A process ioal conce.rns the procedures of counsclling. including such variables as the frtttuency of mttrings and the nnture of the counselling relationship. Process ,;oals are strategies for reaching outcome gooJs. There is wide suppon in the counselling literarure fo r the importance of setting goals (Nystul, 20 11 ; Marrin & Pear, 20 11) Goal setting serves many important purposes, including giv ing direction, d efining roles, motivating, and measuring progress. Supporting Empowerment and Change goal setting: Acomefling prooen t!l.i'! hefps tlieals de.fine ii precise. musurablf' lefms what they h04)e to adliew fiomtile r.ort ot CCJUns6g. outcome goal: Atoal rtla;edto what the dient llopes to achieve from uunselling, process goat: The •~sand pnndures tut -.ill be used iacaselling to assist cli!•ts in ieaclil:g tileir to3ls. 219 Giving Direction GooJs help to give direction, purpose, and structure to the work of counselling, thus, helping counsellors and clients decide whic.h topics and activities arc rcJcvant. When clients and counseJlors arc dear about their goaJs, they can begin to structure their thinking and action toward their artainmcnt. Setting g,c,als hcJps clients make reasoned choices about what they want to do with their lives. Goal setting helps clients prioriti:e these choices. Defining Roles Goals provide a basis for defining roles. When g,c,als are dear, coun.seJlors know which skills and techniques are appropriate, and clients know whnt is expected of them. Moreover, when counsellors lcnow the g,c,al of the work they can make intelligent decisions regarding whether they have the skills., capacity, and rime to work with the client. Jf not, they may make a referral. Motivating Cools motivate clients. Setting and reaching g,c,als is also therapeutic. 1t energi:es clients and helps them dcvcJop optimism and self-confidence about change. Cool achievement confirms personal capacity and further promotes action. \Vriting dO'l.\rn goals ma'>' add an extra measure of motivation. Measuring Progress Goals help pro\tidc benchmarks of progress., including de.fin.ing when the counselling relationship should cnd--that is, when the gools have been reached or their pursuit is no longe.r \•iable. Developing Effective Goal Statements Sometimes clients arc able to dear!'>' articulate whnt they hope to achieve as a result of counseJling. At other rimes, they have difficulty identif)ting their pi.ls; however, through systematic interviewing counsellors can help these clients define and target their goals. ThewidcJy used acronymS.M.A.R.T. (Bovcnd'Ee.rdt, Botcll, & \Vadc, 2009; Harms & Pierce, 2011) defines the c.haracte.ristics of effective g,c,als: Specific, Mcasureable, Ac.hicv.. able, Realistic, and Timely. Effective Goals Are Specific One defining feature of a counselling relationship is its goal-dir«ted nature. But some clients begin counselling with vague and undefined gools: ■ "I want to feel better." ■ "My husband and I nttd to get along better." ■ "I need to make something of my life." These g,c,als arc starting points, but they are useless until they arc described as dear and concrete targets. Beginning phase work that explores problems and feelings should lead to the dcvclopment of goals that define and structure subsequent worlc. Then in the action phase, clients can devcJop these goals as specific and measurable targets. This step is a prerequisite for action planning-the development of strategics and programs to achieve gools. Vague g,c,als result in vague and ill-defined action plans, wlu~rcas explicit gools lead to precise action plans. In Chapter 5, concreteness was introduced as the remedy for vagueness. Concreteness can add pr«ision to unclear and ambiguous g,c,als. For example, when clients are describing the.ir goaJs, counsellors can use simple encourage.rs., such as "TeJI me more" and "Yes, g<> on" to g,tt a general overview of what clients hope to achieve. This is the first step in shaping workable goals. The next step is to use questions to define terms, probe for detail, and develop examples. This step hcJps to cast the emerging g,c,als in precise language and move from 220 Chap1er 7 good intentions and broad aims to sp«ifac goals (Egan & Schroeder, 2009). He.re arc some sample probes: ■ ■ \Vhat is )'OUr goaH \Vhcn you say you'd like to feel better, what exactly do )'OU mean! ■ Describe how )'OUr life ,vould be different if you were able to reach your goaL Try to be as detailed as possible. ■ ■ If )'OUr problem were to be solved, what would need to be different in your life? \Vhat do you think would be the best resolution to your problem? ■ \Vhat arc some examples of what you would like to achieve? ■ As a result of counselling, whnt feelings do you want to increase or decrc3sc? ■ \Vhat do )'OU want to be able to do thnt )'OU can't do now? ■ If I could watch you being successful, what would I sec! Some clients are reluctant or unable to identify gools, and they may respond with a dead-end statement like "I don't know" when they are asked for their goals. To break this impasse, counsellors can use some of these responses: ■ "Guess." ■ "\Vhat might 't'OUr best friend (mother, father, teacher, etc.) SUfiCst as your gool!" "\Vhat W'Ould you like to achieve but don't think is possible?" ■ A good gencroJ technique is to encourage clients to visunli.!c themselves reaching their gools. \Vhcn clients say, "I don't know," their responses may indicate friction in the coun.selling relationship. and this answer is a way of sabotaging the work. In such cases, goo! setting might be pre.mature, and the focus of the interview ma)• nttd to shift to relationship problem solving (immediacy). Moreover, when clients say, "I don't know" they might also be saying, "I can't do it" or "I'm afraid." Here, counsellors can suggest setting a very small goal as a starting point (e.g., "If you could make just one tiny change in )'OUr life, what W'Ould it be?"). SUCCESS TIP Yv'hen clients say, ·1don't know: oon•t rush in too quickly with anolhe( quest.ion 0t comment Often, aftet a short s,lencQ, clit:?nts wil generatQ ne-w ideas, fQelings, or thoughts. Effedive Goals Can Be Me.asured \\:fhcn goals arc measurable, clients arc able to evaluate progress, and they know precisely when they have reached their goals. More• over, dear goals sustain client enthusiasm and motivation. Vague and unmeasurable gools, on the other hand, can result in aP3th)• and vague action plans. Baseline A baseline is a measure of what is hnppcning now. 1t becomes the reference point for measuring future change. For example, a baseline miaht be how often during any I .S-minutc interval a child is off task in a classroom. Baselines might be taken over one or many selected rime frames to obtain an average. Mcasurc3blc pl]s identify how much change in the basclinc is targeted. ln this example, suppose the baseline shows that the child is off task an average of 8 minutes during any I .S...minutc interval. The goo! might be to increase the frequency of on-task behnviour to 12 minutes during any I.S...minutc interval in the next three weeks (i.e., reduce off-task behaviour to maximum 3 minutes). Thus, goals need to be defined in terms of changes (increases or decreases) in baseline behaviours, thoughts, or feelings. Gools should also hnvc a realistic schedule (a target Supporting Empowerment and Change 22 1 date to start working on them and a rorget date to reach chem). Counsellors can help clients frame goals in quantifiable language with questions such as. "how often?" "how many times?" and "how much!" The question "When will 't'OU start!" is a simple but pO\\•erful way to ensure client commitment co the change. Example (sk ill): "My goaJ is to upress my opinion or aslc a question once per class." Example (thoughts): "My goal is to manaae self-depr«acing chouaht patterns by substitutina positive affirmations each time 1 say to myself that I can't do it." Example (fee.lings): "My goa.1 is to reduce anxiety when I speak in public from a subjective level of 8/10 to 3/10 within the next six months." Other measurable goals would include, "Tari;:et \\-eiaht reduction of 9 lcilograms in 10 weeks" or "Make five calls per day to potential employers." Effective Goals Are Achievable and Re.alistic A goaJ has to be somethina thac clients can reasonably expect to achieve, even though it may rttauirc effort and commit.mem. So counsellors need to consider variables such as interest in achieving the goals, skills and abilicic~ and resources (induding the counsellor) available to help in rcuhing the goals. In addition, the goals need to be significant enough to contribute to managing or changing the core problem situation. Bue some clients may be reluctant co set chaJlengina goals or even to set goals at aJI. This situation can occur for a number of reasons: ■ Poor sclf-estcem ■ Fear of failure ■ Lad: of awareness of capacity for change ■ Fear of change and rclucronce to give up established patterns ■ Lad: of resources to support pursuit of the goal (Shcbib, 1997, p. 210) Addrcssina these reluctance issues is a prc.rttauisitc for goal setting. \\:1hen problems arc complex and the client's capacity or self-esteem is low, settina short.-term goals or subgoa.Js is particularly useful. Short-term goals represent small, anainable steps to,.,,.-ard long-term goa]s, and they help clients build confidence that long-term goal achievement is possible. Clients need to sec goals as relevant to their needs and consistent with their values. Thus, when clients arc involved in the process of deciding what their goa.Js arc, they are more likcJy to be motivated to worlc coward achieving them. Counsellors can suagcst goals, as in the follO\\•ing: Ex3mple: Evelrn w:lS referred to the oounsellor for help in copin& with Trevor. her IS.,.~r-<>1d stepson. who wu in\'Olved in petty crime. E"elyn·s itnmedi:ue ~-041I w3s t'O enrou~e Trevor to move out of the house. and she hoped that the counsellor tni~t help her do thi$.. Durina the interview. it btt21n~ apparent to the counsellor that Evel,.,n needed help ck...elopina parentina ski.Us for dealu~ with Trevor 3nd her tv.'O other teen, 3~ step$ons.. Without di:smissinK E,-ely-n 's objec1h-e. the counsellor su~.sted th3t this be p3rt o( their 3~•end3. When clients are forced co come to counsdlina by a third party, they may not feel committed to any of the aoa.Js of counselling. Thus. the chances of success arc dimin.ished greatly unless some mutually acceptable working agreement can be reached. Understanding a client's values is an important part of goaJ settina. Some clients arc motivated by spirituaJ va.Jucs, some b\• mate.rial gain, and others by family values. Other diems focus on immediate gratification, while still others have objectives th3t arc long term. 222 Chap1er 7 ?l.·1 ina Le(t his &nuly in Ch.in:1 to ron\e to North A n ~. He has see.1 his wi(e ooly once in the last lh'i' )'i'arS. wben he rc-1.u med to C hin.2 (or a sho rt visit. He main12ins ~ ularcont:k't with her 2nd their s~'i'3.r,okl son. He sends mueh o( hli monthly tor home to support hli wi(e and extended futruly. Ah.hoUW, he hopes th:3t one d ay hii &nuly will be 2bte t'O joi.n him, he has at«pt.ed th:. his purpMe is to position futun- ~ner.ttionsol his furruly (or a belt.er lie Sometimes clients set go3fs that require others to change, such as " I want my husband to stop rreating me so badly." Counsello rs nttd to encourage clients to form gooJs based on what is unde.r the.ir control, name.I)• their own fccling:si, behaviour, and thoughts. C lient complaints and problem statemems c3n usually be rd ramcd as positively worded goa.1 statements. Herc arc some examples: Ex.:unple I Client : E\'e-r)One 2lwa)'S takes ad" a.1112~-t of me. Cou nseU.o r: Sounds as tho~ you 'd like to Je3n, to sttnd up for yoursel(. Exmnple? Client : I'm tired o( not worldn,a, Cou nsello r: Put simply. your ~-Ml is to ~t a job. Ex.:unple 3 Client : M)• li(e is a mess. Cou nsellor: You would like to Ond a way to ~t your li(e in order. The above responses change the focus of the interview from problems to gooJs. Of course, the co unseJlor and client will have to worlc togcthe.r to shape these vague goaJs into more explicit te.rms. Effective Goals Are Timely Setting go3Js in a rime frame, that is, identifying a target for gool achievement, is important for planning the work. The rime frame should also be realistic-not too quick and not too slow. \Vhcncvcr possib le, goal statements should include "b)• when" the goaJ will be achieved. For example-: ■ To improve my grade-point average from C ■ To make prayer a daily part of my life. ■ To develop skills at organi!ing my rime and setting priorities. I need schedule so 1 can plan at least a month in advance. ))!} INTERVIEW to B b)• the end of the semester. to set up a 7.2 The fOllowing interview e:xc:e-pt illustrates goal-settii,g techniques. Prior to this d ialogue, ex.plo,ation and active li$lening enabled the counsell0r to develop a solid base of understanding. With this work apparently finished, it seems timely to move on to goal settii,g. Counsellor: I'd like your optnion. Am you (eady to move on to makl~ a change? If so, the nex.t steps would be set a goal. then exi:,ore hO'N you can ad'lieve ii. Analysis: The counsellor uses a phaSe trat1sib'ot1 to suggest moving f,om problem exploration to making a change. This wf/1 also Change the eot1tract. The c/J'enrs response signals that he is Client: Yeah, I'm not getting any younger. It's now or nevef. ready to move from the C011templa.tlw! stage to the prepatatlotl CounselIOI: Help me understand what )(llld like to change. c,i.,.., 1need IOrelocus my IKeoo the ir.-es 1na1a,esrc,o,1an1. Counsellor: What do you mean? Client: I've been so busy with \\()rk that I (eally haven't had too much time f0t family. That has to d'lange. for change phase. Analysis: At this point. the counsel/Or will have the criteria for effectMJ goals (i.e.. specific. measureable. ach;evable, te:Jllstic, aM b'mely) as a teferer,ce point. Subsequent questioos Mill be deslf!l1e<J to help ffame the goal atowld these ctiteria. Supporting Empowerment and Change 223 >» INTERVIEW 7.2 Goal Setting<conHn,e> counsellor: JUSI so we can be dear, can you try to be more specific? Suppose you're successful. What Will be diffetent from the way thi~ are noN? Client: Less work, more famity time. NON, work takes so much of my rime and energy I don't ha\18 anything 18ft for family. counsellor: Okay, you'd like to be able to give tnOr'e time and commitment to family. To do that you'd have to cut baek on work. What's the situation now? Analysis: The counseJIOr' e.Slablishes the baseline at'ld encourages goal setting k, behavjoural terms that are clear and measuteable. Goals should specjfy what clie.nts v.i/1 be oo;,1g, oot ;,, temrs of what they want to stO() dOing. A Clear measurable target for change emetgeS. Client: I'm locky if I can have dinner- with my family onice a week, and I can't remembe-r the last time my wife and I had a night out. counsellor: So, in a typical week, wtlat do you see as the balance between WOrk and famtly? Client: If possible, weekends-strictty famil'j. One night a week rese-rved as ·<Sate ni~t· with my wile. counsellor: You smile and seem excited as you talk abOut this. Client: I lhink it's what I 008d to do to be happ,j. Analysis: Empathy is still an lm()Oftant compooont of the worl< even though the eortvetSat!M has become more focused on the behavloural domain. The c/J'e,,l's res()()(lse conlitms tl'lat the empathic statemoot is accurate. II gives this c/J'ent an opportUJlity to be mere deftnmve abOut his em<Jljooal needs counsellor: You said ..if possiblEt when you talked abOut cutti~ baek on wOt'k. What problems do you anticipate? Analysis: CounseJIOrS have a tesportSibility to help clients CMskier the implicatiCt'ls (positive and negative) of tflt!ir goalS and Client: 1-'d like tot,y for a manageme-nt position at the company. but evetyone's so competitive. I've got to pu1 i"I the hours if I'm going to keep my sates abOve the others. And ~ S3leS is the flrst thing lhey IOOk f0t when It's time f0t promotion. action p/ar>s. counsellor: vou·,e torn. To compete-. you\ie got to put in the hour'S. Bui if you dO that, it 1akeS away from you, time Analysis: The courtSe/lOr acJu'lowiedges the ctient's ambivalettee-a factor that often ;mpeoes decis.kx'I mak;11g and acb'oo. Jdenb'freati<Jn of ambivaleoce helps the client gel Clarity Oil the and energy 'Mth the famlly. That's a lot of st,ess. Client: Now that you JX)int it out, it seems obvious. I've been under stress fo, so IOog. I don't even think abOut it anymore. It's ctea, to me now that the p(ace ot success is just too much. chokes. counsellor: Meaning that if you have 10 sactifice time with youf famtly to get aMad. you're not interested. (Client nod~) counsellor: Sounds as if you've made a decision, but let me play devil's advoc.ate. Suppose you cut back on your job and IOst a promotion. How would you feel abOut that? Client: It would be hard on me, but I think not near1y so hard as what's happening n<YN. At heart, I'm really a family man. I'm certain of it. Famity has to be number one. My career is impoftant to me, but it's my second p(aotity. 224 Chap1er 7 Analysis: By exploring the imp/icatkx'Js of the client's goal, the courtSellor helps w ,:,tevent the client f(()((J acting ;mpuisive.ty. Goals atld actiotl plat1s are much more likely to be pursued jf l/'Je costs and bet1efits a,e clearly uMerstOOd atld antld,:,ated. ~JO INTERVIEW 7.2 Goal Setting<conHn,e> CounsellOf: Lei's go back to you( goat What Olher problemS do you anticipate? (20 seconds of s;1ence.J Cllent He-re's one. My family is so used to geniog along without me, they've developed lives of theit ONn. I guess I can't ex,:,ec1 them to dro,:, everythlflg f0t me. Analysis: The counsellor cot1b'nues the ptOCeSS ofexf)IO(ing risks at'ld problems. By dOing so. ptOblemS may be anUcipated at'ld srrateg;es to overcome them devekJped. Often goalS and actiotl plans fail or are abatl<JOiled because of u,ianb'c/pated obStacles. The cout1sell0r is free to be an acJive participant in kJentify;ng riSks. but, as a tule. dNMts shOuld have the fitst Of)()Orlut1Uy. Counsellor: So hO'N can you daal with that reality? Cllent: That's easy. 1guess 1·11 just have to negotiate with 100 family on how much time we'll spend together-. Counsellor: One thought oe:curS to me. How Yrul youf bOSS teact if you suddenly start spendi~ less time on 100 job? Oo you think 1tiat's somethi~ to considet? ReHectJons ■ What indicators suggest it is appropriate to move on from problem exploration to goal setting and action planning? THE PROBLEM-SOLVING PROCESS Counselling is a dcvclopmcmal process. Jn the beginning phase, the process go3J is the development of a strong dicm...counsdlor working relationship and contract th:.n describes the worlc to be done and the respective roles of both the counsellor and the client. 1f clients arc motivated to make chan,;c~ then problems c:m be identified and explored, which provides the foundation for goaJ ~tting and action planning. Clear goa.Js and a systematic action plan hcJp to prevent failure that often comes from impulsive or premature action. Problem Exploration Problem Solving Problem solving has four steps: (1) identify a1tcrnatives for action, (2) choose an 3Ction strategy, (3) develop and implement plan~ and (4) evaluate outcomes. Step 1: Identify Alternatives The first task in selecting a plan is to list alternative ideas for nchieving the goals. This step holds clients bade from impulsive action based on the first alternative awil3ble, which may simply be a repe3t of previous unsuccessful anempts nt change. When there is choice, clients can make more rational decisions. Brainstorming is one way to quickly generate a list of possibilities. To encourage clients to generate ideas, counsellors can use leads such as these: "Let 't'our imagination run wild and see how many different ideas you can come up with that will help you achieve 't'OUr goa]s," "Don't worry for now about whether it's a good idea or n bad one." Sometimes counseJlors can prompt clients to be creative by aenerating a few "wild" ideas of their own. Step 2: Choose an Action Strategy Once a creative list of alternative action strategies is identified, the next task is to assist clients in evaluating aJte.rnntives nnd making choices. This involves helping clients intd· ligently consider each aJte.rnntive by exploring questions such as: Supporting Empowerment and Change 225 ■ Is it sufficient to make n difference to the problem! ■ Is it within the capncity (resources and ability) of the client! ■ Is it consistent with the client's values! ■ What are the costs? Cost miWlt be me3sured by time, money, and energy expended in finding resources to execute the alternative. As well, n1te.rnntives might result in other losses for the client. For example, suppose a client wishes to end a P3ttern of alcohol abuse, but the pe.rson's friends are drinking buddies. If quitting drinking involves developing new activitie~ the potenti31 loss of friends and social structure must be considered as a negative con.sequence that will have an impact on the client. Unde.rstanding and exploring this loss is important, for unless clients are awnre of nnd prepnred for these contingencies, they may be unable to sust3in an)' efforts at changing. SUCCESS TIP HelJ) dients conduct autopsies (atso known as post-mortems) on past experiences as a tool to helJ) them identify er(ors tn thinking,. triggerS, J)roblemat.ic (espooses, and successes. HelJ) them answe( the ciuestions -What wen1 wrong?" "What couk1 I have done differen.Uy'r and "What worked weir?· Step 3 : Develop and Implement Plans conti,_enc,- plans: Prewntiw plans that anti:ipate possillle barriers tu dients miglll NOO'.llter as lley carry cm actioo,e.s. Developing and implementing plans involves four substeps: (I) sequencing plans, (2) devcJoping contingency plans, (3) putting plans into action, and (4) CV3luating plans. Effective plans are maps that detail the sequence of events leading to the finaJ gonJ. Counsellors should avoid t3ilor-made plans in favour of customized strategies that are desianed in collnbomtion with individuaJ clients. Some of the import3nt questions that need to be answered include the following: ■ What specific strategies will be used? ■ In what orde.r will the strategies be used! ■ What resources or support will be needed at each step? ■ What are the risks and potential obstacles? Contingency Planning Effective plnns nnticip:ne the potential obsrades thnt clients might encounter along the wa)t Once clients know and accept the possible barriers that could inte.rforc with their plnns, they cnn develop contingency plans to deal with these bnrri,ers. This preventive work hdps lcttp clients from giving up when things don't go smoothly. A variety of different strategy choices can be used to suppon- contingency planning:: ■ AnticiP3tory questions such as "What will )'OU do if .. . (detail possible obstacles)?" ■ Role pln)•ing (including counsellor modelling) to explore and practise strategies. ■ Use of contracting-before problems occur, counsdlors can ask clients for advice on how they can respond when the time comes. For example (to a client who has just begun a job se3.rc.h): "\\:'hat would you want me to do if a few weeks from now I notice thnt you're becoming frustrated with your job senrchf' With flight simulators, airline pilots learn to tly aircraft in eme.rgencies. Should n re3l-Jife emergency happen, they are able to respond with confidence knowing that their training has preP3rcd them. Simila.rly, contingency plnnning helps clients prepare for pe.rsonal challenges and sustain the.ir goals. It hdps to prevent rclapse to previous but ineffective ways of thinking and reacting. 226 Chap1er 7 Other Selected CBT Techniques A wide range of behavioural change techniques can be used and customi.!ed to address the needs of clients (Maclaren & Frttman, 2007; Neenan & Dl)tden, 2006; Vonk & Early, 2009). These include the following: ■ "Auropsie.s'' hcJp clients evaluate and learn from past experiences. As we have discussed, clients often rcpc11.t and reinforce the same thoughts and actions., sometimes with full knowledge that they arc not w-orking. A counselling autopsy involves systematic review of past actions to identify "triggers," unhelpful thinking and thc.ir link to behaviour and feelings. Of course, there is also considerable wJuc in reviewing what worked. This enables clients to identify and build on proven strategics. ■ Relaxation rraini'ng helps clients manage anxiety and tension. ■ Assertion rmining, where clients learn to express feelings or thoughts and achieve their rights while respecting the rights of others. ■ Relationship problem solving, where clients can learn communic3tion skills and conflict management strategics. ■ Homeu.ffl enables clients to implement and practise change strategics discussed during CST, such as activities that provide pleasure. Home,.vork may also include charting and monitoring: emotions or bdi.aviour through the use of diaries and checklists to measure baselines and progress to goals. Homework enables clients to see tangible and positive results from counseJling, which builds confidence for further change. (f clients encounter implemcnrotion barriers., these can be addressed quickly. ■ Expo.n,re provides gradual desensitization to anxiety-prO\-olcing events. Real or imagined exposure ma)' be combined with relaxation training to inhibit anxiety. SUCCESS TIP HALT (hungry, angry, IOnely, and tired) is an acronym fof common feelings that can triggef (elapses. Help d ients explore what they tend to dO, and what they migt\t dO differently, when they are hungry, anwv. lonely, or tired. HALT: An acronymfer hungry. angry. ic.ly, and tired. HALI is a quick w.y to ~ clients as.sess trigvrs and plan alteruti...e ,esponses. Counsellors need to support and encourage clients as they deal with the stress of change. One way they can help is to remind clients that anxiety, awkwardness, and periodic slumps are normal when change is occurring. Meanwhile, counsellors can loolc for ways to re.frame failure or setbacks as learning opportunities. Empathy should be used to support clients dea.Jing with feelings that accompany chanacor setbacks. During implementation, counsellors should also encourage clients to use fnmih•, friends, and support groups to assist them. Step 4: Evaluate Outcomes Effective plans include continua] evaluation during the implementation phase. Evaluation recognizes and confirms success and is a powerful motivator; however, cva.Juation may also uncover problems that need to be addressed. For example, it may become apparent that the goals arc too unrealistic. (f they arc too challenging and unreachable, counsellors can hcJp clients define smaller goals. Similarly, if goaJs prove to be too easy, they can be modified to provide more chaJlengc. Thus, regular review of progress ensures that goals and action strategics remain relevant and realistic. \Vhcn evaluation rcvcaJs that the plan is unlikely to be successful, efforts can be redirected toward redesigning the plan or scJecting a different strategy for action. In some cases, the client may need help that is beyond the capacity of the counscllor; in this case, referral to another counsellor or service is appropriate. Supporting Empowerment and Change 227 CONVERSATION 7.3 STUDENT: I get stuck when a client sa~ Mf've tried 4M),ything and nothing seems to wor'k.• TtACHER: You feel stuck, \\tlich is ,:recisefy how the client feels. ,....,gs Clionis cllen t,mg out in coun,..,., the same !hat they are experien::::ing. This reality can be a useful tool f0t empathy. Wl>!n clienlS say lhey'"' trkld ev~-,g. ;r, important not IO ge1 into a )'es, but. game, vd'lereby counsellors generate ideaS and clients diStl'iss them with a "yes, blA. response. ST\JOENT: So what are my cooices? TUCH£R: I'd be interested in ex.plOfing wtlat the client did. Oid he or She try loog enough? At the rigf\t time? In 100 right way? Satnetimas problems gel worse before they get better, and clients may gj\18: up too soon. A mother migt\t lty igoor~ her' child wtlen he has a &antrum and then tell you ignoring doesn't WOrk, but She may have abandOned this tactic after a few minutes wtle-n 1t appeared that the intensity of her chikS's tantrum was incteasing. In thi:S situation., you could help her anticipate thi:S obSlacle so lhat she would n01 be demota!ized if it recurred. Or maybe she has been giving her cr.ik1 lots of OOl'Wet'bal attention, not realizing hO'N this has been reinfOr'c- iog the tantrum. STUDENT: I can think of anothe-r example. One of the members of my work group was havi~ uouble with her supervisor'. She tOld us that lhere was no point k'I &al.Id~ to him because he didn'1 listen af'r'f'N<¥Y. But from lhe w.ry She desctibed hOw she 1a1ked to him, I wouldn't listen either. She was vicious and cruel. TEACHER: So, if She we-re )'()IS c~nt, she WOIAd need SOtne help devetopi~ awareness about hO'N she affects Olhers. BRIEF COUNSELLING t..ief counselling: A.uippioadlito counselling characteriled bJ a foClls OR r~ s and solutic.s rather than pobl.-s. Since the I980~ the 3ssumption th3t counselling nttded to be lengthy to be effective h3s been successfully challenged. In many settings. counsclling relationships are brief, sometimes limited to a few sessions, a sing.le session, or e\-en a brief encounter. Brief coun.wllin~ approaches., with the.ir emphasis on strenarhs, resources, problem solving. solutions, and coll3bora.tion with clients, are now accepted as effecti\-e for m3n't' clients (&ttino, 2007; Cameron, 2006; Carpctto, 2008; Hoyt, 2009~ and Presbury, Echterling:, & McKtt, 2008). Steve de Sha:er (1985), one of the early pioneers of brief counscJling, argues that it is n()( necessary to spend time searching for the root causes of a problem, nor is it necessary to have elaborate knowledge about the problem. In brief counselling, the gonJ is to help clients do something different to improve their situ3tion rather than repent the same ineffectual solutions. Small changes (e.g., insight, reduction of painful feelings, and new skills) can h3ve a dramatic long-term impact by moving clients from a point of despair to one of optimism and motivation to work on changes in other areas of their lives. Bec3use of its emphasis on action and change, brief counselling hdps clients become "unstuck" from ineffectual ways of thinking, foding, and acting. Clients can be encouraged to rdrame by focusing their 3ttention on wh3t's working. thu~ interrupting their preoccupation with problems 3nd foilure. This focus may gene.rate or renew the clients' optimism that change is possible. In addition, brief counselling., even a single session, can be therapeutic for clients if they are able to unload pent-up feelings. A car~ ing and empathic counsellor can encourage such ventilation and reassure clients that their reactions and fodings are normal. This can significantly reduce feelings of isol3tion by disputing the belief that many clients hold: "I'm the only one who feels this way." Selected Brief Counselling Techniques P'recounselling Change Momentum for change is often established at the momem clients seek counselling. Carpetto (2008) notes that studies have shown that chanaes frequenth• occur in the interval between the rime clients make an 3ppointment to see a counsellor and the first meeting. Thus, counsellors can make use of the foct that some clients realize progress while w3iting for their first scheduled appointment. 228 Chap1er 7 SUCCESS TIP capitalize on the possibttty of p(ec:ounselling change by asking questions suctl as MSince making )'Ou( appcintment, have )'Ou noticed lhat lhings have i.mproved in arry way, hOw· M!I' sma1r?· If lhe response is pos,tive, suss.a~ thi:S change (l'l()vement by helping the client identify lhe feelmgs, thougNs, and behaviout associated with ii. The Miracle Question A cypicaJ miracle question might be formulated as follows: "Suppose that tonight while you're s1ttping a miracle happens and )'OUr problem is solved. \\:fhen you w-nke up. what will be different 3bout your life?" Variations of this question ma'>' need co be dcvdopcd to accommodate different dic:nts. For example, some clients may object to the religious overtones in the question and a more neutral term, such as something remarkable, could be used. The following example illustrates the process: m.irade question: Used ia twiel or si• •s.ssi:in coun~ asa Wk/ to ~ dients who It.ave difficulty coaing up •ill definei:I goals. ne miract!' questica dlJlenges clieaa to imagine how their lives 'M)Uld be different ii a mftde sct,e:J their pobl.-s. CourueUor: Suppose when you v.'OkC' up tomorrow son~hin& rem::u-kab1e has h3p, pened and your problem i.s ~one. How would )'Ou know t~t )'Our proble1n is soh~! Client: Well. for one thin¥, I'd be worryin¥ leu. Coun.se.ltor: What mi~,i )'Our fanuly ~ as d1((erent! Client: I'd be n\Ol'i' w1llu)¥ l'O ~l involved in fanuly activities. Coun.se.ltor: Actwities! Client: Thinv like SportS. family outin~rnovies 2nd so forth. Coun.se.U.or: \Vh::u else would ther Ond di((erent? !Note: 1t is imporbnt (or the cow,~ sellor l'O use probes sueh as this to elicit detail. I( a chan~e can be inu¥ined, the more possible it "'111 ~m 2nd the 11\0re the behaviou~I e~n~-e.s 10 1nake it possible will berome 2ppore:nt.l Client: I think that we'd be h3ppier. Koc just because we' re <loin¥ fun thi~ tOiether, but we'd be 2f¥uh1¥ less about money 3nd our other problems.. Coun.se.ltor: How much o( this is already happenina! The above excerpt shows how quickly the counsellor c:m move the interview to focus on change and solution possibilities, which heJps clients become more hopeful about their situation. As Carpeno (2008) concludes, "they nre aJready on their way to findina solutions to their problems" (p. 181). Since the client has imagined nnd described some o( what nttds to h3ppen to solve the problem, the counsellor's next task is to get the client mO\tina in the direction o( the "miracle" with questions such as "\\:'hat would you need to do now to beain co move tO\\>ard the miracle?" or "\\:'hat would it t3ke to make the first step?" SUCCESS TIP It is important lhat lhe client, 001 the counsellor, articulates the answet 10 the miracle ciuestion, and it is the client whO must describe what changes or SOiutions need to happen fot the miracle to occut. The counseUOt's role is to manage lhe explOration and solutionfinding ptocess. Helping Clients Get on Track Counsellors don't need to stay with clients until all the.ir problems are solved and the.ir lives are in order. With brief counsdlina, the relation• ship may end when the client has a plan in mind, nnd they are headed in the right direc• tion. Once clients st3rt the process, counsellors should consider ,;errina out o( their way. Suppo rting Empowerment and Change 229 Looking for Exceptions Clients often st3\' fix3ted on their problems 3nd on whnt doesn't work, and they continue to repeat or cxnggerntc "solutions" that have alread't' proved unwork3blc. By doing so, they fail to notice times when they are successfully managing their problems. Looking for exceptions ch3Jlcngcs clients to focus on those momc.nts, hO\\•cver r3rc, when they arc coping successfully. The assumption is that there 3rc times when clients arc successfully m3naging their problem, 3nd they do many positive things th3t they 3rc not aware of (\Vchr, 2010). There are moments when anxious persons foe] calm, 3Cting-out children listen to their par.ents, and 3ngry people arc peacdul. By dr3wing clients' attention to these moments, they c3n remember and discover potentially successful answers to chronic problems. Challenging clients in this way stimulntcs them to think about more exceptions in their live~ thu~ increasing sclf.-confidcncc and their 3Wareness of proven success experiences. When clients are 3skcd, "\Xlhnt is different 3bout those occasions when )'Our child obeys you or 3t least responds more receptively to your requests?" or "What is different about those rimes th3l you're not 3ngry or only minim31Jy up~d" the coun.scllor is requesting that clients report on experiences to which they h3\'e paid 3lmost no nncntion. Working with exceptions provides a quick 3nd powerful wa't' to motivate and encrgi!e clients to think about solutions rather than problems. The process is as follows: I . Identify exceptions to those times when the client is hnving difficulty. 2. Help the client explore what was different about those times; including what (specifically) the client w3s doing differemi)•. 3. Identify elements (e.g., behaviour, setting, and timing) thnt contributed to n successful solution. 4 . Hclp the client plan to do more of what was successful. In the follO\\•ing brief excerpt, the counsellor uses the technique to 3Ssist a diem who is having trouble dC3ling with her tttn3ge son: CounS(>IJOr. From "-hat )'Ou\,e been sarifl$:. it's a r.are moment when )'Ou 2nd your son ean sit t0$;ed~r and 1:ilk e:dmlr. C lient: M3)'be on« or 1wi«' in the bsc year. CounS(>IJOr. Let' s look 21 those two times. I'm rdil)' curious :.bout wh::u w:lS d1ffe-rent about them th::u en:!lbled )'Ou to talk without A~tin¥, Pd one lime that worked best. C lient: Th::u's e:.sy. ?l.·1)• $011 was excited be<-3use he w:lS ~h,¥ 10 a n'.K':l. concert, and he was in a re31l)• K()od mood. I (e.lt more refaxed too. He just seemed more approach:3ble th:u day. CounS(>IJOr. H::n,e )'Ou cons.dertd that port of your success m,d\t h3,,e t'O do with )'Our mood! Perh:3ps your $011 was more appro:lt.h:3ble because )'Ou Yi'eri' more refaxed. C lient: Interest in¥ point. CounS(>IJOr. Let' s explore- tJ13t 2 bit furtheT. Btt2use )'Ou w~re inore relaxed. what else w:lS dif(ert:nt 2bout tJ,e wa)' you handled this encounter! C lient: I d,dn't (eel stressed, $0 I think I w:lS more open to listenif1¥ t'O him. CounS(>IJOr. \V~t v.>ere )'Ou doin&di((ere:ntl)·! C lient: I let him talk witJ,out jutnpina into aJ'iue. Finding Strengths in Adversity Hardships 3nd difficulties often have positive spin-offs in th3t people develop skills to deal with their misfortunes or discover cap3ci.tics that they did not know they had. Following arc some S3mplc probes: 230 Chap1er 7 ■ How hnve you mnnag~ to keep going in conditions that would h.nve defC3tcd n IQ( of people! ■ You h.nve dealt with this problem for a long time. Man)' people would not have sur\•ivcd. How did you man.a.gem keep going? \Vh.ntstrcngthswe.reyou3bletodrnwon! ■ \Vhat h3\-e you le3rncd from life's trin.Js and tests? ■ Have hardships heJped to shnpe your values 3nd ch3racter in positive wnys! ■ People often develop t3lents or discover strengths from facing challenges. How has this been true for you! Using Solution Talk To gee clients to notice their skills and C3P3cities, counseJlors c3n use smcemems nnd questions such as, "\Vhen )'OU've successfully coped, how did you do it!" (n 3ddition, counsellors need to be 3lert for opportunities to reinforce clients' strenw:hs. Personal qualitie~ actions th.nt underscore their determination, nnitudes, positive decisions, nccomplishments, effort t0\\"11.rd ch3nJ;c. and courage in the face of 3dversity can 3JI be used to bolster clients' sense of c3pncity and self-esteem. Clients mny nlread't' h3ve 3 rich undersmnding of their problems 3nd the W"n)'S in which they might be solved. Counsellors need to tnp their clients' expertise about possible nnswers to their problems: ■ \Vhat solutions h3\-e you already rried? ■ \Vhat would your best friend 3dvisc you to do! ■ To soh-e )'Our problem, wh.nt will you have to do? ■ Lee's cry to identify something different for 't'OU to do to solve 't'our problem. ■ Lee's brainstorm solution ideas. The wilder the idea, the better. SUCCESS TIP Use a ciuestion such as ·What do you want to d'lange abOut yourself today?· as a quick way to set a goal-ditected sessional contract. The Change Continuum Often clients 3re overwhelmed with the number and depth of their problems. Their despair C3n C3sily infect counsellors. The continuum is a tool to assist clients to become motiwted in the direction of positive chnnge (sec Figure 7.5). When clients c3n gain some control over their situation through smn.11 successes, this promotes further optimism nnd chnn,;c. Counsellors do not have to be involved for the whole change process.. Sometimes helping clients hC3d in the right direction is the extent of their involvement. Here's3nexampleof the use of the continuum with Figure 7.6a toe illustrating how it might be present~ to the diem: Kim, n young woman of 19 who is heavily involved in drugs, seeks counselling for help "to get her life in order." Couruellor. (U~:s a mp <:har t to draw the continuum depkted fate:r.) Khn. think about :m are::t of ,.·our life where )'Ou v.--oukl hk.e t'O nuke a chan~-e. The eontinuum represents thi~ ai bad :lS ther eould be if thi~ K()t v.-'Orse 21 one end, and )'Our ultimate iOaJ at the other end. Kim: I ,~d to c~,~ my whole h(e. As Bad a:s I Coold 8e {Nea;ative> My Ultim.ate Go.al (P-ositiTe) Figure 7.6a Supporting Empowerment and Change 231 Counse.Uor: Okay. let 's work on the bi& picture. Let's ::.cld desi!ripl'OrS that represent each end o( the continuum. Kim: (Rei/x>nse depfcaed later.) My Ultiaate Goat (PositiTe) As Bad a:s tt Cookl Be (Neptive} - Using hard narcotics - Job - Prosaitution - Drug-free - HIV-positive - Money in the bank - Criminal activi ty - Friends who are "clean• Figure 7.6b CounseUor. \Vhere 3re )'Ou on the continuum! Kim: (Dr.I.wit 3 cl.rcle.) I'm 3bout here. prett)• lle3r the bottom. Figure 7.6c Coun!l(>IJOr. \V~t direction 2re you headina! Kim: (Dr.l.wit3n urow.) "?l.·ty li(e is a n ~ 2nd it's~ttin& worse." Figure 7.6d CounseUor. M2)•be you'd :1.¥re<e that the direct ion )'Ou' re he::.clin¥ in is ultimately more llnport3nt that where you 2re on the continuum. Kim: Absolutely, I can see th3t. Coumellor: So wh3t 's one thll,i th::n v.'Oukl need l'O happen for )'Ou to cl12flie directions! Kim: Th3t'se::asy. I need a pl~ o( m)•Own. a.nd I need to~~ out o( this3re3. CounseUor. let's st~ut there 2nd mW th::n the locus o( our work. Figure 7.6e Comments: T he continuum hns a number o( usdul fe3ntres. lt is visual, whic.h makes it easier for some clients to understand. It is a quick way to prioritize complex problems and aools. This helps clients aenerate a sense o( control and d irection. Once completed, it provides shortha nd communication for counsellors and clients. The two basic questions o( the continuum can be used at the beginnina o( subsequent interviews to nssess proaress and to identify emeraem issues: "\Xfhe.re are you on the continuum!" and " \Vhat dir«tion are you headed!" 232 Chap1er 7 SUMMARY ■ Empowerment counselling rests on the foundariona.1 belief that clients are capable and that they have the right to manage their own lives. ■ Canada's senior population, now almost 6 million, represents a growing diverse group with 3 wide range of differing needs and cxp«tarions. ■ C risis intervention aims to empower clients by helping them regain physical and psychologicaJ safety, control, and b aJancc. ■ Morivurional imcrviC\\•ing is a practice 3pproac.h that uses rhc scages of change model to hcJp clients overcome ambivalence to changes. Its central fenturcs include active listening, especial I)• empathy, developing discrepancies, and rolling with resistance. ■ The stages of change modcJ {prccontcmplarivc, contemplative, preparation, action, and maintenance) provide a useful framework for understanding where clients are in the process of chanae and for making intdli~ent decisions regarding the usefulness of particular counselling skills. ■ C ognitive behavioural counsclling hdps clients understand how unhelpful thinIcing can lead to prob lematic behavioural and emotional responses. Cognitive behavioural counselling hdps clients brc:.llc out of established (but ineffective) patterns of thinking and behaviour. ■ Brief counselling recogni.!es that short encounters have the potential to be helpful for clients. Brief counselling techniques include the use of skills such as the miracle question, looking for exceptions, finding strengths in adversity, using solution talk, and the chan~e continuum. EXERCISES Sett-Awareness I. RetlectMareasW'l you life~echat'@e:isp:)SSitje, is MC~ sa,y, cx has already occurred. Classiy your Sla!l<! ol Chare, ~ilh ead'I issue baSed on the stages ot d'la(€e model: pmcontem- plative, conlM'li:tative. i:reparal.bn, action, and maintenance. What could potential~ ·mo,,e• yQtJ from ooe stage to aoo,het? 2. Start a log that chronic&es your automatic lhtnking, for example, wtlen you meet someone new, before ask.i~ a question in class., when you want to ask fOr' help, etc. 3. Think of a crisis thal you have faced. Try to recal your reactbns in each of the three majOr' domains:. feetil~. thtnki'lg. an:S behaviou'. What h ~ you cope with and rec:ovet balance lollOwi~ the crisis? What factors acted 33:linst recovery? 4. Use the concepts fromi this chapter to practise goal setti~ and action planntng fOr' yourself. Pick ooo or more 1arge1 areas (behaviour, feeli~. thoughts, skirts., Or' relationship). DevelOp a baseline. 5. Practise mindfulness: a. Go lot a watk. focus on COOtdinating your breath with your steps. b. Eat a banana or other fruit. Pay careful attention (sequentially) to lhe sttuclure, cotour, and feel of the fruit. Next, slowly chew it while foousing on the taste and feel ot the fn:it in your mouth. c. Bteath meditation. Find a quiet place 'lff'lere you can be comfor&able. Obser\18 your breathtng by attendtng to the flow of air through your nose and into your lungs. Watch yQIJ' lhaugl\ts, and when a judgment arises, silently label ;1 "iudli)ng." (Adapted from Siegel. 2010, p. 83) 6. Interview seniot'S. Discuss their current oeedSand expectations. Meet with coueagues to Share your fandtngs and to exi:,ore implications fOr' counselli~ this group. Skill Practice 1. Working with a COiieague. take turns exptoring a time in your life when you were unmotivated. What feelings were associated with lhis periOd? What helped you get unstuck? 2. Worktng ~th a part~r. use setected brief counsetltng techniques from lhis chapter to help him or her deal with a prOblem area. 3. Conduct a practice interview with a coueague lhat focuses oo goal setting, 4. Conduct an interview with a colleague (as client) usmg the principles of cognitive behavioural counselling.. Expl0te a Supporting Empowerment and Change 233 problem area that the client ideotiOes as real and cu«ent where they wish to make a cha• . Tty 10 help you( dient: 4. Suggest refr'amed responses f0t ead'I of the folto.vi~ client ssatements: a. identify automatic thoughts. a. 1can, dO it b. evaluate automatic thougt\ts. b. (A studetlt counsellor.) I feel so unnahxal and phony expressi~ empathy au the lime. c. develop strategies for controlling and modifyi~ automatic thoughts that are not heli)flA. d. set a goal fo, action (home.-ork). 5. Rec0td an interwew with a coneague (as dienl) wt'lere you explOre a ptoblem 0t situation where they are ambivalent. Review the recording ar\d i::lentify statements lhat "suslai.n 1alk· and "change &alk. • Concepts 1. Suggest quesltons you mi~t ask dients to assess their slage of cha~. 2. Identify wtlid'I saage of d'lange beSI describes each of the fOUOwing clients: a. "I hardty knON anyone who smokes anymore. I'll get the<e too one day." b. MWhat's the i:ont of IOOking f0t WOrk? Since the big stock market Cr'ash there a(en't any jobs: out u-iere ariyway: c. "It's been almOSI six. m::,nths since my lasl drink. I don't even crave it like I used to: d. Ml wish I could fr'ld a way 10 get off drugs: c. I really want my kidS to avoid maki~ lhe same mistakes I did. I dOO'I know wtly they don't listen to me. d. If he realy IOved me, he'd send me flowers. e. M'ylife isa mess. f. I'm tired of being depressed al the time. 5. Name at least 10 different ways to motivate clients. 6. £valuate haw the folloliing ssate~nts meet the ciileria f0t effective goals: a. To be a better perSOn. b. To get my bOSS to stop haSSling me. c. To drink tess. d. To be able to disagree with someooe without dis.missi~ lhem or their' ideas. e. To improve my fitness by next year to the potnt whel'e I can run 1 ldlo.ineue in eight minutes.. 7. Practise brainstO<ming techniques. Identify 5- 7 diffe(ent action Sltategjes for a client wt'lo wishes 10 qllt drinking, 3. ~lore how each of the dient sa.atemeots might impact their bahaviwr at'd em::>tioos. What errors .-. th~g am api;:ar'ent? a. " 111oev« get a job: b. "She didn't even sayhettowhen She saw me at the st0re. I guess She doesn't like me." c. Ml have to be number one.· WEBLINKS Links and resources on the toplc of motivation.al interviewing www.motiv.ationalinterviewing.org Sh0rt a1ticle on anti-oppressive p,actke from a child and youth care perspective http://Cyt•net.org/cyc-on Ii netcycol- 1203-moore.htm I Links to .articles and resources on goal setting Mindfulness Exercises www.selfgrowth.com/goal .html www.sh1lm1nd.eom.au/m1ndfulnessandrelax.ation.htm Beck Institute fOt Cognitive Behavior Therapy A practical guide to elder .abuse and the law www.becki nstitute.org http://www.bcl1.o,gk.1tes/def.ault/f1les/Practic.a1_Guide_ EogHsh. Rev_JULY. 20 11_0.pdf Online tools for CBT https://www.psychologytools.tom .and search far the heading ··cer tools" Substance Abuse Mental Health Service Administration (SAMHSA> publication: '"Brief Interventions and 8,ief Therapies for Substance Abuse·· www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/N8K64947 234 Chap1er 7 ■ Understand the nature of client resistance. ■ Describe techniques for dealing with resistance. ■ Explain the use of confrontation. ■ Identify key wriablcs for violence risk assessment. ■ Identify and describe strategics for preventing violence. ■ Describe strategics for intervening at c3ch phase of violence. ■ Understand the importance of debriefing critical incidents. ■ Describe counselling interventions for deaJing with angry and potentinJly violent situations. RESISTANCE Resistance, a term first introduced by Freud, refers to a normal defensive re:.lction chat comes from the natural d rive to preserve the scarus quo. Changing one's patterns of thinking and behaving. even when desired, creates anxiety. le requires people to alter existing and familiar P3ttc.rns of communic:.lting o r coping which, however painful o r resistance: Adefensiw reaction br dients that iMerf«ts ■idl, « debys the pnnss of a.selling. 235 unhelpful, are at least familiar, and so the prospect of ch:.mJ;c represents some risk 3S well 3S potentiaJ gain. Thus, resistance protects clients from the stress and threat of ch3ngc. Thus, resistance may be the dient's re3ction to being pushed (by the counsellor) to do or accept something the client does not ,.,,.,mt. ln fact, the psychological need to stay connected to the fumili3r may c3usc dients to resist the very ch3nges they 3re sedcing. For example, 3 client may verbalize a strona desire to curb drinking, but foil to engaJ;c with aarced.-upon goaJs or 3ction plans to work t0\\'3rd th3t pl]. Clients may be ambivalent about ch3nge and the risks 3nd fears of chanJ;c may cancel any momentum tO\\>ard 3ction. Active listcnina. particularly empathy, reduces or prevents resistance. Other counse.llor responses may increase it. These include the follo"'ina: ■ Arauing for change ■ Assuming the expert role ■ Critic.i!ina. shaming, or blaming ■ L3belling ■ Being in a hurry ■ Claiming pre-eminence ("I know what is best for you") (Miller & Rollnic.k, 2002, p. 50) By pa)ting attention to diem resist3nce, counsellors can e.x3mine how the.ir o"'n responses miaht contaminate the intervic"', and what they might do differently to prevent, ncutrali!e, or reduce resistance. SUCCESS TIP Newton's third law of motion states that for eiJety action lhem is an ec:::iua1 and opposite reaction. Resistance is lhe equal and opposite madion thal happens when clients feel pressumd or coerced. CounsellOrS need to monitor and reduce the.' tespon~ thal are aceeler-ating resistance while incmasing responses that reduce 11. Signs of Resistance Resistance may reveal itse1f in a variety of ways, rangina from oven hostility to passivity that impedes the work. Herc are some client beha\tiours and signs that m3y suagest rcsist3ncc(Cormicr & H3ckney, 2008; Gl3ddina& Alderson, 2012; Miller & Rollnick, 2002, 2013; and Shulman, 2009). I . Failure to comply with the basic procedures of counselling, including keeping 3ppointment~ being on time, 3nd pa)•ing fees. 2. Hostile or argumentative st3tcments (c.a., "This is a \\'3Ste of time," "You can't make me cooperate," "That's none of 't'OUr business.," and "I don't "'3nt to be here"). 3. Passivity (e.g., silence, withholding information, persistent short responses such as "I don't know," extreme self-censorship of ideas and feelinas)--such passivity may indicate th3t the client does not want to be there, or it m3y mean that the feelings, content, and ch3Jlenges of the interview are more than the client is willina or 3ble to face. 4. Diversion as a \\"ll't' of avoidina difficult, rhreatcnina, or incrimiMring content (e.g., chanaina the subject, using excessive humour, making sm3lJ t3lk, inrroducina irrelevant m3teri3I, being overly talk3tivc, intellcctua1i!ina. and restrictina the conversation to parricul3r topics). 236 Chap1er 8 5. Uncoopc.rativc behaviour (e.g., failure to follow through with plans or homei.vork, foJsc promises). 6. Subtle unde.rminina (e.g., acting seductivcJy, nnemptina to redefine the counsdlina relationship as a friendship. uccssive praisina. being sarcastic). 7. Creating the illusion of ,vork, described by Shulman (2009) as cngnging in convcrsa, tions that appear important but that in reality are empty and hnvc no real meanina bcc:.mse they do not cmpO\\•er cliems to change. 8. Nonve.rbal cues suagcsting a passive-aggressive response, such as not making e\'C contact, foldina arms. sitting on the edge of the SC11.t, using an nngry tone of \'oice, clenching fists, raising eyebrows, fl"O\\•ning, and sighing. 9. Blaming, malcina excuses, and expressing unwillingness to chnnae. Understanding and Responding to Resistance Some Resistance ls Normal and Desirable Counsellors do not have to view all resistance as problematic. Skilled counsellors rccoanizc resistance, but they are fl()( threatened b\• it. They see resistance as a sianaJ that clients' defences are cngngcd, and this insiaht opens a pathway to greater unde.rstandina of their clients. For example, in the beginning phase of counscllina, before trust and a working contract are ncgoti• atcd, mnny clients tend to hold bade. At this stage, their counsellors arc srrangers, and it would be unwise for clients to open up too quickly without lcnowina how precious personaJ information might be treated. Shenfor nnd Horejsi (2008) note that it is common for clients to be somewhat defensive, particularly in the bcginnina phase when a person's naruraJ resistance to change can be trigi;crcd by fear of what lies ahead: "Even a smnJI amount of change can create a discomfort or fca.r for clients, cspccinJI)• if they hold riaid beliefs. are inflexible in their thouaht processes and behaviors, or arc fearful about risking change in the.ir relationships with others" (p. 205). Some clients resist because they do not understand the expectations or the process of counselling, so they wisely remain cautious and guarded. Until relation• ship contracting estab lishes the gonJs and purpose of the work, clients may hold back from fully pan-icipating. CounseJlors also need to be explicit regarding their expectations. They should not assume that what is obvious to them will nJso be obvious to the.ir clients. SUCCESS TIP Help clients unclefSland how anxiety and ambivalence abOut change may c,eate more anxiety wtlid'I sabOtag,es action plans, then use anticipatory conttaeting to sttategjle hO'N this can be addtessed. Resistance and the Stages of Change The '""ll< of change modcl (ProdUlska & Norcros~ 2001) was introduced in Chapter 7 as a modcl foe unde.rstanding the developmental nature of change. Different skills and strategies nre used to cn~c clients durina diffe.rcnt srog:cs. For example, clients who arc at the precomemplativc stage of change do not accept that they ha\'e a problem and arc noc thinking about making c.han~ e\'en though their behaviour is problematic for them and others. At this srog:e, stratejpes such as confrontation ro push a client tml"-ard change arc likely to be met with resistance, bur other stratejpes (ca., open questions and empathy) will help to ncutrali.!c the resistance. Some clients who arc precontemplarivc hold ro their current mode of thinking, feeling. and actina because thq• lack the cne.rg)• necessary for change, or because they nre pessimistic about the possibility of change. Whate\'er the reason, these clients resist counselling because it is casie.r and safc.r than cmbracina change. Counsellors might deal with this resistance b\• OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clients 237 communicating optimism and by helping clients set small but achi,ei,-nblc: g,ools. By supporting and rc:.inforcing smaJI successes, counsellors contribute to the emp<:M·c:m'litm of the.ir dim.ts. Hcmrevcr, during this proc~ counsc:llors should express empathy rcgnrding the cha.Jleng:es and fears associated with any chani;c:. Oients nttd to unde.rscand that they will 00( be humiliated or ovc:rwhdmed b\• the demands of counsclling. Counselling can be presented as a way for them to find d"K" resources, suppon-, and motivation for change At the contemplative srog:e, dim.ts arc ambivalent about the change process and may simultaneously desire and resist efforts and opportunities for change, "even when such action is counterproductive and dysfunctional" (Gladding & Alderson, 2012, p. 141). The messai;c:s from clients seem to say, "I want to change, but I don't want to change." This ambivalence: can frce!c: clients in a state of indecision; and the resolution of ambiwlc:ncc: is the key to change (Mille.r & RoUnidc, 2013). Even for those clients who arc highly m()(ivatcd to change, the prospect of changing involves risk; risk creates anxiety, and the simplest way to reduce anxiety is avoidance. From this perspective, resistance: is viewed as selfproto:ti,e. To rc:solvc ambivalc:nct in favour of change. the benefits of change must ourn't'iJC'l the risks and anxiety associated with change, or anxiety regarding chani;c: must bt reduco:J. SUCCESS TIP Openly extifessed resisiance from a client can be a weat opportunity fof felationship building and goal setting If it leads to frank discussion of (~ expectations, barriers, and fears. Relationship Issues Somc:timesdic:nts become increasingly resistant as counselling psychological reac:tance: TIie teadeaq for peopleto iflttiSe problea behavicu if t!ley bEIM thei fie«tim is threatened. Dis lkory can help us •d.f~and -.fly uiging by COIICfflled triffids and family mayh.Ma pa.radcaical effec.1. progresses. This mn't' signa] that the process is moving too quickly or that there is unrc~ solved conflict in the counsellor- client relationship. Clients ma,., be resistant because of transference renc:tions or simply because they do 00( feel a good connection with their counsellors. Resistance may emerge when counseJlors chaJlenge long•c:stablished behaviours or attempt to encourage: discussion or goal setting in areas that clients would like to avoid. Miller and Rollnick (2002)dc:vc1opc:d the theory of psyc.holos:ical rcac.tance to describe how painful consequences (e.g., personal suffering from drug addiction, nagging from concerned family members) may actually increase the undesired behaviour. This thtory predicts "an increase in the rate and attractiveness of a 'problem' behaviour if a person pe.rcc:ivc:s that his or her personal freedom is being infringed or changed'' (p. 18). Some clients have dealt with the social service system for many years and sometimes their whole lives. They ha\'t' had many o:peric:nces with socinJ worke.r~ ps)•chiatrists, foster homes, counsellors, and the criminal justice system, which have shaped their expectations. Frequently, they have had bad c:xpe.ric:ncc:s with helping professionals or other persons in authority, and they fear the same outcome again. For example, if they expe.ric:nced othe.r counsellors as rude or unrrustworthy, they may be guarded with new workers. This defense protects them from furthe.r rudc:nes~ inconsistency, or breach of trust. Armed against the counsellor before they even meet, these clients may view caring as manipulative and empnthy as intrusive. Asking nbout prior o:peric:nces hclps to bring feelings and issues into the open, including any preconceptions or fears about the current relationship. \\:lhen counsellors do this, they shoukl provide: a brief explanation to let the.ir clients know they arc not prying for gossip: CounS(>IJOr. H::1:"e )'Ou had 311)' other e-xpedences with eounsie1!1~ in the p.,n! C lient: Yes, 11\)' h uslxlnd and I went for marital rounsellin¥ about 1wo yearS :lK(). CounS(>IJOr. \V~t dkl )'Ou like and dislike ::ibout that e,:pedenee} 1'1n 2ski~ beeau.u I think it will help me to un.derStand 2 bit about your eicpeetatiorn1. I'd like to learn what v;·orked for )'OU 2nd wh::1:t d,dn't. 238 Chap1er 8 Resistance may also dcvdop because of conflict in the current rcJntionship. Counselling rcfation.ships, like all rcfotionships, a.re subject to periodic stress and conflict. Counsellors cnn make mistakes and say the wrong thing, and they can offend their clients. Vulnerable clients may be ovcrh• sensitive, or they might misinterpret mes.sages and fed ang,crcd. This is an inevitable reality of the chemistry of human encounters. h's a.I.so rruc that resistance may have origins that beg3n long before the current relationship. Man)' clients have had negative cxpc.riences that leave them suspicious and doubtful about the wluc of yet another encounter with someone representing the system. \Vhac sets effective counsellors a.part is chc.ir ability to be sensitive to clues such as verbal and nonvc.rbal shifts in the tone of the interview that signal that there is friction in the relationship. Effective counsellors arc further distinguished by their willingness and capnc:it)• to address these issues with nondefen.sive caring, By doing so, they not only prevent furthc.r resistance but they also build trust and understanding with their clients. Immediacy was introduced in Chapter 3 of this book as a process for exploring. dttpcning, and evaluating counselling rcfotion.ships. \Vhen resistance blocks the work of counselling, immediacy provides a way to deal directly with diem concerns rcgnrding the counselling process or the rcJntionship itscJf. As a rule, if resistance is increasing. it is wise to deal dirccth• with it; ochc.rwise, the client ma)' never return. The following questions and statements illustrate the potential variety of responses that can be used to move the interview to,\--a.rd a discussion of resistance: ■ How do you fed about be.ing here! ■ I'm wondering what's happening between us. Arc you feeling angry toward me! ■ Let's Stt if we cnn agree on what we want to accomplish. ■ lf J'm not mistaken, every time I mention your father you change the subject. \Vould 't'OU rather avoid that topid ■ How committed arc you to making changes? ■ Do you believe it is possible for 't'OU to chan,;c? ■ \Vhat does it mean to you to be scc.ing a counsellor! ■ Arc you worried chat 1 will cry to force )'OU todo something you don't want todo! \Vhcn nonverbal cues sug,;cst resistance (e.g., lack of eye contact, single word an.swc.r~ crossed arms, and abrupt tone), counsellors miaht try "breaking the ice" with statements such a~ "ff I fdt forced to come to counselling, I think I'd fed quite resentful." Shulman (2009) comments on the fact that communication is frequently indirect in that feelings and concerns are expressed in ways that might not be immediately clear. Such indirect communication challenges counsellors to understand what clients might be trying to SU)' behind the words expressed. For example, a client who asks whether a worker has children may be communicating her fcnr that a childless worker might not understand her struggles. By picking up on the question behind the question, workers create an opportunity to explore these fears. Similar indirect communication might be embedded in clients' questions such as these: ■ Have you e-.-cr been in jail! ■ Do you know what it is like to be on welfare? ■ Have you used street drugsl Table 8.1 presents alternative ways of responding to personal questions such as those mentioned earlier. Resistance and Fear of Change For most people, it is difficult to change from established routines and ''"-a.ys of coping. They communicate fears regarding the imagined consequences of change through resistance. Some clients have trouble with intifl'IOC)•, and OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-10- Reacll Clients 239 TABLE 8.1 Five Choices for Respondi ng to Personal Questions Client! 00 )'OU "3ivt Child11n? 1. Answer 100 ciuestion: Mt dO not have any ch'iklren.• 2. Uptore 100 meaning of 100 ciuestion: Ml'm cu(k)US abOut your reasons for ask.-ig.• 3. Uptore 100 implication ot different answe-rs: ·what would it mean 10 you if you heard that I don't have any d'ltldreo?" or if you heard that I have d'lldreo?" 4. Empathy: "Are you pemaps wonted lhat I might not underStand what it's like f0t you. a single mom with rwo kids?· 5. Silence: Provides an opportunity foe the client to elaborate and perhaps share concerns and feelings associated Viith the ciuestion. M • • • counselling may be seen as an unwanted intrusion that thre3tens their need to maintain persona] distance and privac.,, A variety of counsellor responses might be considered: ■ Candid discussion with clients about the.ir fears and the reaJ risks of change. ■ Target small but achievable goals. ■ Empathi:e with the clients' fears. ■ Reassure clients that they will n()( be pushed beyond their capacity and that they are in control of the pace of change. ■ Limited counsellor self-disclosure to nonnali:e fcars about change. Resistance and Personal Beliefs Some clients are resistant because they believe that taking help is a sign of weakness. They may belie,rc that counselling will undermine their persona] autonomy. For others, culturnJ or familinJ values promote privacy about one's pe.rson:.d struggles and the belief that they should 00( be shared with stranJ;ers. One Wtt)' for counsellors to address this resistance is to look for appropriate opportuni.. ties to reframe counseJling as a sign of strength rather than feebleness. CounseJlors can also deal with fcars about loss of independence by making sure that clients are active and informed partners in the wo rk of counselling. Involuntary Clients and Resistance Sometimes resistance stems from clients' resentment at being forced to come for counselling and an inab ility to see a need for change. These clients may see themselves as fighting "the system," and the counsellor who represents it. Jnvoluntary clients typically receive services from large bure:mcraric organi.!ations, but the structure and procedures of these agencies can make it d iff,cult for counsellors to suppon the.ir clients. Systems designed to help clients may overwhelm them with rules and regulations. and counsellors often have to make troubling decisions on how to use their SOl.«:e resources and time. It is important that counsellors understand how clients ma,., percei,rc them. Johnson and Yanka (2004) remind us that clients may overestimate the extent of a worker's power. \\:'hen clients assume counscUors have more power than they acrually ha,rc, they might withhold information, avoid mcetin~ or otherwise resist counselling: therefore, frank discussion of roles. responsibilities. and dlC' limits of p,0\\tC.r may assist in clients' fears. With imoluntary clients, it is important to restore their sense of control and right to self-determination. These clients need to be able to answer the question "What can counselling do for me!" They need to see go3Js and outcomes that they desire as opposed to those imposed on them. Counsellors need to be patient with unwilling di,. ents by rem3ining nonjudgmental and ca.ring. Moreover, they can decrease resistance by demonstrating their ability to talk calmly with their clients about their re3sons for not wanting to be there. Counsellors should be especially diligent about informing unwilling clients about their rights, includ ing the limits of confidentiality. Cfe3r, succinct statements about these issues will help to reduce the.ir suspicions. 240 Chap1er 8 The brain is wired to keep us safe. Ne-ut'31 patl'wtays over timetesult rn Mhacd wited" ways of thinki~ 0r dci~. Em::>tiooal teactions to risk tald~, changi~ behaviout, Or feeling presSlXed by others may be ex.perienced as threats to tne comfOrt of the siatus quo. This c,eates anxiety aoout change. even when lhe d'langes are soon by clients as gOOd and oosirable. The brain reduces this anxiety by avoiding the change or creati~ pressure to reverl to famtliat patterns, thus, sabOtaging the change. Significantty, some of this anxiely may be dis~ ced as resistance or ange-r towatd counset.lOl'S, eve-n when clients are wilting parttlers in the Objective to change. CounsellOr'S can help by assisting clie-nts to anticipate and plan for the natural an.x.ie-ty associated with modifying established patterns. Sometimes cou nsello rs C3n modify expectations throuWl re.framing. The follo"'ing interview excerpt provides a b rief illustration: Cou nselto r: What do )-Ou hope to :te.hie-.,e! Client: Kothin i, Cou nsello r: What' s behind th:u answer! Client: I Ju st think th at eounsellin K is 2 waste o( t ime. W h::u iood does it do to talk 2bout problems 2n)•way! Cou nsello r: You :Uso seern to be s:ayina th::u i( eounsellina could in some W'3)' help )'OU with your p roblems,. rou would be tn<Ke s::ttisf",ed. Client: I iueti so. (n Cha pte r 7, " rolling "'ith resistance" "'as introduced as a way to avoid an)' direct ch nJlengcs that might p r«ipitate a power struggle. This strategy ide ntifies bu t accepts the resistance. This approach is illu strated as fo llows: Client: I Ju st think th at eounsellh,i is 2 waste o( t ime. W h::u iood does it do to talk 2bout problems 2n)•way! Counse!Jor. Gn'en your pessimism . it seems t'O 1ne t~t you 're wi.se to be eau oous 3bout w~t we mi$:ht aeromphsh here. The following story pro\•idcs anoth er example: A hol)• man and an athe.ist met o ne dar. The 2theisc ehal!ena«( the ho!y rnan to deb.1te, exd:1ilnll1i, "I don't beUe-,,e in God!" TI,e holr nun replied. " Tell me about the God you don't belie\~ in... TI,e atheist talked :lt l ~ h about the2bsu n:I W'3rSth ::u h::.d been (ou~h t in the name o( God. H e m :M':ked the "hypoerites" who espoused their reliaious values 2nd belie(s but beha..,ed in q uite the opposite fashion. TI,e holy man hstened p.,tiendy until th e atheist h::.d sakl his pieee. Onl)• then d,d he respon d: "You and I h ave 2 lot in eomrnon. I don't beUe-,,e in that God either... Figure 8 .1 o udincs some counsello r responses that both incrc3se resistance and d«rc3se resistance. Resistance and Counsellor Self-Awareness Cou nseJlors should monitor a nd manage their own emotional rcoctions to resistance. C lient resistance can be u nsettling and demoralizing, and it can test almost any counsellor's ability to be- nonjudgmental. Common co u nseJlo r rc3ctions include fo3.r, anxiety, avoidance, defensiveness, anger, pessimism, and a sense of r~jection. Counsellors ma y tu rn against their client~ b lame them fo r their problems. and look for "'ays to rder them to another counsellor. (n response, clients ma y v iew their counsellors' defensive reactions as proof thnt the situation is hopeless. Thu~ it is important that cou nsello rs find wa)'S to d eper sonalize OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reac h Clients 24 1 Rnponses Tllat lncttase Resistance -Unsolicited advice - Pushing for change - Pre.aching. moralizi~ and b lamWt.g - Argui ~ and warning - Powe, struggles and defensive res,ponses - Judging 11.!sponses Tllat Decrease 11.!sistance - Empathy - Nondefensive responses/open mind - Genuineness and respect - Rolling with resistance (see glossary} - Reflective res,ponses - Strengths approach -Radical acceptance (see glossaty} Figure 8.1 Resistance CONVERSATION 8.1 COUNSEllOR: You Ya(lr'k, With stroot-ir'WOtved youth. What have you leamed about working with invduntary clients.? YOUTH COUNSULOR: I learned the ha(d way dOeSn'I work. r oom's no point in lecluring, mol'aliziog. Or' p(eachi~ abOut lhe dange-rs of dfugs. What seems to work bes.I is to focus on lhe mtationship. COUNSELLOR, How dO you dO that? YOUTlt COUNS£LLOR: Somelmes it's just little thk,gs. lil<e bring- a ing a cup coffee to a sex.-trade "M.er, Or' cheeklr'lg to see If they are all '1@1\t 0t 0000 anyth;~ I t,y., be ready b- the "teacfl- able moment· That can hai:.:,en anytime, such as after' a #bad date" 0t "1len they'm Wng oo.n. Ti>!n, empathy and list,n;~ stulls are best, espedaly empath-,. Spend;~ lime voth Clients vothout r,aw,gan "agooda" goes a bng waylOward eslabHsli ~ trust When the time is ~t. you'll be the "Ill> to" person. COUNSELLOR, That's ,lghl As you know, involuntary clients can be (ebeUious, and bei~ fotced into counseni~ arouses lhei( defences. F'Ot example, I fecentty me1 with one- W'ho was refe(red by his emplOye( beeause- he could not get along with his CO-\\()rkets. He ctaiined that others i.n his wOl'k team simpty had diff!CIAty ooaH.ng with his assertive- man~ and his ~ standards. He came in to see me-. but ii was evident that his main motivation was to preser\'e- his job. With him I found that 1t worked best to encourage him to express his angerabout being told vd\at to dO. This diffused his resi:slance to the point whe(e- he- no longer- saw me as the eoomy. YOUTH COUNSEUOR: It's like that With OIS clients as weU. With youth on probation, I like to look fOr' w.rys to gNe- them powe-r and i.nvOlve lhem i.n decision maktng. Here- again, empathic listening can he-Ip lhem arrive at a plan that suits them, one that doesn't fool imposed. COUNSlliOR: So invduntary clients are n01 necessarily precontemptative. Many ar-e well awa(e- of their prOblems and the need to change. They just don't like bei~ t(:j(I what to dO, and that's the key to "«ki'lg succe-ssft.Jly with them. When I "«keel in corrections, I found that many of my clients wem initiall'f resistant and overtly hostie to authority. Oients wilh such anti..authOritarian values are not goi~ to respond to directhie, rtgi:j attempts toconuot them. St.d'I strategies will onlySeM to ircrease resislar.:e. Asalways, payi~ attention to the relatiooShip is. crucial. F'OI' example, 'lfith dients comi~ out of prison, retationShip eted1biity can be devet)pe-d btf OOlpi~ them 'lfith baSic needs_ SUCf'I as hOuSiog. d:)thes, lood, and a job. the situation. Otherwise, they run the risk of further worsening the situation by rcject.ing the client or reta1iating in subtle W'tl)'S.. CounseJlors need to be ab le to objectively evaluate their own conduct and take the.ir foir share of responsibility for resistance. \Vhen counsellors have high scJf-awarencss o f their action~ they are able to monitor themselves and change their behaviour to be 242 Chap1er 8 })!} INTERVIEW 8.1 The followi og inte,view excerpt shows some ways avoid and reduce resistance when dealing with an angry client. The client is a young male, age 19, who has been referred to an addiction c-ounsellor as a condition of his probation. It is clear from the client's nonverbal Mhaviour th.at he dOesn't want to be there (e.g.• he has not removed his coat, he gives single-wo,d or shOrt answerS to questions. and his voice tone is hOstile). Client (with angry tooe): Me we going to be hete IOOg.. I got things to do. Counsellor: I know that you wefe fofced to come here by you( probation office(. I'm wondering hON you feel abOut 1h31. Client: I' m teally not in the mood to be cros.s~mioed. Counsellor: Of coul'Se-. you a(e free to leave at any ,:dnt. But be:fofe you do, why 000·1 we take a moment to talk Slr'aighl. Client (sal'C'Astk:'al,),'): I think lhis is al crap. It makes no sense. What's lhe JX)inl? Counsellor: I appreciate youf honesty. Client: I'm here, so let's get lhis done. Counsellor: It sounds like you've been through lhis befO(e, and it didn't wOl'k out. Client: Yep! More Ihan once. Counsellor: If you want, I'd be hapP'f 10 listen 10 what went wro~. Client: I'm lited of people tryi~ to control my life. Counsellor: Fait enough. We agree. You don't want to be cross-examined. and I cSon't intend to try. You don't have to tel me abOut anything you d0n'I want to Ialk aoout. Client: Let's get one thing clear. I do 001 nOOCI you( permission to do anything. Counsellor: Ag(eed. But since you have decided to stay, let's talk. If you'te feeling angry because yotX prObation officet ltlinkS you ooed counselling, I can undel'Sland. I s...-e do not like it when I'm forced to do something against my v.ill. Cllent: It's noI you. I just don't see the point. There's n01hing wro~ with me. I don't undel'Slancl why I have 10 come here. Counsellor: Souncts as if you reatly want to star\CI up and say, "Thisi:smy life. 8uttou1.· Client: Yeah. What gives tnem the right to say I'm ctazy? Counsellor: Aocl now that you're hem, you might be wottied that l'lldo the same thing, That I will try to get into you( Mad. tell you what to do. Analysis: The client's oPening comment clearly communlcbtes his ,es/stance in a way that should not be Ignored. Analysis: At th;s Point, the counselk:Jt needs to conuot her own emotional response to ensure that she does not become defensive, a response that would almost certainty Increase resistance. lnsJe.ad, the counse/10t encourages the client to say more about his feellngs. The counsel/Or reminds the client that he does have a coo;ce about whether to stay or go, which ls designed to give him back some of the power he feels he has lost. Analysis: Use of "rad;ca1 acceptance" (see Chapter 7). The counsellor II/es to find a point of agreement, but her respanse ls greeted by m0te anger. At this point, it ls Important that the counsel/Or not give up. Even though the client's respanse Is less than Ideal. he has heard what the counsellor said. The counsellor needs to remain calm, patient. and empathic. This will give the client an Of)p()ttunity to sp/11 out some of his anger, which often helps to soften it. Analysis: The client's earlier statement that he ..doesn't want to be cross-e.umlned" Is a good ind/c.ation that it might be w;se, at least at this paint. to avoid directly questioning the client. Questions would be inapp,o,:,,iate In this interview. The counsellor proc.eeds, while trying to honour the client's need for autonomy and control. Analysis: The counsellor contlnue.s to honour the client's right to self-determination and autonomy. Analysis: The counsellor continues to ..roll with ,es/stance. " The counsellor tries to ally herself with the client by using setfd;sc1osure to encourage him to talk about h;s res;stance. She emphbSizes that the client has made choices. Analysis: The counsellor's persistence wo,-ks, as the client begins to open up. At this paint, it Is Important for the counsellor to avoid becoming defensive. If she starts to "sell" her client on the merits of counselling, she may lose him. Analysis: An inferred empathic response .acknowledges the client's feelings. Analysis: Cautiously. the client begins to share his feelings, Including his reservations about what will happen In the relationship. Analysis: The counsel/or uses immediacy to verbalize the client's central concern, which the client has expressed lmf)l/c.itly. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clients 243 >» INTERVIEW 8.1 Dealing with Resistance <cont;nue) ClleM: Of coufse. Isn't that how it wor'ks? 1have been to counseling before. (Laughs.) You guys a,en'I hap~ unleSs you're mucidng someone up. Analysis: Despite his initial resolve to 1<1tep his distance from the counsellor, the client Is beginning to connect. He Is seeing the counsellor as less of a thieat. counsellor: (Laugt'ISJ Well. we have to Shrink our ciuota of heads. ClieM: (Laughs.) My Mad is staying just where it is.. ,:,o,t while Analysis: A little humour from the counsellor helps build rapshOwlng empathy with the clfent 's feelings. The counsellor's humour affirms he,- ability to talk about the issues without becoming defensi've. However. when using humour timing is cdtlcat. What WOrlts very v'le/1 in one situation might result in disaster in another. counsellor: I am impressed that you're able to say what you want ClleM: I do not believe in playing games. Analysis: The counsellor does not attempt to break down her client's defences, which are helping this client cope with a threatening situation. Instead, she reframtfS his stance as a strength. counsellor: Me neitnet. So. let's talk abOut Vtt\at you'd like to see happen here. I wdl need some help from you. And if it's okay with you, 111share some of my ideas. ClleM: I guess so. It is not like I have a chOice. I've seen dozens of social wor'kerS in my lite. They alt talked a good game, but it didn't hell:) me one bit! How tS this going to be any difte(en1? Analysis: There is much wo,k to be done to establlsh a solid working relationship with this client. The counsellor's responstfS allow the process to move forward, but her manner gives the client some much-needed cont.rot and power. Asking far the client's help about process and direction is very empowering. An imp0rtant beginning has been established. Reflections: ■ How ml&Jlt tllls lnttrvlew have evolved diffttentfy It tbe counsellor bad used questlonin1 as her main tool for Inquiry? ■ What are SOftle ot tbe personal feelings you ml&Jlt need to control if you were tbe counsellor In Uds scenario? ■ How can you approach clients wt,o have bad muldpte " bad,. experiences with counstllOrs or others In the soclal se-rvice ■ system? How would you respond to tile cllent's last question...How b tllls goin1 to be any different? more effective. Hill (2004) echoes sentiments from mtmy sources with the simple yet profound 3dvice to counsellors to "respond to client 3n,;cr as they would to 3ny other emotion" (p. 417). Counsellors can use colleagues and supervisors for support when dc3Jing with highly resistant clients, who can tax the patience of even the most do:lic3ted counsel.. lor. CollcginJ support c3n help counsellors unwind from tough sessions. They c3n help counsellors to be more objective, or they can be 3 source of fresh ideas for rc3ching difftc:ult clients. CONFRONTATION: PROCEED WITH CAUTION M3ny people associate confrontation with conflict and hostility, an association arising from the fact th3t confront3tion often comes from frustration or anger. For counsellor~ dfective confrontation is not 3 hostile 3ct. Confrontation is simply a way of directing clients' attention to 3spects of their personality or behaviour that they might othcnvise overlook. 1t is a tool to move clients to a higher level of understanding of themselves and others. Moreover, caring confrontation can d«pcn the level of trust in the counselling relationship. It is nJso a m3jor skill for helping clients dcvclop fresh pe.rspcctives on 244 Chap1er 8 CONVERSATION 8.2 STUDE:NT: What are someways tos:¥y Mno• toc~nts? I feally hate 1t wtlen I have 10 deny them what they want o r ~. TEACHER: That is my reacti::)n too. None of us in lhe hefpi~ professions wants to be seen as harsh or uncaring. Saying Mno• may evoke feelr'lgs of gull in us. as well as stro~ negative re.actions from our clients.. We realy ooed to be able to address our own emotions as well as those ot the clW!nt. STUDE:NT: I suppose it's a realtly of the business. Sometimes we have to make tough decisions, suctl as who gets the training money and who qualifles for assistanice. In the tesiclential part of the protJam wtlete I wOl'k, we often have to say no when the klds want exceptbns to then.des. No pto~m when you're able to give them what they want. But vd\at about wtlen you have to turn oown reciuests? TEACHER: Even when you're sayi~ Mno: it's important lhat clients kOON you cam. You ooed to istan and be available to respond with empathy and compassion. fk'ld a way to ShOw you understand. even if you are no1 able to give yout clients what they want. Or see If there rS a way to compromise to help yout dient save face. What do you think? STUDE:NT: I have teamed a couple of thi~. Be ditecl, deat, and brief. Don't waffle, hrll, Or' a\'Oid 1he ·oottom line.· With lddS, I've found that, even wtlen they test lhe limits, they may need limits and even welcOl"OO them when imposed. It increases lheit se~ of safety and control when they learn the bOundaries of acceptable behaviout. TUCHER: I agree. I think it is important that you dOn't make a hasty tetreat. Expect that anger, defensiveness, and countetattaek ate the ways that some clients tespond to frustratbn. In extr'etne situations., you need to protecl youtself. Anticipate potentially violent situations and take defensive action. Also, be s....-e to debfaef with a colleague or superviSOr' after difflellt encount-el"S. And if ~ssary, take a tl'eak 10 e~ute that yout teacrions do not contaminate yout abdity to deal with your next client objectively. Flnall'j, remind yourself that no mattet how yout client teac1s, you must stay in a professional role. ST\JOENT: woon someone says ·no· to me, I find it a IOt easier 10 accepr it if I koow why. So, I try to explain my tationale or the policy. Then I invite questio~ while remaining clear 'llf'len the policy is nonnegotiable. TEACH£R: If you can, help your clients identify othet ways to meet theit needs. themselves and the.ir behaviour. Neverthcless., it is a skill that should be used sparingly and with caution. As a ,;eneral rule, confrontation has the greatest chance of success when clients accept it as part of the counseJling contract. Types of Confrontation The rw-o main types of confrontation arc feedback confrontation and confrontation of incongruities. Feedback c.onfronrarion provides new information to clients about who they are, including how thq• are pe.rcci\'ed b)• others and the effects of their behaviour on others. Feedback confrontation can be used to hcJp clients become aware of the consequences of their decisions and actions. It is not reserved for ncg:itivc or c.ritical feedback; it can also be used to identify strengths. ln some case~ clients do not rccogni!e the hnrmful effects of their behaviour on themselves and others. They continue to behave in ways that are hurtful, yet they lack insight into how they arc affecting others. Because they are unaware and fail to sec the.ir behaviour as problematic, they have no motivation to chan,;c. Feedback confrontation can hcJp these clients examine the consequences of their actions. The following arc examples of client blind spots: ■ feedback confrMtalion: Used to prom!~ informatiln to tli!alsabol!II who they are. iflduding ha# they al! peaiwd by octiiers ud the effects d tileir bebl'iour 011 others. Jerry thinks of himself as humorou~ but he is unaware that his jokes are offensive and sexist. ■ Nathan has b3d breath and body odour. ■ Parvindcr is unaware of how his aagrcs.sive behaviour pushes others away. ■ Estelle has bttn in a series of rclntionship.s in which she has been batter~. She does not understand how this has affected her children. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clien ts 245 Despite its potential power 3S 3 helping tool, focdb3clc confrontation is often mis.used. Some counsellors 3Void it, perh3ps because they foar that they might alien3te their clients or arouse their ange.r. Other counsellors feel the need to keep the hcJping rd3tionship pleasant, so they distort or lie to clients to sustain their 3pproval; howeve.r, effective counsellors need to be willing 3nd able to confront clients when ncces.s3ry. Thus, counsellors must re.main aw-arc of their beliefs, fears, and expectations regarding confrontation to use this skill 3ppropriatdy. Sometimes beginning counsellors (and some experienced ones too) arc reluctant to confront. They ma)' hold beliefs such as the following, which potenti3lly limit their effectiveness: confrontation of ir1COf'CRJities: US!d to point «11 incoosiM•iesiu client's wfbal and nofl\'elbal aessaies. wlues « beliefs. and behlriour. ■ "I was brought up to believe th3t if you don't have something good don't s3y anything 3t all." ■ "If I confront, 1 might damai;e the relationship. I don't want to upset mydient.s." ■ "I don't want to hurt my clients." ■ "My clients might retaliate." to SU)', then Yet most of the preceding beliefs 3rise from an erroneous unde.rstanding of confrontation as 3 "no holds ba.rrcd" assault on clients. As.saufo-typc confrontation strate~ gies should, of course, be avoided. At the othe.r extreme, refraining from confronting clients under any circumstance is 3n evasion of responsibility that cuts clients off from the potential benefits of new information and focdbaclc. Competent counsellors should not withhold potentially useful feedback. The second type of confront3tion, confrontation of inconiruities 0vey, Jvey, & z3foquctt, 2010), is directed at inconsistencies 3nd mixed mes.sages: ■ Discrepancy between a client's verbal 3nd nonverbal messai;es. Client: (Crying.) It'll really nothifl$:.. I'm not bothered. ■ Discrepancy between a client's values or beliefs 3nd bch3viour. Client: There' s nothi~ more important IO me than my 1:...-.ls. I know I h:wen't spent much tin-.e with them. It' s just $0 h3rd to !lay no to my buddus when tlltyuk me 10 help. ■ Discrepancy between wh3t a diem s3ys 3nd what he or she docs. C lient: I'm ronunitted to l0<>kh)¥ (or v.-'Ork. Yesterd3)' sornethil)¥ eaine up before I could ~-et to the emplorrnent omee. In confronting discr~pancies, counsellors need to re.main calm 3nd nonjudgmental while presenting clients with facts. Ivey, Ivey, 3nd 231:.lquett (2010) look at confront3• tion as 3 way to support clients in a gentle and respectful manner rather th3n 3 h3rsh c.h3lleni;e. Its purpose is to 3id clients to h3\-e a more complete understanding by offering additional inform3tion or perspective. 1t opens up new possibilities for changes in thinking and behaving. The Misuse of Confrontation Although confrontation has potential for motivating clients to change and can assist clients in dcvcJoping insight, misuse of confrontation can be destructive. As a rule, counsellors should use it sparingly 3nd should be prepared to offer support and c3ring to ensure that confront3tion does not overwhelm or dcvast3te their clients. There are risks to confrontation, 3nd some diems do react poorly. They ma,., respond with hostility 3nd 3ttempt to question the integrity or credibility of the counsellor. Such a hostile renction m3y be 3 type of denial, indicating that the diem is simply not read)• to 3clcnowlcdi;e the va.lidit)' of the confront3tion. Hostile renctions arc more lilcdy to occur when foedb3clc or confront3tion is unsolicited, but they may 246 Chap1er 8 occur even whc:n dic:nts nppc:3r to be seeking informntion or feedb3clc. Counsellors aJso nttd to consider that harsh dic:nt rc:3ctions may arise for legitimate re3sons. Somc:times fc:edb3ck is confusina or the manner and cone: of the: counsellor are abrupt. Secure: counsellors have: to be opc:n to the possibility that they may have erred. Confrontation is not an oudct for n counsellor's anger or frustration. \\:fhen counsellors are not in control of their own fceJings, dic:nts are more lilcc:ly to view them as agg:rc:ssivc: and to fc:el che.ir confrontation is unsupportive. The: counselling reJntionship is formed to mttt the: needs of clients., and responsible counsellors forgo thc:ir own needs to this c:nd. In addition, counsellors should be: se.lf-aware enough to know che.ir reasons for wanting to confront. Ovc:rly confrontational stylc:s have bc:c:n found to rc:sult in a hiah diem dropout rate and poor outcomes. "Counsel in a directive, confrontational mannc:r and client resistance aoes up. Counsc:l in a reflective:, supportive manner, and rc:sistancc: goc:s down while: change tallc incre3sc:s" (Miller & Rollnic.k, 2002, p. 9). Ultimatc:ly, "the: manner in which we prc:sent confrontations affects the way thc:y are hC3rd and accepted or rejected by the client" (Spc:rry, Carlson, & Kjos, 2003, p. 120). SUCCESS TIP "Oo n01 confront another- perSOrl if you do not wish to inc:rease your tnvolvemi:mt wdh that indh,iduar (Hamaellek, 1982, p. 230). Principles for Effective Confrontation Principle Number 1 Unsolicitc:d confrontation cc:nds to result in resistance:, hostiLity, and dc:fc:nsivcnc:ss, but solicited (invited) feedback is more: likeJ,., to be: accept~. The skill of anticipatory contractina can be used to engaae clic:nts in acceptina fttdback, CounselJor. One of the wa)'!I I rni~t be abte to help is br s.h3rin& sorne of tn)' impressions :.bout wh::u )'Ou 3re <loin¥, or e"en about our rt.l3tionship. \\1 h3t do )'Ou think! Client: Sure. I would 2pprtti.:ue that. CounselJor. \Veil, let's look ahead. Suppose I wanted t'O t hee )'Ou sorne feedback about son~hifl¥ I thou~,t you v.--ere <loin¥ wron¥ th::u )'OU were noc aware of. \Vh:n would be the best way {or me t'O 2pprooch rou! Client: I do 1101 like to be O\"erwheln~. And I like th e ~ mixed with the bad. This example shows how contracting can be: used to hclp the counsellor "custom,i:e" feedb3ck to mttt the needs and expectations of the client. Some: clients like blunt fttdback; othc:rs prefc:r it "sandwiched" bc:twcen positive statc:ments. AnticiP3tory contracting empowc:rs dic:nts and communicatc:s respect for their rights to malcc: choices. \\:fhen confrontation is invit~, it is much less lilcc:ly to mttt with resistance. Principle Number 2 Confrontation should be: used sP3ringly and in combination with ocher skills, particularly sensitivity and empathic listc:ning. Confrontation may involve: fc:c:db3c.k thal is unsenling for clic:nts, and emp3thy reminds counsellors to remain sensitive to the impact of confrontation. In addition, counsc:llors should not confront dic:nts without assisting them to dc:vc:lop new altc:rnn,. tivcs. Confrontation should also be: measured to avoid ovc:nvhdming clients with more: informntion than they can handle:. Jde31Jy, confrontation should not unde.rminc: the: sc:lfc:steem of clients. At first, dic:nts may rc:spond defc:nsivc:ly to feedb3ck, but after re.flc:c.tion, thc:y ma,., be more accepting. Altc:rnativc:ly, they may nppC3r to be: accepting but latc:r become resc:ntful. Thus, it is important to chc:clc with dic:nts how chc:y fttl about 0iHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-10- Reacll Clients 247 the fttdba.ck or confrontation. Counsellors should monitor immediate rc3ctions. As well, checking back with the client during the next session is a u~ful tool for identifying delayed reactions and for noticing any feelings that might impair the relationship. The foUO\\,ing example illustrntes the process: CounseUor. rm wondedni how )Ou (elt 2bout our last rneetinK. Remember, I sh3rtd with you some o( my opinions about the thin,iS )Ou 2re doll,i th:u seem to d1stan« you from )Our family. Client:! 2lmost did not eome tod2y. (S1leoce.) CounseUor. Beeause! Client: I W2S emb3rr.lSS('d by what )'Ou thol¢ht o( me. Coun!l(>IJOr. You thou~t th3t I 1nleht think less o( )OU! C lient: Yes.. Coun!l(>IJOr. \VouJd )'Ou like to Ond out for sure w~t I think! C lient: Oh1y. This counsellor's strategy ~ts the staJ;c to help the client correct any distortions, and it is cruci3l for dealing with the aftcrm:.nh of confrontation. It :.dso reinforces the understanding thu any feeJings about what happens in the counselling relationship can be dealt with openly. Principle Number 3 Confront3tion should serve the goals of counselling by leading the diem to improved ways of behaving, thinking, and feeling. Relevant confront3tion alw'n)'S meets the needs of the client. Thus, it is in3ppropri.atc for a counsellor to use confrontation as a means to vent frustration, anger, or to punish clients. Counsellors can best deal with feelings related to the relationship or the work b\• using 1-st3tcments ruhe.r than trying to mask their feelings as helpful feo:lback. I-statements are assertions about personal feelings or rc3ctions that do not b lame or judge othe.rs. Instead of saying "You don't care," an ].-message would be "J feel confused when )'OU don't answer my questions." I-statements arc much less likely to cause resistance. Principle Number 4 Confrontation must be timed appropriately at a point when clients 3re ready and willing totalcc ad\.-antageof fecdb3clc and when there is a reasonab le possib ility thu feo:lbock can motivate them to change. Counsellors need to pay attention to timing and ensure thu there is a well-developed counselling relationship to support confrontation. As a rule, it is preferable to avoid strong confrontation in the beginning phase of coun~lling. Cliems are more receptive and likely to 3ccept fttdbaclc as credible when there is a relationship and di.mate of trust, when they do 00( feel insulted and misunderstood. Otherwise, they may neve.r return. Confrontation should be done as dose as possible to the relevant behaviour, events, or circumstances chat ::are being addres~. In some case~ such as when strong emotions arc clouding communication, it may be best to wait. A client's ab ility to handle confrontation is a cruci3l va.ri3b le. ff clients arc aJrcady ovcrwhclmed with feelings., con,frontation may add to their stress b ut contribute little to their ability to cope Moreover, clients who are hiahly defensive and guarded may respond poor!)• to confrontation. In such siruation~ counsellors may find it wi~ to deJay or avoid confrontation entirely. Effective confrontation is an investment in the relationship. After confronting, counsellors neo:I to be able and willing to invest ti.me to hclp their clients understand any feedb3clc. As well, counsellors must be 3Wilable to heJp clients deal with any feeJ.ings chal ma)' result from the confront3tion. Conscqucnth•, the end of a counselling inte.rvicw is J;Cnerally a poor time to confront. 248 Chap1er 8 Principle Number 5 Effective confrontation needs to be specific without 3ttadcing the personality of the client. Coun.seltor (Choice 1--inefTecth"(' confront:ulOn): You don't ~m 3t 211 interested in w~t's h3ppeninSt he-re. I( you're too la:y t'O eare 3bout our v.-,ork. why don't )'Ou just quie (Coirnsdlor U a1tackmg and ji.dging the dknt w&hmd of/nm.a any concrde ffflloock.) Coun.se.U.or (Choice 2-more e:tTe:ct.h-e confront3t.ion): When )Ou don't show up lor 2ppointments. I wonder whether you're 2s committed to your ~"()c.11$ 3S )'Ou say )'OU are. (CoirnselJor'J ro:mmenu me linked to ipttlflc dlfflt bmadou,.) CoumeUor (Choke 3-most e:tTe<:.th·e confront:uion): I think )Our best work h::1s h::1ppened on those d3)'S when )Ou C3tne on time and when you mok the e(lort to (ocus. ?l.·ty sense is that i( )'Ou eould nuke e\'err 3ppointrnent, )'Ou·d ~'t't a lot rnore out o( our time tottether. (Counsdlor {oruseJ on u,engtM and u.fam the clfrnt can Jo tl,m u,·ill bt mtm elftttlt,e-flf!O/,/_eare motfrau-J more fry posklt" f....dbad.: 1han n~th~ /«dbad.:.) AGGRESSION AND VIOLENCE CounseJlors, social worke.rs, child care counsellors, and othe.r social service profession3fs, especi3lly those who work in residential c3re, arc increasingly vulnerable to \'lolence (Macdonnld & Sirotich, 2005, 2001; Newhill, 1995, 2003). For ex3mplc, 3 counseJlor's denial of a client's request for fin3nciaJ assistance may e-.•oke rcta1iation. Hospitals, especially emergency rooms, can be a particularly d3nj;erous pl3cc. A survey of over 9000 rcgiste.red nurses in Canad3 revenled rhat 3Jmost 40 percent had experienced some form of workplace \•iolcnce and 3bout 20 percent had been ph)•sic3lly ass3ulted (spit on, bitten, hit. or pushcd)(Canadian lnstitute for Health (nformation, 2012). A study at one private psyc.hi3tric hospit31 found that the frequency of violence by m3Jc patients was SO percent higher than a dec3de before, and that violence by fom3Je patients was ISO percent higher than a decade before (fardiff, Marzuk, Leon, Portera, & \\:leiner, 1997). One srudy (Alink, Lenneke, Euser, &ke.rmans.-Kmnenbury, & Van (J:endoorn. 2014) of worke.rs in residential care rcvca1ed th3t 81 percent experienced some type of victimization (verbal, physical, and sexual harassment) and 37 percent were subject to physical \•iolence. Situations th3t may increase counsellors' risk for violence include: ■ Dealing with people who arc using street drugs. ■ Dealing with menta11y ill people who 3re not tnlcing their mcdic3tion or mixing prescribed medication with street drugs. ■ lnvestig3ting situations of child abuse 3nd neglect. ■ (nstitutional w-ork in prisons, group homes, and hospita1s. ■ \Vork th3t includes some clements of social control (e.g., prob3tion, involuntary clients, 3nd establishing eligibility for income assistance). ■ Assisting police intervention in domestic abuse. ■ Hospital emergency work. Canadian studies by MacDon3ld & Sirotich (2001, 2005), de LCSClcuc (2004), and Rytm (2016) found the following: ■ Almost 90 percent of soci3J workers have experienced verbaJ harassment. ■ 90 percent of C3nadian front.-line residential care ,vorkers experienced physic31 \•iolence from residents (or the.ir rcfatives). ■ About 65 percent have been threatened with physic3l harm. ■ About 30 percent have been sexually h3ras.scd. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-10- Reacll Clients 249 intimidating behaviour: Beha'AOUrs such u aa.e calling: using obsce. • st1uall1 harassing lang_u.aie and g_~ures: sho~ •d tlrm1ening tkough lisplays al po-• soch as fist shaking. iMdilc personal ~ . stalking, and issuing wfbal 1-Ws. Ttles.e behlriours should be testrMled to l)fMllt escalatioo to~o!Nce. violent behaviour: ~ . pu-,:. biiing. slawing. lid.ing. th10t1ing obje::ts. •d usilc weapons such as ,.ns. lniws. or s,ringes. ■ Close to 8 percent have been physically ass3ultcd 3nd injured. ■ One-third of 31) workplace \•iolence incidems took place in soci3I service or health cnre setting~ with about 71 percent involving physicn.1 assault. ■ About SO percem of incidents were linked to substance 3busc. ■ Males were nccused in 93 percent of the 3ssnults, and 54 percent of them were under 35 years of 3gc. Sometimes clients c3usc fc3r bcc3usc their behaviour is thrc3tening, or they h3\'e a history of violem behaviour. At other times, counsellors' fears arc b3scd on intuition or hunches, the inte.rnnJ response to subtle signals thnt not all is well. Jn fact, some clients provide 3bundant reasons for fear, because of either intimidating behaviour or overtly violent acts. Intimidating behaviour includes name c3Jling, obscene or sexually hnras.sing language 3nd gestures, shouting, threatening displays of power such 3S fist sh3king, invasion of person3J sp3ce, stalking. and verbal threats. Clients also beh3ve in an intimidating m3nner when they will not take no for 30 answer or when they refuse to leave the office. As weJI, clients ma'>' attadc workers with personal insults, or they ma'>' intimid3te them with threats to call the newspaper or ch•il rights groups. Jn gen.era], intimidnting bchnviour should be controlled or manngcd to prevent escal3tion to violence. The following case ex3mplcs of threatening behaviour arc aJI b3scd on re3J incidents: ■ New client in a welfare office s3y~ "If I don't get some help. )'OU'll be sorry." ■ Man, in his lnte twenties st3.res obstinately at an inmke ,vorker. ■ Angry parent tells child protection w-orkers that if his child is not returned, the worker will know what it's like to lose someone you love. ■ Tccnai;er in a group home refuses to com pl)• with house rules. He tells his child c3re counscJlor. "I've had enough. Things arc going to change nround here." ■ Parole officer meets 3 new parolee for the first time. He is pleaS3nt 3nd cooperative, but the parole officer knows the man h3s a short fuse and a long history of ass3ult chnrges. ■ Mental health counsellor dC3Js with her client, a young m3fe with a history of self. destructive behaviour. 1t is obvious that he is not caking his medication, and he seems unusunJly agitated. ■ Ten.-year-old child who witnessed 3busc at home grabs a pair of scissors 3nd lunges tO\\>ard the counsellor. V io lent behaviour means hitting, pushing, biting, slapping. kicking, throwing object~ and using weapons such 3S guns, knives, or syringes. 1t 3fso refers to kidn3pping and st3lking.. ■ SociaJ worker in a hospital emergency ward is threatened with a syringe by 30 3ngry HIV-positive patient. ■ Angry client picks up 3 chair nnd hurls it 3t the counscllor. ■ Client, disgruntled with the counsellor's rcfus3l to provide him with money, spits in the counseJlor's face. Nonetheless., it is important thnt counsellors do not become hypc.rvigil3m 3nd con.duct their w-ork in constant fear. Such 3 Sta.nee m31ces it difficult for them to seP3rnte nctu3l h3!ards from siruations thnt present no rcnJ risk. Moreover, unw3rramed fear of clients leads to uninformed responses. Though very real dangers exist in the workplace, 250 Chap1er 8 by and large it is a pince of safety. The challenge is to be able to answer some basic questions: ■ \Vhich clients are likdy to become violent! \Vhat arc the indicators of potential \•iolence! ■ Under what conditions should a client's anger be cause for concern? ■ \Vhat are the skills and behaviours that can be used to de-escalate dangerous situations! SUCCESS TIP Anget, when ex,:itessed assertively, rS a n0tmal and potentlalt, useful part of retationShip communication. Assertive anger' respects the tigt\ts, obligations, and feeh.ngs of setf and others. /1€gressive anget k\volves intimidation, misuse of po-Her, and disr'especl fOr' Olhel'$. Risk Assessment for Violence Violence arises from a complex array of psychological, sociaJ, biologicaJ, and physiological foctors. Although certain wri3blcs are more lilcely risk factors. risk assessment is difficult and violence ca.nnot be predicted with precision (Miller, 2000). There is simply no foolproof way co predict with certainty who is likcly to become violent. Violence may be pe.rccived as a desperate act by an angry client to regain control and power. Multiple srressor~ such as poverty, the loss or absence of supportive relationships, and substance abuse, may magnify a client's vulne.rability and stress to the breaking point. Moreover, counsellors ma'>' be in positions of authority with the right to deny clients access to goods or services. Clients ma'>' perceive such denials as further threats to their fragile power and sclf-estce.m, and the risk of violence may escalate. Attacking others works as a psychological defense against feelings of shame and humiliation. Based on his review of the academic literature, Ross ( 1995) identifies five primary causes of violent crime in Canada: "interpersonal conflict situation (over smru~ resources, power, control, and reputation), presence of WC11.pon~ influence of drugs and/or akohol, media facilitation, and cultural or subcultural reinforcement" (p. 348). The key variables that have been found to have some validity for predicting \'lolencc include: (I) past and current behaviour, (2) substance abuse, (3) ai;c and gender, and (4) personality (sec Fiaure 8.2). The more risk factors present, the greater the risk, but the presence of a risk factor docs not mean that a given person will become violent in a given situation. Past and Current Behaviour The best predictor of future violence is a history of violence (Miller, 2000), and the more r«ent and severe the violent behaviour, the greater the risk. Kclleher's (1997) conclusion that a history of violent behaviour should always be given serious consideration is «hoo:I consistently in the research on violence: ''Although the argument can be made that historical c-.•idencc of violence is not a guarantor future violent behavior, an understanding of any form of violent criminal activity clearly supports the contention that a history of violence is often a pr~ictor of future violence" (p. 13). Counsellors should be particular!'>' interest~ in noting how a client has handled difficulties and frusrrations in the past. Some clients who were victims of abuse as children have grown up without a capacity for warmth and empathy for others, which can make them oblivious to the suffering of othe.rs (Miller, 2000). ln extreme cases, violence ma'>' even bring these clients pleasure or sexual gratif,cation. Counsellors should also be interested in the level of remorse that clients show for past acts of violence, P3rticularly OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-10- Reae ll Clients 251 Histay .-o1c-"', c::=::: Puor Conflict Resolution Skil s Command Halucinalions Figure 82 Risk Factors for Violence for those who show no regret. On the other hand, clients who have IC3rncd other ways of man3ging thc.ir anger now have more choices and 3re less likely to 3ct out physically. (n this respect, it might be rcve3Jing for counsellors to explore how their clients arc managing stress outside the counscllina relationship. For cx3mple, do they show evidence of a lack of concern for the s3fcty of others! Are the.re indic3tors of inappropriate or uncontrolled anger? Arc they typicnJly c.xtremet,., defensive, irritable, or self-centred! To what extent arc they prone to impulsive behaviour! Impulsive clients might assure counsellors that they have no intent to harm 3nyone and then artack another client in the w3iting room 10 minutes later. Furche.rmore, clients who have 3 specifK pfon of \tiolent action and the means to carry it out rcpresem 3n immediate risk of violent behaviour. Counsellors need to con.sider their professional obliaations 3nd lcgnJ requirements to w3rn 3ny intended victim by examining their codes of ethics 3S wcll 3s relevant legislation or lea31 precedent. Substance Abuse Viole.nee from substance abuse is associated with ■ the effect of drugs. ■ violence to act drugs, and ■ violence in the drug culture. Common sense 3nd cmpiric3J rcsc3.rch sugaest that intoxic3ted 3nd agitated clients should be appro3ched C3utiousi)•. Substance abuse, particularly in combination with other risk factor~ compounds the risk of violence (Miller, 2000). Rcvicwina the role of druas in violence, Roth (1987, pp. 13-14) concludes the followina: ■ H3Jlucinogens such as LSD 3nd PCP, glue sniffing,, amphetamine~ 3nd barbiturates have been 3SSOCi3tcd with agaressivc and homicidal beha\tiour. ■ N3rcotics tend co suppress violence, but individu3ls miaht become violent in order to g,et these druas. ■ Alcohol reduces inhibitions. and it is implicated 3S the most frequent drua linked to violence. Furche.rmore, many studies link substance misuse to violent behaviour (Sw-anson et al., 1997; Tardiff ct 3J., 1997). Newhill (1992) reviewed the available research and recorded that certain druas subdue aggression, whereas others escalate it: 252 Chap1er 8 ''Anticholincrgics. antipsychotics., antidepressants. sedative hypnotics. and analacsics tend to suppress aagrcssion. Amphetamines and withdrawal from drugs such as morphine or nkohol induce aggression" (p. 70). Moreover, people who abuse drugs are at an increa~ risk of victimization. The link between drua abuse and violent behaviour may arise, at least in pan, from the fact that alcohol nnd other drugs are more likely to be abused in a dan,;crous pince. Age and Gender The vast majority of people who arc \•iolent and who have bttn arrested for violent behaviour are male. The highest risk for violence is found in people from 15 to 39 't'cars of age. The rate of violent nets for this age group is three times chat of the general population (Newhill, 2003). Violence declines with age, but dementia and other cognitive problems cnn result in an increase in violence by those over 65. Personality Some clients deal with their sense of persona] fragility by lashing out at others, and they arc hypcrvigilant about protectina themselves from perce.ived threats from others. Miller (2000) notes: Tendendes IOW3rd low frustration 1oler.u1ee, impulsive beh:wior, ,-ulne~bi.lit't' m criti~ dsm. {eelini hmnil1:ued and powe-rless. superlkial rel.:uionships, l.:iek o( emp3thy. a p.1ttern o( exte-rnali:inK problems. and failinK 10 aceep.t responsibilit't' for one's own :1etions 2re 311 assoeiated with more-violent beh:wior. (p. JOO) De Becker (1997) nutions that some people assume the worst possible motives and character and thnt they write che.ir own scripts: "The Scriptwriter is the t)'J)C of person who asks you a question, answers it himself, then walks aW'll't' angry at what you said . .. The things that go wrona arc the work of others who will try to blame him. People are out to get him, period" (pp. 148- 149). These clients beJicve that you arc uncaring and bent on harming them. \Vhatevcr counsellors do and however caring che.ir actions. these clients will react based on their expectations. They may try to control the rcJationship through manipulation and imimiduion; however, this behaviour should be interpreted as a warning signal only. These clients may not escalate co violence. Violence and Mental 11 lness The question whcche.r people with mental illnesses nrc more dangerous than the aeneral public continues to be the subject of research, debue, and controve.rsy. Not surprisinaly. many people believe that there is a strong link between mental illness and violence. But advocacy aroups argue that the media, through selective and exnagerated reporting, have stimulated the deveJopment of false assumptions 3bout the dan,;crs posed b\• people with mental illnesses. Sens:ation3Jizcd headlines such as "Schizophrenic Man Kills \Vife, Then Turns Gun on HimseJf" and "Voices Told Mc to Kill My Child" create the impression thnt mcntaJ illness is associated with violence; however, objective research evidence supports different conclusions. SUCCESS TIP Viole-nee that Ot'igj.nate-s from psychOSeS and olhef ne-ufdOgjc:al pfoblems can fOr' the most par1 be prevented lh(OUgh r'nedication and suppor1 sel'Vic:es. This unde-rscore-s lhe imJ)Or'tance of wortung with dients to enhance- medication compliance, as well as providing teady access counse-lling fot ettSis management, pee(support, and basic ne-eds soch as hOuSing. One comprehensive Canadian stud,., of the literature on the link between mental illness and violence concluded that there is no scientific evidence that mental illness causes violence (Arboleda~Florez, Holley, & Crisanti, 1996). Echoing many other research finding~ they aJso implicated substance abuse as the most significant risk OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reac h Clients 253 ))I) BRAIN 11 : j T : I BYTE I' I : ,1 I j , Otganic brain disease and head ttauma may reduce clients' rn'lpulse contrOI and le-ad to an iocrease in aggre-ssion and viotenice, as wet.I as changes in memory and ability to teason. ' I ' A Sludy of prisoners linkS a hist.Or)' of brain trauma with an increased likellhOOO lot viOlence (McCOOk, 2011). factor, noting that studies suggest that "individuals are 3t grc3tc.r risk of being assaulted by someone who abuses substances rather than someone who is suffering from major mental illness such as affective disorder, anxiety disorder, or schi:ophrcni3." Another study (Sw-nnson ct aL, 1997) confirms the link between violent behaviour and substance abuse, particular!)• when there has bttn absence of recent contact with mc:ntaJ hC31th service providers. A different stud,., concluded that predictions of violence based on a history of violence were more accurate than clinical predictions based on diagnosis (Gardner, Lich, Mulvey, & Shaw, 1996). Overall, persons with mental illness arc over 2.5 times more likcJy to be \•ictims rather than perpetrators of violence, particularly when other factors such as poverty and substance abuse arc present (Canadian Mental Health Association, 2005). The vast majority of violence comes from people who are not mentally ill, yet the widespread belief that persons with mental illness pose a threat contributes to the stigmatization of this group (University of 'W ashington, School of Social Worlc, 2015). Although "major mental disorder and psychiatric disturbance arc poor prcdic~ tors of violence" (Harris & Rice, 1997), Miller (2000) found that certain mental disorders, such as schizophrenia with paranoia and command haJlucination~ mania, substance use disorders, antisocial personality disorders, and borderline personaJity disorders, arc more lilccly to be associated with violence. Moreover, in recent dcadcs, deinstitutionalization of psychiatric patients has resulted in unprecedented numbers of people with mental illnesses in the community. Clients with a history of severe mental illness and violence who stop taking their medications can be very dangcrou~ particular!)• if they have command hallucinations (voices and images directing them to be violent). A comprehensive follow-up study of patients discharged from psychiatric hospitals concluded that former patients who do not abuse drugs arc no more violent than a random population sample (Bower, 1998). Pastor (1995) concluded that unrealistic and dcJusionnJ thinking tends to increase the likelihood that violence will result. He aJso noted, "Manic symptom~such as irritability, increased energy or activity, ps,.·chomotor agitation and grandiosity, also increase the rislc of violent behavior. A belief that 'others' arc responsible for the person's misfonune increases the lilcclihood of srriking out against those persons" (p. 117 3). Violence Risk Assessment: Key Questions Although long-term prediction of violence is difficult, counsellors should be able to make reasonable short-term forecasts based on consideration and assessment of the follO\\•ing questions and issues: I . Docs the client have a history of violent behaviour or an arrest record for \•iolcm crime? The counseJlor should review agency file records and other anecdotal evidence for information. 2. To what extent does the client appear dangerous, as evidenced by marked or escn,lnting agitation or threatening behaviour! The counsellor shoukl consider verbal threats as weJI as nonverbal expressions of aggression. 254 Chap1er 8 3. (f the diem is threatening violence, are the thrents concrete nnd specific? Docs the client have a plan? Docs the diem have the means to carry out the stated plan! Docs the diem have a weapon or access to one, especially a gun? 4. Is the client under stress (e.g., recent death, poverty, unemployment, or loss of social support)? Has there been a r«ent event that represents the last straw for the cliend Noticeable changes in baseline behaviour (the client's usual pe.rsonalicy and manner) should be noted, such as the folJO\\,ing examples: ■ ■ Haydon, usually quite demanding and argumentative, becomes quiet. Jeff, a 16-yenr-old group home resident, who is typicaJly ve.ry social, withdraws to his room. 5. \Vhat systemic factors might be exacerbating the situation (e.g., missed or delayed appointments and denial of benefits)? 6. \Vhat counsellor variables might be heightening the client's anger! Is the counsellor acting in ways that the diem might see as provocative! For example, is the counsellor defensive or judgmental coward the client! 7. \Vhat high-risk symptoms arc present! For example, is the client experiencing com.mand hallucinations! Is the client impulsive? ls the client near panid Js the client narcissistic or sdf<entred and prone to blaming others for his or her misfortune! Is the client hypersensitive to any criticism or hint of rejection? 8. Is the.re e-.•idence of substance abuse! 9. Has the client failed to talce ps)•chintric mediations! Has the client cut off or failed to lceep scheduled contact with a psychiatric caregive.r! 10. Docs the diem believe that he or she is able to control his or her behaviour! Is the client socially isolated? I I. Is the.re a history of brain injury or organic brain disease? These questions are references for the purpose of assessment only. The presence of any of the factors docs not menn that the client will necessarily become violent. However, when there are numerous strong dues that suggest violence, counsellors should procttd cautiousl)• and look for ways to reduce risk factors to establish safety. Managing Angry and Potentially Violent Behaviour Preventing Violence Effective intervention begins with prevention. Org3ni:::ations nttd to be open to the fact that there may be clements of their se.rvice system that act as trigi;ers for clients who are stressed or have short fuses. Additionally, W'Orkers need high self-awareness to r«ogni:e their own triggers, as well as how their responses and behaviour miaht escalate frustrated and angry clients to \'lolent responses. Systemic Factors Many clients come to counselling inn state of crisis, with low tol• e.rnnce for added stress. Consequently, it is important that ai;ency policies and routines Soctely f0r Neutoscience (2007) tepotted findings on IM neutobiology of aggression. II found evidence of brain damage in neutal cifcuits telated to motal decision maki~ in viOlent individuals. Damage to the pte:frontal cortex, and the angular' gyrus can al:SO increase violent behaviout. Hyperactive tesponses in the amygdata (r'esJX)nsible foe managing thteats and fear) and decreased activity in lhe frontal IObe are also imi:,icated. As well. bw fe\iel:S of the neurotransmitter serOlonin may help predict violence. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-10- Reaell Clients 255 do not compound the risk by exacerbating: client frustration. Parada, Sarnoff, Morron, and Homan (2011) comment on this Canadian rea1ity: Conununity member!? who use ~bl services o(ten h::1:"e to wait too Ion¥ for an 2ppoint, n~u, wait too loi,i to be seen on the day o( the If 2ppointment, and ha"e t·o o little tune with )Ou or othe-r pro(ession.3ls when ther are f'ln.31ly seen. The (ornu they must rom, plete are o(ten le:i,Kthy and con(usinK. Some a~-t:i1C)' sta(( can be insensiti"e, unhelp(u1. or dow·n rlj~ht rude. Then t·o~-tther. these prae,e«s reinfor« the idea that community member!? who have to use these service!l 2re unworth)' and fad:. di1;nit)' (p. 6) Organizations need to understand that for many diem~ systemic change is what is needed. Part of this ought to include review of the structure and service delivery systems of the agencies whose mandate is to help. Agency Safety Precautions In settings where there is significam risk for violence, procedures should be developed for dcnJing with potentially \tiolent clients. In foct, employers usuaJI)• have a leg3J responsibility to provide a safe working environment. Minimum S3(cty precautions might indude the following: Policy Agencies should develop and regularly review policies and procedures for dealing with potentially violent situations. Policies should address issues such as the procedures for visiting homes, giving clients home phone number~ using last names, and interviewing after hours. Gene.rally. counsellors should not make home visits alone if there is a possibility for violence. Many counsellors who work with potentin11)• dan.gerous clients use unlisted phone numbers as a way to ensure privacy and safety. In e>..'"treme situations, such as dange.rous child abuse investigation~ counsellors may need to be protected by police. GenernJI)•, counsellors should avoid making unescorted visits to high-crime areas. And onl)• those counscJlors with leg3l authority should investigate allegations of child abuse or neglect. Staff Training Training: should address tactics for dealing: with difficult clients, including those who arc involuntary, angry, or acting out. Front office and reception staff should also be rrnincd so that they can relate to clients in W'n)'S that do not escalnte the clients' frustration or anger. Periodic team simulations will ensure that everyone is familiar with their roles and responsibilities. This prevents members of the team from becoming confused during: a critical incident. Simulations also help staff build confidence in themselves and trust in the.ir colle3gues as backups. Interviewing Procedures and Office Design Counsellors who arc interviewing: diffteult or dangc.rous clients should work in offices where access to immediate help can be provided. A silent system for alerting othe.rs that a dangerous situation is developing: should be implemented (e.g., panic button and encrypted phone message). Leaving the When counsellOr'S 0r clW!nts feel fear 0r threat from the other-, the classic "flight or fighr response may result f0r eithe-r 0t bOth. Stofed me-m0tie-s of sinilar threatening events have an eOOr'mous influence on hO'N individuals fe-spood. five majOt afeas of the brain, amygdala, hippocampus. hypothalamus, thalamus. and se-nSO<y c0tte-x all play a part in the deci. sion to fun (fligt\t) Of fight, (although some may respond btf freezing). When the lhreat is pefCeived as real, h0<mones such as epioophrioo (adrenaline) and norepinephrine 256 Chap1er 8 (OOr'adfenalioo) are released which cause an incfe-ase in heaft rate and blOOCI pmssure. MuscleS tense-, breathing rate iner-eases, digestion SIOw Of stops and blOOCI glucose levets iner-ease-. Because attention is fuly directed at the lhreateni~ situation, individuals may be- unawafe of 01he-r things such as hO'N lheir responses are affecting Olhe-rs (Layton, 2015; Shetr'3r'd. 2015). Thus, some angry and aggfessive clients may be quite unaware how Mghte-nlflg the-.' behatJiouf i:s to Other' peo,:,e. door open durina the inte.rview can aJlow other staff to monitor any incrc3sing danger, but this practice may violate the client's conf.denti3lity. SUCCESS TIP AA ideal office seating artangemen1 gives bOth the eounsello t and lhe client a clear, unobStructed path to the dOOr'Way. Files on clients with a history of violence should clearly document details of any pa.st violent behaviour or thrc3ts. For clients with a high propensity t0\\"11.rd violence, a te3m approach may be desirable, with nvo or more persons being present during the interview. In such cases, it is usually preferable if onh• one person does the interviewing. This can lessen any feelings the client might have of be.ing ganged up on. Too many people may heighten the client's anxiety. Backup help can be stationed out of sight, but on quick standby for dangerous situations. Off1Ce furnishings should be carefully c.hrucn to minimize risk. For example, shatterproof glass can be u~, and items that a.re potential weapons, such as scissors, should be removed. Also, soft lighting and calming colours ma)' have some modest effect on mood. In addition, the agency itself should have good external lighting. Finally, during high-risk hours. such as late at night or earl,., in the morning, access doors should be locked, and worke.rs should not have to w11.lk alone into dark parking lots. Table 8. 2 on the next page provides some tips on how to prevent and manage anger and \'lolent behaviour. The table is ori;pnized according to the phases of violence, which are discus~ in the next section. SUCCESS TIP A writtM script for staff call$ to police 0t emergency baekup intervention ensures lhat relevant tnfotmation is presented quickly and Cle.arty. In a panic situation, people may forget bas.ic information, such as emetge:ncy phone numbel's. The Phases of Violence The Na.tionaJ Crisis Prevention Institute (2012) has developed a modcl for nonviolent c.risis inte.rvemion that is widdy used in Canada. It is based on four phases of violence: (I) anxiety, (2) defensiveness., (3) acting out, and (4) tension reduction (see Figure 8.3). Each phase is characterized by particular indicators and demands specific responses. phases of violence: The lour-phase med.I (a:IW!.1J', de-fenSM!leSs.. aclillg Gil and tensioo fedo::tiol) duit desc!Us tic,,. u is.es escabte to ~olelce:. Phase 1: Anxiety In the anxiety phase, there are often enrly warnings that a.re marked changes in the client's behaviour. The client's agitation and anxiety may include verbal cha.Henges, such as the refusal to follow directions or questioning of authority. Statements such as "You can't tdl me what to do" accompanied by finger pointing may suggest escalating anger. Signs of escalation, such as pacing, intense staring, and refusing to sit down, should be noted (Shea, 1998). Other indicators may include excessive euphoria., angry facial expressions, increased voice volume, and prolonged scaring. Counsellors should watch for changes in diem baseline behaviour or personality panerns. During the anxiety phase, the diem may respond to gentle directives and invita.,tion~ such as "Let's mlk and see if we can work things out" and "I'm willina co listen." This phase offers counsellors the best opportunity to intervene earl)• to prevent anger from intensifying into acting-out behaviour. OiHlcull Situatio ns: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reac h Clients 2 57 TABLE 8.2 Preventing and Managing Anger and Violent Behaviour Preventive Phase • Recogrilze (tSk factors. • Identify and minimize systemic factors lhat might be triggers fOr' clients. • Structu,e the agency to reduce client s1ress and danger to personnel. • Set up emergency (esponse protocols. • Ptaetise crisis f&SJX)nses \\1th simlAatioos. • Take steps to ptotecl identified intended victims.. • Self-awareness. Earty Wamill& P11ase (Anxiety) • Pay attentbn to changes in clienl behaviour such as increased anxiety. • Attempa to identify and mctify client ~trtggerS. • • P,omote client inVOlvement in dedsi:)n making to g'Ne 100m a sense of emJ)Owerment and contrOI. • Take Mgut instincts· and 1hmats se-riouSly. • Use empathy and feassuraoce to acktlowledge and atteoo to client needs. Lall Wamlnc Phase (Defensive) • Pay attentbn to changes in clienl behaviour such as increased defensiveness, challenges, aoo vefbal threats.. • Set dear, reasooat,e. aoo enforceable limits. • Respect client need for increased space. • Remain calm and avoid sudden movements. • Avoid using an authoritarian tone; fesJ)Ond assertively. • Use basic: counselling Skills. • SeafCh lot compfomises and -win-win· solutions. Uncontrolled Anger and Violence (Acting 0111) the police (do not try to disarm clients who have weapons and do n01 risk personal safety untess una\lOidable). Try to ensure the safety of eve-ryone, including bySlanclers, Other Slaff, and the client. Use a team apptoach, induding. if necessary and appropriate, physical festr'aint, but ex.treme caution is reciuired as untrained persons can inflict inj...y or death. • Refef or artang,e to transpor'l dients to hOspital fof assessment or medication. • Try to re-eslablish verbal eotrwnunication. Tension Reduction • Support lhe client's feturn to a state of calm. • Re-e:ssablish communication. • £licit availat,e family support. Post-Event follow Up lr'WOtve clients in loog-term counselling. Help clients le.am nonviolent ~lutions to prot,ems. Implement consequences, if any. Conduct i'ldividual and team debriefing. • When clients have plans to harm a specific victim. wam the victim and notify the police. • Review ptOCedures fof handling distupaive clients. ca1 Usually. clie nts enter the anxiety phase bcc:3usc of stress., which can come from muLtip le sources, including jobs, rcfotionships, health, 3nd fin3nces. Clicms define stressful events; thu s, counsellors cann ot measure stress just by k nowing the facts about a situ3.tio n . What one d iem might sec as an o pportu nity, ano ther m ight ex perience as a threat. Kcllchc.r ( 1997) d escribes the triggering event as 3n incident that pushes the poten tially 258 Chap1er 8 Figure 8.3 The Phases of VIOience violent person toward violence-: "ft is the provc.rbi3l 'stmw that broke the camel's bade,' and , like the straw, may often be perceived by others with far less significance than it's perceived by the perpetrator" (p. I I). ~fore clients sec counscllors, they may nJrc:ady be feeling helpless and abandoned. Any counsellor o r agency behaviour th:.n the client views as provocative or rcjcctina ma'>' further propel the client tou•ard violence. Cou nsellors may have to d eny assistance, and clients ma'>' believe that they are denying them 3ccess to goods or services. These clients may perceive- themselves as "losers" and look for ''""n't'S to save focc, indudina resistance, with statements such as "I don't have to put up with this rreatment." (ndividuals who arc predisposed to violence respond to stress with incrc3sing anger and anxiety. A person's cmotionnJ reaction can also in6ucnce whether he or she might become violent. La.big (1995) suggests that people who are p rone to anger, hatred, and those who tend to blnme others arc at h igher risk or becoming violent, while those who are more cmP3thic are less likdy. Oe.aling with Threats CounseJlors need to take action when clients exhibit changes in their norm:.d behaviour. T his action co uld include referral for psychia tric assessment and re-cvnJuation or medication. Jmmcdiatc crisis intervention might result in moving the diem o ut or the environment where others might be injured, for examp le, a crowded waitin g room. As wcll, long-te.rm co u nseJling might focus on anger management or relaxation train ing. The immediate goaJ is c risis management, but the long-term goaJ is crisis prevention. T h is interesting conclusion reached by Quinscy, Harri~ Rick, and Cormie.r ( 1998) cha.Jlcnges one common misbdief: "encouraging angry individunJs to relieve anger through catharsis (e.g., boxing, using a punching bag) is concraindicatro because it ma'>' lead to increased hostility and aggression" (p. 204). SUCCESS TIP "When arry type of th(eat (fr0tn a client) includes indirecl or veiled ,efe(ences to lhings lhey might do, such as 'You'I be SOfr/ Or' 'Don't mess wilh me; ii is best to ask directly, What do you mean by that?' ASk e.xaclty what lhe person is threatening to dO. HtS elabOt'ation w,II almost always be weaket than hi:S implied threat If, on lhe Olhet hand, his ex~nation of the comment is actualy an explicit lh(eat, bettet to ieam ii now than to be uncertain latet· (de Becker, 1997, p. 117). Cou nsellors need to be attuned to their own fears and anxieties. Appropriate anxiety is a due that the situation is escalating and that remroiaJ action is necessary. De Becker (1997) argues that people have a basic intuition that teJls them when aJI is not well, bur that they often disregard the red flags or danger. It is only in rhc aftermath OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clients 259 that they re.fleet and renli!e that they had suff,ciem informntion to make bener choices but that they ignored it. Phase 2: Defensive This is a late warning phase with dear indicators that the person is about to lose control. The client may become more challenging and beJligercm by making direct threats and pro\'Ocations. The client has become irrational and dear warning indicators may be present, including clenching or raising of fists, rapid breath.ing, grasping objects to use as weapons, and showing signs of movement to,.,,.-nrd nttack (e.g., grasping the arms of the chair and denoting that the client is about to rise and advance) (Shea, 1998; Shea for & Horejsi, 2008). At this point, it is crucial that counseJlors refrain from reciprocating with the same ngg,-essive behaviour that the client is using. This requires some self-discipline, as the counsellor's narural reaction might be to respond in kind, which onh• serves to escalate or precipitnte \•iolence. Decreased eye contact might be nppropriate with some clients. As well, counsellors arc wise to increase the physical distance between themseJves and their clients since potentially violent persons ma't' have an increased need for space. Note that physicaJ contact, hO\\rever wdl intentioned, should be nvoided. Sometimcscounsel.lors try to calm clients by touching the.ir shoulder~ but this is ill-advised as clients may interpret it as aggression. During this phase, counseJlors need to be .self-disciplined and to modeJ calmness. \Vhen counsellors stay calm, clients arc more likely to emulate their composure. This calmness should be rcftecto:I in their voice and manner with slow, non.-jargonistic language Counsellors who speak caJmly and avoid any loud or authoritarian tone have a greater chance of caJming their anxious clients. On the other hand, counsellors who match their clients' defensiveness and anger exacerbate the situation and increase the possibility of \tiolent retaliation. Rigid and authoritarian counsellor reactions may leave clients feeling pressured or trappo:I. It is essential that counsellors mnintain their own equilibrium and remain in con.trol. They need to develop the.ir capacity to monitor their own feelings and behaviour, including the.ir ability to ask for hclp or to withdraw when they arc not in control. Coun.seJlors also need to resist any tendency to be baited by clients inro angry confrontation or retaliation, which only escalates the crisis. Jf clients ~rce.ive that their counsellors arc anxious and not in control, they may become more irrational. Labig (1995) re.minds us of the importance of emotional tone. He notes that a loud or aggressive \'Oice can quickh• precipitate retaliation, while a voice tone that is calm and supportive inhibits violence. Simply put, a threatening environment increases the risk of violence. &sic communication and counselling sJcjlJs are excellent tools both for preventing violence and for dealing with clients who nre on the verge of losing control. In particular, active listening skills communicate that counsellors nre willing to listen to and learn about clients' wants and nttds. Counsellors should try to speak calmly and avoid any mannerisms that clients might inte.rprct as threatening (e.g., touching a client, making a sudden movement, or invading a client's persona.1 spoce). Encourage the client to sit and to be comfortable. Listen, e.mpathi.!c, paraphrase, and sum.mari:e. while avoiding defensiveness. As a rule, respond to clients in the anxiety and defensive phases with supportive and empathic. smte.n'litm:s. However, some clients mn't' misinterpret empathy as an um\--nnted intrusion on personal privacy and react defensiveJ,.,. Counsellors should be alert to clients' reactions to certain topics or questions. This will help counseJlors make intelligent decisions about when it is appropriate to chaJlenge or confront, and when they should back off because the subject is agitating the client to a dangerous level. The Power of Compromise Violent clients often fee] disempo\\'ered and disadvan.ta.g:ed. \Vhe.n counsellors promote compromise, they restore some balance of power 260 Chap1er 8 in the rclntionship and show their willingness to reach n solution. Conve.rscJy, when counsellors argue with, threaten, or ignore the needs of their client~ the clients may become incrcasingl,., belligerent. Compromise helps clients find a way to save face and retain the.ir dignity. While counsellors have the responsibility to set appropriate limit~ they must not argue with, ridicule, challenge. threaten, or unfairt,., critici:e clients. The lanauage used b\• the counsellor can help establish an atmosphere of compromise and mutual problem solving-. for example, "Let's work together to find a solution we can both live with" and "I really do want to find a solution." Client: (Ydling loudJ:y.) I 3m sk.k a.nd tired of ~ttin& the run3round. Counse.Uor. (Calmf:,.) Your ::u-~er nukes it dear to me how stronaly rou feel 2bout thil. l can see that this is a.n import:mt issue fm- )'Ou. but I wi.11 be able to work better with ,..ou i( you St2)' calm a.nd don't threaten me. let's~ i( there·s 2nothe-r w-3y to appro-Y.h it. Client: (Padng and ,dling.) Are rou '--oi~ l'O help me or not! CounseU.o r: (Calmf:,.) I'm willina to work with )'Ou on the problem. Client: (Siu and stmes lnttndJ.) Counsello r: I understand th::u )'Ou think that thii is the best solut ion. I al.so appredate )'Our reasonilli, but there ::are two of us here. We !"K'ed to Ond 2 solution that both of us ea.n ln't' with. Client: (l.At.1dl,-. but not 1dlms.) I a.in tq•i~ l'O be reason::tble! Counsello r: Oka)', I'm liste:nina. I'd like to hea.r your ide:as. Hocker and Wilmot (1995) identify five principles for establishing effective collaboration: (I) join with the other, (2) control the proccs~ 00( the people, (3) use productive communication, (4) be firm in your goal~ flexible in your means, nnd (S) remain optimistic about finding solutions to your conflict (p. 212). They suggest a variety of means for ope.rntionn1i! ina the principle~ such as usina "we" language to affirm common interests, activcJy listening even when you disaarec, and persuadina rather than coercina. As well, they emphn.si!e the importnnce of separatina the issues from the rcJarionship and dealing: with the important items one at a time. Such a collaborative approach requires that counseJlors remain positive, creative, and constructive. The gene.ml goal must be "\Ve, working together, can solve this problem that is confronting: us" (Hocke.r & Wilmot, 1995, p. 205). Dubovsky and \\:lcissbera (1986) underscore the importance of promotingcollnborntion. They contend thnt the diem "protects himself from feeling powerless, inadequate and frightened by attempting to demonstrate how powerful and frightening he can be. His threatening: behavior increases if he feels he is not be.ina taken seriously" (p. 262). SUCCESS TIP If aggressive behaviout is escalating. the safety of otherS must be a p(aorily. This might include evacuating the waiting room, removing ot;ec1s lhat ~ t be used as weapons, and seeking baekup from othet avatlable staff. Setting Limits Setting and enforcina reasonable limits makes it possible for counsellors and clients to continue ,vorking: together. Failure to set limits reinforces actin,;-out behaviour, which if unchecked could lead to more violent and destructive consequences. In the defensive phase, clients may still respond to appropriate limits. Limits let clients know what will and will not be tole.rnu,.d, but counsellors need to apply ce.rcain principles in setting limits. Counsellors should be specific and tell di• ents which behaviour is inappropriate since they ma)' not be aw3re what is acceptable. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-10- Reae ll Clients 261 Moreover, they may 00( know how their behaviour is affecting others. Limits should include enforceable consequences, and counsellors should state the consequences of noncompliance. SUCCESS TIP um,t setting is m:::,(e effective when it is s1atoo rn a poSrtive tone Viith a payoff f0t compliance, as tn lhis ex.ample: •If you stop yet.ling at me, then I wiU sat wdh you to see if we can find a Sdution.• Phase 3: Acting Out At this stage, the diem has lost control and has become assaul.tive. Protection of seJf and others is the primary goal. Jde~dly, a,;ency procOOures are operative, 3nd counseJlors who are dealina with such situ3tions will receive immediate assistance from the st3ff team. Police intervention 3nd restraint of the acting-out diem may aJso be rttauircd. \\:lhen deaJing with acting-out client~ a team approach with a weJl.ori:ani!ed and trainOO staff is the preforr~ way to address the crisis. A team approach provides increased safety for everyone, including the client. A wcll.-train~ team may subdue violent clients before they injure themsclvcs or othe.rs, but staff should be train~ in techniques for physical restraint and control. The team members provide support and can act as witnesses if litigation should arise because of the incident. Police Intervention Counsellors should not hesimce to call the police if a client becomes too threatening or 3garessive. No counsellor is expected to risk his or her lifo or endure physical assault as part of the job. Moreover, sometimes clients are unwilling or unable to constrain che.ir hostility, 3nd police or psyc.hi3tric restraint is esscntial for managina the crisis. Police intervention is particularly crucinJ when deaJing with clients who have weapons. In addition, counsellors should not cry to prevent 3 client who is determined to leave by blocking the exit. In genera], counseJlors who are assaulted by clients should consider laying criminal charges. This establishes the importance of clients' takina responsibility for their 3ctions. SUCCESS TIP Neve( t:,ock angry chents from leaving yout offa; allow a deat path f0t them 10 exit. Never run aftet clients wtlo storm out Never interview when )'OU arc alone in the office. Never enter a client's home when you know the client is talking about hurting someone. Phase 4: Tension Reduction The tension r~uction phase is characterized by a gradual reduction in aggressive behaviour and 3 return to more rational behaviour. The client may still be driven by adrenalin, so it is important that counsellors proceed cautiousl't' to avoid reoctivatina aagres.sive acting out. Follow•up Counselling Interventions Clients can be counselled to b«ome nJert to their own warning sign~ such as "tenseness, sweating pa]ms, a ciahtening of the stom,. adi, pressure in the chest and a surge to the head" (Morrissey, 1998, p. 6). Once clients 3re aware of che.ir own trigge.rs, they can be counselled on appropri3te diversion3ry tac.tics, such as employing rclax3tion techniques, talcina time out, and using assertiveness 3nd other bchaviouraJ response. alcern3tives. Morrissey ( 1998) describes a technique that a counsellor used with a client who was on the verge of violence. The counsel,. !or reassured the client "that he was there to help him and commended the client for 262 Chap1er 8 coming to sec him rather than acting on his feelings of rage. He also asked the client what was keeping him in control thus far and used that as proof to reinforce the fact that he could indeo:I control himself" (p. 6). At the end of the tension reduction phase and after the diem has returned to normal, the client ma,., be mcntaJly and ph)•sicaJly exhausted and show signs of remorse and shame. Con5tt1uently, counseJling can be direct~ toward helping the client use the experience as a learningopportunit)•- forexamplc, todcvclop alternative responses for future similar stresses. Interview 8.2 provides an example. Counsellors arc wdl prepared to tcnc.h theirdients techniques for resolving conflict and crises nonviolcmi)•. The skills of counselling arc also, to some extent, the skills of effective everyday communication. Communication skill training equips clients with more choices for asserting the.ir rights and respecting others. Assertiveness training cnn hclp clients express feelings in a nonaggressive manner. When clients arc able to respond assertively, they establish an atmosphere of cooperation and conflict cnn be peacefully resolved. Often conflict is difficult for clients to settle because they arc unable to sec the perspectives or foclings of others in the conflict. Clients who learn empathy and other active listening skills are better able to compromise because they arc less likely to judge their own behaviour as absolute!)• right and that of others as absolutely wrong. Sometimes, long before \•iolence erupts, counsellors intuitively focl chat the situation is worsening. This foding ma,., be based on unconscious reactions to subde cues and indicators. Counsellors and clients might find it useful to rry to concretely identify these dues. Doing so will assist clients in becoming sensitive to those initial psychological responses that signaJ the imminent onset of the anxiety phase. Clients who become adept at rccogni!ing early warning indicators arc in a much better position to cake early warning action, such as withdrawing from an explosive situation or switching to healthie.r problem-solving strategies. Critical Incident Debriefing An organi!ation needs to have a mechanism in place for debriefing after a \'lolent or hostile act. This enables the counseJlor to restore a sense of equilibrium. It is important to remember that a critical or violent incident may also affect and traumatize staff who were not direcdy involved, including clerical, janitorial, and kitchen personnel; therefore, they should be involved in the debriefing. Counsellors who have been assaulted or threaten~ with assault ma)' be traumati!cd. They ma,., experience symptoms such as recurrent images or thoughts of the event, distressing dream~ flashbacks, and intense srrcss when returning to the scene of the incident. There may be a marked decline in their ability to handle routine work tasks. and they may fee] detached and isolated from colleagues. They may dcvdop sJeep difficulties and have difficulty concentrating. Frttauently, they return to work in a state of hypervigilancc, constandyexpecting funhcr trauma. Often, they describe themselves as "numb" and unable to enjoy activities that usually give them pleasure. Macdonald and Sirotich (2005) review~ studies and reported that victims of client violence might experience the following: ■ Troubled relationships (with colleagues and famil't•) ■ Reduced ability to function in the ,vorkplace ■ More absenteeism ■ Higher levels of burnout, depression, anxiety, and general irritability stemming from threats or abuse \Vhen symptoms such as these arc present, counsellors should consider obtaining mcdicnl assessment or professional counselling. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clients 263 )}) INTERVIEW 8.2 In the following e:x.ample, the counsellor, a g,oup hOme worker, is revi~ing an incident with her client. The incident o«uned two hours ago and was predpi~ted when the C-Ounsellor denied the client, a 16-ye:ar-old male, permission to meet with some of his friends later that nigtit The client threw his chair ac,os.s the room and stormed out of the office while saeaming obscenities. Counsellor: I'm wondering if ltlis is a good lime to talk abOut vd\at happened eartiet tOOay. Client: It won't happen again. Analysis: Whenever ,:,oss/ble. it's im,:,ortant that clfents be Invited to review prior incidents. can we just forget it evet happe-ned? counsellor: You're ~t. We need to move on. HoNevet, I think it's im(X)rtant we bOth rake a IOOk at it to make some ~ns so it doesn't oc:cuf again. Okay? ClleM: I guess I gol a bit carried away. counsellor: 1was scared. ClleM: I'm sony. I won't let ft happen again. counsellor: 1accept youf apol:)gy. counsellor: It mighl be helpful fof bOth of us to go ove-r what happe-ned to see hON it migt\t ha\18 been prevented. Client: I was stil upset from see-ing my mOlhef. When you said no, it was just too much. Counsellor: H' s never bee-n easy to, you to Ialk to your mom. You always seem to come back realty wound up. Clitnt: Yeah, lhOSe are- the days lhal people Should Slay out of my face. Counsellor: Good point. Sounds like you know lhal you need some time alone when you're stfe-ssed. Analysis : Often. violent or acting-out clients are so preoccu• pied with their own needS and fears that they don't realize the impact they have on others. By telling the client how she fell, the counsello, hopes to inc,ease his capacity for empa. thy. Acceptance of her client's aPology does not condone his behaviour. as would a statement such as "lt'sok.ay. Don't worry about it. No real harm was done." Analysis: One goa.l of counsel/Ing is to help clients recognize their own early warning indlcatOrS that they are in danger of losing control. Analysis: Empathy confirms that feelings have been heard and understood. Analysis: The client rationalizes his behaviour, putting the respons/bj//ty on others. Without directly challenging the raUonalizatlon. the counsellor shifts the focus baek to a client strength. Client: You got it Counsellor: As we talk. I'm wondeting what p(evented you from &aking that time. If you' d taken lhe time- to coal off befOfe approachi"lg me-. tt'li"lgs would have been a IOt diffefe-nt Analysis: Feedback confrontation challenges the client to consider so~ new alternatives. The counsellor takes advantage of an opportunity to reframe the client's problem statement Into a goal. Client: Sure, I koow I have to le.am to control my tempe-t, bul once- I gel gotng I just can't seem to stOI) myself. counsellor: Put anott'le-t w.ry. yotX hope is to find a way to deal with your feelings so that you don't get angry and huft someone. Client: I don't know if tnal's possible-. counsellor: You've already shown me that you have some Sklll at doing this. You threw the chair and you said some awflA lhiogs, bul afte.-ward you left lhe (OOm withOut doing any mOl'e damage. This tell$ me lhat you have the- ability to bring thi~ under contrOI. Analysis: Acknowledgment of the client's restraint. hov,-eve, late. ,:,rovl~s a base for further development. This recognizes the client's strengths by /JCknowledging and reinforcing nonag. gressive behavioural altematfves. Reflections: ■ ■ How would you assess that the time is right to initiate a follow-up interview? Suggest hOw anticipatory cont,acting migJ,t be used as a next step. 264 Chap1er 8 CONVERSATION 8.3 Youtti Worker: What Should a eounsetlOr' dO if assallted btf a client? counsellor: The(e are many lypes of assaults fa~iog from verbal lhfeats to ph)'Sical anackS causing i.njuiy. All of them afe frigt\teni~ and potentialty traumatic. Youtb Worker: We Should not f0<get that any assault on a counsel!Or also impacts other wor'k.ers in the agency, even those who wefe not pfesent during the altercation. Their psychOIOgjcal needs sholJd not be ignored Or' minimized. AA assault on one v.()rker is a fetninclef to othets that they are also vl.dnerable. In some cases, the assaulted worker- (or tnell colleagues) ate 1taumatized. Thi:S can have serious tepe-rcussions fOr' lheit pe-rsonal and profe-ssional wol'k. COuMellor: lndividualS may ex.perienice a myriad of ern::,t.ions. including fear, anger-, Shame, denial, contempt f0t dients, Or' even guilt. All of lhem are normal; au of lhem ~d to be processed. Poople whO wol'k in the eounselli~ field already know 100 be-neflt of the counselling ptocess. and they ShOuld not hesitate to use counselling to deal with their own em~ t.ions. To do so is a sign ot strength, 001 weakness. Oetr'iefiog with a trusted cOlleague 0t supervisof 0t using emptoyee assistance services afe possible options. Youtti Wor\et: A team detr'ief whefe indi\lk:lua~ are enicouraged to Shafe their feelings about the incident is an important way to regroup. The team deb(aef ShOuld include all personnel in the setting, no1 just the prolessional counsem.ng staff. It may be helpful to have an outside facilitator conduct the team deb(tef. STUDE:NT: What Should happen dufing the deb(t0f? Youtb Worker: The basic goal of any counselling or team debtief is to f&-eStablish a sense of contrOI and saiety. The deb(t0f is an opportunity to Share lee6~ and concerns. By doing so, indjyijua~ typicaly diSCover that Olhers are affected in similar ways and 100 powef ot group support is mobilized. Counsellor: In addition, fMJCamining the clfcumsaances of the assaul is important. A numbef of key questions shoud be addfesSed, including: Wefe there indicators ot an esw:.alati.ng risk of violence that were misSed? Were thefe aspects of the seuing's sttuctu(e Of policy that contributed to the assault? Was thefe ade(luate sharing of inf0tmation within 100 agency (e.g,, history of viOlence, substance misuse, and non~pliance With psychiatri:: medications)? What ctia~am necessary to pfevent further k'lck:lents? Uptoring these questions can help the team to develop bette-r procedufes and confidence f0t handling futu(e incidents.. Youth Worker: Since an assault increases peoples' feeli~ of vulnerability, 1t is important to monitot how it migtit affed relationships with othef dients. For example, individuals, Or' even the entife setting. may ovefestimate the risks posed by the entire client population. This might resl.dt in excessive procechxal rutes or struch.-al changes that impair the agency's overau effectiveness. Counsellors must aaso be wary of tta!WerrW'lg uncesolved feelings to other clients. Counsellor: GOOCI point. I know o~ worker who, after an assallt at the agency, deck:led to leave his office dOOr halfopened during intel"Views which compromised confidentiality. He alSO became very reluc&ant to addfess pote-ntiallysensilive issues fearing lhat it m.igt\t arouse client anger 0t defensiveness. As a fesUt. many of his counsetling interviews femained superficial With opportunities for meaningful WOr'k passed over. foftunately, an alert supervisof intervened with supportive supervision and feferfed the WOl'kef to an emptoyee assistance counsem~ service. Even whc:n counsc:llors are not injured, the thre3t of \•iolence can be just 3s traumatic. Typic3J rc:sponses may include hclplessnc:s.s 3nd thoughts of lc:aving the: profession. Thc:se fc:c:lings may devc:lop immo:li3tdy or emerge: after 3 dd3y of monrhsor c:ven years. Consc:quc:nth•, it is important to debric:f critical incidents to lc:s.sen shock, reduce: isolation, and restore personal control. Tc:3m debriefing should take place: as soon 3S possible: after the: incident. Debriefing should be conducted by 3n objective third part)' in a s3fc: setting. lt should be: hcld as soon 3S possible 3ftc:r the: critical incident, usually within 24 to 72 hours, to minimize: the effects of any traum3 that victims or witnesses may be e.xpc:riencing. This is important in promoting a rc:curn to the norm3J routine of the agency. A t)tpic3l debriefing sc:s.sion is like 3 counsc:lling inte.rvic:w. The debriefing should reinforce team inte.rdepc:ndence. Sometimc:s counsc:llors 3.rc: re1uct3nt to ask collC3guc:s for 3ssist3ncc:, bc:lieving th3t 3slcing for heJp is a sign of incompetence. One: goa.1 of a debriefing is to develop a staff culture in whidi. asking for heJp is understood OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clients 265 critical incident debriefing: A tummeeling held to deius.e the ~ I ol a rio!NI or tra.atic Mal sudlas • assault on a staff meiaber. Oelwiefing assists 'Mlfkers to nonn• and deal 11ith t h e ~ that my be amsed because ol the Mal. As wel. <1£,,lmfing is used to ieriM and rt'nse prewa(iw, ud crisis illefYNlica, pnndures. as a sign of strength rather than a weakness. A critical incident debriefini generally has the following elements: I . All team members are invit~ to share feelings and reactions about the curre.nt or prior incidents. Active listening can be used to promote this process. This hcJps indh•iduals who were threatened or assaulted to "normaJizc" their own rcac~ tions. Counsellors should rttiuirc little persuasion about the benefits of talking about their feelings. They might be reminded that sharing foeJings is something they routinely ask of their clients. Helping team members manage feelings is the major objective of the debriefing. At this time, it is important to identify the potential ph)•sical and emotionaJ reactions that staff may experience. As well, information regarding service~ such as employee assistance programs (EAPs) that arc available to staff who need additionaJ help to manage their emotions. should be detailed. 2. The team conducts a post~moncm on the violent event. A thorough analysis of what transpir~ is used to re,.•iew and reinforce procedures for dealing with \•iolem clients. An important question for the team to consider is "\Vhat, if anything, could we have done to prevent this incident!" For example, the team can explore whether an)' early warning indicators of pending violence were overlooked. They can investigate whether there were things that individuals or the agency did or did not do that contributed to the client's behaviour. 3. The tcam debriefing is an important "tcnc.hablc moment" when staff are highly motivated to develop their skills. Jt is a chance to explore alternative responses that might have bttn used at all stages of the critical incident. Role-play and simulations can be used to practise alternative responses. This step helps empo\\'er individuals, and the tcam by moving them away from any tendency to foci hcJplcss. COUNSELLING ANGRY AND VIOLENT CLIENTS The obvious counselling goal is to assist these clients to develop skills and responses that do not harm others. Safety is the top priority. \Vhile there is no single best strategy, the follO\\•ing intervention choices c3n be tailor~ to meet the needs of individuaJ clients. Prevention Sometimes, long before violence erupt~ counsellors intuitively foci th:.n the situation is worsening. This feeling may be based on unconscious reactions to subtle cues and indicators. Counsellors and clients might find it useful to try to concretely identify these dues. Doing so will assist clients in becoming sensitive to those initial psychologicnJ responses that signaJ the imminent onset of the anxiery phase. Clients who become adept at recognizing early warning indicators arc in a much better position to take early warnina action, such as withdrawing from an explosive situation or switching to hcaJthicr problem-solving strategics. Assertiveness Training Assertiwmess: AssertiYEflm inYC!hes eiertisilc personal rights, including the ability to EqftSS ~ and ii!as Mthout "'1 or~ aaiiety. witb>ut den,ing the ripls ol cthen 266 Assertiveness involves exercising persona] rights, induding the ability to express focJ~ ings and ideas without guilt or undue anxiety, without dcnyina the riahts of others (Shcbib, 1997). 1t rttiuircs respect and empathy for oth~r people. Assertiveness training helps clients express feelings in a nonaggrcssivc manner. \Vhcn clients are 3blc to respond assertively, th~y establish an atmosphere of cooperation where con6ict can be pcac~fully resolved. lt is dcnrly distinguished from aggression, which involves the use of po\\'er, domination, and intimidation to achieve one's goa.Js, and p3ssivity, which Chap1er 8 foregoes personal rights and needs. CounseJlors can he.Ip clients develop assertive communication skills such as active listening, especially empathy. Some clients know how to respond asscnivcJy, but low seJf-estccm or fe3r inhibits them from making appropriate assc.rtive choices. Cognitive bchaviouraJ counselling can be used to address these issues. StTategics such as rcJa.xation training, deep breathing. and mindfulness can be used to assist clients to deal with anxiety. The skills of counseJling arc also, to some extent, the skills of effective cveryda'>' communication. This puts counsellors in a good position to tC3ch their clients techniques for resolving conflict and crises nonviolently. Communication skill tTaining equips clients with more choices for asserting their rights and respecting others. Often conflict is difficult for clients to settle be.cause they arc unable to sec the perspectives or feelings of othc.rs in the conflict. Clients who learn empathy and othc.r active listening skills arc bettc.r able to compromise because they arc less likely to judge thc.ir O\\•n behaviour as absolutcl)• riaht and that of others as absolutely wrong. Cognitive Behavioural Counselling (Therapy) As discussed in Chaptc.r 7, Cognitive BchaviouraJ Therapy (CBT) hcJps clients to identify and manage unhelpful thinking patterns such as catastrophizing or blaming others. CST can also focus on hcJping clients learn alternate behavioural choices which, when practised, will lessen any tendency to default to the anger mode. Anger Management Anger is a normal emotion and the appropriate expression of ange.r can dttpen relationships. Out of control anger can destroy relationships. Anger management skills include recognizing and managing: trijlR:e.rs (e.g., avoiding problematic situations). CounseJlors can use role playing and modeling as a Wtt)' to help clients develop alternate responses. They can aJso teach breathing and relaxation techniques. Substance Misuse Interventions The use of illicit substances is strongly linked to increased \•iolencc, so intc.rvention tari;:cting this important area is crucial. A wide range of choices include 12-step programs, residential treatment, CBT, harm reduction, rreatmem of co-occurring mental disorders, traditional hC3ling practices, exercise, nutrition, spiritua1ity, and many other strategics have proven effective. Psychiatric Intervention Psychiatric assessment can determine whether medication is wnr-rantcd. Antidepressant or antiaru:iety medication may be useful as an adjunct to counselling. Medication alone is not recommended. Reduction of Stressors Resolution of issues rcJatcd to unemployment, poveny, relationship d,•sfunction, and housing arc important targets for intervention. Counselling Victims CounseJlors may be caJled upon to deal with domestic \'lolcncc where the majority of victims arc women. A 2015 survey by the Canadian \\:1omen's Foundation provides startling statistics that unde.rscorc the c:xtem of the problem for women in Canada~ OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltll Hard-lo- Reach Clients 267 ■ Fifty percent of women over 16 report h.nving expc.ricnccd :.n IC3st one incident of physical or sexual violence since the a,;c of 16. ■ Every six da)'S a woman in Canada is killed by hc.r intim3tc partnu ■ On 3ny given day in Canad3, more dun 3.300 W'Omcn (along with thc.ir 3,000 children) 3re fore~ to sleep in 3n emc:ri:ency shelter to esc3pc domestic violence. ■ Each year, over 40,()()() arrests result from domestic violence-that's about 12 pc.rccnt of 3JI violent c.rime in C3nada. Since onl'>' 22 percent of 31) incidents 3rc report~ to the police, the rcaJ numbc.r is much higher. ■ As of 2010, there were 582 known cases of missing or murdered Aboriginal women in C3nada. ■ In a 2009 Can3di3n national survey, women reported 460,000 incidents of sexual 3ssault in just one )'C3.r, but only about JO percent of all scxua.1 assaults arc reported to police. ■ More than one in ten Can3dian ,vomen SO)' they h.nvc been stalked. When counsellors are ,vorking with ,•ictims of violence, the number one concc.rn is to help them take steps to ensure their s3foty. Clients should be made aware of their rights 3nd options, including use of police (phone 911), restraining orders, and tr.msi.tion homes. When dC31ing with pc.rprtrators of victims of spouS31 violence, counseJ,. lors may face the ch3llcn,;c of dealing with cultural or religious ideologies that favour p3triarch3l domin3nce 3nd control. Further, cultural norms may preclude disclosure and the victim, fearful of judgment and shame, may suffc.r the 3buse in private. Counsellors might explore whether there 3re culture-specific resources such as support groups or community lea.de.rs th.nt might be of assist3ncc. For m3ny and varied reason~ women ma'>' choose to stay in abusive relationships. Counsellors nttd to rem3in c.mp3thic 3nd suspend any tendency to impose judgment or to push women to leave. While counseJlors can help women understand the inherent risks of remaining in the home, they need to support the decision to Sta)' or leave as belonging to the W'Oman, even where this choice sec.ms to defy logic. SUCCESS TIP A comtn00, repeat~g pattem (cycle), often emerges in abusive (elationships. This cycle of abuSe ot violence develOps lhrough lou(slages: (1) build-up of tension, (2) abusive incident (Wf'bal. emotiOtlal, physical, and sexual), (3) abuse( rem0fSe, and (4) hOOeymoon pe-riOd (when al is calm). ))}) BRAIN BYTE I Cl '.I' I : 1,: ;,,,1, The br"ains of children who are abused (Or witness abuse) can be profoundly affected and lead 10 a wide range of p(oblems, including emotional (egulatbn (damage 10 tne amygdala, and cha~ in brain chenistty affecting neurottansmitterS such as epinephrine, dOpami"le, serotonin, and tne stress hOtrnooe 268 Chap1er 8 cortisol), rearni~ deficits such as difficulty concenttating/ focusing, language acquisition, orga'-ling. loss of interest (damage to the cortex and hippoc.ampus), sleep distu(bances, retationShip issues, and low self-esteem (American Psychological AssoclaUon. 2015; Kendall. 2002). SUMMARY ■ Resistance is a common defensive reaction thnt interferes with or delays the process of counselling. It may be evident in a variety of ways, such as failure to cooperate with the basic routine of counselling, subtle or direct nnacks., passivity, and nonvc rbaJ cu cs. ■ lt is important for counsellors to evaluate their own feelings and behaviour as well as aspects of the a~cncy that might be triggering resistance. ■ Effective confrontation heJps clients come behaving, or feeling. ■ Clients ma,., become violent or rhrc:.nening for 3 number of reasons. Although it is difficult to predict with certainty which clients will become violent, some risk factors can be isolated. The best pnxlictor of violent behaviour is a history of violence; substance abuse is also a common variable. Other factors that counsellors should consider when assessing risk are age, gender, and pcrsonaJity characteristics. ■ Effective management of potentially violent situations includes prevention and appropriate responses to the four phases of violence: anxiety, defensiveness, acting our, and tension reduction. It is important to debrief critical incidents to lessen shock, reduce isolation, and restore personaJ control. Team debriefing should take place as soon after the incident as possible. lt should provide an opporrunity for people ro ta1k about their feelings and to review what went wrong. ■ Counselling interventions include a focus on safety, assertiveness training. anger mana~ement, cognitive behavioural counseJling, harm reduction, psychiatric assessment and treatment, and support for victims of spousaJ abuse. to a different level of understanding, EXERCISES Sett-Awareness I. Self-evaluate your pe-rsonal comfo,1 wtlen confronting others. a. What people woukl you have difficulty confronti~? b. Do you avoid confronti~ c. Think of times wtle-n it was feasonable 10 confront but you dkl.n't What prevented you from confronting? d. Flnish the fOUOwing sentenice: Whe-n I confront, I foot • . a. Youth whO has ~ne problems b. COiieague who has, in youf opinion, behaved in an unprofessional maMer c. Client whO coosiste-ntly arrives late for appointments 2. Evaluate the effectiveness of each of the confrontations that foltow; suggest impfovements: a. Try to dO bettef oex.t lime. b. You'fe an idiot. c. You'fe saying that you'fe Okay, yet you're ctyk'lg. d. Grow up and ac1 yout age. 2. Review )'OU' extie-riences deali~ 'Mth inclMdualS wtlo are a~. fe-sistant, or pote-ntialy vident. What i:S youf natural reaction whe-n someone's ange-r starts to e-scarate? Oo you te-nd to fight baek? Of do you withdr'aw? What aspects of yout experience wiU help you deal effectively 'Mth difficllt situations? What aspects will impede your ability? e. As IOOg as you continue to act llk.e a doofmat, you'te 3. Reflect on your thoughts, feelings, and behaviour wtle-n you wer-e fOfced ot pfessured to do somethi~ against your will. 3. Interview counse-llOfS from diffetent settings tegafding their experiences with tJiolent Of JX)tentiall'j vident clients. Discuss suategies that they have found effective. How might your feactioos help you to undel'Sland and wOr'k with clients whO are "involuntary·? Skill Practice 1. Wot'k with a colleague to role-play an appropriate counsellOt confrontation in each of the fOUOwing situations: gotng to get abused. If you'te setious at>out protecting y0Ul'Self, le.ave hint 4. Work in a small group.Assume thatyouaremembel'sof an innet-city needle exchange centte. Devetop detailed JX>liciies and pfocedures fOr' deaW~ with violent and JX)tenlialty violent clients. OiHlcull Situations: Engaging wltl'I Hard-to- Reael'I Clients 269 5. Suppose you review lhe fde on your oox.t dienl, a l&yeaf. Old male, and discovef thal he was IOUCI and abusive with his previous counsetlOr'. What are some JX)SSible ex~nalions tot this client's behaviour? Suggest some strategies fof wOr'king with this clienl 6. Work in a smatl group to exi:,ore the potential beneflls and riskS ot each of the fOllowing: a. Having an unlisted phone num bet c. He's stil a~ry. 8. Wot'k with one Or' two COiieagues to practise asse-rtiver'W!lSs: a. &pressing angerb. Saying Moo• to a requesa c. Sharing positive feelings such as IOve Of affeclion d. Accepti~ a compliment b. Making home visits alOOe e. &pressing disagreement c. Making home visits onty when accompanied by a coueague d. Conducti~ joa"lt interviews for potentiall'y hostile clients e. Using only youf fll'St name with clients t Knowing that a dient has a history of viole~ r.. b. He doNtlplays the serious nature of the incident. Interviewing a client with a police office( present h. Refusing to see a client with a history of tJiolence I. Striking a dient to defend yourself J. ca1;og the police k. Warn.i~ an intended victim I. Seeing a client whO has been dra"lking 7. The setting is a residential centm foe youth. Youf laSI lntet..;ew with Petet was partkl.Jarl'j distressi~. It ended wilh his throwing lhe Chait against the wall, swearing loudly at you, and then stormi~ out of yout office, Slamming the dOOf in the pfocess and breaki~ one of the hinges. This in.ddent seems to have been pfecipitated by his frusttation at not being anowed to smoke in the centre. OevelOp a ~n for dealing with Petet during the next lnteMew and in the coming months. Suggest specific leads you can use in the oox.t lnteMew. Considef Itvee possible scenarios: a. He di.splays remorse over- wtlat happened. (Suggestion: Role play aggressive and passive responses fOr' each of the pfeceding scenarios, then discuss hON assertiveness dlfet'S). 9. Conduct an ex.tended role play baSed on the fOUOwing situation: You have just begun a new job as a youth wOr'ket in a residential woup hOme. Yout client i:S a 14-yeat-dd bOy wM has been in care since he was six years old. Ouri~ that time, he has lived in ovef 17 foster ho.ines. After mooting you, he says, '"Why ShOtAd I tfust you? You guys are all allk.e. You make all sorts ot promises, but nothi~ ever happens. This is just a jOb fof you, but it's my life. Next month, there wil probabl'f be anOthet new wOr'kef.• Concepts I. Research legal and ethtcal codes to ex.plore your responsibility to notify intended victims of vidence. Talk to counseltors and agencies fOr' their opinions. 2. Write a ShOrt concept paper lhat deSO'ibes what you believe are lhe elements ot effective confrontation. 3. Hamachek (1982) says, "Oo not confront anothef person if you do not wish to rnc,ease yolM' invdvement with that individuar (p. 230). DIM!lop a tationale that supports lhis statement. 4. How can assertively ex.pressed anget deepen relations.hips? WEBLINKS The Crisis Prevention Institute provides information abOut training programs and resou1ces fo, nonviolent crisis inf0tmation A comp,ehensive Canadian study on mental illness and violence https://www.er1sisprevenbon.com/Spec1a1ties1Nonvio1entCnsis-l ntervention www.phac-aspc.gc.calmh-sm/pubslmenta1_111ness/indexeng.php Canadian Centre f01 Occupational Health and Safety provides information about violence and violence p,evention Canadian Centre fo, Threat Assessment and Trauma Re:spoose offers information and training for responding to th,eats and potentially violent situations www.ccohS.caloshanswers/pS)'t'hosociaVviolence.html http://www.cctatt.c-am Th is ttbsite provides acc-ess and links to a wide rang_e of health and emotional issues (use the sea1ch feature to find material on violence). www.mayocl1nic.com 270 Chap1er 8 sleep hygiene healthca sports nutrition physical activity C.anbedone/Shutterstock ■ Understand the nature and bf'COOth of mental illness in Canada. ■ Ex-plain the structure, use, and limitations of the Diagnosiic and Suuisrical Manual of Menral Disarders (DSM). ■ Describe rhc characteristics of and rrearmcm for major mental disorders., including sc.hi:ophrenia, mood disorders. :mxicry disorders, eating disorders, and personality disorders. ■ Explore the mcntaJ health issues of children and youth. ■ Describe rhc nnrure and impact of substance abuse. ■ Identify best-practice approaches for w-orking with clients with substance use problems, including those with co-occurring disorders. ■ Identify suicide warning signs and strategics for dc3ling with clients who arc suicidal. MENTAL HEALTH IN CANADA Attempts to treat mental illness date back thousands of years, but they were typically inhumane and crud when judg,ed by tocfay's standnrds. Historically, trc3tmcm of poople with mcntaJ disorders was barbaric and ineffective with practices such as exorcising, burning "witches/' bloodletting, whipping, starving, imprisoning, or housing in overcrowded "snake pits'' or insane asylums. During the twentieth and twenty-first centuries, especially in the last 50 years, mental disorders have gradually been recogni:ed as health problems. and more humanitarian practices have been dcvdopcd co rcplncc procedures based on superstition, fear, and ignorance. Over the past 70 years in Canada, there has bttn a major and continuous shift in the delivery of mental health services from lonj;•tcrm treatment in hospitals to tT'C1lt.mcm of patients in the community, a process known as dcinstitutionalization. Today, the population of mcntaJ hospitals in Canada is only a smaJI fraction of what it was 40 years ago (Scaly & 'W hitehead, 2004) and some, such as Riverview HospitaJ in Coquidam, British Columbia, which once hou~ thousands of patients, are virrually dosed. However, there arc some proposals to reopen abandoned facilities based on modeJs of treatmem different from the traditional "wnrchousing" methods of the past. The development nnd refinement of a ran,;c of psychotropic drugs has been the driving force behind deinstirutionali!ation because these drugs enable patients to control hnJ,. lucinations and behaviour that might otherwise preclude their living in the community. However, this move toward community treatment has often been poorly funded, nnd new problems for those with mental disorders have resulted, particularly homelessness (Davis, 2006). Dcinstitutionalization in Canada left many people with mental illness in communities with in:.ldcquate tre3tmcnt. suppon, and outreach. \\:rhile no one would argue for a return to the ''\\--nrchouscs" of the nineteenth and earl)• twentieth centuries, it is clear that many people dischar,;cd from rhc mental hospitals are now living in dire conditions, often in poverty-stricken inner cities such ns the Downtown Eastside in Vancouver. Table 9. 1 outlines some facts about mental health in Canadn. The Mental Health Commission of Canada (2012) proposed an overhaul of the mental health system that called for broad changes, including the promotion of mental health throughout life, suicide prevention, support of recovery through use of optimum integrated services, removal of S)'Stemic barriers to worlc and education, and the strengthening of services to Northerners. First Nations, and Jnuit peoples. Mental Health Assessment The purpose of psychiatric diagnosis is 00( to label clients but to match dingnosis to treatment decisions based on the best scientific evidence regarding which rreanncnts are likely to be most effective with each disorder (Corcoran & \\:lnlsh, 2009). Psychiatric assessment and dingnosis involves (idea.Hy) an in-depth interview, including a thorough history of the person's situation. Physical examinntions, including brain scans, electroencephalograms (EEGs), and lab tests, mny be u~ to rule our O'l'J:anic illness, which can cause psychiatric symptoms. Psychological tests mny be u~ to nsscss thinking, person.aliry, and other variables. ln nddition, families and friends are an important source of information, particularly when clients arc denying the presence of psychiarric symptoms. Psrchintric diagnosis is influenced by cultural and societal values. For example, at various times in history, homosexuality has been considered both an aberration and a gift. Jt is no longe.r considered a mental disorder. There may be vast differences among individunls with the same mental disorder. Psychological, social, and b iological variables in8uencc how illness manifests in each 272 Chap1er 9 TABLE 9.1 Mental Health, Canadi an Fac ts • One in frve C3nadians ot au educatbnal backgroundS, income tievets. and cultures will experience a menial illness or subsiance mis.use problem duri~ their lifetime-. • Most mental itlnesses begin in adOlescence and young adulthood. • Mental itlness arises from a complex k\tetaetioo of biologk.31. genetic, persooaffly, and e-nvitonmental factors. • Social ar\CI wOl'kptace pressures, poverty, subsiance abuse, and learned behaviow'al and lhinking patterns can inftuence 100 onset and outcome of mental illness. • Studies have Shawn that at least 23 percent and as many as 67 percent ot homeless people have a mental l lness.. • During any ooo-yeat period: • Over 8 pefcent ot the canae1ian population expedence a mooo diwdet • 0.3 percent ex.pe-rience sct.zophrenia • • • • • • • • • • • • 12 percent experience an anxiety diSOr'det • AltOOSt 2.5 percent expe(aeoce an eating disotder • One in ten people ex.petience some disability from a diagnosable mental disorder. In canae1a duri~ 2001- 2002, tnere were almost 200, 000 psychiatric hOspital admissions with an average stay of 43 days--over 8 mtlion patient days. MOr'e hospital beds in canada (8 percen0 are tl\Jed with persoos with schiZoph(enia than with any Olher condition. Mental itlness costs the healthcare system as much as $7 biltbn, while the annual total impacl of mental heafth (healttk::a(e, lost prOductMty) exceeds $51 billion. As many as one--thir'd of the homeless have a mental disorder. App(oxlI1'13tety 1 percent of canae1ians wi\J ex.pel'ience bipolar disotde(. At least 2 percent of au deattrs are from suidde. Personality di:sol"ders affect between 6 percent and 9 percent (estimated) of the C3nadian population. Suicide accounts for 24 pe(cent of au deaths among tnose 1S to 24 years of age and 16 percent among 1oose aged 25 to 44 years. Psychiatric ptoblems are the second leading cause of hospital admissions among 1oose 20 to 44 years (j(I. Most mental itlness can be 1reated. Best-practice intervention favours t(eatment in the community using a variety of counselling inter-ve-ntions, occupational therapy, and medication. Sources.- British CotufT't>ia Schizophrenia Society. 2008: Centre Jot Addiction and Mental Health. 2017: Corcoran & Walsh. 2009: [>a,.,is. 2006: Go.<emment oi Canada. 2017a: Heatth Canada. 2002a: NIMH. 2012: Public Heatth Pf,,ett:y oi Canada. 2002: Regen( & Glancy. 2010: and Siatistics Canada. 2005. person . In addition, people with mentaJ d isorders ma)' have con cur rent p roble ms, such as poverty, su bstance ab u se, a nd social or reJationship d iffic ulties. A co-occ urring diso rder is p resent when a person has both a substance abuse problem o r addictio n and a psyc.hiarric d iso rder. Psychiatric d iagnosis is made by a physician, prcfcrab l)• a psych iatrist, o r a psrcholo gist who is train~ in clinical assessm ent. Some jurisdictions aJlow social ,vo rke rs who have co mp le ted considerab le training and supervised experience to make a diagnosis. Everyone who wo rks in the field should be aJert to sians and S)'mpto ms that warrant a referral fo r medical and psychiatric assessment. Significant warning signs include: hallucinations, delusions., identity confu sion , m em ory loss, parano ia, inapp ropr iate anxiety, eupho ria or sadness, mood swings, eating a nd bod,., image problems. o bses.sions and co mpulsion s., self~harm (e.g., c utting), and substance misu se. Menial Disorders and Substance Misuse 2·73 SUCCESS TIP Unless you have specific training, avcid lhe temptation to diagnose me-nt.al iUness. Le.am to (ecognize the ge-ne<al symptoms and signs of me-ntal disorde-rs such as psychOstS (hatluclflations and delusions), uncootrOllable- emotions (anxiety aoo depression), and disturbances in thinking. Then make appropraate ,eterrals, support treatment, aoo promote tnedication cotnplian::::e. The Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders (DSM) Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Mental Oisorders: Publisiled by the American Pi)(.hiatric As.sociat._i is uv.d ps,t.hct>gists. Pi)(.hiatrists, •d Oiher psyddllerapiUi todassify and "° lia:gnose aEGtal disorden. The DiagnoSLic and Statistical Manual of Mental Di$0Tders (DSM), published by the American Psychiatric As.soci3tion, is used by ps,.·chologists, psychiatrists, 3nd other psychotherapists throughout the United States, Cannda, and many other countries to classify and diagnose mcnta.1 disorders. DSM docs not include guidance or information on treatment. In Europe and some other countries, the International Classification of Oiscascs-10 (IC0- 10) is used. The first edition, known as DSM-1, was published in 1952, and it was lar,;ely based on psycho3na.l'tttic principles. DSM-I listed 106 diagnoses and with cnch subsequent revision, the number increased to the current number of almost 300. With the publication of the third edition in 1980, psychoannhttic theory was aban.doncd in favour of a system b3scd on diagnostic criteria. The criteria were rcsc3rched and developed to help increase rdiabilit)•- the prob3bility that different clinicians would assess a client with the same diagnostic result or conclusion regarding a person's mental disorder. DSM-Ill and DSM-IV used a multiaxinJ S\'Stcm (five axes) to facilitate a more comprehensive assessment. ■ ■ Axis I and II: to classify clinicaJ disorders, with Axis JI reserved for pcrsonn1ity disorders and mental retardation Axis lll: to rcpon relc..,ant medic:.ll conditions such as hypothyroidism (which can cause depression) that affect a mental disorder ■ Axis IV: to report significant strcs.sors such as job and housing problems that miRht be concributina to the mcntaJ disorder ■ Axis V: Cjlobal Assessment of Functioning Srnle (GAF): used to score on a scale of 0-100 an individunJ's highest level of functionina in three major are3s: socinJ functionina, occup3tional functioning:, and psychological functionina. Predictably, people who have a higher level of functioning before their illness ,;cnemllydo better than those with a lower level (Saddoclc & Saddock, 2004). DSM-5 DSM-5, the latest edition, was published in late sprina, 2014. lt contains a number of sianificant changes including: the followina: I. The traditionnJ Roman numeral has been dropped and subsequent revisions will be identified as DSM-5. 1, DSM-5.2, and so on. 2. The multiaxial S)'Stcm introduced in DSM-HI has been eliminated, and all disorders arc now classified in a single section with 22 chapters. 3. Chapters are ori:ani!cd with a lifosp3n approach, beginning with disorders that are most likdy diagnosed in childhood. 4. Aspcrae.r's S)rndromc has been eliminated. 274 Chap1er 9 5. Revised model for classifying substance use disorders. which also includes the addition o f g3mbling disorder 6. New disorders: hoarding and disruptive mood dysregulation 7. The archaic term "mental retardation" has been rep laced by inteJlecrual disability and intcllecrual developmental d isorder Appropriate Uses of the DSM The over view in this chapter is a b rief introduction to the basic structure of the manual. Counsellors should use the DSM classification S)'Stcm as a diagnostic tool onh• if they have appropriate specialized clinical training. Typically, ind ividmds who use the DSM in the.ir cou nselling p ractice are licensed psychiatrists or those with grnduate degrees in counselling or psychology. Unrrained practitioners should not attcmJX to make ps,.·chiatric diagnoses. Ho\\'ever, all counsellors should have a thorough knO\\•ledge of mental disorders and the.ir effect on individuals and fam ilies. At the ver y least, they should be able to recogni!c behavioural, cmotionaJ, and cognitive difficulties that suggest the need for further assessment (sec Figure 9. 1). The DSM contains valuable information rcg3rd ing variations in culture, age, and ,;ender with respect to particular mental disorders. The manual also provides counsellors with refcre.nce materiaJ on the prevalence of mental disorder~ including lifetime ris k, the typical patterns o f disorders, and data on the frequency of specified d isorders among biological famil y members. Warning Signs Figure 9.1 - Signs of a Potential Mental Disorder CAUTION: The presence of one 0t f1'IOfe oi these warni "1 signs does not mean lhe i ndividual has a men1a1 disorder: however. 1hey may signal the need for a professional assessment to assess medical or psychiatric illness. Menial Disorders and Substance Misuse 2·75 Definition of a Mental Disorder DSM-5 de.fines a mental disorder 3s follows: A mental dison:le-r is a S)'ndrome eh3r:v!ted:ed by dmic::alJy si¥ni0eant disturb.In« in ::an individu::al's COitJ1it.On. emotion r~ufatk>n. or behavior th::n refleets. 2 dys.(unetion in the psyeho1otie3I, bio1otie3I, or de"eloprnent2I process.es underl)' int ment21 (unetionh-)¥. MentaJ disorders. ::are us.uaJI)' assoc:i::ated with si~nil"tet.nt dist ress in sociaJ. occupational. o r other import::ant 2ctivities. An expec12ble or euhur:1111)' ::approved response 10 a oommon strdSOror loss. such 3S the de:ith o( 2 IO\wl one. ii not 2 mentaJ disorder. Soefallr ckvi2nt behavior (e.~. politkal. reli&iOu!l. o r seicwil) and conflicts. that ::are prim::ml)' beh'i~n the individuaJ 2nd soeti'l)' 2rt not ment::al dison:lers unless the deviance or conflict results (ron, 2 dys-fo~1on in the individuaJ. 2s. described 2bcn-e (Amerk::an Ps.yehi::atrie Assod::at ion, 2013. p.20). Unlike medic:)) disorders. sueh 2s.di::abete!l. there2re oode:ar fab1ests th3t helpdinki:ms 10 di2~nose 111ent11I disorders. Consequentlr, 111en121 health dinK"fans. must rely on DSM~5 criteria 2nd their jud~rnent 1odeterrnine i( the DSM threshold for 2 mental disorder has been re::.ched-"siil)if'leant distress. in soei.31, oee-upahon31. or other important ::.etwities.. (Amerlean PsrehiatrK" Assodat.On. 2013, p.20). T he.re can be significnnt diffe.rcnces among individu:.ds with the s:.un,e diagnosis. One person with schizophrenia may suffer debilitating effects 3nd his o r her bch3viour may present as bizarre. but 3nother m3y respond to medic3tion to the point where he o r she functions "norma.11)•, " with no one suspectina that this per son h3s a mentaJ disorder. In addition to the severity o( the disorder, other foctors. such 3S age of onset. presence o( social support~ 3Vail3bility of treatment, 3nd willingness to follow rreatmem regimes, affect how weJI people cope. SUCCESS TIP Everyone can have intense emot.ions and lhOughts when dealing with stress. These reactions sholld not be confused with a mental disor'der. A diagt'losis of a mental diSOr'det can only be justified when lheSe reacti:)ns happe-n over an extended pe(tOCI, and there is significant impairment ot a perSOO's ability to function in daily life. Critique of the DSM~S Even before it w3s published, OSM-5 3ttractcd a high level o ( criticism. Among the most voC3l was Dr. Allen France~ author o ( Sm.,ing Normal: An Insider's Relolr Agai1m Our..-of-Comrol Psychiatric Diagnosis, DSM-5. Big Pharma. and rhe Medicalizarion of Ordinary Life. Frances, ch3ir of the task force that compiled DSM IV argued th3t the new DSM-5 will "IC3d to massive overdiaanosis and harmful ovcrmcdic3tion" with n ew or sharply revised mental d isorders such 3S disruptive mood dysregulation disorder, medicali!ing normal arid, minor neurocognitive disord er. and m3ny others. T he DSM, however, usdul as 3 tool for intcllcctu311)• understanding mental disorde.rs, is based on the medical model of diaanosis with an emph3sis on symptoms and p3thology. Cou nscllina is p rimarily concerned with individua.Js in a soci3l conre.xt, with an emphasis on hcJping them to deal with re lationship problems, crisis events, difficul.ties rcJatcd to in3dequate resource~ and problems dealing with ori:ani!ations such 3S schools or government wclforeoffaces. Effective co u nsellors 3dopt a strenarhs 3pprooch to problem solving that 3ssumcs the powero( individua.Js to overcome adve.rsit)'. With a strengths perspective, they emphasi:e "human resilience-the skills. abilities, knowledge, and insight that people accumul3teover time as they srruggle to sur mount 3dversity and mttt lifo ch3Jlenges" (Corco r3n & Walsh, 2009, p. 10). They endeavour to find and respect the successes, 3ssets, and resources o ( people, indudina those resources avail.able within their culture such 3s swe3t lodges and other hcaJina ritua.Js. \\:fhiJe Compton 276 Chap1er 9 and Galaway (2004) rccogni!e the advantages of the DSM in terms of its wide use and common language for professionals, they also uri;e caution, re.minding us that: ■ Many phenomena included as mentaJ disorders are more usefully explained in social, economic, or environmental terms. ■ Psychiatric labels often IC1ld co lifetime stigmnti.!ation. ■ Diagnostic reliability re.mains suspect (p. 196). Lloyd SOOe.rer, medical dir«cor of the New York State Office of MentaJ Hea1th offers this succinct comment on the value of the controversia.J DSM: A di.:1KJ10stie m.:m~I of men1:il disordeTS eannot be eluded. Clink':ians need spec1(k· ways of dedarin¥ what the)' obse-n'i' co be one oondit1on or~mother so che)'C2n spe::ak t'O eaeh other 2nd t'O p3tients and fanulies. Rese::trehers need reliable db¥ooses co stud)' whether t re::ttments work, and the course- and proauosi.s of diseases (Sederer. 2012.) SUCCESS TIP Most practitioners as well as people wrth mental diSOfderS and theif families wfl find mud'I more useful and use-r-friendly infotmation on psychiatrk:: illness thtough organizations sud'I as the C3nadi:an Mental Health Association (d'lma.ca) 0t lhe canae1aan Cen1re f0t Addiction and Mental Health (carm.ca) than lhey Viill from the DSM. Both sites pfovide compfehen. SNe information and ad\lice on specific iUness, medications, tfeatment and supPQC'I fof fecovery, not jusa tfeatment of symptoms. Structure of the DSM DSM-5 organi:es mental disorders under 20 major chapters with each diagnostic class funher subdivided into specific disorders (APA, 2013). The chnpters arc organized based on a developmental lifespan, starting with disorders first diagnosed in childhood, then progressing to adult disorders. Table 9 .2 provides an overview of the structure. Major Mental Disorders This section provides only a very brief synopsis of some of the most common mental disorders that counsellors are like1)• to e.ncounte.r, including sc.hizophrcnin, mood disorders. anxiety disorders, eating disorders, and personality disorders. Schizophrenia According to the Schizophrenia Society of Canada (2009), schitophrenia is a chronic (continuing) mental disorder affecting about I pe.rcent of the population. ln rare case~ children can develop schi:ophrenia, but it usuaJly sta.rts in the late teens or early Ntenties for men, and in d"K" twenties and Cl.rl)• thirties for women. Although the exact cause remains unknown, it is bdievcd that the disease is a biochemical brain disorder involving suspect neurotransmine.rs sud,, as dopamine and serotonin. The children of a pGrent who has schi:ophrenia are IO times more likcly to dcvdop the disorde.r compared to children of a parent who does not have it (NationaJ Institute of Mental Health [NIMH), 2012). Schi.!ophrenia is a chronic, lifdong illness with no cure: 00\,·evcr, it can be treated, and most people are able to rccovc.r and continue with their lives. Nevenhcless, an estimated one of every ten people with the illness dies by suicide (NIMH, 2012). Contrary to popular opinion, people with sc.hi:ophrenia do not have split personaJj,. tics, like Dr. Jekyll and Mr. Hyde. Furthermore, although some once accepted it as truth, parents do not cause sc.hi:ophrcnia➔ The current perspective on the disorder is that it is caused by an imbalance of the complex, inte.rrcJat~ chemical systems of the brain (NIMH, 2012), but the.re may be no single cause. The symptoms of schizophrenia wry among individual~ sometimes dramaticaJI)•. The s~mptoms arc commonly classified as Menial Disorders and Substance Misuse schizophrenia: Athronic Mft1al disorder i11rot-..., s,'llft.aas std as hallucilations.. delusioa, discwdefed t!lillling. and social isciblion. 2·77 TABLE 9.2 DSM-5 Structure M•JO< c.te&OIJ Specific DJsorde.-s Under Thb Cateaory Neu(Odevelopmental disotderS • lntetlectual; communication; autism spec1rum; attantion deflcil/hyperacrivily; learning; SchizOl')htenia spectrum and other psychork:: disorders • SchiZotypal per'SOOatity, delusional; bl'ief psychotk; subStanc&-incluOOCI psychotic; Bipola( and related disorde-rs • Bipolar I; bipolar II; cyctothymic; subslance induced bipolar Depressive disorders: • Disruptive mood CfySregulation disol"dEr; major' depressive disorder; persistent depressive diSOr'det (dysthymic) pramenstrual dySphoric diSOr'det; subslance/ meclkation◄nduced depressive diSOr'der Anxiety disorders: • Separation anxiety; selective mutis.m; specific phobia; social anxiety; panic; ago,aphobia; generali?ed anxiety; subStance induced Obsessive-compulsive and (elated disorders • ObsessmKompulsi\18; txxly dySmorphic; hoarding; hair putling (trichotillomania); excoriatiOl'Vs.Jdn picking. subslaoce induced Ttauma and stresw-related disorders • Reactive atiachment: disinhibitecl social e~etnent; post-traumatic stress.; acute stress disorder; adjustment Dissociative diwde<s Somatic symptom diwders • Dissociative identity; dissociative amnesia deper'SOOali:zation/dereali?.ation F'eeding and eating disorderS • Pie.a; rumination; avoidant restrictive fOOO intake; anorexia oorvosa; bulimia oervosa; binge eating motor catatonic; schizophreniform; schizoaffeclive • Somatic symptom; illness anxiety; corwersion: psychOlogical factors affecti~ medical conditions; factitious Elimtnation di!.orde-rs • Enuresis. eOCOl')resis Sleep.-wake disorders: • Insomnia; hyper'SOtnnolence; narcOlepsy; sleep apnea; central steep apnea; Sleep. related hyi::x,ventilation; circadian rhythm sleep wake; diSOr'det of arousal; nightmare; rapid eye movement sleep behaviour; restiess leg; subStance induced Sexual dySfunctions • Delayed ejaculation; erectile; female orgasmic: female sexual intetest/arousal disorder; genil~petvic pain penetration disotder; male hypoactive sex.ual desire; premature ejaculation; substance induced Gender dysphoria Disruptive, impulse controt, and • Gencl« dySph0tia in children; gendet dysphOr"aa in acldescents or adults • Oppositional defiant; inte<mittent ex.ptosive: conduct; antisocial perSOnality disorder: conduc1 disorders: Subs1aoce use and addktive disorders • Akxlhol: caffeine; cannabis; hallucinogen; k'lhalant: opioid; Sedative hypnotic; stimulant: tobacco; unk.no-,m subStance; gambling P}'l'omania; kleptomania Neurocognilive di:sol"ders • Oefirium; mild & ma;or neurocogoitive (e.g., Alzheimer"s, vascular oeurocognilive, traumatic brain injury, due to HIV infection) PerSOOality disorders: • Paranoid; schi:zoid: Sd'li:zotypal; antisodaf; bOr'dertine; histtionic: narcissistic; avoidant; dependent; o~ompursi\18 Paraphilk disorders: • Voye-uristic; exhibitioni:stic; frotte-uristi::::; sexual masochism; sexual sadism; pedaphillk; fetishistic Condit.ions kit furthet Sludy • Attenuated psychosis syndrome; depmssive episodes with short~uration hy(X)mania; perSistent complex bereavement; caffeine use disotder; Internet gambti~ disorde1; OOIXObehavioural disorder associated with prenatal ale:OhOI ex(X)sure; non-suicidal selfinjury; suicidal behaviour (further research encouraged with poss.ibil~y of i~lusion in future editions ol DSM) Soorce: Based on Diagnostic and Statisaic-al Manual of Mental Oiscrdets (OSM-S-), American Psychiatric AssociatKIO positiw, symptoms: S>,9rptoms ol ps,t.hosis that incWe hal!l:inatioa, delusioa, biiarre bdt,lriout, agitati>n, thought disorder, dis«ganind sp«th •d bebtiour, and cata;oai:: behariour. (See also nega!Ne sy,tt¢Mt1J 278 positive o r negative. Positive symptoms may include hallucinntions, delusions., bizarre behaviour, agitation, thought disorder, disorpni:ed speech and behaviour, and catatonic behaviour. Ncaative symptoms include blunted or flattened affect, poverty of speech, emotional and social withdrawal, lack of plC3sure (anhedonia), passivity, difficulty in abstract thinking, and lad, of ,;oaJ.-dirccted behaviour (Ralph, 2003). Antipsyc.hotic medications (neuroleptics) are the most effoctive way of tre3ting the positive symptoms of sc.hi:ophrenia➔ Chap1er 9 There arc a wide variety of early warning sians of schizophrenia, indudina noticeable sociaJ withdraw-a.I, deteriorating persona] hygiene, irrational behaviour, s1ttp disturbancc5i. extreme rcaction5i. inappropriate laughter, cuttina or strange use of words., and many others (for a more complete list, sec British Columbia Schi:ophrcnia Society, 2008, p. 6). negative symptoms: s.,np,oas d ps,chosis tu include blunted c:r Hattened afP.Ct. pc,.,e,tyof speech, emotilnal ud social 'lliihdn111al, lack of plei.suf! (anhedonia). passivity. drlficu., in abstract Hilling. -.:I Del ol g_oal• direaEd bebl'iour. l'See also positive S]1Q,Ot(IIIS.) SUCCESS TIP Psychotropi::: medication, wtlete warranted, is only the firSt step in treatment Aftet medication, counsetlOt'S play a key role tn assist~g clients to manage the negative symptoms of Sd'li:zophrenia and othet mental disotderS. This is crucial since negative syrnptOO'ls can be far more dt$1'uptive for people with mental diSOtderS and lheir families than positive symproms.. Counsenors can also educate families abOut oogative symptoms, which Viill help them 10 reali:ze lhat these ate symptoms of the disotder, not the resun of lack ot wYlpower. (Velllgan & Pips, 2008). Hallucinations There arc wide variations in the symptoms of persons with schi:o phrcnia➔ Most sufferers, however, experience hallucinations, usually auditory but sometimes visuaJ or olfactory (related to smcJI). These hallucinations ma'>' be \'oices that tell clients what to do (command hallucinations), or they may be \'lsions of things that do not exist. Persons with command hallucinations telling them to harm themselves or others are dangerous risks for suicide, homicide, or other violent behaviour (Soddock & Soddock. 2004). Hallucinations can affect any of a person's senses, causing them to hear, see, taste, touch, or smell what others do not. Auditory hallucinations arc the most frequent type of haJlucination and arc most common for people with schi!ophrenia (60-90%) (Clark, 2015; Fauman, 2002). VisuaJ hallucinations arc much less common, and they are more likely to occur as a result of acute infectious disease. Olfactory haJlucinations may occur because of schi:ophrcnia and oraanic lesions in the brain. Tactile hallucinations (touch) ma'>' occur as a reaction to drugs. Kinesthetic hallucinations may occur after the loss of a limb ("phantom limb") and O\\•ing to schi zophrenia➔ 'Withdrawal from drugs may cause vivid hallucination5i. such as the sensation that insects are crawling under the skin (delirium tremens, common with alcohol withdrawnJ; Saddodc & Saddodc, 2004). In fact, the symptoms of alcohol withdrawaJ may be clinically indistinguishable from schi:ophrcnia (NIMH, 2012). \\:lith disordc.rs such as schi.!ophrenia, people may have auditory hallucinations with voices that arc complimentary, but more often the \'oices are hostile (Shea, 1998). These \'oices may be so re3f that clients bcJievc that they have had broadcasting devices planted in their bodies. For example, one client was convinced that her demist had secretly implanted "radio receivers" in hc.r dcntaJ fillings. Jc w·as so rca1 to her that she could not dismiss it as imagination. lt is important to know that many things can cause hallucinations, including psrchosi~ high fever, mind-a1tering drugs (marijuana, psilocybin, LSD, and opium), medication5i. withdrawal from depressant drugs such as akohol, brain disease and injury, epilepsy, sensory deprivation or sensory ovc.rlo3d, oxrgcn deprivation, hyperventila, tion, hypoglrcc.mia. extreme pain, e>..'tended fasting, dehydration, and social isolation (Bcrerstein, 1998: Regehr & Glancy, 201 O; S3ddock & Saddodc. 2004). Hallucinations can also occur in persons who have impaired vision but no mental disorder. Delusions Delusions are false beliefs that "cannot be influenced or corrected by rea, son or contradictory evidence (Fauman, 2002, p. 149). Persons with sc.hi:ophrcnia may experience delusions or distorted beliefs involving birnrre thought patterns. OcJusions of persecution, t)tpical in paranoid sc.hi:ophrenia, may lead people to believe they are Menial Disorders and Substance Misuse hallucination: Afals.e • distor;ed senso,y pattplion std as Ilea,.,_ ~ tasi.i, to~ or s.lling_ what otks do not c:onvnand hallucination: Adistor;ed peaptioo of voi::es-.:J iaa,es dir..ct-, aae to perfcm some a«ion (e.g., attack or ijtsa.eone). delusion: Oist«tEdbeiefsort~ pat.'lerns t!l.it c..nct be thallengEd by «hen • sint ruson • "'idelltf. 2·79 thought broadcasting: The delusiod baie-f that aae's thinking caa be heard t,, cthen. thought insertion: ne delusi:inal belief that thoughts are being inS!fted il:o• 's brain t,,othffs. be.ina chC3ted, controlled, o r poisoned. Other common deJusions indude reliaious delusions (bclief th3t one is a m3nifost3tion of God), deJusions of grandeur (bizarre beliefs about one's 3b ilities), deJusions of being controlled (e.a., belief that one is being: d irected b\• radio mcs.s3gcs), thought broadcasting (belief that one's thinking: can be hC3rd b\• others), 3nd thouJ:ht in....ertion (beJief th3t thoughts are being inserted into one's brain by others). Not all deJusions arc bizarre. Ex3mplcs of non-bizarre delusions are the client's belief that he or she is being watched or that 3 famou s person loves the client (erotom3ni3) (F3um3n, 2002; Saddock & Saddodc, 2004). Disordered Thinking Another common feature of sc.hi:ophrenia is disordered think.ing. Jndividuals may be unable to think logically, o r they may jump from one idea to another without any apparent logic3l connection. Thinking ma'>' be so disorganized and fraamented that it is tota.11'>' confusina to others. Social Isolation Persons with schi:ophrenia arc often socially isolated and withdrawn. They may be emotionally numb, have poor communication skills, 3nd show decreased motivation 3nd 3b ility for self-care. Treatment of Schizophrenia Hospitali!3tion may be 3 ncccss3ry first step in the effcc.. tive treatment of 3Cute psychotic symptoms, p3rticularh• if there is a risk of violence (R3lph, 2003). Antipsyc.hotic medications such 3S clozapine and risperidone are used to decrease the positive symptoms of the disorder- h3llucinations, aaitation, confusion, distortions, and delusions. There is no cure for schizophrenia, but long-term d rug m3intcnance now en3bles most people with the disC3sc: to live outside 3 psychiatric institution. Counselling is an import3nt adjunct to antipsychotic medication. Counsdlors rypi.cally target their 3ctivitics at helping clients d eal with the socinJ aspects of the disease. As well, counsdlo rs c3n be instrumental in encouraging clients to sedc psychiatric attention when necessary, and they c.nn suppon psychiatric initiatives by cncouragina clients to continue with any prescribed medic3tion. This is crucinJ since about 50 percent of people with schizophrcnfa are noncompliant in mkina their mediation 3nd for those wirh co-occurrina disorders., medic3tion noncompliance is more common than not (Substance Abuse 3nd Mental Health Services Administration, 2008). l ong-actina (one to six weeks) antipsychotic medication is an option for those who have difficult)' (R31ph, 2003). One client, a young university stu dent, jpvcs us a sense o f what the world of a person with schizophrenia is like: I want t'O sue 11\)' dent ist. O\'er the pr3st year. he has been installu)¥ r:1d10 t ransrniuers in ll1Ji1l{tS. Now he uses them to rontrol me. A t Ar-St, he was nke. and then her.aped me wlule he ..vork.ed on 11\)' tee-th. Sometimes he makes me sl~p with eomplete str.1.ns;er!l. I( I don' t ~-et them remo"~ soon. I misht be forced t'O do son~hin~ awful. There are others. I talked to a woman on the phone the otllt-rday. Her dentist d,d the s::une thin&\Ve ne«I to~-<> undef¥round where Yi't, ea.n be sa(e from the e:nemr. 11\)' depr-ession: P«v1.Siw de-fbtica in aood dufatteriz!d by S)mptoms std as sadness. hope-lmness. dec1uS!d enera, • d diffiOlty CC1Ceatr~ • d ma-,: Meisi>ns. nmeatering, bipolar disorder: A aooi disorder characteriied by alternatilc pericds al depressi>n and a.tmally hEigltt.enEd aood. sometimes to tbe pciill of i,andi>siy. , , . Mith bipctar diticwder auy t>euve irrati)nallyte.g..!(ini on .aintdled bu,-i sprees. committing seiual indisueioa, and talilg part in foolish businen iMstmeats). 280 Mood Disorders The two most severe mood disorders (3Jso known as 3ffcctive d isorder s) arc major depression 3nd bipolar disorder, o r manic-depressive illness. Depression About 8 percent o f Canadians will deaJ with depression 3t some point in their lives; however, it is diagnosed twice as often 3mong women, who m3y be more vulnerable to it or they m3y be more likeJ,., to seek treatment (Davis, 2006). Although ever yone has bad day~ the depressed foding:s usually pass q uickly. A clinic.nl d i3gnosis o f depression is made when a person's depressed mood becomes pcn'3sive over time and interferes with the person's ability to cope with or enjoy life. In this way, depression is differcntinted from the normal mood swings th3t ever yone experiences. Dep ression is almost certainly more widespread th3n statistics suggest since it often goes Chap1er 9 _ CONVERSATION 9.1 STUDE:NT: What is pafanoia? MENTAL HEALTH WORKER: Paranoia is a very common type of delusion that involves faase Of lflc!ltional beliefs 1riat others afe intant on caus~g one harm. A certain level of suspicion is normal and desirable as it ptotects us fratn venturi~ into dangetous situations and from othets taking advantage ot us. Ho-NENet, i.ndividualS with pamnoia jl«Sist in lhell mistrust of olhefS, even when evidence to the conttary is ptesented. They are hypervigilant, and they ate obsessed abOut the hidden motives of others. Typically, lheit interactions With people, inch.Jdiog counsellOrS and othet ptofessionals, ate filtered thr'OUgh theit paranoid lens.. STUDE:NT: How can you tel if it's a delusion or n01? MENTAL HUlTH WORKER: Sometimes. delusions are bizarre aoo easdy identified such as the patient who believes that someone has put trans.rnittets in Mr teeth in Otder to send her messages and control her behaviou". Other times. 1t may be difficult to detet'mioo if it is a delusion or if 100 client's fears are justified. It's important to keep an open mind. One woman, who had schizophfenia and a number of bi:zarfe delusions, had trouble convincing people she had been sexually abused by her doctor. They assumed that because ot he-r illness. her accusation was yet another delusion. In fact, 1t later- proved to be true. STUDE:NT: My gfandmothef, who had detnentia, thOUgt\t lhat her ldds were steali~ ftom her. She aaso believed that they ~Med to kill het in ordef to get he-r money. In fad, it was hef faili~ memory. She was misplaci~ hef possessions, then she would conclude she was a vi::::tim of lheft. MENTAL HEALTH WORKER: YOU( gmndmothef'S situation is not uncommon wilh detnentia. HowtM!I', we need to be open to the possibility ot elder- abuSe. Seniors with dementia afe a vlJoorable g(oup, and there are certainly Sduations v.t'lere famly membets take ad\<antage of them btf controlli~ and using their money for personal gain. STUDE:NT: So, what's the t'OOt cause ot paranoij delusions? MENTAL HEALTH WORKER: The cause rS stdl unknown, but the consensus is lhat there is no s~ gJ,e cause. Envir0nment, genetics. stress. laek ot sleep, hi~ fevef, side effedS of medication, street drugs. and medical conditions such as st(Okes can all conttibute to paranoia. Paranoia rS also a common symptom in many mental diSO<ders includi~ dementia, schiZOl)hfenia, par'anoid personality drSO<der, and moOCI disorders such as depression and tipolar disorder. ST\JOENT: How do you treat it? M£NTAL HEALnt WORKER: Medications and counselling can be effective, but often people afe unwd\i~ to seek treatment beeause they do not believe they have a problem. M0teovef, they are highly suspicious of lheir doctors and counsellors. Antidepressant, antianxiety, and antipsychOtic medications are often used. Counse!IOl's can help btf working with thei( dients to ens.xe medication complt.ance. When symptoms get noliceabty wOl'se, it rS often a sign lhat they am off theif medication. ST\JOENT: What are some counselling stmtegjes? Mt NTAL HEALTH WORK.ER: Counsellors and others Should avoid being drawn into ar'guments regardi~ the delusion. Most often, such an approad'I wdl be met with fesistance and the client wiU only furthef question lhe moti\ies of lhe hefpef. As atways. relationship is the key to workil'lg effectively with someone who rS paranoid, but this will fe(fuire patience, as 1t is common that the client with paranoid delusions w'III be highty diStrusrhA of counsetlors, particularty if they challenge the validtly of strongfy held beliefs. Generalfy, you·• want to empathize with the client's feeli~ without supporting the delusion. Ho-.vevet, with SOtne clients. empathy may be experienced oogativel'j as an "attempt to get inside lhei( heads_· so the counsellor may need to Shift to a less. threatening topic. Sometimes, the beSI course of action is to distract the diient by changing the subjed Of actMty. Clients who are motivated to overcome paranoia can use anxiely manage. ment techl'liques and cogriitive behaviour'3I strategies 10 addfess unhelpful thinking. Innovative approad'les am atso avatlable. One uses custom.ized avatafS to represent a pe(. son's paranoia, lhen the person lea(ns to confront and control the pamnoia (avata() through role plays and simulations. untrc3tcd. Jn fact, it is sometimes rderred to as the "common cold o f menta1 illness." The signs of depression, sometimes described as clinical depression o r major depression to separate it from ordinary sadnes~ can be organi!cd into four major categories with specific S)rmptoms: t. Mood disturbances ■ constant sad, anxious, or empty mood feelings of hopelessness or pessimism ■ feelings of guilt, worthlessness, o r helplessness ■ Menial Disorders and Substance Misuse 281 CM:r SO bilioo neu-ons i"I the bfain al"d b:)jy communicate with each other- by sendi'lg li1y chemical$ called neurotransmitters from one neuron to another-. A neufon may have actNe neural pathway connections to 10,<XX> or more neu-ons. Dysfunction in 100 neurotransmitter- may be one conlributing factor in a number of mental and physical diSOrdets. A com pl& a«ay of factorS iocludi~ he-redity, social factors, environment life sttess, and othe-r unknown fact0ts make it unlike-ly that a single cause fer mental inness is pre-sent GABA: anxiety and fear (def.cit) Se101onln: depression, mOOCI, sleep. appe-tite, impulSe controt, and aggression Dopamine: Parkinson's disease, schizophrenia. altention deficit hype-ractMly diSOtder, motivation. and depression, moveme-n1 Gllltamale: obSeSSiw<0mpul:Sive disorder (OCD), Sd'li:zophrenia, depression, and autis.m Aeelylchollne: deptes.sion (excess) and deficit (dementia) Horeplnephrfne: depression (deficil) and schizophrenia (excess) Sources: NIMH, 2015; Hefner, 2015: Mohler, 2013: and Beish.am, 2001. 2. Ch3ng:es in behaviour ■ diminished inte.rest or pleasure in d3ily activitie~ including sex ■ decre3scd energy and fotiguc ■ withdraw·nl from others 3. Alterations in thinlcina ■ difficulty thinking, concentrating, and remembering inability to malce decisions ■ recurrent thoughts of dC3th or suicide ■ 4 . Physical complaints ■ restlessness or irritability ■ fatiaue or loss of enc.ray ■ sleep disturbances, indudina insomnia ■ loss or gain of appetite and weight ■ chronic P3in or other pe.rsistent bodil't' symptoms that are not caused by ph,.•sical disC3.sc ■ suicide 3ttempts (American MedicnJ Association, 1998; American Psychiatric Association, 2013; NIMH, 2012). Scott Simmie, a Canadian journ3Jist, describes how his depression included obsession with thoughts of suicide: I spent wttks in bed, un:tble to f'lnd a rea.son t'O ~t up. S1eep wu 11\)' drut- dlt only. albeit te1nporary. Ml)' to esc:,pe what had befallen 1ne. \\1hen ::rwake I brooded. almost obsessiv~I)·, on death. Pietured 11\)'stl( dttinK pulleys $0 I oouJd h::ma 11\)'Sel( in the eondo. .. . Mose mominKS, tilt llrSt thol¢ht that entered my he:3d was to put 2 i[un t'O it. lbna. Problem solved. (Simrnie & Nunes,. 200 I. p. 27) In a repon on diaanosis trends by Intercontinental Medical Statistics Inc. (IMS, 2001), which compiles statistical information for the Can3dian hC3lthcare community, researchers noted th3t visits to 3 doctor for depression have shown the largest increase among C3n3d3's leadina diagnoses. Ourina the period of 1995 to 2000, JMS statistics rcve3lcd that visits to doctors in C3n3da for depression inctc11.Scd 36 percent, with 7.8 million consult3tions with doctors for depressive disorders. Put another way, almost 3 percent of nJI physici3n visits we.re for depression. \Vomcn represented 66 percent of those diagnosed with depression. About 47 percent of individuals (m3lc and fom3Jc) di3gnoscd with depression were in the 3ge group 40 to 59, 3nd 31 percent were from the next largest group. m3de up of individu3ls aged 20 to 39. Significantly, depression 282 Chap1er 9 CONVERSATION 9.2 STUDENT: What ShOI..ICI I do when clients begin halllJC~tiog? TEACHER: The first cotUm ShOulcl be the safely of lhe cli- ent and others. including yourself. Pay particular attention to die-nts whO desctibe voices Otdering them to hurt lhembe a psychiatric emer-gency, particularl'j if lhete is evidence that the clW!nt haS little at.:lity to resist the commandS.. Police intervention may be necessary to bri~ the person to the hOspital. Let's talk abOut vd'lat not to oo. Counsenors need to tesist the tamptation to argue with clients abOut the reatdy of their setves or others (command hattucinations). This might halh.,cinations. Altnough some clients are aware of wtle-n they are hallucinating and have leamed to li\ie 'Mth 1t, others are convinced of their hallucination's authenticity and dis.miss argi.unents to 100 contrary. Their' ex.pe-rience is very real and has to be accepted as such. Thi.s is alSO ltue when dients are delusional; however-, imptobable 0t bizarre the delusion, it is real to lhem. Re~mbe-r that many thi~ can cause haUucinations. When someooo is hallucinating beeause lhey have 1aken a s1ree1 drug such as LSD, the beSt appfoach is to @Mure safely and wait until the effects of the drug dear. I..n some circumsta~ such as 'llf'len the dient has schizophrenia, hallucinations afe g,ener-ally tteated wtth anti psychotic medications. Consec:iuently, feferr-al to a ph)'Sician Or' psyd'liatrist is essential to make sufe that cliants have been assessed fof an appropriate medication to control their hallucinations. Subse(luently, it is important to ensure that clents are taJd~ theif medkation and that their dosage is appropriate. Haih.,cinations can be frigt\teni~, so it is important that counselbrs remain cam a..nd offet reass...-ance to clients that they are safe. The canae1ian Mental Health Association (2015 onU..ne) emphasizes 100 impor1ance ot fespecting a client's personal space and not touching them without invitation. They suggest minimiMg distr-actions and noise, femaini~ calm, and anowiog dients more lime 10 process and fespond are important when dealing with dients ~ are haltuc~ti~. Counsellors sOOUld avoid patronizi'lg 0t huinouri~ clients abOut lheif hallucinations, as lhis behaviour may pfomote further halluc~ atrlg. One way that counsellors can fespond 'Mthout arguing is to simply state lhat they do not sense what theif clients afe ser\S.ing. They can ex.press empathy that ack~dges the lee6~ that clents may be ex.periencing beeause of theif hallucinations. CounsellOrs atso can help dients deal wsth any stressors that may be inc,easi~ the frequeocy of hallucinations. F'Ot example, if being in large crowds or rl"is.u'lg Sleep br"i~ on halludnations., clients can take steps to minimi:ze these pfecursors. It may be helpful to work With clients to help toom learn ski!IS for contfCIU..ng theif hallucinations.. F'Ot ex.ample, they can discipline 1oomselves to dir'ect lheir thoughts and activtties el:Sewhere. One researthet found that silence, isolation, and attention to oneself tend to promote hatlucinalions, but distr-action, explOt'atary activity, movement, and extemal stimulation tend to impede hallucinations <S.lva & Lopez de Sitva, 1976). So simpty diverting dient attention can be a useful strategy. ST\JOENT: I learned something from one of my dients that I found helpflJ and profound. I remembef him saying to me, Ml have a mental di:sor'd,e,, but don't forget I ha\18 the same needs and fears as ENe,Yone else.· I was reminded that he and I were m::,fe a•ke than unlike each other. TEACHER: MOfOOVef, hallucinatior\S and delusions, which often define illnesses such as Sd'li:zophfenia, are common k'I nOf'mal "e. Clar'k (2015) reported that -nanu::::inations, despite common mi:sconceprions, are a part ot normal healthy life: F'o, ex.ample, we might hear a noise and lt'link someone has called our name. Or, in the periOd between waking and sleeping, we nigt\t temporarily rose contacl with reaHy. now ranks second behind essential hypertension as the leading reason for visiting a physician. Moreover, the report su~est~ that almost 3 million Canadians have serious depression, but less than a third of them seek help. SUCCESS TIP Premorbid functioning is a n'l8asufe of how wel an individual coped bef0te the onset of mental disofdet or the nisuse of subStances. Ma tlJe, lhOSe who have a histo,y of success in broad areas of life such as car'eer, relationships, and management of emorions Ml have a more positive prognosis lot success. Asking clients to describe rimes in lheir IN8s when they dkl not ha\18 a prOblem (e.g., when they wete not misusing drugs) is an effective way of identifying strengths as well as reasonable success goalS (i.e., retum to premorbid functioning). Depression is beJieved to be caused by a complex combination of three primary variables-biologicnJ, genetic (inherited), and emotional or environmental (American MedicnJ Association, 1998). BiologicaJ o rigins are associated with brain chemistry and Menial Disorders and Substance Misuse 283 hormon3l activity. RcsC3rch has demonstrated that some families are more likely to have members who suffc.r from depression. Although no specific gene has been linked to depression, the.re appears to be ample evidence that heredity lends to an increased vulnerability to depression. EmotionaJ and environmental causes might include stress.ors such as the death of a loved one, a job loss, or the brc3kup of a relationship. As well, depression might be the result of sleep disturbances. illness, or drug reaction. Depression that originates from physicaJ illness usually abates once the physical illness is trcnt~. Depression is symptomatic of a medical condition in about 10 pc.rccnt to IS percent of all cases. Known physical causes of depression include thyroid disease, adrenal gland disorders., hyperparathyroidism, diabetes, stroke, infectious diseases such as \•iral hepatitis, autoimmune disorders, vitamin and minc.raJ deficiencies, and cancer (American Medical Association, 1998). Thu~ clients who are den.ling with depression should be referred for a medicaJ chcclc,up as an adjunct to counselling. Counsellors can assist people who are depressed in a numbc.r of ways: ■ HcJp them recognize and identify the symptoms of depression. ■ Rdcr them for appropriate medical examination and treatment, whic.h might include medication or hospitalization. ■ HcJp them to develop coping strategics for dcaJing with stress. ■ Counsel them for loss or grief. ■ Assess and manaac suicide risk. ■ HcJp them develop cognitive/behavioural strategies for overcoming low seJf-estccm and other self-defeating thought patterns t.hat often accompany depression. ■ Support and understand emotions. ■ Provide family counselling to intc.rrupt communication patterns that contribute to or escalate depression. Bipolar Disorder With bipolar disorder, depression a1tcrnates with manic episodes. During manic periods, people typically experience heightened energy, a euphoric mood, and a grearJ,., incrca~ sense of confidence, sometimes to the point of grandiosity. They may have sharpened and unusuaJl,.•creative thinking, aJong with a much-decreased need for sJeep. Or they ma,., experience a flight of idC3s (thoughts without logicaJ con.ncction). Alt.hough they may engage in increased aoaJ-directed activities at work or school, they often engage in them without rcg:ird to the consequences, thus, IC3ding to irrational behaviour such as uncontrolled bu)•ing sprees, scxuaJ indiscretion, and foolish business investments (Amc.rican Psychiatric Association, 2013; NIMH, 2012). Scon Simmie's recollection of his mindset when he was in the midst of the manic phase illustrates the irrationality of this state: Despite e"\>erythinK rd been throu~,. I w:lS still oonvineed that I w:lS in pe-rfe<"t health. t~t the real probLe1n wu the (~1lure o( other!? to ~ i : e that somethinK extraordi, nar't' and wonderful h::.d h::,ppentd to 1ne. That I had been spintuall)• re.born. TI,::u 11\)' limitless potential had Onall't' been (reed. (Slnunie &. Kunes. 2001. p. 25) ))}) BRAIN BYTE I C,_:,r ,, ,r Current thinking suggests that it tS a combination of fac:tOrS that results in deptession. For example, if people with a pre,. disposition to depression ex.pe-rieoce stressful life crises. tney may devetop depression. SubSe<!uently, lheif first deptessive epiSOde may stimulate d'langes in brain chemistry 1h31 leave 284 Chap1er 9 tnem more vulnerable to further episodes, when even small stressful events can tr1gger depression (American Medical Association. 1998). Thyroid prOblems (overactive 0r uncleractNe) and hOfmooal imbalances (e.g.• after' chikibirth) can also pray a rde in depcession CTartakovsky, 2015). Thus, it is very difficult, though not impossible, to persuade people to accept treannent. including hospitalization, during the manic phase of the illness. Supportive counsellors, famil't', and friends may convince them to seek trentmcnt. but in some cases., particularly where behaviour has become self-destructive or dangerou~ involuntary hospitalization may be necesS3ry. Bipolar disorder usually begins in adolescence or early adulthood and continues throughout life. It is often not recognized as an illnes~ and people who have it may suffer neo:llcssl)• for yenrs or even decades. There is evidence that b ipolar disorder is inherited (NIMH, 2012). Persons with untreated bipolar disorder ma)' experience devastating complications, including marital breakup. job loss, financiaJ ruin, substance abuse, and suicide. However, almost everyone with bipolar disorder can be helped through the use of medications such as lithium, whic.h has demonstrated effectiveness in controlling both depression and mania. Bipolar disorder ca.nnot be cured, but for most people, treatment can keep the disease under control. Anxiety Disorders A nxiet)' disorders arc characterized b\• higher than normal levels of fear, worry, tension, or anxiet)' about daily events. High anxiety may be present without apparent reason. Four serious anxiety disorders arc obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD), phobia~ panic disorder, and post-traumatic srress disorder (PTSD). anxiety disorders: "'>ce than nonnll 1Mb al fear. 'Mlff)', v.sion.« afllie1y abOCII daily ewnts. Obsessive-Compulsive Disorder (OCD} An obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD) involves recurrent, unwanted thoughts and conscious, ritualized, seemingly purposeless acts, such as counting the number of tiles on the ceiling or needing to wash one's hands repetitively. Behavioural techniques and medication have proved effective in treating this disorder. •asllone'i'-'is repetiiwfy. Phobia A phobia is an irrational fear about particular events or objects. Phobias phobia: An irr.atic.al fear atoll result in overwhelming anxiety in response to situations of little or no danger. Most people have phob ias of one sort or a.nother, such as fear of flying, height~ public speaking, or snakes. For the most part, people dcaJ with their phobias through avoidance, which decreases the anxiety associated with the fear. Unfortunately, avoidance increases the fcar of the particular object or situation. Treatment of phobias is necessary when they interfere with a person's capacity to lead a normaJ life. For example, agoraphobia (fear of open or public spaces) prevents people from leaving the S3fety of their homes. Trcatmcnt in such cases is essential to help clients escape what ,vould otherwise be seve.ret,., restricted lives. \Vith systematic desensitization, individuals with a phobia arc first taught how to manage anxiety through relaxation. \\:'ith the help of the counsellor, they construct a hierarchy of anxiety-provoking events associated with the phobia. Finally, they lcarn how to control their anxiety with progressive.I,., more difficult exposures to the anxietyproducing object or event. ln addition, other specialized bdi.aviouraJ techniques, such as flooding (immersing a person in the situation causing fcar or anxiety), relaxation training. and pharmacologic (drug) trcatment, may be necessary to relieve anxiety disorders. particdar events or obje::ts that mula in t'l!hflelming anriety ii iesp)llse to siiuatioos ■heie tilef! is little or no danga. Panic Disorder A panic disorder involves sudden attacks of terror and irrationaJ fear accompanied by an overwhelming sense of impending doom. During a panic attack. a person may cxpe.ricncc symptoms such as an acccle.rated heart rate, sweating., shaking, shortness of breath, chest pain, and nausea. as well as a fcar of dying or losing control (American Psychiatric Association, 2000). Medication and psychotherapy have proven effective in trcating this disorder. Post.Traumatic Stress Disorder ( PTSD} Post~trau matic str ess d isorder (PTSD) S)•mptoms devcJop following traumatic events such as rape, assault, natural diS3stcrs (ennhquakcs, floods, etc.), war, torture, or an automob ile accident. Symptoms may Menial Disorders and Substance Mi suse obsesSM-Compu.lshe disorder (OCO}: RecurNI, unw•ed thoughts and conscious.. ritualilell s ~ purp)seles.s acts, such as u untii-, the numbs of tiles on tile ttiling oc aeeding to panic disorder: Sudden atlaclsClf tero and irr.atic111I fear~ i . d by an c,,endllelming SMSe Clf impeading doom. 0uri-, a panie attack. a persoo mlJ eq>Hiellce S)'lllp,-s std as an aroeli!rated he.aft ra~ SM:--,_ shaking, shortness o! bieath. dlieSI pail. . .sea. and fear Clf dying or 1os;.g aintd. posHraumatic stress disorder (PTSO): Disabling symptOms such as emotilnal n..t.ess.. sleep dm.bance (11. -mares. difficulty sleeping).• ieli--, tbe Mal fdbaing a tt-atic e.811 sedl as r•. ass.tttt. n.a.111ra1 disaster (earthquakes, foods.. et£:.). •ar. tortuf!, or aa w.omobie accident 285 occur immo:linccly after the event or ma,., be dcla,.·ed by months or 't'C3rs. R«ollec~ tions of the event result in disabling symptoms, such as emotional numbness; sleep disturbance (nightmares, difficulty sleeping): reliving the event; intense anxiety at exposure to cues that remind the person of the trauma: avoidance of activities. people. or conversations that arouse r«all of the trauma; hypervigilance; and outbursts of ange.r (American Psychiatric Association, 2013). PTSD symptoms often dissipate within six month~ but for some people the symptoms may last 't'ears. Relaxation training and counselling are effective tools for treating this disorder. Eating Disorders The two most common eating disorders. anorexia ne.r~a and bulimia, are most likel)• to affect adolescent and 't'oung adult ,vomen, with about 90 percent of all those afflicted coming from this group (NIMH, 2012). Approximately I percent of adolescent girls dcveJop anorexia ner~a and as many as 10 percent develop bulimic disorder (NIMH, 2012). Eventually, half of those with anorexia will develop bulimia (NIMH, 2012). Eating disorders are difficult to rreat because many people refuse to admit that they have a problem and resist treatment. Counsellors and family need to persuade those affected to see.k rreatment, but this can be hard because people with these disorders may argue that their only problem is the "nagging" people in their lives. Because of the life~threatening nature of eating disorder~ involuntary rreatment or forced hospitalization ma,., be necessary, particularly when there has been excessive and rapid we.ight los~ serious metabolic disturbances. and serious depression with a rislc of suicide. The National Eating Disorder (nformation Centre (NEDJC), a Toronto-based non.profit orpni!ation, offers this explanation of the cause of eating disorders: E2tinK d1sordeTS 21re C3used b't' 3 combiMtion o( soc:iet2!. indMdu2I, and l211nily l2ctors. They 2re 21 maiufest3tion o( rompLex underf)•ina str~!es with ;dentity 21nd self~oncept. and of problems t~t often stem from tr.-um2tic experiences and patterns o( soc:ialb,, t.On. E3tina d1sorderS are oopifl¥ behaviourS that provide the indMduaJ with ai, outlet for d1spbcement o( (ee.linv <>r with 21 (false) sense o( be.in¥ in oontrol. Common t'O a.JI ea.till¥ disorders is a per\'asive underi)'ifl¥ sense of pcM•erlessness.. (2005) Social and Cultural Variables For most of recorded history, plumpness in women was deemed desirable and fashionable. But during the last 60 years, particularly in Western cultures, women have been bombarded with media messai;es t